The Project Gutenberg eBook of Tactics, Volume I (of 2), by William Balck

This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms
of the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online at
www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the United States, you
will have to check the laws of the country where you are located before
using this eBook.

Title: Tactics, Volume I (of 2)
      Introduction and Formal Tactics of Infantry

Author: William Balck

Translator: Walter Krueger

Release Date: March 26, 2021 [eBook #64927]

Language: English

Character set encoding: UTF-8

Produced by: Brian Coe, Harry Lamé and the Online Distributed Proofreading
            Team at https://www.pgdp.net (This file was produced from
            images generously made available by The Internet Archive)

*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK TACTICS, VOLUME I (OF 2) ***


 Transcriber’s Notes

 Text printed in italics has been transcribed _between underscores_,
 bold face text =between equal signs=. Text printed in a different
 (sans-serif) type has been indicated ~by tildes~. Small capitals have
 been replaced with ALL CAPITALS.

 Footnotes [513]-[516] were not present in the source document text;
 please see the Transcriber’s Notes at the end of this text for more
 details.

 More Transcriber’s Notes may be found at the end of this text.




 TACTICS

 BY

 ~BALCK
 Colonel, German Army.~


 VOLUME I.

 INTRODUCTION AND FORMAL TACTICS OF INFANTRY.


 TRANSLATED BY
 ~WALTER KRUEGER,
 First Lieutenant 23rd Infantry, U. S. Army,
 Instructor Army Service Schools.~


 Fourth completely revised edition.
 With numerous plates in the text.


 U. S. CAVALRY ASSOCIATION,
 FORT LEAVENWORTH, KANSAS.
 1911




 COPYRIGHT, 1911,
 BY WALTER KRUEGER.


 =PRESS OF KETCHESON PRINTING CO.,
 LEAVENWORTH, KANSAS.=




TRANSLATOR’S PREFACE.


The translation of this book was undertaken at the instance of Major
John F. Morrison, General Staff, who desired to make use of it in the
course in tactics in the Army Service Schools.

It is an epitome of the interpretation and application of tactical
principles in the various armies, discussed in the light of the
tactical views and methods prevailing in Germany, and amplified by
numerous examples from military history.

The professional value of this book to all officers of our Regular Army
and Militia who are endeavoring to gain a working knowledge of tactics,
is so obvious that any comment would be superfluous.

 Army Service Schools,
 Ft. Leavenworth, Kansas,
 December, 1910.




PREFACE.


The first volume of “Tactics,” which appeared in its first edition
in 1896, and for which the preparatory work reached back more than
a decade, now appears in its fourth edition in a completely changed
form. The lessons gained in war and improvements in weapons have
corrected many earlier views. While the Boer war confused the views
on infantry combat and brought forth more lessons in a negative than
in a positive form, the Russo-Japanese war has had a great educating
influence, in that it corroborated the soundness of the lessons
gained in the Franco-German war, but also in that it amplified those
lessons commensurate with the improvements in weapons. The fundamental
principles upon which success depends have remained the same.

For a long time I hesitated to comply with my publisher’s wishes for
a new edition. It would not have been difficult to publish long ago
a new edition, based upon the many lessons of war communicated to me
by members of foreign armies soon after the Russo-Japanese war. But,
after an extended period of theoretical work, I was more inclined
to avail myself once more of the opportunity of gaining practical
experience by service with troops. Pure theoretical reflection is only
too apt to depart from the requirements of practice and to overlook
the friction appearing everywhere. The battalion commander, more than
any one else, is called upon to act as the tactical instructor of his
officers and knows best where the shoe pinches. Moreover, the proximity
of the maneuver ground to my present station gave me an opportunity
of observing the field training of a large number of battalions
and regiments of infantry and artillery, and to compare notes with
brother officers of the other arms. In addition, several trips abroad
and, incidental thereto, visits to battlefields, furnished valuable
suggestions. I postponed issuing the new edition until the publication
of the new Russian and Japanese Drill Regulations, which, with our
own excellent regulations, best illustrate the lessons learned from
the war in the Far East. For this fourth edition I was further able
to draw upon the new French (1904), Italian (1905), Belgian (1906),
U. S. (1904), British (1905), and Swiss (1908) Drill Regulations.
This enumeration alone justifies the statement, “completely revised,”
appearing on the title page.

I have earnestly endeavored to make use of foreign experiences in
detail. The words of Lieutenant-General Sir Ian Hamilton of the
British Army, to whose writings I owe a great deal, deserve special
attention in studying the drill regulations of foreign armies: “It is
a blessing that the greater and prouder an army, the more immovably it
is steeped in conservatism, so that as a whole it is finally incapable
of assimilating the lessons gained by other armies. Military attachés
may discover the most important points in the training and employment
of foreign armies and urgently recommend their imitation, but their
comrades will pay no more attention to them than did Napoleon III.
to Stoffel’s reports on the Prussian army before the outbreak of the
Franco-German war.”

The treatment of the subject matter has remained the same throughout;
it represents, as in the first edition, the principle that tactical
lessons must be deduced from human nature, from the effect of weapons,
and from experience in war, proper regard being had for national
characteristics and historical transmission. _Tactics is psychology._
My statements in regard to fire effect are based, as before, upon the
works of His Excellency, Lieutenant-General Rohne. The publications
of Historical Section I of the Great General Staff and the splendid
works of the late Major Kunz, furnish the basis for examples cited
from military history. An almost too copious literature is already
available on the Russo-Japanese war. The monographs (_Einzelschriften_)
of the Great General Staff, and of Streffleur, especially “_Urteile und
Beobachtungen von Mitkämpfern_,” published by the latter, afford a rich
field for research.

It is not difficult to cite examples from military history in support
of any tactical procedure, but such examples require a very careful
sifting before they can be recommended as worthy models for our action
in front of the enemy.

The Austrians deduced the necessity of the most brutal shock action
from the experience gained by them in their combats in Upper Italy in
1859, and the British were not very far removed from completely denying
the feasibility of making an attack soon after the Boer war; but the
desire to avoid losses was forced into the background by the necessity
of annihilating the enemy. In the Far East the Russians finally had to
learn again the same bitter lessons as at Plevna.

Simultaneously with this fourth edition, there appears in Athens a
translation in Modern Greek from the pen of Captain Strategos of the
Greek General Staff, well known to many German officers from his War
Academy days.

It is hoped that the fourth edition may receive the same kind reception
at home and abroad that was given its three predecessors. For all
communications, suggestions or corrections, directed either to me or to
my publisher, I will be sincerely grateful.

 THE AUTHOR.

 POSEN, March, 1908.




CONTENTS.


 =INTRODUCTION.=
                                                                   PAGE

   =1. War=                                                           1
     Eternal peace                                                    1
     War the _ultimo ratio_ of state policy                           2
     Courts of arbitration                                            3

   =2. Strategy and Tactics=                                          4
     Definition of strategy and tactics                               4
     Relation of strategy to tactics                                  6

   =3. The Method of Instruction=                                     7
     Value of examples                                                8
     Applicatory method                                              10
     Advantages and disadvantages                                    10
     Arrangement of the subject matter                               12

   =4. Drill Regulations=                                            13
     Instructions for campaign                                       15
     Regulations and the science of combat                           15


 =THE FORMAL TACTICS OF INFANTRY.=


 =I. ORGANIZATION AND EQUIPMENT=                                     19

   =1. The Importance and Employment of Infantry=                    19
     Relative strength as compared to other arms                     19
     Élite infantry. Guards                                          21
     Jägers and riflemen                                             22
     Mountain infantry                                               23
     Machine guns                                                    24
     Mounted infantry                                                25
     Patrols and scouting detachments                                27
     Cyclists                                                        28
     Snowshoe runners                                                30

   =2. The Tactical Unit=                                            32

   =3. Organization=                                                 34
     The company                                                     34
     Peace and war strength                                          35
     The battalion                                                   36
     The regiment                                                    37
     The brigade                                                     37

   =4. Intrenching Tool Equipment=                                   38

   =5. The Load of the Infantryman=                                  39
     Comparison of the loads carried by infantrymen in various
     armies                                                          40


 =II. THE FORMATIONS=                                                41

   =1. The Issue of Orders=                                          41
       Trumpet signals                                               41

   =2. The Purpose of Formations. Comparison Between Line and
   Column=                                                           42
     Assembly and route formations                                   42
     Maneuver and combat formations                                  43
     Napoleonic columns                                              44
     Comparison between line and column                              44
     The origin of column tactics                                    44

   =3. The Company=                                                  46
     (_a_) Formation of the company                                  46
       Number of ranks                                               46
       Interval and distance                                         47
       Front and facing distance                                     48
     (_b_) Division of the company into three or four platoons       48
       Losses among officers                                         50

   =4. Length of Pace and Marching=                                  53
     Comparison (table)                                              54
     Double time                                                     55

   =5. Movements of the Company in Line=                             56

   =6. The Columns of the Company.  Movements in Column. Formation
   of Line=                                                          56
     Column of twos                                                  56
     Column of squads                                                57
     Route column                                                    57
     Column of fours                                                 58
     Double column of squads                                         59
     Comparison of column of fours with column of squads             59
     The importance of the squad                                     59
     The employment of the column of squads                          59
     Company column                                                  60
     Column of platoons                                              61
     Column of sections                                              61
     Guidon flags                                                    63
     Posts of platoon commanders                                     63
     Movements in column                                             64
     Suggestions made by Colonel Fumet, French Army                  65

   =7. The Battalion=                                                67
     Normal formation of the German battalion                        67
     The color                                                       68
     Formations in various armies                                    69
     The value of double column                                      71
     The battalion in route column                                   72

   =8. The Regiment and the Brigade=                                 73
     Formation in line or in echelon                                 73

   =9. Extended Order=                                               75
     Thin and dense skirmish lines                                   75
     (_a_) The formation of the skirmish line                        78
     (_b_) Movements in skirmish line                                81
     Advance by rushes                                               82
     Time required for making a rush. Strength of the force making
     the rush                                                        83
     Rising                                                          84
     Short or long rushes                                            85
     Advance by crawling                                             86
     Lessons of the Boer War                                         88
     Lessons of the Russo-Japanese War                               89
     Provisions of the various regulations relative to the advance
     by rushes                                                       90
     Fire while in motion                                            92
     Examples of the employment of fire while in motion              93
     Examples of the employment of rushes                            93
     (_c_) Reinforcing the firing line                               96
     (_d_) Closing up. Assembling. Re-forming                        97

   =10. Supports=                                                    98
     Duties                                                          98
     Distance                                                        99
     Commander                                                      100
     Movements                                                      100
     Formation                                                      100
     Supports in rear of the firing line or not?                    101

   =11. Comparison Between Close and Extended Order=                102
     Necessity of drill                                             104
     Combat drill                                                   105
     Training                                                       105
     Training of leaders                                            109


 =III. THE POWER OF FIREARMS AND EXPEDIENTS FOR MINIMIZING LOSSES=  111

   =A. THE POWER OF FIELD ARTILLERY=                                111

     =1. The Field Gun=                                             111
       Percussion shrapnel                                          111
       Time shrapnel                                                112
       Shell                                                        115
       The French _obus allongé_                                    115

   =2. The Light Field Howitzer=                                    116

   =3. The Heavy Field Howitzer=                                    118

   =4. Expedients for Minimizing the Effect of Fire=                118
     (_a_) Increasing the difficulties in the adjustment of the
     hostile fire                                                   119
     (_b_) Minimizing the effect of fire                            120

   =5. The Results Obtained by Artillery Against Various Targets=   122
       French data                                                  123

   =6. The Effect of Shrapnel Bullets on Animate Targets=           125

   =B. INFANTRY FIRE=                                               126

     =1. The Effect of a Single Projectile on Animate Targets=      126
       Explosive effect                                             127
       Tumbling bullets                                             127

     =2. The Effect of “S” Bullets on Materials=                    131


 =IV. THE EMPLOYMENT OF INFANTRY FIRE=                              132
   Stunning and exhaustive effect                                   132
   The engagement at Modder River, Nov. 28, 1899                    132

   =1. Fire Discipline=                                             133
     The employment of the bayonet; bayonet fencing                 134

   =2. Fire Control and Fire Direction=                             134
     Squad leaders                                                  135
     Company commanders                                             136
     Uncontrolled fire                                              136
     Russian experiences in the Far East                            137

   =3. Selection of the Line to be Occupied=                        138

   =4. The Strength of the Firing Line=                             139

   =5. Ascertaining Ranges=                                         140
     Influence of the knowledge of the range upon the efficacy of
     the fire                                                       140
     Ascertaining ranges by pacing or galloping                     141
     Influence of the terrain upon the length of pace               141
     Errors of estimation                                           142
     Provisions of various regulations                              143
     Memorizing distinguishing marks on the enemy                   144
     Scaling the range from maps                                    144
     Obtaining the range from other troops                          145
     Trial volleys fired for the purpose of obtaining proper sight
     elevation                                                      145
     Range finding instruments                                      146

   =6. Selection of a Target and Time for Opening Fire=             147
     Short or long range fire                                       147
     Limit of long range fire                                       147
     The moral effect of withholding  the fire                      151
     Marshal Bugeaud’s narrative                                    151
     Provisions of various regulations                              153
     General rules for opening fire in attack and defense           154

   =7. Pauses in the Fire=                                          155

   =8. Kinds of Fire=                                               157
     Volley fire and fire at will; bursts of fire (_rafales_)       158
     The rate of fire                                               160
     The influence of the rate of fire upon the efficacy of fire    161
     The volley                                                     163
     Bursts of fire (_rafales_)                                     164

   =9. Rear Sight Elevations and Points of Aim=                     165

   =10. Commands=                                                   166

   =11. The Observation of the Fire=                                167

   =12. The Effect of Fire=                                         167
     Comparison between losses produced by infantry and artillery
     fire                                                           167
     (_a_)  Influence of training                                   168
     (_b_)  Influence of the error in estimating the range          170
     (_c_) Fire effect as regards time. Number of rounds to be
       expended                                                     172
     (_d_) Additional influences affecting the accuracy of fire     173
       Wolozkoi’s theory of the effect of the constant cone of
       misses                                                       173
     (_e_) Influence of rifle-rests in firing                       178
     (_f_) Influence of the ground                                  179
     Danger space and beaten zone                                   179
     Firing upon hill positions                                     183
     Indirect rifle fire                                            184
     Ricochets                                                      185

   =13. Losses In Action=                                           185
     Losses in the various formations                               186
     Losses among officers                                          189

   =14. The Moral Effect of Fire=                                   191
     The impressions produced upon General Bonnal by the battle
     of Wörth                                                       191
     Surrenders of British troops in South Africa                   192
     Limit of endurance in battle                                   193
     The “void of the battlefield”                                  194
     Mixing of organizations                                        195
     Fighting power of improvised units                             197
     Overcoming crises in action                                    198


 =V. DEPLOYMENTS FOR ACTION=                                        201

   =1. Normal Procedure=                                            201
     The normal attack                                              202
     Drill attack                                                   204

   =2. Concentration, Development, and Deployment for Action=       205
     Development for action                                         207
     Deployment for action                                          209

   =3. The Battalion, the Regiment, and the Brigade=                210
     The battalion                                                  210
     The regiment                                                   214
     The brigade                                                    216
     Base units                                                     218
     Examples of changes of front                                   220

   =4. Distribution in Depth and Frontage of Combat Formations=     222
     Dangers of distribution in depth                               222
     Plevna and Wafangu                                        222, 223
     Distribution in depth necessary during the preparatory stage   224
     Contrast between distribution in depth and frontage            225
     Dangers of over-extension (Spicheren)                     225, 226
     Influence of fire effect and morale upon frontage         227, 228
     Influence of the task assigned a force                         231
     Delaying actions. Night attacks. Defense                  232, 233
     Approximate figures for the extent of front that may be
     covered                                                        233
     Frontage of the several units                             235, 236
     The Boer War                                                   238
     The Russo-Japanese War                                         239
     Table of troops per km. of front                               240
     Recapitulation of the most important points governing
     frontage                                                       241
     Provisions of various regulations                              241

   =5. Combat Orders=                                               243
     Combat tasks                                                   243
     Division of work in staffs                                     245

   =6. Communication on the Battlefield=                            246
     Signal and wig-wag flags                                       246
     Signal arrangements in the Austrian, French and British
     armies                                                         248

   =7. Local Reconnaissance of the Infantry=                        248
     Reconnaissance in force                                        251
     The object of local reconnaissance                             251
     Scouting detachments                                           252

   =8. The Importance of the Terrain=                               254
     The attack over an open plain                                  255
     The French group attack                                        256
     Combat sections                                                257


 =VI. MACHINE GUNS=                                                 259

   =1. Development of the Arm=                                      259
     Mounting and method of transportation                     261, 262

   =2. The Power of Machine Guns=                                   262
     Kinds of fire                                                  263
     Combat value of machine guns and infantry                      267

   =3. Infantry Versus Machine Guns=                                268
     Conduct of troops when exposed to machine gun fire        268, 269

   =4. Machine Guns in Germany=                                     270
     Organization                                                   270
     Formations                                                273, 274
     Machine gun companies                                          275

   =5. Going Into Position=                                         276

   =6. The Fire Fight=                                              283
     Machine guns in the engagement at the Waterberg                283

   =7. Machine Guns in Other Countries=                             284
     Switzerland                                                    284
     Austria                                                        286
     England                                                        289
     Japan and France                                               290
     Russia                                                         290
     Machine guns at Liao Yang, 1904                                291

   =8. The Employment of Machine Gun Batteries=                     293
     Rencontre and attack                                           295
     Rear guards                                                    295
     Defense                                                        295
     Coöperation with cavalry                                       296
     Machine guns versus artillery                                  297
     English views                                                  297
     Swiss views                                                    299


 =VII. INFANTRY VERSUS CAVALRY=                                     301
   Deployment for firing                                            303
   Moral effect of a charge                                         306
   Aiming positions                                                 307
   Time for opening fire                                            308
   Selection of sight elevation                                     310
   Kind of fire                                                     310
   Distribution of fire                                             311
   Charge of the French Cuirassiers of the Guard                    311
   Advance against cavalry                                          313
   Infantry versus dismounted cavalry                               313
   Provisions of various regulations                                314


 =VIII. INFANTRY VERSUS ARTILLERY=                                  316

   =1. The Passage of Infantry Through Artillery Lines=             316

   =2. The Advance Under  Artillery Fire=                           318
     Increasing the difficulties in the adjustment of the hostile
     fire                                                           318
     Fire for effect                                                320
     Formations used by infantry when under artillery fire Russo-
     Japanese War                                                   322
     Lessons of war                                            321, 323

   =3. Firing on Hostile Artillery in Position=                     324
     Cover afforded by steel shields                                324


 =IX. THE ATTACK=                                                   329
   Attack and defense compared                                      329

   =1. The Surprise=                                                330
     Examples of surprises                                          331

   =2. The Rencontre=                                               333
     Conduct of the advance guard                                   334
     Issue of orders                                                336
     Conduct of the main body                                       338
     Provisions of various regulations                              339
     Examples                                                       339


 =X. THE ATTACK ON AN ENEMY DEPLOYED FOR DEFENSE=                   340

   =1. Lessons of War=                                              340
     Boer War                                                       340
     The infantry attack in the Russo-Japanese War                  340
     Russian infantry                                               340
     Japanese infantry                                              341
     Examples                                                  343, 344

   =2. The Conditions Upon which Success Depends=                   345

   =3. Preparation of the Attack=                                   346
     Reconnaissance. Preparatory position                           346

   =4. The Coöperation of Infantry and Artillery in Battle=         351
     Preparation of the assault                                     352

   =5. The Point of Attack=                                         355

   =6. Envelopment=                                                 356
     Holding attack                                                 357
     Launching the enveloping force                                 359
     Separation of holding and flank attacks                        361
     Provisions of various regulations                              362

   =7. Removal of Packs=                                            363

   =8. The Employment of Machine Guns=                              365

   =9. The Conduct of the Attack=                                   365
     The advance of the firing line                                 365
     Distances                                                      368
     The fire fight                                                 369
     The superiority of fire                                        370
     Fixing bayonets                                                372

   =10. The Assault=                                                373
     The decision to assault                                        373
     The decision to assault emanating from the firing line         375
     Fire support during the assault                                379
     Bayonet fights                                                 382
     Wounds produced by cutting weapons                             384
     Assaulting distances                                           385
     Conduct after a successful attack                              385
     Conduct after an unsuccessful attack                           386

   =11. The Use of the Spade in Attack=                             387
     Sand bags                                                      390
     Results of Russian experiments                                 390
     Provisions of various regulations                              392
     General rules governing the use of the spade in attack         393

   =12. The Employment of Reserves=                                 394
     Launching or withholding reserves                              395

   =13. The Conduct of the Leaders in Action=                       399

   =14. United Action Versus Tactical Missions=                     401
     The attack on the “Tannenwäldchen” at Colombey Aug. 14,
     1870                                                      402, 403
     The attack on Grugies  (St. Quentin)                           403
     The dangers of assigning tasks                                 405


 =XI. THE DEFENSE=                                                  408

   =1. The Passive Defense=                                         409

   =2. The Defense Seeking a Decision=                              409
     Troops required to occupy the position                         410
     Division of the position into sections                         411
     Advanced positions                                             413

   =3. Fortifying the Position=                                     415
     Battalion groups                                               417
     Observation of the foreground                                  420
     Clearing the foreground                                        421
     Dummy intrenchments and masks                                  421
     Cover trenches and communicating trenches                      421
     Obstacles                                                      422
     Russian views                                                  422

   =4. The Conduct of the Defense=                                  423
     Protection of the flanks                                       425
     Employment of machine guns                                     425
     Occupation of the position                                     426

   =5. The Counter-Attack=                                          428
     Position of the general reserve                                429
     The moment for making the counter-attack                       432
     The counter-attack after the position is carried               433
     The counter-attack in conjunction with a movement to the rear  434
     Frontal counter-attack                                         436
     Provisions of various regulations                              438


 =XII. THE RETREAT=                                                 440
   Breaking off an action                                           441
   Rallying positions                                               442


 =XIII. CONTAINING ACTIONS=                                         445
   The delaying action and the holding attack                       445

 =XIV. THE INFANTRY COMBAT ACCORDING TO VARIOUS DRILL REGULATIONS=  448
   The Austrian Drill Regulations of 1903                           448
   The Italian Drill Regulations of 1903 and 1906                   451
   The French Drill Regulations of 1904                             453
   The British Drill Regulations of 1905                            459
   The Japanese Drill Regulations of 1907                           463
   The Russian Drill Regulations of 1907                            466
   The Swiss Drill Regulations of 1908                              466


 =XV. THE EXPENDITURE AND SUPPLY OF AMMUNITION=                     468

   =1. Historical Sketch=                                           468
     Table showing ammunition supply of the various armies of the
     world                                                          475

   =2. Regulations Governing the Supply of Ammunition in Armies=    476
     Germany                                                        476
     Austria                                                        479
     Russia                                                         480
     France                                                         480
     England                                                        482
     Italy                                                          483

   =3. What Deductions May Be Made From the Regulations of the
   Various Armies=                                                  483


 =INDEX=                                                            487


 =INDEX OF EXAMPLES FROM MILITARY HISTORY=                          527




ABBREVIATIONS USED IN THIS TRANSLATION.


 C. D. R.    = Cavalry Drill Regulations.
 F. A. D. R. = Field Artillery Drill Regulations.
 F. A. F. R. = Field Artillery Firing Regulations.
 F. S. R.    = Field Service Regulations.
 Gen. St. W. (_Generalstabswerk_) = German General Staff account of the
             Franco-German War (unless otherwise indicated).
 I. D. R.    = Infantry Drill Regulations.
 I. F. R.    = Infantry Firing Regulations.

 g. = gram = 15,432 troy grains.
 kg. = kilogram = 1000 g. = 2.2 lbs.
 kgm. = a unit of work accomplished in raising a kilogram through a
        meter against the force of gravity.
 m. = meter = 39.37 in.
 km. = kilometer = 1000 m. or ⁵⁄₈ mile.
 x = pace.




INTRODUCTION.


1. WAR.

Clausewitz, in his work _On War_, defines war as “a continuation of
state policy by other means; an act of violence committed to force
the opponent to comply with our will.” The civil code is incapable
of furnishing full satisfaction to individuals in cases of outraged
honor, and is obliged, under certain circumstances, to allow the
injured party to obtain such satisfaction by immediate chastisement of
the offender or by challenging him to a duel. In like manner there is
no law which could afford nations complete satisfaction for affronts
to their honor; and it is obvious that it would be as impossible to
abolish war in the world, in the family of nations, as it would be to
abolish dueling among the subjects of a state. The total abolition of
dueling would produce the same results on the life of the individual
that the cessation of wars would produce on the development of the
national life of every state and on the intercourse of nations with
one another. “Eternal peace,” wrote Moltke on December 11th, 1880,
to Professor Bluntschli, “is a dream, and not even a beautiful one;
for war is a part of God’s system in ruling the universe. In war, man
develops the highest virtues; courage and unselfishness, devotion to
duty and self-sacrifice even to death. Without war the world would
stagnate in materialism.” Treitschke ventured a similar opinion in
1869.[1] “Every nation, especially a refined and cultured one, is apt
to lapse into effeminacy and selfishness during a protracted period
of peace. The unlimited comfort enjoyed by society causes not only
the downfall of the state but destroys at the same time all those
ideals which make life worth living. Narrow provincialism or selfish
and worldly activity, looking only toward the gratification of all
desires of the individual, undermines the foundations of a higher
moral philosophy and the belief in ideals. Fools arrive at the vain
conclusion that the life object of the individual is acquisition and
enjoyment; that the purpose of the state is simply to facilitate the
business affairs of its citizens; that man is appointed by an all-wise
providence to buy cheaply and to sell at a profit; they conclude that
war, which interferes with man’s activities, is the greatest evil, and
that modern armies are only a sorry remnant of mediaeval barbarism.
* * * It proves a positive blessing to such a generation if fate commits
it to a great and righteous war, and the more it has become attached
to the comfortable habits of mere social existence, the more violent
the reaction which rouses it to warlike deeds in the service of the
state. * * *” “The moment the state calls, ‘My life, my existence is at
stake,’ there is aroused in a free people that highest of all virtues,
the courage of self-sacrifice, which can never exist in time of peace
nor be developed to such an extent by peaceful pursuits. Millions
are united in the one thought--the fatherland; they are animated by
that common sentiment of devotion unto death--patriotism--which, once
experienced, is never again forgotten, and which ennobles and hallows
the life of a whole generation. * * *” The greatness of war lies in
those very phases which an effeminate civilization deems impious. “A
great nation must be powerful,” exclaimed Scherr, in 1870.[2] “That
is not only its duty, but its nature. If opposition is encountered, a
nation is not only permitted to force a way for its righteous cause and
resort to war, but it is its duty to do so. War always has been, and,
so long as men and nations exist on the earth, it always will be, the
_ultima ratio_.”

   [1] _Das konstitutionelle Königtum in Deutschland_, in _Historische
 und politische Aufsätze_, New edition, II.

   [2] _Das grosze Jahr_, in _Hammerschläge und Historien_.

Since war is the _ultima ratio_ of state policy, and as a sovereign
state must insist on absolute independence in determining its affairs
and its course of action, it follows that the verdict of a court of
arbitration, on the larger and more serious questions, can have a
decisive influence on the action of the contending parties only if
the arbitrator possesses the power to enforce his decision, and is
embued with a determination to use that power. Thus the Pope was able
to arbitrate the question of right between Germany and Spain as to the
possession of the Caroline Islands, but a like verdict could never
decide the question of might between Germany and France as to the
possession of Alsace-Lorraine.[3]

   [3] The constitution of the old German Confederation provided for
 a settlement of disputes arising among its members; this verdict was
 to be enforced by summary proceedings when necessary. The war of
 1866 proved that the paragraphs of the constitution mentioned, of
 necessity had to fail the moment the vital interests of two powerful
 states came into conflict. See VON LETTOW-VORBECK, _Geschichte des
 Krieges von 1866_, I, p. 115.

The utopian plans for a universal international court of arbitration
are chimerical and conjured up by idealists unacquainted with the harsh
facts of reality, if their ideas are not, indeed--as are many proposals
for disarmament--calculated to serve as a cloak for ambitious plans.

If diplomatic means do not suffice to adjust a dispute, then the
question of right between two states at once becomes a question of
might. But the existence of a spirit of fair play is taken into account
nevertheless, for each party to the controversy will seek to have
the justice of its cause recognized. The moral support engendered by
fighting for a just cause is so great that no state is willing to
dispense with it.[4] This circumstance, coupled with the growing power
of public opinion and with the influence of representative government,
has contributed to reduce the number of wars. Wars between cabinets,
like those in the days of Louis XIV., are no longer possible. As a
result of the universal liability to service, the whole nation takes
part in a war; every class of society suffers and has its pursuits
interfered with; everything presses to an early decision, to a prompt
crushing of the opponent.

   [4] “If princes wish war they proceed to make war and then send for
 an industrious jurist who demonstrates that it is therefore right.”
 FREDERICK II.

   “Every war is just which is necessary and every battle holy in
 which lies our last hope.” MACHIAVELLI, _Il Principe_.

This is attained by defeating the enemy’s forces, by occupying the
hostile country and seizing the enemy’s sources of supply, so that he
will be convinced of the futility of further resistance. (Campaigns of
1859, 1866, and 1870-71). Only in the rarest cases will it be necessary
to continue the war until the power of resistance of the hostile state
is completely destroyed. (American Civil War). The extent to which the
enemy’s power of resistance may have to be crippled or broken, in order
to compel peace, depends upon his tenacity. Political considerations
will also have to be taken into account in answering this question.
From the military point of view, however, the purpose of every war will
always be the complete overthrow of the enemy.


2. STRATEGY AND TACTICS.

Precise definitions of strategy and tactics, clearly fixing the scope
of each, have been vainly sought in the past. That efforts in this
direction have led to no results is only natural, as tactics and
strategy are complementary subjects that often encroach upon each
other, while grand tactics is frequently identical with strategy.

Von Bülow, the author of _The Spirit of Modern Warfare_ (1798)[5],
calls those movements strategical which are made outside the enemy’s
sphere of information. Von Willisen considers strategy the science
of communications, tactics the science of fighting. Von Clausewitz
calls strategy the science of the use of battles for the purpose of
the war (Jomini: “_l’art de diriger les armées sur les théatres
d’opérations_”)[6], tactics the science of the use of military forces
in battle (Jomini: “_l’art de diriger les troupes sur les champs de
bataille_”).[7][8] General von Horsetzki (1892) defines strategy as the
study of the conditions necessary for success in war. Archduke Charles
calls strategy the “science of war” and tactics the “art of war”.
Frederick the Great and Napoleon always employed the term “_l’art de
guerre_” instead of the term “_strategy_”. None of these definitions
are comprehensive enough, because they do not cover marches, outposts,
the supply service, and enterprises in minor tactics. Professor
Delbrück’s definition is much more appropriate: “Strategy is the
science of utilizing military resources for the attainment of the
object of the war, tactics the art of leading troops into and in
battle.” Thiers, the French historian, instead of seeking to define
strategy and tactics, contents himself with explaining the problems
of each: “_Le stratège doit concevoir le plan de campagne, embrasser
d’un seul coup d’oeil tout le théatre présumé de la guerre, tracer
lignes d’opérations et diriger les masses sur les points décisifs. Le
tacticien a pour mission de régler l’ordre de leurs marches, de les
disposer en bataille aux différents points, indiqués par le stratège,
d’engager l’action, de la soutenir et de manoeuvrer pour atteindre le
but proposé._”[9] Fieldmarshal Moltke calls strategy “the application
of common sense to the conduct of war.”[10] For practical purposes it
is sufficient to define strategy as the _science of the conduct of
war_, tactics as the _science of troop-leading_. Strategy brings about
the decision on the theater of war, while the duty of carrying it out,
in the manner desired by the commander-in-chief, devolves upon tactics.
Thus the strategical idea culminates on the battlefield. The concentric
advance of the Prussian armies into Bohemia in 1866 naturally led to a
complete envelopment of the Austrians on the field of Königgrätz. The
German attack in the battle on the Hallue, Dec. 23rd, 1870, was based
on the strategical requirement of driving the French from their line of
retreat leading to Arras and Bapaume, by enveloping their right flank.
The attempts made by the 15th Infantry Division, which was holding the
enemy in front, to envelop the left wing of the French, interfered
with the execution of the correct strategical plan. Thus, in following
up a success, in itself quite unimportant (the capture of Bussy), the
leading basic principle was forgotten. The same thing happened here
that Moltke censured in his official report on the war of 1866, wherein
he stated: “The higher commanders have not been able to make their
influence felt down to the subordinate grades. Frequently, as soon as
the divisions and brigades have come in contact with the enemy, all
control over them has entirely ceased.”

   [5] _Geist des neueren Kriegssystems._

   [6] “The art of directing armies In the theater of operations.”

   [7] “The art of directing troops on the field of battle.”

   [8] “Everything affecting the use of troops in battle and the
 regulation of their activity with reference to battle, has been
 included in the term ‘tactics’, while the term strategy is synonymous
 with ‘generalship,’ exclusive of such matters as fall into the domain
 of tactics.” BLUME, _Strategie_, p. 33.

   “Tactics teaches _how_, and strategy _why_, one should fight.”
 General V. SCHERFF.

   Strategy determines direction and objective of the movement of
 armies, while the manner of execution belongs to tactics.

   [9] “Strategy should devise the plan of campaign, take in with a
 comprehensive glance the entire probable theater of war, establish
 the lines of operations and direct the masses on the decisive points.

   “It is the mission of the tactician to decide upon the order of
 march of the troops, to form them for battle at the various points
 determined by strategy, to begin the action, to sustain it, and to
 maneuver so as to attain the desired end.” THIERS.

   [10] V. MOLTKE, _Tactical Problems, No. 58_ (1878) p. 133.

Archduke Charles considered the subordination of tactics to strategy
a law. “Tactics should execute the conceptions of strategy; where the
two come in conflict, where strategical considerations are opposed to
tactical interests, the strategical considerations should, as a rule,
take precedence. Tactics must occupy a subordinate place and attempt to
neutralize existing disadvantages by skillful dispositions.” Clausewitz
not unjustly censures Archduke Charles for placing advantages of
terrain in the first rank, and for failing to attach the proper
importance to the annihilation of the hostile forces. Should the
demands of strategy conflict with those of tactics on the battlefield,
the latter must unquestionably take precedence, since the general’s
foremost thought must be the annihilation of the hostile forces.
Tactical considerations should likewise govern in the selection of the
direction of attack in a battle, strategical reasons for striking in
this or that direction becoming effective only after the attainment of
tactical success. It is true that strategy, by directing the armies and
their concentration on the battlefield, provides tactics with the tools
for fighting and assures the probability of victory; but, on the other
hand, the commander-in-chief appropriates the fruits of each victory
and makes them the basis for further plans. “The demands of strategy
are silent in the presence of tactical victory; they adapt themselves
to the newly created situation.” Fieldmarshal MOLTKE.[11]

   [11] The view that the direction of attack should be governed by
 the possibility of easy execution in minor warfare only, is held by
 General v. Scherff, who says: “General v. Moltke was not influenced
 by the question ‘will the attack here or there be tactically
 easier or more difficult?’ Only the question, ‘will it there be
 strategically advantageous or not’ was able to determine his course
 with reference to measures on the battlefield.”


3. THE METHOD OF INSTRUCTION.

While Archduke Charles considers mathematical axioms the basis of the
higher art of war, military history is for us the principal source from
which to gather knowledge.[12]

   [12] See lecture by Prince HOHENLOHE: _Kriegserfahrung und
 Kriegsgeschichte_, Neisse, 1879.

   “Let my son often read and meditate upon history; it is the only
 true philosophy. Let him often read and meditate upon the wars of the
 great captains; it is the only means of learning the art of war.”
 NAPOLEON I., on April 17th, 1821.

   “Past events are useful to feed the imagination and furnish the
 memory, provided their study is the repetition of ideas that judgment
 should pass upon.” FREDERICK THE GREAT.

In military history we have a guide by which, if we lack personal
experience in war, we can test the results of our reflections and of
our experience on the drillground. Military history moreover enables
us to appreciate those controlling factors which, in map problems,
do not appear at all, and which, in exercises on the terrain, appear
only in a restricted measure. One must learn the conduct of war from
the experience of others; one’s own experience is costly and is almost
invariably gained too late. That experience in war, of itself, is
not sufficient (aside from the fact that it is gained too late in a
given case) is illustrated by the defeat of the Austrians in 1866,
of the French in 1870-71, and of the British in South Africa. “_Les
Autrichiens_,” says Colonel Foch,[13] “_ont fait la guerre sans la
comprendre, les Prussiens l’ont compris sans la faire, mais ils l’ont
étudiée._” “Military history is neither a compilation of clever
theories nor a book designed for whiling away idle moments. It is,
on the contrary, a careful teacher, who, if we are attentive, allows
us to view and grasp matters which we have never before been in a
position to see, but which, nevertheless, are liable to confront us
in the same, a similar, or a changed form, and demand unpremeditated,
instant and decisive action, entailing heavy responsibilities. Military
history, it is true, offers us, in the first instance, only events and
their outline, conditions and phenomena, but it also presents, what
the cleverest theory is unable to furnish, a graphic illustration of
the disturbing elements in war, an illustration of the influences,
doubts, embarrassments, unforeseen accidents, surprises and delays. It
describes the course pursued by commanders and by practical military
common sense in surmounting these difficulties. It prepares in advance
the mental balance necessary at the moment of action; it should prepare
also for the unexpected. It affords a substitute for lack of military
experience, for the accumulation of which the life of the individual,
prior to the moment of action, has been too short.”[14] The pedantic
enumeration of a few examples in support of a stated opinion cannot
suffice. It should not be difficult to find examples from military
history in support of any opinion; frequently even an incorrect
tactical contention can be vindicated by such examples. For in war
the action taken is as often wrong as correct; the scales are turned
by factors which in most cases appear indistinctly or not at all. The
experiences of military history must, therefore, only be used with
caution if tactical lessons are to be drawn from them. “A mere allusion
to historical events,” says Clausewitz in his chapter on examples, “has
the further disadvantage that some readers are either not sufficiently
acquainted with these events, or remember them too imperfectly to enter
into the author’s ideas, so that such students are compelled to accept
his statements blindly or to remain unconvinced. It is, of course, very
difficult to describe historical events as they ought to be described
if they are to be used as proofs, for authors usually lack the means,
as well as the time and space, necessary for such descriptions. We
maintain, however, that in establishing a new or a doubtful view, a
single event, thoroughly described, is more instructive than a mere
allusion to ten. The principal evil resulting from a superficial
reference to historical events does not lie in the fact that the author
cites them incorrectly in support of his theory, but in the fact
that he has never become thoroughly acquainted with those events. In
consequence of such a superficial, haphazard treatment of history, a
hundred erroneous views and theoretical projects are created, which
would never have appeared if the author had been compelled to deduce,
from a careful analysis of the connected facts in the case, what he
publishes and wishes to support by historical proofs. If we have
convinced ourselves of the above outlined difficulties attending the
employment of historical examples, and appreciate the necessity for
thoroughness in their treatment, we will come to the conclusion that
the more recent military history is the most natural source from which
to select examples, inasmuch as recent history alone is sufficiently
known and analyzed.”[15] The events from military history mentioned in
this work are cited simply as proofs of certain phenomena; the proper
analysis of these proofs must be left to the student.

   [13] _Principes de la Guerre_, 1903.

   “The Austrians,” says Colonel Foch, “made war without understanding
 it; the Germans understood war without making it; but they studied
 it.”

   [14] From _Meinungen und Mahnungen_, Vienna, 1894.

   [15] _On War_, II, Chapter 6, p. 111.

   See also CLAUSEWITZ’ remarks on “_Criticism_,” II, Chapter 5.

The applicatory method[16] is used frequently by preference as the
system of instruction, but its creator, General von Verdy du Vernois,
considers it merely a complement of the deductive method, on which
it is predicated and based. “The weakness of the whole applicatory
system of instruction lies in the fact that a textbook based upon it,
although written by a master hand, can portray only isolated examples,
and that these, studied again and again, soon lose their value in the
same manner as a maneuver terrain that has become too well known. For,
although we ordinarily find principles represented in a connected
form, this method of instruction can only convey them in a fragmentary
manner in connection with the details of the events described.”[17]
The success of the applicatory method depends largely upon the
individuality of the instructor, and owes its charm to the personal
intercourse between teacher and pupil. Only an expert, who possesses a
thorough professional knowledge, who is master of his subject, and who
has the faculty of presenting it skillfully, will be able to produce
imaginary scenes which faithfully represent reality and are free from
objectionable features. By constant practice with specific cases, under
the most diverse situations, the nature of war may in this way be
taught and initiative developed as well as facility acquired in issuing
appropriate, clear, and concise orders. One danger of using nothing but
the applicatory method must be noted. The instructor, as representative
of a definite theory, finds it comparatively easy to select the
conditions governing a specific case in such a way that the theory
which he represents necessarily appears to be the correct one. This is
especially true when the director of an applicatory problem determines
the action of the opposing side. The two methods (the applicatory, or
inductive, and the deductive) must be so supplemented that the lesson
in tactics clearly illustrates the purpose and object of a tactical
operation and allows of the attainment of a thorough knowledge of the
means necessary to gain that object.[18] “He who is able to understand
the situation, has a definite purpose in view, and knows the means with
which to carry out that purpose, will, by a simple mental operation,
arrive in each particular case at an appropriate decision, and will be
able, furthermore, to carry out that decision, provided he does not
lose his head. If a clear comprehension of the purpose in view and
of the means for carrying out that purpose lie within the sphere of
theory, the estimate of the situation and the decision are governed by
the circumstances of the particular case. Should the training in this
direction lie outside the sphere of theory, it will logically belong to
the domain of the applicatory method of instruction. The two methods
must, therefore, supplement each other.

   [16] See KÜHNE, _Kritische Wanderungen_, 4 and 5, Preface p. 5.

   [17] VON BOGUSLAWSKI, _Entwickelung der Taktik_, II, p. 17.

   [18] “When one attempts to establish a principle, immediately
 a great number of officers, imagining that they are solving the
 question, at once cry out: ‘Everything depends on circumstances;
 according to the wind must the sails be set.’ But if you do not know
 beforehand which sail is proper for such and such a wind, how can you
 set the sail according to the wind?” BUGEAUD, _Aperçus sur quelques
 détails de guerre_.

If the decision is to culminate in action, strength of character
is required, providing the determination to execute, in spite of
unavoidable difficulties, what has been recognized as proper, and also
the professional ability necessary to carry out the determination to
its logical conclusion. All that theory can do toward forming this
character is to emphasize its importance and to refer students to
military history. The applicatory method, however, can develop strength
of character by compelling the student to form decisions under pressure
of a specified time limit (in solving problems) or by subjecting him to
the influences of certain situations such as would be encountered in
war (maneuvers). The means available in tactical instruction in time
of peace, for the development of strength of character, are, however,
very limited when compared with the great demands made by the abnormal
conditions of war, so out of all proportion to those of peace. This
should be thoroughly understood, lest we overestimate the value of
these means as well as the results to be obtained from them in times of
peace.

After theory has fulfilled its mission of clearly indicating the
purpose and object of an operation, as well as the means by which it
may be attained, and applicatory practice has performed its office
of developing initiative and professional skill, a third factor is
still necessary--the study of military history. From this fountain
of knowledge both “theory” and “applicatory method” must draw their
material; to this source they must again and again refer in order to
guard against erroneous ideas of their own creation, which are often as
different from reality as day is from night.”[19]

   [19] F. C. V. H. (_Fieldmarshal Lieutenant General_ CONRAD V.
 HÖTZENDORF, Chief of Staff of the Austro-Hungarian Army). _Zum
 Studium der Taktik_, p. 2.

Viewed as the science of the leading and employment of troops, tactics
may be divided into two parts:

1. =Formal tactics=, or that contained in drill regulations. This
portion of tactics furnishes the formations used by troops when
assembled, on the march, and in action, and contains the regulations
governing the conduct in battle of troops acting alone without regard
to the coöperation of the other arms, and without reference to the
terrain.

2. =Applied tactics=[20] deals with the combined action of the several
arms on the march, in camp, and in action, taking into account
influences of the terrain, seasons, and the time of day in field
warfare. Fortress warfare should, strictly speaking, be included under
this heading; that is to say, the employment of tactical principles[21]
pertaining to the mobile arms, in conjunction with foot-artillery and
technical troops on a prepared battlefield. The principles are the
same in field and fortress warfare; the only difference between them
lies in the employment of the means necessitated by the preparation
of a field of battle in time of peace. Military history shows that a
clear distinction between field and fortress warfare is impossible.
(Sebastopol, Düppel, Plevna, and Port Arthur).

   [20] V. BOGUSLAWSKI, _Entwickelung der Taktik_, II, Chapter
 23. “The higher, Grand Tactics, is the Initiation and conduct of
 battles--subordinate, or minor tactics, is the manner of fighting, or
 the battle-tactics of an arm considered in its details.”

   [21] MAJOR GUNDELACH, _Exerzierreglement und Festungskrieg_,
 Berlin, 1908.


4. DRILL REGULATIONS.

Drill regulations are the accumulation of the tactical views and
lessons of a certain period. They illustrate the tactical condition
which becomes perceptible at the moment of a certain development of
the fighting tools as represented by man and weapons. Man, in his
peculiarities, in his weaknesses, is the constant. He constitutes the
psychological element, inseparable from the science of combat, and
as such is the definitely given magnitude; the effect of weapons,
however, appears always as the variable factor. New weapons, therefore,
necessitate new tactics.

It will be observed also “that changes of tactics have not only taken
place _after_ changes in weapons, which necessarily is the case, but
that the interval between such changes has been unduly long. This
doubtless arises from the fact that an improvement of weapons is due to
the energy of one or two men, while changes in tactics have to overcome
the inertia of a conservative class; but it is a great evil. It can be
remedied only by a candid recognition of each change.”[22] The history
of the tactics of the 19th Century furnishes more than one instructive
example of the magnitude of such “obstinate conservatism.”

   [22] MAHAN, _The Influence of Sea Power upon History_, pp. 9 and 10.

It is a marked peculiarity of manuals of instruction, that, no
matter with what far-sightedness such regulations may have been
originally compiled, they become antiquated in a comparatively short
time. Napoleon estimated this period at ten years. Frequent changes
are certainly not desirable, if tactical development is not to be
interfered with and if inconveniences are to be avoided in organizing
our mobile army from our peace organizations, Reservists, and Landwehr.
On the other hand, the regulations must keep abreast of requirements
if the conditions to which they owe their existence have changed. In
his “Military Fantasies” the Prince de Ligne wrote in 1783: “An article
which should be added to all drill regulations, and which, I know not
why, is omitted, is: ‘Act sometimes contrary to the regulations.’
It is just as necessary to teach that one must act contrary to the
regulations, as to teach the disorder of troops as it will occur in
action.”

It is always dangerous to be behind the times, as troops thereby
relinquish a superiority previously possessed over others, which
knowledge they must later purchase, with streams of blood, in the face
of hostile bullets. Of what avail, to the Austrians in 1866, to the
Russians in 1877, were all their valiant assaults, made with tactical
formations that had outlived their usefulness in the face of newer
weapons, although made with the firm determination to conquer?

The self-sacrificing spirit and firmly rooted discipline of the
troops found an insurmountable obstacle in the rapid fire of unshaken
infantry. The war experiences of our regiments show that bullets
quickly write a new tactics, demolish superannuated formations and
create new ones. But at what a sacrifice![23] In the Franco-German
war, superior leadership and a better artillery permitted us to pay
this price for the lesson. But how an army fares when it lacks these
auxiliaries is shown by the British experiences in South Africa. The
initial failure of accustomed tactical formations causes a dread of the
frontal attack and finally leads some tacticians to deny entirely even
the feasibility of such an attack. In peace training, therefore, set
forms are of less importance; stress should be laid on developing the
faculty of adaptation to changing conditions of combat and terrain.

   [23] It is frequently customary on the outbreak of a war to issue
 “Instructions for campaign,” in order to prepare troops, trained
 according to superannuated regulations, for action on a strange
 theater of war. It is desirable to disseminate the first experiences
 gained in action to all parts of the army. We failed to do this in
 1870, and all organizations were therefore compelled to gain this
 experience for themselves. Even as late as the 18th of August, 1870,
 the Füsilier Battalion of the 85th Infantry advanced in double
 column formed on the center, although the campaign in Bohemia had
 already demonstrated that this formation was out of date. See MOLTKE,
 _Feldzug von 1859_, p. 65.

Further development and justification of the principles of the drill
regulations, and the modification of those principles under certain
assumptions, are reserved to the science of tactics. Drill regulations
should not be textbooks of tactics, but, on the other hand, a textbook
of tactics should deal with formations only in so far as that is
necessary to ensure a clear comprehension of the fundamental principles.

“Regulations and the science of combat are in a certain sense very
different subjects. The regulations are law, authority--no doubt can
be entertained on this point; but that also invests them with the
character of something fixed, at least for a certain space of time.
They cannot be kept up to date so as to meet quickly enough the rapidly
changing and ever growing demands of modern combat: that would indeed
be an unfair requirement, impossible of realization. Here must enter
the science of combat, which should be independent in every direction,
which should know no fixed rules, and which should point to no other
authority than that of truth and reality. It is not the province of
the science of combat, like that of regulations, to retain that which
is in keeping with prevailing views and forms; it must take into
consideration the fleeting theory and practice, ever developing and
changing anew.”[24]

   [24] KEIM, _Gegenwärtiger Stand der Gefechtslehre_, p. 1.

A positive system of tactics will therefore be based upon one’s own
drill regulations, from the standpoint of which it will investigate
and compare the principles of the service manuals of the different
powers, and finally develop the science still further by the aid of
experience gained from military history and the knowledge of the
effect of weapons. While these are the ever changing but nevertheless
measurable factors of tactical reflection, a third, perhaps the most
important factor, must be added, viz., that the leader must reckon
with the action of men frequently exposed to the influence of great
exertions and great mental agitation. _A doctrine of tactics which does
not properly appreciate the psychological element stagnates in lifeless
pedantry._




THE FORMAL TACTICS OF INFANTRY.


I. ORGANIZATION AND EQUIPMENT.


1. THE IMPORTANCE AND EMPLOYMENT OF INFANTRY.

In all modern armies infantry is, in virtue of its numbers and
importance, the principal arm. Since the introduction of firearms,
infantry has gradually increased in importance and numbers as compared
with the other arms.

 In the Thirty Years’ war, the proportion of cavalry to infantry was
 as 1:1, or 1:2, and frequently the cavalry even predominated. In
 the Swedish army one gun per 1,000 men was considered sufficient.
 During the era of linear tactics in the 18th Century the proportion
 between the two principal arms had become as 1:2 and 1:3; in the
 Napoleonic wars as 1:6 and 1:8. The number of guns was increased to 4
 per 1,000 men. In the course of a campaign the ratio changes to the
 disadvantage of infantry. At the outbreak of the war of 1870-71, the
 relative proportions of the three arms in the German IInd Army were
 as follows: cavalry to infantry as 1:8; and 3.4 guns per 1,000 men.
 The proportion between the two principal arms in the IIIrd Army Corps
 of the German army, at the outbreak of the Franco-German war, was as
 1:18.8; on the first day of the battle of Le Mans it was as 1:16.6;
 at the opening of the campaign there were 4.6 guns per 1,000 men, at
 the close of the campaign 5.8 guns per 1,000 men. This was still more
 marked in the Ist Bavarian Army Corps, which, on October 31st, had
 5.8 guns and on December 9th even 11.1 guns per 1,000 men. At present
 Germany has approximately 6, and France 3.63 guns per 1,000 infantry.

The manner in which infantry fights imprints its distinguishing mark
on the tactics of an entire period; thus, according to the combat
formations of infantry, we may speak of a period of “linear,” “column,”
and “extended order” tactics. Infantry can be equipped more cheaply and
trained more quickly than the other arms. In July, 1870, the French
army consisted of 116 infantry regiments and 21 rifle battalions,
but 38 rifle battalions were raised in addition to a large number of
regiments of _gardes mobiles_ and volunteers.

Infantry is as well adapted for combat with firearms as for combat
with the bayonet, for attack as for defense, for action in close as in
extended order. It can fight on any terrain which is at all passable,
and is more independent of weather and seasons than the other arms; it
surpasses the other arms in endurance, a man, on account of his will
power, bearing privations and exertions better than a horse. On the
other hand, the losses suffered by foot troops in action and through
exertions on the march are greater than those of the mounted arms.[25]

   [25] Percentages of cases of sickness in the campaign 1870/71:

 Infantry:  69.8; Field Officers: 13.26; Captains: 10.19;
 Lieutenants: 3.85%
 Artillery: 57.7;   „       „      4.04;     „      4.84;
 Lieutenants: 4.52„
 Cavalry:   37.5;   „       „      5.61;     „      2.29;
 Lieutenants: 3.24„

The rate of march of infantry is so slow that in reconnaissance it
can only by great exertions attain results which a small force of
cavalry would obtain without appreciable effort. Infantry acting alone
therefore unquestionably requires the assignment of mounted men for
reconnaissance and messenger duty. As regards reconnaissance, infantry
is like a man walking in the dark, who can guard against collisions
only by stretching out his hand and feeling his way.

The lack of artillery support will also make itself felt when infantry
encounters fire at ranges at which it is defenseless, owing to the
limited range of its rifle. Infantry cannot dispense with artillery
when it has to attack localities or fortified points in villages.

The infantry of the 19th Century fell heir to the distinction made
in the 18th Century between heavy infantry (infantry of the line)
and light infantry, the latter being employed only in skirmish duty
and in the service of security. In the 18th Century the expensive
method of recruiting by means of bounties made it necessary to avoid
using troops in indecisive, costly fire actions, and to preserve the
expensive personnel for decisive shock action _en masse_. Skirmishing
was left to volunteer battalions, to Jägers, and to Füsiliers. In
Prussia the number of Füsilier battalions was increased to 24 at the
close of the 18th Century. Napoleon I. was, on principle, opposed
to the theory of light infantry. He demanded but one species of
infantry, “a good infantry.” In spite of this, however, he became the
originator of an _élite_ infantry, when, for reasons of discipline, he
created one _voltigeur_ and one _grenadier_ company in each battalion.
While battalion tactics predominated, _i.e._, until the close of the
campaign of 1866, this arrangement was imitated in most states. At
the time of the Russo-Turkish war, Russia still had in each battalion
a fifth company, one of sharpshooters, which, though not recruited
at the expense of the other companies, was formed of better material
and received special training in extended order fighting. Following
the example set by Austria, Prussia, in 1812, designated the third
rank principally for extended order fighting, by forming it into a
third platoon in each company when in action. This was called the
sharpshooters’ platoon and was composed of the best shots and the
most skillful men of the company. As late as the campaign of 1866
there were instances of the employment of the combined sharpshooter
platoons of a battalion. Here we have an actual _élite_ force assembled
in provisional organizations, not at the expense of the rest of the
troops, however.

The system of column tactics, which required that every company should
be equally skilled in extended order fighting, led to the abolishment
of _élite_ companies. The Prussian _élite_, consisting of the platoons
formed from the third rank, although not always compatible with the
employment of company columns, was not abolished until 1876. The
experience of the Franco-German war had shown that, in view of the
extensive use of extended order formations, an independent employment
of single platoons was out of the question, as in the course of an
action the firing line absorbs not only entire companies, but regiments
and brigades; and, moreover, that every platoon, as a unit for fire
action, must possess those elements which will carry it forward even
after its leader has fallen.

Napoleon formed his Guards by selecting men and officers from the
entire army for use as a battle reserve. By granting them privileges
and by loading them with distinctions, he attached them to his person,
and they assumed the character of household troops of a dynasty.

The Prussian and Russian Guards are differently constituted. They are
not, strictly speaking, _corps d’élite_, for they are not selected
from the ranks of the army. While it is true that the Prussian Guard
receives a better class of recruits and the composition of its corps
of officers and the selection of its commanders guarantee conspicuous
results, its principal superiority lies in the fact that it serves
constantly under the eye of the emperor.

Since the introduction of accurate breechloading weapons, and their
use by all infantry, Jägers and riflemen have no tactical excuse for
existing, except where they are specially trained in mountain warfare
(_Chasseurs alpins_, _Alpini_)[26], or where they are intended to serve
as a support for cavalry divisions. (France). While Jäger-battalions
are at present employed like the rest of the infantry, they are
retained by us as such because of tradition and for reasons of
organization (they are recruited from forestry personnel), and an
attempt is made in their tactical employment to turn their excellent
marksmanship and skill in the use of ground to good account whenever
possible. Jägers will be employed in defense, preferably for holding
important points, and for combat and service of security on difficult
terrain. Military experience has shown, however, that in actual war it
was seldom possible to take advantage of these special characteristics;
that in most cases the Jägers were used as other infantry, and that
infantry units fighting shoulder to shoulder with Jägers accomplished
as good results as the latter. Since the war of 1866 the demand for
special employment of Jägers has ceased. The brief course of the
campaign of 1866, in which our infantry acted mostly on the offensive,
gave the Jägers an opportunity for profitable employment only where,
contrary to accepted notions, they fought side by side with the rest of
the infantry.[27]

   [26] See _Über Gebirgstruppen_, VI, p. 273, and also
 _Schweizerische Monatsschrift für Offiziere aller Waffen_, 1907, May
 to July.

   V. GRAEVENITZ, _Beiheft zum Militär-Wochenblatt_, 1903.

   [27] The 6th Jäger-Battalion on July 3rd at Sendrasitz; the 4th
 Jäger-Battalion at Podol; the 5th at Skalitz; the Jägers of the
 Guard at Lipa; or where during an action a reverse threw us on the
 defensive (1st Jäger-Battalion at Trautenau, and also at Rosberitz).
 The superior commanders, in attempting to assign them a special role,
 frequently employed them unprofitably in taking up rallying positions
 (3rd, 7th, and 8th Jäger-Battalions on July 3rd), sometimes even to
 escort baggage (3rd and 4th Companies of the Jägers of the Guard at
 Soor; and the 1st and 4th Companies of the 5th Jäger-Battalion at
 Schweinschädel); or they distributed them along the whole front for
 the purpose of conducting extended order fighting. When they were
 thus distributed among infantry organizations their efforts merged
 with those of the infantry.

   For example, at Königgrätz half companies of Jägers were posted
 on both flanks of the Guard Infantry Division, and the 2nd
 Jäger-Battalion was on this day distributed by companies along the
 front of the entire division.

   V. MOLTKE, _Kritische Aufsätze zur Geschichte des Feldzuges von
 1866_.

   KUNZ, _Die Tätigkeit der deutschen Jäger-Bataillone im Kriege
 1870/71_. On page 169, et seq., a number of excellent examples are
 recorded (for instance: 5th Prussian Jäger-Battalion in the actions
 on November 29th and 30th, 1870, and on January 19th, 1871, in siege
 positions in front of Paris).

Mountain warfare presents such difficult problems to troops,
requires a sum total of endurance, energy and intelligence, physical
qualifications and special familiarity, that neither every recruit nor
every unit of the army will quite fulfill all its demands, although
the experience of Suworov, during his campaign in the Alps, apparently
contradicts this statement. Many disadvantages can be neutralized by
peace training and discipline, of course, but training alone will not
suffice. For overcoming the difficulties peculiar to mountain warfare,
a suitable equipment permitting free movement, and at the same time
ensuring the comfort of the men while at rest, is necessary. The
lack of such mountain equipment is keenly felt even during short
exercises lasting only a few days. Even Switzerland plans at present
the formation of three mountain brigades. Austria already has special
mountain brigades assembled for mountain warfare in its Kaiser-Jäger,
Rural Riflemen, and also in the troops of Bosnia and Dalmatia. The
Italian _Alpini_ (consisting of 22 battalions in time of peace, to
which militia companies are attached on mobilization, and which have
in addition a reserve of 22 territorial companies) form a selected
corps which is doubtless capable of accomplishing excellent results.
The Italians propose to attach machine guns to these units. It is
worthy of note that these troops carry explosives. In France the troops
garrisoned in the Alpine districts are divided into thirteen groups,
each consisting of one battalion, one mountain battery, one engineer
company, and machine guns.

As modern fire effect makes it impossible for mounted officers to
direct the firing line, it was natural to use the more improved means
of communication, the telephone and telegraph, in addition to the
visual signals employed by the navy.

The improvements made in weapons have had a further influence on the
transformation of the infantry. Even a small force of infantry can with
its magazine fire inflict annihilating losses in a very short time on
closed bodies offering favorable targets, especially when this fire is
delivered from a flanking position. This requires, on the one hand,
that greater attention be paid during combat to local reconnaissance,
which can be but imperfectly made by mounted officers with the troops,
and, on the other hand, it necessitates the employment of smaller
independent detachments for our own security and for harassing the
enemy. Intimately connected herewith is the introduction of machine
guns, possessing great mobility, which enables them to take advantage
of rapidly passing moments for pouring a heavy fire on the enemy and
also for reinforcing the independent cavalry in advance of the army.

In England it was decided to form mounted infantry charged with the
additional duty of augmenting the fire of a cavalry division, and
of furnishing the commander-in-chief with a reserve possessing the
requisite mobility to permit its being thrown to any threatened point
of the long battle lines of today. But of what importance is the fire
of a single battalion in the large armies of the present day? The
principal drawback to the employment of mounted infantry is, however,
that, when mounted, it is defenseless against cavalry, and that, while
in motion, it really needs a supporting force. In the Boer war the
mounted infantry grew finally to a strength of 50,000 men. As it was
not confronted by cavalry, it made good during the execution of wide
turning movements, which Lord Roberts employed with success for the
purpose of striking the flank of the Boers, who always rapidly extended
their lines. In spite of these good services, it could not be denied
that mounted infantry had many faults. The men knew nothing of the care
of their mounts, as is evidenced by the large percentage of horses
which became unserviceable. As mounted infantry units were improvised
bodies, they lacked the requisite training in marching and tactical
employment. After the war had lasted for some time, the mounted
infantrymen, however, had completely forgotten their infantry character
and deported themselves like cavalrymen, even if only as poor ones.
Thus, we find toward the close of the campaign numerous attacks made by
mounted infantry on the British side, as, strange to relate, also on
that of the Boers.

In this experiment of creating mounted infantry, all those drawbacks
which had been learned for centuries were exemplified. As an
improvisation, mounted infantry disturbs the cohesion of organizations;
if permanently organized, it must become cavalry, just as the dragoons
became cavalry: for mounted infantry is neither flesh, fish, nor fowl
and cannot endure.

The British Drill Regulations (1904) for mounted infantry lay down the
following principles for its employment:

 In the practical employment of mounted infantry, sight must not be
 lost of the fact that this arm is drilled and trained as infantry. On
 account of its greater mobility, it should be able to cover greater
 distances, and, in addition, be capable of executing wider turning
 movements than infantry. As a rule, mounted infantry is to be used in
 the following cases:

 (a) It is to perform the service of security in the immediate front
 of infantry divisions in conjunction with cavalry and the horse
 batteries assigned to the latter, in addition to augmenting the
 fire of the cavalry. It is further to occupy, as expeditiously as
 possible, tactically important positions. It is to find positions
 from which it can bring fire, preferably flanking fire, to bear on
 the flanks of hostile cavalry before the actual combat begins. It
 is to improve every success gained and constitute a formed nucleus
 in case of a retreat. Moreover, mounted infantry should enable the
 cavalry divisions, far in advance of the army, to devote themselves
 exclusively to the strategical reconnaissance with which they are
 charged.

 (b) In addition, the mounted infantry is to constitute a light
 mobile reserve which the commander-in-chief can despatch at a
 moment’s notice from one wing to the other for the purpose of lending
 assistance, or for influencing the action at particular points
 and for which other troops are not available on account of the
 extraordinary extension of modern lines of battle.

 (c) Finally, mounted infantry is to fill the role of a mobile
 column in minor warfare or in expeditions in colonial wars, and in
 performing this duty assume the functions of the absent cavalry in
 the service of reconnaissance and patrolling.

 The following is the organization and strength of mounted infantry
 organizations:

 In war every infantry battalion is to furnish one company of mounted
 infantry, consisting of 5 officers, 138 men, and 144 horses; and
 every brigade (4 battalions) one battalion of four companies. To each
 battalion of mounted infantry is assigned: one machine gun platoon,
 consisting of two guns and two ammunition carts (2 officers, 40
 men, and 54 horses). Hence the aggregate strength of a battalion of
 mounted infantry is: 28 officers, 630 men, and 676 horses.

The creation of mounted infantry is only proper where climatic
conditions make long marches by European troops impossible, or in
cases where the arrival of a few soldiers at distant points will exert
a potent influence on the actions of an opponent. As shown by our
experience in Southwest Africa, the proper field for mounted infantry
is colonial (guerrilla) warfare, especially when it is important to
prevent the outbreak of threatened disorders and to let the country
return quickly to a state of peace upon completion of the principal
actions. On European theaters of war, space is lacking for the
employment of mounted infantry, and, moreover, there are not enough
horses. In organizing mounted infantry, an auxiliary arm, which can be
of use only occasionally, has been created at the expense of infantry
and cavalry. The infantry itself should endeavor to meet all demands
for local reconnaissance and communication, without weakening the
cavalry for its principal duties, and without, in so doing, crippling
its own fighting efficiency.

For the purpose of reconnaissance, patrols or scouting detachments are
used. Their usefulness in difficult country and in enterprises against
the enemy’s flank or rear cannot be denied. In minor operations, by
advancing on side roads, they can hamper the enemy’s reconnaissance,
secure the flanks of their own force, ascertain the probable extent
of the prospective battlefield, and, finally, having gained a firm
foothold, they can become very annoying to the hostile artillery. In a
large battle the necessary elbow room for such employment is lacking.
To form special organizations of picked men, as is done in Russia, is
always of doubtful value. An organization cannot dispense with its
best men in action; it needs them as group leaders and as substitutes
for disabled non-commissioned officers. While everything goes without
a hitch, the withdrawal of good men from an organization is of little
importance; the drawbacks to this procedure become apparent, however,
when heavy losses deplete the ranks, when the line begins to waver,
when, in the absence of officers, only the example of courageous men
prevents the weak-kneed from running away. Our regulations properly
appreciate the importance of psychological impressions during
critical combat situations; they state: “The man who feels his
courage and coolness going, in the excitement of battle, should look
toward his officers. Should they have fallen, he will find plenty of
non-commissioned officers and brave privates whose example will revive
his courage.” (Par. 268 German I. D. R.). If it becomes necessary to
despatch a stronger infantry force on a mission of minor importance, it
will usually be better to detail an entire company than to improvise
a detachment whose leader would know his men only imperfectly. From
the standpoint of training, scouting detachments have an entirely
different value. They give young infantry officers, who are tied to
a command, an opportunity to develop self-confidence, decision, and
tactical judgment; to cope with hardships and difficulties on their
own responsibility. In this manner characteristics may be developed in
the young officers which will be of benefit to them in a large battle.
It is obvious that scouts should be assigned bicycles to give them the
mobility which infantry lacks.

If the roads are good, cyclists[28] will frequently be able to take
the place of cavalry in messenger service. In this case they remain
with their organizations and perform the same duties as the other
soldiers. The employment of cyclists is in accord with the principle
that in war every resource the country offers for warfare should be
utilized. The advantage of the use of cyclists for messenger service
and their value to the command generally is obvious; they are, in
addition, adapted for reconnaissance work and for reinforcing the
divisional cavalry. Cyclists, however, do not lend themselves to the
formation of separate organizations for battle purposes (each division
has 110 cyclists), for a large number of picked men would thereby be
withdrawn from the ranks of the troops engaged. An improvised cyclist
detachment would, in addition, accomplish very little, as it would
lack the thorough peace training requisite for cohesive action as an
organization. If the opinion is entertained that cyclist detachments
could furnish substantial aid to the cavalry[29] in advance of the
army, that they could be employed profitably in the supply districts
and in minor operations, and, finally, if the available material in
the country is to be utilized, nothing remains but to proceed to
the creation of cyclist companies in time of peace. The material
necessary for repairs and for ammunition supply can only be entrusted
to permanent organizations. The advantages of cyclists are their great
mobility,[30] their prompt readiness for firing, and, above all else,
the noiselessness of their movements. Their weakness lies in their
dependence upon a complicated machine, in the comparatively large road
space taken up by them on the march (100 cyclists in column of twos
take up about 250 to 300 m. road space), and in their dependence on the
terrain. The last mentioned drawback can be remedied apparently only
by the adoption of a folding wheel, but, since the cyclist’s equipment
cannot be secured on the machine, it is better in difficult country to
push the wheels or to leave them behind under guard when necessary.

   [28] Pars. 78, 82, 86, 99, 101, 132, 151, 152, 194 and 200, GERMAN
 F. S. R.

   [29] By occupying positions so as to give the cavalry freedom of
 action; by advancing ahead of the reconnoitering cavalry for the
 purpose of re-establishing contact with the enemy, of forestalling
 him in occupying important points, or of outflanking him: finally, by
 coöperating with cavalry in cavalry combats, in covering a retreat,
 in outpost duty, and during the execution of technical work.

   [30] According to the _Italian Regulations of 1904_, the rate of
 march of cyclists is as follows: slow rate 8 km., maneuvering rate,
 10-12 km., road speed, 12-17 km., accelerated rate of march, up to 20
 km. per hour. Cyclists can ride up to 80 km., without long rests. For
 riding 90-100 km., from 5 to 6 hours are required.

 In Italy, France, and England more has been done towards the
 formation of cyclist detachments than elsewhere. In Italy each
 _Bersaglieri_ Regiment has one company of cyclists, which is to be
 employed in supporting a cavalry brigade. Cyclists have accomplished
 a good deal in surmounting difficulties of the terrain. In England
 the development of cyclist bodies is left mostly to the volunteers
 and their exercises have demonstrated that such units are capable of
 expanding in a brief space of time.

 In France the cyclist movement is led by Major Gerard, who rendered
 valuable service during a short maneuver of the cavalry division
 (1905). Opinions are as yet divided as to the advisability of forming
 cyclist battalions. Both Major Gerard and General Langlois are
 advocates of their employment. General Langlois desires to oppose the
 brutal German battle tactics with rapid maneuvers of mobile reserves
 which he would form of cyclist battalions, artillery, and cavalry.

According to the Cyclist Regulations dated September 10th, 1904, the
cyclist company is to be looked upon as infantry, which is capable of
moving at great speed, but is tied to the network of roads. The cyclist
companies are principally intended for defensive action, holding
an important point until the arrival of infantry. They are also to
serve as support for cavalry and artillery, but are not adapted for
reconnaissance work. Since it is difficult for them to secure their
flanks on the march, they are to be used mainly in combination with
other arms.

In winter campaigns, when wheel and horse cannot be used, recourse is
had to the Canadian snowshoe (a web shoe) or to the Norwegian snowshoe
or ski (skee). In France, Italy, Austria,[31] Norway, Sweden, and
Switzerland marching on snowshoes is assiduously practiced, while in
Germany the troops have so far done little in this line. The ski is,
however, coming more and more into vogue among the rural population of
the German mountains.

   [31] One of the most remarkable snowshoe marches ever recorded is
 without doubt that made by the ski detachment of the 4th Regiment
 of Tirolese Kaiser-Jägers (Austria) stationed in Salzburg. In
 June, 1905, this detachment, consisting of 4 officers, 15 men and
 4 guides, all with field equipment, marched around the base of the
 “Grosz Glockner,” via Mittersil, Felber-Tauern (elev. 2,500 m.),
 Windisch-Matrey, Lienz, Dolsack, Hochtor (elev. 2,570 m.), into the
 Fuscher valley, despite violent cyclonic snow storms, a journey
 which, even in mid-summer, can only be undertaken by experienced
 tourists. In several of these detachments experiments were made with
 white covers for uniform and equipment, which enabled individual men
 and patrols to approach unseen to within 200 to 300 m. of an opponent.

Deep snow is an effective obstacle for troops not equipped with
snowshoes. This is not entirely due to the fact that the march is
retarded, but to the unusual difficulties attending the service of
security. Covering bodies are stalled. Besides, the difficulties of
maintaining communication with neighboring detachments are increased
when valleys or abrupt declivities intervene between the forces. The
only remedy in such cases is to employ the snowshoe, upon which one
can move rapidly without regard to roads, and up or down hill without
difficulty. Patrols can be despatched to adequate distances from the
marching body on skis alone. Ski-runners can perform the same duty
which cavalry performs on the plain; for instance, they can occupy
points in advance which are of importance to us, dispute crossings
with the enemy, and hold him at bay. Ski detachments alone are able
to reconnoiter the condition of roads and test the carrying power of
snow in advance of a command, and they alone can furnish the connecting
links in an extended outpost position, because they alone are able to
move off the roads. During halts they furnish guards; in action they
easily turn the enemy’s flanks, reconnoiter his weak points as well as
the position of his reserves; and after the fight they maintain contact
with him as patrols. They can hasten forward in advance of a command
and prepare cantonments and bivouacs, and attend to the cooking.

The great depth of a detachment of ski-runners is a disadvantage. Each
ski-runner takes up 2.20 m., and in addition a distance of 1 m. must
be left between men. Besides, as the men are not all equally skilled
in using skis, the road space taken up by a detachment of runners is
increased considerably. This necessitates the employment of small
detachments not exceeding 100 men. The proper sphere of ski-runners is
patrol duty. In winter campaigns ski-runners are a necessary substitute
for cavalry. In Scandinavia reconnaissance detachments are composed
of ski-runners and cavalry, the horses pulling the runners. This
permits a very rapid movement over snow-covered ground and may also be
employed where the use of the much slower sled is impracticable owing
to the nature of the terrain. Much practice is undoubtedly necessary
to acquire proficiency in this sport[32], for it surely cannot be
easy to preserve an upright position on skis behind a galloping horse,
while at the same time overcoming all the difficulties of the ground.
When troopers cannot continue to perform reconnaissance work, they
are replaced by snowshoe or ski-runners. The snowshoe performances in
France, since the establishment by War Department order of a training
school in Briançon, are worthy of note. According to the experiences
gained at that institution, a period of four weeks is ample for
training men for extended mountain marches. On January 18th, 1904, a
body of men on snowshoes covered a distance of 80 km., including a
climb of 1,700 m., in 20 hours (4 hours’ rest included).

   [32] During the Norse winter sports of 1905, the winner covered a
 distance of 67 km. in 2³⁄₄ hours.


2. THE TACTICAL UNIT.

By the term tactical unit is meant the smallest element of a body of
troops capable of sustaining an action independently, of performing
a simple combat task, and the elements of which (man and horse) are
personally known to the leader. Moreover, the tactical unit should be
small enough to allow of its being controlled by the voice of a single
leader. This requirement limits the battle front of the tactical unit
to about 100 m., which corresponds approximately to the front of a
troop[33] (_Eskadron_) in line, or to that of a battery of six pieces.
The frontage of the tactical unit of cavalry might with advantage be
decreased, while that of artillery, on account of its stability in
action, might be extended, were it not for the fact that the increase
in the quantity of matériel and in the number of horses involved in
such extension would make the supervision of the unit too difficult
for a single person. In nearly all large armies the strength of a
troop (_Eskadron_) of cavalry and of a field battery is approximately
150 horses.[34] This corresponds approximately to what the farmer
of northern Germany considers suitable to keep together in one
establishment. If the estate is larger, requiring more than 150 men and
horses, subsidiary farms[35] are established.

   [33] _Eskadron_ has been rendered by “troop” in this work. The
 German _Eskadron_ consists of 4-5 officers, 138-144 men, and 135-139
 horses. It is the smallest administrative unit of the German cavalry
 and is divided into four Züge (platoons). _Translator._

   [34] GENERAL MARMONT, in his _Esprit des Institutions Militaires_,
 p. 41, states that experience has shown that the most suitable
 strength for a troop is 48 files, divided into four platoons; but, he
 recommends that platoons should consist of 16-18 files in order to
 maintain this strength throughout a campaign.

   [35] _Vorwerke._

While column tactics were in vogue, the above mentioned requirements of
a tactical unit were completely fulfilled by the battalion, but this is
no longer the case. It is quite impossible for one voice to control the
movements of a battalion in action; this is scarcely possible in case
of a company. On the other hand, a company is too weak to carry out an
independent mission in action. Nothing less than a battalion possesses
the requisite fighting power, strength, and capacity for subdivision,
to sustain an action independently, to solve minor problems of combat,
and to remain a body full of fighting efficiency even after sustaining
serious losses such as are unavoidable in every modern infantry action.

To attempt a further definition of the term “tactical unit” would be of
little value. General von Scherff in a logical manner[36] constructs
a “troop unit”[37] from “fighting groups”[38] (squad of infantry or
cavalry, or one gun), several of which form a “fighting unit”[39]
(company, troop or battery), “possessing the requisite power to carry
out a specific task,” and placed under the command of a responsible
leader. “The definition of a fighting unit includes, on principle,
its indivisibility in action. Dispersion is a crime, division at
least an evil.” The “combat unit”[40] consists of a number of fighting
units. “The commander of the combat unit (infantry battalion, cavalry
regiment, or artillery battalion) should be able to lead it as a
compact entity, and should have the power of employing its component
parts independently for combined action against some point.” General
von Scherff has found imitators in Austria, where the term body of
troops (_Truppenkörper_) is applied to an organization having the
necessary means for feeding, clothing, and equipping the men, and which
is composed of a number of “basic units.”[41] Such “basic units” as
can be supervised, handled, and controlled directly by one leader, who
knows the individual men thereof and their characteristics, are the
troop (_Eskadron_), battery, and company. Von Boguslawski[42] applies
the term “fighting unit” to organizations from the company (troop) to
the brigade, which act in accordance with the tactics of their arm,
supported by the other arms, in the sphere assigned to them by orders
or by circumstances. Divisions, which, by the coöperation of the three
arms, are capable of independent employment on the march and in action,
he calls “combat units.” According to Boguslawski, army corps are
“battle units,”[43] with which the commander reckons in battle, and
which are strong enough to meet an energetic attack or to execute one
themselves.

   [36] _Von der Kriegführung_, p. 49.

   [37] _Truppeneinheit._

   [38] _Kampfgruppen._

   [39] _Kampfeinheit._

   [40] _Gefechtseinheit._

   [41] _Schlachteneinheiten._

   [42] _Entwickelung der Taktik_, III, p. 125.

   [43] _Grundeinheiten._


3. ORGANIZATION.

The basic unit of infantry is the company, from 200 to 250 men strong
in the larger armies. It seems hardly practicable to exceed a strength
of 150 men, as this is about the greatest number in which a relation
based upon personal influence of the leader on his subordinates can
still be obtained. In armies in which companies are composed of more
than 200 men, the numbers in excess of this figure may be regarded as a
margin of safety, intended to maintain the company at a strength of 200
rifles after the first casualties of a campaign, produced by marching,
detached service and battle losses. In view of the losses, which
frequently increase with extraordinary rapidity in modern battles, it
appears undesirable to fix a lower figure than that above mentioned,
as the companies would otherwise lose their independence and could no
longer be considered basic units.

 ===========+=========+===================================++
            |         |                                   ||
            |         |                                   ||
            |         |                                   ||
            |         |                                   ||
            |         |        (a) PEACE STRENGTH.        ||
            |Company. +-----+--+------+------+------+-----++
            |         |     |  |      |      |Offi- |     ||
            |         |     |N.|      |      |cers’ |Hosp.||
            |         |Offi-|C.|Musi- |Pri-  |Ser-  |Corps||
            |         |cers.|O.|cians.|vates.|vants.|Men. ||
 -----------+---------+-----+--+-------+-----+------+-----++
 ~=GERMANY=~|Minimum  |   4 |15|     4 | 128 |  ... | ... ||
            |Maximum  |   5 |17|     4 | 142 |  ... | ... ||
 -----------+---------+-----+--+-------+-----+------+-----++
 ~=AUSTRIA=~|Minimum  |   4 |11|     2 |  76 |    4 | ... ||
            |Maximum  |   4 |14|     2 | 109 |    4 | ... ||
 -----------+---------+-----+--+-------+-----+------+-----++
 ~=ITALY=~  |Infantry,|     |  |       |     |      |     ||
            |Bersa-   |     |  |       |     |      |     ||
            |glieri   |   3 |13|   ... |  87 |  ... | ... ||
            |         |     |  |       |Musicians (trum-  ||
            |         |     |  |       |peters only) and  ||
            |         |     |  |       |sappers armed with||
            |         |     |  |       |rifle.            ||
            |Alpini   |   4 |19|   ... |  121|  ... | ... ||
 -----------+---------+-----+--+-------+-----+------+-----++
 ~=FRANCE=~ |Ordinary |   3 |15|     2 |  108|  ... | ... ||
            |Maximum  |   3 |15|     2 |  158|  ... | ... ||
            |Chasseurs|   3 |21|     2 |  125|  ... | ... ||
            |         |     |  |       |  and|      |     ||
            |         |  ...|..|    ...|  150|  ... | ... ||
 -----------+---------+-----+--+-------+-----+------+-----++
 ~=RUSSIA=~ |Approxi- |     |  |       |     |      |     ||
            |mately   |   3 | 7|    ...|  96 |    4 | ... ||
            |         |     |  |       |     | [44] |     ||
 -----------+---------+-----+--+-------+-----+------+-----++

 ===========+=========++=========================================++
            |         ||                                         ||
            |         ||                                         ||
            |         ||                                         ||
            |         ||                                         ||
            |         ||            (b) WAR STRENGTH.            ||
            |Company. ++-----+--+------+------+------+-----+-----++
            |         ||     |  |      |      |      |Lit- |     ||
            |         ||     |N.|      |      |Train |ter  |Hosp.||
            |         ||Offi-|C.|Musi- |Pri-  |Sol-  |Bear-|Corps||
            |         ||cers.|O.|cians.|vates.|diers.|ers. |Men. ||
 -----------+---------++-----+--+------+------+------+-----+-----++
 ~=GERMANY=~|Minimum  ||   5 |20|    4 |  226 |    4 |   4 |   1 ||
            |Maximum  || ... |..|  ... |  ... |  ... | ... | ... ||
 -----------+---------++-----+--+------+------+------+-----+-----++
 ~=AUSTRIA=~|Minimum  ||   4 |19|    4 |  195 |  ... |   4 | ... ||
            |Maximum  || ... |..|  ... |   4 Pio-    |4 Officers’||
            |         ||     |  |      |   neers.    | servants. ||
 -----------+---------++-----+--+------+------+------+-----+-----++
 ~=ITALY=~  |Infantry,||     |  |      |       |     |     |     ||
            |Bersa-   ||     |  |      |       |     |     |     ||
            |glieri   ||   5 |16|  ... |   180 | ... | ... | ... ||
            |         ||Musicians (trumpeters only) and sappers  ||
            |         ||            armed with rifle.            ||
            |Alpini   || ... |..|  ... |   ... | ... | ... | ... ||
 -----------+---------++-----+--+------+-------+-----+-----+-----++
 ~=FRANCE=~ |Ordinary ||   4 |28|    4 |   218 | ... |   2 |   1 ||
            |Maximum  || ... |..|  ... |   ... | ... | ... | ... ||
            |Chasseurs|| ... |..|  ... |   ... | ... | ... | ... ||
            |         ||     |  |      |       |     |     |     ||
            |         || ... |..|  ... |   ... | ... | ... | ... ||
 -----------+---------++-----+--+------+-------+-----+-----+-----++
 ~=RUSSIA=~ |Approxi- ||     |  |      |       | non-combatants. ||
            |mately   ||   4 |22|  ... |   200 | ... |  20 |...  ||
            |         ||     |  |      |       |     |     |     ||
 -----------+---------++-----+--+------+-------+-----+-----+-----++

 ===========+=========++===============
            |         ||Difference
            |         ||between
            |         ||minimum peace
            |         ||strength and
            |         ||war strength.
            |Company. ++-----+--+------
            |         ||     |  |
            |         ||     |N.|
            |         ||Offi-|C.|Pri-
            |         ||cers.|O.|vates.
 -----------+---------++-----+--+------
 ~=GERMANY=~|Minimum  ||   1 | 5|  103
            |Maximum  || ... |  |  ...
 -----------+---------++-----+--+------
 ~=AUSTRIA=~|Minimum  || ... | 5|  132
            |Maximum  ||  4 Officers’
            |         ||   servants.
 -----------+---------++-----+--+------
 ~=ITALY=~  |Infantry,||     |  |
            |Bersa-   ||     |  |
            |glieri   ||   2 | 3|   93
            |         ||Musicians (trum-
            |         ||peters only) and
            |         ||sappers armed
            |         ||with rifle.
            |Alpini   || ... |..|  ...
 -----------+---------++-----+--+------
 ~=FRANCE=~ |Ordinary ||   1 |18|  110
            |Maximum  || ... |  |  ...
            |Chasseurs|| ... |  |  ...
            |         ||     |  |
            |         || ... |  |  ...
 -----------+---------++-----+--+------
 ~=RUSSIA=~ |Approxi- ||     |  |
            |mately   ||   1 |15|  104
            |         ||     |  |
 -----------+---------++-----+--+------

   [44] In addition, five non-combatants.

 After the heavy losses at =St. Privat=, two companies were combined
 into one for tactical purposes in some regiments of the Guard
 Corps. The administration of the consolidated companies had to
 remain distinct on account of the preparation of casualty lists,
 recommendations for promotion and decorations. On the day of the
 battle of =Orleans=, the strength of the German battalions varied
 from 459 men in the 1st Bavarian Army Corps to 747 men in the 40th
 Infantry Brigade. During the pursuit after the battle of =Le Mans=,
 the strength of the 56th Füsilier-Battalion was even reduced to 280
 men.

The actual training of troops must be completed in the company. Combat
by an independent company is the exception; combat by battalion the
rule. By the consolidation of four companies into one unit, the
battalion, consisting of 800-1,000 rifles, is formed. The French
Chasseur battalions are the only ones that consist of six companies,
because their proposed independent employment, for instance, in
mountain warfare, makes it more often necessary to detach small units
than is the case in operations on more favorable terrain.

 As, in the course of time, the independence of companies in action
 developed, and as the combat of the battalion as an entity was
 transformed into combined action of the four companies, the strength
 of the company increased from 120 to 250 rifles while the number of
 companies in a battalion diminished. The battalion of Frederick the
 Great was divided for administrative purposes into five companies
 and for tactical purposes into eight _pelotons_. The battalion of
 the first empire consisted of six _Füsilier_ and two _Voltigeur_
 companies, and the Austrian battalion, until the reorganization after
 1866, consisted of six companies of which each two formed a division.
 Until 1866 the six company battalion predominated in the infantry of
 all European armies (France, Italy, Austria, and the minor German
 states), but early in the seventies most of the states adopted the
 four company battalion, Russia being the last to do this (four line
 and one sharpshooter company). In the regulations of 1812, Prussia
 had adopted the four company battalion. The independent employment
 of the four united sharpshooter platoons of a battalion was the
 exception even during the campaign of 1866. At present only the
 British battalion consists of eight companies, which cannot, however,
 be said to possess a capacity for independent action on account of
 their small size.

In the four-company organization the battalion possesses an asset
which enables it to adapt itself easily to any combat situation. The
battalion organization is the outgrowth of practical necessity; the
regimental commander cannot handle 12-16 companies without difficulty,
and an intermediate unit, the battalion, is necessary. The battalion
is the practical, and the regiment, consisting of 3 or 4 battalions,
the ideal unit. Regiments consisting of two battalions do not possess
the same advantages, as the regimental staff becomes superfluous during
each necessary division of the regiment. Two battalion regiments do
indeed facilitate command; they are, however, more expensive in time
of peace and are of advantage in action only when formed into brigades
of six battalions each, in which case the commander has a compactly
organized reserve available.

“The regiment, by reason of its history, the uniformity of its
training, the _esprit de corps_ of its officers, and its division into
three battalions--thereby facilitating subdivision--is pre-eminently
fitted for carrying out definite combat tasks.” (Par. 470 German I. D.
R.). A glance at the map of the battle of Vionville (5B of the German
General Staff work on the Franco-German war) shows that regiments,
whenever they entered the field intact, fought as unbroken units
throughout the battle, whereas brigade organizations were frequently
broken up.

This breaking up of brigades is practically induced by the two regiment
brigade organization. (Par. 471 German I. D. R.). When once the brigade
commander has assigned sections or points of attack to his regiments,
there remains very little for him to do. He can form a reserve only
by taking two battalions from one regiment, or one battalion from
each. The brigade is, however, not like the regiment, an entity of
bodies of troops, but a unit assembled for tactical purposes, which
may, without regard to the whole, be increased or diminished by one or
more battalions in case of necessity. On the march and in action the
brigade organization as a subdivision of the division cannot always be
maintained; groups are frequently formed in which the normal units
must be broken up. In large battles the brigade is the largest force
which may yet be employed as an intact unit, although the employment of
infantry by regiments will continue to be the rule. Brigade commanders
are necessary for decreasing units of command and desirable for
relieving the division commanders of a part of their work. In time of
peace brigade commanders are useful for directing recruitment and,
moreover, as connecting links between regiments and the division.
The unmistakable advantages of the three-battalion organization have
induced the United States to form its brigades of three regiments, each
of three battalions (of 400 men each). An English division consists of
three brigades of four battalions each.


4. INTRENCHING TOOL EQUIPMENT.[45]

   [45] In the Russo-Japanese war the Russian companies were equipped
 with 80 small spades and 20 hand axes; the Japanese companies with 68
 small spades, 17 mattocks, 8 hatchets, and 30 wire cutters.

Earth as a covering material and, incidental thereto, the adoption
of the small spade after the Russo-Turkish war, have increased in
importance owing to the greater penetrating power of the modern
infantry bullets. The disadvantages of the spade lie in the danger of
its being misused and in the consequent impairment of offensive spirit.
There is, moreover, danger that the fire effect will be impaired and
subordinated to considerations of cover. The spade should therefore not
be employed on every occasion, but only when the tactical purpose in
view requires it.

What the weight of the portable intrenching equipment of the Japanese,
Russian, and British infantry will be, is still undecided, but
experiments are being made with a uniform tool. When we consider, that
for the purpose of intrenching, one man requires a space of 1.20 m.,
and for handling his rifle a space of 0.8 m., and that when intrenching
under fire all the men cannot work, it is obvious that it would be
impracticable to equip each man with an intrenching tool. According
to all experience, it is sufficient to furnish every other man with
spade or pick. In addition to this, however, a company requires a large
number of wire cutters. Only the French infantry is equipped with
explosives, every regiment having 108 cartridges.

The following table shows the intrenching tool equipment available in
each battalion:

 +=========+================================+=================+=======
           |        FOR EARTH WORK.         | FOR TIMBER WORK.|
 ----------+-----------------+--------------+---------+-------+-------
           |      Small      |    Large     |  Small  | Large |
           |   Intrenching   | Intrenching  |    Intrenching  |
           |     Tools.      |   Tools.     |       Tools.    |
 ----------+-------+---------+-------+------+---------+-------+------
           |Spades.|Mattocks.|Spades.|Picks.|Hatchets.| Axes. |Total.
 ----------+-------+---------+-------+------+---------+-------+------
 Germany   |  400  |   40    |  20   |  10  |    35   |  8    |  513
 Austria   |  400  |   64    |   8   |  16  |   ...   |  8[46]|  ...
 Italy[47] |   32  |    8    |  36   |  18  |   ...   | 62    |  ...
 France[48]|  448  |  128    | ...   | ...  |   ...   |...    |  ...
 ----------+-------+---------+-------+------+---------+-------+-------

   [46] Each company has 4 pioneers, which carry intrenching and
 carpenter tools in addition to their rifles. These men are formed
 into a pioneer platoon of 64 men in each regiment.

   [47] The adoption of portable intrenching tools, 50 spades and
 12-15 mattocks per company, is contemplated.

   [48] The following demolition tools are available in each
 battalion: 64 picks, 64 fascine knives, and 16 wire cutters. Sappeur
 sections carry in addition a mattock or a pick apiece, and each
 ammunition carrier also carries a pick, a fascine knife, or a saw.
 The large intrenching tools are apparently being changed at the
 present moment.


5. THE LOAD OF THE INFANTRYMAN.

The load carried by the infantryman should not exceed one-third of
the man’s weight (84 kg.), or not more than 28 kg. According to the
“Regulations for the Employment of Infantry Equipment, M/95,” the load
of a soldier whose height is 1.67 m. (the equipment consisting of new
experimental pieces) is about 27 kg., distributed as follows:

 Clothing                            5.397 kg.
 Equipment[49]                       3,964  „
 Baggage[50]                         5.600  „
 Arms and ammunition                 8.507  „
 Rations (including breakfast).      3.238  „
                                    ----------
   Total                            26.706 kg.

To this must be added intrenching tools:

 Small spade and scabbard   0.89 kg.
 Hatchet                    1.08  „
 Mattock                    1.48  „
 Load with spade          27.596  „

   [49] Tent equipment 1.620 kg.

   [50] Iron ration, 2.388 kg. The British soldier carries only a 269
 g. ration on his person, sufficient for 26 hours. It consists of two
 parts, one containing cocoa paste, the other concentrated extract of
 beef (Pemmican).

COMPARISON.[51]

 ===========+==========+=======+========+=======+=======+===========
            |          |       |         |Weight|       | Weight
            |          |       |         |  of  | Weight|   of
            | Without  | With  |Clothing.|knap- |  of   |  ammu-
            | spades.  |spades.|         |sacks.|rifles.|nition.[52]
 -----------+----------+-------+---------+------+-------+-----------
 Germany    |26.706    | 27.596|  5.397  |20.919| 4.707 | 4.714 kg.
 Austria[53]|26.615    | 26.443|  4.428  |22.187| 4.200 | 4.080 „
 Russia     |28.216    | 29.206|  4.000  |22.622| 4.576 | 3.426 „
 France     |26.125    |       |  6.222  |19.903| 5.049 | 3.675 „
 Italy      |29.135[54]|       |  5.993  |23.143| 4.505 | 4.320 „
 Japan      |26.365    |       |  3.475  |22.890| 4.435 | 3.600 „
 -----------+----------+-------+---------+------+-------+-----------

   [51] According to _Journal of Military Scientific Societies_, 1906.

   [52] Italy 162, Japan and Germany 150, the other states 120 rounds
 per man.

   [53] Depending on whether the man carries intrenching tools (front
 rank only) cooking utensils (rear rank and a few men of the front
 rank).

   [54] Alpini carry 32.096 kg.


II. THE FORMATIONS.


1. THE ISSUE OF ORDERS.

Troops are set in motion by words of command, and, when these do not
suffice, by orders. (Orders give information of the situation and the
intentions of the commander, and assign tasks, but leave the recipient
free to choose the method of carrying them out). When commands are
given from a distance, time and energy may be saved by employing the
telephone and visual signals. To these may be added shouts, signs, and
the following signals: _To advance_, the leader raises the arm; to
indicate that the command is _to follow him_, he extends his raised arm
in the direction of march; _to halt_, he lowers the arm; _to deploy_,
both arms are raised laterally to the height of the shoulders, and if
necessary the direction the skirmish line is to take is subsequently
indicated with one extended arm; _to assemble_ his men, the leader
describes a circle above his head with one arm. These signals may also
be made with the sabre or rifle. Additional signals should be agreed
upon beforehand in each separate case. If a signal is made to a body of
troops in close order, it is meant, in the first place, for its leader.
(Par. 11 German I. D. R.). Other signals, such as those indicating a
change of direction of march, or a change in the battle formation, must
be specially agreed upon beforehand. Trumpet signals are only used by
troops in garrison at drills, and in barracks or billets as service
calls. To prevent troops from misunderstanding signals or from obeying
those not intended for them, all trumpet calls in battle, except
“charge,” “fix bayonet,” and “attention,” are forbidden.

 During the engagement of =Trautenau= (27th June, 1866), the trumpet
 signal “assemble,” given at another point, caused four Prussian
 battalions to withdraw.[55] See also the effect of the signal
 “assemble” after the taking of =Problus=.[56] Notice the effect of
 the signal “form square” during the assault on the =Forest of Bor=
 (=Königgrätz=).[57]

   [55] KÜHNE, _Kritische Wanderungen_, 3, 2nd Edition, pp. 55 and 85.

   [56] _Geschichte des Infanterie-Regiments Nr. 16_, p. 230.

   [57] _Geschichte des Infanterie-Regiments Nr. 57_, p. 47. HÖNIG,
 _Untersuchungen über die Taktik der Zukunft_, 4th Edition, p. 61.

 On the morning of June 26th, 1866 (day of rest), reveille sounded
 by a trumpeter was mistaken for an alarm signal. The 7th Infantry
 Division assembled and the signal was repeated in two other army
 corps. Two days previous another useless alarm had occurred because a
 trumpeter, surprised by a number of Radetzky Hussars, had blown the
 alarm signal.[58]

   [58] _Geschichte des Regiments Nr. 66_, pp. 48/49.

 The village of =Diletz= (action at =Gitschin=, 1866) was to be
 evacuated at the sounding of the signal (Saxon) “First Brigade
 withdraw.” The signal was, however, understood and carried out
 by only three battalions; two battalions, which were at the time
 engaged, did not hear it at all and maintained their position until
 they were taken in reverse by hostile fire and forced to withdraw.[59]

   [59] _Anteil des Königlich-Sächsischen Armeekorps_, p. 130.

 In the crisis of the fight of the Füsilier Battalion of the 48th
 Infantry and the 1st Battalion of the 52nd at =Vionville=, the signal
 “assemble” was sounded and repeated by other trumpeters, further
 mischief being averted by the energetic efforts of the officers who
 prevented trumpeters from blowing the call and ordered them to blow
 “commence firing” instead.[60]

   [60] _Geschichte des Regiments Nr. 52_, p. 59.


2. THE PURPOSE OF FORMATIONS. COMPARISON BETWEEN LINE AND COLUMN.

The object of assembly formations is to unite troops, usually prior
to a movement, in a restricted space permitting an easy survey of the
entire body. Assembly formations serve also the purpose of placing
troops in readiness before starting on a march, before beginning an
action, and for moving them on the battlefield when out of reach of
hostile fire (columns). Route formations should permit an orderly,
comfortable march of the troops, as much of the available width of road
being used as possible, a space being left for orderlies and mounted
messengers, and for troops which are drawn forward. In order to permit
a prompt deployment of troops for action, it is necessary to reduce
their depth. Columns only are suitable for moving troops. The situation
existing at the moment will determine to what extent allowances may
be made for the comfort of the troops, or how far considerations of
comfort should be ignored in view of readiness for action, and to what
extent the depth of the columns should be decreased.

The formations for moving troops (to be employed in marching across
country and to be used on the battlefield) should be such as to
cause the least discomfort to the troops, should make it possible to
avoid obstacles, to utilize cover, facilitate changes of front and
direction of march, and permit a prompt deployment in any direction.
These formations are columns unless the hostile fire effect makes a
deployment into line necessary.

Battle formations should be such as to permit the employment of all
weapons (rifles, lances, sabres, and guns). This requirement is not
satisfied by columns, but only by the line. Modern fire effect excludes
every employment of close order formations under effective hostile fire
and compels the most extensive deployment.

Whether line or column is the preferable battle formation is a question
belonging to a bygone age. The battles of the British in Spain and at
Waterloo, the engagement at Groszbeeren, and the attack of the six
battalions of Borke’s Brigade (the 8th) at the Katzbach,[61] amply
demonstrate that the defeat of the Prussians at Jena was not due to
the employment of linear battle formations alone. In a fight with an
equal opponent, formed in columns, well trained and disciplined troops,
formed in line that allows of the use of all the rifles and is suitable
for shock action as well, have always carried off the victory.[62]
On the other hand, in the battles of the Empire we find columns
formed, which of necessity excluded a large part of the men from
participation in the action, but which were designed to break through
the hostile battle line by sheer momentum. At Wagram, Macdonald’s Corps
was formed with eight deployed battalions in rear of each other in a
single column, supported on the flanks by seven and eight battalions
respectively, also in column. At Austerlitz and Waterloo we find attack
formations in which from eight to twelve battalions of a division were
deployed one in rear of the other at distances of twenty paces. Column
and line must be examined with reference to their mobility, their
vulnerability and their fire and shock power.

   [61] FRIEDERICH, _Herbstfeldzug, 1813_, I, p. 305.

   [62] RENARD, _Considérations sur la tactique de l’infanterie en
 Europe_, Paris, 1857.

   RÜSTOW, _Geschichte der Infanterie_, II, p. 316.

The column possesses greater mobility and is better adapted than
the line for executing changes of front and for taking advantage of
the cover afforded by the ground. In a column steadiness and shock
power (produced by the crowding forward of the ranks in rear) and the
influence exerted by the officers, is greater than in a line.

The line is more dependent on the terrain in its movements. The
characteristics of the line are great frontal fire power, weakness of
the flanks, difficulty of quickly changing front, and the ever present
danger of being pierced. The line has been called the formation of the
bold, the column that of the weak.

 The column[63] was proposed as a battle formation in France as early
 as 1774 by Mesnil Durand, but did not find practical application
 until the wars of the Revolution. In those wars columns were used
 because the raw levies lacked the training necessary for making
 movements in line. Whenever a line formation was used, battalions,
 owing to the scarcity of efficient officers, resolved themselves
 into disorderly skirmish lines which were exceedingly difficult to
 control. The adoption of the column was, therefore, the result of
 practical experience, but as a formation it could be justified on
 the battlefield only so long as it remained capable of development
 for the purpose of firing. The endeavor to combine the advantages
 of column and line by a combination of both formations led to the
 placing of columns in rear of the wings of the battalions deployed in
 line. This formation was employed for the first time in the attack
 made by a demi-brigade during the battle on the =Tagliamento= (1797),
 and subsequently it was used at =Marengo= (attack made by Desaix’s
 Division).

   [63] The development of the French column tactics is splendidly
 portrayed by KUHL in his work _Bonapartes erster Feldzug, 1796_, p.
 46, et seq.

[Illustration]

 During the first decade of the 19th Century the French leaders had
 a marked _penchant_ for this formation, until it sank more and more
 into insignificance in face of the deep column. (Ney at =Waterloo=,
 and Macdonald at =Wagram=). Formations suggesting the above are found
 even in the Prussian regulations of 1876. (Posting of sharpshooter
 platoons of the companies at first in rear of the wings of the
 deployed battalion, and later in rear of the outer flank platoons of
 the companies).

[Illustration]

On account of the increased penetrating power of infantry projectiles,
especially at short ranges, a column will suffer greater losses than a
line; at longer ranges the curvature of the trajectory causes bullets
which pass over the first echelon to strike the second or third. On
ground falling with respect to the line of sight, lines, and on ground
rising with respect to the line of sight, columns are exposed to
greater losses when they come within the beaten zone.[64]

   [64] At 1000 m., the projectile of rifle model ’98 falls 5 cm. for
 each meter of the range, and at 1200 m. it falls 6 cm. per meter of
 the range, so that the second and third platoons of a company in
 column of platoons (7.2 m. distance between platoons) would offer a
 target having a vulnerable surface 35 cm. high (¹⁄₅ the height of a
 man), at 1000 m., 42 cm. high (¹⁄₄ the height of a man) at 1200 m.


3. THE COMPANY.


(a) Formation of the Company.

(Par. 83 German I. D. R.).

In the company the files are placed in two ranks according to height
from right to left. Each four files form a squad or group, and the
entire company is divided into three platoons (_Züge_). When a platoon
consists of more than three squads it is divided into two sections
(_Halbzüge_).

In the normal formation of the company, the three platoons, each in
two ranks,[65] are posted on a line in numerical order from right
to left. This formation facilitates firing and in garrison meets
the requirements of barrack life, each two squads forming a section
(_Korporalschaft_) under a non-commissioned officer. During the
campaign of 1866 Prince Frederick Charles gave permission to arrange
companies so that friends and relatives could serve together in the
same squad or section. A company formed in this fashion would, of
course, not look so well on parade as one formed regularly, the men
according to height from right to left flank, but it would without
doubt give a better account of itself in action. For details of the
formation of a company and division into fractions see pars. 82-85,
German I. D. R. The squad leaders and the two range finders in each
platoon are posted as file closers at facing distance in rear of the
rear rank of the company.

   [65] The number of ranks is intimately related to the rate of
 fire of the infantry weapon. During the days of slow loading, the
 necessity of keeping at least a part of the rifles at all times ready
 for firing led the Imperialists in the Thirty Years’ war (loading
 was executed by 90 motions) to form their musketeers into sixteen
 ranks, while Gustavus Adolphus was able to form his infantry into
 six ranks owing to the greater loading facility of their rifles.
 In the Seven Years’ war the Prussian infantry was formed in three,
 that of the Austrians in four ranks, the fourth rank serving as a
 reserve. The first rank fired kneeling. The British infantry was the
 first to adopt the two rank formation for fire action, forming into
 four ranks for shock action and frequently for warding off cavalry
 attacks. Emperor Napoleon considered a third rank useless for fire
 and shock action and initiated the double rank formation on the eve
 of the battle of Leipzig. In 1888 the Prussian infantry--the last to
 do so--gave up the three rank formation which had long since lost its
 importance in battle and which was retained side by side with the
 double rank formation for purposes of parade only.

[Illustration: Germany.]

The _non-commissioned officers_ are posted in the front rank, on the
flanks and in the center of the platoons in Russia, Austria, and
Switzerland. In Germany and Italy they are all posted in rear of the
line as file closers, and it is their duty to supervise the men. In
France a part of the non-commissioned officers are posted in the front
rank, the remainder as file closers. A German company of 200 men has
a front of 100 paces, or 80 m. The infantryman with field equipment
occupies a space about 75 cm. square.

 The German Infantry Drill Regulations define interval (_intervalle_)
 as the space between two elements on the same line, and distance as
 the space between two elements in the direction of depth. An interval
 is measured from the left flank of the element on the right to the
 right flank of the element on the left (or vice versa); and distance
 in the company and in the battalion is measured from the rear of the
 element in front to the head of the element in rear (or vice versa).
 If the distance between two elements is equal to their front, the
 column is called an “open column”, otherwise it is called a “close
 column.”

FRONT AND FACING DISTANCE.

 ===========+=========================+================================
            |        FRONT.           |       FACING DISTANCE.
            |      (Per man.)         |  (Distance between ranks.)
 -----------+-------------------------+--------------------------------
 Germany    |About 0.80 m. Loose elbow|0.80 m. from back of front rank
            |contact.                 |man to breast of rear rank man.
 -----------+-------------------------+--------------------------------
 Austria    |About 0.75 m. Files are  |120 cm. from heels of front rank
            |separated by an interval |man to those of rear rank man
            |of the width of a hand.  |(according to German method of
            |                         |measuring, about 0.88 m.).
 -----------+-------------------------+--------------------------------
 Italy      |0.70 m.                  |0.75 m. from breast of front
            |                         |rank man to breast of rear rank
            |                         |man(according to German method
            |                         |of measuring, 0.45 m.) on the
            |                         |march, 1.20 m. (according to
            |                         |German method of measuring,
            |                         |0.90).
 -----------+-------------------------+--------------------------------
 France     |0.70 m. including 0.15 m.|1 m. from back or knapsack of
            |interval between files.  |front rank man to breast of rear
            |                         |rank man.
 -----------+-------------------------+--------------------------------
 Russia     |0.70 m. Files are        |Rear rank man is an arm’s length
            |separated by an interval |from back of knapsack of front
            |of the width of a hand.  |rank man = 60-70 cm.
 -----------+-------------------------+--------------------------------
 England    |About 0.80 m.            |1.50 m. from heel of front rank
            |                         |man to heel of rear rank man
            |                         |(according to German method of
            |                         |measuring, about 1.20 m.).
 -----------+-------------------------+--------------------------------
 Switzerland|About 0.75 m.            |0.80 m. from back of front rank
            |                         |man to breast of rear rank man.
 -----------+-------------------------+--------------------------------
 Belgium    |About 0.80 m.            |1 m. from heel of front rank man
            |                         |to heel of rear rank man
            |                         |(according to German method of
            |                         |measuring, about 0.70 m.).
 -----------+-------------------------+--------------------------------
 Japan      |About 0.85 m.            |0.75 m. from back (or knapsack)
            |                         |of front rank man to breast of
            |                         |rear rank man.
 -----------+-------------------------+--------------------------------


(b) Division of the Company Into Three or Four Platoons.

In Austria, France, and Italy, platoons are considered as distinct
bodies, so long as they have sufficient numerical strength. They are
placed side by side and constitute the company in line. In Germany
and Russia the company is at each formation divided into platoons of
approximately equal strength. In the armies of Austria, France, and
Italy, it is contended that the soldier has nothing further to learn
when once he is taken up for duty in the company. All movements are
executed, after preparatory commands given by the company commanders,
by commands of execution or signals given by platoon commanders. The
execution of movements is retarded by this procedure and the movement
itself becomes clumsy. It would also seem that the multiplicity of
commands in the simple, oft-repeated movements, is superfluous,
especially in the weak platoons at peace strength.

[Illustration: France.]

 Column of platoons from line (par. 121 German I. D. R.: “Form column
 of platoons”) is formed in Austria as follows (Austrian I. D. R. par.
 360): At the preparatory command, “Column,” given by the company
 commander, the leaders of the 1st, 3rd, and 4th platoons command
 at once, as in forming column of fours to the front, “Fours right
 (left), column right (left).” At the command “march,” the platoons
 step off, each turning in column to the rear, and are conducted to
 their new positions, halted, and dressed to the right (left).

The companies of all powers, those of Germany, Japan, and Belgium
excepted, are divided into four platoons; each two platoons may in
addition be combined into a half-company. The German, Japanese, and
Belgian companies are divided into three platoons. “The platoon is not
an independent subdivision by reason of the mere fact that it consists
of a certain number of men, but because the term platoon denotes a
force led by a man of superior intelligence. The officer commanding
the platoon makes it what it should be. The strength of the platoon is
therefore solely dependent upon the number of officers available.” (VON
SCHERFF).

The obvious advantage of the three-platoon organization of the company
is that fewer platoon commanders are required, which fact is well
worthy of attention in the mobilization of units of both Line and
Reserve, especially in view of the extraordinarily heavy casualties
among the troop leaders in the course of a campaign.[66]

   [66] See also _Taktik_, V, pp. 81, 88.

 It is only necessary to recall the situation of the Guard Corps and
 of the IIIrd Army Corps after the battles around =Metz=, and the
 condition of the German troops during the advance to =Le Mans=. On
 January 7th, 1871, there were 36 officers with the 57th Infantry, of
 which 16 led platoons of the 36 platoons in the first line, and 8
 lieutenants commanded companies. On mobilizing, 25 lieutenants were
 assigned as platoon commanders and six as company commanders in the
 57th Infantry.[67]

   [67] HÖNIG, _Gefechtsbilder_, I, p. 25. For additional facts in
 regard to the dwindling of the number of officers consult _Die
 sieben Tage von Le Mans_, by V. D. GOLTZ; also _Supplement to
 Militär-Wochenblatt_, 1873, p. 368; also VON KORTZFLEISCH, _Feldzug
 an der Loire_, p. 43.

 The eight infantry regiments and the Jäger-Battalion of the Xth Army
 Corps had, at this time, instead of the required 506 officers, only
 286, of which number 174 were for duty. The 22nd Infantry Division
 had only 108 officers left; companies and even half-battalions were
 led into action by very young officers of the Reserve, and, on many
 occasions, even by vice 1st sergeants.

 On the morning of August 17th, 1870, the 40th Füsilier Regiment
 had two field officers and four captains present for duty. Two
 captains, two first lieutenants and eight second lieutenants
 (four of these belonging to the Reserve), led companies; only two
 lieutenants of the Reserve, one cadet, and four vice 1st sergeants
 remained available for duty as platoon commanders. The regiment
 participated in the battle of =Gravelotte= with this small number
 of officers.[68] The 6th Grenadier Regiment, which, in July, 1870,
 had marched out with four field officers, seven captains, six first,
 14 second lieutenants, and four cadets, all on the active list,
 lost so many officers at =Wörth= and =Sedan= that a field officer
 of the 46th Infantry had to take command of the regiment; three
 first lieutenants of battalions; and four second lieutenants, two
 officers of the Reserve, and six vice 1st sergeants of the companies.
 The 12 companies had available five vice 1st sergeants as platoon
 commanders. The 1st Battalion of the 58th Infantry had only seven
 officers left (including its commander and the adjutant) after its
 losses at =Weiszenburg=.[69]

   [68] KUNZ, _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, 8/9, p. 162.

   [69] _Geschichte des Regiments Nr. 58_, p. 56.

 The 7th Grenadier Regiment lost 40 officers at =Weiszenburg= and
 =Wörth=. On August 7th, three captains commanded the battalions and
 three officers of the 5th Jäger-Battalion were detailed to command
 companies in it.[70] At =Gravelotte= the Füsilier-Battalion of the
 1st, the Ist Battalion of the 2nd, and the IInd Battalion of the
 3rd Regiment of the Guard lost all of their officers. The French
 organizations, having more officers and less men than we, were by no
 means so badly off in 1870-71. Upon mobilizing in 1870, the German
 army had 13.7 officers to every 1,000 men, the French army, 32.2
 officers.

   [70] KUNZ, _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, 14, p. 122.

On the other hand, it should be remembered that in armies consisting
of militia it is considerably more difficult to command a platoon of
60-70 men than to command one of 40-50 men. A disadvantage inseparably
connected with the four-platoon company is the small size of the
platoons during peace exercises. On account of this circumstance most
regulations permit the three-platoon formation when the company is
small, because platoons consisting of less than ten files are of no
instructional value. An advantage of the three-platoon company is
the simplicity and rapidity with which changes from one formation to
another may be effected.

The three-unit column of platoons is very broad for movements on the
battlefield. It offers, when numbering 200 rifles, a target about
25 m. wide and only 15 m. deep. The four-unit column of platoons is
better suited for movements. With a front of 17 m., its depth is only
15 m., when the distances between platoons are assumed to be 6 paces
(Austria, France, Italy, Russia, 5 paces). (See p. 62).

For a company consisting of 200 rifles, the following would be the
forms:

[Illustration]

The other advantages praised by advocates of the four-unit company are:

1. That a smaller platoon is more suitable for field service--that a
picket is perhaps only in the rarest cases to be made 60 men strong.

2. That a small platoon makes a better and more comprehensive
employment of the company in action possible, as the company commander
has an opportunity to use ¹⁄₄, ¹⁄₂, or ³⁄₄ of his company according to
the requirements of the situation, while the three-unit company affords
less favorable combinations, permitting only an employment of ¹⁄₃ or
²⁄₃ of its strength.

These advantages can also be obtained in the German company by the
employment of sections (¹⁄₆, ¹⁄₃, ¹⁄₂, ²⁄₃, ⁵⁄₆) so that the objections
to the three-unit company would appear to be groundless.

The platoons (in Italy called _plotone_, in France, _section_) are
subdivided into sections (_demi-sections_, _Halbzüge_), in Austria
into two skirmish groups (_Schwärme_) of 4-7 files each, and, when
consisting of 16 files, into four skirmish groups (in Italy this is
also done, the groups being called _squadriglio_). In Germany the
platoons are divided into groups or squads of four files each, and
in Russia the platoons are divided into sections of 8-15 files each
and these again into groups or squads of 4-6 men each. If the squad
is to have any importance at all in action, it must have a leader,
and it might easily happen that a mobilized company lacks the number
of leaders necessary to provide one for each group. The withdrawal
from the line of a number of good shots for duty as squad leaders is
compensated for, in our opinion, by the more thorough supervision over
the men. This consideration has, however, apparently caused other
states (Austria and France) not to count on the activity of the squad
leaders in a fire action to the same extent as is the case in Germany.


4. LENGTH OF PACE AND MARCHING.

An extended, swinging step, without haste and without unduly taxing
the lungs, is advantageous in all movements. When accustomed to this
pace on the drill ground, the men will march with practically the
same step on varied ground, and this appears more desirable than to
shorten the step, while at the same time increasing the distance to be
covered in a given time. The length of the pace depends largely upon
the height of the individual, but even small men can maintain a step
of 0.80 m. without undue exertion.[71] In Switzerland the cadence has
been fixed at 116-120 steps per minute “with a view of suiting the
peculiarities and the varying degree of mobility which characterize
the inhabitants of the different cantons.”(!) For purely practical
reasons it is advisable to fix upon some even number of paces in order
that the cadence may be tested with the watch. (Austria excepted). The
longest pace in conjunction with the highest cadence (_Bersaglieri_,
whose march is almost a double time, excepted) is found in England
and Switzerland. Such a performance could not be kept up by a fully
equipped man without impairing health.

   [71] When the leg is extended at an angle of 57 degrees the length
 of pace would be as follows:

 Height of man.  Length of leg.  Length of foot.   Length of pace.
    1.6   m.        0.8   m.        0.24  m.     =    0.75  m.
    1.675 „         0.857 „         0.253 „      =    0.776 „
    1.70  „         0.87  „         0.26  „      =    0.80  „
    1.75  „         0.88  „         0.26  „      =    0.82  „

 ===========+====================++====================++
            |     QUICK TIME.    ||  ACCELERATED TIME. ||
            +------+-------------++------+-------------++
            |      | PER MINUTE. ||      | PER MINUTE. ||
            |      +------+------++      +------+------++
            |Length|Number|      ||Length|Number|      ||
            |  of  |  of  |      ||  of  |  of  |      ||
            | pace.|paces.|      || pace.|paces.|      ||
            |  m.  |      |  m.  ||  m.  |      |  m.  ||
 -----------+------+------+------++------+------+------++
 Germany    | 0.80 | 114  | 91.2 || 0.80 | 120  | 96.00||
            |      |      |      ||      |      |      ||
 -----------+------+------+------++------+------+------++
 Austria    | 0.75 | 115  | 86.25|| 0.75 | 125  | 93.75||
 -----------+------+------+------++------+------+------++
 Italy, Line|      |      |      ||      |      |      ||
 and Alpini | 0.75 | 120  | 90.00||  ... | ...  |  ... ||
 Bersaglieri| 0.86 | 140  |120.  ||  ... | ...  |      ||
 -----------+------+------+------++------+------+------++
 France     | 0.75 | 120  | 90.00|| 0.80 | 124  | 99.00||
            |      |      |      ||      |      |      ||
 -----------+------+------+------++------+------+------++
            | 0.71 | 118  | 84-  || 0.71 |      |      ||
 Russia     |      |      |      ||      | 122  |119.  ||
            | 0.89 | 122  |109   || 0.89 |      |      ||
 -----------+------+------+------++------+------+------++
 Japan      | 0.75 | 114  | 85.5 ||  ... | ...  |  ... ||
 -----------+------+------+------++------+------+------++
 England    | 0.84 | 128  |107.5 || 0.91 | 128  |116.5 ||
 -----------+------+------+------++------+------+------++
            |      | 116- | 92.8-||      | 120- | 96-  ||
 Switzerland| 0.80 |      |      || 0.80 |      |      ||
            |      | 120  | 96.00||      | 140  |112   ||
 ===========+======+======+======++======+======+======++

 ===========++=====================
            ||   DOUBLE TIME.
            ++--------+------------
            ||        | PER MINUTE.
            ||        +------+-----
            || Length |Number|
            ||   of   |  of  |
            ||  pace. |paces.|
            ||   m.   |      | m.
 -----------++--------+------+-----
 Germany    ||0.75-   | 170- |127-
            ||0.90    | 180  |162
 -----------++--------+------+-----
 Austria    ||0.90    | 160  |144
 -----------++--------+------+-----
 Italy, Line||        |      |
 and Alpini ||0.90    | 170  |153
 Bersaglieri||1.00    | 180  |180
 -----------++--------+------+-----
 France     ||0.30[72]| 180  |136
            ||        |      |
 -----------++--------+------+-----
            ||        | 170- |181-
 Russia     ||1.066   |      |
            ||        | 181  |192
 -----------++--------+------+-----
 Japan      ||0.85    | 170  |144
 -----------++--------+------+-----
 England    ||1.02    | 180  |183.6
 -----------++--------+------+-----
            ||        |      |
 Switzerland||0.90    | 160  |144
            ||        |      |
 ===========++========+======+=====

   [72] The following, taken from _La marche du fantassin_ (_Journal
 des sciences militaires, 1897_), is here inserted for comparison.

     _French Drill Reg. of 1791_ (in force until 1862):
 _Pas ordinaire_              100 paces at 0.65 m. = 65   m. per minute
 _Frederick The Great’s
 Infantry_                     75   „   „  0.70 m. = 52   m.  „    „

     _Prussian Drill Reg. of 1812_:
 _Ordinary pace_               75   „   „  0.70 m. = 52   m.  „    „
 _Accelerated pace_           108   „   „  0.70 m. = 75.6 m.  „    „
In general, double time is considered of little value. In Austria
double time is to be maintained for periods of two minutes, quick
time of five minutes duration alternating, up to sixteen minutes,
_i.e._, until a distance of 1,726 m. has been covered. In Germany,
an alternating quick and double time march in heavy marching order
is prescribed. A different practice prevails in Italy. According
to the Italian Regulations all troops are to be trained to march
in double time without rest and without knapsacks for 2 kilometers
(with knapsacks, 1 km.); _Bersaglieri_ without knapsacks, 3 km. (with
knapsacks, 1¹⁄₂ km.), also without rest (_i.e._, 13 and 16.8 minutes
respectively). When we consider that in double time with the necessary
alternating step, 2,000 m. can be covered in 17 minutes, and in
accelerated step, in 19-20 minutes, the time gained is unimportant when
compared to the fatigue of the men and the exertion of the lungs, which
interferes with deliberate, accurate firing. During an Austrian firing
test the number of hits fell from 76.5%, attained while advancing in
quick time, to 51% after a period of double time.

The run, without keeping step (_Marsch! Marsch!_) is employed in
rapidly crossing short, fire-swept spaces, in changing quickly from one
formation to another, and in the charge.


5. MOVEMENTS OF THE COMPANY IN LINE.

The commander of the center platoon is the guide.

A change of direction is effected by inclining toward the new direction
(at the command: “Half right, march!” when the angular change of
direction is less than 45 degrees), by indicating a new point to march
on, or by executing a turn.


6. THE COLUMNS OF THE COMPANY; MOVEMENTS IN COLUMN; FORMATION OF LINE.


Column of Twos.[73]

   [73] _Reihenkolonne._

Column of twos is formed by facing in the indicated direction. Marching
at attention the depth of an organization in column of twos is equal
to its front when in line. The column of twos is used in marching by
the flank for short distances only, as the march at attention in this
formation unduly fatigues the men. In addition, this formation may be
used, in exceptional cases, on narrow roads; but the column becomes
considerably elongated (as much as 165%), when marching at route step.
Line is formed from column of twos either by facing, or by executing
front into line.


Column of Squads.

This is an open column formed (the company being in line at a halt or
in motion) by each squad executing a turn of 90 degrees. It may also
be formed from line at a halt by the squad on the designated flank
moving straight to the front, the others executing a turn of 90 degrees
toward the proper flank, then following the leading squad.[74] Column
of squads may also be formed by executing “Squads right (left), column
right (left).” Line is formed by each squad executing a turn of 90
degrees or by executing front into line (without regard to the original
front).

   [74] “Right forward, fours right.” _Translator._

[Illustration: Column of Squads.]

[Illustration: Route Column.]

Route column is formed from column of squads by the squads in each
section closing to facing distance, the file closers, musicians,
and hospital corps men forming ranks of four men, in the gaps thus
created. (Par. 91 German I. D. R.) With the exception of Russia, which
employs a section column, of Switzerland, which uses a column of
squads, and of France, which has adopted a wheel by fours like that of
the cavalry, all other armies employ the _column of fours_[75] as their
march formation.

   [75] _Doppelreihenkolonne_.

Column of fours is, as a rule, formed as follows:

The even numbered men place themselves on the right or left of the odd
numbered men by making an appropriate turn, thus forming a column of
fours whose length is equal to the front of the company in line. In the
plate below let the Roman numerals represent front rank men, the Arabic
numerals rear rank men, and the horizontal line the original front
occupied; column of fours will then be formed to the right, in the
different states, as shown:

[Illustration: Austria.

Russia, England, Belgium, Sweden, and Japan.

Italy. Netherlands.]

For the purpose of increasing the front of the column, the double
column of squads, having a width of 8 files, may be employed. This
is formed in practice by placing the columns of two organizations
(companies or battalions) side by side. In large bodies of troops,
the depth of a column is reduced in this manner by one-half. A column
of fours formed by closing on the center instead of by wheeling to a
flank, is employed in Italy and Russia for the purpose of reducing the
front of an organization.


Comparison of Column of Fours with Column of Squads.

The column of fours has the advantage over our column of squads in that
it can be more quickly and easily formed; that the front rank men must
make a turn, while, at the same time, observing the march direction,
can scarcely be considered a disadvantage.

The column of fours and the column of squads have the same depth. The
Austrians consider movements made in column of fours on the battlefield
more clumsy and fatiguing than when made in column of squads, because
checks are transmitted to the whole column of fours owing to its
rigidity, while in column of squads the march is easier, more rapid
and more orderly. The squad organization, moreover, facilitates the
employment of small parties in the service of security and increases
the importance of the squad leader in fire action. For the last named
reason we should not like to dispense with the column of squads.


The Employment of the Column of Squads.

The route column is suitable for movements under frontal artillery
fire, as the cone of dispersion of bursting time shrapnel combines
small lateral spread with great effect in the direction of depth,
and as it is very difficult for the opponent to observe whether a
shot falls short or goes over, unless it strikes just in front of the
column. When artillery can bring a flanking fire to bear on the column
it becomes necessary to neutralize this by placing the platoons side
by side so as not to present an easily observed target to the enemy.

Movements by the flank and changes of front are easily made in column
of squads, and after some practice the deployment into line of
skirmishers from this formation offers no difficulties. This column
is best adapted for movements over varied ground. In column of squads
difficult terrain can be crossed and advantage can be taken of the
most insignificant cover. In addition, it is difficult for an enemy
to observe a force moving in column of squads along the edge of woods
and rows of trees, and such a column entails the least expenditure of
energy on the part of the men. The leaders must insist, however, that
the men cover in file, and that elongation of the column does not take
place. The column of squads or the route column is therefore to be
employed on the battlefield as long as possible.

A column of squads or route column may be shortened by placing the
platoons, each in column of twos or squads, side by side. By this means
the =Company Column= (_Kompagniekolonne_) is formed.

[Illustration]

The normal interval between platoons in this formation, measured from
the leading guide of one platoon to the leading guide of the next in
line, is nine paces. This interval may be increased as required by the
nature of the ground and the intended deployment for action (deployment
on a broader front). Movements in company column are facilitated by
the fact that platoon commanders are posted four paces in front of
the center of their respective platoons. The leading squad follows
the platoon leader, the guide of that squad moving directly in that
officer’s tracks. Thus, small, unimportant deviations, unavoidable on
varied ground, can easily be adjusted, while too definite rules would
tend to restrict the mobility of the platoon commanders in front of
their platoons. The principal thing is that the platoon follow its
leader who guides it without command.

The musicians distribute themselves in rear of the platoons in
readiness for their subsequent duty in action--that of maintaining
communication between the several parts of the company. The intervals
of nine paces between platoons are not rigid, but rather the reverse.
The flexibility of the formation considerably facilitates movements in
difficult country. This “meandering” of the company over the terrain
requires special training. The old, historic company column, in which
the platoons were formed in line one in rear of the other at a distance
of nine paces (Russia 5 paces = 3.55 m., Austria, Italy, France, 6
paces = 4.50 m., and Japan, 8 paces = 6 m.), their commanders on their
respective right flanks, is now called the


Column of Platoons.

Austria, France, and Italy have retained the old designation.

The front of the column of platoons may be decreased by forming column
of sections. The column of sections is suitable as a route formation on
broad roads; the transition from column of sections to column of squads
is not difficult, and for the purpose of passing through occasional
narrow stretches of road, the files on the flanks may be removed. In
most cases it is, however, more desirable to place several columns
abreast than to employ column of sections, because deployment is
facilitated in the former case.


Company in Column of Platoons.

[Illustration: Germany.]

[Illustration: Russia.]

 =Russia.= The four squad leaders of each platoon are posted on the
 flanks of the rear rank and in the center of each rank. The ranking
 non-commissioned officer of each platoon stands on the left flank of
 the front rank of his platoon. The 1st sergeant, the guidon bearer,
 and one trumpeter, and behind them two drummers, are posted in rear
 of the company.

[Illustration: Austria.]

 The staves of the guidon flags (_Jalonneurflaggen_) are inserted into
 the rifle barrel of a soldier (in case of a battalion into the rifle
 barrel of a N. C. O.) and serve to indicate battalions and companies.

 According to the color scheme used in Russia: red = 1, blue = 2,
 white = 3, green = 4. “R” indicates the number of the regiment in
 the division, “B” the number of battalion, and “K” the number of the
 company. A red flag is carried by the 1st Company, and a red flag
 with one green horizontal and one blue vertical stripe is carried by
 the 8th Company of the 1st Regiment of an infantry division. In Japan
 and England so-called storm-flags (small national flags) have been
 adopted to facilitate mutual recognition of friendly troops.

[Illustration]


Posts of Platoon Commanders.

In Switzerland, in Russia, and in Germany, the post of platoon
commanders is on the flanks of their respective platoons when the
company is in column of platoons. In England and Austria platoon
commanders are posted in rear of their platoons, with the exception of
the commander of the leading platoon, who is posted beside his guide.
In all other states platoon commanders are posted in front of their
platoons. Officers are posted in front of their platoons so as to
facilitate observation on their part, and so that their platoons can
follow them. This position becomes a necessity when the regulations
require that all movements of the company be executed at commands given
by platoon commanders. When they are posted in front of their platoons,
they cannot supervise their men unless they turn around to do so.

The column of platoons is a close column from which line cannot be
formed directly. It has not been found necessary in Germany to provide
an open column permitting prompt deployment toward a flank. The column
of platoons unites the company on the smallest space and facilitates
supervision, but in companies at full war strength it is not well
adapted for executing changes of front and for taking advantage of
cover, on account of the size of the platoons (40 files each). In
platoons at war strength the men look more toward the point upon which
they are to march than upon the enemy, and the deployment of the rear
platoons offers difficulties which occur principally when a deployment
in an oblique direction or one by the whole company becomes necessary.

The column of platoons is formed by the flank platoons placing
themselves in rear of the center platoon. Line is again formed by rear
platoons moving to right and left and abreast of the leading platoon.

The German company column is much more flexible, and the advantage
of a prompt deployment for action, made possible by the fact that
all platoon commanders and the heads of platoons are in the lead and
therefore can see the objective, should not be underestimated. The
company column is formed from line by the center platoon forming column
of squads to the front (or rear), the flank platoons, each in column
of squads, closing on the center platoon, heads of the three columns
on the same line. Company column is formed as follows from column of
platoons: the leading platoon executes squads right (left), column left
(right), the two rear platoons execute squads right (left), and are
led to a position abreast of the leading platoon. Company column from
column of squads is formed by rear platoons moving to the right and
left respectively, and abreast of the leading platoon.

When line is to be formed from company column, the flank platoons
have to incline to the right and left respectively in order to gain
sufficient interval.


Movements in Column.

For marching short distances to a flank, column of twos may be
employed; for longer distances, column of squads (or fours); and the
march direction may be changed by inclining in the proper direction.

      *       *       *       *       *

Since March 1904, experiments, which deserve to be mentioned here,
have been made in France under the direction of Colonel Fumet, having
for their object the simplification of the drill regulations. In the
experiments a four-rank formation is being considered. In this proposed
scheme the platoon is formed so as to place the four single-rank squads
(_escouades_) in rear of each other at the very close facing distance
of 0.50 m., the leaders of the _escouades_ taking post on the right
flank, a first class private being posted on each flank and in the
center of each _escouade_.

[Illustration: Forming Double Rank from the Four-Rank Formation and the
Reverse Movement.]

[Illustration: Deployment of a Half-Platoon formed in Four Ranks into
Two Half-Platoons formed in Double Rank.]

[Illustration: The Platoon (_section_) in Line.]

[Illustration: Deployment of a Half-Platoon Into Line of Skirmishers.]

[Illustration: The Company.]

The platoon at war strength (50 men) has a front of 8-10 m. and a
depth of 3 m. The movements are very simple. Route column is formed by
simply facing to flank, without first dividing the platoon into squads.
Double rank line may be formed from column of fours, by executing
right and left front into line. The double rank line may be deployed
into half-platoons. Furthermore, a single rank line may be formed by
the men of the rear rank stepping up into the front rank. One drawback
of this scheme is, that, in forming route column, facing distance of
0.80 m. between ranks is to be gradually gained after stepping off.
The deployment of half-platoons into line of skirmishers offers no
difficulties. It is otherwise, however, when the platoon is formed in
four ranks and marching in platoon front, for then line of skirmishers
can be formed only by deploying each rank in turn. The depth of the
column may be decreased by placing platoons (formed in column of twos
or fours) abreast, this expedient affording a suitable route formation
on broad roads. The company is formed by placing the platoons on a
line and abreast of each other at intervals of 2 m. In the battalion,
column of platoons and “mass” are the only formations considered. In
the “mass” formation the companies, each in line, are in rear of each
other.


7. THE BATTALION.

The movements of the battalion have been considerably simplified
in all armies. Battalion drill is, however, necessary, since, as
shown by the advance of the IInd Army on the morning of August 18th,
1870, simultaneous movements of large masses across country will be
unavoidable in future wars on account of the great size of modern
armies.[76]

   [76] Additional examples: Advance of the 6th Infantry Division on
 Vionville. _Gen. St. W._, I, p. 556. The flank march made by the 3rd
 and 4th Bavarian Brigades from La Maladerie toward Schloss Goury (5
 km. battle of Loigny). HÖNIG, _Volkskrieg_, IV, p. 22.

   Advance of the 33rd Infantry Brigade from Champdoux against Loigny
 (_ibid._, IV, p. 80).

   Advance of the 22nd Infantry Division from Lumeau on Poupry, 4.5
 km. (_ibid._, IV, p. 139).

   Advance of the French to the battle on December 1st, 1870 (_ibid._,
 III, p. 164).


Normal Formation of the German Battalion.

The four columns of platoons, or the company columns of a battalion,
may be placed, as dictated by space or purpose, abreast of each other
as a =broad column= (_Breitkolonne_), or in rear of each other as a
=deep column= (_Tiefkolonne_). The numerical order of companies is
immaterial.

[Illustration: Deep Column.]

[Illustration: Broad Column.]

[Illustration]

The deep column is employed for assembling troops if the terrain
necessitates a formation on a narrow front. If sufficient distance is
allowed between companies, line may be formed to a flank, but this
increases the depth of the column to such an extent that movements
at attention are impossible. The deep column may be used as a route
formation in addition to the column of squads. During the change from
route formation to that of action, the deep column formation may be
retained so long as the depth of the whole column does not have to be
further reduced. When necessary, the deep column may be replaced by a
formation in which the four companies, each in route column, are placed
abreast of each other.

The broad column finds proper employment, aside from parades, in cases
where the terrain or the contemplated deployment requires more front
than depth. It is also advisable to assemble the widely scattered
troops in a broad column after an action. The broad column does
not lend itself, however, to the execution of changes of front by
battalion; but should such changes of front become necessary, they are
always to be executed by company.

The color is posted between the right and left center companies, in
broad column, and on the right flank of the third company, in deep
column. In action the color remains with the company with which it
happens to be at the moment.[77] Should this company also join the
firing line, the color accompanies it; but under all circumstances one
squad must remain with the color. (Par. 236 German I. D. R.). It has
been contended that this is a disadvantage, as the enemy can direct
his fire on the color and the men in its vicinity. If the colors, upon
which the soldiers have been sworn, are taken into the field, it is
always better to endure the unavoidable losses incidental to carrying
them, and even to expose them to capture, than to send them back to
a safe place under escort.[78] At the Albrechtshaus farm (Wörth)
the colors served as rallying points around which the disordered
skirmishers rapidly assembled.[79]

   [77] In Japan the color joins the battalion commander. British
 troops leave their colors in their garrisons. In Russia and France
 the color is carried only by one battalion of each regiment.

   [78] See KUNZ, _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, 14, p. 180,
 battle of Wörth. A platoon of the Füsilier-Battalion of the 47th
 Infantry was sent to the rear with the color, and a squad of the
 Füsilier-Battalion of the 46th Infantry finally had six colors
 to guard. In the 88th Infantry, out of a total of 48 sections, 9
 sections remained in rear as a guard for 2 colors, but finally 6 of
 these sections crossed the Sauer.

   [79] KUNZ, _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, 13, pp. 77, 152.

The figures given on pages 72 and 73 of the German Infantry Drill
Regulations illustrate formations with organizations at peace strength.
The approximate dimensions of broad and deep columns at war strength
are as follows:

[Illustration]

 =Russia.= Numerous formations are prescribed. In addition to route
 column, columns with half company front and with company front are
 prescribed. Reserve columns are mentioned. These, according to the
 number of companies on the same line, are called single platoon
 column (deep column), two platoon column (double column), or four
 platoon column.

 =Austria.= _The mass_, in which the companies of the battalion are
 on the same line, each company in company column[80] with intervals
 of three paces between companies, is employed for assembling the
 battalion in a restricted space in a position in readiness when out
 of range of hostile fire, or for assembling the battalion under
 cover. The _line of columns_, in which the companies, each in column
 or some other suitable formation, are formed abreast of each other at
 deploying intervals plus three paces, is also used.

   [80] In the Austrian company column (_Kompagniekolonne_), the
 platoons, each in line, are formed one in rear of the other. This
 formation was formerly called company column (_Kompagniekolonne_)
 by the Germans also, but at present they designate it by the term
 “column of platoons” (_Zugkolonne_). _Translator._

 _The line._ In this formation the companies, each in line, are placed
 abreast of each other at intervals of three paces.

 _The column._ In this formation the companies are placed in rear of
 each other, each either in line or in column, with distances of nine
 paces between companies. The companies are numbered 1st, 2nd, 3rd,
 4th, etc., from head to rear, if in column, and from right to left,
 if in line.

 =Italy.= The formations are like those of Austria, but the double
 column has been retained.

 =Japan.= The only formations prescribed are the broad and deep column.

 =France.= The companies are formed in column or in _ligne de sections
 par quatre_, intervals and distances being 10 paces. Distances and
 intervals may be increased when required. The _battalion in line_ in
 which the companies are formed in line in numerical order, abreast of
 each other at intervals of six paces, is only retained as a parade
 formation.

 _Line of company columns_ (_ligne de colonnes_). Companies abreast
 with intervals of six paces.

 _Deep column_ (_colonne de bataillon_). The companies in normal
 formation in rear of each other at distances of 10 paces.

 _Double column_ (_colonne double_). Intervals and distances 10 paces.

 The formation in which the companies are abreast of each other, each
 in column of fours at deploying intervals, is employed in marching
 across country and also under artillery fire. Only the regiment
 carries a color, the battalion a guidon (_fanion_).

[Illustration: =Deep Column=

(_colonne de bataillon_).

The companies in line of platoons in column of fours (_ligne de
sections par quatre_).]

[Illustration: =Double Column=

(_colonne double_).]

[Illustration: =Deep Column=

(_colonne de bataillon_).]

[Illustration: =Line of Company Columns=

(_ligne de colonnes_).]

[Illustration: =Double Column=

(_colonne double_).

The companies in line of platoons in column of fours (_ligne de
sections par quatre_).]

 =England.= Columns are formed, in view of the (8) weak companies in
 a battalion, with company or half-company front at full or reduced
 distances (_quarter column_). In actions with savages echelon
 formations and the square are also employed.

 =Switzerland.= The company is divided into four platoons. The line is
 used as an assembly formation and for purposes of parade. The company
 column, corresponding to the German formation of the same name, is
 used for movements on the battlefield. In both line and company
 column the platoons are posted abreast, at intervals of three paces.
 Finally the route column is used. This is formed either by wheeling
 by squads, or by platoons executing column right (left). On the
 battlefield the platoon may be deployed and formed in several lines.

 In the battalion, company columns in line of columns, or route
 columns in the battalion column, are posted abreast at intervals of
 10 paces. Line and double column are abolished.

Opinions are divided as to the value of the double column. Formerly,
when the double column was still the column of attack from which
deployment for fire action had to be made, a discussion of its merits
was of special importance. While Austria abandoned the double column
formation in 1881 and Germany in 1905, Switzerland replaced it by a
column having a front of two platoons (_Plotonkolonne_), and Russia
readopted it again recently. All other states utilize it as of equal
value with the deep column in making movements beyond range of
artillery fire and as an assembly formation in addition to the deep
column. The change from double column to any company column formation
is easier than a like change from the Swiss “Ploton column” (double
column of platoons), which has the same front, since in the double
column two companies can be deployed at the same time toward both
flanks.

The deep column appears to be better adapted for making movements and
for advancing under cover, and, on account of its narrow front, a force
in this formation is better able to adapt itself to the forms of the
ground in hilly or close country than a body of troops in double column
of twice the width of front.


The Battalion in Route Column.

(Par. 316 German F. S. R.).

The companies are formed in route column and follow each other at
distances of 8 m. Mounted officers, musicians,[81] led horses and
vehicles are to be included in actual depths of columns given and not
in the distances. A permanent extension of distances for the purpose of
restricting checks of the march to a single organization is as little
permissible as the permanent elimination or reduction of distances;
distances may be dispensed with temporarily only. The reduction of the
depth of a column, obtained by eliminating distances between elements
entirely, is so small that the rapidity of deployment gained does not,
by any means, compensate for the increased exertion of the troops.[82]

   [81] A trumpeter marches in rear of the battalion for the purpose
 of blowing “Give way,” when necessary to open one side of the road.
 At this signal all the troops close in toward the flank of the guide.

   [82] The depth of a brigade of six battalions on the march is
 about 2500 m. By eliminating distances between elements a space of
 only 100 m. is gained, while by marching in a front of six files,
 approximately 750 m. is gained. The march of the 10th Infantry
 Division from Weiszenburg to Preuschdorf, on August 5th, 1870, proved
 exceedingly fatiguing. The distances between organizations had been
 eliminated pursuant to orders. “Some of the rearmost elements had to
 double time uphill to keep up whenever the head of the column went
 down hill. Great fatigue and many cases of overexertion were the
 result.” _Geschichte des Regiments Nr. 37_, p. 124.

During the march the company commander goes wherever his presence may
be necessary for the proper supervision of his company. Neither are
platoon commanders tied to a fixed place; one officer is, however,
required to march in rear of the company. The company ammunition
wagons follow in rear of their respective companies, or, assembled, in
rear of the battalion. In marches in campaign the field train marches
separately.

The depth of the battalion on the march, without field train, is 400
m., and the depth of the field train is 100 m.

 =Austria.= Column of fours. Depth of a battalion on the march,
 including combat train, 670 paces (502 m.). The distance between
 companies is nine paces (6.7 m.).

 =France.= The distance between companies is 10 paces (7.5 m.). The
 depth of each rank is reckoned at 1.40 m. on the march (in Germany
 1.10 m.), and that of every 100 men at 50 m. Depth of a battalion,
 including combat train, on the march is 450 m.

 =Russia.= The distance between companies is 10 paces (7.1 m.). The
 battalion without combat train has a depth of 350 paces (249 m.). The
 combat train follows in rear of the regiment.

 A German regiment of four battalions with combat train has a depth of
 1,650 m. on the march; a Russian regiment, a depth of 1,725 paces (@
 71 cm.)=1,215 m. (elongation on the march not considered).

 =Italy.= The distance between companies is 10 paces (7.5 m.). The
 battalion has a depth of 422 m. on the march.


8. THE REGIMENT AND THE BRIGADE.

For a discussion of the importance of the regiment and of the brigade
see page 37 _supra_. All movements must be executed in an orderly
manner by regiment and brigade, in any formation, without breaking up
tactical units, and the entity of the whole body must be preserved at
the same time by a skillful use of the terrain. If necessary, a base
battalion may be designated.

When regiments or brigades are assembled, the formation, disposition,
intervals and distances of the tactical units depend upon the terrain
and the intentions of the commander. Frequently the tactical units
(battalions and regiments) are assembled in separate groups.

When considerations of the enemy and the terrain do not dictate
otherwise, the battalions, each, as a rule, in deep column, are
posted in one or more lines, at 30-pace intervals and distances,
rear battalions covering those in front or the gaps between them. An
appropriate formation will frequently be that in which route columns
are placed abreast and on the same line.

In the brigade, when assembled or deployed, the regiments may be placed
abreast of each other, on the same line, or in rear of each other,
_i.e._, in line or in echelon. When the regiments are formed side by
side, two adjacent independent sections are created, each commanded
by a regimental commander; this insures better supervision, better
control, and a more energetic conduct of the action, since the first
line can be reinforced by troops belonging to the same organization.
This formation, moreover, facilitates tactical combinations. It may,
however, be a disadvantage that the first line is not subject to the
orders of a single commander; that it is difficult to employ the
reserve battalions in one body; and that the brigade commander can
influence the action only by withdrawing units from the regiments for
the purpose of forming a reserve.[83] The echelon formation, each
echelon consisting of a regiment, is frequently used in rencontres,
because troops are thrown into action directly from route column.
The regimental commanders then become leaders of echelons, the first
line cannot be reinforced by its own troops, and the organizations of
different regiments finally become mixed. The echelon formation is
proper only when the second line is intended to be used independently
abreast of the first in the course of the action; for example, on a
flank, for the purpose of making or warding off a flank attack.[84]
When part of a larger force, the most suitable combat formation for
troops is usually the one in which the regiments are formed side by
side.

   [83] For historical reference as to the importance of the brigade
 in action, see essay published in _Jahrbücher für Armee und Marine_
 (August and September numbers 1877) entitled: _Die Infanterie Brigade
 in ihrer Entwickelung aus der Brigade von 1812_. In regard to the
 employment of regiments in line or in echelon, see Memoir by General
 von Moltke on the tactical lessons gained in the campaign of 1866.
 MOLTKE, _Taktisch-strategische Aufsätze_, p. 99, et seq.

   [84] The fight of François’ Brigade at Spicheren. _Gen. St. W._ I,
 p. 310, et seq. The formation, side by side, of the six battalions
 of the IIIrd Army Corps in the attack on the hill at Forbach
 (Spicheren) would have been inappropriate and would have disrupted
 all organizations.

The disadvantages of the echelon formation, when taken up from route
column, can be obviated by deploying the second regiment in rear of a
flank of the first. It should be kept intact in that position until the
decisive moment, although the state of the fight may, at the outset,
invite a more rapid extension of front.


9. EXTENDED ORDER.

Combats are begun and carried out in extended order. The defender can
be induced to disclose his dispositions, to occupy his position, and
to open fire, only by the advance upon him of a skirmish line. The
deployment of a thin firing line will frequently suffice to furnish
the commander of the attacking force with a clue to the strength of
the force holding the hostile position. In close country, skirmishers
are pushed forward primarily to guard against surprise the force which
sends them out, but when thrown forward only a few hundred meters in
open country, such skirmishers are unable to furnish protection. The
strength and density of a firing line (by means of which the fight is
sustained) depend upon marksmanship, upon the purpose of the action,
and upon the terrain. The poorer the marksmanship or the weapon, or
the more unfavorable the field of fire, the greater the number of
skirmishers needed (_i.e._, the denser the firing line).[85] If the
enemy is merely to be kept at a distance, less skirmishers (_i.e._,
a thinner firing line furnished with plenty of ammunition) will be
required, than if the action is to be carried to a decisive conclusion.

   [85] The Boers with their superior weapons and better marksmanship,
 and further because they never cared to become involved in a fight at
 close quarters, found thin firing lines sufficient.

Cohesion and order are best maintained, and the least time is lost in
action, if efficient, dense firing lines are led forward as units up to
the moment of opening fire. (Pars. 169, 321, 334 and 413 German I. D.
R.). But on open terrain such dense firing lines would begin to suffer
too great a loss at ranges at which they could not reply to the fire.
Nothing remains then but to cover the available front with a very thin
firing line, followed at irregular distances by thin skirmish lines
which ploy for the purpose of utilizing cover or for opening fire.
Skirmish lines of this description will hardly justify the opponent’s
expenditure of ammunition, as he can only cover broad spaces with
volley fire. On the other hand, these skirmish lines are in themselves
too weak to facilitate the approach of the following echelons by their
fire. Besides, it must not be overlooked that the soldier, separated by
a considerable interval from his comrades in line during the advance,
and withdrawn from the influence of his officers, succumbs more easily
to temporary spells of weakness and is more apt to remain behind
than the skirmisher in a dense firing line. The advance in several
successive, thin skirmish lines is therefore only an expedient. In each
case the leaders will have to decide whether, in view of the close
proximity of the enemy, a united advance with dense, powerful skirmish
lines is possible or advisable (for instance, when entering at once
upon the decisive stage of the action). Before opening fire the firing
lines must be sufficiently reinforced. (Par. 334 German I. D. R.).

This advance in thin skirmish lines stood the test both in the Boer war
and in the Russo-Japanese war,[86] but we must not forget that thin
skirmish lines are only maneuver formations in an attack that is to be
pushed home, and that the mistake made by the British of attempting to
make an attack with such weak skirmish lines should not be imitated.
The Japanese also used this formation after they had once opened fire
with a dense skirmish line.[87]

   [86] Four battalions of the 6th Division advanced at Paardeberg on
 February 18th, 1900, on a front of 2000 m. with 800-1000 rifles, in
 two lines of equal strength and separated by a distance of 300 m.,
 the remainder following at 400 m. Three battalions of the Highland
 Brigade even advanced on a front of 4000 m. See my lecture: _Lehren
 des Burenkrieges_. _Kriegsgeschichtliche Einzelschriften_, 33, pp. 43
 and 67.

   For the Japanese procedure see V. LÜTTWITZ, _Angriffsverfahren der
 Japaner_, pp. 44 and 66. BRONSART VON SCHELLENDORFF, _Sechs Monate
 beim japanischen Feldheer_, p. 217.

   [87] In regard to the advance of the 6th Reserve Regiment
 against Husanta-Kantsy at Mukden, on March 5th, 1905, BRONSART VON
 SCHELLENDORFF (_Angriffsverfahren der Japaner_, p. 225), says: “Some
 500-600 m. from the Russian position, individual men sprang out of
 the shelter trench at intervals of 10-25 paces, rushed forward for
 about 30 m., or perhaps farther, where they threw themselves down and
 fired. This procedure was repeated until a new skirmish line, with
 the men approximately 3 paces apart, had been formed about 100-150
 m. in front of the trench mentioned. The rest of the men, who until
 this moment had remained in the trench, now rushed forward in groups
 of 5-10 men for distances of 30 m., for the purpose of reaching the
 advanced line.”

It might be well to mention here that thin and dense skirmish lines,
when under fire, lose an equal number of men in proportion to their
strength, provided the front occupied by them is the same.

RESULTS OF A FIRING TEST AGAINST THIN AND DENSE SKIRMISH LINES.

 FIRE AT WILL, FREEHAND FROM A PRONE POSITION.
 ============+===========+=======+======+====+=======+========+=======
             |           |       |      |    | Hits. | Figures|
             |   Range & |       |      |    +---+---+  hit.  |
   Target.   | Elevation:|No. of |No. of|Time|   |   +---+----+Figures
             |     m.    |rifles.|shots.|min.|   | % |   |  % |missed.
 ------------+-----------+-------+------+----+---+---+---+----+-------
 180 head    |    680    |  166  | 1268 |  5 | 54| 4 | 49| 27 | 131
 targets     |Elevation  |       |      |    |   |   |   |    |
 placed at   |used: first|       |      |    |   |   |   |    |
 intervals of|600 then   |       |      |    |   |   |   |    |
 1-2 paces.  |700 m.     |       |      |    |   |   |   |    |
 ------------+-----------+-------+------+----+---+---+---+----+-------
 90 head     |    680    |  166  |  850 |  5 | 35| 4 | 27| 30 |  63
 targets     |Elevation  |       |      |    |   |   |   |    |
 placed at   |used: first|       |      |    |   |   |   |    |
 intervals of|600 then   |       |      |    |   |   |   |    |
 3-4 paces.  |700 m.     |       |      |    |   |   |   |    |
 ------------+-----------+-------+------+----+---+---+---+----+-------

The superior effect of fire on the dense skirmish line, as expressed
by the greater number of hits, and in consequence thereof, by the
gradually growing number of figures hit, is apparent. It is worthy
of note and at first glance strange that, presupposing the two lines
considered occupy an equal front, the percentage of figures hit is
the same. The explanation of this lies in the fact that in correctly
distributed fire any specified front space is equally covered with
hits so that it is immaterial for the relative proportion of figures
hit whether an equal number of figures is removed or added. While,
however, the dense skirmish line still has 131 effectives, the
weaker line has only 63 left. The casualties are therefore far more
perceptible in the smaller force.


(a) The Formation of the Skirmish Line.

Skirmish line with intervals of two paces between the men is formed at
the command, “As Skirmishers.” (Pars. 142 and 174-180 German I. D. R.).
The skirmish line may be deployed from any formation, in any direction,
either with or without first changing front. (Par. 177 German I. D.
R.). A greater interval than two paces must be specifically ordered.
Squad leaders hasten in front of their squads and form the framework
of the skirmish line. The men follow their squad leaders absolutely.
When the terrain requires it, squad leaders may increase or diminish
intervals without command. In other armies (for instance, in those
of Italy, France, and England) the desire to keep the skirmishers
under control as long as possible, has led to advancing the platoons
designated for the firing line at first in close order, the deployment
being made only when the state of the action requires it. In France,
the intervals between files may be increased, or a single rank line
may be formed before the force is deployed as skirmishers. During an
advance it will often happen that intervals are increased or diminished
in accordance with the peculiarities of the terrain. The advance is
continued until the command or signal “Halt” is given. If line of
skirmishers is to be formed when marching to the rear, the command is
first faced to the front and then deployed on the line then occupied.
(Rallying position, par. 180 German I. D. R.). On varied ground,
deployments will be made under cover whenever possible in order to
allow of an immediate advance in skirmish line from that point. The
number of platoons to be deployed depends upon the tactical situation.
When three deployed platoons are formed abreast, it is difficult
for the company commander to control them; but this formation is an
appropriate one if a company is surprised or enters immediately into
decisive action, or in cases where the battalion acting alone requires
complete units in reserve for additional tasks. (Pars. 462, 463 and 469
German I. D. R.). When the battalion is engaged as part of a larger
force, it is a good plan to occupy all the available front space at
once with skirmishers and to maintain the intensity of fire of the
firing line by constantly reinforcing it. The losses are less in this
case than when the men crowd together in groups. (Italy).

Platoon and squad leaders are posted on the side of their commands
facing the enemy while advancing; in moving to the rear, squad leaders
are posted on the side away from the enemy, their duty being to
maintain the march direction, and the platoon commanders remain in rear
of their platoons (_i.e._, on the side toward the enemy). Russia is the
only country where the leaders of a firing line are posted in the rear.
In Austria one non-commissioned officer in each platoon is designated
to march in rear of the advancing firing line for the purpose of
supervising the skirmishers. As this non-commissioned officer is to
prevent straggling, he should be selected with great care.

The platoon commander indicates the march direction to the leader
of the base squad, and, accompanied by the range finders and the
musicians, moves to a point at least ten paces in front of the line
of his squad leaders, as a rule, opposite the center of his platoon;
but he is not restricted to this position. He must possess mobility
if he desires to lead his platoon skillfully on varied ground, if he
expects to avoid interfering with neighboring platoons, and if he
wishes to observe the enemy at the same time. The musician keeps the
company commander constantly in view. (Par. 221 German I. D. R.).
The range finders observe the battlefield, estimate the range to any
targets appearing in view, without being specifically told to do so,
communicate the range found to the platoon commander (this should not
be done by shouting, as misunderstandings might result therefrom), and
observe the effect of the fire. (Par. 173 German I. D. R.).

Whenever the flanks of a skirmish line are not protected by other
troops or by natural obstacles, a few men under a prudent leader should
always be sent out as combat patrols to the flank, or better still, to
the right or left front. The patrol should under no circumstances lose
connection with the command which it is to protect, but, on the other
hand, should not stick so close to it that the file on the exposed
flank is in a position to see as much as the combat patrol itself. As a
report from a combat patrol frequently arrives too late, or cannot be
made at all on account of hostile fire, signals should be agreed upon
and the leader of the squad on the exposed flank of the line should
keep the combat patrol constantly in view. Signal flags may also be
employed advantageously in such cases.

 The =Austrian= deployment is similar to the German, the intervals
 between skirmishers being about two paces. In =Italy= the skirmishers
 are posted at intervals of 1.5 m. (_catena ordinaria_), but this
 interval may be increased by order up to three paces (_catena rada_).
 The interval between squads in extended order is 4-5 paces to
 facilitate volley fire by squad. The =French= deployment is similar
 to the German. An intermediate extended order formation is that in
 which an advance is made in line, the files at extended intervals. In
 =England= skirmishers are placed at intervals of 5-15 paces during
 the initial deployment. At short ranges where the decision is sought,
 one rifle per 2-3 yards of front (1.8-2.7 m.) is the rule, one rifle
 per yard of front (0.90 m.) being the maximum. In =Russia= and
 =Japan= the intervals are as ordered. In =Switzerland= skirmishers
 are posted at intervals of 1-2 paces; when a greater front is to be
 covered the intervals between squads are increased. The length of the
 rushes depends on the ground, the effect of fire, and the endurance
 of the men. In exceptional cases an advance by rushes, by squads or
 single men, is authorized.


(b) Movements in Skirmish Line.

Fire action requires steady breathing, and, on this account, all
movements to the position at which the fire fight is to be taken up,
should be made, as long as possible, in a free swinging stride. A
careful observation of alignment or of intervals cannot be insisted
upon. Cover found within the allotted front should be utilized
by ploying, but this must neither interfere with the harmonious
advance of the entire force nor cause a loss of the march direction.
Considerations of cover for individual men should not interfere with
the spontaneous progress of the movement. Orderly movements in long
skirmish lines are best made by designating a certain element as the
_base_, whose leader is far in advance of it; all neighboring leaders
maintain their intervals from, and endeavor to remain approximately on
line with him. This has the advantage of relieving the commander of
the whole line from looking after these details and leaves him free
to concentrate all his attention on the enemy. Minor changes of the
march direction are executed by inclining to the right or left or by
designating a new objective. More extended movements by the flank,
within range of hostile fire, are possible only under cover. Changes
of direction are executed like a gradual front into line, in which a
temporary echeloning of the elements, or one which can be adjusted by
degrees, is unavoidable. (Par. 185 German I. D. R.).

In the absence of cover, an advance in quick time will be possible
only at long ranges unless the hostile fire can be kept down by fire
from enfilading or commanding positions. Skirmish lines advancing
without fire support over ground devoid of cover, begin to suffer
appreciable losses at 1000 m. The more effective the hostile fire, the
more pressing the necessity of diminishing, as far as this is possible,
the periods of time during which the skirmishers present their whole
bodies as targets to the enemy. This leads in itself[88] to an =advance
by rushes=, since the whole distance separating the advancing line
from the enemy cannot be covered in one rush. Double time may be
employed by a skirmish line when it becomes necessary to reinforce an
advancing firing line quickly, to forestall the enemy in reaching a
certain point, or in moving under fire, from the covered fire position
occupied, to another position. It is impossible to prescribe definitely
and for all cases at what ranges the advance by rushes should be taken
up and when fire should be opened in advancing by rushes, since it
depends upon the intensity of the hostile fire.

   [88] KUNZ, _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, 14, pp. 40, 48 and 77.

The assailant will, in the first place, endeavor to advance without
firing, in order to reach those ranges quickly at which his fire
will begin to be effective against the well-covered targets of the
defender. The skirmishers advance in strong detachments, by rushes
of the greatest possible length, taking short breathing spells at
each halt. Very soon, however, the hostile fire makes this advance
impossible. A fire fight of variable duration must first make a further
advance possible by silencing the fire of the defender. In a serious
infantry engagement every step forward must be purchased by the fire
of the attacking infantry. The attacker will, in exceptional cases
only, continue his advance in long lines, although this must appear
desirable to him, for almost invariably only a part of his force will
still be able to gain ground to the front when supported by the fire
of neighboring detachments. Favorable local conditions, insignificant
losses, and, above all, the personality of the commander will embue a
force with the determination to advance.


Time Required for Making a Rush. Strength of the Force Making the Rush.

The squad requires 5-6, the platoon at war strength about 10-15 seconds
preparation for making a rush.

 To cover 80 m., requires 26-30 seconds;
  „   „   40 „      „     17-20    „
  „   „   25 „      „     10-15    „

While the attacker covers a distance of 80 m., the defender, if in
readiness, can fire 4-5 shots. This proves very clearly that, in order
to be able to make such a rush, a certain superiority of fire is
absolutely essential. These figures change radically as soon as the
troops are seriously engaged with the enemy and come under his fire
at short ranges. At short ranges, aside from the size of the target
offered, attempts to advance by rushes with entire companies must very
soon cease of their own accord.

The character of the terrain and the fire of the enemy play a decisive
role here.

The strength of the force making the rush is intimately connected with
the length of the rushes. A small, isolated force would run the risk of
being fired on by its own neighboring detachments. Besides, confidence
and moral courage are difficult to find in a small force. It is
difficult to carry forward long lines as units. The use of long lines
necessitates, as a rule, an almost complete cessation of fire, and, in
addition, mutual fire support suffers. Long lines should therefore be
employed only when the attacker possesses a very marked superiority of
fire. In practice it has been found advantageous to make the rush with
the smallest fraction led by an officer, _i.e._, with a platoon.

 The following appropriate statement appears in _Taktische Rückblicke
 auf 1866_: “In the danger zone which suddenly surrounds and startles
 him in war, the soldier feels, in the first place, a desire to have
 someone assure him that the seemingly critical situation in which
 he finds himself, is as it should be. His eye is naturally directed
 upon his officers. If the officer’s quiet glance reminds him that
 here, as in peace time, the first duty is obedience, and if he sees
 the officer subsequently advance fearlessly and vigorously, he will,
 as a rule, not worry about the why and wherefor. It is this faithful
 attachment to the person of his officer, rather than ambition and
 patriotism, which inspires the soldier to highest efforts. Those
 who suppose that all our soldiers are heroes simply because they
 are products of a courageous race, are very much mistaken. This
 would indeed be an invincible army, requiring no tactical advice,
 if its soldiers would do nothing in action but their simple duty
 voluntarily.”

The severest test of discipline is for a skirmish line to rise and
rush forward under an effective hostile fire. This movement had best
be executed with precision and energy even during peace exercises. The
formation and manner of execution must become second nature to the
soldier, like a movement of the manual of arms, which he retains during
his entire military service, and a knowledge of which he brings with
him when called to the colors during mobilization. The example set by
advancing leaders and the arrival of reinforcements, which move forward
through the firing line, have been found to be the most effective means
of carrying a skirmish line forward.

The critical moment occurs when the men rise and prepare to rush
forward, for an unsubdued enemy will be desirous to prevent, by
increasing his fire, any attempt to advance. The fire support afforded
by neighboring detachments would seem to have a conditional value only;
for, being themselves under fire, the skirmishers of these detachments
cannot be expected to divert their fire from the opponent previously
fired upon, to an enemy by whom they themselves are not threatened. In
oblique fire, the rifles, on account of their short barrel, interfere
with neighboring ones, and, in addition, expose the men advancing on
the flanks to the danger of being hit by the fire of their comrades.
The fire support is, therefore, restricted to hindering the hostile
skirmishers directly opposite from firing on the advancing unit. When
the terrain is favorable, infantry and machine guns should not hesitate
to fire over the heads of their own skirmishers. The coöperation of
artillery will, in any case, be of great value, and infantry will have
to select those moments for advancing when the defender is driven under
cover by the hail of shot.

The advance by rushes, consuming time and energy, is an expedient to
which the enemy compels us to resort as the only means of gaining
ground to the front. The firm determination to close with the enemy
and the ever-increasing difficulty of inducing the men to advance from
cover, require that long rushes be made. Short rushes are neither
consonant with the nature of the attack, nor with the desire to
close with the enemy. “Many halts during an advance are fatal to the
offensive.” (HÖNIG). The powers of endurance of the men, the character
of the ground, and the hostile fire, as well as the support afforded
by infantry and artillery fire, influence the length of the rush. If
the leader has already caused the skirmishers to rise, it is best to
let them run forward so long as the physical powers of the men and
the hostile fire permit. The only danger is that the men will throw
themselves down prematurely, and without orders. It is rather an
advantage that during the rapid advance, increasing both muscular and
nervous activity, the men do not think of danger and have no time to
pay attention to their fallen comrades. One fact is, however, worthy of
special attention: If we train a soldier to make long rushes in time of
peace, he will be able to make them in time of war, and it is easier
for a leader to decrease than to increase the length of rushes in the
field.

The short rushes are considered advantageous because they take the
enemy by surprise, in consequence of which he is not in a condition
to direct his fire on the advancing unit. Rushes should be made with
startling suddenness. They should not be made in step at double time,
but, on the contrary, as rapidly as possible (by rushing); by the time
the enemy directs his fire on them, the skirmishers should already
have thrown themselves down. Stragglers should also throw themselves
down, when the men in the lead drop down behind cover, and should then
endeavor to reach the firing line by crawling.

The enemy will concentrate his fire on the unit which advanced first.
The fire of this unit will at the start be rather weak, getting
stronger gradually. If this unit is left in its advanced position for
some time there is danger of its being thrown back; all neighboring
units must therefore endeavor to rejoin it as soon as possible.

The greater the superiority of our fire, _i.e._, the marksmanship which
compels the enemy to keep under cover, the greater the length of the
rushes and the rapidity with which they follow upon each other.

Short rushes with small units occur quite naturally, because the
platoon leader no longer succeeds in inducing his whole platoon to
rise, since his influence extends only to the men nearest him, and
because the flank squads at first remain behind and only gradually try
to rejoin the leading skirmishers. If only a part of the skirmishers
have jumped up, it is quite natural for them not to make a long rush,
but to throw themselves down before reaching the new position, because
of the feeling that they have been abandoned by their comrades and the
fear of running into their field of fire. Thus, in spite of the best
intentions of the leader, the short rush by small units occurs. In time
of peace, however, we should retain the long rush by platoons and not
endeavor to give human weaknesses the force of regulations.

When once compelled to employ short rushes the following question
presents itself: Is the advantage of such a small gain of ground worth
the trouble of inducing the soldier to rise for making an advance
by rushes? Would it, therefore, not be more profitable to =crawl
forward=? A man crawling on his belly presents a vulnerable surface
of approximately the size of a breast plate 50 cm. high. In an advance
made by a large unit, or over covered terrain (fields of standing
grain) crawling would be difficult (difficulty of maintaining the
direction of march and reduction of the rate of advance); it would
also be difficult to get men to advance to the charge after they have
crawled along in this fashion for some time. The supervision of a unit
crawling forward would also be exceedingly difficult. The following
results were obtained in experiments made under favorable conditions:
A distance of 500 m. was covered by crawling in about 10 minutes;
crawling tired the men, increased the activity of the lungs to such an
extent that deliberate aiming and firing was out of the question and
the motion produced a noticeable swelling of arms, hands and knees.[89]
The Boers occasionally used the following method: One man crept forward
once or twice his own length, raising his body slightly, while the
man next to him fired; then they exchanged roles and this procedure
was repeated uninterruptedly. In any case, troops ought to be able to
execute both the advance by rushes and the advance by crawling with
or without firing. On terrain devoid of cover a skirmish line will
frequently be able to advance only by crawling.

   [89] During the engagement at Paardeberg (18th February, 1900), the
 fighting line of the British 9th Infantry Division was reinforced
 by troops crawling up into the line, and carried forward to within
 450 m. of the enemy’s position. An isolated assault was subsequently
 repulsed by the Boers.

 Procedure: The man throws himself on the ground at full length, head
 resting upon the bent left arm, right hand grasping the small of
 the rifle-stock. The man moves forward by alternately bending and
 straightening the right leg. When the right leg is straightened the
 body slides forward without rising in the least from the ground, and
 the head also remains in position resting on the left arm. The head
 is raised only when the man fires his piece, the butt of which is
 placed against the shoulder. Crawling on all fours is very tiring,
 the man offers a larger target, and, in addition, is not immediately
 ready for firing.

 In this manner the Boers succeeded in shooting the enemy out of
 his position. The firing line, while keeping up an incessant fire,
 slowly but steadily advanced. The advance of this uncanny crawling
 line is said to have produced an especially disquieting and
 paralyzing impression on the immovable defender, who was tied to his
 position, because of his inability to inflict perceptible losses
 on these small, prone targets, and because, moreover, he himself
 was continually under a galling fire. As no assault was made, no
 opportunity was offered the defender for using his rifles against
 targets the height of a man. The British infantrymen were, however,
 insufficiently trained in handling their weapons independently. As
 to rise and to retreat meant annihilation, the determination to
 resist weakened gradually during the long fire fight, and, in order
 to escape from this seemingly unendurable situation, which grew
 more and more acute with every minute, and which paralyzed every
 energetic decision, one avenue of escape only seemed open, that of
 surrender.[90]

   [90] Engagement at Nicholson’s Neck, October 29th, 1900.
 _Vierteljahrshefte_, 1905, pp. 145 and 149.

 One who fought on the Boer side writes as follows: “After we had
 crept up, in this manner, constantly firing and crawling, to within
 about 300 m. of the enemy, we saw many white handkerchiefs waving
 over in his lines, as a signal of surrender. As we placed little
 credence in these signs of surrender, however, on account of many a
 bad experience, we continued the advance by crawling. But, as soon as
 we saw that most of the men in the enemy’s ranks were throwing away
 their weapons, we rose to make the British prisoners. When we came up
 with them, I noticed that a great many of the men were weeping like
 children. Later, when I voiced my astonishment over the morale of
 their troops to some English officers, they stated that it was due to
 the uncanny manner of our advance.

 “These officers stated, moreover, that the sight of danger
 approaching ever closer without their being able to ward it off
 effectively, caused great depression and alarm among their troops;
 for the Boers, utilizing every available rock in crawling over the
 plain, presented such an unfavorable target that the British fire had
 had very little effect, while they themselves had been constantly
 exposed to the Boer fire. All this, they claimed, had contributed to
 unnerve their troops.”[91]

   [91] _Supplement No. 8 to Militär-Wochenblatt_, 1900. _Spionskop_,
 in _Kriegsgeschichtliche Einzelschriften_, 34/35, p. 59.

=Lessons of the Boer War=: “The rushes * * * were of variable length,
according to the intensity of the hostile fire; they varied from 30
to 80 m. According to the opinion of many British officers it was
exceedingly difficult to induce skirmishers to rise and rush forward
under hostile fire; but that once upon their feet, it became necessary
to push the attack forward as far as possible regardless of the
increased losses entailed by the longer rushes.”[92]

   [92] _Kriegsgeschichtliche Einzelschriften_, 33, p. 69.

One who fought on the Boer side reports as follows in regard to the
British advance by rushes: “The men rose gradually and hesitatingly.
This gave the attentively watching enemy time to pour a well directed
fire upon the last men who arose. Thus even short rushes made by long
lines became generally too costly to be executed. Smaller groups,
on the other hand, were able to move with startling rapidity. * * *
Every sudden interruption of the firing that might attract the enemy’s
attention should therefore be carefully avoided, but, as a rule, this
is possible only when the advancing units are small.”

The British Regulations of 1896 prescribe rushes of 30-40 m., and those
published immediately after the war (1902) prescribe rushes of 70-90
m., but the rush is to continue only while the surprise of the enemy
lasts.


Russo-Japanese War.

In the Japanese army, the 5th Infantry Division employed short, and
very short, rushes by preference, while other divisions of the 1st Army
as a rule preferred long rushes. From an English work we obtain the
following data in regard to the length of rushes and the expenditure
of ammunition per rifle during halts between consecutive rushes in the
engagement on the Shiliho on October 12th, 1904, at ranges beginning
with 1,000 m.

From the table it appears that after gaining the superiority of fire,
beginning with the fifth rush, at about 625 m. from the enemy, the
length of the rushes increased; the last 400 m. were covered in one
rush as the enemy withdrew from his position.

 1st rush  132 m., about 30 rounds of ammunition per rifle
 2nd  „     58 „     „   15   „     „     „       „    „
 3rd  „     63 „     „   15   „     „     „       „    „
 4th  „     61 „     „   15   „     „     „       „    „
 5th  „     75 „     „   15   „     „     „       „    „
 6th  „    151 „     „    5   „     „     „       „    „
 7th  „    400 „
           -----------------------------------------------
           940 m., about 95 rounds of ammunition per rifle

If we assume that three shots per minute were fired from each rifle, it
follows that the attack consumed approximately 40-45 minutes.


Provisions of the Various Regulations Relative to the Advance by Rushes.

 =Germany.= (Pars. 188, 189 and 337 I. D. R.). To advance by rushes,
 the following commands are given: (Such) =Platoon (section, squad)
 Rush!... Rise!... March! March!= At the command =Rush!= the
 skirmishers finish loading, lock pieces, close cartridge boxes, and
 prepare to rise. Skirmishers lying prone take the piece in the left
 hand, lean on the right, and draw the right knee as close to the body
 as possible without thereby raising the body from the ground. After
 a brief pause, during which these preparations are made, the platoon
 commander jumps up and at the same time commands: =Rise!... March!
 March!= At this command the skirmishers jump up and rush forward. The
 length of the rush will rarely exceed 80 m. (Par. 337 German I. D.
 R.). While rushes should, as a rule, be as long as possible, short
 rushes, which are designed to leave the enemy no time for firing,
 should also be practiced. The principal thing is that skirmishers
 rise promptly and simultaneously and that they rush forward rapidly.
 The rush is terminated by the command “_Position_”; the sight
 setting is changed when necessary and fire opened without further
 preliminaries. Frequently the new firing position may be indicated
 before the rush is made.

 =Austria.= Rushes are as a rule made by platoons. “The length of the
 rushes depends upon the character of the ground and the tactical
 situation, as well as upon the physical condition of the men. They
 serve as an expedient for reaching the next firing position.”

 =France.= Rushes are made, without fixed rules, from cover to cover
 (_par bonds successifs_).

 =England.= (Regulations dated 1896): Originally the regulations
 prescribed rushes 30-40 m. long, but, as a matter of fact, their
 length was actually increased to 60 and 100 m. during the first
 engagements of the South African war, in cases where the fire of the
 enemy was not especially heavy. The regulations of 1905, recently
 published, state: “Rushes over open ground should not exceed 80-100
 yards (_i.e._, 70-90 m.) and will, in fact, rarely reach this length.
 At decisive ranges, _i.e._, under 540 m., they should be short enough
 to afford the enemy no opportunity to pour a well-directed fire on
 the skirmishers. When cover is available the advance is made from
 cover to cover.” At another place the regulations state: “On open
 ground and within effective range, long lines of skirmishers, rising
 simultaneously, will suffer heavy losses even when making short
 rushes; the sudden movement of smaller units may take the enemy
 unawares, so that for a time at least well aimed fire is avoided. The
 rush is continued only while the surprise of the enemy lasts. The
 shorter the range, the smaller the advancing units will have to be,
 and the shorter the length of the rushes.”

 All preparations for a rush must be made as unostentatiously as
 possible. The units following in rear should, whenever possible,
 advance beyond the leading unit which is lying down and firing. When
 an advance by rushes in units is impossible, individuals may run or
 crawl forward.

 =Italy.= Long rushes, at least with platoons, otherwise with
 companies, are used as a rule, so long as the hostile fire permits.
 When the intensity of the hostile fire increases, or after the
 organizations have become mixed, rushes can no longer be made by
 entire units but only by squads or like fractions. These leave the
 main line and endeavor to reach the next cover at a rapid run, or if
 cover be lacking, throw themselves down in order to open fire again
 at the shorter range thus gained. As a rule, the leading echelons
 open fire at once from their new positions so as to facilitate the
 advance of the others, unless special circumstances make it advisable
 to delay the firing until all the other units have reached a good
 position and are able to direct an effective fire upon the enemy.

 =Japan.= Rushes are made according to German pattern, their maximum
 length being 100, their minimum 30-40 m. Rushes are not made by units
 smaller than a platoon.

 =Russia.= Rushes are made by individual men, by groups, by sections,
 and by platoons. The length of the rushes is not indicated. When
 sections advance by rushes the platoon commander indicates the
 section which is to advance first, and also the order in which the
 others are to follow. The Russian regulations are the only ones which
 prescribe a “movement to the rear by rushes,” at a run.

Frequently, when the men are very much fatigued, when advancing over
plowed ground and through extensive grain fields, an advance by rushes
will be impossible. Whether =fire while in motion= ought to be
employed in this case should be determined. A preliminary condition
for its employment is, however, that the enemy’s fire has been subdued
or that he has been forced under cover. To advance against an unshaken
enemy with fire while in motion must lead to the annihilation of the
attacking force. While the defender scores only 12.8% hits against
advancing skirmishers at 700 m., the attacker scores only 1.6% to 3.5%
hits against head and breast targets. With such a discrepancy in fire
effect, the attack, if employing fire while in motion, is bound to
collapse, unless it has already gained a superiority of fire prior to
the advance. It is unfortunate that fire while in motion is frequently
employed when inappropriate during drills. The danger of men wounding
each other and of the advance hesitating because the officers are not
in front of the line is not to be underestimated. On the other hand,
the advantages of eliminating the difficulties of inducing the men to
rise, of the troops leaving their losses behind, of stragglers being
more easily detected, and of keeping the entire hostile line under
fire, cannot be denied. In war this method of advance will frequently
result without orders while advancing to the charge after the defender
has been driven under cover. (In Russia this mode of advance is
prescribed).

 During experiments in field firing, held in Austria by a force
 advancing from 1,400 to 600 paces, with an expenditure of an equal
 number of rounds of ammunition in each experiment, the following
 results were obtained:

     Regulation attack:             Fire while in motion:
 Time         26 min. 28 seconds      18 min. 40 seconds
 Fire pauses  12  „   18   „           7  „   40   „

                 Attacker against the defender:
 Percentage of hits     7                 16.7
                 Defender against the attacker:
 Percentage of hits     9.2               33.

 Percentage of hits obtained during the execution of the attack from
 1,400 to 100 paces:

 Attacker              22.7               20.
 Defender              32.2               51.2

There is no model advance within the zone of effective infantry fire.
All expedients, whether they be sneaking or crawling, long or short
rushes, or fire while in motion, are of equal value, if the force, kept
well in hand by the leader, is thereby brought closer to the enemy.
Every opportunity to gain a foot of ground to the front, offered by
flanking fire or fire directed at the enemy over the heads of the
advancing force, must be utilized. The effect of our own artillery
fire should also be attentively followed with a view to advancing when
the hostile skirmishers have sought refuge under cover to escape our
shrapnel.


Examples of the Employment of Fire While in Motion.

 The successful attack made by the 1st Turco Regiment at =Wörth=.[93]

   [93] V. BOGUSLAWSKI, _Geschichte des Regiments Nr. 50_, p. 212.

 This attack was made against disordered and exhausted troops which
 lacked officers and reserves. The attack was finally repulsed by
 Prussian artillery and the IInd Battalion of the 58th Infantry.

 The attempted sortie of the Turks on December 10th, 1877.[94]

   [94] Springer, VI, p. 204.

 The attack, made in superior force and supported by artillery, was
 successful in that the Russian intrenchments and rifle pits were
 taken. With the arrival of Russian reinforcements, which advanced
 against front and flank of the Turks, the situation was reversed.

 The attack made by Vinoy’s Corps on September 30th, 1870, against the
 VIth Army Corps in =l’Hay= and =Chevilly=: “The defender’s coolness
 and confidence in victory grew with this ineffective fire of the
 attack, and finally the dead were piled up in heaps by the steady
 volleys delivered by him at short ranges (300-400 paces).”[95]

   [95] V. SCHLICHTING, _Taktische und strategische Grundsätze_, 1, p.
 71.


Examples of the Employment of Rushes.

 1. Attack on =Le Bourget=, on October 30th, 1870.[96]

   [96] HOHENLOHE, _Briefe über Infanterie_, p. 80.

   KUNZ, _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, 10, p. 43.

 Two battalions of the _Kaiser Franz_ Guard Grenadier Regiment had
 to advance from Dugny against the enemy in the northwest edge of Le
 Bourget over 1,500 m. of very open terrain, covered only with high
 potato crops. The battalions were formed in two lines with two
 companies entirely deployed in the first line, and the battalion
 reserves in rear of the center of the line with files at extended
 intervals. The second line was formed similarly. The two companies
 in the firing line advanced at first without firing, by rushes of
 about 300 m. each, made by alternate companies, each moving forward
 beyond the point where the other had halted. When effective range
 was reached one company opened rapid fire while the other moved
 forward by long rushes. The companies in rear followed in a similar
 manner. The tall potato bushes partly concealed the lines while lying
 down. In this manner the two battalions reached the outskirts of the
 village almost without being checked, the defender having withdrawn
 to the interior of the village.

 The losses of the two battalions, while advancing by rushes, were
 insignificant.

 The regimental commander, bearing in mind the lessons gained at St.
 Privat, had drilled the regiment beforehand in this mode of attack.

 2. Attack on Redout No. 2, at =Scheinovo=, on January 9th, 1878.

 The attack by Skobeleff’s Division, consisting of four battalions
 (_Drushines_) of Bulgarians, and the _Ugla_, _Vladimir_, and _Kasan_
 Regiments, was to be made under cover of the fire of two rifle
 battalions armed with Berdan rifles, and of a provisional battalion
 of the _Ugla_ Regiment armed with captured Turkish rifles. The only
 artillery available consisted of a mountain battery, while the Turks
 were able to bring twenty guns into action.

 The Turkish rifle fire began at about 1,000-1,200 m., but the Russian
 firing lines continued the advance with shouldered arms. Only when
 the losses increased noticeably did they advance by rushes, _without
 firing_, from 750 to about 500 m. where they opened fire. The rushes
 were made by the entire firing line; the supports, with files at
 extended intervals, did not follow until the firing line had thrown
 itself down.

 After the firing had lasted for some time, the Ugla Regiment, from
 the reserve, was formed in three lines, each consisting of one
 battalion, each battalion again into two lines with 350 m. distance
 between lines (total depth of the column about 1,800 m.). From 900
 m. on, the advance was made by rushes, the entire force inclining
 to the right front. While covered by the fire of the skirmishers of
 the firing line in front, the length of the rushes was 100-150 m.
 At 250 m. from the enemy, the leading line, extending the line of
 the Bulgarian and Rifle Battalions, was able to open fire and, after
 about thirty minutes, when it was clearly apparent that the Turks
 were evacuating the work, the regiment began the assault, which was
 successful.

 Of the troops in the first line, the 11th Rifle Battalion lost 11
 officers and 422 men; the 9th Rifle Battalion, 5 officers and 269
 men; the original strength of each being about 800 men. Expenditure
 of ammunition: 11th Rifle Battalion, 120 rounds per rifle.

 The Ugla Regiment, which advanced in close order after the defender’s
 fire had been silenced, lost only nine officers and 391 men. The
 Kasan Regiment, which followed the Ugla Regiment, participated in the
 assault on the second Turkish position. The Turkish fire had abated
 to such an extent that the battalions were able to advance in rear of
 one another, each in two lines with distances of only 35 m. between
 lines; the intervals between companies were 15 m., and those between
 files were extended. Losses: four officers and 76 men. Expenditure of
 ammunition: 12 rounds per rifle.[97]

   [97] KUROPATKIN-KRAHMER, _Kritische Rückblicke auf den
 Russich-Türkischen Krieg_, III, pp. 168-186.

In contrast with these examples of long rushes, almost every obstinate
engagement with an unshaken enemy showed that “every step forward”
had to be literally gained by the impulse imparted by the arrival of
small, fresh detachments, that the rushes often faltered after only
20-30 paces, and that frequently nothing remained but to work forward
individually. (See pp. 76 and 87 _supra_.)

 The frontal attacks made at =Wörth=, at the Roten Berg at
 =Spicheren=, opposite =Flavigny=, on August 16th, 1870, and opposite
 the gravel pits of =Point du Jour=, on August 18th, 1870, etc.

 In the Russo-Turkish war, the engagement at the mills north of
 =Lovtcha=, the fight for the possession of the Green Hill ridges
 south of =Plevna=, and the fight during the advance from the west
 and southwest against the large work of =Gorni Dubniac=, show how
 rushes, repeatedly attempted at short ranges, faltered after only a
 few paces. “On a signal given by Ljapunov, which was to be repeated
 by all the officers, the men were to rush forward immediately. Just
 before the movement began, the Turks opened the usual incessant
 fire, and the simultaneous advance of so many squads was of course
 absolutely impossible. The rushes were, therefore, always made by
 groups of 2-3 men. These groups would rise, one in this company, one
 in that, run forward a few steps, and then throw themselves down
 again.”[98]

   [98] PUSYREWSKI, _Die russische Garde im Kriege, 1877-78_, p. 127.

 The attacks on =Railway Hill= and on =Hart’s Hill= (February 1900),
 on the =Tugela=, show an endeavor to advance at first by long rushes,
 then by rushes gradually diminishing in length, the infantry finally
 working itself forward by twos and threes for the purpose of reaching
 the last firing position from which the final assault could be
 made.[99]

   [99] _Kriegsgeschichtliche Einzelschriften_, 34/35, pp. 129, 139.
 _The Times History of the War in South Africa_, III, p. 539.


(c) Reinforcing the Firing Line.

If the fire power of the firing line is to be maintained after heavy
losses, or the intensity of its fire is to be augmented, or when it
finally is to receive the impulse for making a further advance, it
must be reinforced. (Pars. 226, 227 and 341 German I. D. R.). This
may be done by prolonging the line (platoons abreast at well defined
intervals), or, when space is lacking and after losses have occurred,
by putting men in the intervals (_i.e._, increasing the density of the
line and filling it up). When the firing line is prolonged, tactical
units are not broken up, and this facilitates fire control. Whenever
practicable, the firing line should be reinforced by prolonging it,
although the other method, that of placing men in the intervals and
gaps of the firing line, is more frequently used and more practical
because the arrival of fresh men and the replacement of incapacitated
officers occasioned thereby renews the strength of the firing line
(replenishment of ammunition). The breaking up of platoons is
unavoidable, and on that account platoon and squad leaders should be
trained in time of peace to form new units at once so that control is
not lost. In order to prevent the mixing of units, so far as this is
possible, and to keep the firing line filled up with skirmishers, even
during an engagement entailing heavy losses, it is indispensable that
the fighting front should be limited, that of a company in attack to
150, in defense to about 200 m. The unit designated to reinforce the
firing line endeavors to approach that line under cover, forms skirmish
line at any rate before leaving the last cover and advances by rushes,
or, if directly in rear of the firing line and under a heavy fire, even
by crawling.

 =Austria.= Both modes of reinforcing the firing line, that of
 prolonging it, and that of filling the intervals and gaps, are used.
 When prolonging the line the reinforcement may remain abreast of the
 firing line. During an attack efforts should, however, be made to
 advance beyond the firing line--“to overreach it.” The other method,
 that of filling up the line, is in attack, as a rule, to be used for
 the purpose of carrying the line forward, the rush to be made as soon
 as the reinforcement reaches the firing line. Signals are prescribed
 for prolonging the line without advancing beyond it, for reinforcing
 that line and advancing beyond it, and for filling it up and carrying
 it forward in a rush.


(d) Closing Up. Assembling. Re-Forming.

(Pars. 211-214 and 230-232 German I. D. R.).

The most effective method of preventing a mixing of organizations in
action is for all units constantly to endeavor to close in toward their
leaders, filling gaps as soon as casualties have occurred. Squads which
have sustained heavy losses unite with adjoining ones under a common
leader. This closing in can, as a rule, be executed only while in
motion. It must be effected gradually and the intervals ordered should
be maintained. Crowding of every description increases losses and
causes dangerous gaps along the entire front.

If in the course of an engagement, the purpose of the action and the
situation make it no longer desirable to retain an extended order
formation, each leader, from the squad leader upward, must assemble his
unit at once and place himself and it at the disposal of the commander
of the next higher unit. Formed bodies must be created quickly and held
well in hand by their leaders, without awaiting specific orders to that
effect.

The troops must be assembled very quietly and always facing the enemy.

The original organizations are not re-formed until the command “Fall
in” is given. (Pars. 214 and 232 German I. D. R.).


10. SUPPORTS.

(Pars. 222-228 and 341 German I. D. R.).

The limited front assigned to an organization necessitates, in the
first place, a division into firing line and retained fractions. At the
decisive stage of a fight every available man must, without question,
be in the first line.

Italy. Supports are not to be used when they cannot be maintained at a
less distance from the firing line than that separating the latter from
the enemy.

It is the duty of supports to reinforce and extend the firing line, to
cover the flanks (par. 222 German I. D. R.), to act as a reserve, and,
in case of necessity, as a rallying force upon which the firing line
can fall back. The presence of supports increases confidence in attack,
and the power of resistance in defense. Supports enable a leader to
influence the action, to give a firing line that has been checked the
impetus necessary to carry it forward, and to affect the action by
sending reinforcements to points where he wishes to gain an advantage.
The support follows that part of the firing line which, in all
probability, will need its assistance; if part of the same organization
as the firing line, it follows in rear of the center, otherwise in
rear of a wing. In a company advancing alone over covered terrain, it
will sometimes be necessary to place small supports in rear of both
flanks. Firing lines can perhaps advance for some time under hostile
fire, whether they move by twos, by squads, or by platoons, but the
power necessary for pushing home the attack must be imparted to them
from the rear; otherwise the energy of the attack will spend itself.
The necessity of having supports in rear of the firing line is clearly
illustrated in the very instructive engagement at Wagon Hill in front
of Ladysmith (6th January 1900). In this fight all attempts to push the
firing line forward failed, and the necessary impetus for the decisive
advance was not given until fresh supports were fed into the firing
line.[100]

   [100] _The Times History of the War in South Africa_, III, p. 200.

In hilly country the supports can fire over the heads of the
skirmishers in front of them without neglecting their proper functions.
(Switzerland and England). Such opportunities should not be overlooked,
as they increase the volume of fire.

Distances depend upon the object to be attained by the action and upon
the terrain.

When a decision is sought, distances should be decreased in the course
of the action. When this is the case, the leaders of all grades should
be animated by but one desire, that of being in front in order to
participate in gaining the victory. The duration of the crisis of an
action is usually brief, and in a very few rapidly passing moments the
leader must decide what to do with the troops remaining available.

When an immediate decision is not sought, it is advisable to increase
distances in order to keep the echelons held back in rear from coming
under fire. In any case, the distance between supports and firing line
should be less than the distance between firing line and enemy. In an
attack, supports should be close enough to the firing line to prevent,
by timely interference, a retrograde movement of the latter. On the
defensive, on account of the difficulty of bringing up supports for the
purpose of repulsing an assault, they will usually be placed a short
distance immediately in rear of or within the firing line (intrenched)
at the points where they are to be employed.

During an attack, whenever the lines in rear cannot be kept out of
hostile fire, care must nevertheless be taken that two echelons be not
simultaneously struck by a cone of infantry fire or by one and the same
shrapnel. The distance between echelons is therefore increased to more
than 300 m., and should not be reduced until the decisive stage of the
combat approaches.

In open country, supports held too close to the firing line will soon
cease to exist as such. When kept in close order, their losses would
be so great that the boldest men would join the firing line and the
less courageous would hunt cover. Everything depends upon the manner
in which supports are led forward, especially during that part of the
advance immediately preceding their junction with the firing line. In
this lies the whole art of fighting in deep formations. Covered terrain
permits distances to be reduced. The commander should be particularly
careful not to let this advantage escape him, since on such terrain it
is more frequently necessary promptly to reinforce the firing line.

The commander of the support must constantly observe the movements and
successes of the firing line in order that he may be able to reinforce
it in the most advantageous manner. Whenever he is obliged to split
up his command during a movement to the front, he should endeavor to
reunite it at the first opportunity.

The support should closely adapt its movements to those of the firing
line. When a part of the firing line makes a rush, the support halts
for the moment, and then runs forward to the next cover, simultaneously
with the next advancing unit of the firing line, and covered by the
fire of the skirmishers in front. “To make a rush at the same time as
the firing line was impossible, because, as soon as the latter rose,
the Turks opened a murderous fire. Whenever the firing line threw
itself down and returned the fire, that of the enemy became noticeably
weaker.”[101]

   [101] _Report of Lieutenant Borsov_, in KUROPATKIN-KRAHMER,
 _Kritische Rückblicke auf den Russisch-Türkischen Krieg_, III, p. 183.

The supports follow the firing line in single or double rank, in column
of twos or squads, in skirmish line or in line of squads, in quick time
or by rushes; it may also be advisable to deviate temporarily from the
direction of advance. Columns having a narrow front, so long as they
are not open to attack from a flank, are able to withstand long range
infantry fire. (Par. 224 German I. D. R.). On coming to a halt, it is
advisable to return to close order formation; at any rate, the leader
must get his command again entirely under control.


Supports in Rear of the Firing Line or Not?

Up to a few years ago (1894), the French battalion was divided into
firing line and companies of the second line. The Japanese, also, often
placed entire companies in the firing line, which could not be quickly
enough reinforced by the companies of the second line, because these
were held too far in rear. At any rate, supports are of advantage
during the first deployment before the situation is clear.

The following arguments are advanced against the employment of supports:

1. _The supports following the firing line suffer losses, without, as
a rule, being able to participate in the action._ This argument is not
well founded, since the criticism made with reference to supports is
equally applicable to companies in the second line. That supports threw
themselves into the firing line in the Franco-German war, in the belief
that they were needlessly suffering losses, was due to the fact that
they followed the firing line too closely.

Supports following the firing line closely (250-300 m.) can reach the
firing line quickly and can easily find cover on account of the small
angle of fall of modern bullets. Besides, the knowledge that supports
are immediately in rear, the moral factor, should not be underestimated.

2. _The supports may be commanded by inexperienced leaders, who will
not always act with the good judgment the situation demands and will
fail to seize the right moment for advancing._ (This can perhaps never
be avoided).

3. _Pushing the supports into the firing line tends to mix units,
makes control more difficult, and impairs the efficacy of fire._ These
criticisms are not applicable to a company, for it is in any case
impossible for the company commander to control the fire; this is the
business of platoon commanders.

The advantages of supports are, that they increase the number of
targets offered the hostile artillery; that, by reason of their small
size, they can utilize every accident of the ground; that they can
be kept close enough to the firing line to reinforce it in case of
sudden emergency; and that they allow companies in the second line to
be kept farther to the rear. A battalion, when part of a larger force,
need not keep formed bodies as supports; but a few platoons, following
the firing line in close order on the flanks, are an advantage. The
drawbacks of the _petits paquets_ would appear only if every company
were to preserve a support up to the decisive stage of the action.


11. COMPARISON BETWEEN CLOSE AND EXTENDED ORDER.

In =close order= the men are placed so close together that they can be
led by word of command and directly influenced by their officers. The
position of the individual soldier is fixed; the men on either side of
him interfere with his utilizing cover or his weapon. On terrain devoid
of cover, close order formations present such large targets to infantry
fire, that their employment, when exposed to the unsubdued fire of the
enemy, is impossible and must lead to annihilation. Thus the hostile
fire compels the most extended deployment.[102]

   [102] Even during the Franco-German war it was impossible to employ
 close order formations in the first line, when opposed by an unshaken
 enemy, although this was still prescribed by the regulations.
 Whenever this was attempted tremendous losses resulted. In the battle
 of Vionville the 5th and 8th Companies of the 35th Füsilier-Regiment,
 formed into a half-battalion, and following the other companies of
 the battalion, which were pushed forward as the first line, suffered
 in five minutes a loss of 9 officers and 150 men (out of a total of
 about 400 men) from infantry fire at 1000 to 1200 m. “The impression
 produced was so overpowering that the commands for extending and
 deploying could not be executed at all and that the half-battalion
 had to be withdrawn in rear of the cemetery where it was assembled by
 the three officers still remaining.” _Geschichte des Regiments Nr.
 35_, p. 23.

   In cases where troops appeared in close order each losses were not
 at all exceptional.

   On August 18th, 1870, the Füsilier-Battalion of the 85th Infantry,
 advancing from Vernéville, at first in double column, then in
 half-battalion column, to within 400 paces of the enemy, lost 12
 officers, 32 non-commissioned officers, and 437 men killed and
 wounded (52%) in 20 minutes by the cross-fire of hostile artillery
 and mitrailleuse batteries. At 800 paces from the enemy the fragments
 of the battalion were assembled in three platoons. _Gen. St. W._, II,
 p. 724. _Der 18. August_, p. 152.

   The success of the bayonet attack made by the 9th Company of the
 29th Infantry at St. Quentin may be explained by the inferiority of
 the opponent. _Geschichte des Regiments Nr. 29_, p. 499.

In =extended order= the soldier’s position is not definitely fixed; he
is not required to keep his body in a prescribed position, nor is he
expected to handle his rifle by the numbers as in the manual. Instead,
judgment, agility, courage, confidence in himself, skill in handling
his weapon and in taking full advantage of the accidents of the ground,
as well as unremitting attention to his leader, are demanded of the
skirmisher.

The difficulties of troop leading are, moreover, increased by the
noise and other disorganizing influences of the fight, especially
in broken or wooded country. Whether an organization is thoroughly
trained and disciplined is best shown in extended order fighting, for,
as the direct control of the leader on his command decreases, the
demands made on the initiative of the individual soldier increase out
of all proportion. It is at any rate more practical to develop this
initiative than to try to prevent the disorganizing effect of combat by
restricting the personal freedom of the individual soldier.

In order to keep troops well in hand and to deploy them quickly in any
direction, it is requisite that close order formations be retained as
long as the terrain and the hostile fire permit. After an action, in
order to make a renewed employment of the troops possible, they must
be assembled in close order without regard to the previously existing
organization.

In night combats, in actions against cavalry not supported by other
arms, in putting down rebellions, and frequently in colonial wars[103]
as well, the importance of close order formations increases when the
troops show a disposition to get out of hand.

   [103] The British _Infantry Training_ contains special regulations
 governing “savage warfare,” in which close order battalion formations
 are explicitly given the preference (order in echelon, square).

In extended order, infantry can most easily surmount obstacles, cross
difficult terrain, and take the fullest advantage of the accidents
of the ground, as cover against hostile fire and as rifle rests. In
extended order, infantry is, moreover, able to develop its fire power
most effectively, while at the same time offering the smallest possible
targets to the hostile projectiles. Thus the _skirmish line_ is the
principal combat formation of infantry; by means of it a combat is
initiated and carried through to the end.

Close order is best adapted for establishing discipline in the
simplest and most rapid manner by means of drill. At Jena the Prussian
battalions were not defeated because of their drill, but because they
were poorly led. What function drill had fulfilled at that time is
pretty well illustrated by the heavy losses sustained by the Prussian
infantry and by the fact that, although placed in a situation to which
they were entirely unaccustomed, the troops retained their steadiness.
No properly led army has been able to dispense with drill in developing
its discipline. In the days of linear and column tactics the ultimate
object of training was the leading of battalions in close order, in
magnificent array, against the enemy. By means of drill a passive
discipline was to be created in which intelligence played no part
whatever. We know with what energy the army of the First Napoleon was
drilled according to the wholly superannuated regulations of linear
tactics in the camp at Boulogne and during the brief pauses between
campaigns. A well drilled organization has ever, when well led, proved
equal to the occasion.[104] The electrifying word of command is an
important factor in assisting an organization accustomed to it to
overcome difficult situations. No leader will voluntarily dispense with
this aid. When Austrian shells struck the company of Count Finkenstein
during the advance against the Shipwald, that officer halted his
command, brought it to shoulder arms and did not continue the movement
until order had been completely restored.

   [104] Compare herewith _Der 18. August_, p. 463, in regard to the
 importance of discipline in the execution of the attack on St. Privat.

General v. Blume considers drill and skirmish training two distinct
methods by means of which efficient soldiers may be created. To
quote: “In this connection the most perfect results would undoubtedly
be attained by efficient drill and thorough skirmish training.”
Where both these methods cannot be coördinated, training in extended
order fighting should take precedence. General v. d. Goltz raises
the objection that this might perhaps produce skirmishers, but not
soldiers, _i.e._, _men whose devotion to duty surpasses their fear of
death_. General v. d. Goltz is right in demanding combat drill. In this
term he includes the painstaking execution of all those accomplishments
which the skirmisher needs in action and which he should be able to use
correctly and quickly without lengthy deliberation. To this category
belong rapid loading and setting of the sight, good pointing in any
position, accurate aiming, cool firing, quick locking of the piece,
prompt jumping up for the advance, taking advantage of accidents of the
ground in lying down for the purpose of heightening the fire effect,
crawling forward with or without firing, etc., etc. Since all these
things must be practiced individually, and since many of them do not
permit of simultaneous execution by an entire unit, we usually speak of
combat training instead of combat drill, without, however, intending
any other meaning.

“Drill is always mechanical. The instructor can make the skirmisher
load quickly and carefully, can cause him to take the position of
aim, just as he drills the correct execution of present arms and the
rise preparatory to advancing by rushes. Training is directed at the
mentality of the man, it makes him independent and allows him to
exercise initiative, even when he is no longer directly under his
superior officers’ influence, and when, in a critical hour, he is no
longer able to follow their example.

“Drill and training are both justified, each in its appropriate sphere;
the scope of both is closely defined and neither one could be dispensed
with. ‘Drill’ assists in creating the ‘soldier,’ because it develops
the characteristics which must be required of a ‘soldier’: Endurance
in surmounting hardships and dangers, unquestioning subordination of
his will to that of the leader, tenacity and trustworthiness, skill
in handling his weapon and in utilizing the ground. The addition of
training will, of course, increase the value of this ‘soldier’ very
considerably.

“Training alone will never attain this object. To arouse and develop
the man’s intellect may make him a good skirmisher, a skillful member
of a patrol, but for battle he remains incomplete, since his awakened
mental powers have not been made available by the disciplining drill.
His energies are not governed by a higher will. Nothing can give us the
assurance that he may not fail at the most decisive moment. He is no
soldier.”[105]

   [105] V. D. GOLTZ, _Zur Gefechtsausbildung_, p. 26.

The French, for reasons inherent in their character, discard this
drill and seek to replace it by developing the moral factors: “Moral
powers are the mightiest pillars of success. Honor and patriotism fill
troops with the noblest devotion. The spirit of self-sacrifice and
the determination to win ensure success; discipline and steadiness
guarantee the influence of the leaders and the coöperation of all the
elements.”[106]

   [106] _Introduction to the French Infantry Drill Regulations_.

 “However, when necessity demands the creation of new
 organizations--whether militia, volunteers, or _gardes mobiles_,--it
 is a great mistake to expect everything from moral factors; even
 though hatred of the enemy, enthusiasm for the fatherland, the
 republic or for glory, rise to the highest pitch. ‘Victory or
 death’ is the watchword when marching out--but neither is quickly
 attainable; weeks and months of the severest hardships, exhausting
 marches, wet and hungry bivouacs must first be endured. Very soon the
 intoxication of enthusiasm is gone and reality weighs heavily on the
 sobered men. Finally the enemy is confronted. But he is not to be
 annihilated at once by a rapid assault--not at all; the advance is
 made very slowly and the highest enthusiasm is given ample time to
 evaporate during the many hours in which death is constantly faced.”
 LAYMAN.

For enthusiasm, we would substitute faithful, unselfish performance of
duty, and unquestioning subordination of the will of the individual
to that of the leader. To be sure, on days of success enthusiasm will
suffice, but not when everything around us begins to waver and to
yield. The importance of drill, which cannot be replaced by anything
else, does not become apparent until all enthusiasm disappears, until
the leader becomes conscious of the specter of panic which stalks by
the side of enthusiasm.

“Discipline,” says Archduke John in his well-known work _Drill or
Training_, “must not be confounded with the snappy drill of troops,
and can, moreover, not be attained by means of it. The straightjacket
has never yet cured one insane person; the soul cannot be disciplined
through the body. One must work from the inside and not from the
outside. It is of little value if the outer annular rings of a tree are
beautiful and regular; it will rot and die in spite of its deceptive
appearance; if its heart is not healthy, the first storm may bring it
down. The inner man must look beautiful; firmness and steadiness are
needed within; the marching tread of feet on the drill ground plain
are of no moment; the beat of the heart filled with the spirit of
self-sacrifice is the important factor.”

It is well known that Emperor William I. changed the title of the
brochure _Drill or Training_, written by Archduke John, to _Drill
and Training_. Training necessitates a good corps of instructors and
a great deal of time, whereas drill will accomplish in a shorter
time results which are not so enduring. It is again presupposed that
the recruits are willing to be trained, otherwise all efforts are
unavailing. The question whether the individual man can be influenced
sufficiently in a two years’ service period to overcome even sentiments
inimical to the state, instilled in him by friends or relatives, can
only be answered by the next war. To answer this question at the
present time would be premature; but one thing is certain: the sharp
word of command, the whole influence of a well-organized body of
troops, will sweep along even the reluctant in the hour of danger.

The importance of the tactical formations which at one time constituted
minor tactics has doubtlessly decreased; unfavorable formations, in
so far as they increase or reduce losses, increase or restrict one’s
fire effect, can be offset by the fighting efficiency of the soldier
and by proper leading. The unfortunate termination of the battle of
Jena for the Prussian arms, as already mentioned, bears no relation
to drill as such. The formations in themselves were not at fault, for
linear tactics scored the greatest successes in the Peninsular war
and at Waterloo; and at the Katzbach, Prussian battalions of Borke’s
Brigade in line overran the French columns. Within certain limits,
numerical inferiority and lack of fighting efficiency can be offset by
leadership. But numbers and fighting efficiency will always remain the
decisive factors for success.

The victory of Spicheren was due primarily to the troops and not to
leadership. This is likewise true of Wörth. The lion’s share in the
victory of Vionville is certainly due to the fighting efficiency of the
gallant Brandenburgers. Finally, at St. Privat, the crisis produced
by the commanders was successfully overcome only by the tenacity of
the troops, who maintained their positions for hours under the most
destructive hostile fire.

Increased demands must at present be made upon the combat training
of the soldier. The combat requires enterprising, self-sacrificing,
cold-blooded men who are imbued with the spirit of the reckless
offensive. “The combat requires thinking leaders, _trained to rely upon
themselves_, and _skirmishers having initiative_.” (Par. 2 German I.
D. R.). “Judgment, self-confidence and boldness must be aroused and
continually developed in the young soldier.” (Par. 144 German I. D.
R.). “The aim of all exercises should be to develop the soldier into
a self-thinking and conscientiously working skirmisher.” (Par. 158
German I. D. R.). “All training should be directed toward producing
self-reliance in leaders and in the individual skirmisher.” (Par. 251
German I. D. R.). “The infantry must nourish the desire for taking the
offensive; its actions must be guided by the one thought, _forward,
at the enemy, no matter what the cost_.” (Par. 265 German I. D. R.).
“The continuous desire to press forward and the endeavor to surpass
all other units must animate all parts of the attacking force.” (Par.
327 German I. D. R.). “It should be a point of honor with skirmishers
not to allow the supports to overtake them earlier than the moment of
penetrating the enemy’s position.” (Par. 348 German I. D. R.). “Those
who fall must be left behind. These sacrifices should not lead to an
abatement of the pursuit any more than the losses sustained in the
previous fight caused the renunciation of the purpose of the combat.”
(Par. 424 German I. D. R.). “A commander who is ever willing to
shoulder responsibility will not shrink from throwing troops into the
fight _regardless of consequences_ even when the outcome of the battle
is doubtful.” (Par. 304 German I. D. R.).

If love of life and fear of death are overcome in a soldier by
discipline, in an officer this must be brought about by a higher sense
of duty and honor. On the battlefield the desire to live does not
appear in a cultured person, as a rule, in its ordinary, undisguised
form; it makes itself felt rather in the shape of tactical scruples,
whether the leader would be justified in leading his subordinates
to certain death, whether it would not be his duty to preserve the
force entrusted to him for more important duty in the service of the
fatherland, instead of sacrificing it uselessly. If, in addition, an
officer has been allowed, in time of peace, to criticise, from the
start, an order of his superior with reference to its feasibility, it
may easily happen in the stern reality of actual war that a subordinate
leader, neither especially courageous nor ambitious, succumbs to the
seductive whisperings of his senses on the approach of danger and sees
in caution the better part of valor. It is always suspicious if troops
have become accustomed to consider insignificant losses, common to
colonial wars, accompanied by great physical exertions, as indications
of good leadership.[107] Great victories are, as a rule, invariably
accompanied by great losses.

   [107] In this connection and in regard to the British losses in
 South Africa, see my lecture: _Die Lehren des Burenkrieges_ (1904),
 p. 8, et seq. The behavior of Sir Redvers Buller at Colenso and
 Spionskop is interesting. See _The Times History of the War in South
 Africa_, III, pp. 234, 236, 297, 318.




III. THE POWER OF FIREARMS AND EXPEDIENTS FOR MINIMIZING LOSSES.


A. THE POWER OF FIELD ARTILLERY.


1. THE FIELD GUN.

The field artillery of all the states that need be considered is armed
with a rapid-fire gun provided with shields and capable under peace
conditions of firing as many as twenty shots per minute. Its caliber
varies from 7.5 to 8.38 cm. (Germany, 7.7; France, 7.5; Russia,
7.62, and England, 8.38 cm., the last-named being an 18 pdr.). The
German gun fires shrapnel weighing 6.85 kg. (the Russian, 6.5, and
the French 7.25 kg.) and high explosive shell of approximately the
same weight, with an initial velocity of 465 m. (the Russian 588 and
the French 530 m.). The projectiles are burst through the action of
combination fuzes (in Germany graduated to 5000, in France and Russia
to 5500 m.). The projectiles have a maximum range of 8000 m., when
percussion fuze is used. Canister has been replaced by shrapnel, which
bursts approximately 200 m. in front of the gun when the fuze is set
at zero. The German field artillery is also equipped with a light
field howitzer, cal. 10.5 cm., which fires shrapnel weighing 12.8 kg.
(time fuze ranging from 300 to 5600 m.) and shell weighing 15.7 kg.
(time fuze ranging from 500 to 5600 m.). The Germans use heavy field
howitzers (cal. 14.91 cm., firing shell that has an extreme range of
6870 m.) in the heavy artillery of the field army. France uses the 15.5
cm. Rimailho howitzer, England a 12.7 cm. howitzer and another long
piece of 12 cm. caliber.

=Percussion shrapnel= is used for defense at short range, and in fire
for adjustment; its effect depends upon the range and the nature of
the ground. It is effective against troops lodged in tall timber.
Masks, branches of trees, etc., frequently cause the premature burst of
the projectiles.[108]

   [108] Engagement of Azay (6th January, 1871). _Geschichte des
 Regiments Nr. 20_. HOFFBAUER, _Deutsche Artillerie_, I, pp. 16 and
 49. _Taktik_, VI, p. 42.

Percussion shrapnel is effective only when bursting immediately in
front of the target (5-25 m. in front of it, depending upon the range).
However, even in this case, the bullets often pass over low targets,
such as skirmishers lying down, and low parapets afford sufficient
protection. An adequate effect can be obtained only when the fire is
directed on vertical targets. Soft ground, newly ploughed fields,
terrain covered with snow or underbrush, small folds of the ground,
or a rising slope, diminish the fire effect. When the angle of fall
is 10 degrees or more (with the German piece at ranges of 3300 m. and
over) half of the bullets penetrate the ground, the remainder ricochet
and pass on at a greatly reduced velocity. The explosive or incendiary
effect of shrapnel is insignificant owing to the smallness of the
bursting charge. However, some incendiary effect is possible if the
projectile strikes an easily inflammable target.[109]

   [109] Consult _Taktik_, VI, p. 45, in regard to the incendiary
 effect of projectiles.

[Illustration: Percussion Shrapnel.]

=Time shrapnel= (used in Germany up to 5000 m.) is fairly independent
of the terrain, the burst being easily observed since the bullets are
embedded in a “smoke-producing composition.” The extreme range at which
this projectile can be employed is fixed by the facility of observing
the fire and by the remaining velocity of the shrapnel bullets, both of
which diminish as the range increases. Field guns, model ’96, may be
effectively employed up to a range of 4000 m.; under 3000 m. their fire
is so annihilating that decisive results are produced in a short time.
(Par. 630 German F. S. R.). The use of the combination fuze, on account
of its certainty of burst, either by time or percussion, permits
the trajectory to be accurately determined in every case. This fuze
also makes it possible to employ shrapnel against rapidly advancing
targets, and in warding off a sudden attack at short range. The French
Regulations give the width of the beaten zone of a single shrapnel
as 20, that of two from the same piece as 25 m. The maximum depth of
the beaten zone is 300 m. The angle of the cone of dispersion of the
German shrapnel, model ’96, is 16 degrees at 2000 m. German shrapnel
(model ’91) fired at a line of infantry did not strike lines following
250 m. in rear of the first, whereas in case of base charge shrapnel
these lines would be safe only at 350-400 m. from the first line. The
German shrapnel gives very good results when set to burst 30 to 150 m.
in front of the target, the height of burst being regulated accordingly
(approximately ¹⁄₃ of the whole number of hundreds of meters of the
range). At ranges under 1500 m., an adequate fire effect may, however,
be expected even when the fuze is set to burst the projectile 300 m. in
front of the target. (Par. 30 German F. A. F. R.).

Shrapnel is most effective against skirmishers lying down from 1000 to
3000 m. when burst 28 to 22 m. short, and against standing skirmishers
at the same ranges when burst 56 to 45 m. short. The two tables given
below, borrowed from the work of Lieutenant-General Rohne on artillery
tactics,[110] give an idea of the effect of a single time shrapnel,
and of the effect per minute of shrapnel fire after adjusting upon the
target:

 ======================+=======================================
                       |When firing at the targets named (1
                       |skirmisher per m.) with time shrapnel,
       TARGETS.        |mod. ’96, set to burst 50 m. short, the
                       |following _hits per shrapnel_ may be
                       |expected after the adjustment has been
                       |effected:
 ----------------------+-------+-------+-------+-------+-------
                       | 500 m.|1000 m.|2000 m.|3000 m.|4000 m.
 ----------------------+-------+-------+-------+-------+-------
 Skirmishers standing  |  18.4 |  14.2 |  12.0 |  11.0 |  10.4
 Skirmishers kneeling  |  10.6 |   8.2 |   6.9 |   6.3 |   5.8
 Skirmishers lying down|   6.4 |   4.9 |   4.1 |   3.8 |   3.5
 Head targets          |   3.5 |   2.7 |   2.3 |   2.1 |   1.9
 ----------------------+-------+-------+-------+-------+-------

 ======================+=======================================
                       |When firing at the targets named
       TARGETS.        |(skirmish line with 1 skirmisher per
                       |m.), under service conditions, with time
                       |shrapnel, mod. ’96, set to burst 50-100
                       |m. short, the following hits per minute
                       |may be expected on an average:
 ----------------------+-------+-------+-------+-------+-------
                       | 500 m.|1000 m.|2000 m.|3000 m.|4000 m.
 ----------------------+-------+-------+-------+-------+-------
 Skirmishers standing  |  364  |  202  |  109  |  46   |   14
 Skirmishers kneeling  |  210  |  117  |   63  |  27   |    8
 Skirmishers lying down|  126  |   70  |   38  |  16   |    5
 Head targets          |   70  |   39  |   21  |   9   |    3
 ----------------------+-------+-------+-------+-------+-------

   [110] ROHNE, _Die Taktik der Feldartillerie_, Berlin, 2nd Edition,
 p. 9.

More than 80% of the men struck by fragments and bullets from shrapnel
bursting within 100 m. are disabled. The penetration of shrapnel
bullets is so great, at ranges under 2000 m., that when they strike
bones or vital organs of horses, they produce instant incapacity for
action. This is especially true when the interval of burst is less than
100 m. The effect of shrapnel directed against batteries provided with
shields is insignificant. Time shrapnel is the principal projectile
employed by artillery against animate objects, provided these are not
located immediately in rear of parapets, within tall timber, or under
bomb-proofs. This projectile is ineffective against such cover on
account of the flatness of the trajectory and the sensitiveness of the
fuze.

Shrapnel is to be supplemented by =shell= filled with explosive charge,
model ’88, which has a great explosive effect at extreme ranges and in
tall timber. (See pars. 159-160 German F. A. F. R., in regard to action
against shielded batteries).

 Percussion shell, on account of its very sensitive fuze, bursts on
 penetrating the shield, while percussion shrapnel goes entirely
 through the shield and bursts about ¹⁄₂ m. in rear of it.

[Illustration: Percussion Shell, Model ’96.]

Targets located immediately in rear of parapets or under light splinter
proofs may be reached with time shell burst directly over or close
in front of them. The depth of the beaten zone of this projectile is
small, seldom exceeding 50 m., even when the fire is directed against
targets in the open. About 75% of all the fragments are capable of
inflicting disabling wounds when the interval of burst is short. The
peculiar character of the projectile necessitates a very careful
adjustment in range and in height of burst. The French _obus allongé_,
a high explosive percussion shell (melinite charge; angle of the cone
of dispersion exceeds 100 degrees) is employed only for the destruction
of material objects.[111]

   [111] When firing on animate objects, the beaten zone of this
 projectile does not exceed a space 50 m. wide and 20 m. deep, but the
 concussion of the explosion will undoubtedly be felt at a greater
 distance. The explosive effect of the projectile is equivalent to
 that of 30 kg. of powder. The explosion of the projectile produces a
 cone-shaped crater having a diameter of 2 and a depth of 0.50 m. Ten
 melinite shells per running meter are required to destroy a parapet 3
 m. thick and 2.30 m. high.

The French projectile, on account of the fuze used, bursts only after
it has pierced thin walls or shields.

[Illustration: Time Shell, Model ’96.]


2. THE LIGHT FIELD HOWITZER.

The realization that the power of resistance of a defender lodged in
deep trenches, could not be broken by the fire of guns having a flat
trajectory, led to the re-adoption of a gun capable of high angle fire,
which had been eliminated from the field artillery upon the advent of
rifled cannon.[112]

   [112] After March, 1859, the artillery of a mobilized Prussian
 army corps consisted of three horse batteries, each armed with six
 6-pounder guns and two 7-pounder howitzers; six foot batteries, each
 armed with eight 12-pounder guns; and three foot batteries, each
 armed with eight 7-pounder howitzers. Thus the artillery of an army
 corps numbered 30 howitzers and 66 guns.

For both flat trajectory and high angle fire, the light field howitzer,
model ’98, employs shrapnel weighing 12.8 kg. (500 jacketed bullets, @
10 g.; time fuze graduated from 300 to 5600 m.) and shell weighing 15.7
kg. (0.37 kg. explosive charge, model ’88; time fuze graduated from 500
to 5600 m.). As delay action fuzes are used, it is possible to utilize
to the fullest extent the power of penetration of the projectile before
it bursts.

A single shrapnel from a light field howitzer produces a greater number
of hits, when the point of burst is favorably situated, than one fired
from a field gun. However, the projectiles fired from the latter have a
deeper beaten zone on account of the flatter trajectory of the piece,
and a greater penetration owing to their greater remaining velocity.
The German Artillery Firing Regulations (par. 30) consider the effect
of both projectiles “very good” and of equal value at the principal
ranges, when burst at a moderate distance (30 to 150 m.) from the
target. The effect of shrapnel from the field gun and from the light
field howitzer is considered adequate at ranges under 1500 m., when
bursts are regulated to occur within 300 and 200 m., respectively, in
front of the target. The superiority of the shrapnel fired from a field
gun is due to the greater penetration of the jacketed bullets (a result
of greater velocity of the projectile itself at the point of burst).
But in this connection it is to be borne in mind that the effect of
single shots only is here considered. The shrapnel fire of the field
gun is considerably superior to that of the howitzer. This is due to
the fact that the howitzer fires more slowly than the field gun and
must expend twice the weight of ammunition to produce the same results.
If, in addition, it is remembered that the field battery carries
approximately 2¹⁄₂ times as many shrapnel as the light field howitzer
battery, it is obvious that the fire of the former will be 2¹⁄₂ times
as effective, against targets in the open, as that of the latter.

The superiority of the heavier projectile asserts itself when it
becomes necessary to destroy material objects.

The shell fired from pieces having a flat trajectory is employed
against troops immediately behind cover. The shell is burst immediately
in front of, over, or in rear of the target, which is thus struck by
splinters from above. The more nearly perpendicular the splinters
strike the target, and the greater their number and weight, the greater
will be the effect produced. The angle of the cone of dispersion is
about 200 degrees; with appropriate points of burst, fragments weighing
15 g. (80%) incapacitate for action. In curved fire, at ranges beyond
2100 m., shell with delay action fuze is capable of penetrating the
splinter proof cover usually employed in the field. At ranges under
2100 m. its angle of fall is too small to make an adequate effect
certain.

[Illustration: Time Shell, Model ’98.]


3. THE HEAVY FIELD HOWITZER.

The heavy field howitzer employs shell weighing 39.5 kg., containing an
explosive charge of 0.85 g., and fitted with a percussion fuze either
with or without delay action. This shell is designed to penetrate the
roofs of splinter proofs. An earth covering 5-6 m. thick is necessary
to afford protection against these projectiles. At 3000 m. a 15 cm.
shell produces a crater 1 m. deep and 2.4 to 3.6 m. in diameter,
_i.e._, 2 cu. m. (in made ground this crater is three times this size).
The heavy field howitzer is a very effective weapon against shielded
batteries. A single shell, owing to its lateral explosive effect, is
capable of placing a whole battery temporarily out of action.


4. EXPEDIENTS FOR MINIMIZING THE EFFECT OF FIRE.

Movements of infantry under artillery fire are unavoidable when firing
lines are to be reinforced and when troops intended for the decisive
attack are to be pushed closer to the enemy. Formations calculated to
minimize the effect of the hostile fire must be taken up in time,
since it is not always possible to make use of cover. The efficacy
of the fire depends upon the accurate determination of the range and
height of burst (fire for adjustment) and upon the careful observation
of the subsequent fire (fire for effect).[113] The effect of this fire
is considerably increased when the opponent’s infantry, against whom
the fire is directed, takes up unsuitable formations (particularly
broad line formations). Infantry has frequently found it advantageous
to advance in small detachments moving rapidly at irregular intervals
in extended order.

   [113] The color of uniforms exerts considerable influence on
 observation. According to experiments made in France, colors rank
 as follows as regards visibility: white (invisible at night), light
 blue, alizarine red, green, dark brown, gray, or yellowish brown.
 _Schweizer Zeitschrift für Artillerie und Genie_, 1896, I, p. 39. The
 following colors protect against heat, in the order named (in reverse
 order against cold): white, red, orange, yellow, green, blue, violet,
 black. The position of gray in the list depends upon the amount of
 white or black mixed with it.


(a) Increasing the Difficulties in the Adjustment of the Hostile Fire.

A battery requires about 0.8 minutes (5 to 6 rounds with percussion
fuze) to secure adjustment at ranges up to 750 m. The time required for
securing adjustment at the longer ranges is as follows:

 At 800-1500 m., on low infantry targets,  1.5 min., 6-9 rounds with
 perc. fuze;
 At 1700-2250 m., on low infantry targets, 3.7 min.,  11 rounds with
 perc. fuze;
 At 2000-3000 m., on artillery targets,    4.6 min.,  11 rounds with
 perc. fuze;

Narrow columns moving to their right or left front are very unfavorable
targets for artillery, as it is very difficult for a battery commander
to determine the relative position of bursts on the flank of a column
with respect to the leading element thereof. Such shots are frequently
considered as over. Numerous small columns, which make it difficult to
designate a target, increase the time required by the hostile artillery
to secure adjustment.

Troops should not be posted in the vicinity of conspicuous objects,
as, for example, trees, visible at a great distance.[114] Intrenchments
that have just been thrown up should be made to look as nearly as
possible like the surrounding country by covering them with snow, sod,
or brush. It is made more difficult for the hostile artillery to secure
adjustment, if our infantry changes position to the front or to a
flank, if it moves rapidly or advances by rushes.

   [114] The cutting down of a poplar at Königgrätz decreased the
 effect of the Austrian artillery fire, which, previous to this, had
 caused rather serious losses. _Geschichte des Regiments, Nr. 2_, p.
 36. A similar effect was produced by tearing down a house at Lovtcha.
 KUROPATKIN-KRAHMER, _Kritische Rückblicke auf den Russisch-Türkischen
 Krieg_, I, p. 59.

It is easy, as a rule, for the artillery to adjust its fire upon masks,
but difficult to determine the distance between mask and target. It is
an advantage when masks are situated obliquely to a position. As masks
(rows of trees) may cause the premature burst of projectiles having
percussion fuzes, they should be at least 200 m. from the troops they
are to =screen=.[115] When so situated they frequently afford better
protection than actual intrenchments.

   [115] Fight of some Prussian batteries against a French battery
 masked by chaussee trees at Weiszenburg. See HOFFBAUER, _Deutsche
 Artillerie_, I, pp. 13 and 49. The 4th Light and the 4th Heavy
 Batteries of the 10th Field Artillery (German) were able to
 maintain their position east of Mars-la-Tour, under the fire of
 superior hostile artillery, because they were screened by the trees
 and the embankment of the chaussee thirty paces in their front.
 _Kriegsgeschichtliche Einzelschrift_, 25, p. 18.

   The sustained bombardment of Schlosz Ladonchamps (situated on
 the Moselle flats north of Metz) with 12 cm. guns, which fired 200
 shots per day from Oct. 9th to 10th, and 100 per day from Oct. 11th
 to 16th, 1870, was unsuccessful, because the percussion shells
 were ineffective. This will not be changed in the future by the
 adoption of high-explosive shells. According to DICK DE LONLAY,
 the garrison of the castle and its park lost only 5-10 men per day
 during this time. The defensibility of the castle was not impaired,
 although projectiles finally fell into the building itself during
 the sustained bombardment. According to the same author (IV, p. 556)
 1,022 shells fell into the park and castle of Ladonchamps on October
 7th, but only ten men were placed out of action.


(b) Minimizing the Effect of Fire.

Formations that increase the effect of artillery fire, as for example
lines and columns, and positions in which a flank is refused, should be
avoided. It is a good plan to increase the number of targets and to
employ narrow columns (column of twos) that are not too deep. Supports
must be far enough in rear (300-400 m.) to prevent two targets being
struck by one and the same shrapnel.

Of the close order formations used in the Russo-Japanese war, platoons
or sections in columns of squads or twos,[116] separated by a maximum
interval of 50 paces, were indeed found more suitable under fire than
line formations, but the losses were nevertheless very serious except
where cover screened the advancing troops from view or afforded them
actual protection.

   [116] The advance against Beaumont and the height of Chancy during
 the battle of Beaumont. HOPFFGARTEN-HEIDLER, _Beaumont_, pp. 124 and
 238. _Geschichte des Regiments, Nr. 93_, II, p. 97. At Gravelotte
 this formation was employed with advantage by the _Königin_ Regiment
 during its advance on Amanweiler, and later in the campaign during
 the assault on Le Bourget. _Geschichte des Regiments Königin_, pp. 9
 and 132.

During the Franco-German war, line of platoons in columns of twos was
found advantageous on several occasions.[117] This formation has the
following disadvantages, however: it is very susceptible to flanking
fire; the influence of the officers is principally restricted to
the leading elements; intervals are easily lost and on that account
it becomes more difficult to form line. It would seem to be better,
therefore, to advance in line of platoons (or sections) in columns of
squads, or, under flanking fire, in line of squads in columns of twos
or files. In the last-named formation the intervals between squads are
easily lost, however, and the company then becomes a dense skirmish
line of from four to six ranks. To echelon the platoons slightly has
very little value on account of the depth of the beaten zone of modern
shrapnel.

   [117] This formation is also well adapted for passing through
 woods. _Taktik_, VI, p. 108.

In attacks made during the latter part of the Russo-Japanese war, both
belligerents finally made use of thin successive skirmish lines for
advancing; these lines followed each other at 200-300 m. and united
again on reaching cover.


5. THE RESULTS OBTAINED BY ARTILLERY AGAINST VARIOUS TARGETS.

_Germany._ According to computations made by Lieutenant-General
Rohne,[118] the following hits may be expected from every time
shrapnel, model ’96, when burst an average of 50 m. short of the
targets named:

 =====+=========+=========+======+=================
 Range|Standing.|Kneeling.|Prone.|   Intrenched
   m. |         |         |      |Skirmishers.[119]
 -----+---------+---------+------+-----------------
   500|   18.4  |  10.6   |  6.4 |      3.5
  1000|   14.2  |   8.2   |  4.9 |      2.4
  2000|   12.   |   6.9   |  4.1 |      2.3
  3000|   11.   |   6.3   |  3.8 |      2.1
  4000|   10.   |   5.8   |  3.5 |      1.9
 -----+---------+---------+------+-----------------

   [118] _Die Taktik der Feldartillerie_, p. 9 _et seq._

   [119] One skirmish figure per meter.

The number of hits per minute obtained by a battery firing 50 shots at
500 m., 30 at 1000 m., 20 at 2000 m., 10 at 3000 m., and 4 at 4000 m.,
is as follows:

 =====+=========+=========+======+=================
 Range|Standing.|Kneeling.|Prone.|   Intrenched
   m. |         |         |      |Skirmishers.[120]
 -----+---------+---------+------+-----------------
   500|   364   |   210   | 126  |      70
  1000|   202   |   117   |  70  |      39
  2000|   109   |    63   |  38  |      21
  3000|    46   |    27   |  16  |       9
  4000|    14   |     8   |   5  |       3
 -----+---------+---------+------+-----------------

   [120] One skirmish figure per meter.

_France._[121] According to the French Field Artillery Regulations
(footnote to par. 277), a gun firing time shrapnel covers effectively
a front of 25 m., and a battery of four pieces, a front of 100 m. This
intensity of fire, which is obtained when each piece fires one shot
with proper corrector and range settings (the battery four shots)
Aubrat calls “_Density 4_.” When _rafale_ fire (two shots per piece)
is employed against a front of 100 m., with proper corrector setting,
density 8 is obtained. When the front exceeds 100 m., the deflection
of the pieces must be changed between successive shots (_tir avec
fauchage_). To obtain density 8 against a front of 150 m., each
piece must fire three shots, as prescribed in the regulations. When
progressive fire (_tir progressif_) is employed, four different ranges
are given, of which only one can be considered effective. When not
sweeping, in this fire, each piece fires two shots, thus also obtaining
a density of 8. A density of 1 always corresponds, therefore, to one
round, fired, with proper corrector and range settings, against a front
of 100 m. When a battery (four pieces) fires one salvo against a target
having a front of 50 m., density 8 is obtained; by firing two salvos,
density 16 is obtained.

   [121] The following is taken from Lieutenant-General ROHNE’S essay
 on the work of Squadron Commander AUBRAT, _Les exercices de service
 en campagne_. The essay mentioned appeared in the December, 1907,
 number of _Artilleristische Monatsschriften_.

The _Commission d’études pratiques du tir_ has made a thorough
investigation into the effect produced by shrapnel fire. The following
table gives a general idea of the effect to be expected when firing
against service targets (_i.e._, the percentage of figures one may
expect to hit when employing fire of varying density):

 ==============================================+=======================
                                               |        DENSITY.
                  TARGETS.                     +-----+-----+-----+-----
                                               |   4 |   8 |  16 |  32
 ----------------------------------------------+-----+-----+-----+-----
                                               |  %  |  %  |  %  |  %
 Infantry skirmishers standing in the open, or |     |     |     |
 a single rank line                            | 25  | 40  | 65  |----
                                               |     |     |     |
 Skirmishers lying down; gun crews under fire  |     |     |     |
 but protected by shields of the French type.  |     |     |     |
 Space between shields and ground not closed   |  7.5| 15  | 25  | 40
                                               |     |     |     |
 Infantry lying down behind knapsacks; gun     |     |     |     |
 crews protected by shields. Space between     |     |     |     |
 shields and ground not closed                 | ----| 7.5 | 15  | 25
                                               |     |     |     |
 Infantry lying down behind their knapsacks,   |     |     |     |
 but not firing; gun crews protected by        |     |     |     |
 shields. Space between shields and ground     |     |     |     |
 closed so that bullets cannot pass through    | ----| 0-2 | ----|----
 ----------------------------------------------+-----+-----+-----+-----

A skirmish line 100 m. long, and lying down, would suffer a loss of 15%
irrespective of its strength, from progressive fire (_tir progressif_;
32 rounds, density 8). If the interval between skirmishers in the
open amounts to 1¹⁄₂ paces, for instance, the front would contain 62
skirmishers, and the resulting loss would amount to 9 men. If the men
have placed their knapsacks in front of them, the loss would be reduced
by half. A line of skirmishers of the same length and strength as the
one considered above, would suffer a loss of 40%, or 25 men, when
standing up or advancing. About 1¹⁄₂ minutes are required to fire one
_tir progressif_, after adjustment has been secured. The same effect
could be obtained in about 20 seconds by firing a _rafale_ of eight
rounds, provided the battery has accurately adjusted its fire.


6. THE EFFECT OF SHRAPNEL BULLETS ON ANIMATE TARGETS.[122]

   [122] BIRCHER, Colonel and Corps Surgeon of the Swiss IInd Army
 Corps, _Die Wirkung der Artillerie Geschosse_, Aarau, 1899. KÜTTNER,
 _Kriegschirurgische Erfahrungen aus dem südafrikanischen Kriege
 1900_. Tübingen, 1900. HILDEBRAND, _Die Verwundungen durch die
 modernen Kriegsfeuerwaffen_. I (1905). BOHNE, _Über die Wirkung des
 Schrapnelschusses_, in _Militär-Wochenblatt_, No. 74, 1902.

The wounds produced by shrapnel bullets are similar to those caused
by the lead bullets of the infantry weapons of the past. When the
bullet strikes normally to the surface, it produces a wound circular
at the point of impact and considerably enlarged at the point of exit;
bones are frequently shattered; and the most serious effect is the
introduction of foreign substances, such as pieces of cloth, particles
of earth or sand, or of the material in which the bullet is embedded.

The effect of shrapnel bullets on animate targets depends upon the
striking energy of the bullets (expressed by kgm.) and on their
density, those of smaller cross-section having the greater penetration.
The closer the point of burst is to the target, the greater the
velocity, and, naturally, the effect.

Opinions differ as to the amount of “striking energy” necessary to put
animate targets out of action. In France, an energy of at least 4.8
kgm. is considered necessary to disable human beings, and for horses an
average of 19 kgm., while in Germany, an average energy of 8 kgm. is
deemed sufficient. The 10 g. hardened lead bullet, having a diameter of
12.3 mm., retains this energy until its remaining velocity is only 120
m. At ranges up to 1500 m., over 80% of the men struck by fragments and
bullets from shrapnel, bursting within 300 m. (and beyond this range
from shrapnel bursting within 150 m.) are put out of action. (Par. 30
German F. A. F. R.). In comparison, artillery projectiles produce a
greater number of fatal wounds than infantry projectiles.

It is worthy of note that the packed knapsack affords protection
against all shrapnel bullets having a velocity of 100 m. and against
half of those having a velocity of 200 m. The overcoat roll stops
shrapnel bullets having a velocity of less than 250 m. The penetration
of these bullets is so great, at ranges under 2000 m., that when they
strike bones or vital organs of horses, they produce instant incapacity
for action. This is especially true when the interval of burst is less
than 100 m.


B. INFANTRY FIRE.[123]

   [123] Lieutenant-General ROHNE, _Schieszlehre für die Infanterie_.
 Colonel MINARELLI-FITZGERALD, Austrian Army, _Modernes Schieszwesen_,
 1901.

The modern infantry rifle, cal. 6.5 to 8. mm., is a magazine arm
employing steel jacketed, pointed bullets, arranged in clips. The
adoption of automatic rifles is contemplated. In these rifles the
recoil energy is utilized for throwing out empty shells and for placing
a fresh cartridge into the chamber at the same time. The objections
made to the adoption of such a rifle (complexity of the mechanism,
danger of wasting ammunition) are similar to the reasons advanced
against the adoption of breech-loading and magazine rifles. In addition
to the increased rate of fire, the advantage of eliminating the effect
of the recoil on the skirmisher must not be underestimated. Moreover,
the elimination of the recoil makes a further increase in the initial
velocity of the projectile possible.

The effect of infantry fire may be considered from two points of view,
viz.: the effect on the enemy of a single projectile, and the effective
hit in itself.


1. THE EFFECT OF A SINGLE PROJECTILE ON ANIMATE TARGETS.[124]

   [124] See _Löbells Militärische Jahresberichte_, 1905, p. 475,
 and 1906, p. 412, which contain complete references to military
 literature. _Militär-Wochenblatt_, No. 1, 1906.

During the Russo-Japanese war the contending parties used the following
small arms and projectiles:

 ======+=========+=======+=====+=====================+=========
       | Rifle.  | Model | Cal.|       PROJECTILE.   |Initial
       |         |(year).|     |Description. |Weight.|Velocity.
       |         |       | mm. |             |  g.   |   m.
 ------+---------+-------+-----+-------------+-------+---------
 Japan |{Arisaka |  ’97  | 6.5 |Hardened lead| 10.5  |  715
       |{Murata  |  ’94  | 8.0 |core with    | 15.42 |  564
       |         |       |     |copper-nickel|       |
 Russia|  ----   |  ’91  | 7.62|jacket.      | 13.7  |  615
 ------+---------+-------+-----+-------------+-------+---------

The ballistic qualities of the _Arisaka_ rifle were superior to those
of the Russian arm, but the maiming effect of the two rifles was about
equal. The striking energy of the projectiles was not sufficient in
every case, however, to put a man out of action. The explosive effect
produced by bullets striking interior organs and bones at short ranges
(within 500 m.) was more evident in wounds made by the 8. mm. than by
the _Arisaka_ rifle.[125]

   [125] “The projectile that penetrates animal organisms displaces
 and consequently destroys the tissue fibers lying in its path. The
 projectile communicates a portion of its energy to the molecules
 struck, and these in turn transfer that energy to adjoining ones.
 The greater the velocity of the projectile at the moment of impact,
 the more rapid is this transfer of motion. Especially in organs
 filled with fluid are the molecules, like firm bodies, thrown with
 the greatest rapidity. This has a destructive effect which in the
 past has never been observed to be so extensive, and which gives the
 impression that the projectile has exploded in the body. In order to
 produce this effect a velocity of about 350 to 400 m. is required,
 which was, of course, not obtainable in rifles of older pattern,
 and was only possible in the immediate vicinity of the muzzle.
 Whenever the projectile strikes a marrow bone with great velocity it
 shatters it completely at the point of impact, and splinters it to
 a considerable extent, all because the bone is filled with a liquid
 substance.” ROHNE, _Schieszlehre für die Infanterie_, p. 69.

At mid ranges the wounds were generally of a mild character, unless
produced by tumbling bullets.[126]

   [126] See also _Ricochets_, p. 185 infra.

Experiments prove that a projectile will tumble if it encounters
varying resistance (for example, if the projectile strikes an obstacle,
even if that be only a twig) or if it penetrates materials of different
density (for instance, if, in penetrating a body, it strikes first upon
a fleshy part, then upon bones). In the last mentioned case the bullet
will frequently tumble in the body. If a projectile be fired through a
series of boards, placed at intervals, it will tumble in the second
board, or if not there, then certainly in the third board. Projectiles
which ricochet on the ground before penetrating a human body change
their form more or less, according to the character of the ground on
which they ricochet. As the jacket is frequently torn, thus exposing
the leaden kernel, wounds may be produced which will equal those made
by explosive bullets.

The striking energy of the projectile is sufficient to perforate two
men at 1200 m. From experiments made with the _Lebel_ rifle on corpses,
it appeared that the projectile passed clear through 5 bodies at 100
m., through 4 bodies at 400 m. (even when large bones were struck) and
through 2 bodies at 1200 m.

In the Russo-Japanese war wounds were distributed as follows, on a
basis of 100 hits: lower limbs, 39.5; upper limbs, 25.4; abdominal
region, 16.5; chest, 15.5; spinal column, 15, and head, 11. Flesh
wounds are generally slight. This is due to the fact that the hole
made by the bullet is small, that the exterior flow of blood is
insignificant, and that the wound rarely becomes infected. Projectiles
remain in the body now much more rarely than in the past.

The central portion of marrow bones is frequently splintered by
projectiles, while thicker flat bones (shoulder blades) are cleanly
perforated.

Unless a tumbling bullet or a splinter of a bone penetrates the lungs,
chest wounds appear in much more favorable forms than in past wars.[127]

   [127] “A soldier of the 3rd East Siberian Regiment, who had been
 shot in the chest, for instance, subsequently walked to the nearest
 railway station, a distance of over 20 km., and felt fairly well
 except for a slight difficulty in breathing. A lance corporal of
 the 36th East Siberian Rifle Regiment, having received a similar
 wound, began his journey to the nearest railway station on a
 two-wheeled cart. The motion of the cart nauseated him to such an
 extent, however, that he preferred to complete the journey on foot, a
 distance of 30 km.” Dr. SELDOWITSCHI in _Wratsch_.

According to observations made in the Russo-Japanese war, wounds in
joints healed without suppuration, the joint and its mobility being
saved. Amputations were extremely rare, and the surgeon’s skill was,
as a rule, seldom necessary in the treatment of shot wounds. Chest
wounds were slight, and often many men walked a few _versts_ to the
dressing station, some of them complaining of difficulty in breathing.
As a rule, such wounds healed in fourteen days. Chest wounds were more
serious when the heart or the large blood vessels were injured; but
even in these cases cures were effected. Abdominal wounds were not so
serious as in the past. Contrary to past experience, skull wounds,
in which the projectile had passed entirely through the brain, were
treated with fair success.

The campaigns in South Africa and Manchuria have amply demonstrated
that wounds produced by jacketed bullets of small caliber are not so
serious as those caused by 11 mm. projectiles. In addition, these
campaigns have shown that a further decrease in caliber is undesirable
from the tactician’s point of view, for a hit by no means affords the
certainty, in every case, of putting a man, much less a horse, out of
action.

Moreover, the wounded man is cured so quickly that in a short time
he can again participate in action. The British report of losses for
the battle of Paardeberg, on February 18th, 1900, contains the names
of a great many men who were wounded at Magersfontain on December
11th, 1899. According to British statements, 40 men out of every 100,
seriously wounded by steel jacketed bullets, could be returned to duty
after 36 days of surgical treatment. Dr. Küttner estimates that of
154 men hit in the chest, 73 were able to return to duty with their
organizations; while, out of 92 men wounded in the knee, only 28 could
be sent back to duty. Wounds produced by the small caliber _Arisaka_
rifle during the Russo-Japanese war healed more rapidly than those
caused by the Russian weapon. Flesh wounds of Japanese soldiers, for
example, healed in ten days, those of Russian soldiers in four. The
following observations were made on wounds produced by the Russian
rifle: Within a week slight wounds were covered by a scab; after
three weeks they were covered by fresh skin and a part of the wounded
were then able to return to the front. The remainder, irrespective of
the number of wounds received by any one individual, were ready for
duty in seven months. Wounds in which bones were perforated without
splintering, healed in four to six weeks, so that the men could return
to duty within four or five months after receiving the wound. When
bones were splintered the cure was, of course, considerably retarded.

The ballistic advantages of a small-caliber projectile (undesirable
from the military surgeon’s point of view) have been obtained by the
adoption of a pointed-nose bullet (called the “S” bullet in Germany and
the “D” bullet in France).[128]

   [128]

                                                Rifle         Rifle
                                  mod. ’88.   mod. ’98;    Lebel rifle;
                                             “S” bullet.   “D” bullet.
 Caliber                           7.9 mm.      7.9 mm.       8.  mm.
 Weight of bullet                 14.7  g.     10.  g.       13.2 g.
 Initial velocity                640.   m.    860.  m.      730.  m.
 Remaining velocity at 800 m.    270.   m.    362.  m.      377.  m.
 Maximum ordinate of trajectory
 at 700 m.                         3.80 m.      1.85 m.       2.10 m.

 _Militär-Wochenblatt_, 1906, No. 53; _Vierteljahrshefte_, 1907. II,
 p. 281.

A further advantage of these bullets is that they produce serious
wounds on account of their tendency to tumble. These wounds, while not
inhuman, instantly disable the man struck, or, at any rate, postpone
his recovery indefinitely.

=The Effect of “S” Bullets on Corpses.=

 ======================+====================================
                       |    THERE WOULD HAVE BEEN
  Of the Total Number  +--------+---------+--------------
     of Men Hit        | Fatally|Instantly|Incapacitated
    in Each Case.      |injured.|disabled.|for some time.
                       |   %    |    %    |     %
 ----------------------+--------+---------+--------------
 Flesh wounds    800 m |  ----  |  36.4   |    27.3
             ----------+        |         |
 produced at    1350 m |  ----  |  43.8   |    37.3
 ----------------------+--------+---------+--------------
 Bones struck    800 m |  20.3  |  79.2   |    75.0
             ----------+        |         |
      at        1350 m |  11.1  |  88.9   |    88.9
 ----------------------|--------+---------+--------------
       Average         |   7.97 |  62.07  |    57.12
 ----------------------+--------+---------+--------------


2. THE EFFECT OF “S” BULLETS ON MATERIALS.

The following thicknesses of dry pine are pierced by the “S” bullet
(rifle model ’98) at the ranges given:

 60 cm     at   100  m.
 80 cm     at   400  m.
 35 cm     at   800  m.
 10 cm     at  1800  m.

In sand and earth the penetration of the “S” bullet amounts to 90 cm.
According to experiments, 3 mm. steel plates were pierced at 350 m.,
while hay stacks afforded protection when 4 m. thick; when of less
thickness, the latter caused bullets to tumble. Embankments of frozen
snow 1 m. thick, of packed snow 2 m. thick, and of loose snow 3 m.
thick, were not pierced even at 250 m.




IV. THE EMPLOYMENT OF INFANTRY FIRE.


Infantry fire may produce either a stunning and paralyzing effect on
the hostile forces, or it may gradually exhaust, wear out, and consume
them. The fire will have a stunning and paralyzing effect when it is
suddenly concentrated upon a narrow front, thereby producing fear and
terror, provided actual losses are added to this moral effect.

On the other hand, the fire will gradually exhaust, wear out, and
destroy the hostile forces when it is distributed for a prolonged
period over an extended front. In this case the material losses
suffered and the exhaustion of his physical energies may force the
conviction on the enemy that he has no longer a chance to gain the
victory. This conviction will cause a suspension of all his energies
and consequently of his determination to fight.

 At =Modder River= (28th November, 1899) the Boers opened fire on the
 British at 1000 m., although they had intended to hold their fire
 until the British arrived within 300 m. of the position.[129]

   [129] General MINARELLI-FITZGERALD, _Die Gefechte in Natal und der
 Kap-Kolonie_, 1899.

 The miscarriage of the contemplated sudden burst of fire resulted
 in a fire fight, which tended to destroy gradually the physical and
 moral powers of the British. The Boers, however, gave this gradually
 destroying fire a paralyzing effect by concentrating it suddenly and
 continuously on tactically important targets that were comparatively
 easy to hit. Minarelli makes the following comments on the attack
 made by the British 9th Brigade and Brigade of Guards at =Modder
 River=: “All further attempts to induce the Guards to advance had to
 be abandoned. For hours they lay on the dearly bought ground under a
 blistering African sun, utilizing as cover every ant hill, every tuft
 of grass, on the apparently deserted battlefield, and being morally
 certain that to get up would draw a deadly hail of shot.” In regard
 to the fight of the 9th Brigade, the same author states: “Meantime
 the 9th Brigade fared no better. It had in part been able to get a
 little closer to the enemy (550 to 900 m.), but was then unable to
 advance farther. The actual losses were very small in the ten-hour
 fight, amounting only to seven per cent. The Highland Brigade,
 surprised at =Magersfontain=, fared still worse. The fight growing
 out of the surprise lasted almost ten hours. At the short range at
 which this action was fought, the Boer method of fire (_i.e._, to
 fire only when an enemy raised himself to get better aim, and then to
 employ only an effective concentrated fire) necessarily produced a
 depressing effect.”

In order that such a fire effect may be obtained, it is necessary that
the individual soldier combine coolness and presence of mind with good
marksmanship, and that company, platoon and squad leaders maintain fire
control and fire direction.


1. FIRE DISCIPLINE.

Fire discipline is indispensable to fire control and fire direction.
It embraces the conscientious execution of all orders and signals, as
well as the scrupulous observation of all regulations bearing on the
handling of the rifle and on combat in general. Fire discipline must be
maintained even though the fire control and fire direction exercised by
the leaders is imperfect or ceases entirely in the course of the action.

=Fire discipline= requires:

Perseverance under hostile fire, even when that fire cannot be
returned; constant attention to the orders of the leaders, and careful
observation of the enemy. It requires further, taking advantage of the
ground; care in setting the sight and in delivery of fire; an increase
of fire by individuals whenever the targets become more favorable, and
a cessation of fire when the enemy disappears; finally, economy of
ammunition.

The decision is prepared by the fire of infantry, supported by
machine guns, field, and heavy artillery. The fire of troops pushed
to within short range of the hostile position will in many cases
suffice to induce the enemy to give way, so that the assault encounters
nothing but evacuated or feebly defended works. The Boer war and the
Russo-Japanese war demonstrate that determined troops will hold a
position until the attacker has massed sufficient troops to charge,
or at least until he threatens to attack with the bayonet. Examples:
Terrayama, on October 11th, 1904. Assault made by the 2nd Division on
March 1st, 1905, at Mukden, on Redouts 17 and 18.

Training in bayonet fencing has by no means lost importance,
irrespective of the fact as to whether or not bayonets will ever be
crossed in future. “Bayonet fencing is one of the most important
means of strengthening the moral force of the individual soldier; of
developing in him energy, initiative, and courage for making a dashing
advance.”[130]

   [130] _Introduction to German Bayonet Fencing Regulations._

Since the armament of the different armies is almost the same, good
individual marksmanship, coolness, fire control and fire direction, and
firmly rooted fire discipline, are the deciding factors in an action in
which two equal skirmish lines contend for the superiority of fire.


2. FIRE CONTROL AND FIRE DIRECTION.

The principal object of fire control and fire direction is to bring
about a superiority of fire at the decisive point by suddenly
concentrating the fire of a large number of rifles upon it. This is the
only way in which a moral effect may be produced on the troops against
whom the fire is directed, while, at the same time, their losses attain
such proportions as to become unbearable. At mid and long ranges,
the efficacy of fire depends more on fire control and fire direction
than upon good individual marksmanship.[131] Whenever the appropriate
rear sight elevation is not used, the densest portion of the cone of
dispersion will not strike the target, and the chances of its hitting
the target diminish as the error in estimating the range and the
standard of excellence of the marksmanship increase.

   [131] See ROHNE, _Schieszlehre für die Infanterie_, 3rd Edition,
 p. 85. “The importance of the line shot (_i.e._, a hit on the
 vertical stripe through the center of the German bull’s-eye target)
 in the marksmanship training of the soldier should by no means be
 underestimated, but rather appreciated at its true value. The line
 shot forms the basis of known distance firing, just as the latter
 forms the basis of field firing. Instruction in line shooting
 (_i.e._, hitting the vertical stripe of the German bull’s-eye target)
 becomes a moral factor of the highest value in field firing. It
 cannot be denied, however, that the importance of the line shot, as
 such, decreases with the range. Likewise all attempts to transfer
 the zone of the line shot from short to long ranges have completely
 failed.” Captain KRAUSE, _Die Gestaltung der Geschoszgarbe der
 Infanterie_, Berlin, 1904, p. 1.

Fire control and fire direction lie in the hands of platoon
commanders,[132] who regulate the fire as their judgment dictates. Fire
control and direction embrace: the opening and cessation of fire; the
designation of a target and of the elevation to be used; the kind of
fire and its distribution; the number of rounds to be fired, and the
observation of the effect of the fire. As a rule, the fire will be
distributed over the whole front, but portions of the hostile line that
are not clearly visible should by no means be neglected (distribution
of fire). Regulations prescribing the scope of authority of individual
leaders are not considered desirable. The platoon commander possesses
in his squad leaders a medium for communicating with his platoon.
(Pars. 162-165 German I. D. R.). The movements of the skirmishers, the
correct _comprehension of the target_, the _distribution of fire_,
the _rate of fire_, and the _employment of the terrain to the best
advantage_, are regulated through the squad leaders. The lack of
thoroughly drilled coöperation on the part of squad leaders inevitably
results, as might be expected, in a so-called “skirmish mob.” The
platoon commander cannot communicate directly with every individual man
of his platoon, but he can control his platoon through his eight squad
leaders, who, by reason of their position in the line, can exert the
proper influence on their skirmishers.[133]

   [132] The _Belgian Firing Regulations_ require that the officer
 directing and controlling the fire fight be able to determine: 1. The
 time necessary to produce a certain effect with a given number of
 rifles; 2. The number of rounds necessary to produce a certain effect
 in a given period of time; 3. Whether a given target justifies the
 expenditure of ammunition in view of the situation or the efficacy of
 the fire. The requirements of the _Italian Firing Regulations_ are
 similar.

   [133] Austria: The position of the platoon leader is not so
 definitely fixed as in Germany; neither is it prescribed that squad
 leaders participate in the firing. In skirmish line fire control
 and fire direction are to remain as long as possible in the hands
 of the company commander. The battalion commander is charged with
 concentrating and distributing the fire; with reinforcing, at the
 proper time, the companies in the firing line; and with replenishing
 the ammunition. At long ranges he designates the companies that are
 to fire, and also the position from which fire is to be opened.

The squad leaders are charged with _constantly supervising_ the setting
of sights; the distribution, the careful delivery, and the rate of
fire; and the expenditure of ammunition.

_The squad leaders participate in the firing only_ when their duties
as leaders permit; and this will frequently be the case in a prolonged
engagement in the same position, especially at short ranges. These
remarks apply also to the range finders.

In Italy and Switzerland the squad leaders participate in the firing
when the whole platoon is engaged in a fire fight. The advantage of
thus gaining a few better shots for the firing line is more than offset
by the more careful supervision of the skirmishers as is required
in Germany, France and Austria. The platoon leader unaided is in no
position to supervise the proper use of the rifle and the expenditure
of ammunition; his subordinates must assist him. It is also desirable
to relieve the company commander from the actual duty of fire direction
and fire control. The company commander is responsible for leading
the company on the battlefield; this does not preclude his thoroughly
supervising his platoons and observing the effect of their fire.

“Whenever the company commander is in the firing line, he selects and
designates the target and gives orders for opening fire. He announces
the range found by the range finders and observes the effect of the
fire. Aside from this, he leaves fire control and fire direction to his
platoon commanders, and interferes only when he desires to concentrate
the fire of several platoons, or of the whole company, on a certain
target, or when he observes something that has escaped the notice of
the platoon commanders.” (Par. 216 German I. D. R.).

In the course of an action, fire control and fire direction will
frequently be imperfect, whether this be due to the loss of the
leaders, or to the difficulty of hearing commands in the noise of the
combat. To provide for such contingencies, the skirmishers must be
taught that, in the absence of fire control and fire direction, they
may fire (_not that they must fire_) at all targets within 600 m.; that
between 600 and 1200 m., they should fire at tall and wide targets
only; and that, at ranges over 1000 m., as a rule, they should not fire
at all.

 In the pamphlet entitled, _Actual Experiences in the Russo-Japanese
 War_, p. 11, et seq., Captain SOLOVIEV, 34th East Siberian Rifle
 Regiment, 1st Siberian Corps, states: “* * * There was an almost
 ungovernable tendency among the men, as soon as they had thrown
 themselves down, to open fire without orders; paying attention
 neither to the target designated, nor to setting their sights.

 “This haste is, first of all, brought about by the desire of drowning
 the consciousness of danger by means of increased activity. * * *
 It is simply impossible to control and direct the fire when the men
 have not been carefully trained. The din of battle, the explosion of
 hostile projectiles, and the thunder of our own artillery make such a
 deafening roar that one can scarcely hear one’s own voice. The long
 firing lines make it extraordinarily difficult to transmit orders;
 even squad commanders can not make themselves understood. Volley
 firing must therefore be dispensed with.

 “Only whistle signals, if repeated by all non-commissioned officers,
 can be heard; but the men must be trained to obey the whistle signal.
 With strictness and application much can be accomplished in this
 direction; it may even be possible to stop the firing along the whole
 length of the deployed company in the hottest phases of the fight.

 “The difficulties of fire control and fire direction increase in
 proportion to the intensity of the hostile fire and the proximity of
 the enemy, especially on the defensive. The men get more and more
 restless, their nervous tension increases, the danger seems nearer
 and greater. In such a moment the leader must make every effort to
 keep his men in hand, and prevent the firing from degenerating into a
 wild blazing away at nothing. This is always a sign that the leader
 has lost control of his troops.

 “The greatest obstacle to good fire control and fire direction is the
 nervousness that usually pervades troops which are not accustomed
 to active service. Only thorough peace training and strict fire
 discipline ensure the maintenance of order in battle and give the
 fire the necessary efficacy. * * * The more laborious the struggle,
 the more embittered the fight, the greater the losses, the more
 fatigue and nervous strain gain the upper hand, the greater and
 more important the role which the officer has to play. The success
 of the 200 men under his command depends entirely upon the company
 commander. The war in the Far East might well be called the war
 of company commanders. The soldiers watch their leader constantly
 and attentively. Two hundred lives depend upon his bearing, his
 determination, firmness, and personal bravery. The men judge the
 situation, the imminence of danger, success and failure, by the
 conduct of their leader. The authority of an officer may rise to
 great heights, but it may also sink very low. To show depression or
 faint-heartedness is fatal; the feeling of despondency is at once
 communicated to the men, the leader loses control of his command, and
 the mischief is done.

 “In battle, more than anywhere else, the officer must be a commander
 and rule with an iron hand. Nowhere does discipline play as great a
 role as in action. Woe to the troops who have not in time of peace
 become thoroughly disciplined, to whom discipline has not become
 second nature! They will pay dearly for this deficiency in war.

 “I have observed that in the most critical situations a resolute
 shout, in a correspondingly imperious tone, had a marvelously
 quieting effect upon the men. It is likewise advisable to make, here
 and there, a remark concerning routine duty. For example: ‘Why have
 the sights not been set in that platoon? Platoon commander, see at
 once that it is done.’ Because the commander is angry, and notices
 neglect, everything goes well, so the men reason, and no danger need
 be apprehended. The men quiet down, forget the whistling of the
 bullets, set their sights carefully, point their pieces properly, and
 aim again.”


3. SELECTION OF THE LINE TO BE OCCUPIED.

While a good field of fire is indispensable for reaping the maximum
benefit from the power of our rifles, the tactical situation is the
determining factor in the choice of a position. The requirements as to
a field of fire and the use to be made of it will vary, depending upon
whether it is desired to avoid an engagement at short range (delaying
action) or whether a decision is to be sought (decisive action). In the
first case a free field of fire at short ranges may be dispensed with.

Cover may be used only to the extent that it does not interfere with
constant observation of the enemy. It is not permissible to hide
entirely behind cover, unless expressly ordered in each case. To
rise from behind cover, for the purpose of firing, and to disappear
subsequently behind that cover for loading, is out of the question in
the firing line. This is physically impossible and much less attainable
for psychological reasons; in addition, the skirmisher will present a
much larger target than when lying down. When portions of the firing
line cannot see the target during an attack, the platoon commander
should consider this a hint, either to gain a better position farther
to the front, or to suspend his fire temporarily. (Par. 190 German I.
D. R.). In defense, in a similar case, cross fire would frequently be
the proper expedient. The attacker will often see nothing except the
heads of the skirmishers who must fire kneeling in order to sweep the
foreground, while these men will present targets of half a man’s height
to his bullets. Since smokeless powder is employed, it is important to
select positions that cannot easily be found by the enemy. Positions in
which the skirmishers are silhouetted against the sky line should be
avoided whenever possible. Faintly illuminated targets, or those lying
in the shade, are not fired on at all, according to all experience,
while the fire is above all else directed against sharply outlined
targets. The leaders must take to cover also, for in many cases single
officers standing upright draw attention to the position. The extent
of the position must be commensurate with the strength of the force;
too dense a line reduces the efficacy of fire and increases the
losses, while, on the other hand, too dispersed a force increases the
difficulties of fire control and fire direction.


4. THE STRENGTH OF THE FIRING LINE.

This depends upon the purpose of the action. Although a thin firing
line may be employed when the situation is still in doubt (protection
against surprise), it must be strong when the superiority of fire is
to be attained. If the firing line is made too weak, we are condemned
to fight a superior force continuously with an inferior one because we
have voluntarily sacrificed the advantage of our numerical superiority.
On the defensive, as soon as the direction of the hostile attack
develops, the firing line is made as strong as seems necessary for
holding the position. In a delaying action, however, we should endeavor
to place as few men in action as possible; and to compensate for the
lack of rifles by an increased expenditure of ammunition. All firing
is done from the prone position, in so far as the ground permits. The
French attempt to regulate the volume of fire by prescribing the
number of rifles to be employed instead of designating the kind of fire
to be used.

In Switzerland and England,[134] it is recommended that supports use
“Fire of position” where the terrain is suitable (hilly country).
The German Infantry Drill Regulations (par. 340) contain a similar
provision. When the supports cannot see the firing line on account of
the conformation of the ground, this fire is not likely to endanger the
latter.

   [134] _Infantry Training_, 1905, p. 132, par. 2; p. 134, pars. 1,
 2; p. 136, par. 6; p. 155, par. 1. See p. 154, infra.


5. ASCERTAINING RANGES.

(Pars. 78-98, 190 and 191 German I. F. R.).

Efficacy of fire depends upon a knowledge of the range. An imperfect
knowledge of the range may be compensated for by the flatness of the
trajectory of the individual rifle and by the favorable conformation of
the ground in respect to the cone of dispersion. In collective fire,
at mid and long ranges, each rear sight graduation commands a beaten
zone approximately 100 m. deep--good aim, proper elevation, and careful
firing being presupposed. The nearer the target is to the densest
portion of the cone of dispersion, the greater the efficacy of the fire.

The following results were obtained in Italian firing tests in which
100 skirmishers fired at a plate 1 m. high and 30 m. wide with the 6.5
mm. rifle:

 =====================+======================+=======================
                      |   MEASURED RANGE.    |  ESTIMATED RANGE.
                      +----------+-----------+----------+------------
                      | Slow fire| Rapid fire| Slow fire|Rapid fire
                      |   [135]  |   [135]   |   [135]  |   [135]
                      |Percentage|Percentage |Percentage|Percentage
                      | of hits. | of hits.  | of hits. | of hits.
 ---------------------+----------+-----------+----------+------------
 At  500 m.           |   21.5   |   15.8    |   14.8   |   11.3
 At 1000 m.           |   11.1   |    8.1    |    6.5   |    5.3
 At 1500 m.           |    5.    |    3.4    |    2.6   |    2.2
 Average results at-- |          |           |          |
 Ranges under 1000 m. |   18.2   |   13.6    |   12.1   |     9.3
 Ranges over 1000 m.  |    7.1   |    5.1    |    3.2   |    3.2
 ---------------------+----------+-----------+----------+------------

   [135] Slow fire four shots, rapid fire fourteen shots, per minute.

Beyond 600 m., an error in the range exerts a greater influence
upon the efficacy of fire than does the marksmanship of the
skirmishers.[136] When an improper elevation has been selected,
the efficacy of the fire decreases as the compactness of the “cone
of dispersion” increases; in other words, the efficacy of the fire
decreases as the excellence of the marksmanship of the men and their
coolness in the face of the enemy increase. (See pp. 170 and 171,
infra).

   [136] ROHNE, _Das Gefechtsmäszige Abteilungsschieszen der
 Infanterie_, p. 13.

The following expedients for ascertaining ranges may be mentioned:

(_a_) Pacing and galloping;

(_b_) Estimating distances on the ground by eye (by comparison with
known distances; by estimating part of the distance);

(_c_) Firing trial volleys (ranging);

(_d_) Taking the range from a map of large scale or obtaining it
directly from infantry or artillery already engaged;

(_e_) Measuring the range directly on the ground.

 Pacing (employed in Russia, France, and Austria) gives inaccurate
 results. There is a difference between the number of paces a man
 takes per 100 m., on a chaussee and in a ploughed field. Length of
 pace depends upon the character and slope of the ground.[137] In
 pacing over varied ground, a man follows the slope line while the
 projectile follows an airline. Therefore it would seem that pacing is
 only practicable at short ranges when the enemy is not near. The same
 is true of galloping over the distance. (The length of a horse’s jump
 at a gallop is on an average 3 m.).

   [137] Professor RZIHA ascertained the following diminution of the
 length of a pace at different degrees of slope:

 _Descending_ slope, degrees.   0     5    10    15    20    25    30
 Length of pace in cm.         77    70    62    56    50    45    30
 Number of paces per 100 m.   129   143   161   179   200   222   333

 _Ascending_ slope, degrees.    0     5    10    15    20    25    30
 Length of pace in cm.         77    74    72    70    67    60    50
 Number of paces per 100 m.   120   135   138   143   148   166   200

 According to Major CZERNY, Austrian Army (_Treffwahrscheinlichkeit_,
 in _Streffleur_, 1906, II), the error may be as much as 16 per cent
 of the range.

In estimates made by individual men, the error amounts approximately
to one-eighth (12.5%) of the range;[138] this may be corrected by
taking the mean of a considerable number of estimates, or by employing
combined sights at ranges over 1000 m. (the difference between rear
sight elevations being 100 to 200 m.), thus increasing the depth of
the beaten zone. The accuracy of the resulting fire is influenced
by local and atmospheric conditions. (Par. 80 German I. F. R.).
Estimates usually fall short of the correct distance when made in
bright sunlight; in clear atmosphere; when the sun is in rear of the
man estimating; when made over uniform surfaces; over water; when
the target is set off by a bright background; when made over rolling
ground, especially when the several depressions cannot be seen. On the
other hand, estimates frequently exceed the correct range when made in
a flickering light; against a dark background; against the sun; when
the sky is overcast; during foggy weather; in the dusk; in woods; and
against an enemy who is only partially visible. According to the Swiss
Firing Regulations (1906) estimates made from a height downward are
usually too short, and those made from low ground up, too great.

   [138] Lieutenant-General ROHNE, _Das Gefechtsmäszige
 Abteilungsschieszen der Infanterie_, 4th Edition, p. 12.

   The following statement is taken from a report made at the British
 Musketry School at Hythe (5th Nov., 1905). In a great number of
 estimates under 700 yards (630 m.) the results given below were
 obtained:

                                         --------Error--------  Greater
                                Correct  ±50 yards  ±100 yards  errors
 Officers of the Regular Army      15        49          20       14%
 Officers of Militia and
 Volunteers                        20        44          22       20%

 France: Officers made errors of 20% at the beginning of the period of
 instruction, 12% at its close; rank and file of the Regular Army and
 non-commissioned officers of the Reserve made errors of 30%.

In action, under the influence of danger, estimates are usually
short.[139] Peace training proves that the skill of the majority of
soldiers in estimating distances can be improved only up to a certain
point.

   [139] The advance of the IInd Battalion of the 2nd Hessian Regiment
 on August 18th, 1870, from the Bols de la Cusse against the height
 northwest of Amanweiler: “The companies, who supposed the enemy to
 be much nearer” (the actual range was 1,100 to 1,200 m.), “advanced,
 cheering, and were received with mitrailleuse, shell, and rifle fire
 (from hill 1,030) which swept the railroad line.” HESSERT.

   Battle of Plevna, September 11th, 1877. Debouchment from corn
 fields: “The distance still to be crossed before the Turkish
 works were reached was underestimated. One company cheered when
 at a distance of 900 to 1,000 paces from the hostile works:
 the other troops took up the cry and rushed forward at a run.”
 KUROPATKIN-KRAHMER, _Kritische Rückblicke auf den Russisch-Türkischen
 Krieg_.

 =Germany.= All the men are practiced in estimating distances up to
 800 m. Officers, non-commissioned officers and suitable men (range
 finders) are to be trained in quickly and accurately estimating mid
 ranges, and practiced in ascertaining long ranges. (Par. 78 German I.
 F. R.).

 “Even a skillful range finder, if he is conscientious, can do no more
 than give a minimum and a maximum estimate of what he considers the
 range to be. The ranges must be communicated to the men accordingly.
 The differences between maximum and minimum estimates should be as
 follows: At ranges up to and including 500 m., 100 m. (for example:
 350-450, or 500-600 m.); between 500 and including 1000 m., 200 m.;
 over 1000 m., 300 m.”

 =Italy.= Subalterns are, as a general rule, charged with estimating
 the ranges. Non-commissioned officers must be able to estimate ranges
 up to 1000 m. All non-commissioned officers as well as suitable
 privates participate in estimating distance drill, which is conducted
 by an officer in each battalion. The results are recorded in a book.
 The following is the classification:

 Excellent range finders: Those whose error rarely exceeds 50 and
 never 100 m.

 Good range finders: Those whose error does not exceed 100 m., and in
 exceptional cases 150 m.

 Fair range finders: Those whose normal error does not exceed 150 and
 never 200 m.

 Poor range finders: Those whose error exceeds 200 m.

 The =Russians= estimate only short ranges, as a rule; the longer
 ranges are determined by means of range finding instruments. In the
 first year of their service all the men are drilled in estimating
 ranges from 400 to 800 paces; officers and twenty specially selected
 men from each company up to 3000 paces. The latter (both officers
 and men) are to make at least 36 estimates in nine days. (Par. 190
 Russian I. F. R.). The result is considered good when the error in
 the estimate does not exceed the figure given below at the ranges
 named:

   Range in paces.   Error in paces.   Percentage of error.
  400 to 1000 paces       50 or            12.5 to 5  %
 1000 „  2000   „        100 „             10   „  5  „
 2000 „  3000   „        200 „             10   „  6.6„

 The Russian range finding instrument (_Souchier_) is used by
 officers and specially trained non-commissioned officers; errors in
 determining ranges are not to exceed a maximum of 2-3 per cent.

 In =Switzerland= recruits are trained to estimate distances up to
 600 m. and specially skilled men up to 1500 m.; all non-commissioned
 officers estimate ranges up to 1000 m. and officers up to 1500
 m. Three weeks after the recruits join, those of the most skilled
 in estimating distances--about an eighth of the total number--are
 selected to undergo further instruction. For this purpose they are
 placed under the orders of an officer charged with this instruction,
 who trains them for at least three hours, every other day, in
 estimating distances on varied ground. The better half of these men,
 regardless of the company to which they may belong, receive further
 instruction. Exercises on wholly unknown terrain are to be had with
 these men and not only extended marches but even railway journeys not
 exceeding 30 km. are authorized for this purpose.

 In =Austria= the men are required to estimate distances up to 800
 paces (600 m.),_i.e._, up to the range within which they might
 frequently have to choose their target independently. Only officers,
 non-commissioned officers, and specially skilled men are required to
 estimate ranges up to 2000 paces (1500 m.). The mean error of twenty
 determinations at short, mid, and long ranges, of a “reliable range
 finder,” is not to exceed 12 per cent. The _Roksandic_ range finding
 apparatus is said to give errors not exceeding 2-3 per cent when
 skillfully used.

To memorize distinguishing marks on the enemy as an aid in arriving at
a correct estimate of the range, is not considered as simulating actual
service conditions, since the power of vision of the men differs.
Furthermore, one sees the enemy mostly in a prone position in action,
and it is not to be expected that the men will remember the various
rules for determining the range by the appearance of the enemy’s
skirmishers. The same is true of the regulation which prescribes that
the soldier estimating the range is to judge the effect which the
target makes upon him. (England and Austria).

It will rarely be practicable for infantry to scale the range directly
from a map. Infantry ranges are usually so short, in comparison to the
scale of most of the maps, especially those available in the field,
that it is difficult to take them between the points of a pair of
dividers. Moreover, in an infantry action conspicuous objects are not
likely to be located often enough near the position of the skirmishers
to make it practicable to find them quickly even on the most accurate
maps. The artillery is much better off in this direction; its ranges
are longer and therefore more easily scaled from a map. Moreover,
artillery is generally posted on or near prominent points, which may
be found on almost any map. It should be remembered that a map is a
horizontal projection, that any range scaled from a map is the base of
a right triangle, and that the line of sight of a rifle, when firing
uphill, follows the hypotenuse of that triangle.

An accurate knowledge of the range to within a meter is not necessary,
as meteorological conditions,[140] especially temperature and
illumination (degree of humidity of the atmosphere) affect the range
of the projectile. Meteorological conditions may necessitate sight
corrections amounting to 100 m. at mid ranges and to 150 m. at long
ranges. According to the French Firing Regulations a difference of
temperature of ±10 degrees C., changes the range of the Lebel rifle by
18 m. at 1000 m. The altitude of the terrain increases the range on
account of reduced barometric pressure; this becomes a factor in the
selection of a rear sight elevation at an altitude of approximately
1000 m. According to the French Firing Regulations, the range of their
rifle at 1000 m. is increased as follows: At an altitude of 500 m. by
18; at 1000 m. by 42; at 1500 m. by 63; and at 2100 m. by 89 m.

   [140] Lieutenant-General ROHNE, _Schieszlehre für die Infanterie_,
 p. 51, and also par. 70 Austrian I. F. R. The effect of temperature
 and of the altitude of the battlefield was strikingly illustrated in
 the Boer war.

These meteorological influences can be eliminated by obtaining the
range from troops already engaged (artillery) or by determining the
proper rear sight elevation (not the range) by trial volleys (pars. 190
and 191 German I. F. R.) or by an animated fire at will (Switzerland:
fire at will, one round).

To ascertain the range by firing trial volleys is, however, practicable
only when the terrain near the target is visible; when the target
itself is stationary; when the ground is such that the strike of the
bullets can be observed; when the firing party is not under fire; and,
finally, when the necessary time is available. Since all of these
preliminary conditions will rarely be fulfilled, it will only in
exceptional cases be possible to determine the proper elevation by this
method.

 When this method is employed, volleys are fired either by sections or
 by platoons, with the same sight, at some one point of the target.
 For the first volley a rear sight elevation sufficiently below
 the proper one should be selected, so that hits on or in front of
 the target can be expected with certainty. This procedure is then
 repeated, as often as necessary, with correspondingly raised or
 lowered rear sight leaves, until the correct elevation is obtained.

This “ranging” by trial volleys promises no result, however, if any one
of the above-mentioned preliminary conditions is not fulfilled. It is
advantageous to establish a bracket by firing volleys, as is done by
artillery, but even with a good glass it is very difficult to observe
the strike of small caliber bullets. Whether it would be advisable to
adopt for this ranging a specially designed weapon, firing thin-walled
shell weighing about 400 g., is a question.[141]

   [141] The 32 mm. _Nordenfeld_ machine gun fires a shell weighing
 400 g.

The older range finding instruments depend upon angle measurements at
both ends of a line (up to 25 m. long). The large range finder (_Hahn_)
has been adopted in the German army. (Pars. 88-98 German I. F. R.).
This apparatus permits a range to be measured from one point, up to
1200 m. on low targets, and on taller targets, such as skirmishers
standing, up to 1600 m. Measurements are considered sufficiently
accurate when the error amounts to

    2-3%    up to a range of  1000 m.
 3¹⁄₂-5%    „    „    „    „  2000 „
    3-3¹⁄₂% „    „    „    „  1500 „

On the defensive the large range finders will find employment before
and during the action. The men charged with the measurement of the
range should be careful not to betray the position by their activity,
before fire is opened. The utility of these instruments is much more
restricted in an attack. However, it will often be possible, before the
fire fight begins, to ascertain the range from the point selected for
the first firing position, to the position to be attacked. According to
Soloviev range finders failed completely in action in Manchuria. (See
p. 137 supra).


6. SELECTION OF A TARGET AND TIME FOR OPENING FIRE.

In selecting a target and opening fire it must be remembered that the
fire cannot have a decisive effect unless the target is well within
effective range. The leader should ask himself whether the result to
be expected is properly commensurate with the probable expenditure of
ammunition entailed, and whether this expenditure is warranted in view
of the total amount available. But the decision to fire upon a target
once made, the ammunition necessary for the attainment of the object
of the fight must be expended without stinting, since all experience
teaches us that an ineffective fire impairs the morale of one’s own
troops, while it raises that of the enemy.

In the selection of a target, its tactical importance is the principal
determining factor. The fire is first directed upon the most dangerous,
generally the nearest target, or the one which is soon to become the
most dangerous. Subsequently the fire should be directed upon targets
which, owing to their height, width, depth, and density, promise the
greatest number of effective hits.

Infantry will, as a rule, offer the most important and promising
target, and the fire should be directed against the firing line, since
the troops following it in close order will in any event come within
range during their advance. In Italy, when two targets are available,
the fire is to be directed on the one promising the best results.

Ballistic and tactical considerations determine whether fire should be
opened at long or at short ranges.

Adequate results may be expected when the fire is directed against
low targets at ranges of 800-1200 m., but at ranges over 1200 m. a
decisive effect is only attainable by the expenditure of a large amount
of ammunition. Skirmishers standing may be fired on with good effect
even at ranges over 1200 m. (long ranges).

When the fire is properly controlled and directed, it will be effective
against tall and deep targets within ranges corresponding to the
highest graduations of the rear sight leaves. However, when the targets
are narrow, a side wind is very apt to throw the cone of dispersion off
the target.

The idea of using our accurate, long range rifle at long ranges in
defense, thus bringing it into effective play, at a time when the
danger to our own troops is still very small, is, at first glance,
very tempting. Military history shows that such fire was successful
here and there, especially where one of the contending parties was
armed with a much superior weapon, or where the enemy failed to apply
the proper remedy. But even in these cases it was successful only
up to a certain point. There is this to be said against employing
long range fire: Its effect is insignificant when compared with the
expenditure of ammunition entailed; it is difficult to replenish
ammunition and it tires the eye and the arm of the skirmisher. Poorly
trained troops finally do not raise their rifles at all, but blaze away
without aiming. To be sure, fire opened at an early moment annoys the
advance of the enemy, but it cannot seriously retard it. Once the fire
is opened, we want it to be effective; we don’t want to injure the
enemy--we want to annihilate him.

Although we fully appreciate the good results obtained at long ranges
on the target range, we prefer to utilize the entire staggering fire
effect of our weapons at short and mid ranges, wholly for the purpose
of annihilating the enemy.

Since only small targets, often scarcely discernible by the naked eye,
present themselves to the attacker, the fire of the defender should
not be returned at once. The forward movement should be continued by
utilizing every expedient (rushes with breathing spells, and cover)
until serious losses are sustained and the leader has reason to fear
that his men will lose their morale and throw themselves down without
orders. Frequently several groups will open fire while the others
continue to advance. The endeavor should be to open fire only when the
attacking force has gotten as close as possible to the lower limit of
mid combat range (800-1200 m.).[142]

   [142] At Paardeberg (18th March, 1900), the left wing of the
 Highland Brigade advanced, without firing a shot, to within 450 m. of
 the hostile position. This advance, to be sure, was made under cover
 of the fire of the right wing of the 9th Brigade, which had made a
 lodgment within 750 m. of the enemy’s position.

Errors in estimating the range are offset by the flat trajectory of the
rifle only at short ranges, and only at these ranges can there be any
question of an effective preparation of the attack by fire. These views
are expressed in the German regulations.

Recent wars demonstrate that, whenever the attacker opened fire at long
ranges, the attack finally came to a standstill, that the troops in
many cases fired away all their ammunition, and that the whole attack
failed.

 “Whenever the attacking regiment opened fire this was unfortunately
 a sign that the attack had been repulsed.” This remark made by
 Kuropatkin in regard to the fight of the Russian infantry (center
 group) on Sept. 11th, 1877, at =Plevna=, is characteristic of the
 Russian ideas. On the occasion referred to, the Russians advanced on
 the Turkish works without fire preparation; the firing lines halted
 400 to 600 m. from the Turkish position and commenced firing. They
 succumbed because it never occurred to the leaders to reinforce
 them and attempt to gain a superiority of fire. Even in Skobeleff’s
 attack there was no sign of actual fire preparation, but, as soon
 as the line halted, strong reinforcements were pushed in to carry
 it forward. The attack, made on a front of about 800 m., suffered
 heavy losses, but succeeded, although all organizations were in
 complete disorder. After advancing 1000 m., the decimated first line
 (8 battalions) halted; fifteen fresh companies carried it forward
 some 150 m.; then Skobeleff threw in twenty companies in one body,
 which carried the line forward to within approximately 100 to 150 m.
 of the work. At this moment Skobeleff threw himself into the fight
 and succeeded in taking the Turkish position with his badly cut up
 troops. Doubtless an act of undeniable gallantry, but not one worthy
 of imitation.

 The war between Servia and Bulgaria (1885) is very instructive in
 this connection. As in 1859, 1870 and 1877, that force was defeated,
 which, trusting to the superiority of its rifles, opened fire at
 long ranges. The Servian skirmishers often did not even get within
 decisive range of the position of their opponents.

The British infantry, armed with a long range rifle equipped with an
excellent rear sight arrangement, allowed itself to be enticed, by the
long range fire of the Boers, into opening fire at 1200 and 1300 m.
(Guard at Modder River) and even at 1600 and 1700 m. (6th Division at
Paardeberg) against an enemy whose position was not discernible even
through the most powerful glasses. The losses were small and not to be
compared with those which our Guard suffered without firing, during
their advance on St. Privat. The advance of the Gordon Highlanders
at Doornkop (29th May, 1900) to within short range of the hostile
position, without firing a shot, although they themselves were under
fire from 2000 m. on, was splendid.[143]

   [143] _The Times History of the War in South Africa_, IV, p. 141.

Since the assailant presents larger targets than the defender, and the
latter can make preparations for firing, ascertain ranges, construct
rifle-rests, and replenish ammunition without difficulty, it is proper
in defense to open fire at long ranges, especially in delaying actions,
for then fighting at short ranges is to be avoided in any case. It is
absolutely correct for the defender to make the most of the advantages
above mentioned. While everything is orderly and in readiness in the
defender’s firing line, the attacker’s line is still in the process of
forming. Should the defender wait until the hostile firing line has
systematically deployed and has made a lodgment within short range of
his position, or should he produce losses and create confusion in its
ranks by suddenly opening fire?

The employment of long range fire on the defensive is justified when
sufficient ammunition is available, when artillery is not present, and
when the hostile infantry pursues the tactics of advancing to short
range without firing. “Infantry should never attempt to take the
place of artillery at long ranges or compete with the fire of that
arm.” If it is important for the attacker to reach the extreme limit
of mid ranges with as little firing as possible, the defender should
in the first place fire on him with artillery, and, when this does not
suffice or is not available, with infantry, so as to prevent him from
accomplishing his object.

At mid ranges the efficacy of the defender’s fire is so great, when
directed upon an infantry line advancing without fire support, that
it becomes an important factor. At ranges from 1000 to 600 m., 8 to
25% hits can be counted on when the fire is directed against advancing
skirmishers; and even assuming an error of ¹⁄₈ in the estimated range,
3 to 12% hits may still be expected. (Par. 623, p. 196, German I. F.
R.).

If the attacker is unable to hide from the defender’s fire by using
cover, his losses will increase until they become unbearable; his
attack will hesitate, and he will commence firing. Fresh troops are
necessary to carry the attacking line forward anew. The success of the
defense is assured, if the defender is able to prevent the attacking
force from getting within short range of the position. The defender’s
chance of making a successful counter-attack disappears, however, as
soon as the attacking force makes a lodgment within short range of the
position; for the closer the defender is pressed, the closer will he
be tied to his position. While the superiority of fire enjoyed by the
defender at mid ranges allows him perfect freedom of action, at short
ranges the attacker’s fire imposes conditions upon the defense which
make the growing power of the attack sensibly felt. The moment the
defender begins firing, however, he becomes at once a favorable target
for the artillery of the attacking force. The defender frequently
betrays his position prematurely by opening fire.

The _moral effect_ of withholding the fire (_fire surprise_) is very
great.[144] A strong fire will be actually annihilating if suddenly
directed upon the enemy at short ranges, especially if he is still
in unsuitable formations, owing to his ignorance of the defender’s
position. (Example: The British brigade under Hart at Colenso, 15th
Dec., 1899, and the Highland Brigade at Magersfontain, 11th Dec., 1899)
or if the morale of his troops is questionable.[145] What good troops
should do in such a situation (employ rapid fire and then advance to
the assault) is shown by the conduct of the IInd Battalion of the 20th
Infantry at Coulomiers.[146] Steady nerves and iron discipline are,
however, prerequisites for the execution of a fire surprise by the
defender.

   [144] Marshal BUGEAUD gives a very graphic description of the moral
 effect of fire in his _Aperçus sur quelques détails de guerre_,
 based upon his experiences in the fights with the British in the
 Peninsula: “The men began to get excited when still 1,000 m. from
 the enemy; they talked to each other; the march became more and more
 hurried; and disorder appeared here and there in the columns. The
 British remained quietly at order arms; their calm demeanor was not
 without effect upon our young soldiers. We approached closer, the
 men shouting: ‘_Vive l’empéreur! En avant, à la baionette!_’ Shakos
 were raised upon the points of bayonets; the march became a double
 time; the ranks became mixed; the excitement caused confusion here
 and there; and a few shots were fired from the column. The British
 continued to stand immovable, and seemed to pay no attention to us
 even when only 300 paces separated the two forces.

   “The contrast was apparent. Everyone felt that he would have to
 deal with an opponent tried in battle; that the fire so long withheld
 by the enemy would surely be annihilating. Our fighting ardor cooled;
 the moral power which calmness, even when only apparent, exercises
 over confusion, which seeks to drown itself in noise, made itself
 felt in our ranks. At this moment, when the highest tension had been
 reached, the British line raised its rifles--an indescribable feeling
 rooted many of our men to the spot--and began to fire. The volleys,
 coolly delivered against a narrow front, plowed through our ranks; we
 wavered, decimated though we were, in order to recover; then three
 overpowering cheers from the opponents’ line, which rushed forward to
 the bayonet attack, and everybody turned to seek safety in disorderly
 flight.”

   [145] The defense of the cemetery at Beaune la Rolande. HÖNIG,
 _Volkskrieg_, pp. 157 to 212.

   [146] Dec. 15th, 1870. _Geschichte des Regiments Nr. 20_, p. 246.
 KORTZFLEISCH, _Feldzug gegen den Loir_, p. 81.

Long range fire was employed with success on the defensive by the
French at St. Privat (the Germans suffered the most serious losses at
ranges from 1200 to 1000 m.) and by the Turks at Plevna. At 1500 m. the
Russian losses were such that they were obliged to begin advancing by
rushes. The losses decreased as the enemy’s position was approached.
The long range fire had produced a retarding but by no means an
annihilating effect. On the other hand, the fire of the defender, at
extremely short ranges, had a telling effect at Beaune la Rolande; in
the defense of Chagey on the Lisaine;[147] in the defense of Shipka
Pass (200 to 300 paces) by the Russians, and in the engagement at Gorni
Bugarov (1st Jan., 1878). Whenever the attacker enters the short range
zone while still in unsuitable formations, his losses increase until
they become annihilating. (Example: The bayonet attacks made by the
Austrians at Nachod and Trautenau).[148]

   [147] KUNZ, _Entscheidungskämpfe des Korps Werder_, II, pp. 53, 93
 and 143. The village was situated in a valley and had only a limited
 field of fire.

   [148] KÜHNE, _Kritische Wanderungen_, I, pp. 73 and 139; III, pp.
 86 and 113. As regards flatness of trajectory and accuracy, the power
 of the needle gun (_Zündnadelgewehr_) at point blank range (280 m.)
 corresponds to the effect of rifle model ’98 at approximately 800 to
 900 m. At Nachod the regiments named below suffered in two hours the
 losses given:

                             Loss, men;
                 Strength;   prisoners
   Regiment.       men.      included.   Prisoners.   Percentage.
 20th Infantry    2,500        722          165          28.8%
 60th Infantry    2,500        685          185          27.4%


Provisions of Various Regulations.

 =Austria.= “_In attack, everything must be done to get as close as
 possible to the enemy before fire is opened._” In each fire position
 the fire should be delivered with steadiness and without haste.

 In _defense_, fire is to be opened as soon as appropriate targets
 appear within effective range. Sometimes--especially in minor
 operations--it may be advantageous to let the enemy come up close and
 then open fire on him suddenly.

 A decisive fire effect can only be counted on when the targets are
 situated within effective range. Ineffective fire is a waste of
 ammunition which impairs the morale of one’s own troops and raises
 that of the enemy. For firing at long ranges it is necessary to
 consider whether a sufficient amount of ammunition is available. Long
 range fire should, in any case, be used only when the size of the
 target makes an adequate fire effect probable, and when the range is
 known, or can be ascertained with accuracy. In long range fire the
 use of small units, each expending a large amount of ammunition, is
 as a rule to be recommended. The _distribution_ and _concentration_
 of fire should be regulated by the officer charged with fire
 direction.

 “_Effective fire, delivered suddenly, especially when taking an
 enemy in flank or in reverse, even when delivered only by relatively
 small forces, shakes the morale of the enemy in the most effective
 manner._” (Fire surprise). “Under certain circumstances, but
 especially when the enemy has used up all, or nearly all, of his
 reserves, comparatively small detachments, skillfully led, can
 contribute materially to success, or even bring about the decision,
 if they are able to get on the enemy’s flank or rear and open
 fire on him suddenly at short range.” Such fire surprises should
 be attempted when the conditions essential for their success are
 present.[149]

   [149] In minor operations this would be a proper place for the
 employment of large scouting detachments, the importance of which
 decreases with the size of the contending forces. Such tasks can,
 however, be just as well performed by a well-trained body of infantry.

 =France.= In _attack_, fire is opened as late as possible, at any
 rate not until the losses make it necessary to discontinue the
 forward movement. Fire is the only means which makes a further
 advance possible.

 In _defense_, long range fire may be used under certain
 circumstances. “Sudden and violent rafales delivered at short range
 take the attacker by surprise if, all at once, he loses a great many
 men.”

 =England= (1905). _Attack._ Infantry is to advance as close as
 possible to the enemy before opening fire; small losses must be
 endured. Fire is decisive under 540 m. (600 yds.). Artillery and
 infantry should support each other. Attention is called to the
 support afforded advancing skirmishers by the fire of infantry units
 and machine guns held in rear. The British are thus the first to
 prescribe “fire of position.” Their Firing Regulations require that
 “fire of position” be practiced by company at a range of 900 m. The
 company forms line of skirmishers (2-pace intervals) while movable
 disappearing targets are placed opposite it. The fire is to increase
 in intensity when the attacking infantry advances over level ground
 or finds obstacles; it is discontinued when cover is reached. “Fire
 of position” is not without danger, but seems to be practicable
 occasionally. Aside from its employment in “fire of position,”
 long range fire is to be used in attack in the following cases: In
 enveloping movements for the purpose of enfilading the enemy’s line;
 when favorable targets present themselves; in containing actions or
 in feints; in concentrated collective fire; and finally in pursuit.
 _Defense_: Fire is to be opened at 1000 m. on skirmishers, but it
 may be advantageous to withhold it until the hostile line comes
 within short range. This will give good results when the enemy is in
 ignorance of the defender’s position, or when the attack is made by
 poorly disciplined troops. Continued long range fire tires the eye
 and the hand.

 =Italy.= In _attack_, the firing line is to reach the extreme limit
 of short range (500 m.) with as little firing as possible; to
 open fire before this with a part of the advancing force is only
 permissible when necessary to carry the line forward. _Defense._ As
 soon as the defender has a chance of obtaining some fire effect,
 he should open fire to prevent the attacking infantry from getting
 within short range. Fire at long (up to 1800 m.) and at mid ranges
 (up to 1000 m.) may also be used for this purpose. The battalion
 commander determines when fire is to be opened.

From what has been said in the preceding pages as to the time when
infantry should open fire, we may deduce the following =General
Rules=:--

It is permissible to open fire at an early moment only in exceptional
cases when the situation requires it; good preparation, which assures
the efficacy of fire and a high moral effect from the very beginning,
is of greater importance.


(a) IN ATTACK.

The attacker should advance without firing to ranges at which an
adequate fire effect against the low targets presented by the defender
may be expected. To open fire at an earlier moment is permissible only
when the defender’s fire is so strong that effective ranges cannot be
reached without firing. Long range fire is only a means to an end. In a
pursuit long range fire will, however, be employed for the purpose of
annoying the enemy.


(b) IN DEFENSE.[150]

   [150] In Manchuria the Russians, when on the defensive, opened fire
 on favorable targets at 1,500 m.; on skirmish lines at 1,000 m.

Fire may be opened at long ranges when sufficient ammunition is
available, only when the object is to gain time, and in decisive
actions, when the enemy presents favorable targets and we have no
artillery. Unless other reasons prevent, fire is opened as soon as
targets are clearly discernible and easily brought into line with the
sights. It is advisable to withhold the fire when the hostile artillery
is superior, when the opponent’s troops are of poor quality, and when
it is impossible to surprise the enemy with our fire while he is in
unsuitable formations. In defense, as in attack, the decision must be
sought by the employment of rapid fire at short range.


7. PAUSES IN THE FIRE.[151]

   [151] A Russian company commander contributes the following in
 _Mitteilungen der Infanterie Schieszschulen_: “On Sept. 3rd, 1904,
 the fire in one of the trenches at Liao Yang lasted throughout
 the entire day. The men were finally completely exhausted; their
 shoulders, hands and fingers stiff. They had to be given some rest,
 and something to eat and drink. Then the fire was resumed, only to
 die down again. The fire of the skirmishers was not very effective,
 as they were completely exhausted and used up.”

 =Swiss.= Firing Regulations p. 44: “It may be advantageous in defense
 to fire on the attacker only until he himself opens fire, and then
 to remain under cover until he resumes his forward movement. A
 prompt resumption of the fire by the defender must, however, be
 assured.”

 =France.= “The fire should cease when the hostile infantry halts and
 takes to cover; its volume is increased as soon as the assailant
 resumes his forward movement, or when he shows himself in dense
 formations on open ground.”

The efficacy of fire depends upon its accuracy, its direction with
reference to the target, and its volume. In the past, pauses in the
fire were necessary to allow the powder smoke to clear away; at
present they are of advantage because they give the men a breathing
spell; rest eyes and nerves; enable ammunition to be distributed, and
allow preparations to be made for concerted action. In making use of
such pauses good cover, good observation of the enemy and instant
readiness for resuming the fire are essential. In a serious engagement
the men either maintain a vigorous, animated fire or they rest. If
the advancing enemy takes to cover, the fire must cease, only to be
resumed with full vigor when favorable targets appear. The attacker
(like the British in South Africa advancing against the Boers) will
in many cases--especially at the beginning of a campaign--be deceived
into believing that the defender has withdrawn; should the attacker now
advance, the defender, by suddenly resuming his fire, will surprise
him to such an extent that he may be repulsed.[152] Pauses in the fire
are a practical expedient for maintaining fire discipline and enable
the leader to keep his troops in hand. An organization is capable
of performing its duty well, so long as it obeys the command “cease
firing.” It might be well at this point to determine when the defender
should _change his rear sight elevations_ if the attacker advances by
rushes. At mid ranges it might be advisable to stop firing, so as to
present no target to the enemy when his line throws itself down after
a rush, and to utilize this interruption for changing the rear sight
elevation. When this is done during a forward rush of the enemy, the
rapidity of fire will suffer at the most favorable moment for bringing
an effective fire to bear upon the enemy.

   [152] Compare HÖNIG, _Vierundzwanzig Stunden Moltkescher
 Strategie_, p. 145, relative to the various opinions entertained in
 the staffs of Generals v. Göben and Steinmetz in regard to the pause
 in the fire of the French at Point du Jour. _Der 18. August_, pp.
 269, 271 and 352.


8. KINDS OF FIRE.

In the days of slow loading rifles of limited range, the importance of
the _volley_ was due to the fact that it enabled the leader to develop
the greatest volume of fire in tactically favorable moments, or, in
other words, when large targets were visible for a short time. Modern
combat is conducted under different conditions. When black powder was
used the volley had the advantage of permitting the powder smoke to
clear away during the pauses. This advantage has now also disappeared.

In the Russo-Japanese war, the Japanese used “fire at will” almost
exclusively. Volleys were used by them only at long ranges; by troops
held in rear and, after an assault, to get the men in hand. These views
are not changed in the new regulations, but immediately after firing a
volley the men are to re-load without command. Rapid fire is retained.
The Russians placed their faith principally in volley fire,[153] but
were soon forced to resort to fire at will. The Russian regulations
recommended volley fire up to the decisive firing position, not so much
because of a belief in the superior efficacy of this kind of fire, but
out of distrust of the individual training of their men; certainly an
admission of the deficiency of that kind of training in their army. It
was feared that fire at will would impair fire discipline and cause
waste of ammunition, and it was believed that the immediate influence
of superiors could not be dispensed with. Even the new provisional
regulations have not discarded volley fire, which may be employed by
section or by platoon. Fire at will may be divided into slow fire (one
shot from each squad) and lively fire with counted cartridges.

   [153] At Nicholson’s Neck (24th Oct., 1899) the British leaders
 ordered their men, who were firing at will on the Boers advancing
 from cover to cover (“_Boer Attack_”) to discontinue that fire, and
 to use volleys only. But the enemy consistently avoided presenting
 large targets to the British volley fire.

_Germany._ _Volleys_ (pars. 106-108 German I. F. R.) are to be employed
by platoons or companies when in close order; in skirmish line
(par. 193 German I. F. R.) only when the enemy is surprised or the
organization is to be kept firmly in hand. Volleys, however, can be
used only when the troops themselves are not exposed to an effective
fire. An organization will be able to ascertain the range by means of
trial volleys only in exceptional cases.

“_The highest attainable rate of fire_--the word rapid fire has
been elided--is to be used in attack during the preparation for the
assault; in defense to repulse a hostile assault; in warding off a
cavalry charge; in all combat situations in which a sudden or immediate
collision with the enemy occurs; and, finally, in pursuit.” (Par. 208
German I. F. R.).

_Fire at will_ is used both in extended and close order.

 =Volley Fire and Fire at Will. Bursts of Fire (Rafales).= “_Il
 n’y a de feu practicable devant l’ennemi que celui à volonté._”
 NAPOLEON.[154]

   [154] “Fire at will is the only kind of fire practicable when
 engaged with the enemy.” NAPOLEON.

 “It may be objected that one frequently reads in military history
 of effective volleys. The explanation of this is that many of the
 so-called volleys mentioned in accounts were volleys only in name. In
 a few instances the defender endeavored to fire volleys, but usually
 their effect was insignificant.” V. BOGUSLAWSKI.

 “Fire at will was forbidden. Volley fire was used only by direction
 of the commanders of the battalion sections of the line. The order
 to fire volleys quickly ran along the trenches. For a few minutes
 a certain amount of unrest was noticeable among the men, which, if
 allowed to continue, might have degenerated into confusion and later
 perhaps into disorderly flight.

 “The first volley was not quite successful. It was ragged--some
 men even firing a second time without waiting for the command, an
 example likely to be followed by the others. The force was on the
 point of getting out of hand. Volleys fired by neighboring sections
 drowned the voice of the commander. In such situations only personal
 experience and resourcefulness can tell a company commander what
 to do. We recommend a course which has always been attended with
 success in practice. Let the officer commanding a section jump upon
 the parapet and from there give the order ‘cease firing.’ Then, if
 the enemy’s fire permits, and his own heart is stout enough, let him
 order the next volley from his position on the parapet. When once the
 force is again under control, the volleys will be as good as if the
 enemy were not so close.” KUROPATKIN-KRAHMER _Kritische Rückblicke
 auf den Russisch-Türkischen Krieg_, II, pp. 304 and 310.

 In his _Comments on Drill Regulations_ (16th Nov., 1840) Prince
 WILLIAM, subsequently Emperor WILLIAM I. of Germany, says:

 “I am personally opposed to volleys by battalion. I am of the opinion
 that in war volleys and file fire will seldom be used. Should this
 fire be used, however, no one will be able to stop file firing after
 volley firing, even though not ordered, _because in my opinion it
 is impossible to combat human nature_, which finds more security in
 rapid loading and firing than in awaiting the commands....”

 _Russian experiences in Manchuria._ “At first _volleys_ by formed
 bodies of troops were attempted, but later fire at will was used.
 In the latter, the men were forbidden to hurry, were instructed to
 bring their pieces down to the ‘ready,’ and, whenever it was possible
 to see the enemy--who was advancing by rushes--to change their rear
 sight elevations at the whistle signal of their commander.... When at
 a distance from the enemy the men remained cool and fired faultless
 volleys. When the enemy came closer the volleys deteriorated. The
 Russians used only fire at will at ranges under 800 paces. This
 enabled the men to fire on individual hostile skirmishers and to
 place the boldest out of action.” SOLOVIEV.

 =Austria.= _Volleys_ are employed, as a rule, only by bodies in close
 order, for the purpose of finding the range, and for firing upon
 targets which appear suddenly at long range and which will probably
 be visible for only a short time. Fire at will is the principal kind
 of fire used, the rate of fire being increased or decreased by the
 men according to the existing situation. When necessary, the leaders
 should regulate the fire; but this should only be done in exceptional
 cases as the men are apt to increase rather than diminish the rate of
 fire (“Rapid fire”).

 The _maximum rate of fire_ is to be employed: “In _attack_, for
 the purpose of gaining a superiority of fire at short range; in
 _defense_, for the purpose of warding off an impending assault. It
 is moreover to be used to inflict the greatest possible losses on a
 defeated enemy as long as he is within effective range; and, finally,
 in fire surprises, repulse of cavalry attacks, and in rencontres with
 the enemy.”

 =France.= The French _Lebel_ rifle has a cylindrical magazine
 situated under the stock and has a capacity of eight cartridges
 which have to be loaded singly. As a rule, _fire with counted
 cartridges_ is employed (_feu à cartouches comptées_) for the purpose
 of obtaining a “burst of fire” (_rafale_). The _rafale_ consists of
 firmly controlled, concentrated, collective fire. Fire at will (_feu
 à volonté_) is also used, eight rounds per minute being fired at the
 short ranges. The rapidity of this fire at will may be increased up
 to 12 rounds per minute by employing the cartridges in the magazine
 (_feu à répétition_). One minute is required to fill the magazine.
 Volleys are to be employed in night combats and when it becomes
 necessary to control the men. In exceptional cases individual men are
 directed to fire.

 =England and Switzerland.= The only fire employed is fire at will.
 The rapidity of this fire varies according to the nature of the
 target and the range.

 =Italy.= Fire at will (in close order in two or four ranks).

 =Japan and Russia.= (See p. 157, supra).


The Rate of Fire.

As regards its rate, fire may be divided into three classes, viz.,
_slow fire_, _accelerated fire_, and _rapid fire_. The command “fire
more slowly” (or more rapidly) serves only the purpose of diminishing
(or increasing) the rate of fire.

The rate of fire depends upon the purpose of action, the character of
the target, and the available ammunition. Unfavorable illumination and
the difficulty of clearly distinguishing the target at long ranges will
reduce the rate of fire. The aiming position (_i.e._, whether the rifle
is fired from a prone position or from a rest) also affects the rate of
fire. A well trained company at peace strength will, moreover, be able
to fire more rapidly than one on a war footing.

Hurried firing should unquestionably be condemned. The rapidity with
which our rifles can be loaded enables us to produce the maximum fire
effect in the minimum time against narrow targets. _The desire of
the soldier to make every shot a hit, carefully inculcated in time
of peace, will of itself regulate the rate of fire._ As the rate of
fire depends upon the distinctness with which the target can be seen,
it will naturally increase as the range decreases, thus generally
corresponding to the requirements of the tactical situation. Moreover,
as it is easier to aim at tall targets than at head targets, this also
exercises either an accelerating or a retarding effect, as the case
may be. Lieutenant-General Rohne has done a great deal to bring about
a correct appreciation of the rate of fire. He states: “The opposition
to an increased rate of fire is perhaps due to the belief that it is
invariably coupled with a reduction in accuracy. This is not the case,
however, and even if it were true to a certain extent, it need not
necessarily be harmful. To be sure, when a high rate of fire is solely
due to the excitement of the skirmishers, it is unquestionably to be
condemned because no attempt is made at aiming; but when it is the
product of systematic peace training, it need not necessarily preclude
good aiming. It is entirely consistent with a high rate of fire to load
and point quickly, to keep the target constantly in view, and, at the
same time, to aim accurately and to pull the trigger without flinching.

“The leader who reduces the rapidity of fire in battle in order to save
ammunition, wastes lives and time, both more valuable than ammunition.
Disabled soldiers are more difficult to replace than ammunition, and
lost time cannot be replaced at all.”[155]

   [155] _Schieszlehre für die Infanterie_, 2nd Edition.

A high rate of fire need by no means be synonymous with waste of
ammunition. Ammunition would unquestionably be wasted if fire were
delivered for hours at the same high rate. It is very probable,
however, that in the battles of the future the fire will be moderate
for some time, or, better still, cease entirely, only to break
forth like a thunderstorm over the enemy when opportunity offers or
necessity demands. The slower the troops fire the longer they will
present a target to the enemy. The coolness shown in firing individual
shots at the commencement of an action will disappear owing to the
impression produced by losses. This is apparent even in field firing.
Lieutenant-General Rohne arrives at the following average results:

 Ranges up to  400      m. 5   rounds per minute;
   „    from   400- 700 „  4-5   „     „     „
   „     „     700-1000 „  3-4   „     „     „
   „     „    1000-1300 „  2-3   „     „     „
   „     „    1300-1500 „  1-4   „     „     „
   „    over  1500      „    1   „     „     „

Troops going into action for the first time are inclined to fire
entirely too fast, due to their desire to overcome their nervousness.
Veteran troops seek to attain the same result, not through rapidity
of fire, but through accuracy. Only the determination to make hits is
calculated to overcome nervousness. Wherever this determination is
lacking, wild firing (fire panic), which is in any case difficult to
prevent, will surely result. Fire delivered hurriedly during unexpected
rencontres is almost invariably ineffective.[156] For this reason most
of the firing regulations have eliminated the command “Rapid Fire,”
which is only calculated to produce confusion.

   [156] At Beaumont the 9th Company of the 27th Infantry, after a
 long advance at double time, encountered the flank of a hostile
 battalion. The men became excited, raised the leaves of their rear
 sights, and opened rapid fire, which had no effect whatever, as the
 range was only 200 paces. _Geschichte des Regiments, Nr. 27_, p. 95.

The Italian Firing Regulations contain the following statement in
regard to the effect of accelerated fire (see p. 140 supra).[157]

   [157] Consult also _Schieszversuche der k. u. k. Armeeschieszschule
 seit dem Jahre 1900_, Vienna, 1905. ROHNE, _Schieszlehre für die
 Infanterie_, 2nd Edition, p. 132.

1. _When the appropriate elevation is used_, two-thirds of the
percentage of hits obtained by firing 5-6 rounds from each rifle per
minute, may be expected when firing at the rate of 12-14 rounds per
minute.

2. _When the elevation selected is too great or too small by 100 m._,
rapid fire produces almost the _same percentage_ of hits as ordinary
fire at will.

3. _When the elevation selected is in error by 200 m._, rapid fire
produces almost _twice as great a percentage_ of hits as fire at will.

From the above it follows that, when the appropriate elevation is not
used, accelerated fire will inflict greater losses upon the enemy than
ordinary fire at will in the same length of time. Within equal periods
of time the actual number of hits will be greater in animated fire at
will than in slow fire; but in the latter the percentage of hits will
be higher.

Of all the different kinds of fire, the _volley_ is best adapted to
meet the requirement of keeping the troops in hand, of concentrating
the fire, and thereby producing great moral effect. Volleys are of
value to troops in ambush, in repulsing cavalry attacks, and in
preventing premature firing against the wishes of the commander. They
should be used against staffs which would be able to seek cover or
spread out when exposed to fire at will.

As the men are, however, not equally skilled in loading their pieces,
the rate of fire is very little increased by the use of volleys.
The command “Fire” can only be given when the pieces of the entire
unit are directed upon the target. The length of the pause between
preliminary command and command of execution varies, depending upon
the distinctness with which the target can be seen, the range, and
the aiming position. When the fire is delivered from a prone position
it will be difficult to determine when the command of execution
should properly be given. Moreover, as fire from a standing or
kneeling position will be the exception, this has contributed to
eliminate volley firing on the battlefield, because the troops lack
coolness--mental as well as physical--which is indispensable in every
volley.

The material and moral effect of a volley is doubtless very
considerable, but who could possibly make his voice heard when a
deployed platoon of sixty men is firing? How about the efficacy of
the fire when the men revert of their own accord from volleys to fire
at will, which they will do when their officers are either killed or
wounded and they themselves are exposed to fire?[158]

   [158] During the advance on Flavigny (Vionville), the support of
 the 10th Company, 12th Infantry, was to move into the firing line for
 the purpose of firing volleys. “The volley was by no means a good
 one, however, and the men at once took up rapid fire. Lieutenant
 C---- jumped in front of the men to stop the firing, but was shot in
 the leg and crawled back. The rapid fire continued along the entire
 line.” _Geschichte des Regiments, Nr. 12_, p. 454.

   During the war between Servia and Bulgaria the Servians always
 opened the infantry combat with volleys, but after casualties had
 occurred among the officers under the heavy fire of the enemy, the
 steady volley fire soon degenerated into wild, hurried fire at will,
 which produced no effect whatever.

If we use squad volleys (Russia), we approximate fire at will without
any of its advantages, besides which, commands, given by so many
leaders, tend to confuse the men. Moreover, it is very difficult to
handle the platoon, to stop firing, to change target, and to initiate
movements. Volley firing is therefore confined to the preparatory
stage of combat and to rare moments in which the troops firing are not
themselves under effective fire. In the defense of fortified positions
many opportunities will be found for the employment of volley fire.
The use of trial volleys for the purpose of testing the rear sight
elevation will be confined to a few favorable cases, and it may be
remarked that animated fire at will concentrated on some definite point
produces the same results.

The French, who retained volleys longer than the other powers (to keep
the men in hand, to regulate the expenditure of ammunition, and to
direct a concentrated collective fire upon the most important target
according to the will of the leader), found a substitute in the fire
with counted cartridges,[159] the “burst of fire” (rafale).[160] This
was also adopted by their artillery. In Germany, the importance of the
sudden effect produced by these “bursts of fire” is recognized, but
the same object is sought to be attained by training alone; while in
Russia, fire with counted cartridges has been adopted, not for the
purpose of obtaining rafale fire effect, but for keeping the men in
hand. Rafale fire has the disadvantage that pauses in the fire are
regulated formally, and that these pauses occur frequently at the very
moment when a favorable target is still visible. Will the individual
soldier remain cool in the excitement of battle and carefully count the
three or five cartridges which he is to fire? In defense, rafale fire
is proper, because the skirmisher in the defensive line is completely
hidden during the pauses, while the attacker presents favorable
targets only temporarily, thus justifying an increased expenditure
of ammunition. In attack, suitable targets are rarely available for
rafale fire, and a substitute for this fire must be sought in well
directed, steadily delivered fire at will, interrupted by rushes to
the front. During an attack, rafale fire might degenerate into wild,
uncontrolled fire at will, the rapidity of which decreases only when
the ammunition runs short. The employment of this class of fire might
sometimes be advisable in action when it becomes necessary to hold the
enemy, that is, in defensive situations. In this connection, one who is
thoroughly familiar with the French army aptly says: “Rafale fire may
be likened to the wild passes made by a man, backed up against a wall,
for the purpose of warding off an adversary who is able to decide the
controversy with one well-aimed blow.”

   [159] Temporarily adopted in Germany also.

   [160] Par. 194.1 of the _French Infantry Drill Regulations_ of
 Dec. 3rd, 1904, states: “The moral effect produced upon an opponent
 by the fire is much more considerable when the fire is concentrated
 and delivered suddenly and unexpectedly.” Par. 194.4 states: “The
 efficacy of the fire, due to its intensity, is augmented when the
 enemy is taken by surprise,” etc. Par. 195.1 states: “The fire is, as
 a rule, delivered by ‘rafales,’ which are short, sudden and violent;
 and, in exceptional cases, by volleys.”


9. REAR SIGHT ELEVATIONS AND POINTS OF AIM.

In Switzerland and Italy the employment of a single rear sight
elevation, less than the actual range, is preferred, even when the
range is not accurately known. The French regulations are silent on
this subject. In Germany one rear sight elevation is used, as a general
rule, up to 1,000 m.; beyond that range combined sights may be used in
which the two rear sight elevations differ from each other by 100 or 50
m.[161]

   [161] See ROHNE, _Schieszlehre für die Infanterie_, p. 93, et seq.

   In view of the greater dispersion of fire in action, the author
 recommends the selection of either one elevation only, or, at the
 longer ranges, the employment of combined sights, in which the
 elevations differ from each other by 200 m. In peace time the use
 of combined sights, by well-trained marksmen, in which rear sight
 elevations differ by only 50 m. would, indeed, be sufficient to
 increase the number of hits, but on the battlefield the favorable
 conditions found on the target range are lacking.

“Rapidly approaching or receding targets are followed by making proper
sight corrections, rear sight elevations being less than the range when
the fire is delivered against advancing targets and greater than the
range when the fire is delivered against receding targets. At short
ranges the same result may be obtained by aiming lower or higher. It
should be noted that, when firing on cavalry making a mounted attack,
the danger space is continuous when the sights are raised to 700 m.”
(Par. 192 German I. F. R.). As a general rule, the proper aiming point
is the lowest line of the target. When it becomes necessary to aim at
the center, to one side of or below a target, its dimensions will serve
as a guide. A change in the rear sight elevation is necessary at medium
and long ranges to raise or lower the sheaf of fire; at short ranges
it is practicable to point higher only when the target is tall. When
the velocity of a side wind cannot be estimated, it is advisable to
distribute the fire over a broader front. At short ranges the selection
of an aiming point may, under favorable circumstances, be left to the
discretion of the individual skirmishers.


10. COMMANDS.

In recounting the several commands to be given for firing, the
regulations take into consideration the logical sequence of the tasks
devolving upon the skirmisher. Thus the first command draws the
skirmisher’s attention to the target; the second indicates the range;
the third directs him to open fire.


11. THE OBSERVATION OF THE FIRE.

The actions of the enemy are usually the only reliable indication of
the location of the sheaf of fire directed against him; the observed
strike of bullets is seldom so good an indication. It is especially
difficult to judge of the distribution of projectiles from their strike
in front and in rear of the target. Suggestions from the subordinate
leaders, whose view of the target is generally restricted, are often
more confusing than valuable.


12. THE EFFECT OF FIRE.

COMPARISON BETWEEN LOSSES PRODUCED BY INFANTRY AND ARTILLERY FIRE.

In 1866 the Austrian artillery inflicted 16% of our losses. In 1870-71
the French artillery inflicted 8% of our losses. Up to the battle of
Liao Yang the 1st Japanese Army suffered the following losses:

 ===========+===========================+========================
            |        PERCENTAGES.       |       WOUNDS.
            +----------+-------+--------+--------+-------+-------
            |  Small   | Art’y |Cutting |Serious.|Slight.| Very
            |arms fire.| fire. |weapons.|        |       |slight.
 -----------+----------+-------+--------+--------+-------+-------
 Guard Div. |  88.42   | 11.50 |  0.08  | 32.17  | 62.49 |  5.34
 2d Div.    |  89.43   |  7.91 |  2.30  | 44.05  | 54.89 |  1.06
 12th Div.  |  80.52   | 14.48 |  2.09  | 39.12  | 46.36 | 14.52
 -----------+----------+-------+--------+--------+-------+-------
 Average    |  86.12   | 11.30 |  2.09  | 38.45  | 54.58 |  6.97
 -----------+----------+-------+--------+--------+-------+-------

The figures given above under the captions “serious” (including
killed), “slight,” and “very slight” wounds have, of course, only a
relative value. The following figures express the average losses of
Russians and Japanese:

 Losses through rifle fire      85.9%
 Losses through artillery fire  11.4%
 Losses through cutting weapons  3.2%

Modern fire tactics count upon a prolonged fire for the purpose
of gradually exhausting the enemy, and upon rapid fire, suddenly
delivered, for annihilating him.

While a statement of the percentage of hits[162] throws some light upon
the effect of the fire of an organization, under normal conditions, the
number of figures placed out of action affords a standard of comparison
by means of which tactical success may be measured, and aids in
deciding how to distribute the fire. Differences in fire effect on like
targets are best determined by comparing the number of figures hit per
minute by 100 marksmen, as a great number of hits is presupposed, which
is not the case when the percentage of hits is taken.

   [162] In this connection the following works have been consulted:
 _Das Gefechtsmäszige Abteilungsschieszen der Infanterie_, 4th
 Edition (1905), by Lieutenant-General ROHNE, and _Schieszlehre
 für die Infanterie_, 2nd Edition (1906), by the same author;
 also _Militär-Wochenblatt_ No. 46 of 1900. To be sure, absolute
 trustworthiness cannot be claimed for the figures given, for the
 conditions of firing in action are variable; but, as obtained by
 Lieutenant-General Rohne, they serve as an excellent standard of
 comparison, and, when their relative value is considered, as a basis
 for tactical deductions.


(a) Influence of Training.

Individual skill in marksmanship is of decisive importance when firing
at targets of appropriate size at the short ranges. A good marksman,
firing at will, may (not _must_) expect a hit from each round fired,
at any target within 250 m., at a single kneeling opponent within 350
m., at a kneeling file within 500 m., and at a standing file within
600 m. At ranges beyond this, influences, due to the imperfections of
the rifle, make themselves felt; and these influences grow to such
an extent that the best marksmanship training is unable to eliminate
them. A considerable number of rifles must fire in order to produce
an effect; for, as some of the pieces fire short and others over,
the hits are thus distributed over a greater area. But even here
skill in marksmanship is apparent in that the cone of dispersion of
the excellent shots produces a shot group of small diameter, that of
the poorer shots one of very large diameter. Lieutenant-General Rohne
computed (_Schieszlehre für die Infanterie_, p. 84) that when firing
rifle model ’98 with the appropriate elevation at a target 1 m. high,
the marksmen named in the following table would obtain the number of
hits given at the ranges indicated:

 =======+========================================
        |         NUMBER OF HITS OBTAINED BY
        +---------------+------------+-----------
  Range.|Excellent shots| Fair shots | Poor shots
        |        Out of 100 rounds fired.
 -------+---------------+------------+-----------
 1000 m.|     27.       |    17.6    |    8.9
 1500 m.|     14.2      |     9.7    |    4.8
 -------+---------------+------------+-----------

This ratio changes, however, very seriously to the disadvantage of the
excellent marksmen when the appropriate elevation is not used. The
figure given below, in which the curves of hits are traced, shows that
even poor shots may obtain better results in this case.

From this may be deduced the great importance of quickly and accurately
ascertaining the range. The excellent ballistic qualities of our rifle
and our thorough marksmanship training can assert themselves fully only
when the range has been accurately determined. At ranges over 800 m.
too great an accuracy in collective fire may be actually detrimental.
In this case individual accuracy matters little; the important thing is
to direct the densest portion of the sheaf of fire, with some degree
of accuracy, on a target the range to which is known only in a general
way. The importance of training soldiers in precise marksmanship
is ethical rather than practical, for a good target shot need not
necessarily be a battle marksman. For the latter a cool head is of more
value than all the marksmanship skill of the target range.


(b) Influence of the Error in Estimating the Range.

At short ranges an error of estimation is offset by the flatness of
the trajectory. Lieutenant-General Rohne used a probable error in
estimation of ¹⁄₈ (12.5%) of the range in his computations. The Swiss
Firing Regulations of 1905 count on an error of 100 m. at 500 m., 200
m. at 500 to 1,000 m., 300 m. at ranges over 1,000 m., and the average
is taken to be ¹⁄₅ of the range, or 20%. For measurements with range
finding instruments see p. 146, supra.

[Illustration]

[Illustration]

In the following table, the number of hits per 100 rounds fired, at a
target 1 m. high, by the marksmen named, is shown under--

“a” When the fire is controlled and the appropriate elevation is used;

“b” When each skirmisher has selected the elevation corresponding to
his estimate of the range. In this case it is presumed, however, that
the ranges are generally estimated correctly. (ROHNE, _Schieszlehre für
die Infanterie_, 2nd Edition, p. 102).

 ======+================+===============+===============
 Range.|Excellent shots.|  Fair shots.  |  Poor shots.
       +-------+--------+-------+-------+-------+-------
    m. |   a   |   b    |   a   |   b   |   a   |   b
 ------+-------+--------+-------+-------+-------+-------
   400 |  65.1 |  58.5  |  50.4 |  47.8 |  26.6 |  26.4
   600 |  46.6 |  32.9  |  32.9 |  26.6 |  16.9 |  15.8
   800 |  35.2 |  15.5  |  23.3 |  13.9 |  11.8 |   9.7
  1000 |  27.  |   7.5  |  17.6 |   7.  |   8.9 |   5.9
  1200 |  20.5 |   4.   |  13.6 |   3.9 |   6.8 |   3.5
  1400 |  16.1 |   2.4  |  10.8 |   2.4 |   5.4 |   2.2
  1600 |  12.5 |   1.5  |   8.7 |   1.5 |   4.4 |   1.4
 ------+-------+--------+-------+-------+-------+-------

The above table shows that when the elevation selected is in error,
the number of hits decreases more rapidly the greater the skill of the
marksman; and that an error in estimation is of less importance than
marksmanship only at ranges under 800 m.

DIFFERENCE BETWEEN “a” AND “b.”

 ======+================+===============+===============
 Range.|Excellent shots.|  Fair shots.  |  Poor shots.
    m. |                |               |
 ------+----------------+---------------+---------------
  400  |      6.6       |      2.6      |      0.4
  600  |     13.7       |      6.3      |      1.1
  800  |     19.8       |      9.4      |      2.1
 1000  |     19.5       |     10.6      |      3.0
 1200  |     16.4       |      9.7      |      3.3
 1400  |     13.3       |      8.4      |      3.2
 1600  |     11.        |      7.2      |      2.
 ------+----------------+---------------+---------------


(c) Fire Effect as Regards Time. Number of Rounds to be Expended.

The greater the losses inflicted within a short period of time in a
limited space, the greater the moral effect of the fire. It should
therefore be the aim of the officer charged with fire direction to
bring about a decisive effect within the shortest possible time. The
leaders must bear in mind from the beginning of the fire fight that the
ammunition carried is limited and that the expenditure of a certain
amount is equivalent to a loss of power, and this is permissible only
where commensurate results would be achieved. When once a decision has
been formed to fire on a target, the ammunition necessary to accomplish
the object of the fight must be expended without stinting, since
ineffective fire impairs the morale of one’s own troops and raises that
of the enemy.

When the enemy is approximately equal to us in numbers, and is deployed
in line at one man per meter of front, presenting breast targets only,
the number of rounds per rifle, given in round figures in the following
table, will be required to place about one-third of the enemy’s force
out of action:[163]

 At a range of  300 m.   3   rounds,
 „  „   „   „   400 „    5     „
 „  „   „   „   500 „    6     „
 „  „   „   „   600 „    7.5   „
 „  „   „   „   700 „   10     „
 „  „   „   „   800 „   13     „
 „  „   „   „   900 „   16     „
 „  „   „   „  1000 „   25     „
 „  „   „   „  1100 „   45     „
 „  „   „   „  1200 „   50     „
 „  „   „   „  1300 „   57     „
 „  „   „   „  1400 „   63     „
 „  „   „   „  1500 „   72     „
 „  „   „   „  1600 „   80     „

   [163] According to ROHNE, _Schieszlehre für die Infanterie_, 2nd
 Edition, p. 214.

In the above table it is assumed that an error of estimation of
7.5% was made and that at ranges over 1000 m. two elevations were
used. Against head targets, approximately twice the number of rounds
indicated above must be expended; and against exposed skirmishers,
visible at full height, about half of the number of rounds given. The
efficacy is increased when the fire comes from a flank. The following
data are taken from an extended firing test: At 600-700 m., 200
skirmishers, firing 5000 rounds against 200 body targets, obtained 4.3%
hits and placed 43% of the figures out of action; under the enfilading
fire delivered by one platoon, the percentage of hits rose to 10.5%,
and the number of incapacitated figures to 80%.


(d) Additional Influences Affecting Accuracy of Fire.

Errors in setting the sight, in pointing, aiming, and pulling the
trigger, increase the area of the beaten zone at the expense of fire
effect on the actual target selected. When we consider the excitement
of men in action, and the numerous sources of error in setting the
sights, in pointing and firing, it is clear that we have to reckon
with the =effect of misses= on the field of battle more than with the
really well aimed and well delivered collective fire of a considerable
number of marksmen. Lieutenant Colonel Wolozkoi, late of the Russian
Army,[164] attempted to obtain an approximate standard of measurement
for the errors in firing made by marksmen. He bases his deductions upon
the opinion that the efficacy of rifle fire in action depends entirely
upon the mental and physical condition of the individual soldier at
the moment; that in serious engagements this condition is such that
accurate aiming cannot be expected; and finally that every skirmisher,
according to the degree of his excitement or fatigue, will fire his
piece at varying angles of elevation. He argues that this produces a
rigid cone of dispersion, whose limits correspond to certain extreme
angles of error, and whose axis (center trajectory) corresponds to a
mean angle of error; that, for each class of rifles, the depth of the
resulting beaten zone is constant; and that the depth of this zone
increases with the range corresponding to the angles of error. It
follows that the depth of this beaten zone is greater in modern rifles
than in those of older pattern.

   [164] _Das Gewehrfeuer im Gefecht_, 1883.

He believes that peace training will have fulfilled its mission if the
skirmisher, while firing, holds his piece in the position to which he
has become habituated through years of practice. This position can be
none other than that in which the piece is horizontal.

Although the theory of the =Rigid, Constant Cone of Misses=, is not
tenable in this form, because there will always be a reasonably compact
core of hits (the dimensions of which depend upon the conditions
indicated in the firing regulations) at the center of the cone of
fire, the views of Colonel Wolozkoi have, nevertheless, a certain
value for us, and find application in large, hotly contested battles,
especially when the firing line has been exposed to the material and
moral influences of hostile fire for a considerable length of time. At
the commencement of every combat we can, at any rate, count on “aimed
fire”; but instead of reckoning at all times with a 75% core of hits,
100 m. in diameter, we must become used to reckoning with a 30 and 40%
core of hits, of the same diameter, produced by greater dispersion of
the bullets.

According to experiments made by Colonel Wolozkoi, a good shot makes
a mean angular error of ±8 minutes, when using the horizontal aiming
position; a poor shot, one of ±40 minutes; the average error being ±25
minutes. In this, however, the sources of error, due to excitement
on the part of the marksmen, are not considered. “The principal
angular errors can be traced to the nervousness of the marksmen; and
this is directly proportional to the magnitude of the danger and
the suddenness of its appearance. The soldier judges the magnitude
of danger by the number of hostile projectiles and by their effect.
Therefore, the livelier the hostile fire, and the longer it continues,
the greater the danger appears to him; while the less the effect of
that fire, and the better he is sheltered from it, the less he will
think himself endangered. On this account, the nervous tension of the
individual soldier will reach different degrees of intensity according
to the magnitude of the danger.

“Now there are combat situations where the danger is insignificant,
and entire engagements in which the impression produced by danger may
be called moderate; moreover, even in lively actions phases may occur
in which this is equally true. The circumstances of each particular
case will, therefore, determine how long it is possible to fire as
prescribed in the firing regulations, and from what moment a reduction
of efficacy, according to Colonel Wolozkoi’s theory, is unavoidable.

“The arrival of this moment will be postponed more or less by better
discipline and training; and, in addition, at the commencement of an
action, we may count on the men putting into practice, to a certain
extent, what they have been taught in time of peace. However, the
efficacy of rifle fire will deteriorate gradually, as the danger and
the intensity of the fight increase, until it reaches the stage which
Wolozkoi considers peculiar to all of the more serious actions.

“When discipline is still further reduced, the efforts of the men to
keep under cover may lead them to duck even their heads and to fire
their rifles at high angles. In this case the decisive short ranges
would not be swept by fire, making it possible for the more determined
of the two opponents to advance to the assault.

“This reduction of the efficacy of fire (_i.e._, the delivery of fire
at high angles) may also take place when troops are surprised and, in
consequence thereof, fire hurriedly. This explains why the enemy’s
fire passes entirely over a body of troops which has gotten quite close
to his position--by no means an unusual phenomenon in surprises.”[165]

   [165] F. C. v. II. _Zum Studium der Taktik_, p. 97.

Wolozkoi assumes that the core of hits of his constant cone is formed
by projectiles fired at a mean angle of departure of less than 4
degrees, while the lower trajectories of the whole cone of fire
correspond to an angle of 1 degree and 30 minutes, and the upper
trajectories to one of 14 degrees and 30 minutes. If we apply these
figures to a particular rifle we obtain a beaten zone containing 50%
of the hits (central zone) at 560-1500 m. for the _Chassepot_ rifle;
at 1000-2000 m. for the 8 mm. rifle, and at 1200-3000 m. for the 6.5
mm. rifle. It should once more be emphasized that these figures are
applicable in combat phases in which the men themselves are under fire,
while firing, or deliver their fire hurriedly or with bad aim.

 During the =Franco-German war= the German troops learned by
 experience that the defender’s fire inflicted serious losses on
 the attacker at long ranges, but that the efficacy of his fire did
 not increase as the skirmishers came closer to his position; that,
 on the contrary, the intensity of the hostile fire effect fell off
 noticeably at ranges below 600 m.

 During the attack made by the Prussian Guard against =St. Privat=,
 the greatest number of dead and wounded were counted at ranges
 from 1200-1500 m., and the fewest losses were sustained at ranges
 from 500-600 m. from the enemy’s position, where it had to remain
 stationary on the slope for about an hour awaiting the effect of the
 enveloping movement made by the Saxon Army Corps. A range of 1500
 m. corresponds approximately to an angle of departure of 5 degrees
 for the _Chassepot_ rifle. The 20th Infantry Division was molested
 by rifle fire from =St. Privat=, during its march from =St. Ail= to
 =St. Privat= (the range in this case was 2200 m., which corresponds
 to an angle of departure of 15 degrees 30 minutes for the _Chassepot_
 rifle) although the skirmishers of the Guard, against whom this fire
 was directed, were only from 400 to 500 m. from the French position.

 In the =Russo-Turkish war= of 1877-78, the same thing occurred.
 Infantry projectiles reached the Russian reserves while they were
 still 2500 m. from the enemy (this range corresponds to an angle of
 departure of 14 degrees 30 minutes).

 Kuropatkin corroborates the statement that at 1500 m. and beyond
 (5 degrees 50 minutes), the losses produced by the Turkish rifle
 fire were very serious; that at 400 m. (1 degree 8 minutes) from
 the hostile position, on the other hand, the losses were remarkably
 small, sometimes even ceasing entirely. The Turks finally kept their
 heads under cover altogether.

 A correspondent writes the following in regard to the engagement
 at =Slivnica= on November 17th to 19th, 1885: “When at 400 m. from
 the enemy, the firing lines suffered scarcely any losses, while the
 reserves, stationed far to the rear, suffered severely from stray
 shots.”

It must be the endeavor of peace training to prevent the occurrence
of unaimed firing in battle. This necessitates careful supervision
by squad and platoon leaders over the individual soldier in the
firing line, and the severe punishment of every act of carelessness
in pointing, aiming, and setting of the sight, in peace time. In war
one must constantly endeavor to avoid opening fire prematurely, as it
tires the eye and the arm of the soldier, to check any unjustifiable
rapidity of fire, and to hold the men down to a steady and slow fire.
This includes, in addition, the avoidance, by the leader, of haste in
giving directions for firing. In defense, one will have to make every
effort to withdraw one’s men from the moral effect of the attacker’s
fire preparation, and to keep them in proper condition to repulse
the assault. This requires the construction of splinter proofs, head
cover, and, in case the hostile fire becomes too deadly, a cessation
of fire, which is again resumed when the enemy attempts to advance.
To carry this out properly, covered observation stations should be
built, and the men instructed to line the parapet and to open fire at
a signal previously agreed upon, sights having been set and ammunition
replenished before they leave cover. A body of troops is not unfit to
resist an assault simply because it has suffered a certain percentage
of losses, but because each individual soldier is so mastered by the
feeling that he is in danger of losing his life that he fires his piece
without raising his head above the parapet. A body of troops in such a
state will fire its projectiles in Wolozkoi’s “constant cone.”

A mobilized organization, thoroughly trained in time of peace, will
still fire a by no means inconsiderable fraction of its projectiles
with good aim and with the proper rear sight elevation, provided its
officers are equal to their task.


(e) The Influence of Rifle-Rests in Firing.

Freehand firing increases the rate of fire. Whether the skirmisher
fires freehand or from a rest is of influence on the accuracy of
the single shot at short ranges. The Belgian, Dutch, and Italian
regulations authorize the bayonet, in the absence of other expedients,
to be stuck into the ground as a rifle-rest, while this is forbidden
in Germany. Collective fire of short duration delivered at mid ranges
has not been found superior because of the use of rifle-rests. Fire
delivered from a rest is undoubtedly superior, however, when the barrel
of the piece is heated by continued firing (position of the left hand
supporting the piece when firing standing, prone, or kneeling) and
when the arm of the skirmisher gets tired. When firing from a rest,
high shots result from vibrations of the barrel;[166] and there is
also danger, when under fire, that the men will not raise their heads
over the parapet, but will fire their pieces into the air. This, as
corroborated by the more recent campaigns, is why a fire fight at
short range is by no means decided in so short a time as the peace
performances of modern rifles lead one to suppose, for great losses
do not take place until skirmishers, who have heretofore hugged the
ground, rise. At Spionskop, the two opposing firing lines remained
stationary for hours at 250 m. from each other.[167] The Japanese
found in their attacks that at ranges from 150 to 75 paces the hostile
fire had no effect.

   [166] According to the _Swiss Firing Regulations_ the change in
 height in the point of the target struck amounts to ¹⁄₁₀₀₀ of the
 range.

   [167] The British Infantry (consisting of 2694 men, exclusive of
 subsequent reinforcements), which was engaged at short range on
 Spionskop from 3 A. M. until 9:30 P. M., lost 40 officers and 721 men
 in 18¹⁄₂ hours (one officer to every 18.5 men), _i.e._, 28.2%. See p.
 189 infra.


(f) Influence of the Ground.[168]

   [168] MONDEIL, _De la résolution des problèmes de tir sur le champ
 de bataille_, Paris, 1900.

So far we have considered only the effect of infantry fire on level
ground. The efficacy of fire is, however, greatly influenced by the
inclination of the ground upon which the cone of dispersion falls.
Where the ground rises in respect to the line of sight, the depth of
the beaten zone is decreased; where it falls in respect to the line of
sight, the depth of the beaten zone is increased.[169]

   [169] Lieutenant-General ROHNE’S definitions are given below in
 explanation of certain technical terms:

   “_Danger Space_” is the distance measured along the line of sight
 within which the trajectory neither rises above the height of the
 target nor falls below the target.

   “_Beaten Zone_” is the distance measured along the surface of the
 ground within which the trajectory does not rise above the height of
 the target.

   Whether a target will be struck by a bullet when the range has not
 been correctly estimated depends entirely upon the danger space.
 In pointing at the bottom line of the target, the aiming position
 (_i.e._, the height at which the piece is held) does not affect
 the danger space. When pointing at the center of the target the
 danger space changes, increasing for low rear sight elevations and
 tall targets, and decreasing for high rear sight elevations and low
 targets, as compared with aim taken at the bottom line of a target.
 “The evil effects of errors in estimating the range decrease as the
 ‘danger space’ increases, which, by the way, is wholly dependent upon
 the ballistic properties of the rifle, upon the range, and the height
 of the target. The danger on the ground in rear of the target fired
 upon, and the difficulty of bringing up reinforcements and ammunition
 over it, increases directly as the beaten zone, which in addition
 depends upon the inclination of the ground to the line of sight.”

 The importance of this circumstance is frequently so magnified in
 the French infantry that sight is lost of tactical requirements. For
 example, they employ formulae to ascertain the point from which a
 height can be covered with grazing fire, or propose to defend the
 ascent to a plateau by evacuating the military crest and occupying
 the reverse slope, keeping the slope facing the enemy under a grazing
 fire with the tail ends of the trajectories.

Let A B B¹, in the accompanying figure, represent a horizontal plane
pierced by trajectories C B and C¹ B¹, at an angle α, forming the
beaten zone B B¹. If now the ground falls from B in the direction B D,
it is obvious from the figure, that the angle of fall β decreases and
the beaten zone B D increases. The limit of this increase is reached
when the angle of slope is greater than the angle of fall of the
projectile. In this case there is a dead angle beyond B and toward D.
If, on the other hand, the ground be rising, the angle of fall will be
C¹ D¹ B and the beaten zone[170] decreases to B D¹. The smaller the
angle of fall of the projectile the greater the influence of the ground.

[Illustration]

   [170] The computation of beaten zones is based upon the formula
 deduced by Lieutenant-General ROHNE in his work _Schieszlehre für
 Infanterie_, p. 127:

 Let α = angle of fall;
     γ = angle of slope (rising or falling);
     β = beaten zone on level ground;

 then
   α
 ----- β = beaten zone on falling ground;
 α - γ

   α
 ----- β = beaten zone on rising ground.
 α + γ

From this it follows that when fire direction is in competent hands the
appearance of the enemy on the terrain as at B D will be fully taken
advantage of, while firing on slope like B D¹ should be avoided. Troops
will, however, rarely be in a position from which they can see a target
on the slope B D. The efficacy of the fire will in such a case be more
or less a matter of accident. A body of troops in broad formation will
in this case receive a greater number of hits than a column, since
each meter of front of the crest line receives a certain number of
projectiles. It is otherwise, however, where the slope rises in respect
to the line of sight. A line is more easily missed than a column of
considerable depth on the march.

 The following data in regard to the increase (diminution)
 of the depth of the beaten zones is taken from the work of
 Lieutenant-General ROHNE on _Das gefechtsmäszige Abteilungsschieszen
 der Infanterie_, p. 44:

 ======+===============+================
 Range.| Rising Slope. | Falling Slope.
   m.  |   1°  |   2°  |   1°  |   2°
 ------+-------+-------+-------+--------
  800  |  ¹⁄₂  |  ¹⁄₃  |   ∞   |   ∞
 1000  |  ²⁄₃  |  ³⁄₄  |   2   |   ∞
 1200  |  ³⁄₄  |  ³⁄₅  |  ³⁄₂  |   3
 1400  |  ⁴⁄₅  |  ⁴⁄₆  |  ⁴⁄₃  |   2
 ------+-------+-------+-------+--------

[Illustration]

 The above figure, taken from Lieutenant-General ROHNE’S work,
 _Schieszlehre für die Infanterie_, p. 128, shows the influence of
 the ground on the efficacy of fire when “poor” shots are firing at a
 target, 100, 200 m. etc., in rear of which are other targets of the
 same dimensions but situated either on level ground, on a 2-degree
 rising slope, or a 1-degree falling slope. On a rising slope of 2
 degrees the depth of the beaten zone is decreased by half, and on a
 downward slope of 1 degree increased by half.

 “The knowledge of this influence of the ground is of great
 importance to the tactician. For this reason I have selected ‘poor’
 shots for the above example because the efficacy of infantry fire in
 battle will approximate theirs more nearly than any other. From this
 we may deduce that where the ground slopes upward in rear of a firing
 line, less distance will suffice to withdraw supports from the fire
 directed at the firing line than on level ground; and that, if the
 ground in rear of the firing line slopes downward, the distances must
 be increased unless the slope is so great or the hostile trajectories
 so flat that bullets pass over the crest, forming a ‘defiladed
 space,’ into which no projectiles strike.”

 On ground rising in respect to the line of sight (_i.e._, on the
 slope of heights facing the enemy, or opposite to commanding ground,
 the slope facing the plain) columns suffer the greatest losses; on
 ground falling in respect to the line of sight (on the reverse slope
 of hills and on plateaus) line targets suffer the greatest losses.

 Where the ground falls at a greater angle than the angle of fall of
 the projectiles (about 5 degrees at 1500 m., and 1 degree at 800
 m.) a defiladed space is formed, which makes it possible to bring
 supports nearer to the firing line than would be practicable on level
 ground. If we assume that each graduation of the rear sight over 600
 m. commands a space 100 m. deep with the normal core of hits, we
 obtain the following depths of the beaten zones at a range of 1500
 m., with rifle model ’98 (angle of fall 5 degrees and 22 minutes):

 Ground rising   1 in 10 = 6° =  50 m.
    „     „      1 in 20 = 3° =  64 m.
    „     „      1 in 50 = 1° =  81 m.
 Ground falling  1 in 10 = 6° = 360 m.
    „     „      1 in 20 = 3° = 180 m.
    „     „      1 in 50 = 1° = 113 m.

[Illustration]

[Illustration]

 The figures on pages 181 and 182 show to what extent the ground is
 capable of increasing or diminishing the efficacy of fire. The French
 assert that the Würtembergers deliberately applied these principles
 in the defense of the park wall at =Villiers=. It was, at any rate,
 only an accident that the masses of troops on the west side of the
 gently sloping Mamelon de Villiers suffered heavy losses on November
 30th, 1870.

 General PAQUIÉ of the French Army[171] lays down the following rule:
 “When the angle of slope of falling ground corresponds to the angle
 of fall of the lowest trajectory of a cone of dispersion, the depth
 of the beaten zone will be 2¹⁄₄ times greater than on level ground.
 When the angle of slope of falling ground is equal to the angle of
 fall of the mean trajectory of a cone of dispersion, the depth of the
 beaten zone will be 2¹⁄₂ times greater than on level ground. When the
 lowest trajectory of a cone of dispersion passes over the crest of a
 hill at the height of a man, and when the reverse slope of that hill
 is equal to ¹⁄₁₀₀ of the range, the depth of the beaten zone will be
 five times as great as on level ground.”

   [171] See also _Le tir de guerre et les expériences pratiques
 du camp de Châlons_. _Journal des sciences militaires_, Sept.,
 Oct., Nov., 1808--_Le Joindre Général. Petit Guide pour les tirs
 collectifs_, 1904.

 These data are of no practical value in war. They serve only to
 increase the appreciation of fire effect when examining the terrain,
 and train the eye in judging such situations.

 The character of the ground may exert great influence when firing
 on intrenchments. Fire delivered from low ground against an enemy
 in shelter-trenches is absolutely ineffective--as shown in the
 action against the French IInd Corps at =Point du Jour= and by the
 experiences of the Russians at =Plevna= and =Gorni Dubniac=. This
 condition becomes aggravated the smaller the angles of fall of the
 projectiles, and the higher the target is situated relative to the
 firing position of the attacking party.

 Attacks on hill positions show that there is a range at which the
 greatest efficacy may be obtained from fire directed against the top
 of the height itself. This maximum efficacy gradually dwindles as
 the position is approached. This fact has led the Swiss to retain a
 _Main Firing Position_. (See Figure, p. 182. Fire effect from A and
 from B). For the purpose of determining the favorable range, “D,”
 corresponding to a certain height (of the enemy’s position) “H,”
 Lieutenant-General ROHNE has deduced the following formula for rifle
 model ’88:[172]

 D = 15.H + 500.

   [172] Capitaine CUGNAC, D = 14 (H + 50). See also the work
 of Captain KNOBLOCH, _Zur Technik des Feuerangriffs gegen
 Höhenstellungen_, _Swiss Monthly Journal_, 1907.

   The well-known plateau of the “Galgenhügel” at Wörth, which is at
 present crowned by the monument of the 50th Infantry (elevation 35
 m.) could be effectively swept by the fire of our present-day weapons
 at 1025 m.; a further advance would reduce the fire effect. For rifle
 model ’98 the formula might be stated: 20. H + 600.

 It is only in fortress warfare that it might occasionally be possible
 to apply this formula. To determine at what distance the defender
 must take position in rear of a crest, in order to sweep the slope
 facing the enemy with his fire (aiming points being resorted to)
 without being himself exposed to view, is of still less value for
 use in the field. According to General Warnet of the French Army, if
 “p” is the degree of slope expressed in centimeters, the defender
 should choose between two points which lie between (p + 5) 1000
 and (p + 3) 1000. When the degree of slope is 1 cm. in 10 cm., the
 defender should take up his position either 600 or 300 m. in rear of
 the main crest. In such a position the defender will, it is true, be
 protected to a certain extent from the enemy’s fire, but can only
 very inadequately defend the slope facing the enemy. A concentration
 of fire on certain targets is impossible and the attacker is given an
 opportunity to reach the crest, here and there, without coming under
 fire. Thus ballistic advantages must be given up in the face of the
 numerous tactical disadvantages. We have mentioned this subject here,
 to show the strange excrescenses which an undeniably sound basic
 principle may develop in the hands of theorists, who have entirely
 forgotten that in war only that which is simple succeeds.

 “Indirect Rifle Fire” is to be used in firing on a target not visible
 from the firing position. In this connection, the following is
 taken from the report of Captain KNOBLOCH, Austrian Army,[173] on
 _Schieszaufgaben unter feldmäszigen Verhältnissen_:

   [173] _Verstecktes Gewehrfeuer. Vorschläge zur Erhöhung des
 Gefechtswertes unserer Infanterie_, Vienna, 1904. _Feldmäsziges
 Schieszen der Infanterie aus versteckten Stellungen._ _Organ der
 militär-wissenschaftlichen Vereine_, Nos. 1 and 2 of 1906. _Resultate
 der Schieszversuche mit verstecktem Gewehrfeuer._ _Mitteilungen
 über Gegenst. des Artillerie- und Geniewesens_, No. 12 of 1905.
 _Militär-Wochenblatt_, 1907, No. 28, pp. 144 and 155.

 “Indirect rifle fire is infantry fire in which aiming points are
 used. These should lie above and beyond the target and in line with
 it. It goes without saying that an aiming point fulfilling all these
 conditions will rarely be found. Moreover, the aiming point must not
 be selected at random at some particular elevation, because the angle
 between target and aiming point, expressed by graduations on the rear
 sight leaf, might possibly lead to a negative sight setting.

 “In the practical tests made on varied ground against targets of
 appropriate height, splendid results were obtained as regards effect;
 but the aiming point had to be indicated by means of a flag. Despite
 the fact that the terrain was covered with numerous objects, such as
 trees, woods, factory chimneys, etc., no suitable aiming point could
 be found on the terrain itself. This largely determines the value of
 indirect rifle fire in the field.”

 This class of fire is, however, worth a trial at any rate. Moreover,
 its tactical, combined with its moral, advantages are so great that
 we could afford to accept calmly a fire effect poorer by comparison.
 Indirect rifle fire will, at times, give troops an opportunity to do
 damage to the enemy without being themselves seen or fired upon.

It remains to mention briefly the effect of =ricochets= which, as
a rule, tumble[174] after striking. Their range upon rebounding is
short. Bullets ricochet most frequently on water, on rocky and hard
ground, more rarely on wet meadows, and on tilled soil, but they do not
ricochet at all on sandy soil. Ploughed fields, in which the furrows
run obliquely to the line of fire, eliminate the effect of ricochets
almost entirely. When jacketed bullets (but not the massive French “D”
projectiles) strike upon rocky ground, they have a tendency to alter
their form materially, or to tear the jacket, thereby considerably
increasing the severity of the wound which is produced. The range
of ricochets upon rebounding depends mainly upon the angle at which
they are deflected. When the lateral deflection is 30 degrees their
range may amount to about 1300 m. The nearer a bullet strikes to the
skirmisher firing it, and the smaller the angle of deflection of the
consequent ricochet, the greater its range; under favorable conditions
this may amount to 2500 m. According to French experiments, in firing
at a range of 800 m., 4% ricochet hits struck a target, the height of a
man, at 1400 m., and 1% ricochet hits a similar target at 1850 m. from
the skirmisher who did the firing.

   [174] According to tests, our small-caliber bullets tend to tumble
 even when only grazing small twigs.


13. LOSSES IN ACTION.[175]

   [175] See _Taktik_, V, p. 76 _et seq._

An attempt to move troops in close order formations within the zone
of uninterrupted infantry fire at ranges under 1500 m. when the enemy
is still in condition to direct his fire on them, is bound to lead
to losses which make the further tactical employment of these troops
impossible.

Bodies of troops following the firing lines will also have to deploy
when the hostile fire reaches them, unless they can find cover. It is
a disadvantage for them to deploy, and every opportunity to return to
close order formation must be utilized.

Troops in rear, not directly fired upon and exposed only to accidental
shots, should employ narrow rather than broad formations. It might
therefore seem advisable to remain in route column so long as no
flanking fire is received. The Italian Firing Regulations contain the
following figure showing the effect of fire directed on troops in the
formations indicated.

[Illustration:

 Vertical axis: Percentage of hits to be expected.
 Horizontal axis: Range in meters.

 Dash-dot curve: Company Column.[176]
 Dotted curve: Line of platoons.[177]
 Solid curve: Line of skirmishers.
 Dashed curve: Line of platoons in columns of fours, at 15-pace
 intervals.]

   [176] In Germany called “Column of Platoons.”

   [177] In columns of fours, at 6-pace intervals.

According to the figure, the Italian Company Column (German Column of
Platoons) suffers the greatest losses; the least losses are sustained
by the company formed in line of platoons, each in route column, at
intervals of 15 paces. According to French experiments, this formation
is said to be no longer suitable when subjected to infantry fire at
ranges under 1300 m.

According to French firing tests made in Châlons,[178] the following
percentages of hits may be expected when using the Lebel rifle firing
old model steel jacketed bullets:

 ==========================================+===================
                                           |   At a range of
                                           +----+----+----+----
                                           |1200|1400|1600|1800
                                           | m. | m. | m. | m.
 ------------------------------------------+----+----+----+----
 Platoon (one rank)                        | 4.4| 3.4| 2.2| 1.4
 Skirmish line, men at 3-pace intervals    | 1.2|----|----|----
 Platoon in column of fours                | 6.6| 3.8| 2.2| 1.3
 Platoon in column of twos                 | 5.6| 3.2| 1.9| 1.1
 Company column (German column of platoons)|22.0|18.0|14.0|10.0
 ------------------------------------------+----+----+----+----

   [178] _Le Joindre, Petit Guide pour les tirs collectifs_, p. 15.

Lieutenant-General ROHNE, in his work, _Schieszlehre für die
Infanterie_, p. 117, computes values for the relative vulnerability
of the several formations. At a range of 1200 m., purely frontal fire
only being considered, we obtain with every 1000 rounds fired with the
appropriate elevation, the following number of hits against--

 ========+=====+=========+=============
         |Line.|Column of|Infantry in
         |     |platoons.|route column.
 --------+-----+---------+-------------
 Standing| 116 |   160   |     98
 Prone   |  20 |    65   |     72
 --------+-----+---------+-------------

And against a company deployed in line of platoons:

 =========+================+==================+===================
          |3 platoons, each| 3 platoons, each |6 sections, each in
          |in route column.|in column of twos.| column of twos.
 ---------+----------------+------------------+-------------------
 Standing |      57        |       39         |       29
 Prone    |      28        |       25         |       14
 ---------+----------------+------------------+-------------------

The company deployed in line of sections in columns of twos would thus
seem to be the most favorable formation for movements, and the line
lying prone is especially well suited for halts. For movements under
purely frontal, concentrated fire, the line is the least favorable
formation, while the route column offers the narrowest target. In
this, the character of the terrain plays a decisive role. In firing
on targets consisting of columns, it has been assumed that a single
projectile will place only one man out of action. Under shrapnel fire
the formations are similarly arranged as regards their vulnerability,
the line formation being less favorable than the column of platoons,
since the former receives all bullets deflected laterally.

The total losses in battles and more serious engagements amount to from
10 to 20% of the participating troops. In some organizations the losses
in killed and wounded may amount to as much as 50-60%. The loss that an
organization will endure is directly proportional to its efficiency.
Good troops, which unexpectedly get into a difficult situation (as,
for example, the British Brigade of Highlanders at Magersfontain), and
which have been trained to look upon heavy losses as unavoidable, will
be capable of enduring a loss of 25% in the course of a battle without
going to pieces and without discontinuing the attack.[179]

   [179] It is notorious that colonial wars with their moderate losses
 spoil troops and their leaders in this respect.

 At the battle of =Gravelotte=, in which 166,400 rifles, 21,200
 sabres, and 732 guns, extending over a front of 19 km., participated
 on the German side, only 109,200 rifles and 628 guns fought the
 decisive action. The losses amounted to 9.51%, distributed as
 follows: 899 officers and 19,260 men; according to arms: infantry,
 10.96%; cavalry, 0.66%, and artillery, 5.74%. On the decisive flank,
 the infantry of the Guard suffered a loss of almost 30%. On this
 flank, the Rifles of the Guard (_Gardeschützen_) lost 44%, the 1st
 Battalion of the 2nd Regiment of the Guard, 55.5% of their enlisted
 strength, the 6th Company of the latter regiment losing even 141 men.

 Although losses are, generally speaking, smaller than during the
 18th Century, and at the opening of the 19th Century, nevertheless
 they may amount to a considerable figure in a brief space of time in
 single bodies of troops which suddenly encounter a heavy fire.

 At =Magersfontain=, (December 11th, 1899) the British lost 13% of
 their total strength; the Brigade of Highlanders, 23% (39% of the
 officers; i.e., 1 officer for every 14.9 men); the IInd Battalion
 of the Black Watch, 42%, and the IInd Battalion of the Seaforth
 Highlanders, 23.9%. At =Colenso= (Dec. 15th, 1899) the British lost
 6.4% of their total strength; the IInd Battalion of the Royal Dublin
 Fusiliers, 23.9%.

=Spionskop= (Jan. 24th, 1900):

 Attacking troops  2,694 men in 18¹⁄₂ hrs. 40 officers, 721 men = 28.2%
 Supports          1,600  „  „  10¹⁄₂  „    8   „        95  „  =  6.4%
 Reserves          1,500  „  „   4¹⁄₂  „   15   „       170  „  = 12.3%
 Staffs             ----        ----        5   „       ---        ----
                   ----------------------------------------------------
                   5,794 men               68 officers, 986 men = 17.5%

 This action illustrates strikingly how rapidly the officers directing
 the fire were shot down.

 Attacking troops  1 officer for every 18 men
 Supports          1   „     „     „   12  „
 Reserves          1   „     „     „   11  „
                   --------------------------
                   1 officer for every 14 men

 For the purpose of comparison, we should like to mention that the
 Prussian Grenadier Battalion “_von Wedel_,” consisting of 12 officers
 and 390 men, lost 10 officers and 301 men (77%) in about one hour
 during the battle of =Soor= (Sept. 30th, 1745). The losses suffered
 by the Grenadier Battalion “_von Münchow_” at =Kesselsdorf= are
 possibly not much lower. The effective strength of the last named
 battalion is not given; it lost 5 officers and 371 men.[180]

   [180] _Kriege Friedrichs des Groszen_, II, Appendix 3, pp. 11 and
 47.

 At =Kolin=, the Grenadier Battalion “_Nymschöfsky_” lost 652 men,
 and six infantry regiments lost between 900 and 1188 men, _i.e._,
 considerably more than 50% of their strength. Two days after the
 battle, the Grenadier Battalion “_Nymschöfsky_” numbered only 24
 men and the enlisted strength of six infantry regiments was 233,
 296, 602, 651 and 711 men respectively. The number of stragglers was
 undoubtedly very great.[181] At =Kolin=, the infantry lost in all
 12,307 men out of 19,000, _i.e._, 65%.

   [181] _Ibid._, III. Appendix, pp. 11 and 20.

The losses among officers are especially heavy. This is by no means
due to the attempt of the hostile skirmishers to pick off the leaders
in the combat at short range, but to the fact that, in order to lead
their men, officers must expose themselves. This becomes more and more
necessary the greater the moral effect of the combat on the nervous
systems of the men, and the poorer the troops. According to past
experience, the casualties among officers are especially heavy in the
early stages of a war.[182]

   [182] See _Taktik_, V, pp. 81, 88 and 358.

 The relative losses of officers and men in the battles named are
 given, in round figures, in the following table:

 At =Weiszenburg (Vth Army Corps)=    1 officer for every 14   men;
 „  =Wörth (Vth Army Corps)=          1    „     „    „   20    „ ;
 „  =Wörth (XIth Army Corps)=         1    „     „    „   15    „ ;
 „  =Vionville (IIIrd Army Corps)=    1    „     „    „   21    „ ;
 „  =Vionville (Xth Army Corps)=      1    „     „    „   24    „ ;
 „  =Gravelotte (Guard Corps)=        1    „     „    „   22.5  „ ;
 „  =Gravelotte (XIIth Army Corps)=   1    „     „    „   20    „ ;
 „  =Colenso=                         1    „     „    „   15    „ ;
 „  =Magersfontain=                   1    „     „    „   11.8  „ ;

 Colonel HESSERT[183] writes the following in regard to the losses
 among the officers of the 25th Division on August 18th, 1870: “Eight
 of the 16 field officers and 6 of the 14 adjutants present with
 the regiments and battalions were either wounded or killed. Almost
 all of these officers were mounted. Seventeen of the 40 company
 commanders--almost all of them dismounted--and 43 of the 151 company
 officers were placed out of action. This would be a loss of 50% in
 field officers, 42% in adjutants, 37% in company commanders, and 29%
 in company officers.”

   [183] _Betrachtungen über die Leistungen der französischen Gewehre
 M/74 und M/66_, Darmstadt, 1879, p. 115.

 On this day the Rifle Battalion of the Guard lost 100% of its
 officers and 44% of its men--19 officers and 431 men, in about
 three-quarters of an hour.

 On Sept. 11th, 1877, at =Plevna=, the _Ugla_ Regiment lost 20 of its
 officers, _i.e._, 40%; the _Jaroslaw_ Regiment, 25 officers, _i.e._,
 64%; the total loss of the first named regiment amounted to 42%,
 that of the last named to 49%. Of the 15 company commanders of the
 _Vladimir_ Regiment, 14 were placed out of action.

 After the assault on the =Tuminling Pass= on Oct. 12th, 1905, the
 East Siberian Rifle Regiment had only 2 officers with its firing
 line, and after the battle of =Sandepu= only 5. These examples are
 not isolated ones. After the battle on the =Yalu=, the 11th Rifle
 Regiment had present for duty only one field officer, and the 12th
 only 3 captains. On March 7th, 1905, the _Yoshihoka_ Regiment (3rd
 Japanese Division) had present for duty only 3 lieutenants; one
 battalion was commanded by a first sergeant and one company by a
 private.


14. THE MORAL EFFECT OF FIRE.

The moral effect may make itself felt in a two-fold way: as the sum of
the impressions influencing the soldier at all times in action, and
as the momentary general impression produced by a sudden considerable
increase in the losses. The great material effect of fire creates such
a consciousness of danger in men’s minds that in a defeated force more
than half of its numbers succumb to this moral effect of the fire.

“Troops do not retreat because they are unable to maintain themselves
owing to their numerical inferiority, but because they fear the losses
which they would suffer if they advanced further. The determination
to conquer has been overcome by the desire to live. The confusion of
impressions increases with the size of the force. Taken individually,
the men might behave quite sensibly, but in a crowd they are claimed
either by insanity or lethargy. The activity of the mind is completely
replaced by imagination; everything is believed; nothing is appraised;
exaggeration prevails everywhere; and precipitation produces unthought
of results. When the men come to their senses, it is as if they were
awakened from a stupor; they are unable to understand how fear could
have induced them to do the very opposite from that which would, most
surely, have saved them from destruction.”[184]

   [184] KUROPATKIN-KRAHMER, _Kritische Rückblicke auf den
 Russisch-Türkischen Krieg_, I, p. 150.

In the midst of the impressions of the battle of St. Privat, General
von Kessel wrote: “The men appear to be either extraordinarily excited
or stupefied. Their faces are distorted and only a few still retain
firm will power.”

General Bonnal describes his first impressions at the battle of
Wörth as follows: “Since half-past seven our battalion was lying,
facing eastward, in the neighborhood of the wood of Fröschweiler. The
shrieking of the Prussian shells, but especially the noise of the
shells bursting in the midst of the batteries of the 3rd Division
in position in our rear, made a considerable impression on our men.
Their joking ceased, and nervousness was plainly visible in their pale
faces. Men to whom tobacco was offered declined it; they had no desire
to smoke. All eyes were focused upon the officers. The latter were
congregated here and there in small groups; a few were trying hard to
joke, others were walking up and down, with a cigarette between their
lips, making convulsive efforts to appear at ease; a small number
were entirely calm as if no danger was present.... The first batch of
wounded made a strong impression. The battalion was to reinforce the
Turcos in the edge of the wood of Fröschweiler. The fire of the Turcos
drowned all other sounds. There was nothing to indicate that the enemy
was also concentrating a heavy fire upon the wood. We deployed into
line to the right. The deployment began, but scarcely ten men had
reached the edge of the wood when a terrible cracking and rattling
commenced. It was a mitrailleuse battery which fired a volley directly
under our very noses. At this moment our men lost their heads. They
blazed away like mad, crowded in three, four, and five ranks at the
foot of the downward slope. The men in front had thrown themselves to
the ground, the others fired kneeling or standing, leaning against
trees. Since all of the men fired without aiming, enveloped moreover
by a dense, impenetrable cloud of smoke, the advanced lines were in
greater danger of being hit by French bullets than by those of the
enemy. We had to throw ourselves to the ground to avoid being shot down
by the lines in rear. On the hill opposite to us, at a range of 300 to
400 m., there rested a white smoke cloud, and we could indistinctly
discern the enemy, who was keeping up a lively fire. The powder smoke
enveloping us was so dense that we literally could not breathe.” This
excitement gradually subsided and the leaders were able to get the
troops again under control.

The numerous surrenders of British troops in the engagements of
the Boer War were due to the peculiar conditions existing in the
theater of war. Besides, Boer and Briton spoke the same language.
During the first few days of the campaign, surrenders of detachments
of considerable strength took place. These were not punished with
sufficient severity. One almost gains the impression that the men
considered the surrenders justifiable in order to escape from a
difficult situation.

On the South African battlefields, devoid of cover and swept for
great distances by the hostile fire, it was indeed very difficult
to penetrate the hostile position, and retrograde movements were
undoubtedly attended with heavy losses. To this may be added the fact
that it was easy for the Boers, who were mounted, to bar the way to
isolated British forces. It must be remembered, moreover, that the
operations took place during the hottest season and in a country where
water is scarce; and that the men felt they had arrived at the limit
of their powers of physical endurance at an earlier moment than would
have been the case under different conditions. Thus, the surrender at
Stromberg of troops exhausted from a night march, is perhaps excusable;
not so, however, the surrender of Colonel Carleton’s detachment,
which laid down its arms at Nicholson’s Neck after offering a feeble
resistance. In the last-mentioned case, it is true, several Englishmen,
who had already laid down their arms, stood among the Boers so that the
commander of the British force did not really know just what action to
take in this situation. His hesitation decided his fate. The demand
must unquestionably be made in future also,[185] that troops surrounded
in the field make a serious attempt to cut their way out before
permitting thoughts of surrender to enter their minds.

   [185] In contrast to this view the British court of inquiry found
 all but three of the 226 surrenders, which occurred up to June 1st,
 1900, justified. In the three cases in which the verdict was adverse
 only a few men had surrendered. Within a period of eight months
 the British lost a total of 1680 officers and 2124 men killed and
 wounded, while their loss in prisoners amounted to 182 officers and
 4984 men.

It is impossible to determine theoretically what losses troops are
able to endure. After the Franco-German War it was believed that
troops had reached the limit of endurance after losing one-third to
one-fourth of their strength. Nowadays this limit would appear to be
reached much sooner. It may be pointed out, however, that the neglect
of continuing the attack at Colenso (loss 5.8%), and at Spionskop (loss
7.2%), may, in part, be charged to lack of energy in the commander;
and that the Brigade of Highlanders, consisting of 2000 rifles and
deployed on a front of about 4000 m., in the engagement at Paardeberg
(loss 13.4%), lacked the necessary depth to continue the attack.
The greater the degree of efficiency and freshness of troops, and
the less the degree of suddenness with which they enter a difficult
situation, the greater the losses which they will be capable of
enduring. Furthermore, we should not forget that our modern personnel
has become much more susceptible to the impressions of battle. The
steadily improving standards of living tend to increase the instinct
of self-preservation and to diminish the spirit of self-sacrifice.
The spirit of the times looks upon war as an avoidable evil, and this
militates directly against that courage which has a contempt for death.
The fast manner of living at the present day undermines the nervous
system,[186] the fanaticism and the religious and national enthusiasm
of a bygone age are lacking, and, finally, the physical powers of the
human species are also partly diminishing. The influence exerted by
officers on the firing line is nowadays, however, considerably smaller
than in the past, so much so that they can actually control only the
nearest skirmishers. In addition, the nerve-racking impressions on the
battlefield are much greater at present than in the past. The “_void
of the battlefield_”[187] has become especially pronounced since the
introduction of smokeless powder. “_The invisibility of the enemy
directly affects the morale of the soldier, the sources of his energy
and his courage. The soldier who cannot see his enemy, is inclined
to see him everywhere. It is but a step from this impression to
hesitancy and then to fear._ The inertia of the troops for whole days
at Magersfontain, Colenso, and Paardeberg, frequently more than 800
m. from the enemy, was not produced by their losses, but by the moral
depression which is caused within the effective zone of rifle fire.”
(General NÉGRIER.)[188]

   [186] See SPAITS, _Mit Kasaken durch die Mandschurei_. After the
 author had turned away in disgust from a Chinese execution, he wrote:
 “And we Europeans will feel just like this in war. We will get to a
 certain point where the strength of our will and our physical powers
 will succumb to the weakness of our nerves, and this state we will
 reach more quickly than did the Russians, who were better off in
 regard to nerves than members of those armies in which nervousness is
 carefully fostered.” See also this author’s remarks about _Courage_,
 _ibid._, p. 206.

   [187] This complaint of the “void of the battlefield” is not
 new. A Saxon officer complains of it in his _Vertrauten Briefen_
 (Cologne, 1807), and the French officers report on the “void of the
 battlefield” in the fights around Metz. BONNAL, _L’art nouveau en
 Tactique_, p. 90.

   [188] _Revue des deux mondes_, for June, 1902.

The effect of danger on the battlefield is indicated by--

 1. Derangement of tactical units;

 2. The mixing of men of the different units during the action; and

 3. The dissolution of units into disorderly masses.

 According to the _History of the Kaiser Franz Regiment_ (p. 113)
 immediately after the battle of =St. Privat=, most of the companies
 numbered only 30 men, and the whole regiment only 340 men, although,
 allowing for losses, there should have been 1922 men. The three
 companies of the 39th Füsilier Regiment which had fought in the
 =Stiring Wald= at =Spicheren=, numbered only 6 officers and 150
 men at the close of the fight in the evening,[189] which means
 that, allowing for losses, 350 men were missing. After the battle
 of =Colombey=, when the Füsilier Battalion of the 55th Regiment
 was assembled, three companies numbered only 120, 60 and 40 men,
 respectively. This battalion had lost about 300 men.[190]

   [189] _Gen. St. W._, I, p. 366.

   [190] _Geschichte des Regiments_, p. 347.

 The plan of the battle of Colombey given in the General Staff Account
 (_Gt. St. W._) shows at 7 P. M. 17 companies belonging to 5 different
 infantry regiments, and to two different infantry brigades, occupying
 a front of 1200 paces, in the following order:

   7.       1.   4.    8.    4.    6.    12.   7.   }
 -------, ----, ----, ----, ----, ----, ----, ----, }
 Jägers.   55.   15.   15.   53.  15.    15.   15.  }

 { 10. 11. 12.    1.    1.   9.10.   4.3.  Cos.
 { ------------, ----, ----, -----, -----,
 {     13.        13.   73.   15.    73.   Inf.

 At =Wörth= 17 different regiments were represented on a front of 5700
 paces.

 “The assault on =Elsaszhausen= (=Wörth=), after preliminary forest
 fighting, mixed up the troops of the different brigades and in some
 cases caused the dissolution of battalions.... The 44th Brigade was
 the only one that remained in fairly good order. Abreast and in rear
 of it were portions of all the other regiments (of the XIth Army
 Corps) which, at the moment, however, represented no actual reserves.
 Even the battalions in the first line hardly appeared to be tactical
 entities.”[191]

   [191] _Gen. St. W._, I, p. 268.

 At several points it was possible to assemble the stragglers into
 formed bodies; but the men in these, commanded by strange officers,
 easily succumbed to the influences of the combat, and the units
 disintegrated rather quickly as soon as they came under fire.[192]

   [192] For details see KUNZ, _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, XVI,
 pp. 122, 124, 177, 231-234.

 In the =Giefert Wald= (=Spicheren=) out of 32 companies (4
 brigades) only four companies fought together as a battalion. In
 the little =Wenzelberg Wood= (at =Nachod=) there were engaged 7¹⁄₂
 Austrian battalions (belonging to four different regiments) and 2
 Jäger-Battalions, all of these troops belonging to three different
 brigades.[193] No attempt was made to lead these troops as one body.

   [193] _Austrian Gen. St. W._, 1866, III, p. 81.

 In the oak wood at =Dubno= (=Skalitz=), there were engaged 12¹⁄₂
 and 8¹⁄₂ battalions belonging to four different regiments and to
 two different army corps. “The Prussian orders led to a breaking up
 of the order of battle and to a considerable mixing of brigades,
 regiments and battalions. In consequence of this, control was lost to
 a certain extent by the commander-in-chief, and the result achieved
 was mainly due to the skill and intelligence of the subordinate
 leaders--especially that of the commanders of battalions and half
 battalions.”[194]

   [194] KÜHNE, _Kritische Wanderungen_, II, p. 48.

 “The wooded region in rear of =St. Hubert= was thickly infested with
 stragglers of all arms. White, red, and blue shoulder straps were to
 be seen in profusion; men with and without rifles; some with helmets,
 some with caps, some bareheaded. There were no officers present
 except those stretched wounded upon the ground. The superior officers
 riding through the valley assembled the men they found, but it proved
 only a small force that they gathered, for the greater portion of
 the men were safely ensconced to one side of the bottom of the
 valley.”[195] “At 5 P. M., the garrison of =St. Hubert= had increased
 to 43 companies, belonging to seven different regiments, and the
 result was utterly hopeless confusion.”[196]

   [195] HÖNIG, _Vierundzwanzig Stunden Moltkescher Strategie_, p. 139.

   [196] _Ibid._, p. 167.

 “At 10 P. M., 48 battalions of the VIIth, VIIIth and IInd Corps
 occupied a space of barely 1500 m. front and a depth of 1000 m., east
 of the Mance ravine opposite the French position. Fortunately the
 enemy was so exhausted that we were able to commit the most serious
 mistakes with impunity under the very muzzles of his rifles.”[197]

   [197] _Ibid._, p. 224.

 “At =Sedan= bodies of infantry of the XIth Corps, as well as of the
 46th Infantry and of the 5th Jäger-Battalion, had gotten mixed up
 with the 43rd Brigade during the course of the battle. The regiments
 of the 43rd Brigade had likewise been so disorganized that after the
 capture of =Cazal= the brigade commander had nothing at his disposal
 but the most heterogeneous mass of troops consisting of about a
 battalion.”[198]

   [198] _Gen. St. W._, II, p. 1249.

 “In penetrating into =Lovtcha= (1877) the foremost battalions became
 disorganized. The companies, and even single soldiers, stood around
 in irregular groups on the streets, crowded into the houses and
 sought cover in drainage ditches.”[199] “In one battalion of the
 _Kasan_ Regiment, which was to move through the town from the left
 flank, officers and men threw themselves down when the enemy’s fire
 became effective and only with difficulty could they be induced to
 rise. When the regimental commander fell, everybody fled, carrying
 along those in rear. Only two company columns, composed of stragglers
 of different organizations, resisted, deployed into a dense skirmish
 line and, encouraged by their officers, rushed forward cheering.”[200]

   [199] KUROPATKIN-KRAHMER, _Kritische Rückblicke auf den
 Russich-Türkischen Krieg_, I, pp. 68 and 72.

   [200] _Ibid._, I, p. 72.

 This fighting power of improvised units, when there were officers
 left to lead them, was displayed on several occasions at =Plevna=.

 The IInd and IIIrd Battalions of the _Kaluga_ Regiment (in the third
 battle of =Plevna=) after taking the second crest, thoughtlessly
 continued the advance in complete disorder.

 “Skobeleff foresaw the coming reverse and attempted to form a
 reserve, but only by dint of the greatest exertions on the part of
 the officers was it possible to collect about 100 men belonging
 to various companies. The men of the IInd and IIIrd Battalions of
 the Kaluga Regiment were scattered all over the battlefield, the
 companies had become completely mixed up, and it was a matter of the
 greatest difficulty to re-form them.”[201]

   [201] _Ibid._, I, p. 154.

 “Dense firing lines, composed of men of all the regiments,
 attempted to climb the opposite slope but they got only half way;
 400 paces from the Turkish works they halted. The survivors of the
 organizations participating in the action gradually assembled in
 Work No. 1, which had been taken. While only a couple of hundred men
 had taken the work, thousands were now assembled there. Not a single
 company or battalion was intact, every vestige of organization had
 disappeared; the commanders, and officers generally, had become
 separated from their units.”[202]

   [202] _Ibid._, I, pp. 236 and 238.

 “Prince IMERETINSKI succeeded in forming stragglers into the
 following improvised units:

 3    provisional companies of the _Libau_   Regiment.
 2         „          „      „  „  _Susdal_      „
 2¹⁄₂      „          „      „  „  _Vladimir_    „
 1    detachment of 100 men of the _Reval_ Regiment.

 “These re-formed stragglers were despatched to Skobeleff’s assistance
 and made a successful assault on Work No. 2 from Work No. 1.”[203]

   [203] _Ibid._, I, p. 243.

 “These stragglers subsequently formed the nucleus of the garrison of
 Work No. 2. During the night of the 11/12 September, the Russians
 succeeded in gathering 1000 more men, which were assembled in
 companies irrespective of the regiments to which they originally
 belonged. This gathering of stragglers lasted, by the way, up to the
 afternoon of the 12th of September. The continuance of the fight was
 made possible only by constantly re-forming the remnants into new
 organizations and then sending these forward into the fight.”[204]

   [204] _Ibid._, I, p. 258.

The remedies provided by the regulations against these evils are,
above all else: Restriction of the front of the several units, the
deployment of tactical units side by side in action (instead of in rear
of each other) and the use of every opportunity for re-establishing
the original organizations. Other suggestions for stemming the tide
of disorder as made by the author of _Summer Nights Dream_ (1888)
(platoons formed in single rank, volley firing, and constant closing
toward the center) are impracticable in a serious action. The
disintegrating effect of a battle is stronger than tactical cohesion.
It is better to recognize this fact than to face the enemy with
illusory ideas.

It is necessary to train the men in peace time to follow willingly any
officer, whether he belong to their own or to another organization;
and, for that reason, exercises in provisional organizations are
requisite for tactical training--a large number of officers being told
to fall out at these exercises to assimilate losses which would occur
in action. The control of mixed firing lines by word of command of
an officer is the foundation of order and troop leading, and thus a
prerequisite of success in the battles of the future. In a successful
engagement, the evils above mentioned are less evident than during a
reverse when troops unexpectedly suffer heavy losses or receive fire
from the flank or rear. Troops formed into well-organized units can
well stand such a test, but in an improvised organization, composed
of fractions and men of different units, especially when their own
officers are absent, such a crisis may lead to panic.

 The following battle episode is very instructive: The 1st Battalion,
 4th Infantry, deployed in line of company columns, advanced at
 =Colombey= (14th August, 1870) under French shell and _Chassepot_
 fire. The morale of the 3rd Company was visibly impaired by two
 shells which burst, one after the other, in its ranks, placing 15-20
 men out of action. “The men began to hesitate; their steps grew
 shorter; and, as if impelled by an invisible power, the company
 executed a half right turn, another half right turn, then another
 and another. One would have thought the movement was being executed
 at command. The column was now facing to the rear, and although
 not running, not fleeing, it was moving back to the Brasserie with
 suspiciously lengthening steps. The drummer, one Borchert, did
 everything to bring the men to their senses; the non-commissioned
 officers assisted bravely, but in vain; the column continued its
 movement to the rear. Filled with shame and indignation, the
 perspiration pouring out of every pore, I shouted to the men,
 repeatedly commanding: ‘Company ... Forward!’ But all in vain. At
 that moment the battalion commander--he was called the ‘marble
 statue’ on account of his coolness--galloped up on his bay, shouting:
 ‘Look at the 5th Company over yonder; see how far it has advanced.’
 Then another superior officer jumped in front of the men with the
 words: ‘Is there no officer here at all?’ At this instant I yelled
 again as if my life depended upon it: ‘You men belong to the color
 company; Company ... Forward!’ and the spell was broken. As if on
 the parade ground the Grenadiers faced to the front; obediently they
 executed my command: ‘To the attack! Carry arms ... Forward!’ and
 soon thereafter we again occupied our position between the 2nd and
 4th Companies.”

 The company lost many men as soon as it entered the fight, among them
 its company commander; then the two shells burst in rapid succession
 within its ranks, and this explains the temporary panic. The company
 lost a total of 86 men (including officers).[205]

   [205] RETZLAFF, _Aus meinem Tagebuch_.

Nothing is more contagious in the zone of danger than the example
of fear or cowardice.[206] Appeals, threats, and intimidation are
of little avail. The most effective remedy lies in developing the
individual soldier’s initiative, in training him to act with common
sense even when his officers are absent. We should send our soldiers
into battle with a reserve of moral courage great enough to prevent the
premature moral and mental depreciation of the individual.

   [206] Some interesting proofs in support of this statement are:

   The attack made by Captain Bechtoldsheim at Custozza against
 Italian infantry. _Oesterreichs Kämpfe_, II, p. 74.

   The combats at the Mance ravine on Aug. 18th, 1870.

   HÖNIG, _Vierundzwanzig Stunden Moltkescher Strategie_, pp. 170,
 184, 193 and 215.

   _Sedan_, _Gen. St. W._, II, p. 1243.

   _Wald- und Ortsgefecht_, p. 179. (Aymard’s Division after the
 capture of Servigny).

   LEHAUCOURT, _Campagne de la Loire_, II, p. 272. (The French Gardes
 Mobiles after the taking of Le Tuilerie at Le Mans).




V. DEPLOYMENTS FOR ACTION.


1. NORMAL PROCEDURE.

The characteristic tendency of modern times is the liberation of the
individual from antiquated ideas and from the restraint exercised
by ostensibly reactionary governmental power. The key-note of this
tendency, which places individualism above collectivism, is absolute
independence of the individual in municipal and national affairs, in
science and art. Even tactics has been influenced to a certain extent
by this tendency. Success in battle, however, will not be assured by
the sum-total of a number of negative or positive individual efforts,
but only by the simultaneous launching of masses controlled by a
single will. Within these limits the independence of the individual is
permissible, for a commander does not exact apathetic obedience, but,
on the contrary, intelligent coöperation on the part of everyone, and
this cannot be regulated by hard and fast rules.

Instead of laying down rules to cover all cases, the German Drill
Regulations leave the leader free to dispose of his troops according to
the purpose of the combat and the nature of the ground. In this he is
assisted by the initiative and independent action of his subordinate
leaders. Normal formations for attack and defense are requisite
however, in armies in which the tactical training of commanders and
subordinate leaders is deficient and where it is feared that the latter
will abuse the latitude allowed them. Where such normal formations
are prescribed, it is assumed that hard and fast rules are requisite
for training; that the average officer cannot be expected to estimate
a situation correctly and arrive at proper decisions; and that the
majority of them must be given definite rules for combat if they are
to render any service at all.

Drill regulations should facilitate quick mutual understanding between
leader and organization and lay down general principles for ordinary
situations, for combat tasks, and for formations, but should not, by
their rules, direct the actions of a leader from the very beginning
into definite grooves. If the regulations contain a normal procedure,
there is danger that it will be employed where inappropriate, and that
the mental alertness of the leaders will relax and fail in war at the
very moment when its presence is most vitally necessary.[207]

   [207] “Leaders who have been trained only in the mechanical part of
 drill and who subsequently have to act independently, fare like the
 lame man deprived of his crutches, or the near-sighted man deprived
 of his spectacles.” VON SEIDLITZ.

“Tactics will always vary according to the nature of the ground,
therefore it is impossible to tell beforehand what might happen in each
particular case.” (FREDERICK THE GREAT). Whether or not a particular
normal procedure is appropriate does not depend upon the terrain but
solely upon the tactical situation.[208]

   [208] It is only in cases where precisely identical situations
 may be presumed to exist that there can be any question of a normal
 procedure. The last stages of the infantry attack in fortress
 warfare present features of this nature and on that account a normal
 procedure has been formulated for it in almost all of the European
 armies.

While there is considerable unanimity of opinion as to the general
manner of carrying out an attack, opinions differ radically as to
details. “If all the advocates of a normal attack had to describe
it in words, there would be about as many suggestions as there are
advocates. Which of the many normal attack schemes is the most
suitable for average troops? A conference called for the purpose of
investigating this point would probably have the strange result that
each representative would concede that what the others desire is
practicable but need not be done.”[209] Anyone who thinks himself
capable of evolving a normal procedure, should bear in mind that
all such systems have invariably failed to fulfill the expectations
entertained for them because of obstacles which could not have been
foreseen during their preparation. Regulations that prescribe too many
details are very apt to lead to stereotyped forms and to that which
cannot stand the test of actual war. So far every war has had surprises
in store for the troops and this will be equally true in the future.
Troops will be able to find a way out of such situations only if they
have been taught to follow the spirit rather than the letter of their
regulations, if they have been individually trained and accustomed to
strict discipline, and if their leaders have been taught to reflect on
tactics. It is better to send troops into battle with the order, “Help
yourselves as best you can,” than to encumber them with combat rules of
doubtful value which leave them in the lurch at the first opportunity,
because the troops have not been taught to depend upon their own
initiative. The consequent indecision is increased in the same
proportion as the faith the troops and their leaders had in the lauded
universal remedy, the normal procedure. In spite of the excellence of
our regulations, we should accustom ourselves to the idea that a future
war may correct their provisions.[210]

   [209] General BRONSART V. SCHELLENDORFF, _I, Betrachtungen_, etc.
 p. 42

   _British Drill Regulations_: “Although a normal attack is
 apparently capable of being changed to suit the various situations,
 the continual practice of it leads to a stereotyped formation, to
 lack of skill and mobility. The disadvantages coupled with a normal
 attack are not apparent in time of peace, but in war they will make
 themselves felt through losses and failures.”

   [210] Major VON HÜLSEN, _Schema oder Selbständigkeit?_, (Berlin,
 1906).

The enunciation of certain technical combat principles as a guide in
the training of the troops is, however, far removed from laying down
a stereotyped form for attack (normal attack). Every thinking officer
will anyhow, consciously or unconsciously, formulate in his own mind
some sort of a “normal attack”, which is nothing but a firm opinion
of how he thinks an attack ought to be carried out. If such combat
regulations are called “drill attack” (_Schulangriff_), many of the
objections advanced against the normal attack are eliminated. Such
definite provisions facilitate in a great measure the intercourse
between leader and troops.

 “Instructions as to what to do in battle,” says Clausewitz (_On
 War_, II), “must not be taken for more than they are; they should
 not be regarded as hard and fast rules or systems, but merely as
 good general forms which individual judgment can utilize as is most
 suitable.... By means of a uniform method, commanders attain skill,
 precision, and confidence, the possession of which qualities on their
 part will make the whole machine run easier....

 “The drawback is that the habit of acting in a certain groove tends
 to become fixed and thus antiquated while the attendant circumstances
 imperceptibly change, and this should be prevented by enlightened and
 thorough criticism. When, in the year 1806, the Prussian generals
 (Prince Louis at =Saalfeld=; Tauenzien on the =Dornberg= at =Jena=;
 Grawert in front of and Rüchel in rear of =Kapellendorf=) without
 exception came to grief by employing Frederick the Great’s system
 of tactics, it was due not merely to the fact that they had gotten
 into a certain groove of acting which was out of date, but to the
 most dire poverty of resource to which a fixed system of tactics has
 ever led. Owing to this incapacity of thinking for themselves, they
 involved Hohenlohe’s army in such ruin as has never before or since
 overtaken any army on the battlefield.”

 General von Boguslawski[211] demands that the conduct of the attack
 be regulated by precise instructions both on the drill-ground and in
 action. He states: “The many different methods of dealing with even
 the simplest cases, unquestionably evident in the army at the present
 time, are an evil calculated not only to train but also to confuse
 the soldier and the subordinate leader. Precise regulations are by
 no means incompatible with adaptation to the varying features of the
 terrain in a given case, and will infuse unity and certainty into
 offensive movements. A normal formation must be prescribed, but it
 should be flexible.”

   [211] _Taktische Darlegungen_, p. 51.

 Elsewhere he makes the following statement in regard to a normal
 attack: “I believe that the normal attack should be regarded as the
 basis of troop training--a solid foundation for further development.
 In carrying out the spirit of this procedure, further work should be
 done on varied ground. This spirit aims at the unity of the attack.
 The formations taught on the drill-ground should be retained as
 long as possible. The training of officers and men must be such,
 however, that they will deviate, whenever necessary, from these
 normal formations. But if the formations, as well as the training
 and drill, are truly practical and adapted for war, departures from
 the scheme laid down in the regulations will be insignificant. This,
 briefly, is my idea of the normal attack or uniform procedure, which
 not only does not have a detrimental effect, but, on the contrary, is
 absolutely necessary in order to facilitate the work of the higher
 leader.”

 General von Scherff states:[212]

 “It would contribute to clearness and to proper division of
 responsibility if the regulations would definitely prescribe:--

 “1. That only the superior commander who makes dispositions for
 battle according to his own judgment, be charged with assigning
 appropriate missions;

 “2. That the subordinate leader, charged with the execution of
 a mission, determine, by an independent choice of any expedient
 provided by the regulations, the formation in which his organization
 is to carry out the task assigned; and, finally,

 “3. That the subsequent conduct of such an organization be governed
 by a definite normal procedure, familiar to the men from the
 drill-ground, so as to ensure mutual coöperation of its component
 parts.”

   [212] _Einheitsangriff oder individualisierter Angriff_, Berlin,
 1902.


2. CONCENTRATION, DEVELOPMENT, AND DEPLOYMENT FOR ACTION.[213]

   [213] _Aufmarsch_, _Entfaltung_, _Entwicklung_.

Column tactics, which influenced us even after the Franco-German
war, required that troops be concentrated, prior to an action, from
the narrow route column into a broad combat formation. This tedious
systematic =concentration=[214] was invariably employed before
entering an action, except when, in critical situations, companies
and battalions had to be launched into the fight directly from route
column. The commander of a force could reduce the time required for
going into action only by approaching the field of battle in assembly
formation.[215]

   [214] “By _concentration_ is meant the passage from route column to
 a broader close order formation. It is employed for the purpose of
 decreasing the depth of a column and for assembly.” (Par. 315 German
 I. D. R.)

   [215] Examples: The approach of the IInd Army to the battlefield of
 Gravelotte, see _Taktik_, III, p. 305.

   The advance of the 1st Army from its cantonments toward the
 Bistrits to the battlefield of Königgrätz was a mistake. The
 army first approached in route columns, then concentrated, again
 formed route columns, and finally concentrated for action. V.
 LETTOW-VORBECK, II, pp. 407 and 480. From what I know of the terrain
 the advance should in this case have been made in assembly formations.

Valuable time was thus lost. Even when the situation was not pressing,
the leader was obliged, for example, to allow a regiment having a depth
of 1200 m. to close up to a depth of 100 paces. When this had been
done, he was forced to wait until thin skirmish lines gained a proper
distance to the front. The rear elements were able to follow only
when the skirmishers had gained a distance approximately equal to the
former depth of the entire column. Such a concentration is only proper
however, when the commander wishes to launch his troops subsequently in
several directions. Advantage should be taken of every opportunity for
decreasing the depth of the column (by forming column of sections).

The advance of large bodies of troops presents no difficulties even in
close country, if, as recommended by the author,[216] the battalions in
route column are placed abreast of each other and are permitted to go
around obstacles and take advantage of the cover available. However,
even at long ranges, troops in such formations present favorable
targets to hostile machine guns and artillery.

   [216] See _Taktik_, III, p. 307.

 The British were surprised in close order formations at
 =Magersfontain= and =Colenso=. In subsequent engagements, in order
 to avoid this, their infantry, when still a great distance away from
 the enemy, took up an attack formation which permitted only movements
 directly to the front (at =Poplar Grove,= for example, this was
 done when 10 km. from the enemy). An advance in such a formation
 was possible only because the plains of South Africa presented no
 obstacles, and because the British had only to hold the enemy who
 stood passively on the defensive. Each brigade formed its four
 battalions into an open double column with a front of 2000 and a
 depth of 800 m., the distances and intervals between battalions being
 300-400 m. Each battalion deployed from this column so that its eight
 companies, each in a thin line (with 2 and finally 20 pace intervals
 between the men), followed each other at a distance of 100-120 paces.
 The advantage of having troops in hand so that they can be used in
 other directions than straight to the front, had disappeared.

[Illustration: =The Formation of a Brigade of Four Battalions of the
6th Infantry Division=

during the advance on =Poplar Grove= on March 7th, 1900. Front about
800 m., depth, 1800-2000 m.]

When an engagement is expected, the different elements, each in route
column, are directed upon their several objectives, i.e., the column
is _developed for action_. This is done because it is necessary to
gain a start over the enemy in deployment and advantageous to move
in route column. Thus a =development for action= (_Entfaltung_)[217]
is nothing but an extension of front accomplished by breaking up the
original route column into a number of separate columns. The latter
march on diverging lines and can generally remain in route column.
Deep column should not be formed unless an immediate extension is not
anticipated. During the development for action, preparations should be
made providing for the necessary depth of the combat formation.

   [217] The German I. D. R. make a distinction between extension of
 front, “development for action” (_Entfaltung_, pars. 315 and 466),
 and “distribution in depth” (_Gliedern_, pars. 287-291 and 427). The
 term “to form for attack” (_Auseinanderziehen_, par. 241), means that
 troops are given a combat formation both as regards frontage and
 depth.

When the necessity for engaging can be foreseen, the concentration into
an assembly formation should be avoided, since it generally entails a
loss of time and energy, and the development for action chosen instead.
(Par. 315 German I. D. R.). The latter has the additional advantage
of affording a higher degree of readiness for action without letting
the troops get out of hand. It should be practiced not only from route
column but also from assembly formation.[218]

   [218] See the defeat of the Russian Reserve Brigade under Orlov
 on September 2nd, 1904, at Liao Yang, in _Angriffsverfahren der
 Japaner_, by von Lüttwitz.

The development for action should begin as soon as there is danger of
getting under effective artillery fire. The length of time required for
going into action may be reduced by shortening the route column (by
concentrating the troops into deep column); by forming several route
columns abreast, unless column of sections has already been formed; by
clearing the roads of troops; by marching across country; by indicating
beforehand on which side of the infantry the artillery is to be
brought up (pars. 315-323 German I. D. R.); and, finally, by directing
the heads of the various elements upon their respective objectives.
(Development for action).

 In the Austrian regulations, the development for action is not
 so clearly emphasized: “A concentration preceding the attack in
 rencontres is permissible in only those exceptional cases when it
 becomes apparent, during the preparatory stage of the action, that
 the enemy has a visible start in deployment.” When time is not
 pressing, the regulations prescribe a concentration for action and,
 simultaneously therewith, such a grouping of the principal units (if
 possible out of range of the effective fire of hostile guns, and
 well concealed) that the attacking troops need move only straight to
 the front. A more extended formation is taken up when the zone of
 hostile artillery fire is reached. The march to the battlefield is
 discussed in detail by the French regulations: In the first place,
 in order to take advantage of cover and to keep the roads clear for
 artillery, it will be necessary to leave the road and to advance
 across country. This will, as a rule, result in widening the front
 of the advancing force, even though this be only to the extent of
 placing columns abreast of each other. Hourly halts are to be made,
 so as to give an opportunity for replenishing ammunition and time for
 reconnaissance. Small columns are preferred in woods and in close
 country and larger columns on passable ground. Attention is specially
 called to the danger to which troops are exposed when surprised in
 defiles by hostile fire. This march to the battlefield is followed by
 a concentration of the troops in concealed and protected positions.

The =deployment for action= (_Entwicklung_) consists of forming the
troops for battle and includes the extension into line of skirmishers.
As a rule, the deployment follows the development for action, but may
be made directly from route column or from an assembly formation.

It is impossible to define clearly where the development for action
ceases and where the deployment begins. The formation of a line of
skirmishers to cover a route column does not constitute a deployment.
There is no room for doubt that the regulations have in mind the
rencontre, in which the passage from route column to skirmish line
proceeds naturally and smoothly. In attacking an enemy prepared to
defend a position, the procedure is much more cautious. In this case
the force which has been developed for action is withdrawn as much
as possible from the view and the fire of the enemy (par. 367 German
I. D. R.), and led forward from cover to cover. (Par. 369 German I.
D. R.). Even in situations in which haste is required, it is a good
plan to follow the procedure laid down by the regulations, viz: “First
direct the troops upon the proper objective, then give them a suitable
formation.”

 An analysis of the question as to whether an immediate launching
 of troops into action is necessary (5th Infantry Division at
 =Vionville=) or whether they should first be regularly concentrated
 (6th Infantry Division at =Vionville=) is of special interest. The
 concentration of the 1st Prussian Army Corps at =Waterloo=, and
 of the 5th Bavarian Infantry Brigade at =Nehweiler= (=Wörth=),
 almost in rear of the French, is justly criticised. At =Nachod=,
 the Austrian brigades, owing to their time-consuming concentration,
 lost an opportunity of throwing the weak Prussian advanced troops
 from the heights south of Wysokow, while the latter were reinforced
 by parts of the main body which arrived by half-battalions. This
 reinforcement, while made in driblets, was, however, sufficient.

 During its march to the battlefield of =Gravelotte=, the 3rd Infantry
 Division concentrated at Buxieres for the purpose of cooking. Then
 it formed again in route column, concentrated once more south of
 Rezonville, and from there moved on in echelon formation. The
 concentration of the 28th Infantry Brigade on August 6th, 1870
 (=Spicheren=), was still less justifiable. About noon, when the head
 of the brigade reached the exit of the Kollertal Wood at Raschpfuhl,
 it received orders to cross the Saar. Upon receiving this order, the
 five battalions present concentrated, unfurled their flags and then
 marched across country to the railroad bridge of Mattstall. In order
 to effect a crossing, route column had to be formed again. The delays
 which occurred here led the parts of the force which had crossed
 first, to throw themselves into the fight.[219]

   [219] _Geschichte des Regiments Nr. 77_, p. 51.


3. THE BATTALION, THE REGIMENT, AND THE BRIGADE.

When part of a larger force, the battalion may be broken up into
companies either by directing the latter upon their respective
objectives, or by forming for attack by command.

When forming for attack by command, the front, the base company,
intervals, distances, and the relation of the companies to each other
must be indicated. The intervals should be sufficiently large to permit
the companies to move unhampered, and so maintained that irregularities
of marching will not be communicated from one to the other.

A space approximately equal to the front of a platoon will suffice
for this purpose. Thus the interval between companies at war strength
would be 150 paces, and between companies at peace strength 100 paces.
Intervals may be increased or diminished when necessary so as to enable
the troops to take the fullest advantage of cover. The same holds true
for distances. For rules in regard to the distance between the second
and first line, see p. 121, supra. When a battalion has formed line
of companies at long range from the enemy for the purpose of reducing
the effect of the hostile fire, distances should be diminished to
facilitate the transmission of orders.

When the battalion is acting alone, the intervals depend upon the
purpose of the combat. In the fights around Mukden, some of the
Japanese battalions, stationed at points where the decision was not
sought, were each assigned a front of 800 m. In these cases the four
companies of each battalion had to be deployed abreast of each other at
large intervals.

[Illustration]

It is impossible to prescribe fixed forms of deployment for particular
situations. In each case the formation of the battalion depends upon
the situation, the purpose of the combat, and the nature of the ground,
the battalion commander having the option of going into action in one,
two, or three lines.

Moreover, the formation depends upon whether--

1. The battalion is acting alone or as part of a larger force; and
whether one or both of its flanks are resting on impassable obstacles;

2. Whether it is fighting a decisive or a containing action; whether it
is to attack or to stand on the defensive;

3. Whether it is to prepare the attack by its own fire or is to take
advantage of the preparation effected by other troops; and, finally,

4. Whether or not it has to fight at night.

=A battalion acting alone=, whose flanks are not resting on natural
obstacles, will, as a rule, place entire companies successively into
action so as to retain complete organizations for other purposes. It
will seldom be proper for the battalion to form for attack in the
regular manner. When this can be done the battalion should form in
three lines in conformity with its task of initiating, carrying out,
and deciding the fight. In this case the leading company is reinforced
by the second company as soon as the situation has become sufficiently
clear. More frequently, the battalion commander will send only a single
company into action, retaining the others for the time being under
cover.

[Illustration]

The =advance guard battalion= of a regiment will, as a rule, be
compelled to develop considerable fire in a _rencontre_ (par. 357
German I. D. R.), in order to check the advance of the enemy,
and for this purpose it will frequently place two companies into
action at once. But since the battalion commander cannot count upon
reinforcements and, moreover, as he does not know on which flank the
combat is subsequently going to develop, he will provisionally retain
the other two companies in rear of the center, or echelon them in rear
of both flanks. (See “a” and “b” above figure).

[Illustration]

In a =containing action= one should endeavor to employ few rifles
but, on the other hand, expend much ammunition, and keep supports and
reserves far in rear so as to minimize the losses. If the force is to
deploy first of all only for fire action, but is later to participate
in the decisive attack, it will be advisable to place two companies in
the first line, one in the second, and one in the third. The companies
in the second and third lines will then be less exposed to hostile
fire, and the battalion commander will be able, by first launching one
and then the other company, to exercise an influence on the course of
the action during a longer period than would otherwise be possible.
(See “b”).

[Illustration]

=When a battalion is fighting as part of a larger force=, and when
both its flanks are secure, it will need only supports for feeding
the frontal attack (par. 289 German I. D. R.) and can cover a greater
front. A reserve may either be entirely dispensed with, or made very
weak.

When only one flank of the battalion is secure, the threatened flank
should be protected by echeloning the supports and the reserve in
rear of it. In this position, these echelons are not so apt to be
bullet-stops as when they are placed in rear of the center. Besides,
they can more easily execute enveloping movements and can take a
hostile flank attack in flank. When both flanks are in the air, only
the most essential precautions should be taken on the one flank, while
on the other everything available is united for the decisive attack.

In =defense=, three companies can sometimes be taken into the first
line for the purpose of developing a strong fire, while the fourth
company is held in rear of a threatened flank or in rear of the center.
(See “d”). When it is desired to employ the reserve offensively, only
one or two companies are placed in the first line, the others being
held in reserve in rear of the flank which is to take the offensive.
Interval and distance increase with the size of this reserve.

[Illustration]

When a battalion from the reserve is called upon to make an immediate
attack which has been prepared by the fire of other troops, all its
companies may be taken at once into the first line. In this case
the battalion may be formed for attack with its companies at close
intervals. This might also be a suitable combat formation for night
operations. All these formations are subject to change however, as soon
as the proper utilization of cover makes it necessary.

The general principles stated for a battalion are also applicable to a
=regiment=. The regiment may either be directly formed for attack, or
the heads of the battalions may be deflected toward the points where
the deployment is to take place. An interval of 300-400 m. between
heads of battalions is best calculated to facilitate the subsequent
deployment. The distances depend upon the nature of the ground and the
purpose of the combat.

The regimental commander assigns tasks to his battalion commanders, but
leaves the latter entire freedom of action in regard to the formation
to be taken up and the manner of deploying. He should interfere with
companies only in exceptional cases. Such interference is justified
only when the conduct of subordinate leaders threatens to impair unity
of action in the combat and when time is lacking to observe the proper
channels in communicating an order.

[Illustration: Methods of Forming a Battalion for Attack.]

[Illustration]

In developing the =brigade=[220] for action, the depth of column
begins to exert an influence. Every concentration of the brigade
retards its entry into action. If the longest distance to be covered
in developing the brigade is assigned to the leading element of the
column, the march into action will be accelerated.

   [220] For historical references in regard to the importance in
 action of the brigade, see essay published in _Jahrbücher für
 Armee und Marine_ (August-September number of 1877) entitled, _Die
 Infanterie-Brigade in ihrer Entwicklung aus der Brigade von 1812_. In
 regard to the employment of the regiments in line or in echelon, see
 MOLTKE, _Kritische Aufsätze sur Geschichte des Feldzuges von 1866_.
 MOLTKE’S _Taktisch-Strategische Aufsätze_, p. 99, et seq.

[Illustration]

When an infantry brigade approaching the battlefield is to prolong the
flank of the fighting line, its entry into action might be hastened,
perhaps, by letting the rear regiment continue the march in the
original direction while the leading regiment takes the longer route.
The rear regiment would then be abreast of the leading one after about
15 minutes. If the battalions are subsequently developed on radiating
lines, the development of the whole force will, after a few minutes,
have progressed far enough to permit a deployment of skirmishers.

When the brigade takes up a combat formation, each regiment is assigned
a separate task (attack of a point, or defense of a section). If the
tasks assigned are definite and harmonize with each other, mutual
coöperation will be assured. The brigade commander ordinarily sends his
orders to the regimental commanders, but, when circumstances (haste,
correction of errors) compel him to depart from this rule, he should
inform those officers of the action taken. In a brigade consisting of
two regiments, its commander, in order to be able to influence the
action, will be compelled to retain at least one battalion as a reserve.

Brigades of three regiments[221] (each of three battalions) have an
advantage in this respect. But if such an increase in infantry units
were contemplated, it would be better, for reasons that will be given
later on,[222] to form the additional troops into a third division in
each army corps.

   [221] The British division consists of twelve battalions formed
 into three brigades.

   In the United States the three unit organization is most clearly
 marked. The division consists of three brigades, each brigade
 of three regiments, and each regiment of three battalions. The
 battalions have a strength of only 400 men.

   [222] _Taktik_ (_Kriegsgliederung_), III, p. 31, et seq.


Base Units.

The possibility of regulating the movements of a body of troops by
means of a base unit, depends upon a number of preliminary conditions
which will seldom be fulfilled in war:

1. _The leader of the base unit would have to remain unharmed to the
very last._ If he were disabled the command of the unit would devolve
upon the next in rank who would perhaps not join it in every case.

2. _The fresh organisation which imparts the impetus necessary for
a further advance, would have to maintain the direction after the
original base unit had ceased to exist on account of the mixing of
organizations._

3. _The base unit would have to encounter less difficulties during
its advance than the other units of the force._ If the base unit were
to encounter greater difficulties than the other units, this might
serve as an excuse for reducing the rate of advance. In attack, the
organization nearest the enemy, in other words, the one that is led
better and more energetically than the others, is quite naturally
charged with maintaining the direction. Moreover, this organization
will be able to facilitate by its fire the advance of the elements in
rear.

The designation of a base unit[223] or unit of direction on the
battlefield cripples the energy of an entire line and the initiative of
the individual in favor of uniformity of movement. A base unit is only
profitable in night operations, in crossing unfavorable ground (woods),
and in bringing the fighting line up to the effective zone of hostile
fire. “With the entry into action, the importance of the base company
gradually decreases as the demands made by the combat increase”. (Par.
242 German I. D. R.). In all other cases, it is better to indicate
either the objective on which the troops are to march, or the flank
toward which they are to maintain connection.

   [223] “A unit may also be designated upon which the others have
 to regulate their movements without thereby being curbed in their
 endeavor to advance (base unit of combat).” (Par. 371 German I. D. R.)

   In France units of direction are prescribed (_la direction est
 confidée aux unités qui suivent les chemins ou les lignes naturelles
 du terrain_), but their duties are not given in detail. Units of
 direction are also prescribed in Austria.

A _change of direction_ of march is executed by wheeling or turning
with the subordinate units toward the new front. (Par. 185 German
I. D. R.). A _change of front_ is effected in the same manner. With
long lines, echeloning and movements by the flank will result, which
can only be rectified gradually by issuing appropriate orders. When
skirmishers have been deployed in a wrong direction, or when a
deployment in another direction becomes necessary after the conclusion
of a combat, it is advisable to deploy a new line in the desired
direction, from the closed bodies still available, and to withdraw, at
the same time, those parts of the former skirmish line which are no
longer necessary.


Examples of Changes of Front.

 1. Engagement at =Helmstedt=, on July 25th, 1866. The 20th Infantry
 had to deploy to its left rear after its successful attack on the
 Ütting Hill.[224]

   [224] _Geschichte des Regiments Nr. 20_, p. 54.

 2. The battalions of the XIth Army Corps wheeling toward the
 =Niederwald= after crossing the Sauer (battle of =Wörth=).[225]

   [225] _Gen. St. W._, I, p. 254, sketch p. 262.

 3. The wheel executed by Kottwitz’ Brigade during the battle of
 =Loigny-Poupry= (2nd Dec., 1870). (This is also cited as an example
 of the conduct of a counter-attack made by the defender). Toward noon
 the advance guard of the 17th Infantry Division held =Lumeau=. The
 33rd Brigade, its battalions in double column, was concentrated south
 of =Champdoux=. The division commander retained two battalions as a
 reserve and ordered Major-General von Kottwitz “to execute a quarter
 wheel to the right and to form his command for attack in the general
 direction of Loigny,” for the purpose of relieving the pressure on
 the Bavarians defending =Schlosz Goury=. The attack was directed
 against the French Division Jauréguiberry, which was attacking
 Schlosz Goury. This division first came under fire at 3-400 m. and
 then approached to within about 150 m. of the defenders’ position;
 strong reserves followed in rear of its right flank, but otherwise
 nothing was done to protect the right.

 By wheeling at once to the right, the right wing of Kottwitz’ Brigade
 would still have struck the eastern garden wall of Schlosz Goury,
 and, as Loigny had been indicated to the general as the objective, a
 fan-shaped extension of the brigade, precluding mutual coöperation,
 would have been unavoidable. The general had fourteen companies
 at his disposal and decided to advance in a southerly direction
 until his second line overlapped the most advanced hostile line, so
 that the attack as planned would have struck simultaneously both
 the first and second lines of the enemy. The slight loss of time
 involved caused the general no uneasiness, as he could carry out
 his intentions without interference beyond range of the fire of the
 enemy, whom he could observe during the entire movement. The brigade
 formed for attack, during its movement to the south, when about 1200
 m. from Goury. The general, who was on the right flank, halted the
 brigade after it had advanced far enough, and wheeled it to the right.

[Illustration]

 As the second line overlapped the first, the Füsilier Battalion of
 the 76th Infantry had to shorten its step until the 2nd and 3rd
 Companies of the same regiment had come abreast and until the 6th
 and 8th Companies of the 75th Infantry had also joined the line. The
 center half-battalion, (2nd and 3rd Companies of the 76th Infantry),
 the unit of direction, was ordered to march on the church spire of
 Loigny. All the units of the force, with the exception of the IInd
 Battalion, 76th Infantry, at once deployed lines of skirmishers. The
 1st and 4th Companies, 76th Infantry, and 5th Company, 75th Infantry,
 covered the left flank and turned toward Ecuillon. Of the eleven
 companies launched in this flank attack, six were in the first line
 (approximately 1100 rifles on a front of 800 m.), and five in the
 second.

 The bulk of the second line, in an endeavor to close with the enemy
 quickly, joined the firing line when 400 m. from the enemy. The
 attack came as a complete surprise to the French; their lines were
 taken in flank, and all their attempts to form new defensive lines to
 oppose the onslaught of the Hansards proved unavailing. The dense,
 unwieldy masses of the French were more and more crowded together by
 the uninterrupted advance of the Hansards and offered good objectives
 to the German marksmen. The advance of the brigade was supported by
 the artillery in position near Lumeau. This artillery followed the
 brigade to Ecuillon.

 The Hansards traversed a distance of 3500 m. during this attack. The
 right wing and the bulk of the 2nd and 3rd Companies, 76th Infantry,
 which had been detailed as the unit of direction, with orders to
 march on the church spire of Loigny, strayed to Fougon; the left wing
 penetrated into Loigny.[226]

   [226] See HÖNIG, _Volkskrieg_, IV, p. 80; also KUNZ, _Loigny_, p.
 105.

 4. The advance of six battalions of the IIIrd Army Corps against the
 =Forbach Hill= (=Spicheren=).[227]

   [227] _Gen. St. W._, I. p. 356.


4. DISTRIBUTION IN DEPTH AND FRONTAGE OF COMBAT FORMATIONS.[228]

   [228] See _Taktik_, V, _Gefechtslehre_, p. 38.

The infantry combat is decided by the combined action of long firing
lines. Retained forces, not launched against the enemy for the purpose
of crushing him, exert no influence whatever on the decision, since
they only increase losses without contributing to the fire effect. In
the battles of the past, distribution in depth at the decisive stage of
the combat (unless necessary as a measure of precaution, in securing
the flanks, for example), was only permissible so long as the short
range of the weapons allowed reserves to be kept in readiness so close
to the firing line that they could assault _en masse_ at once and
without any diminution of their strength. The deciding factor, which
rested in retained reserves during the Napoleonic era, lies at present
in the firing line.[229]

   [229] The French still entertain a contrary opinion.

=Distribution in depth= _is, therefore, only a means to an end; an
expedient made use of to maintain a dense firing line permanently at a
constant strength; to give the firing line the impetus for the assault;
to protect it against a reverse; and to secure its flanks. Victory
is assured only by the simultaneous employment of superior fighting
forces. A force should go into action in a deep combat formation, but
it must extend its front during the fight._ To launch an insufficient
number of troops for combat and to reinforce them gradually is a
fatal error, as we are thereby compelled to fight a superior force
continually with an inferior one, without being able to take advantage
of the superiority which we may actually possess.

 The Russian attacks in the battles around =Plevna= are very
 instructive in this respect. On July 30th, 1877, the =Grivica=
 intrenchments were attacked by two columns consisting of nine
 battalions. The Ist and IInd Battalions of the 121st Infantry
 succeeded in reaching the trench, but then the attack failed. The
 IIIrd Battalion then attacked, with a similar result Thereupon the
 IInd and IIIrd Battalions of the 123rd Infantry were launched, but
 these also only succeeded in reaching the edge of the ditch of the
 trench. The attack of the left column proceeded in a similar manner,
 likewise that made by the reserves. An attack made simultaneously by
 the entire force undoubtedly would have been successful.[230]

   [230] _Russisch-Türkischer Krieg_ (_Gen. St. W._), German
 Translation, III, pp. 254 and 264.

 On September 11th, 1877, after the attack made by the 63rd and 117th
 Infantry Regiments on the =Omar Bey Tabia= had been repulsed, the
 64th and 118th Infantry Regiments of the IVth Army Corps, and the
 31st Infantry Division of the IXth Army Corps (the last mentioned
 force was not under the orders of the commander of the IVth Army
 Corps) were placed in readiness for a renewed attack at 3 P. M. In
 spite of the heavy losses (42 and 49%) and the fact that the failure
 of the first attack had demonstrated that such a small force was
 insufficient for taking the Turkish work, only two regiments were
 again sent forward to the attack (in other words, 6 battalions
 instead of 18). When this assault had also been repulsed, and
 one regiment from the reserve had in addition been thrown in, 6
 battalions of the 15 still intact, were again sent forward, but they
 likewise failed to take the work. A regiment began its attack only
 when the preceding one had been repulsed with loss. The 24 battalions
 lost 115 officers and 4319 men. A timely reinforcement by troops in
 reserve would have averted a reverse at any rate, and a simultaneous
 employment of adequate forces would have assured the success of the
 Russian infantry.[231]

   [231] KUROPATKIN-KRAHMER, _Kritische Rückblicke auf den
 Russisch-Türkischen Krieg_, I, p. 211.

 The same thing occurred at =Gorni-Dubniac=. As the Russians, who
 advanced on a broad front, did not attack simultaneously, the weak
 garrison of the trenches was able to concentrate its fire on the
 isolated attacking groups which followed each other.

 The same peculiar feature, namely, small frontage with insufficient
 fire power and strong reserves, was frequently observed during the
 battles in the =Russo-Japanese war=. On the left flank, at =Wafangu=
 (15th June, 1904), the 1st East Siberian Rifle Division advanced
 with one battalion of the 2nd Regiment and one of the 3rd in the
 first line, with four battalions in the second line, and with three
 battalions of the 1st Regiment in the third line. A full development
 of the fire power of the division did not take place at all.[232] The
 2nd and 3rd Regiments, in all about 6000 men, lost 49 officers and
 1464 men. The 1¹⁄₂ batteries attached to the division were shot to
 pieces in a short time and fell into the hands of the Japanese.

   [232] LÖFFLER, _Russisch-Japanischer Krieg_, I, p. 56.

Distribution in depth is necessary during the preparatory stage of the
fight, as it enables the commander to meet unexpected developments in
the situation. Moreover, it is justifiable so long as the information
in regard to the strength and intentions of the enemy is insufficient.
When reconnaissance work is not thoroughly performed, the force may
be obliged to deploy in a direction other than the one originally
chosen. This will be difficult to do as changes of front and movements
by the flank can only be made when the front is narrow. Moreover,
after a force is once deployed within the zone of hostile fire, it is
committed to the direction chosen and can only move straight to the
front. Considerable changes of front can only be executed by the lines
in rear. The troops held in rear are to reinforce the firing line and
to increase its density to the maximum at the decisive moment. As the
losses are smaller in defense than in attack, a force can cover a
broader front and keep its supports in closer proximity to the firing
line in the former than in the latter case, especially if it was able
to strengthen its position. The reserve, however, should be kept at a
greater distance from the firing line than in attack, in order that it
may retain complete freedom of movement--in covering the retreat, or in
making a counter-attack--and may not be involved in the fire fight.

The reserves of the attacker are to protect the flanks, give the
impetus for the assault, serve as a force upon which the attacking line
can rally, and cover the re-forming of the troops after a successful
attack. The several echelons of the attack formation, except the small
fractions immediately supporting the firing line[233] and covering
its flanks, should have become merged with that line by the time the
decisive moment of the combat arrives. The commander who takes up an
unnecessarily deep attack formation dispenses with an advantage; on
the other hand, the one who prematurely deploys in force, exposes
himself to grave danger. _The troops should be sent into action in a
deep combat formation, since the firing line is to be fed from the rear
until the decisive moment arrives, but every available man should be
thrown in for the assault._

   [233] The advantage of having such supporting forces in rear of the
 line is clearly shown in the fights of the 18th Brigade at Wörth.
 KUNZ, _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, 14, pp. 110, 129 and 172.

=Distribution in depth and frontage= are interdependent; the greater
the frontage, the less the distribution in depth, and vice versa. In
every deployment for action the following question awaits solution
by the troop leader: “How deep ought the formation to be and how
great an extension of front is allowable.” The result of the combat
depends in many cases upon a happy answer to this question. Broad
combat formations have great initial energy, facilitate turning and
flank movements, but their energy is not constant when the means are
not available to replace casualties. In addition, the difficulty of
leading, the danger of the line being penetrated, and the weakness
of the flanks grow apace with the extension of front. Distribution
in depth makes it possible to initiate the combat with a part of the
force and to get information of the situation; to fight the action
with another part of the force in accordance with this information;
and, finally, to bring about the decision and reap the fruits of that
decision with the third part. A deep combat formation enables the
leader to exercise a constant influence on the course of action; it
gives him the means with which to execute turning movements or to
repulse them--something which would be entirely impossible, or, at any
rate, only possible under great difficulties, with troops deployed in
the first line. As only a limited number of rifles can be brought into
play in a deep combat formation, it is obvious that this is an element
of weakness of which an opponent deployed on a broader front, may take
advantage.

Although the danger of going too far in distributing a force in depth
is not inconsiderable, this is, at any rate, a smaller error than the
opposite extreme, that of deploying troops, from the very start, on too
broad a front.

 At noon on August 6th, 1870, General von François received an order
 for his brigade to dislodge the hostile artillery posted on the
 =Roten Berg= of the =Spicheren Heights=,[234] it being assumed that
 only insignificant hostile forces were in front. The other brigade
 of the 14th Division was expected to be able to take part in the
 action in about three hours. When the attacking force was 2000 m.
 from its objective, the IInd Battalion, 74th Infantry, and the IIIrd
 Battalion, 39th Infantry, were set in motion against the French right
 flank, while the Ist Battalion and the Füsilier Battalion of the 74th
 Infantry were retained as a reserve. The brigade accordingly covered
 a front of about 4000 m. While the frontal attack on the Roten Berg
 was undoubtedly difficult,[235] this wide extension, which made all
 leading impossible, increased the difficulties still further. In the
 first place, the brigade commander led his two reserve battalions
 against the Roten Berg and fell finally while leading a company. The
 brigade was too weak to carry out the task imposed upon it. The 28th
 Brigade, which followed, came into action at various points of the
 battlefield, so that the two brigades became mixed, thus considerably
 increasing the difficulties of leading. At 3 P. M., the following
 troops were in the first line on the right wing:[236]

  I. Bn.     II. Bn.     1. 2. and ¹⁄₂3. Cos.   4. and 1. Cos.
 --------  ------------  --------------------   --------------
 53. Inf.  ~=74. Inf.=~     ~=74. Inf.=~           77. Inf.

 10. 11. and 12. Cos.    ¹⁄₂3. Co.
 --------------------  ------------
     ~=39. Inf.=~      ~=74. Inf.=~

   [234] _Gen. St. W._, I, p. 310.

   [235] _Gen. St. W._, I, p. 318.

   [236] The units printed in heavy type belong to the 27th Brigade.
 The 4th Company of the 74th Infantry was separated by 2.5 km., as the
 crow flies, from the left flank of its battalion.

 The following troops were in the second line:

 Füsilier Bn.  2. and 3. Cos.[237]  II. Bn. and Füsilier Bn.
 ------------  -------------------  ------------------------
   53. Inf.         77. Inf.              77. Inf.

   [237] These two companies were separated by about 1 km. from the
 other companies of their battalion.

 This admixture of organizations along a front of about 1.5 km. might
 have been prevented by the commander. Toward 6 P. M., a similar
 situation existed on the Roten Berg and at the south end of the
 Giefert Wald--39²⁄₃ companies belonging to the 12th, 39th, 40th, 48th
 and 74th Infantry Regiments were scattered along a front of 1600
 m. It is true, the peculiar situation existing on the German side,
 operated against a simultaneous employment of the several bodies and
 a mixing of units was unavoidable, but it would undoubtedly have
 been possible to prevent such a complete dissolution of all units,
 by François’ Brigade taking up a more suitable formation before
 the action commenced. The mistake made here was repeated over and
 over again in the other preliminary combats of the campaign, and
 invariably led to the same result.[238]

   [238] Consult _Erste Gefechtsentwicklung des XI. Armeekorps bei
 Wörth_, KUNZ, _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, 13, p. 10, et seq.

 The failure of the attacks made by the British brigades at
 =Magersfontain= and =Paardeberg= may be traced to the lack of
 sufficient reinforcements. At Magersfontain, the four battalions
 of the Highland Brigade were deployed on a front of 3000 m. and at
 Paardeberg on a front of 4000 m.

In deciding how many men are required to occupy or attack a position,
the principal point to be considered is the effect of fire. The
modern long range magazine rifle will, no doubt, enable us to defend
a position with a smaller force than was possible in the past with
the older less improved weapons. However, combats last longer
nowadays, and the shock action of Frederick the Great’s tactics is
no longer practicable. The fight is carried on at longer ranges, and
the tremendously costly decisive moments of the past are of rarer
occurrence. As a consequence, the casualties of the whole force engaged
are smaller, although, owing to unfavorable conditions, certain
organizations may suffer losses quite as great as those incurred in
the battles of Frederick the Great and Napoleon.[239] Instead of the
sanguinary hand-to-hand fight with cold steel, we now have a prolonged
fire fight carried on by a firing line which requires to be constantly
fed by troops held in rear, who have to be sheltered as much as
possible from hostile fire until the moment of their employment. This
fire fight is frequently decided by psychological factors and without
the troops suffering material losses.

   [239] At Wörth, the 1st Turco Regiment lost the enormous total of
 93.1%, and twelve other French regiments suffered a loss of over 50%.
 To be sure, the losses sustained during the retreat are included
 in this total. At Albuera (16th May, 1811), the 57th Regiment
 (British) and the Füsilier Brigade lost 70%; in four hours the army
 of Beresford lost 25%, and of the British infantry, which originally
 numbered 7000 men, only 1800 remained.

“The duration of the combat under modern conditions,” writes General
Négrier,[240] “leads to a considerable mental exhaustion of the troops
which is apparent in nervous lassitude. This explains the impotency
of leader and troops the day after a defeat and even after a victory.
This lassitude is still greater on the day of the battle. While it
is true that this has always been the case, the nervous exhaustion
has grown in an inconceivable manner, its intensity increasing at
the same rate as the invisibility of the opponent. _The invisibility
of the enemy directly affects the morale of the soldier, the sources
of his energy and courage. The soldier who cannot see his enemy is
inclined to see him everywhere. It is but a step from this impression
to hesitancy and then to fear._ The inertia of the troops for whole
days at Magersfontain, Colenso, and Paardeberg, frequently more than
800 m. from the enemy, was not caused by their losses, but by the
moral depression produced within the effective zone of rifle fire.
Another factor, which governs the modern combat at short ranges, the
_impossibility of the commander making his influence felt in lines
which are seriously engaged_, is of still greater importance. _The
influence of the officers who lead these lines is also limited. They
are scarcely able to direct the three or four men nearest them._ The
combat depends upon the individual fighters, and there never has been
a time when the personal efficiency of the individual soldier has
had a greater significance.” We should not forget that this change
occurred during a period in which we no longer fight our battles with
professional soldiers of long service, but, on the contrary, with peace
cadres of our conscript armies raised to war strength by Reservists.

   [240] _Revue des deux mondes_, June number, 1902.

Another factor to be considered is the fighting quality of the
opponent. In an action against an enemy who is a match for us, the
necessity for distribution in depth is, of course, greater than when
fighting against poor troops.

 General v. Werder could with impunity oppose the newly raised levies
 of the French Republic on the =Lisaine= with 1.12 men per meter of
 front. The victory was won by this very extraordinary extension of
 front, which, if employed in the face of the Imperial army, would
 have led to defeat.[241]

   [241] KUNZ, _Entscheidungskämpfe des Korps Werder_, II, p. 11.

_Considerations of importance in deciding upon the extent of front to
be covered by a force, similar conditions on both sides being presumed,
are_--

1. _Whether it is compelled to fight an independent action alone_;

2. _Whether it is fighting, from the preparatory to the decisive stage
of the combat, as part of a larger body, with at least one, or perhaps
both flanks secured_;

3. _Whether it has been selected to make the decisive attack against an
enemy already shaken by other troops_.

In the last mentioned case a sudden effect, a short, powerful blow,
is required, and the maximum frontage of all the units employed on
the same line is admissible. But even a force advancing to the final
assault can by no means dispense with distribution in depth; supports
and reserves are needed to carry forward the firing line when it has
been checked, to cover its flanks, and to carry on the pursuit (second
line).

The frontage of an organization whose flanks are secure and which
is acting as a part of a larger force, depends upon other troops;
considerable extension of front is admissible provided the firing line
is constantly maintained at a strength which will enable it to gain a
superiority of fire over the enemy. “While an organization which has
only one flank protected, is less restricted as regards frontage, it
will have to provide for distribution in depth on the exposed flank.
In this case, it is a good plan to move the units held in rear toward
the particular flank (echeloning). Interval and distance increase with
the size of this echelon.” (Par. 290 German I. D. R.). The German
Infantry Drill Regulations (par. 397) further emphasize the fact that,
when well-trained infantry employs its rifles to good advantage in
defense, it is very strong in front; that it can hold a position with
a comparatively small force; and that, in this case, it has only one
weak spot, the flank, which it must seek to protect by distribution
in depth. This view is fully borne out by the recent events in South
Africa and in Manchuria. Under favorable conditions (deliberate
defense), a battalion fighting as part of a larger force may put all
of its companies into the first line, a front of 200 m. being assigned
to each. The battalion can thus defend a front of 800 m. The only
restriction is the requirement that the battalion commander must be
able, at all times, to direct the course of the combat.

An organization acting alone which has to fight an action independently
from beginning to end under varying conditions, cannot employ all of
its available strength in the first line at one time. A distribution
into three parts, viz., firing line, supports, and reserve, is
therefore required. During the preparatory stage, the firing line
should be as weak as possible, while, for sustaining and deciding the
action, the reserve should be as strong as possible. As a rule, this
distribution will not come into existence until the combat has begun;
it must disappear again, during the subsequent course of the fight,
through reinforcement of the troops that initiated the action, thus
resulting in an increase of the combat front.

While the frontage is thus increased, an equal density along the
entire attacking line is not produced. This is due to the fact that
one will endeavor to increase the distribution in depth only at the
point where the decision is sought (offensive wings), while one will
seek to obtain results by a generous expenditure of ammunition at
points where the enemy is only to be contained. When a broad front has
to be held with a weak force, it is a good plan to post the troops in
groups. Of the attack as well as of the defense it may be said, that
the skillful combination of the offensive and defensive advantages of a
piece of ground is a sign of good leadership. (Austerlitz). Frequently,
however, after an action is over, the assault that penetrated a line is
called the main attack, and the one that failed, a demonstration. An
organization fighting alone will generally begin an action by deploying
on a narrow front; it will protect its flanks by distribution in depth;
and, finally, mass troops at the decisive point in readiness to make
the assault. The force making an assault in attack or a counter-attack
in defense cannot be strong enough.

Another factor that must be considered in deciding upon the frontage is
the task which a force is to perform, _i.e._, whether it is to make an
attack or to stand on the defensive; whether it is to fight a delaying
action or is to withdraw. The object of distribution in depth is to
keep the firing line constantly at the same strength; this requires
stronger reinforcements in attack (owing to the greater losses), than
in defense, and leads, consequently, to a contraction of the front.

The number of troops which will be required to hold a given piece of
ground must be determined separately in each case. The strength of the
fighting line depends upon the effect of the hostile fire. Military
history tells us how many troops the leader sent into action in order
to gain the victory, but it seldom gives us a clue as to the number of
troops that might have sufficed in the particular case.

In deploying from route column in a rencontre, the leading battalion
may be fully engaged by the time the next one arrives on the
battlefield. In such cases, the tactical situation may require the
employment of longer firing lines than would be deemed proper for the
size of the command when making a more serious attack. (Par. 357 German
I. D. R.). The assailant should then endeavor to throw the enemy, who
is likewise advancing, on the defensive. The situation is similar to
that in which an advance guard has to cover the main body’s debouchment
from a defile.

 At =Nachod=, five Prussian battalions, which had only two companies
 in reserve, fought on a front of 2500 m. from 8 A. M. until noon.

 The conduct of the advance guard of the 8th Infantry Division
 at =Beaumont= is worthy of imitation. In this case, the support
 battalion was deployed and the artillery went into position; strong
 detachments were retained in rear of the left wing until the main
 body had arrived. Likewise, a proper relation existed between
 frontage (4 battalions on a front of 1400 m.) and distribution in
 depth. According to the General Staff Account of the Franco-German
 war (II, p. 1045), the distribution was as follows:

 _First line_: 4th Jäger-Battalion, which was subsequently reinforced
 by the IInd Battalion, 96th Infantry and the Ist and IInd Battalions,
 86th Infantry.

 _Support for the Artillery_: Füsilier Battalion, 96th Infantry.

 _Reserve_: IIIrd Battalion, 86th Infantry.

 We have already mentioned the deployment of the advance guard at
 =Spicheren= (p. 226 supra). In that instance the whole force was
 thrown in at once, whereas at =Beaumont= the deployment of the
 different units was coördinated and proceeded systematically. An
 advance guard should be able to repulse an attack and then assume the
 offensive without outside assistance. An example which is not worthy
 of imitation is the engagement of the 29th Infantry Brigade at the
 =Hallue=. The brigade began the fight, without being compelled to do
 so, and deployed its 4530 men on a front of 5000 m. The 30th Infantry
 Brigade (4070 men) then entered the fight and deployed on a front
 of 3000 m. in prolongation of the line of the 29th Brigade. If the
 French had made a decisive attack at this point, the 15th Infantry
 Division would not have been able to repulse it.

Distribution in depth, for the purpose of warding off an enveloping
movement and for making a counter-attack, is more necessary in defense
than in attack; besides, a greater front may be covered in the former
case on account of the smaller losses. The following factors in part
determine the extent of front to be occupied and the number of troops
required to defend it: (1) the strength, natural or artificial, of the
position; (2) obstacles in its front; (3) salient angles which can be
easily enveloped; (4) the intentions of the commander (_i.e._, whether
he contemplates fighting a purely defensive combat or one including
offensive action).

=Delaying actions= are usually fought at long and medium ranges as
purely passive defensive combats and no provision is made for replacing
casualties, the object of the fight being to avoid a decision. Few
men should, therefore, be placed in the firing line, but these should
be supplied with abundant ammunition. However, as the force desires
to avoid a decisive engagement by withdrawing, distribution in depth
should be provided to protect the flanks and to facilitate breaking off
the action. (Par. 419 German I. D. R.). This requires that distances be
great.

=Night attacks=, on account of the element of surprise involved, do not
require great distribution in depth; as a rule, the fight is decided
in a very short time by the collision of the opposing forces. However,
measures must be taken to protect the flanks, to ensure victory, and to
give the first line the impetus necessary to carry it forward in case
it is checked.

 The British attack on the Egyptian position at =Tel el Kebir= (1882)
 was made by only 11,000 men on a front of about 6 km. After a short
 fight the works were taken.

An attempt will now be made to give some approximate figures for the
extent of front that may be occupied in various situations.

Assuming one rifle for every three meters of front occupied, the
following might suffice for temporarily defending a line 1000 m. long:

 Firing line                                   300 rifles
 Supports (one platoon in rear of each wing)   120   „
 Reserve (two companies)                       400   „
                                               ----------
 Total                                         820 rifles

Thus 0.8 men per meter would be sufficient. This is borne out by the
Boer War. With a good field of fire, even a thin firing line, provided
with plenty of ammunition, is capable of bringing any attack to a
standstill, at least for the time being.

=A defense seeking a decision= requires fighting at short ranges; the
firing line must be kept constantly at the same strength; losses of
about one-fifth (killed, wounded, and missing) must be reckoned with;
and, finally, a reserve, consisting of about a third of the effective
strength of the force, is required for making the counter-attack.
The firing line is, from the outset, made as dense as possible, and
echelons posted on the flanks must oppose any advance against the
flanks.

The following would thus suffice for defending a front of 1000 m.:

 Firing line                     1000 men
 Replacement of casualties        200  „
 Flank protection (2 companies)   400  „
 Reserve                          800  „
                                 --------
 Total                           2400 men

Hence, 2.4 rifles per meter of front would be available for defense.

The defense is decided by a successful counter-attack made by the
reserve, whereas the attack requires an additional force to cover and
assure the assembling and re-forming of the troops. The greater force
is naturally required by the attacker, who must be stronger than the
defender at the moment when the assault is made. The following would be
required for making an attack on a front of 1000 m.:

 Firing line                      1200 rifles
 Replacement of casualties (¹⁄₂)   600    „
 Flank protection                  400   „
 Reserve                          2000   „
                                  -----------
 Total                            4200 rifles

This would be equivalent to 4.2 rifles per meter of front.

These figures can only serve as a very general guide, of course, and
should be considered minima.

 The number of troops required for attack or defense must be
 determined separately for each individual case. At =Lovtcha=, 25
 battalions, 92 guns, and 15 sotnias were not considered too large
 a force for attacking 8000 Turks with only 6 guns. At =Gorni
 Dubniac=, 3 infantry divisions of the Guard, with 90 guns, attacked
 6 weak Turkish battalions having only 4 guns. After the first two
 unsuccessful assaults on =Plevna=, the Russians overestimated the
 strength of the enemy. Osman Pasha’s force was estimated at 80,000
 men, and, consequently, during the September assaults, 90,000 men and
 400 guns were deemed necessary to attack barely 40,000 Turks and 60
 guns.

From a consideration of the foregoing, it appears that the =maximum
frontage= is justifiable, when a force whose flanks are secure,
occupies a position prepared for defense, or acts as a reserve and is
to bring about a decision which has been prepared by other troops.
On the other hand, the =maximum distribution in depth= is necessary
for a force acting alone in attack with both flanks exposed. Between
these two extremes lie many intermediate degrees, and it is therefore
impossible to lay down hard and fast rules for the frontage of an
attacking force. The German Infantry Drill Regulations (par. 373)
accordingly fix the frontage of a company in attack at 150 m. and that
of a brigade of six battalions at 1500 m. It is impossible to give a
definite ratio of effective strength to combat frontage. Thus, while
in attack a company puts into the line about 1.3 rifles per meter of
its front, the brigade employs 4 rifles per meter, and the larger units
a proportionally greater number. The necessity for distribution in
depth increases with the size of the force and with the number of units
composing it.

In a company, for example, a platoon is sufficient to fulfill, within
certain limits, all the functions of a reserve, while in a larger force
the duties of a reserve are so complex that each task (protecting
the flanks, reinforcing the firing line, giving the impetus for the
assault, and covering the assembling and re-forming of the attacking
force) must be assigned to a separate unit. Moreover, the duration of
a combat, and, in conjunction therewith, the necessity of reinforcing
the firing line and covering the flanks, increases with the size of the
force. During protracted periods of peace, one is too much inclined
to underestimate the wastefulness of a battle and the necessity for
reinforcing the fighting line; one cannot understand why 5 to 6 men
will not suffice, during the course of a combat, for a front wherein
only one man can use his rifle. From the foregoing it follows that the
frontage does not increase in proportion to the number of men. Thus,
an army corps would not occupy a front four times that of a brigade,
or twice that of a division. This is best illustrated by doubling or
trebling a plane area when both length and breadth have to be equally
increased.[242]

   [242] See _Taktik_, V, p. 46, et seq.

The maximum frontage to be covered in attack by the firing line of
a =company= is fixed at 150 m., in order that the density and fire
power of that line may be constantly maintained during a prolonged and
costly action. During shorter (_i.e._, rear guard actions), or less
costly actions (defense), it is, however, permissible to exceed this
limit. The regulations by no means insist upon a literal interpretation
of this paragraph, since they mention the deployment of the entire
company, when it would certainly occupy a front of about 200 m. There
is no disguising the fact, however, that, when extended on a front of
200 m., it is out of the question for the company commander to lead his
men.

The regulations do not fix the combat frontage of a =battalion=, as it
depends upon the tactical situation, and the battalion commander is
at liberty to place one, two, three, or four companies into the first
line. The frontage of a battalion would thus be 300 meters when making
an independent attack, and not exceeding 600 meters when fighting a
purely defensive action as part of a larger force, in other words, a
mean frontage of 400 meters.

This is also true of the =regiment=. The combat frontage of a regiment
acting alone, will, at the start, seldom exceed that of two battalions
deployed abreast. From this we obtain a frontage of 600-800 m. for the
regiment when it is acting independently, and a frontage of about 1200
m. when it is fighting a purely defensive action as part of a larger
force.

Military history tells us that an army corps consisting of 25
battalions, acting as a part of a larger force in a deliberately
planned attack, occupies an average front of 2.5 to 5 km. According
to this, the frontage of a brigade would amount to about 800-1000 m.,
_i.e._, to 6-7.5 rifles per meter of front.

 This limit was frequently exceeded during the =Franco-German war=
 according to the circumstances under which the brigade went into
 action and the commander’s estimate of the situation. If the brigades
 had to cover the concentration of the columns in rear, and if the
 battalions came into action successively, both brigade and battalion
 frontages were frequently very great. The endeavor to close with the
 enemy as soon as possible and the desire to bring a large number of
 rifles into action, led to enormously increased frontages at the
 expense of depth. The brigades which arrived later, entered the line
 where other brigades were already engaged, and the result was a
 dissolution and admixture of all tactical organizations.

 At =Colombey=, the 25th Brigade covered a front of nearly 3 km. with
 28 companies, only four or five companies remaining in close order.
 Connecting with this brigade on the north, 22 companies, belonging to
 two different divisions of the 1st Army Corps, covered a front of 4
 km., supported by three or four companies in close order. With such
 an overextension of front the offensive or defensive power of a force
 is, of course, crippled.

 During the battle of =Amiens=, the 3rd Prussian Brigade advanced in
 three columns against the heights north of the Luce. On the left, six
 companies of the 4th Infantry advanced from Domart, in the center,
 four companies from Hangard, and on the right, two companies from
 Demnin. A battery and a troop (_Eskadron_) were attached to each
 column, and the right column was followed by the 44th Infantry.

 The French advanced troops were pushed back without special
 difficulty, but at the northern edge of the timber, the
 brigade now found itself opposite the French main position
 Cachy--Villers-Bretonneux. The attack on this position began at once,
 and in a short time the 4th Infantry and two batteries were in action
 on the line East corner of the Bois de Hangard--Gentelles (5 km.
 long). At the same time, the 44th Infantry with one battery deployed
 on a front of about 2000 m. to the right of this line. The right wing
 of the 44th Infantry subsequently advanced to attack the trenches
 southeast of Villers-Bretonneux and captured them. The enveloped
 French left wing withdrew to the village named, and rallied on strong
 reserves.

 This was the situation when the fight came to a standstill toward 1
 o’clock P. M. The brigade fought in a thin line over a mile (four
 English miles) long. The reserve only consisted of three companies
 of the 4th Infantry, at Gentelles, and four companies of the 44th
 Infantry, in rear of the right flank.

 A defeat was averted only by the timely interference of other
 troops, especially of strong artillery (76 Prussian guns against 24
 French).[243]

   [243] KUNZ, _Nordarmee_, I, p. 47, et seq.

The frontage of a company is definitely fixed, so as to make it easier
for battalion and regimental commanders to designate combat sections;
the higher leaders reckon with regimental and brigade fronts. In war,
however, the numerical strength varies constantly, and it is therefore
advisable not to reckon with companies, but with a corresponding number
of rifles (200 on an average). The combat frontages mentioned in drill
regulations only give an approximate idea of the extent of front to
be covered by organizations which act as part of a larger force in an
attack seeking a decision. The extent of front to be covered in other
situations, under favorable or unfavorable attack conditions, requires
in each case a separate estimate.

In the Boer war, we notice for the first time overextensions of front,
which were undoubtedly caused by a desire to avoid the costly frontal
attack.

At Magersfontain, on December 11th, 1899, the British division under
Lord Methuen (7300 men) covered a front of 12 km.; and during the
attack on Pieters Hill, on February 27th, 1900, the troops under
General Buller (30,000 men) extended over a front of 11 km.

At Poplar Grove, 7000 Boers with 7 guns fought on a front of 17 km.
(0.4 men per meter), while the British deployed 25,000 rifles, 5000
troopers, and 116 guns on a front of 32 km. (0.8 men per meter). In
the engagement at Diamond Hill, on June 11th, 1900, the army under
Lord Roberts (40,000 men) advanced on a front of 37 km. Such liberties
could be taken only in the face of a shaken enemy who had given up all
thoughts of the offensive. At Paardeberg, February 18th, 1900, the 6th
Division and the Brigade of Highlanders succeeded in getting close to
the enemy, but there the attack failed on account of the lack of an
impetus from the rear. Even in the Russo-Japanese war the frontages
were greater than those to which we are accustomed. The reason for this
overextension lies in the fact that a numerically inferior assailant
was desirous of vanquishing the defender, and in order to accomplish
this purpose, he was obliged to make an extensive use of the spade and
to put all rifles into the first line.

 ===================+=======+=======+======+==========+==========
                    |       |       |      |Per 10,000|
                    |  Jap. | Russ. |Front-|men.[244] |  Per m.
                    |       |       | age. |Jap.|Russ.|Jap.|Russ.
 -------------------+-------+-------+------+----+-----+----+-----
                    |       |       | km.  |    m.    |   men.
 Liao Yang (West and|       |       |      |    |     |    |
 South front)       |106,700|150,000|  26  |2600| 1750|3.9 | 5.9
                    |       |       |      |    |     |    |
 Shaho              |148,000|257,000|  48  |3330| 1980|3.  | 5.
                    |       |       |      |    |     |    |
 Mukden (exclusive  |       |       |      |    |     |    |
 of Yalu Army)      |247,000|336,000|  96  |3960| 2970|2.6 | 3.4
 -------------------+-------+-------+------+----+-----+----+-----

   [244] According to data given by Lieut. Col. Yoda in the _Journal
 of the Officers’ Association_, Tokio.

The realization that troops in fortified positions only require small
reinforcements or none at all, very naturally caused frontages to be
increased and depth of combat formations to be decreased. Gaps in the
attacking line, provided they were kept under observation, proved by no
means a disadvantage.[245]

   [245] At Mukden, on March 3rd, 1905, there was a gap of 7 km.
 between the Japanese IVth and Ist Armies, which was covered by
 only one infantry regiment of Reservists, two dismounted cavalry
 regiments, and one battalion of artillery. However, the Russians were
 fighting on the passive defensive in this case. The insignificant
 danger to be apprehended from such gaps is especially emphasised by
 the French regulations.

During attacks it frequently appeared that the Japanese lacked the
necessary reinforcements.

~INFLUENCE OF VARIOUS RIFLES ON THE DENSITY OF BATTLE FORMATIONS.~[246]

   [246] General MINARELLI-FITZGERALD, _Infanteristische Reflexionen_.

 ========+======+=======+=============+==================+================
 Rifle.  |Year  |Battle.|Belligerents.|Per km. of the    |Remarks.
         |      |       |             |combat frontage.  |
         |      |       |             +-----+------+-----+
         |of    |       |             |Bat- |Esca- |Field|
         |the   |       |             |tal- |drons |guns.|
         |Cam-  |       |             |ions |@ 150 |     |
         |paign.|       |             |@ 900|troop-|     |
         |      |       |             |ri-  |ers.  |     |
         |      |       |             |fles.|      |     |
 --------+------+-------+-------------+-----+------+-----+----------------
 Muzzle  | 1815 |Water- |French       | 12  | 19   |46   |After Napoleon’s
 loaders.|      |loo    +-------------+-----+------+-----+concentration
         |      |       |British      | 10  | 15   |25   |for battle
         |      |       |             |     |      |     |toward noon.
         +------+-------+-------------+-----+------+-----+----------------
         | 1859 |Sol-   |French and   |  7  |  5   |19   |After the victo-
         |      |ferino |Sardinians   |     |      |     |rious advance of
         |      |       +-------------+-----+------+-----+the Austrian
         |      |       |Austrians    |  7  |  2.5 |21   |VIIIth Corps to
         |      |       |             |     |      |     |S. Martino.
         +------+-------+-------------+-----+------+-----+----------------
         | 1866 |Cus-   |Austrians    |  8  |  2.  |17   |
         |      |tozza  |             |     |      |     |
 --------+      +-------+-------------+-----+------+-----+----------------
 Breech  |      |König- |Prussians    |  9.5| 10   |39   |Situation at
 loaders |      |grätz  +-------------+-----+------+-----+noon.
 large   |      |       |Austrians    | 10  |  8.5 |43   |
 caliber.|      |       |& Saxons     |     |      |     |
         +------+-------+-------------+-----+------+-----+----------------
         | 1870 |Wörth  |Germans      |  9  |  5   |37   |
         |      +-------+-------------+-----+------+-----+
         |      |Grave- |Germans      | 11.5|  9   |46   |
         |      |lotte  +-------------+-----+------+-----+
         |      |St.    |French       |  8  |  6.5 |32   |
         |      |Privat |             |     |      |     |
 --------+------+-------+-------------+-----+------+-----+----------------
 Mag.    | 1899 |Colen- |British      |  1.5|      | 4   |Including 1¹⁄₂
 rifles  |      |so 1st |             |     |      |     |heavy guns.
 of      |      |battle,|             |     |      |     |
 small   |      |Dec.   |             |     |      |     |
 caliber.|      |15th   |             |     |      |     |
         +------+-------+             +-----+------+-----+----------------
         | 1900 |Colen- |             |  2.5|  1.5 | 7.5 |Including 1¹⁄₂
         |      |so, 2d |             |     |      |     |heavy guns.
         |      |battle,|             |     |      |     |
         |      |Febru- |             |     |      |     |
         |      |ary    |             |     |      |     |
         |      |27th   |             |     |      |     |
 --------+---+--+-------+-------------+-----+------+-----+----------------
 7.6 mm. | M | 1|Febru- |Russians     |  1  |  0.4 | *5  |Total extension
 against | u | 9|ary    |             |     |      |     |from the Liao to
 6.5 mm. | k | 0|20th   |             |     |      |     |Tung-wha-sien.
 Mag.    | d | 5|       |             |     |      |     |*Incl. 1 heavy
 rifles. | e | .|       |             |     |      |     |gun.
         | n |  |       |             +-----+------+-----+----------------
         |   |  |       |             |  3  |  0.7 | *5.5|Excl. East and
         |   |  |       |             |     |      |     |West Det. *Incl.
         |   |  |       |             |     |      |     |3 heavy guns.
         |   |  |       +-------------+-----+------+-----+----------------
         |   |  |       |Japanese     |  3.5|  0.8 |*15.5|Exclusive of the
         |   |  |       |             |     |      |     |approaching Vth
         |   |  |       |             |     |      |     |army. *Incl. 2
         |   |  |       |             |     |      |     |heavy guns.
         |   |  +-------+------+------+-----+------+-----+-----+----------
         |   |  |March  |West  |Rus-  |  5  |  0.8 |†18  |†Ex- |Excl. of
         |   |  |3d     |front.|sians |     |      |     |clu- |Trans-
         |   |  |       |      |      |     |      |     |sive |Baikal
         |   |  |       |      |      |     |      |     |of   |Cossack
         |   |  |       |      |      |     |      |     |heavy|Div.
         |   |  |       |      +------+-----+------+-----+guns.|
         |   |  |       |      |Japan-|  3.5|  1   |†11.6|     |Excl. of
         |   |  |       |      |ese   |     |      |     |     |2d Cav.
         |   |  |       |      |      |     |      |     |     |Brigade.
         |   |  |       +------+------+-----+------+-----+     |
         |   |  |       |South |Rus-  |  1.7|   .5 | †6  |     |
         |   |  |       |front.|sians |     |      |     |     |
         |   |  |       |      +------+-----+------+-----+     |
         |   |  |       |      |Japan-|  2.2|   .3 | †5.6|     |
         |   |  |       |      |ese   |     |      |     |     |
         |   |  +-------+------+------+-----+------+-----+     |
         |   |  |March  |West  |Rus-  |  4.6|  0.7 |†15.6|     |Excl. of
         |   |  |7th    |front.|sians |     |      |     |     |Trans-
         |   |  |       |      |      |     |      |     |     |Baikal
         |   |  |       |      |      |     |      |     |     |Cossack
         |   |  |       |      |      |     |      |     |     |Div.
         |   |  |       |      +------+--- -+------+-----+     |
         |   |  |       |      |Japan-|  4  |  0.6 |†10.5|     |Excl. of
         |   |  |       |      |ese   |     |      |     |     |Cav. Div.
 --------+---+--+-------+------+------+-----+------+-----+-----+----------

Let us now recapitulate the most important points which have a bearing
on combat frontage:

1. The frontage of individual units cannot be definitely fixed, as it
depends upon the situation and the purpose of an action.

2. Favorable terrain, cover, and intrenchments permit an extended front
to be obstinately defended with a weak force.

3. The frontage does not increase in proportion to the size of the
force.

4. An organization (company, battalion, or regiment) fighting as part
of a larger force is justified in deploying on a wider front than when
acting alone.

The necessity for distribution in depth increases with the size of the
force and with the number of units composing it Only the result can
decide whether a narrow or a wide frontage was justified in a given
case. A commander will endeavor to hold certain parts of the line with
a weak force, posted in groups, while, at the decisive point, he will
throw in every available man in order to gain the victory.


Provisions of Various Regulations.

 =Austria-Hungary.= Frontage depends upon the tactical situation and
 the terrain. The frontage of a company acting as part of a larger
 force in attack is fixed at about 130-150 paces (97-112 m.). “In
 other situations, a greater frontage is, as a rule, permissible.”
 The battalion acting as part of a larger force in attack, “is, as
 a rule, not to cover a frontage exceeding its own front when in
 line”--in peace exercises, 300-400 paces (225-300 m.). With companies
 of 200 men, 2 rifles, and in the battalion 2.6 rifles are reckoned
 per meter of front. “The increased fighting power of infantry, due
 to better fire effect, in general permits a greater frontage to be
 covered. This will often be taken advantage of, in order to make
 as many troops as possible available for the decisive stage of the
 combat. But this frontage should not be so great, that the requisite
 power of resistance is weakened, or that tactical coöperation or the
 attainment of the object of the combat are impaired.” Further than
 this nothing is prescribed.

 =France.= Nothing definite is prescribed. The combat is carried on by
 groups separated by intervals.

 “When _an organisation is acting as part of a larger force_ and has
 to advance directly to the front against a well-defined objective,
 its commander may from the outset push a strong force into action,
 retaining a reserve only in exceptional cases. If one of the flanks
 of this force is in the air, it will be advisable to echelon units in
 rear of the flank which may be threatened. When _an organisation is
 acting alone_, and when both flanks are in the air, a weaker line is
 pushed forward and a reserve is retained....”

 The enhanced power of firearms permits an extended front to be held,
 especially at the commencement of an action. The only restrictions
 are those dictated by necessity--always to assure effective control
 by the leader and mutual coöperation between the various tactical
 units.

 This mode of fighting does away with continuous firing lines which no
 longer fulfill the requirements of modern battle.

 =Belgium.= The frontage of a battalion acting as part of a larger
 force in attack is fixed at 300 m.; in defense this is increased.

 =Japan.= The provisions of the Japanese regulations are identical
 with those of the German regulations of 1889. The frontage of a
 company is not given. A battalion may cover a frontage not exceeding
 that of three companies. The frontage of a brigade, as a rule, does
 not exceed 1500 m. at the initial deployment.

 =Russia.= The frontage of a company, unless otherwise specified, is
 governed by the object of the action, the terrain, and the effective
 strength, and, as a rule, does not exceed 250 paces (180 m.). No
 figures are given for the larger units.

 =England.= While great stress was laid upon narrow fronts and thin
 firing lines prior to the Boer war, opinions swung to the opposite
 extreme after that war. During a decisive attack, a battalion in the
 first line may employ 125 rifles per 100 yards of front (_i.e._, 90
 m.), distributed as firing line, supports, and battalion reserve;
 the latter may consist either of one company or of parts of several.
 Entire companies are deployed only in exceptional cases, for
 instance in terrain devoid of cover where it is difficult to bring
 up reinforcements. The size of the reserve depends upon the losses
 likely to be suffered by the fighting line. When these losses will
 be small in all probability, the reserve may be as strong as the
 firing line and the supports combined. In accordance with these
 general principles, a battalion may deploy for attack on a front
 not exceeding 800 yds. = 720 m. (Formerly 540 m. was prescribed).
 A brigade consisting of four battalions will thus be able to cover
 either a front of 1400 or one of 2100 m., depending upon the number
 of battalions put into the line.

 =Italy.= Only general principles are prescribed. “Skill in judging
 the proper frontage to be covered by a force is attained in time of
 peace by exercises on varied ground and under different situations,
 especially when organizations approximately at war strength are used.”


5. COMBAT ORDERS.[247]

   [247] V. KIESLING, _Gefechtsbefehle_, Berlin, 1907.

Modern fire effect does not permit a commander to direct the course
of an action by despatching adjutants from time to time. This must
be borne in mind when issuing a combat order. Such an order can only
regulate the launching of the troops into action and prescribe a task
as a guide for their subsequent conduct. Since leaders change during
the course of the combat, the order must ensure coöperation of the
component parts of the force by thoroughly explaining the purpose of
the fight. The troops have a right to know what the commander expects
of them; it is not sufficient to order them to occupy a certain
point--they must be told whether or not they are to defend it. An order
which directs troops “to oppose” the enemy, conveys an extremely vague
meaning; it should specify instead whether they are “to attack” the
enemy, or whether they are “to defend” a position. The subordinate
leader’s pertinent question, as to the purpose of the combat, forces
the commander to indicate clearly whether he intends to attack, or
to stand on the defensive; whether he will fight a delaying action,
or avoid a decision by withdrawing. Even the lowest grades must be
informed of this decision of the commander. The troops will perform
anything that is demanded of them in definite terms. On the other hand,
the commander must demand that no subordinate “hide” behind an order
and that, on the contrary, he act on his own initiative when an order
is not received or the situation changes.

Clearly defined sections of the battlefield (par. 475 German I. D. R.)
and definite combat tasks, each complete in itself (par. 293 German
I. D. R.), are assigned to the tactical units to be employed in the
first line (battalions in case of a regiment; regiments, as a rule,
in case of a division). In attack, the order indicates the front upon
which each one of the larger units is to deploy and what portion of the
hostile position it is to attack. This demarcation defines the extent
of the combat sections (par. 371 German I. D. R.), within the limits of
which the particular unit must make the most of the accidents of the
ground. In carrying out these combat tasks, unity of action is ensured
by the mutual coöperation of the tactical units fighting abreast of
each other (par. 475 German I. D. R.), and by the designation of a
unit upon which the others regulate their movements, without, however,
thereby being hampered in their endeavor to advance. (Base unit of
combat). Moreover, by employing his reserves, the commander “can shift
the decisive point of the action to any place desired, reinforce where
he deems it advisable, equalize fluctuations of the combat, and,
finally, bring about the decision.”

The first orders--those for putting the troops in motion in the desired
direction--are usually verbal; more detailed orders, which are the rule
from the brigade on up, are issued subsequently. (Par. 274 German I.
D. R.). In most cases, the commander knows quite well what he wants,
but only the effort required in expressing in writing what he desires
to say, enables him to reproduce his thoughts with the necessary
clearness. Even in peace maneuvers, the officer who issued an order
and its recipients quite frequently disagree as to its interpretation;
the superior remembers only what he desired to say at the particular
moment, but not the language in which the order was couched. Written
orders minimize the possibility of a misunderstanding. They have the
further advantage that the recipient has in his possession a document
to which he can always refer in case of doubt.

Orders should not provide for maintaining communication, for protecting
flanks, and for keeping up local reconnaissance, since these matters
are attended to as a matter of course, every leader being held
responsible for making proper dispositions, within the limits of his
command, for the performance of these duties. The higher the rank
of the commander, the farther he should stay away from the scene of
battle. As the commander can exercise an influence on the course of
the action only by employing his reserves, he should remain near them,
or, at any rate, retain their leader on his staff. If the commander
selects a position too close to the point where the first line is
engaged, he loses sight of the action in its entirety, and allows
himself to be influenced too much by events within his immediate range
of vision.[248] The subordinate commander, in selecting his position,
has to consider only good observation of the enemy, communication
with neighboring units, with the next higher commander, and with his
subordinates.

   [248] This was true of Sir Redvers Buller at Colenso, and likewise
 of Kuropatkin. The latter led in person too much and was completely
 lost in the details of minor troop-leading.

At headquarters, the work to be performed must be carefully apportioned
among the different members of the staff.

The commander, assisted by an officer of his staff, observes the enemy
and his own force, while another officer maintains communication with
the neighboring force and with the next higher headquarters (signal
flag squads, telephone), and receives and prepares reports. (The scheme
described would be appropriate for a brigade staff, for example). It is
furthermore desirable to despatch information officers to neighboring
troops, and to detail officers from subordinate units to receive orders.

The detailing of adjutants from subordinate units for the purpose of
facilitating the issue and despatch of orders of higher headquarters is
very properly prohibited by par. 83 German F. S. R.; on the march, this
is permissible temporarily only. The battalion supply officers will,
however, frequently be utilized as information officers, for, on the
day of battle, they would thus be most profitably employed.

 In =France= this is regulated by _Agents de liaison_. These are to
 keep the commander informed in regard to the special situation, the
 action of subordinate units, and the intentions of their commanders.
 “The importance of permanent communication between leader and
 subordinate increases with the distances separating troops in action;
 the leader’s influence on the course of the combat can be ensured
 only by these _agents_.

 As a general rule, one mounted officer from every infantry unit,
 from the battalion up, reports to the next higher commander for the
 purpose of maintaining communication. This officer may detail a
 cyclist or trooper to accompany him. He is to be prepared to give all
 necessary information in regard to his unit, and to keep in touch
 with the general situation in order to inform his immediate superior
 in regard to it. He communicates with his own unit either by sending
 orderlies with messages, or by carrying the orders of the commander
 in person.”


6. COMMUNICATION ON THE BATTLEFIELD.

Cyclists and mounted messengers can be employed on the battlefield
only when the conditions are exceptionally favorable; even intrenched
connecting posts communicating with one another by means of shouts
or signals do not absolutely ensure communication in a protracted
engagement. Heliographs or signal lamps are valuable only during the
approach to the battlefield and in large battles.[249] The same is
true of the field telegraph, by means of which, for example, division
headquarters may be connected with the headquarters of the corps. In
an infantry combat, only the field telephone, wig-wag flags,[250] and
signal flags can be used. The employment of telephone and telegraph
has the advantage of ensuring greater quiet at headquarters, since the
coming and going of messengers is eliminated; on the other hand, the
commander is at once informed of every reverse (which may perhaps be
only temporary) and will not always be able to resist the temptation of
leading subordinate commanders by apron strings. The Japanese made a
very extensive use of the various means of communication, but neglected
to guard against an interruption of their lines of information by
installing signal flag stations. This cannot be dispensed with. In the
Japanese army visual signals[251] were not used, and in the Russian
army they were not adopted until October 4th, 1904. Thus means of
communication did not develop beyond the rudimentary stage in both
armies. According to all previous experience, telephone lines, as
now operated, are practicable in attack only for the purpose of
establishing communication down to brigade headquarters.[252]

   [249] See _Taktik_, III, p. 116, et seq.

   VON LÖBELL’S _Jahresberichte_ 1906, p. 390: _Employment of
 Heliographs and Signal Lamps in Southwest Africa_.

   [250] Wig-wag signals have been abolished and Morse signals
 prescribed in their stead by Cabinet Orders dated January 16th, 1908.

   [251] Sir IAN HAMILTON, _A Staff Officer’s Scrap Book_, I, pp.
 173-174, 196, 241 and 323.

   [252] The station apparatus furnished by the firm of “Zwietusch” of
 Charlottenburg, weighs 5.5 kg. with its battery.

   In defensive positions, which are held for a prolonged period,
 it is, of course, practicable to establish telephonic connection
 with the most advanced line. This was, for example, the case in the
 Japanese 10th Division on the morning of March 3rd, 1905 (Mukden).
 On this occasion the division commander in rear was informed by
 telephone of the presence of wire entanglements in front of the
 Russian position, and permission was asked and granted to postpone
 the attack.

Until recently, both signal and wig-wag flags were used in
Germany.[253] The signal motions are made in an upright position,
the Morse code, which is rather difficult to learn, being used. This
method of signaling permits communication to be kept up within a radius
of 7 km.; moreover, it can be used at night and in combined land and
naval operations. The wig-wag signals are easily learned and entirely
sufficient for communicating over distances within 3 km.; they also
permit information to be despatched rapidly, as abbreviations are
employed for certain frequently recurring movements. These signals
possess the additional advantage that they can be made by a man while
in a prone position.[254] Wig-wag signals are a very effective means of
communication and will rarely fail.[255]

   [253] _Jahrbücher für Armee und Marine_, June number, 1906, and
 March number, 1907.

   [254] Signals with wig-wag flags can be made by a man lying flat
 on his belly or on his back; this is, however, frequently impossible
 with outstretched arms and the sender must be content to make the
 signals by grasping the staves of the two flags in the middle, then
 placing them in appropriate position relative to each other (for
 example in making the letters, d, e, k, l, p, u).

   [255] The signals prescribed in par. 11 German I. D. R. are very
 effective if made with wig-wag flags; if made with signal flags they
 require constant observation, without, however, precluding mistakes.
 For example, when given with signal flags, the signal “halt” - “h,
 h, h,” (.... .... ....) is frequently confused with the signal “the
 assault is about to begin” (... ... ...). This mistake is not so apt
 to occur when wig-wag flags are used.

   When General Stakelberg, after his right flank had been turned at
 Wafangu, sent orders to withdraw to General Gerngross, the commander
 on the left flank, it took the officer who carried the order through
 this mountainous country, nearly an hour to cover the 5 km. which
 separated the two commanders. An order sent by means of wig-wag flags
 could have reached the leader in question within a few minutes.

A commander should not exercise a constant influence on his
subordinates just because modern means of communication permit him
to do so, as this would destroy all initiative and independence. The
permanent communication to which we are accustomed in time of peace,
and the method of leading produced thereby, do not allow real qualities
of leadership and initiative to develop. It is unquestionably not easy
for a commander to refrain from interfering when a deployment does
not progress with sufficient rapidity or not in accordance with his
wishes.[256]

   [256] Interference of the Commander-In-Chief of the IIIrd Army
 with the deployment of the 1st Bavarian Army Corps at Wörth. KUNZ,
 _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, 15, p. 44, et seq. The impatience
 of the commander-in-chief was natural perhaps, but, due to his
 interference, the enveloping movement skillfully initiated by General
 v. d. Tann, could not be executed.

 =Austria-Hungary.= “Infantry telegraph detachments” are assigned
 to every infantry division and brigade of mountain troops.[257]
 These detachments are charged with the duty of keeping up the
 visual signal and telegraph service in field and mountain warfare.
 The Morse alphabet is used in visual signaling and in telegraphic
 communication. In this the Austrian regulations differ from the
 German. The infantry telegraph detachment attached to an infantry
 division is divided into three sections, and is equipped with
 telephones, wire, heliographs, and signal flags. Each section
 consists of 15 men (6 of whom are telegraphers), and is equipped with
 24 km. of wire.

   [257] _Streffleur_, 1905, April-May number.

 =France.= Provisional signal detachments have been formed in some of
 the infantry organizations. These detachments are to take care of
 visual signal and telephone communication. The telephone sections are
 expected to maintain two stations (12 km. wire).

 =England.= Each brigade (4 battalions) has one telephone detachment.
 Wire (9.6 km.) is carried along on two pack animals.


7. LOCAL RECONNAISSANCE OF THE INFANTRY.

(Pars. 305, 319, 355, 363 and 376 German I. D. R.).

It is a strange fact that, while splendid work was done in strategic
reconnaissance in the large maneuvers of recent years, not only in
Germany but also in France, the local, tactical reconnaissance was less
good and often deficient, so that in consequence thereof surprises
were not rare. Frequently a gap occurred in the reconnoitering line
when the cavalry in front of the various parts of the army was brushed
aside and the stronger cavalry force deprived the weaker of the freedom
of choosing its line of retreat. Occasionally, when this happened,
cavalry patrols were sent out with orders to report directly to the
infantry, or, at any rate, to find the hostile route columns, but
this expedient was only partially successful. It must be remembered
that troopers cannot ride close enough to the enemy to see anything
of importance, and that they frequently are in ignorance of the very
things which are of value for the infantry. In addition, the divisional
cavalry is entirely too weak to perform all the tasks assigned to
it. Therefore infantry and artillery should not rely upon cavalry
reconnaissance. The mere fact that infantry has sent out cavalry
patrols in a certain direction does not relieve it from the duty of
providing for its own reconnaissance.

The greatest obstacle to infantry reconnaissance lies in the fact
that its cyclists are confined to good roads; that its mounted
officers cannot be withdrawn from their appropriate duties except
for short periods; that, as a rule, orderlies are not available for
carrying messages; and that, if officers carry messages in person, the
reconnaissance is interrupted. Infantry patrols, on account of the
slowness of their movements, cannot transmit messages quickly, and,
as a result, such messages frequently arrive too late to be of any
value. On the other hand, infantry patrols possess an advantage in
that, by utilizing cover, they can get close to the enemy without being
observed. The need of local reconnaissance is greater now than it was
in the past, because troops can no longer change front when deployed,
and because those which come under hostile fire while in close order
formations may, in a short time, suffer well-nigh annihilating losses.

 In the South African war the British infantry was frequently placed
 in difficult situations by the suddenly delivered fire of the Boers
 (=Magersfontain=, =Colenso=), which induced it to deploy all of its
 lines on a wide front at an early moment.

 The Japanese attached much importance to local reconnaissance,
 whereas the Russian leaders considered it as something unusual, so
 that Kuropatkin was finally obliged to prescribe it in army orders.
 “Local reconnaissance was performed by 20 to 30 infantrymen. These
 carefully approached our positions in small groups. One man of each
 group laid his rifle aside and crawled close up to our trenches,
 raised his head and observed, while three or four of his companions,
 whom he had left farther in rear, opened fire on the trenches.
 Occasionally all of these men threw themselves flat on the ground for
 protection. This mode of procedure continued for seven hours.”

 The thoroughness of the reconnaissance generally made a timely
 deployment possible, even when the enemy was well concealed, but that
 neglects occurred nevertheless is borne out by the advance of the
 Japanese 2nd Division at =Fuchau= and =Kapukai= on March 10th, 1905.
 This division advanced without reconnoitering, struck the fortified
 Russian position, was unable to move forward or to the rear, and had
 to fight under unfavorable conditions, and while suffering heavy
 losses, from early morning until 4 P. M., when the general situation
 compelled the enemy to evacuate the position. The advance of the
 Russian 54th Division (Orlof) during the battle of =Liao Yang= (2nd
 Sept.) is a similar example of disproportionately greater importance
 and with a tragic ending. The noise of the battle at =Sykwantun=
 caused the commander of the 54th Division to leave the position
 assigned him on the heights of the =Yentai= mines and to march toward
 the sound of the cannonading. The division, advancing over covered
 terrain without adequate reconnaissance, was taken in flank and rear
 by the Japanese 12th Brigade (Sasaki),[258] and thrown back in utter
 rout upon its former position, carrying with it the troops which had
 been left there. Thus the Yentai heights fell into the possession of
 the Japanese.

   [258] For details of the attack made by Sasaki’s Brigade, see
 GERTSCH, _Vom russisch-japanischen Kriege_, I, sketch 14.

The primary object of local reconnaissance is to protect a force from
surprise. This may be accomplished by sending out combat patrols, and
by company commanders riding ahead in time. (Par. 457 German I. D. R.).
The latter are likewise charged with picking out avenues of approach to
selected fire positions, and the sooner they begin the reconnaissance
the better, for the accidents of the ground can then be utilized to the
best advantage.

The difficulties of the reconnaissance are increased when we have to
reckon with the measures taken by the enemy to screen his force.[259]

   [259] The attacker’s reconnaissance must be prevented as long as
 possible. Frequently patrols in the foreground will suffice for this
 purpose. (Par. 406 German I. D. R.)

Weak infantry patrols can neither break down this resistance nor create
the necessary opening through which the leaders can reconnoiter in
person. Stronger forces are requisite, and “reconnaissance companies”
may have to be sent out toward the enemy to serve as a support for the
patrols, to reinforce them when necessary, and to constitute natural
collecting stations for messages. “Reconnaissances in force” are the
result of these endeavors to obtain information,[260] for the defender
will not reveal his dispositions unless the attacker threatens an
attack. Reconnaissances in force are especially appropriate in this
case, since the information obtained in regard to the position and
strength of the enemy can be utilized at once. (Par. 134 German F. S.
R.).

   [260] See _Taktik_, IV. p. 214, et seq. The results of the
 reconnaissance in force made at Neuville aux Bois were very
 unsatisfactory.

In France great importance is attached to forcibly gaining information
by means of detachments of all arms which also prevent hostile
reconnaissance. In minor operations the French send out infantry
detachments, which, from secure hiding places, pick off observers,
screen the position of their own force, and prevent the enemy from
using covered avenues of approach. However, these very patrol combats
may cause the commander to come to a false conclusion in regard to
the hostile position. If the cavalry reconnaissance has determined
that the enemy intends to accept battle within a particular area, the
details of his intentions must be obtained by local reconnaissance.
Then the commander will wish to know whether or not an immediate attack
is feasible, or whether it is advisable to wait until nightfall for
bringing up the infantry. The local reconnaissance determines where
the flanks of the enemy are located; whether the position in front is
the hostile main position or only an advanced post; whether the enemy
has made preparations for defense; and where the hostile artillery is
posted. As a rule, it will be impossible, until after the engagement
has begun, to recognize a skillfully located fortified position,[261]
to distinguish between the real and dummy trenches, determine the
position of obstacles and estimate whether they can be surmounted with
or without adequate apparatus. Then it likewise becomes necessary
to find and mark covered avenues of approach.[262] In moving to new
firing positions, it is important that advanced positions, masks, and
dummy trenches be recognized in time. The commander of a unit on a
flank should make dispositions for observation on his flank, and for
permanent communication with neighboring units, even though no specific
orders have been received by him to that effect. Strange as it may
seem, the troops deployed on the road Gorze--Rezonville (battle of
Vionville), by their failure to get into early communication with the
troops which had been on the ground for some time, neglected to take
advantage of the information gained by those troops.[263]

   [261] See _Taktik_, V, p. 243, et seq.

   [262] HOPPENSTEDT (_Schlacht der Zukunft_, pp. 134 and 140) draws a
 graphic picture which is a faithful reproduction of reality.

   The procedure outlined by that author (_Ibid._, p. 122) for
 indicating, by means of flag signals, points sheltered from hostile
 fire, seems practicable. He states: “Holding his flag upright, the
 member of the patrol proceeds steadily on his way to Weyer. Now he
 has arrived at the point where the road bends slightly toward the
 south; his flag descends,” etc.

   [263] KUNZ, _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, 8-9, p. 128, et seq.,
 p. 243.

   The necessity for thorough reconnaissance is illustrated by the
 successful “fire surprises” carried out by the Boers at Modder River
 on November 28th, 1899, and at Colenso, against Hart’s Brigade
 advancing in dense masses, on December 15th, 1899.

The enumeration of these tasks shows that local reconnaissance should
not be restricted to the preparatory stage of the combat alone, but
that it must be kept up during the whole course of the action. To
the duties enumerated, we may add, occasional tasks, such as picking
off staffs and signal men; sneaking up on artillery that has been
incautiously pushed forward; and annoying the enemy by flanking fire.
For such tasks, so-called “scouting detachments,”[264] after the
Russian pattern, have frequently been recommended. Their usefulness
in difficult country and in operations against the enemy’s flank
and rear cannot be denied. In minor operations, if provided with
ample ammunition and advancing on side roads, they can hamper the
reconnaissance of the enemy, secure the flanks of their own force,
ascertain the probable extent of the prospective battlefield, and
finally, having made a skillful lodgment, they can become very annoying
to the hostile artillery. In a large battle the necessary elbow room
for such employment is lacking. To form picked men into special
organizations, as is done in Russia, is always of doubtful value. The
constant transfer of their best men to the mounted infantry during
the second part of the South African war was fatal to the British
infantry battalions. An organization cannot dispense with its good
men; it needs them to replace wounded non-commissioned officers. While
everything goes without a hitch, the withdrawal of good men from an
organization is of little importance; the drawbacks to this procedure
become apparent, however, when the line begins to waver, when, in the
absence of officers, only the example of the courageous men prevents
the weak-kneed from running away. Our regulations properly appreciate
the importance of psychological impressions during critical combat
situations; they state: “The man who feels his courage and coolness
going, in the excitement of battle, should look toward his officers.
Should they have fallen, he will find plenty of non-commissioned
officers and brave privates, whose example will revive his courage.”
(Par. 268 German I. D. R.).

   [264] V. TETTAU, _Die Jagdkommandos der russischen Armee_, Berlin,
 1901.

   HOPPENSTEDT, _Patrouillen- und Radfahr-Kommandos_, 1907.

If it becomes necessary to despatch a stronger infantry force on a
mission of minor importance, it will usually be better to detail an
entire company than to improvise a detachment whose leader would know
his men only imperfectly.

 Before the 95th Infantry (French) made its attack on the brewery
 of =l’Amitié= (south of =Noisseville=), on August 31st, 1870, a
 reconnoitering detachment had ascertained the strength of the
 position and the manner in which it was held by the defender.[265]

   [265] _Wald- und Ortsgefecht_, p. 192.

 =Examples of the successful employment of flanking fire by small
 forces:=

 The flanking fire, delivered from the =Bois des Ognons= by about
 30 men of the 12th Company, 72nd Infantry, compelled the French to
 withdraw their left flank. (Combat on the Gorze--Rezonville road,
 16th August, 1870).[266]

   [266] KUNZ, _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, 8-9, p. 146.

 At =Gravelotte-St. Privat=, flanking fire is said to have caused the
 withdrawal of nine French battalions which had until then delivered
 an effective fire upon the Prussian Guard Artillery.[267]

   [267] _Ibid._, 10, p. 24, and 12, p. 24, et seq.


8. THE IMPORTANCE OF THE TERRAIN.

The defense requires extensive, open terrain, permitting unobstructed
view, while the attack requires stretches of ground hidden from the
observation of the enemy and sheltered from his fire, in order that
the troops may be deployed for action at the decisive ranges. A piece
of ground will rarely possess all these advantages, but, nevertheless,
well-trained infantry will be able to defend successfully a piece
of ground that has a poor field of fire, and infantry which is
energetically and skillfully led will be able to cross even an open
plain.

At the longer ranges, a force will, in the first place, endeavor to
keep concealed. While advancing, troops will rarely be able to take
advantage of available cover, but at a halt and while firing they
will be able to do so. Their taking advantage of the ground should
not lead to a diminution of the energy of the advance, and should
not cause parts of the force to fall behind.[268] “The terrain
exerts considerable influence on the formation of troops. Open
country requires that distances be increased so that the losses may
be minimized, while close country permits distances to be reduced.
The commander should take particular care not to let this advantage
escape him, since it is often necessary in this case to reinforce the
first line promptly. Close order formations may be retained longest on
covered terrain.” (Par. 307 German I. D. R.).

   [268] This is equally true of ground that is difficult to march
 over; the troops must cross it. The evasion of difficult portions of
 terrain usually leads to disorder and a dispersion of the troops.
 For the advance of the 18th Infantry Brigade at Wörth, see KUNZ,
 _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, 14, p. 101. (Thick underbrush in
 the woods on the Fuchshübel.)

An attack over a plain devoid of cover “should be avoided as far as
possible, or weak, widely extended detachments only should be ordered
to advance over it, while the bulk of the force is launched at a point
where an approach under cover is practicable. If suitable terrain is
lacking to permit this, then the decisive attack must be led over
the open plain.” (Par. 325 German I. D. R.). In contrast with the
continuous skirmish lines of the past, which are still favored by the
Austrians, the German regulations permit a gap to be left in the line
where an open plain devoid of cover exists, without thereby implying
that it cannot be crossed. The French regulations (par. 257), contrary
to the German, contemplate that “only weak detachments be left in the
open, fire swept spaces,” and that the troops intended for the fire
fight be pushed forward under available cover, separate groups being
thus formed.[269]

   [269] This should be an important hint for the opponent. The lines
 of approach may perhaps be sheltered with reference to a certain
 point, but there will always be portions of the enemy’s line from
 which a fire may be directed upon these avenues of approach and the
 troops marching thereon.

“This mode of fighting in groups does away with the continuous firing
lines of the past which no longer fulfill the requirements of modern
battle.

“The rearmost fractions of the force endeavor to avoid open spaces,
or such as are swept by hostile fire, by moving, sometimes in a close
order formation and again widely extended, toward the lines of cover,
without regard to the direction in which the enemy may happen to be.
The unit that finds the advance easiest takes the lead, and all the
others, supported by the fire of their immediate neighbors, endeavor to
follow it.

“Depending upon the character of the terrain and available cover, the
forces deployed for the fire fight will, therefore, advance in a
rather dense formation in the areas favorable for such a procedure,
while weak forces only will be found on open and fire swept ground. The
advance is regulated by designating the objective of the attack and by
stipulating the necessity of mutual coöperation.”

This French group attack owes its existence to the silently accepted
fact that an open plain cannot be crossed when swept by unsubdued
hostile fire; it reckons with an unfavorable terrain such as an
attacker will only find in exceptional cases. We by no means fail to
recognize the fact that individual portions of the attacker’s force,
when favored by the terrain, will be able to advance more quickly than
others, and that other portions may even be compelled to discontinue
their advance for a time; but it seems a precarious proceeding to lay
down this result of the hostile fire effect as a guide in the training
of troops. The group tactics of the Boers stood the test only on the
defensive; they could not prevent individual groups from being attacked
by far superior forces. In an attack, the units favored by the terrain
will constitute the framework upon which the units which are compelled
to advance more slowly, will form. There is, however, danger that these
leading groups will succumb to the superior fire of a defender who is
deployed on a broader front. Although this may not happen, the spirit
of the regulations tempts leaders to drive everything forward, to rush
ahead with isolated parts of the force. An additional drawback of these
systematic group tactics lies in the difficulty of deploying the troops
moving in the narrow avenue of approach. If the French infantry really
desires to avoid the plain and wants to stick principally to cover,
who will guarantee that the great freedom allowed it, will not cause
it to crowd together under cover, lose the direction to its objective,
and become completely mixed up?[270] This danger is the more imminent
since no importance is attached to a more definite limitation of the
frontage to be covered, while wide extension is, on the contrary,
actually preached. The fear of losses will gain the upper hand and
the attack will lose its energy. “It is easy to teach troops to be
over-cautious, but it is a precarious undertaking to lead such troops
against the enemy.” (Sir IAN HAMILTON).

   [270] The plentiful cover along the ravine of the Mance brook was
 by no means an actual advantage for the Ist Army. The 18th of August
 presents the strange phenomenon of the success of the attack on St.
 Privat, made over terrain devoid of cover, and the failure of the
 attack on the French IInd Corps, made over the most favorable terrain
 imaginable.

 Whither such an endeavor to utilize cover must lead, is shown by the
 advance of the 35th Füsilier Regiment past =Vionville= on =Flavigny=
 and the group of trees north of that village. The violent fire
 directed upon these companies caused them to deviate to right and
 left, to leave their battalions, and to lose the march direction
 designated by the regimental commander.[271] One company of the IInd
 Battalion 35th Füsilier Regiment, which formed the center (march
 direction, a point north of Flavigny), participated in the assault
 made on Flavigny by the IIIrd Battalion; the other companies moved to
 the left against Vionville and were joined by a company of the IIIrd
 Battalion.--“A peculiar feature of this fight was the fire directed
 from the group of trees on the attacking force which advanced against
 the center of the hostile position. Ten of the twelve companies of
 the attacking force (3rd, 4th, 5th, 6th, 7th, 8th and 11th of the
 35th Füsilier Regiment, and 9th, 10th and 12th of the 20th Infantry)
 were scattered to right and left by this fire, and forced to move
 in a totally different direction than was originally intended. The
 direction was maintained to a certain extent only by two companies
 (the 3rd and 11th of the 20th Infantry).”[272]

   [271] _Gen. St. W._, I, p. 560.

   [272] V. SCHERFF, _Kriegslehren_, II, p. 106. With a sketch (A)
 showing lines of advance of the companies.

While the new German Infantry Drill Regulations do not underestimate
the difficulties of an advance over open ground, they require that the
march direction be maintained and that cover be utilized only within
the assigned “combat section”; they leave it to subordinate commanders
to choose suitable expedients for crossing such unfavorable ground.
“Within the limits of the section assigned to an organization for an
attack, the plain devoid of cover should be avoided as far as possible,
or weak, widely extended detachments only should be ordered to advance
over it, while the bulk of the force is launched at a point where an
approach under cover is practicable. _If suitable terrain is lacking
to permit this, then the decisive attack must be led over the open
plain._” (Par. 325 German I. D. R.). For purposes of instruction, it
is entirely correct to require “that even on terrain devoid of cover,
well-trained infantry should not open fire until the medium ranges are
reached.” (Par. 326 German I. D. R.). The necessity, when under hostile
fire, of adapting movements to the accidents of the ground, should not
impair the energy of the advance and cause portions of the attacking
force to lag behind, thereby disintegrating it. On the other hand, we
should not be afraid to leave gaps in our attacking line, as the enemy
would, in any case, not be able to use them for his own advance.

Thus we have here the German united attack, on the one hand, and
the French group attack, on the other. Since group tactics no
doubt diminish losses, they should be used in delaying actions, in
holding attacks, and in defense; they should unquestionably not be
employed when a concerted, rapid movement of skirmishers to the front
becomes necessary. How should the Vth Corps at Wörth and the Guard
at St. Privat, for instance, have attacked, according to the French
regulations?




VI. MACHINE GUNS.[273]

   [273] _Exerzierreglement und Schieszvorschrift für die
 Maschinengewehrabteilungen_, 1904.

   Captain BRAUN, _Das Maxim-Maschinengewehr und seine Verwendung_,
 Berlin, 1905.


1. DEVELOPMENT OF THE ARM.

The effect of canister had decreased considerably with the introduction
of rifled guns, and this was the more noticeable, because,
simultaneously therewith, the accuracy and rate of fire of the infantry
rifle was greatly increased. The attempts to re-invest the artillery
with its one-time superiority were directed in two channels: one aimed
at perfecting shrapnel, which had been rather neglected up to this
time (England, Prussia, Austria), while the other resurrected the
mediaeval idea of the “barrel-organ gun,” with a view of assembling a
number of rifle barrels and of combining thereby the accuracy of the
small arm with the moral effect of canister. Thus, among others, the
4-10 barreled _Gatling_ gun was invented in America in 1861, it being
the oldest representative of this type of weapon. In order to obtain
a weapon matching the Prussian _needle_ gun, Bavaria adopted the 4
barreled _Feldl_ gun and France the 25 barreled _mitrailleuse_.[274]
The name _canon à balles_, which was given the gun, sufficed to
indicate the manner in which it was intended to be used. As these guns
frequently failed in action, offered the same target and required the
same equipment and approximately the same road space as field guns,
the states who had first adopted them, finally decided to dispense
with them on European theaters of war. The further development of
machine guns was not especially accelerated by the fact that the French
_mitrailleuses_ had not fulfilled the expectations entertained for
them during the Franco-German war, isolated cases excepted,[275] and
that they were quickly silenced by the German artillery, which was
equipped only with percussion shell, as soon as their position was
ascertained. Thus, these guns seemed useful only in colonial wars and
on board war ships for warding off torpedo boats. Although they took up
very little room when in position, they were not considered useful for
flank defense in fortresses, on account of the frequent breakdowns. In
addition to their height, other defects developed; for example, they
could obtain only a very insignificant rate of fire, betrayed their
position by the powder smoke, and lacked the means for ascertaining
ranges.

   [274] The 25 barreled _mitrailleuse_, cal. 13 mm., fired volleys at
 the rate of 125 rounds per minute. Its fire was considered equivalent
 to that of 50 needle guns; its weight was 1,485 kg., each of its
 four horses pulling 371 kg.; its maximum range was 3,000 m. Its most
 favorable, practical range 500-1,500 m.--A glaring defect of the
 gun was that fire pauses occurred whenever cartridges were fed into
 the slot and that the lateral spread of its cone of dispersion was
 extremely small.

   [275] Battle of Gravelotte. _Gen. St. W._, pp. 705-712, 723 and
 781. The employment of three Gatling guns in rear of the park wall
 of Yoré, during the defense of the plateau of Auvours. (_Revue
 d’artillerie_, 1900, p. 297; _Gen. St. W._, IV, p. 817).

The situation changed entirely when a practicable, smokeless powder
was invented, and Hiram Maxim, an American, succeeded in utilizing the
energy of the recoil (a factor neglected up to that time, although
annoying to the marksman) for opening the breech, inserting a fresh
cartridge into the chamber, closing the breech, and automatically
firing the piece.[276] Through this invention it became possible to
fire a maximum of 900 and an average of 500 rounds per minute, from a
single barrel moving laterally back and forth. The desire to obtain a
still greater rate of fire was checked effectively, because of the fact
that with such an increase the danger of jamming increased and the use
of infantry ammunition was precluded. The water in the jacket continues
to be a decided drawback to this type of gun, for it is not always
easily procured, impairs the mechanism by freezing, makes it difficult
to change barrels, and constitutes a considerable weight. If cooling
the barrel by means of water were to be dispensed with, the accuracy of
the piece would rapidly diminish, and, after 1000 rounds of continuous
fire, bullets would tumble even at short ranges. At the present time
water is still the most effective means of cooling the barrel.[277]

   [276] Of the other types the following may here be mentioned:
 _Hotchkiss_ (France), insufficient cooling of the barrel by air;
 _Schwarzlose_ (Austria), machine gun model 7, a very simple weapon
 which has only a single spring.

   [277] In the _Colt_ Machine Gun, which is not water-cooled, after
 500 rounds had been fired, a cartridge inserted into the piece
 exploded in seven seconds, and cartridges placed in the chamber a
 quarter of an hour later exploded in 20 seconds.

Machine guns fire ordinary small arms ammunition carried in loops on a
canvass belt (weighing 1 kg. when empty), which is generally capable
of holding 250 rounds of 8 mm. cartridges weighing 8.315 kg. These
belts are very carefully manufactured, the material being shrunk, so
as to prevent their shrinking when in use. Two men can refill an empty
belt with 8 mm. cartridges in seven minutes, according to Swedish
experiments, while a belt filling machine can refill one in a still
shorter time. The rate of fire of machine guns is approximately 500
rounds per minute. They are variously mounted,[278] according to
circumstances, on sleds (in which the gun rests on a frame similar
to that of a wheelbarrow), on tripods, or, for mountain warfare, on
basket frames. Although the greatest readiness for firing was obtained
with guns mounted on cavalry carriages (two-wheeled carts, similar to
limbers, and equipped with shafts), which also permitted the greatest
amount of ammunition to be carried along, these guns offered such a
high target that their use, in an infantry action, was entirely out of
the question, leading only to their being quickly silenced. Another
defect was that the guns were unable to follow immediately upon the
heels of the organization to which they were attached. Guns mounted
on light tripods possess the least readiness for firing, as the gun
must be dismounted during each change of position; but tripods are
indispensable in mountain warfare. In India a tripod frame on wheels
is employed. The basket frame, which is very light and is carried on
the back of a soldier, affords nothing but a rest for the gun. This
type of mount has the disadvantage of necessitating, in reality,
freehand firing when the barrel is supported near the muzzle; that
the operator, when firing continuously, becomes greatly fatigued,
and that the accuracy suffers in consequence thereof. The advantages
of the tripod and the wheeled carriage have been skillfully combined
in the carriage adopted in Germany. In this the gun rests on a sled;
this is in turn supported by the carriage proper, which is wheeled.
In exceptional cases the gun may be fired from the carriage, but
ordinarily it is fired from the sled, which is detached from the
carriage for that purpose. This sled permits the gun to be laid at any
desired height and enables it to follow the infantry anywhere during an
action.[279]

   [278]

 British cavalry machine gun with mount                   152.3 kg.
 Machine gun with tripod       }               16.5 + 18 = 34.5  „
 Machine gun with basket frame } latest model              35.0  „
 Machine gun with sled         }               16.5 + 24 = 40.5  „

   [279] The following complement per gun is considered necessary:

 Germany       14¹⁄₂ men   9 horses.
 Switzerland    8¹⁄₂ men  12 horses.

 In the Russo-Japanese war the machine gun detachments of the Russian
 cavalry were equipped with _Rexer_ guns which can scarcely be
 considered machine guns owing to their slow rate of fire and extreme
 heating of the barrel.

Machine guns can be transported upon larger vehicles capable of
being unlimbered; they can also be carried on pack horses or other
pack animals, and for short distances by men. Although pack animal
transportation enables the guns to follow the troops anywhere, the
amount of ammunition that can be carried along is limited, and the
opening of fire is retarded, since gun and tripod must first be
assembled; the opening of fire may even be delayed when a pack animal
falls; ammunition cannot be carried on the gun; and the animals get
sore backs even if pack saddles are carefully adjusted.


2. THE POWER OF MACHINE GUNS.

The machine gun is noted for its adaptability to any terrain, and the
constancy of its high rate of fire as compared with that of a body of
infantry, which decreases with the range, the diminishing visibility
of the target, and prolonged fire. On the other hand, a single jamming
can make a machine gun valueless, at least for the time being. For
this reason, the Germans employ machine guns only in platoons, as a
rule, and the Swiss let both guns of a platoon fire simultaneously
only in exceptional cases. Theoretically, the maximum rate of fire of
600 rounds per minute will rarely be attained; and 200-300 rounds per
minute will usually suffice against prone targets. In Germany volley
and continuous fire are employed; fire by a single piece is used only
to ward off patrols when the machine guns do not want to betray their
position.[280]

   [280] The following kinds of fire are used in the countries named
 below:

   Austria: Single shots; volleys (20-25 rounds); fire by a single
 piece.

   Switzerland: Fire by a single piece; volleys (20-30 rounds); rapid
 fire (volleys of 100 rounds); and fire at will (both pieces of a
 platoon simultaneously employing rapid fire). The last-named is
 only employed in exceptional cases, for example, when the danger is
 imminent and when favorable opportunities offer.

A volley consists of about 25 rounds and is followed by a pause for
observing the effect of the fire. It is employed in adjusting the fire
upon difficult targets in rolling country. Fire for effect consists,
as a general rule, of “continuous fire,” and is interrupted only when
the tactical situation requires it. The water in the jacket should be
renewed and oiling attended to during the pauses in the fire, whether
these grow out of the tactical situation, or are made necessary by
technical considerations.

The fire is either directed upon a point (concentrated fire), the
elevation and direction of the piece being fixed, or it is distributed
over the entire target or over a designated part of the same (sweeping,
and progressive fire).[281]

   [281] For example, when sweeping the crest of the parapet of a line
 of trenches, or the edge of a wood, both hands move the gun slowly
 and evenly from side to side. When searching an area in the direction
 of depth and obliquely (progressive fire with sweeping), the left
 hand gives the gun the proper horizontal direction, while the right
 manipulates the slow motion elevating gear. When firing on rapidly
 moving targets--for example skirmish lines advancing by rushes--or
 targets advancing over rolling country, both the traversing and
 elevating movements may be unclamped. The rapidity with which the gun
 is moved, when sweeping or searching, depends upon the range and the
 kind of target on which the fire is directed. As a rule, the piece
 is moved slowly and steadily. The accuracy of the fire is impaired
 when the gun is moved too rapidly. When the fire is well observed,
 it might be advantageous, in exceptional cases, when firing against
 either stationary or moving targets, to direct the gun, without
 aiming, after the bullets have been seen to hit their mark, by
 properly manipulating the elevating and traversing apparatus while
 the firing is in progress.

The ballistic properties of the gun are the same as those of the
infantry rifle.[282]

   [282] The destructive power of the projectiles fired from a machine
 gun, as they strike within a small space, is, of course, much greater
 than that of the scattered projectiles of a body of infantry. Trees
 having a circumference of 30 cm. are felled by machine gun fire in
 about 15 seconds at a range of 450 m.

In the machine gun an important factor in the dispersion of infantry
fire--flinching and errors in aiming--is eliminated, while the heating
of its barrel and the vibrations of its carriage in continuous fire do
not produce a corresponding increase in dispersion. On this account
the cone of dispersion of the machine gun is more compact than that
of the infantry rifle and its accuracy at long ranges is therefore
considerably greater than that of the latter.[283] Firing tests
indicate that the accuracy of machine gun fire diminishes only very
slightly with increasing range, provided the appropriate elevation is
used.[284]

   [283] According to Austrian experiments the depth of the beaten
 zone of a machine gun is only ¹⁄₃ to ¹⁄₂ that produced by the fire of
 a platoon of infantry.

   [284] The following average results were obtained in experiments
 made at the Musketry School, while firing on infantry targets
 advancing alternately at quick and double time:

 At ranges from 2000-1600 m.   1.72% hits
  „   „     „   1500-1200 m.   2.53%  „

 Firing against disappearing head targets placed at intervals of
 0.60-0.70 m.:

 At 600-800  m.   1.89% hits „  800-1100 m.   1.69%  „

 In firing first with an elevation of 1800, then with one of 1750 m.
 (the range being 2000-1600 m. and 254 rounds being expended per gun),
 on 50 advancing, kneeling targets, placed at intervals of 1 m. 3.10%
 hits were obtained and 52% figures were placed out of action in 1¹⁄₂
 minutes.

 In firing at the same targets for 2¹⁄₃ minutes, with an elevation of
 1900 m. (304 rounds expended), the result dropped to 0.3% hits and
 8.3% figures placed out of action.

In war the influence of the compact cone of dispersion will be still
more potent, for we will then have to reckon with a single, specially
selected machine gun marksman who is well protected, while the
excitement of battle will produce a far different impression upon an
organization composed of men differing materially from each other. The
compactness of the cone of dispersion of the machine gun requires
that the appropriate elevation be used if the fire is to be effective
against well concealed prone skirmishers. This can be accomplished only
in part by employing range finders. Since the probable error of these
instruments is ±5% of the range, this determination is so inaccurate
for machine gun fire that nothing remains but to increase the
dispersion artificially. When it is impossible to observe the strike of
the bullets, the dispersion may be artificially increased by employing
combined sights, two in a single platoon and three in a machine gun
battery (company), and above all by sweeping. The employment of
combined sights would appear to be too rigid a method; sweeping fire is
at any rate better.[285]

   [285] Lieutenant-General ROHNE, _Schieszlehre_, 2nd Ed. p. 185, et
 seq.

From general ballistic data, Lieutenant-General ROHNE[286] computes
that the following results would be obtained by a machine gun and a
detachment of skirmishers when firing with the appropriate elevation at
a broad target 1 m. high:--

             Machine     Detachment
               gun     of skirmishers
 At  500 m.   32.4       16.8% hits
 „  1000 „    15.3        8.1%  „
 „  1500 „    10.2        5.1%  „
 „  2000 „     6.4        3.2%  „

   [286] _Jahrbücher für Armee und Marine_, 1901, IV, p. 268.

This nearly double superiority is reversed, however, when the
appropriate elevation is not used:

 ======+========================================================
       |Firing on a target 1 m. high, the following percentages
       | of hits may be expected when the error in estimating
       |                     the range is--
 Range.|     50 m.   |    100 m.   |    150 m.   |    200 m.
       +-------+-----+-------+-----+-------+-----+-------+------
       |Machine|Skir-|Machine|Skir-|Machine|Skir-|Machine|Skir-
       | guns. |mish-| guns. |mish-| guns. |mish-| guns. |mish-
   m.  |       | ers.|       | ers.|       | ers.|       | ers.
 ------+-------+-----+-------+-----+-------+-----+-------+------
  500  |  27.5 | 16.0|  19.0 | 13.8|   7.0 | 11.7|   1.3 | 7.3
 1000  |   9.2 |  6.8|   2.0 |  4.8|   0.2 |  2.7|   --  | 1.0
 1500  |   3.6 |  3.9|   0.2 |  1.8|    -- |  0.5|   --  | 0.1
 2000  |   1.7 |  2.2|    -- |  0.8|    -- |  0.2|   --  |  --
 ------+-------+-----+-------+-----+-------+-----+-------+------

From this it follows that the good qualities of the machine gun can be
utilized to the fullest advantage only when the appropriate elevation
is used. When this is not accurately known, the fire effect of the
machine gun drops down to zero more quickly than that of a skirmish
line. Where local conditions are at all favorable, the determination of
the appropriate elevation is facilitated by observing the strike of the
projectiles in “volley fire.”

 According to British firing tests, at ranges from 500-1000 yards an
 error of estimation of 100 yards, reduces the effect of the fire
 50 per cent. According to firing tests 75% of all shots fired by a
 machine gun and body of infantry are distributed as follows:

 =====+==================+==================+====================
      |   Machine gun.   |   Detachment of  |Errors of estimation
      |                  |     infantry.    | permissible for the
  At  |Depth of 75% strip|Depth of 75% strip|    machine gun.
  m.  |       m.         |        m.        |        m.
 -----+------------------+------------------+--------------------
  450 |      112         |       192        |     54 = 12 %
  900 |       63         |       108        |     31 = 3.5%
 1350 |       54         |        90        |     27 = 2  %
 1800 |       67         |       140        |     31 = 1.8%
 -----+------------------+------------------+--------------------

It is clearly apparent that the permissible error of the range finder
is smaller than the depth of the vertical dispersion strip covered by
75% of the bullets.

The difficulty of hitting a target lodged in some feature of the
terrain requires that the machine gun be used first of all against
large targets that are visible for a short time only. When the
appropriate elevation is used, a decisive effect may be confidently
counted on within a short space of time; when an inappropriate
elevation is used and the fire is not properly observed, only
accidental hits can, as a rule, be expected, even when the fire
is directed on tall, dense targets. When the fire is directed on
skirmishers lying down, the effect produced is not commensurate with
the amount of ammunition expended, and a slight error in the elevation
used may nullify the effect entirely. A straight line of trenches,
which is plainly visible, is, on the other hand, an eminently favorable
target. The heating of the barrel, and the difficulty of replenishing
ammunition and renewing the water in the jacket, tend to work against a
participation of machine guns in a protracted fire fight. The machine
gun is not at all suited for carrying on a prolonged fire action.

It is very difficult to determine the relative combat value of a body
of infantry as compared with that of a machine gun. One will not be far
wrong in placing this value between 50 and 60 men.

In experimental field firing at the Swiss Infantry Musketry School, it
was demonstrated that 30-40 skirmishers almost in every case rapidly
gained the upper hand over a machine gun in the open, at 900 m., but
that the infantrymen had small chances of success when the position of
the machine gun could not be accurately determined. In Switzerland a
machine gun is considered equivalent to 50 infantrymen. Skirmishers are
the most difficult target for machine guns to fight, and, at the same
time, they are the most dangerous. When the fire is well observed, a
good effect can, indeed, still be counted on, when the fire is directed
at prone skirmishers at ranges up to 1000 m., but this is not true when
the fire cannot be observed; in the last mentioned case, no effect
worth mentioning is produced.

 =Austria.= In a field firing test (which was repeated four times)
 between a machine gun (gun pointer covered by a shield) and 30
 infantrymen, the following results were obtained at 600 m. in 1¹⁄₂
 minutes:

 Infantrymen   120 rounds   10 hits (9%)
 Machine gun   215   „      14  „   (7%)[287]

   [287] Firing tests of the Army Musketry School at Bruck, a.d.
 Leitha, 1905. _Streffleur_, Apl. 1906, p. 524.

 =England.= At the Infantry School at Hythe, in a firing test at 300
 yards, lasting 5 minutes--perhaps the longest period during which
 continuous fire is possible--the power of a Maxim gun was found to
 be equivalent to 60 rifles. In field firing this comparative power
 dropped down to 25-35 rifles. In this connection, it should be
 borne in mind that moral influences do not make themselves felt in
 firing under peace conditions, and that, on the other hand, a single
 favorable hit can place the machine gun out of action for a long
 period, while the skirmishers can keep up the fire.


3. INFANTRY VERSUS MACHINE GUNS.

It will rarely be possible to concentrate upon a machine gun battery
of six guns a fire equivalent to its own. Because of the small
target offered by machine guns, it is necessary for a firing line to
concentrate its fire upon one machine gun at a time, thus gradually
silencing the battery in detail. This procedure is feasible because
it is very difficult for the machine guns to reach with their fire
all parts of a well concealed skirmish line. The normal relation,
unfavorable for the infantry, changes in its favor, however, as machine
guns cannot keep up a high rate of fire for a prolonged period, even
when nothing is considered but ammunition supply; as serious breaks are
especially apt to occur when the gun is worked to its maximum capacity;
and as the ammunition expended in one minute (3600 rounds) cannot
produce an effect unless not only the correct range but also the proper
elevation is accurately known.

The fight against machine guns may be advantageously conducted
according to the following principles:[288]

1. Infantry skirmishers should conceal themselves so well that it will
be difficult for the hostile machine gun battery to find them. Color of
immediate vicinity (shade) and background should be considered; platoon
and other leaders must not stand upright; objects that are clearly
visible should be avoided.

2. It should be made difficult for the hostile machine guns to observe
their fire (ricochets) and to measure the range. (No prominent features
that would facilitate such measurements should be located near the
infantry position).

3. The firing line, as far as this is possible, should not be
continuous; the several parts of the line should be posted in echelon.

4. Kinds of fire: Lively fire at will should be used.

5. Expenditure of ammunition: At least 600 rounds should be expended
against each machine gun.

6. At the outset a single company should concentrate its fire upon a
single machine gun, picking out the one that is most clearly visible.
Machine guns on the flanks are not good targets, as a strong wind may
deflect the fire directed upon them.

   [288] Switzerland: Machine guns, “on account of their small gun
 squads, are more sensitive to losses than artillery. They cannot
 adjust their fire so easily as artillery, but, when once on the
 target, the effect of their fire is great.

   “The principles governing the combat against artillery are
 applicable, in general, to the fight against machine guns. It may be
 assumed that at medium ranges, one platoon of infantry will suffice
 for silencing one machine gun, provided the platoon of infantry
 fights the action under favorable conditions. At short ranges, a few
 good marksmen suffice for silencing a machine gun. For this reason
 selected men are sent forward, when the situation permits, to sneak
 up to the machine guns and to pick off the men serving them.”

The following rules, governing the conduct of infantry when exposed to
machine gun fire, may be deduced from the above:

Even skirmish lines cannot continue their advance over terrain devoid
of cover, when exposed within a range of 1500 m. to the unsubdued fire
of machine guns; nothing remains but for them to lie down, and to gain
ground to the front in groups, or one by one.

The same is true of route columns. They can only deploy to the right
and left front at double time, and take cover.

The most unsuitable formation under machine gun fire is the column of
platoons, whether lying down or in motion.[289]

   [289] Within ³⁄₄ to 1 minute a column of platoons (lying down)
 sustained an average of 4.22% hits at 1400 m. and 4.31% hits at
 900-1100 m. with 42 and 32%, respectively, figures placed out of
 action.

If the column of platoons is reached by effective machine gun fire,
when lying down, line must be formed. The men must not rise, however,
to execute this movement, but the platoons should crawl forward into
line. For the men to rise would mean annihilation.

The low target offered by machine guns makes them a difficult target
for field artillery to hit, in spite of the accuracy with which the
latter can adjust its fire.


4. MACHINE GUNS IN GERMANY.

The German machine gun (drawn by 4 horses driven from the saddle) is
mounted upon a sled which forms the firing frame. On the march, this
sled is placed on a wheeled carriage, from which it must first be
detached (10-15 seconds) before the gun is used; in exceptional cases,
the gun can be fired from the wheeled carriage.

The gun commander is mounted. Two of the gunners are seated on the axle
chest of the carriage, their carbines buckled to the gun carriage; two
are seated on the limber chest, their carbines slung over their backs.
When surprised by a direct attack, all the men that can be spared form
as skirmishers in the intervals between the guns of the machine gun
battery. The machine gun can be served by a single man. The water in
the jacket need not necessarily be renewed when the gun is fired for a
short time only.

The machine guns can be used on any terrain passable for infantry. When
detached from the wheeled carriage they can even surmount considerable
obstacles. In action, they present no larger target than skirmishers
fighting under similar conditions, and are capable of offering more
resistance than infantry.

The sled can be carried or drawn by the men for short distances. The
ammunition, placed in belts holding 250 rounds each, and packed in six
boxes, is similarly drawn on an ammunition sled. If the conditions
permit, the guns may be drawn by horses.

The “fighting battery” consists of six guns, formed into three
platoons, and an ammunition platoon (three ammunition wagons and one
store wagon); the combat train consists of officers’ and other led
horses. The field train consists of one baggage wagon, one ration
(commissary) wagon, one forage wagon, and a second store wagon.

[Illustration: Machine Guns in Germany.

Lead Team Hitched to Gun.

Carrying the Machine Guns.]

The movements and gaits of a machine gun battery are the same as those
of a field battery: the order in line, at close or extended intervals,
in which the guns are abreast, the intervals between them, measured
from center to center, being 5 and 17 paces, respectively. The order in
line, at extended intervals, is used in moving to the front or rear;
the order in line, at close intervals, for assembly, for movements in
that formation, for parking, and for parade. The section column[290] is
the principal maneuver formation on the battlefield; it is employed as
an assembly formation on a road, and as route column. (Par. 320 German
F. S. R.). In section column the guns follow each other at a distance
of four paces. In addition to this column, a column of platoons is
used, in which the platoons follow each other at a distance of 22
paces. (This may be reduced to 6 paces).

   [290] The guns are placed in rear of each other, the ammunition
 wagons and other vehicles bring up the rear. _Translator_.

A machine gun battery has available 87,300 rounds of ammunition (10,500
rounds with each gun and 8100 rounds in each ammunition wagon, or a
total of 14,550 rounds per gun), which may be drawn forward to the
firing position upon sleds, in boxes holding 250 rounds each. The
ammunition wagons are refilled from the ammunition wagons of the light
ammunition columns of the cavalry division and from the wagons of the
infantry ammunition columns marked with a red stripe, which carry
ammunition for machine gun units. A reserve machine gun is carried with
the ammunition column.

The machine gun battery combines high infantry fire power
(approximately equivalent to that of the skirmishers of a German
cavalry regiment, armed with carbines, or to that of 4-6 platoons of
infantry)[291] with instant readiness for firing, and a mobility which
enables it to follow the mounted arms anywhere. The chance of producing
a sudden fire effect within a short space of time must be especially
utilized, and, therefore, an endeavor should be made to put entire
machine gun batteries into the first line. The employment of single
guns is precluded owing to the danger of breakdowns, and the employment
of platoons is especially proper on the defensive as well as in action
at short range.

   [291] A German cavalry regiment at peace strength numbers from 552
 to 576 sabers: a platoon of infantry (on a peace footing) numbers
 from 48 to 53 men.

   In making a comparison between a cavalry regiment and a machine gun
 battery, it must be borne in mind that horse holders are deducted
 from the strength given for a cavalry regiment. _Translator_.

[Illustration: Order in Line

(extended intervals).]

[Illustration: Column of Platoons

(closed up).]

[Illustration: Section Column.

(Route Column).]

[Illustration: Explanation of Symbols used:]

[Illustration: Order in Line

(close intervals).]

The duties of machine guns naturally grow out of their tactical
advantages. Their fire power should be saved for decisive moments, when
the development of strong fire power at short ranges is requisite, and
when the available time and the situation do not permit of pushing
infantry into action. The machine gun batteries, which constitute
an independent arm, and which are assigned to cavalry and infantry
divisions, are best adapted for these duties.

The heavy matériel and the teams designed for rapid movements make the
machine gun battery less suited for employment in infantry combat,
where such a high degree of mobility is not so necessary. In the
battle on the Shaho an employment of machine guns by platoons in
the first line, came about quite naturally. The guns prepared the
assault, reinforced weak points, and supported the advance. In Germany,
provisional machine gun companies consisting of six two-horse machine
guns, driven from the carriage (these guns cannot be fired from their
carriages), have been adopted for this purpose. These machine gun
companies are principally an auxiliary weapon of the infantry, and,
distributed by platoons to the battalions, or sent into action as a
single unit by the regimental commander, they serve the purpose of
augmenting the fire of the infantry.

Movements at increased gaits are possible in exceptional cases only;
as a rule, the guns follow the infantry at a walk, and in combats
terminating in a defeat, it may frequently be impossible to keep them
from falling into the hands of the enemy. The permanent assignment of
machine guns to battalions does not seem to be advisable.


5. GOING INTO POSITION.

The principles which govern the reconnaissance and occupation of a
position by field artillery are applicable also to machine guns.
The tactical situation determines whether the guns should move
into position under cover or in the open. As a rule, the interval
between two adjacent machine guns in line is 17 paces; but the proper
utilization of favorable cover does not preclude posting the guns close
together. It may likewise be advantageous to post the guns in echelon
on the flanks.

In action the carriages remain, as a rule, in the nearest cover in
rear of the line. The advance from this point is effected by the men
carrying or dragging the detached guns and ammunition sleds; under
certain circumstances, it may also be advisable to have the guns
or ammunition sleds drawn forward by single horses (mounts of gun
commanders). On level ground the ammunition platoon and the wheeled
carriages of the machine guns take post in rear of and as close as
possible to the guns. Whether the two groups are combined, or whether
the machine gun carriages should occupy the nearest, and the ammunition
wagons the more distant cover, depends upon the available cover. The
commander of the machine gun carriages sends full ammunition sleds
to the firing line at an early moment and has empty boxes and belts
brought back.

[Illustration: A Machine Gun Platoon Crawling Into Position.]

[Illustration: Range Finder. A Machine Gun Platoon in Position.]

[Illustration: A Machine Gun Platoon Intrenched.]


6. THE FIRE FIGHT.

 The machine gun. squad consists of one gun commander and four
 gunners, numbers 1-4; number 2 is the gun pointer. The gun commander
 sees that the gun is set up for the prone, sitting, or kneeling fire
 position, according to the terrain, supervises the service of the
 gun, which can be served in any position of the body, and removes all
 obstructions that interfere with its effective use. The gun pointer
 handles the gun, _i.e._, he loads it, sets the sight, aims and fires
 it. No. 3, who lies to the right of the gun pointer, assists the
 latter in these duties, places a box of ammunition on the right of
 the gun, and feeds the ammunition belt into the slot. When necessary,
 he takes the place of the gun pointer. No. 1 lies in rear of the gun
 pointer, keeps his eye on the battery and platoon commanders, and
 transmits their orders to the gun commander and gun pointer. No. 4
 has charge of the replenishment of ammunition; he takes cover or lies
 down 20 paces in rear of, or on a flank of the gun.

 The range finders, without special orders to that effect, measure
 the range to targets as they appear, or to fixed points, and call
 it out to the battery commander. The battery commander designates
 the target, the range, and the kind of fire to be used. The platoon
 commanders assign a section of the target to each of their guns,
 designate the elevation that is to be used, and supervise the service
 of the guns; they are especially held responsible that the fire
 is directed upon the proper target. Platoon commanders constantly
 observe through their field glasses the strike of the bullets and
 the enemy. The commander of the gun carriages is charged with their
 supervision; he constantly sends forward ammunition, and, when
 necessary, men and matériel, into the firing position. When the
 detached guns change position, he follows the movement under cover
 with the gun carriages, bringing them as close to the firing position
 as possible.

 After machine gun batteries had been employed at maneuvers as an
 auxiliary arm of the cavalry, they did especially good work in the
 fights in Southwest Africa,[292] where they were not opposed by
 artillery.

   [292] _Militär-Wochenblatt_, 1904, Nos. 136, 139 and 140.

 Through their ability to follow a skirmish line into the densest
 thickets, they were a valuable support to the infantry in the close
 country in which the African fights took place, where artillery of
 necessity had to fail owing to absence of a clear field of view. It
 was demonstrated, however, that the machine gun squads became so
 engrossed in the work of serving their guns that supporting troops
 had to guard them against surprise.

 In the engagement at the =Waterberg=, the machine guns did splendid
 work in meeting, with an effective volley fire, the sudden, energetic
 attacks made by the Hereros against the flank and rear of the
 Germans. In two critical moments, during the attack against the left
 flank of the advance guard, and during the attack made with a yell
 against the right and rear of headquarters, it was principally due
 to the machine guns that the enemy, who had come within short range,
 was repulsed. Participants of this fight believed that the Hereros
 did not dare to make a real attack when machine guns went into action
 against them. It had been impossible to avoid using single machine
 guns. Just as the enemy was making an attack upon the 11th Company,
 machine gun No. 3 (2nd Machine Gun Battery), which had done splendid
 work, broke down. This was the only case of jamming that occurred.
 Although exposed to a galling hostile fire, the gun commander managed
 to change barrels in 30 seconds, and then to resume the firing. The
 2nd Machine Gun Battery expended 20,775 rounds of ammunition; the
 expenditure of the different guns varied between 7350 and 120 rounds,
 according to the part taken by them in the action. The ammunition
 supply was certain and steady; no shortage of ammunition, not even a
 temporary one, occurred anywhere.


7. MACHINE GUNS IN OTHER COUNTRIES.

 =Switzerland.= In 1892 Switzerland began to organize four mounted
 Maxim machine gun companies, which were assigned to the weak
 cavalry brigades (consisting of six troops[293]) on account of the
 defensive role of the Swiss cavalry and the lack of batteries of
 horse artillery. Three machine gun companies were assigned to the
 fortifications on the St. Gotthard and one to St. Moritz for the
 purpose of augmenting the fire of the advanced positions belonging to
 those fortifications, and to cover the approaches thereto.

   [293] Eskadrons.

 A Maxim machine gun company consists of 6 officers, 105
 non-commissioned officers and privates, 99 horses (24 pack horses
 and 24 draft horses), 8 guns mounted on tripods, and 7 vehicles (two
 of these are two-horse supply and baggage wagons, one four-horse
 field forge with field kitchen, 4 two-horse ammunition wagons, each
 carrying 15,520 rounds of ammunition). The guns and the ammunition
 are carried on pack animals. A packed gun horse carries a load of 108
 kg. inclusive of 5 kg. of oats. An ammunition horse carries a load
 of 123 kg. inclusive of 5 kg. of oats and 8 ammunition boxes (each
 holding 250 rounds, or a total of 2000 rounds weighing 90.5 kg.). A
 machine gun company of eight guns is divided into four platoons, each
 consisting of two guns and four ammunition horses, and the combat
 train, consisting of four ammunition wagons and the field kitchen.
 Every gun is commanded by a “gun chief,” and two of the five men
 belonging to the gun squad are horse holders. After the command
 “halt” has been given, 1-1¹⁄₂ minutes are required to get the gun
 ready for firing. The company carries 5940 rounds of ammunition for
 each gun.

[Illustration: Switzerland.

Machine Gun and Ammunition Horse.

Gun Commander and Gun Ready to Fire.]

 Route column from line is formed by the guns moving successively
 in the proper direction, the two ammunition pack animals following
 directly in rear of the gun to which they belong. The company takes
 up a road space of 150 m. For movements off the road the company may
 move in “mass,” or with the platoons in “combat formation.” When
 in “mass” the platoons, each in route column, are abreast, with
 intervals of 10-20 paces between them. When the platoons are in
 “combat formation,” the two guns of each are placed abreast at equal
 intervals.

[Illustration: Platoon In Route Column.]

 The three machine gun companies assigned to the line of
 fortifications consist of two to three platoons, each of four guns.
 A platoon consists of 2 officers and 60 non-commissioned officers
 and privates. The men are armed with rifles and equipped with alpine
 sticks. “Gun carriers” (_Waffenwarte_) carry the gun basket, which
 weighs 33 kg. The weight of the water in the jacket is only 1 kg.
 “Ammunition carriers” (_Munitionswarte_) carry the ammunition in
 specially constructed frames, each man carrying 500 rounds.

 Kinds of fire: “_Fire by a single gun_” is employed at the opening of
 an action to drive away patrols and reconnoitering officers, when it
 is not desired to betray the presence of machine guns to the enemy.

 “_Volley fire_” is the usual fire employed by machine guns and
 corresponds to the volley fire of infantry. After the target and the
 elevation have been designated, the platoon commander directs that
 fire he opened by calling the name of the gun pointer who is to fire.
 A pause is made after every series of 20-30 shots, which is used to
 make necessary corrections.

 As soon as the proper elevation has been determined, “_rapid fire_”
 is opened. In this the _guns of a platoon fire alternately_. The fire
 is delivered in series of 100 rounds, and the time during which one
 of the guns is not firing is utilized by the non-commissioned officer
 with it to examine and oil the mechanism.

 The “_fire at will_” (continuous fire) of the machine guns
 corresponds to the magazine fire of the infantry. _All the guns fire
 simultaneously_ series of 50 to 100 rounds, interrupting the fire for
 a moment at the end of each series for the purpose of examining and
 oiling the mechanism; then they resume the fire with a new series of
 50 to 100 rounds. On account of the great expenditure of ammunition
 entailed, and also in order to prevent the premature deterioration
 of the matériel, fire at will is used in exceptional cases only, for
 example, when danger is imminent, or when favorable opportunities
 offer.

 “_Progressive fire_” may be employed against narrow, deep targets,
 when the range could not be accurately determined. It may also be
 employed for searching an area 100-200 m. deep.

 =Austria= has begun to organize _cavalry and mountain machine gun
 batteries_ consisting of four guns each. The machine gun Model 7
 (_Schwarzlose_), with pack animal equipment, has been adopted. The
 gun horse carries 500, and each of the two ammunition horses, 1500
 rounds of ammunition. During mobilization two ammunition horses
 are to be added for each gun. Mountain machine gun batteries are
 similarly organized; each ammunition horse carries 2000 rounds of
 ammunition. On the gun itself, and on the gun frame, 44 belts, each
 holding 250 rounds, or a total of 11,000 rounds, are carried.[294]

   [294] The Schwarzlose machine gun weighs 18 kg. exclusive of frame
 and the water in the jacket. (The Maxim weighs 28 kg.).

 The formations employed by the cavalry machine gun batteries are the
 order in line (at close intervals), the combat order, and the route
 column.

 The mountain machine gun batteries, carrying guns and ammunition
 upon pack horses, are equipped with tripod and basket mounts. These
 machine gun batteries combine the system of mounting and carrying
 employed by the Swiss cavalry and mountain machine gun companies.
 Three pack animals are employed to transport each gun with its
 ammunition. The gun squad consists of three men. Officers and
 non-commissioned officers are mounted; the other men of the battery
 are not. Unpacking the guns, posting them, and getting them in
 readiness for firing, is managed in a similar manner as in the Swiss
 machine gun companies.

 The gun adopted for _infantry machine gun batteries_ is the light and
 simple Schwarzlose machine gun, Model 7.

             Springs   Parts of breech   Screws & Pins   Weights
 Maxim          14           35                52        27.5 kg.
 Schwarzlose     1           11                13        17.5 „

 Tripod mounts and pack animal transportation are necessary in view
 of Austrian theaters of war. The batteries consist of four machine
 guns.

 “The great length of modern battle fronts, and the gaps and local
 combats along the latter, would seem to make a distribution of
 machine guns along the entire front desirable. Attention is thereby
 directed to organizing the machine guns to be employed with the
 infantry as ‘Regimental Machine Guns.’ Such an organization would
 best ensure the training of this new arm for the infantry combat and
 the prompt attainment of an understanding of its employment.

 “In the cavalry, the difficulties of organizing, training, and
 employing machine guns are considerably greater than in the infantry.
 These difficulties are best overcome by organizing the machine guns
 assigned to cavalry into independent batteries, and placing them at
 the disposal of the higher cavalry commanders.

 “In determining upon the size of the machine gun batteries attached
 to infantry, an attempt should be made to combine minimum size with
 adequate fire effect and maximum mobility. Two machine guns would
 seem to be almost the maximum number that should be posted at one
 point in an infantry action. From a tactical point of view, it is,
 moreover, undesirable to post a greater number at one point, because
 gun shields, steam, etc. would frequently form too prominent a
 target, for the hostile artillery to forego firing on it promptly and
 with telling effect.

 “In connection with the desire for more than two machine guns in each
 infantry and Jäger organization--about two guns per battalion--the
 tremendous increase in ammunition trains should be considered. It
 would also be well to bear in mind that we have, as a matter of fact,
 not even become accustomed to the numerous ammunition columns of our
 rapid fire artillery.

 “In the cavalry, the necessity of dividing a machine gun battery
 for the purpose of assigning the parts thereof to brigades, and
 of assigning machine guns to reconnaissance and other independent
 detachments, must be reckoned with. When we bear in mind that single
 machine guns are to be used only in exceptional cases, the machine
 gun battery intended for the cavalry cannot well be made smaller than
 four guns.”[295]

   [295] _Streffleur_, January, 1908, p. 114, et seq.

 =England.= During the =Boer war= 1-2 machine guns mounted on a high
 carriage were assigned to each of the British battalions. These guns
 were unsuited to employment in an infantry combat and were quickly
 silenced. The campaign demonstrated that these guns could frequently
 not be used, and that they stood idle in rear of the line. They were
 not combined into detachments for the purpose of supporting the
 attack, as should have been done, until the engagement at =Pieters
 Hill= (27th Febr., 1900). On account of the long range at which these
 guns came into action, the effect of their fire was indeed very
 small, but, nevertheless, its moral effect impaired the steadiness
 of the Boer aim. Since the great fire power of these guns can be
 brought into play only when several of them are employed together,
 it is not a good plan to assign single guns to cavalry regiments for
 the purpose of supporting the dismounted line in action. Only the
 commander of the entire force, and not each battalion commander,
 is able to judge where the employment of machine guns would be
 advantageous. The proposal to assign machine guns to the artillery
 was not followed, as it was justly feared that the machine guns would
 then be assigned tasks to which they were not adapted.

 At the present time, each battalion has a machine gun platoon
 consisting of two guns. Both guns with their tripods, and a portion
 of the ammunition, are transported on one wagon drawn by two horses.
 They are in addition equipped with a two-horse ammunition cart. The
 complement consists of 1 non-commissioned officer, 15 privates, 1
 saddle horse, and 4 draft horses.

 Each battalion of mounted infantry has a machine gun platoon which is
 similarly organized. Each of the four vehicles of this platoon is,
 however, drawn by four horses. In addition, this platoon is equipped
 with six machine gun pack saddles for transporting the guns on pack
 animals. The complement consists of 1 officer, 1 first sergeant, 23
 privates, 16 saddle horses, and 16 draft animals.

 The machine gun platoon of a cavalry regiment consists of only
 one gun, which is carried on a four-horse wagon, and a four-horse
 ammunition wagon. The platoon is equipped with three pack saddles.
 The complement consists of 1 officer, 1 non-commissioned officer, 13
 privates, 11 saddle horses, and 8 draft horses.

 The following ammunition is carried by the British machine gun
 platoons:

 ======================+========+==========+==========+========
                       |        |  In the  |  In the  |
                       |With the|ammunition| Division | Total
                       | organ- |  column  |ammunition|  No.
                       |ization.|  of the  |  column. |rounds.
                       |        |F. A. Bns.|          |
 ----------------------+--------+----------+----------+--------
 Infantry M. G. P.     | 11,500 |  10,000  |  10,000  | 31,500
 Mtd. Infantry M. G. P.| 19,500 |  10,000  |  10,000  | 39,500
 Cavalry M. G. P       | 19,500 |  10,000  |  10,000  | 39,500
 ----------------------+--------+----------+----------+--------

 =Japan= and =France= seem to have decided to follow the British in
 assigning machine gun platoons to regiments. In =Japan=, soon after
 the outbreak of the =Russo-Japanese war=, the Guard, the 1st, 2nd,
 3rd, 4th and 6th Divisions, and the two independent cavalry brigades,
 had machine gun batteries consisting of 6 guns each. During the
 winter 1904-5, 320 machine guns were gradually placed in position,
 singly and by platoons, in the fortifications on the Shaho.

 =Russia.= At the outbreak of the =Russo-Japanese war=, a machine gun
 company was assigned to the 1st, 3rd and 5th East Siberian Rifle
 Brigades. This company consisted of 5 officers, 85 combatants, 13
 non-combatants, 10 saddle horses, 29 draft horses, and eight guns.
 The latter were mounted on high carriages, and were protected by
 steel shields. Of the ammunition, 1350 rounds, in belts holding 450
 rounds each, were carried on each gun carriage, and 4500 rounds
 on each of the six two-wheeled ammunition carts. The field train
 consisted of nine one-horse carts. The loss of the machine gun
 company at the =Yalu= was probably due to the fact that the guns,
 mounted on high carriages, were quickly deprived of their mobility
 in their second position, after they had, from their first position,
 effectively flanked the advance of the Japanese infantry. Immediately
 after this first lesson, the high wheeled carriage was apparently
 abolished, and the tripod adopted. On September 26th, 1904, the
 machine gun companies were reorganized. There were (old) wheeled,
 and (newly-organized) so-called “mountain machine gun companies,”
 the latter having pack animal transportation. These companies were
 assigned to infantry and Rifle divisions and were designated by the
 numbers of their divisions.

 On December 12th, 1906, the machine gun organization was again
 changed, because it was asserted that the assignment of machine gun
 companies to divisions hampered the division commander; that the
 employment of 8 guns at one point was injudicious; and that so large
 a machine gun battery actually induced a scattering of the guns.
 Infantry, Reserve, and Rifle regiments are each assigned a machine
 gun organization consisting of 4 guns, mounted on tripods, equipped
 with 6 mm. steel shields, with pack animal transportation.

 Complement: 3 officers, 7 non-commissioned officers, 46 privates,
 7 non-combatants, 10 saddle horses, 21 pack and draft horses (8 of
 these for carrying ammunition), 4 ammunition carts, and 5 train
 wagons. The personnel is drawn from a regiment in which the men to be
 detailed for machine gun duty are trained.

 According to an officer who commanded a machine gun company in the
 battle of =Liao Yang=[296], his company went into position on August
 30th, on the right flank of its division behind an earth embankment
 at the south edge of the village of Gutsealing, and 300 m. from the
 railroad running in a southwesterly direction. This position was
 taken up with the object of preventing the envelopment of the right
 flank of the division. Sufficient time was available for cutting
 down the kaoliang crop for 650 m. Beyond this range the kaoliang
 fields continued for several hundred meters. Directly in front of
 the position of the company there was a hill, upon which several
 mounted men showed themselves toward 10 A. M. As soon as fire was
 opened on them, they threw themselves down in a field covered
 with tall kaoliang. When these mounted men had reached a fairly
 open space, about 900 m. from the machine gun company, they could
 be clearly seen. In rear of them was observed a mountain battery
 of artillery, which endeavored to go into position on the hill
 mentioned, apparently with a view of directing a flanking fire on
 the Russian skirmishers farther to the front than the machine guns.
 Fire was opened at once, without first bracketing the target, the
 first gun firing at 1200 paces (about 850 m.), and each succeeding
 gun increasing the range by 25 paces, thus covering with fire a space
 150 m. deep. Immediately after fire was opened on it, the mountain
 battery attempted to escape to the right, but succumbed to the fire
 of the machine guns. The latter had fired about 1¹⁄₂ minutes, and had
 expended 6000 rounds of ammunition. About noon, hostile (Japanese)
 skirmishers attempted to cross the railroad embankment, one by one,
 apparently with a view of flanking the machine guns. The latter
 opened fire on the Japanese, combined sights, and, for a short
 period, rapid fire with sweeping being resorted to. The movement
 made by the Japanese was discontinued; an advance made by groups
 against the front of the machine guns got only as far as the edge of
 the cleared kaoliang field. In the open, the skirmishers were unable
 to advance a single step; every attempt, on their part, to rise,
 was prevented. Whether it would have been possible to advance by
 crawling, while keeping up a constant fire, can, of course, not be
 determined now.

   [296] _Russian Invalid_, October 1904.

 At nightfall the Japanese again advanced in the kaoliang field and
 annoyed the machine gun company throughout the night with rifle fire.
 At daybreak they were again driven back by a continued fire from
 the machine guns. The Japanese skirmishers remained in readiness,
 however, in the kaoliang field, and fired on any target that offered.
 When their fire became more and more galling, the machine gun
 commander decided to send forward a non-commissioned officer and 15
 men (Reservists and horse holders, armed with rifle and bayonet) to
 drive them out. The undertaking was successful. It was found that
 this continuous annoying fire had been kept up by only 1 officer and
 24 men.

 At 3 P. M., several Japanese assembled at the railway bridge; a
 signal detachment also appeared. The fire at will of the infantry,
 directed on this body of men, had no effect whatever; but after
 two machine guns, one using an elevation of 1025, the other one of
 1075 m., had fired on that point for a short time, the Japanese
 disappeared. At 5 P. M., the machine guns succeeded in repulsing an
 enveloping movement made against their right flank. This movement was
 betrayed only by the motion of the kaoliang stalks. Toward 7 P. M.,
 the Japanese directed artillery fire upon the machine guns, which
 suffered considerable losses, although the personnel was protected by
 an earth parapet and had ceased to work the guns. This fire did not
 cease until nightfall, and, at 9 P. M., the position was evacuated
 by order. An attack made by the Japanese during the night found the
 machine guns gone. During the two days of the fight the company had
 lost 30% of its personnel, and had fired 26,000 rounds of ammunition,
 or only about 3200 rounds per gun during two days. The superiority
 of the fire of these machine guns over that of the Japanese skirmish
 line can perhaps only be explained by the small numbers of the latter.

 In the defensive position on the =Shaho= and at =Mukden=, machine
 guns were employed in favorable positions, behind sandbag parapets
 and under splinter proof roofs. According to Lieutenant-Colonel
 ANISINOW, good results were obtained against skirmishers up to 1050
 m., against closed bodies of infantry and against troops of cavalry
 (_Eskadrons_) up to 1400 m.; against batteries of artillery, halted
 in the open, staffs, and columns, the fire was sufficiently effective
 up to 1960 m.


8. THE EMPLOYMENT OF MACHINE GUN BATTERIES.

Machine guns will never be able to replace artillery at long ranges; on
the other hand, they will often find an opportunity to support other
arms with their fire at medium and short ranges.

It has been asserted that machine guns do not always follow the
movements of the firing lines in action, that the commander of a
force is not always able to find a good position for them; and the
question raised whether the space taken up by the machine guns and
their ammunition wagons in a column could not be more profitably filled
by companies of infantry or by a portion of an ammunition column of
corresponding length. To be sure, machine guns are a special arm; the
justification of their existence lies in the combination of constant
readiness for firing with highly developed mobility, so that, held back
under direct control of the commander of a force, they give him the
means wherewith to produce within a short time a sudden effect, in the
nature of a surprise. This is the very purpose for which machine guns
were created. They are not intended for prolonged fire action, not for
accompanying an infantry skirmish line in an advance by rushes, and,
least of all, for fighting well covered firing lines. In addition, the
fact that machine guns make it possible to concentrate fire quickly on
any space, whereby the moral effect is considerably increased, ought
not to be underestimated. It would seem to be advisable to employ
machine guns in conjunction with infantry when it is impossible to
develop a powerful fire on account of the conformation of the ground,
but when such fire is desirable for commanding approaches or defiles;
further, when fire alone suffices for delaying the enemy (for example,
in rear guard actions). In this case the guns may either be pushed far
to the front, or may be used in defensive positions, which can then be
held by a few men during the pauses in the fight.[297] Although machine
gun fire may perhaps be relatively less accurate than that of a body of
infantry, the value of pouring a large mass of projectiles on the enemy
within a brief space of time should not be underestimated.[298]

   [297] At the Austrian Musketry School it was found that it was
 not easy for a body of troops to fire on targets illuminated by the
 shaft of a search light; few men possessed the requisite eyesight to
 make this possible. It would no doubt be practicable, however, to
 attach such men to the machine guns posted in a defensive position. A
 considerable increase in fire effect could thus be obtained.

   [298] Platoon volleys, directed for one minute on figures advancing
 from 1200-1100 paces, resulted in 5, fire at will, in 1¹⁄₂, and
 machine gun fire, in 3% hits. The three kinds of fire, when directed
 against 30 prone skirmishers, resulted, in one minute, in 13, 18, and
 10% hits, respectively.

Whether machine guns are distributed by platoons, or are employed as
a unit under control of superior leaders, will depend upon whether
it is contemplated to employ them in a purely defensive way for the
purpose of reinforcing the several weak points, or offensively in fire
surprises or in covering the flanks. The distribution by platoons
has the undeniable disadvantage that single guns will frequently
not find an opportunity to fire; that the difficulty of ammunition
supply is increased; and that the combined employment of the several
platoons will produce friction that cannot be easily avoided. On
the other hand, in machine gun batteries of three platoons each, an
employment by platoons is easy. Although a distribution by platoons is
permissible in a passive defense, the employment of the guns by battery
(company) against the flanks of the attacker permits the mobility and
fire power of the arm to be utilized to better advantage. While a
distribution of machine guns by platoons--if we except colonial and
mountain warfare--is, indeed, cheaper, it generally leads to a useless
frittering away of fighting units.[299]

   [299] Lieutenant ULRICH (retired), who participated in the fighting
 in Manchuria, voices the same opinion in _Jahrbücher_, March number,
 p. 285:

   “The opinion has been quite prevalent that the organization of
 strong machine gun units is one of the most important requirements of
 modern battle.”

Machine guns will be able to bring all their powers into play to the
best advantage at the beginning of a rencontre, when, from their
position as far forward as possible in the column, they are pushed to
the front to occupy important points and to compel the enemy to deploy
his infantry. The commander should, however, endeavor to withdraw the
machine guns from the fight as soon as his own infantry has deployed,
in order to avoid involving the guns in a protracted fire fight
necessitating an expenditure of a great amount of ammunition and in
which the accuracy of their fire would gradually suffer.[300] The
proper sphere of machine guns lies in their employment as a separate
arm, whether they are posted so as to flank an enemy, or are kept
at the disposal of the commander as an ever ready reserve, which
is pushed forward to keep the point to be attacked under fire, to
meet a counter-attack, or--and to this use they are best adapted--to
participate in the pursuit. Their employment is also proper in rear
guard actions, since they are able to remain in position longer, for
example, than rear guard infantry, whose energies are paralyzed by the
thought of getting away from the enemy in time. Machine guns are much
more independent than infantry on account of their ability to withdraw
at an increased gait. On account of their greater staying power and
the greater intensity of their fire, they increase the delay which
the enemy suffers, as well as the start gained by their own force;
they moreover enable their own force to get away from the enemy and to
escape pursuit.

   [300] This applies particularly to machine guns which have air
 cooled barrels. After four minutes of continuous fire, part of
 the projectiles, and after seven minutes all of the projectiles
 fired from a Hotchkiss machine gun go over the target (platoon).
 _Kriegstechnische Zeitschrift_, January number, 1907.

In employing machine guns in defense, it must be borne in mind that the
guns are not adapted to carry on protracted fire actions; and that the
advantage of the mobility of machine gun batteries cannot be properly
utilized if they have been assigned, from the outset, a definite
section to defend. As a rule, it will be advisable, in defense, to keep
the machine guns at first with the reserve, and to employ them later,
as necessity requires, even by platoons, to reinforce the defensive
line at threatened points, or, by battery (company), to prevent an
envelopment, or to participate in offensive movements. This does not
preclude the employment of machine guns during the preparatory stage
of the engagement, for example, to command important approaches. When
a covered withdrawal of the guns is assured, it will also be possible
to post machine gun batteries in such a manner in front of, or to a
flank of the main defensive position, that they can suddenly sweep
with their fire the ground on which the opponent will probably place
his artillery. Flanking machine gun fire can sometimes be employed for
sweeping dead angles.

The provisions of the Austrian machine gun regulations correspond in
the main to those of the German Army. In Austria special stress is
laid upon the use of machine guns with cavalry, while in Germany they
are in addition a mobile reserve. Machine gun batteries accomplish the
principal objects which cavalry expects to attain by the assignment
of infantry,[301] viz., relief from fighting on foot, great fire
power, and mobility. Even in reconnaissance duty, machine guns will
be employed to break down the resistance of the enemy in occupied
localities and to augment the resistance of their own force in such
places. During an advance, machine guns should go into position at an
early moment in order to cover as effectively as possible the approach
and the deployment for attack. It is advisable to post the guns of
a machine gun battery together, so as not to have numerous lines of
fire interfere with the movements of the cavalry; this is especially
emphasized by the Austrian regulations. Machine gun batteries, like
horse batteries (artillery), remain with the cavalry divisions during a
battle.

   [301] In regard to the employment of machine guns in the maneuvers
 of 1905, see _Streffleur_, 1906, May number.

German machine guns are especially adapted for resisting cavalry, while
guns transported upon pack animals are entirely helpless on the march
and when going into position, and require the support of the other
arms. German machine guns, whether on their wheeled carriages or on
their sleds, are capable of warding off cavalry. The fire of the guns
should be distributed over the entire front of the mounted attacking
line. Special attention should be paid to lines following the first
attacking line, to the flanks of the guns themselves, and to covering
the carriages when they are not with the guns. Machine guns are able to
advance on open ground without regard to cavalry, so long as the latter
is not supported by artillery or infantry, or is not so superior in
force that it can attack simultaneously from several directions, or in
several lines.

In action against artillery it should be borne in mind that artillery
possesses an unquestioned superiority of fire at the longer ranges; at
ranges at which machine guns are able to fire at all, they must seek to
find protection under cover, or by distributing the guns. Artillery is
very susceptible to flanking fire. When that arm is to be engaged, the
machine gun sleds should be brought as close as possible to the hostile
batteries. In this case it is, moreover, advisable to have large
intervals between the machine gun platoons. The great mobility of the
machine gun battery, when limbered, will sometimes enable it to take up
a position from which it can flank the enemy. In distributing machine
gun fire it would be well always to assign the same task to two guns.
It is not a good plan to have all the machine guns sweep the entire
front of a firing battery (artillery).

 The opinions in regard to machine gun employment in field
 warfare--mountain and fortress warfare are not considered
 here--differ considerably. In =England= machine guns are attached to
 battalions, and Japan of late leans toward this mode of employment.
 In =Switzerland= machine guns serve in addition as a substitute for
 horse batteries, which their army lacks.

 The =English= view is obviously affected by their experience in
 colonial wars.

 The following are given as the duties of machine guns _in attack_:

 1. The machine gun is above all to be employed at long ranges. In
 open country it will seldom be possible for the gun to reach a
 position in the first line, where, moreover, the gun would offer too
 good a target. Covered terrain should be taken advantage of to get
 the gun close to the enemy. The advance of infantry may be supported
 at long ranges by machine gun fire (fire of position).

 2. The delivery of volley fire against any point of the hostile
 position.

 3. The warding off of counter-attacks or attacks made by cavalry.

 4. The utilization of flanking positions.

 5. The support of cavalry during delaying actions (ammunition being
 in this case a substitute for men) although the fire effect against
 low targets is very small.

 6. The holding of captured positions.

 _In defense_ the isolated employment of machine guns at a distance
 from the organization is prohibited and their use against extended
 skirmish lines cautioned against. Machine guns are well adapted for
 protecting flanks and can be kept back as a reserve to prevent the
 advance of hostile reinforcements, to support counter-attacks, to
 direct fire against deep and dense targets, and, finally, to support
 the firing line in action at short range.

 _In defense_ the principal duties of machine guns will consist of--

 1. Sweeping obstacles and commanding terrain which is specially
 favorable for the attack; flanking of salients.

 2. Reinforcing weak points.

 3. Firing on advancing hostile reinforcements.

 The cavalry regulations, contrary to those of the infantry, also
 permit a massed employment of machine guns when ordered by brigade or
 division commanders.

 “As a rule, it will not be advisable to open fire on isolated mounted
 men or small groups of approximately platoon strength, as this would
 betray the position prematurely. In action, machine guns may be
 employed in conjunction with dismounted skirmishers for the purpose
 of forming a supporting point for movements, a rallying position, or
 for protecting a flank. Finally, during an attack, machine guns may
 support the fire of the horse battery, on the outer flank of which
 they go into position, to serve as support, or to facilitate by their
 fire a withdrawal.”

 These official regulations are not entirely in accord with the views
 entertained in the army. The combined use of the machine guns of
 a brigade, such as quite naturally resulted in the engagement at
 =Pieters Hill=, is advocated by many. At the longer ranges, machine
 gun companies are to fire on favorable targets, discontinuing their
 fire when their object has been accomplished. In addition they are to
 cover the advance or withdrawal of the infantry; to fire on certain
 points of the hostile position; to act against the enemy’s flanks in
 pursuit; and, in defense, posted in pairs, they are to flank salient
 angles and make it difficult for the enemy to approach the obstacles.

 In =Switzerland= machine guns are considered an auxiliary arm. “Our
 field army should be capable of accepting and sustaining battle in
 the mountains and on highland plateaus without necessitating the
 creation of numerous special detachments for that purpose. Machine
 gun companies should be a tool which can be used in the mountains and
 on highland plateaus, and which can be turned over for use to any
 organization.”

 The platoon is the firing unit; the company commander posts his
 platoons at large intervals and regulates their mutual coöperation.
 Fire, suddenly delivered from various points, frequently rather
 far distant from each other, is considered to have a particularly
 demoralizing effect; the scattered posting of the platoons makes it
 difficult for the enemy to combat effectively the individual platoons
 which are skillfully concealed on the terrain. “The indefinable,
 uncanny and confusing aspect of their appearance enhances the effect
 of the fire surprise.” The defensive character is here especially
 clearly marked, for cavalry which counts in the first place on the
 offensive will prefer a combined employment of machine guns, so as
 not to be hampered in its movements by the various lines of fire. On
 the march, machine guns are posted as far forward as possible in the
 column; single platoons may also be attached to troops (_Eskadrons_)
 of advance guard cavalry, and, in exceptional cases only, to troops
 (_Eskadrons_) of reconnoitering cavalry. Machine guns, supported by
 weak cavalry detachments, may be pushed forward to occupy defiles;
 moreover, the machine gun company assigned to a cavalry brigade may
 be sent into action either as a whole unit, or it may be divided from
 the start or during the course of the fight. This machine gun company
 may also be attached to regiments, troops (_Eskadrons_) or platoons
 of cavalry charged with special missions, in which case it is, as a
 rule, broken up into platoons. The premature detaching of machine gun
 units is especially cautioned against. “The mobility of the machine
 gun unit is such that it is not at all dangerous to hold them back
 until the last moment before sending them to the actually threatened
 point.”

 The regulations deem a special support necessary for the machine
 gun batteries when they are sent on independent missions. Single
 guns are not to be so used. Machine guns, distributed by platoons,
 invest cavalry dismounted for fire action with a special power
 of resistance. It will frequently be advantageous to occupy the
 enemy in front with weakly supported machine gun batteries, while
 maneuvering with the main body of the mounted force so as to gain the
 enemy’s weak point, and attacking him there with fire or a charge.
 In a cavalry fight Maxim machine gun marksmen, by timely, hold,
 and energetic action, will very often be able to create favorable
 conditions for their own troops, facilitate the selection of a point
 of attack, and retard and interfere with the hostile deployment.

 The following statements taken from the regulations for the _Service
 and Training of_ =Swiss= _cavalry_ (1904) are of interest:

 “Machine guns invest pursuing cavalry with tremendous power.--Their
 violent fire, suddenly breaking forth, especially when quickly
 delivered at the flanks of the retreating mass, must have an
 annihilating effect and convert the retreat into a rout.

 “In a retreat, Maxim gun marksmen with their guns can quickly occupy
 rallying positions (when possible, flanking), which, thanks to their
 mobility, they are capable of holding longer than other arms. Thereby
 they facilitate for the other troops the critical breaking off of the
 engagement.

 “The retreat will proceed with greater steadiness and time will be
 gained for organizing resistance and for making that resistance more
 obstinate.

 “When, during the crisis of battle, every available man joins in the
 fight, machine guns may take a hand in it, even when the terrain is
 unfavorable for the employment of cavalry, by gaining the flanks at a
 rapid gait, turning and firing upon the hostile flank or the hostile
 masses launched for the counter-attack.

 “It would be incorrect, however, at such a moment, simply to throw
 the machine guns into the fighting line or to a flank. By doing this
 the mobility of the guns would not be utilized, and they would lose
 their character of a mounted arm.

 “The assignment of machine guns to cavalry augments the fighting
 power and independence of the latter and increases to the utmost its
 desire to go ahead, its enterprise and bold initiative. With the aid
 of machine guns, our militia cavalry, even when opposed by better
 drilled cavalry, can go into battle calmly on our terrain, with the
 firm conviction of defeating it.

 “But a cavalry leader should never shrink from sacrificing his
 machine guns when the object to be attained requires it, and when no
 other means remain to save the force. _These weapons should never be
 more to him than a welcome and powerful aid toward the fulfillment of
 his mission. Cavalry which degenerates into a mere support for its
 machine guns has ceased to be cavalry._”




VII. INFANTRY VERSUS CAVALRY.[302]

(Par. 451 German I. D. R.).

   [302] _Taktik_, II, p. 137: _Die Attacke der Kavallerie auf
 Infanterie_. For examples from military history consult the splendid
 works of Major KUNZ, especially _Die deutsche Reiterei_, and
 _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, 5.


The individual infantryman whose rifle is loaded and who knows how to
use his bayonet is more than a match for the individual mounted man
even on open ground; and, if he remains cool, retains his presence of
mind, and uses his rifle properly while keeping the opponent constantly
in view, he is even superior to several mounted men. Infantry which
retains its steadiness has nothing to fear even when outnumbered by
cavalry. Its main strength lies in steadily delivered fire, while
cavalry relies on the possibility of making an unexpected rapid charge,
on quickly covering great distances, and on the moral effect which its
irresistible onslaught undoubtedly produces upon infantry. So long as
there is a possibility of surprise and misunderstanding, of infantry
allowing itself to become discouraged, and of the individual soldier
being exposed to hunger and hardships, so long will cavalry that is
energetically led be able to gain brilliant victories. Tactics would
look differently upon the possibility of making a mounted charge
during a battle if one or two German cavalry divisions had been on
the Japanese side during the pursuit after Mukden. “If we demand of
infantry that it close with the enemy after it has suffered tremendous
losses, why should we not demand the same of cavalry whose mobility
is disproportionately greater.” (_Skobeleff’s Order for the Day, June
15th, 1882_). The less the world believes in a victory of cavalry, the
greater the certainty of such success. The troops should be accustomed
in time of peace to the sight of charging cavalry. The recommendation
made by the late General Dragomirov of the Russian army is, at any
rate, worthy of consideration.[303] He proposed that cavalry ride at
full speed through infantry lines deployed with three paces between
files. Some infantrymen are, indeed, bound to be injured in such
charges, but the wounds produced are not likely to be serious. Infantry
accustomed to such charges will not lose its steadiness so easily in
action as when it comes in contact with cavalry for the first time on
the battlefield.

   [303] _Vorbereitung der Truppen für den Kampf_, I, p. 55.

 The success of the charge made by Captain Bechtoltsheim of the
 Austrian army at =Custozza= with three platoons of Sicilian Uhlans,
 may be ascribed principally to the fact that the Italian infantry
 was not accustomed to field service and lacked training. This small
 force of cavalry broke entirely through Pisa’s deployed Brigade
 (Italian) and struck the route column of Forli’s Brigade, throwing
 it into complete panic, so that of five battalions only one remained
 intact. The three platoons of cavalry, which numbered about 100
 sabers, lost 2 officers, 84 men, and 73 horses killed and wounded.
 The charge made by three troops (_Eskadrons_) of the Dragoons of the
 Guard at =Mars-la-Tour=, to facilitate the retreat of the defeated
 38th Brigade, and that made by two platoons of the 7th Hussars at
 =Sapignies= were likewise successful.

Any formation that permits effective firing is suitable for warding off
cavalry. Skirmish lines through which a cavalry charge passes suffer
losses that scarcely deserve mention. The fight is not hopeless even
when the hostile troopers halt within the ranks of the infantry. When
cavalry has charged through a skirmish line, the latter should be
careful not to face about to fire at the troopers,[304] as that would
give a second cavalry line an opportunity to approach and strike it
unawares.

   [304] “The French firing lines through which the cavalry had
 charged (evening attack made by Rauch’s Brigade in the direction
 of Rezonville on August 16th, 1870) fired after the Hussars, while
 the French Infantry units in rear fired in the opposite direction.
 The result was a frightful cross-fire, which, while undoubtedly
 disastrous for the Hussars, certainly must have worked havoc among
 the French.” KUNZ, _Reiterei_, p. 153.

The supports in rear of the first line form the objective of the
cavalry after it has charged through the firing line. These supports
must therefore open fire on the cavalry regardless of the skirmishers
in front.

The flanks of a firing line can be bent back only when that line is
not exposed to hostile infantry fire. The threatened wing should never
be bent forward since that interferes with the fire of adjacent units.
The task of repulsing an attack directed against a flank had best be
left to the supports in rear of the flanks. The German Cavalry Drill
Regulations (par. 349) state, that toward the end of a fight the bulk
of the supports and reserves will have been absorbed by the firing
line; that the fire that such a line could direct toward a flank would
be insignificant; and that at any rate a _new_ firing line could not be
formed within a short time; and, therefore, that a charge against its
flank would be advantageous. This statement should be a warning for us
always to retain echelons or machine guns in rear of the flanks. The
most critical situation for infantry is that in which it is charged by
cavalry while retiring defeated under hostile fire with no supports
available to repulse the attack. A halt means annihilation; it must be
left to each individual to save himself as best he can.

 During the battle of =Scheinovo=, three companies of the 11th Russian
 Rifle Regiment made an unsuccessful attack and had to retreat under
 the pursuing fire of the Turks, while Turkish cavalry began to
 charge their left flank. When only 200-300 m. from the Turks, the
 4th Company, which was most seriously threatened, halted and formed
 square as if on the parade ground. During this maneuver, all the
 officers and many non-commissioned officers were either killed or
 wounded. The heavy losses of the battalion (50%) may, in the main, be
 ascribed to this halt under the most violent fire of the enemy.[305]

   [305] KUROPATKIN-KRAHMER, _Kritische Rückblicke auf den
 Russisch-Türkischen Krieg_, I, p. 166.

When the cavalry charge comes more from the front, however, the hostile
infantry and artillery will have to stop firing, and it may then be
possible to rally or re-form the defeated force, provided the men will
heed their leaders.

Units in close order can deploy quickly toward the front or flank for
the purpose of firing. However, they will be able to fire in close
order only when not themselves subjected to hostile fire. The front and
flanks of a body of infantry in proper formation are equally strong,
but, in this connection, it should be borne in mind that a deployment
toward a flank, for the purpose of firing, always takes time and is apt
to impair the steadiness of the men.[306]

   [306] General VON SCHERFF (_Kriegslehren_, II, p. 263) believes
 that a frontal charge made by cavalry of sufficient strength has
 better chances of succeeding than a charge in deep formation against
 a flank. In a frontal charge, the suddenly appearing cavalry is
 exposed “only to the fire at will of individual skirmishers whose
 continuous front masks the fire of units in rear.” In the other case
 (charge against a flank) the cavalry receives not only the fire of
 the closed bodies first encountered, but also that of the supports
 firing through the gaps between these groups. The frontal attacks
 executed with superb gallantry by the French cavalry at Sedan rather
 prove the opposite.

If time admits, a position may be looked for near obstacles, such as
ditches, hedges, swampy ground, etc., which impede the hostile cavalry.
It is not necessary, however, for the infantry to occupy the obstacle
itself; in fact, it is better to take up a position some distance
away. The shortness of our rifles obliges us to form the firing unit
at right angles to the line of advance of the approaching cavalry,
and to avoid aiming obliquely. The provision contained in a number of
drill regulations, including the French, that the bodies in close order
(supports, reserves) should be formed in echelon, is objectionable,
as this is apt to lead to their firing on one another (as the French
infantry did in repulsing the charge made by Bredow’s Brigade and
the Dragoons of the Guard at Vionville). The deployment from “broad”
and “deep” column to meet a sudden cavalry charge can, as a rule, be
ordered directly by company commanders on the caution of the battalion
commander, the method of meeting the attack being promptly decided
upon. The main thing is to be in instant readiness for firing and to
protect the flanks by means of echelons.

 In a deployment from “deep column,” the measures taken by the
 commanders of the rear companies must conform to those of the leading
 companies. To meet a cavalry charge coming from the right front, for
 example, the following scheme would be appropriate:

 _The 1st Company_ forms left front into line so that its front is at
 right angles to the line of advance of the cavalry;

 _The 2nd Company_ forms as a support in rear of the left flank of the
 first company;

 _The 3rd Company_ forms right front into line, and prolongs the line
 of the first company;

 _The 4th Company_ also forms right front into line, or is held in
 readiness as a support in rear of the right flank. In this way the
 approaching cavalry can be met by the fire of from six to eight
 platoons.

[Illustration]

It is a very simple matter to ward off a cavalry charge directed
against the flank of a marching column (form line by wheeling by
squads). When the cavalry charge is directed against the head or
the tail of a column, as recommended by the German Cavalry Drill
Regulations (par. 350), there will not be time enough, as a rule, for
the entire company or battalion to form line. It will suffice to let
the leading elements form line, the rear elements moving out of the
column and forming in rear of the flanks as supports.

Successful resistance does not depend upon the formation taken up; in
fact the latter is of importance only when it increases the feeling of
security. The morale of an organization is of more importance than the
formation taken up. A proud confidence in victory and morale are the
only factors which decide success, and the training of infantry should
be such as to develop these qualities.

Cavalry will in many cases consider that it has gained a success if it
causes infantry to discontinue a movement, or to take up formations
which interfere with the highest development of its fire, or which
offer favorable targets to the hostile infantry and artillery. This
is especially the case where infantry is in the act of beginning an
assault, when the slightest hesitation may jeopardize success. If
cavalry actually begins to charge at this moment, only the bodies
immediately threatened halt at the signal “attention,”[307] and face
the cavalry; the remainder continue the march.

   [307] The German army is the only one that employs an appropriate
 signal for this purpose. The attack made by the 28th Infantry Brigade
 against the wood of Bor at Königgrätz is very instructive in this
 connection. HÖNIG, _Taktik der Zukunft_, p. 56. At the signal,
 “cavalry,” the threatened portions of the brigade halted and formed
 square. Fortunately the Saxons had already begun to retire from the
 edge of the wood. A stray hostile troop (_Eskadron_) had caused all
 the trouble.

The sudden appearance of a line of charging cavalry produces such a
tremendous psychological effect on troops not immediately threatened,
that they either watch the attack passively, or else too many of them
take a hand in repulsing it. This moment, in which the attention of
the troops is so completely riveted on the cavalry, is seldom utilized
for the purpose of gaining ground to the front, or for effecting a
withdrawal.[308] It needs but little imagination to picture to one’s
self the success which the French army could have gained at Waterloo if
infantry masses had followed on the heels of Ney’s cavalry squadrons.
In the battle of Vionville the German infantry fired at the most
incredible angles at the charging French Guard cavalry. While Bredow’s
Brigade was making its charge during the same battle, part of the
infantry of the 6th Division stopped firing on the French skirmishers,
to follow with intense interest the cavalry charge that was taking
place on a totally different part of the battlefield. This conduct,
as natural as incorrect, suggests the advisability of profiting by
such moments of the enemy’s inattention for the purpose of executing
a movement or holding him with our own fire. It also seems absolutely
necessary to support with rifle fire the charge made by one’s own
cavalry, or at any rate to prevent the hostile infantry from firing
undisturbed on our troopers.

   [308] “Every leader should carefully watch the progress of a
 cavalry charge, and, as soon as he observes that friendly cavalry has
 succeeded in penetrating the hostile line or that the enemy is shaken
 and directs all of his fire against the charging cavalry, he should
 immediately advance to the attack and be upon the enemy with the
 bayonet before the latter recovers his senses. Such an attack will
 not have been made in vain, even if the cavalry has been repulsed.”
 General GURKO’S comments on the maneuvers of 1893.

   Prince FREDERICK CHARLES, in his _Winke für die Offiziere der unter
 Meinen Befehlen ins Feld rückenden Truppen_ (1870), also demands that
 the infantry should quickly follow up cavalry attacks.

There are other reasons, however, why a sharp lookout should be
kept during a hostile cavalry charge. All cavalry drill regulations
recognize that a charge has greater chances of succeeding when it is
made in deep formation, in successive lines, or simultaneously from
several directions. The fire of the infantry is distributed, and,
unless a good lookout is kept, a part of the cavalry, scarcely or not
at all molested by fire, may perhaps succeed in driving the attack
home. This will be the case when infantry allows itself to be enticed
into developing a heavy fire in a direction from which only a feint is
made, while the main attack comes from another, or from several other
directions. Well led infantry will, therefore, never employ more rifles
in repulsing cavalry than are absolutely necessary, while the mere
threat of a cavalry charge will induce badly led infantry to develop an
excessive volume of fire.

On open terrain, when the approaching cavalry is visible at a
considerable distance, and when the infantry itself is exposed to
effective fire, the prone aiming position is to be preferred. The men
lying flat on the ground are not so easily wounded by the hostile
troopers, and the horses will generally avoid stepping on them, besides
which, the danger space is greater than when the men fire standing. In
rolling or close country, where cavalry cannot be seen by men lying
down, the aiming position kneeling or standing should properly be
assumed. The losses inflicted by hostile fire must then be endured.
Horses and riders are more apt to lose dash when charging an upright
human wall that is spouting fire, than when charging a kneeling or
prone opponent who scarcely offers an obstacle to the charge. What is
of greater importance, however, is that men standing upright can more
easily execute a change of front, fire on passing cavalry, and use
their bayonets in case the cavalry actually penetrates their line. The
British and Italian regulations very properly prescribe that the front
rank of a body of infantry in close order should kneel in such cases.

As the success of infantry depends to a great extent upon the
steadiness with which it receives the cavalry, it would seem to be
advantageous to withhold the fire until the cavalry gets within short
range.[309] General Dragomirov says in his forcible manner, “It is
not the bullet which has been fired, but the bullet which is still in
the rifle-barrel, and reserved for short range, that harms charging
cavalry.” If infantry in line was able to repulse a cavalry charge
in the past at 40 paces, with smoothbore muskets and at the first
volley,[310] the chances of doing this with modern rifles would be
still greater, if the “stopping power” of the 8 mm. projectiles were
absolutely certain at short ranges. As this is not the case, it is
necessary to open fire at an earlier moment.[311] If infantry does
not fire until cavalry gets within very short range, it will have to
reckon with the fact that even wounded horses will still be able to
carry their riders into its ranks. However, for purposes of instruction
in time of peace, it is proper to open fire late. If an infantry unit
is trained in time of peace always to open fire at the medium ranges on
charging cavalry, the unexpected appearance of hostile cavalry at short
ranges in actual war, is more likely to bring disorder into the ranks
of such a unit, than if it is trained in time of peace to reserve its
fire until the cavalry has come within short range.

   [309] “The best preparation against rapidly executed mounted
 charges is for all commanders to keep their eyes open, quickly and
 coolly to size up the situation, and to act with determination. All
 precipitation or haste would be disastrous, for it would communicate
 itself to the troops. Infantry has never yet fired too late upon
 cavalry.” Feldzeugmeister V. WÄLDSTATTEN.

   [310] At Sedan, the 5th Company of the 46th Infantry fired only at
 140 and 80 paces, and repulsed the charge. _Geschichte des Regiments
 Nr. 46_, p. 186. In the same battle the 9th and 12th Companies of the
 87th Infantry repulsed a charge at 60 paces. _Gen. St. W._, II, p.
 1217.

   [311] The _France Militaire_ contains the following statement
 in regard to the effect produced on horses by bullets from the
 French Lebel rifle in the engagements near Casablanca in 1907:
 “Many officers serving in the field observed that the small caliber
 bullets stopped horses only when a foot had been shattered or when
 a vital organ had been hit. _At Casablanca, horses that had been
 hit by several bullets continued to gallop for a long while._ This
 is a remarkable phenomenon, for the gentlemen of theory count as
 out of action every horse that has been hit by a projectile. This
 is entirely incorrect. _Many wounded horses carry their riders into
 the melée and do not die until the day after the fight._ This was
 observed on the French as well as on the Moroccan side.

   “Troopers charging full tilt, with the firm determination of
 penetrating the hostile line, are not stopped so easily. In the first
 place, they would have to be hit, and that, in itself, is not such
 an easy matter. This is still more difficult for the infantry, if it
 knows the dash of the hostile troopers. Let us cultivate the dash of
 our cavalrymen, even if unreal situations are thereby produced in our
 peace exercises. If, on the other hand, we teach our troopers in time
 of peace to turn tail in the face of imaginary projectiles, we are
 training our cavalry for panic in time of war.”

 At =Garcia Hernandez= (1812), a French square was broken by a
 wounded horse falling down within the ranks of the infantry. This
 is, however, only true of closed bodies of infantry formed in two
 ranks. Horses will frequently break through a skirmish line--whether
 or not the horses are wounded is immaterial. Men are wounded in such
 an event in exceptional cases only, and the wounds produced are
 generally insignificant.

 The following episode shows the effect produced on cavalry when it
 attacks unshaken infantry which is in good formation and reserves its
 fire. During the retreat after the battle of =Jena=, on October 28th,
 1806, the Grenadier Battalion _Prinz August_, threatened by hostile
 cavalry, did not feel equal to continue its march to Prenzlau and
 attempted to cross the Ucker farther down. In the expectation that
 a cavalry charge would be made, square was formed and the officers
 were told not to fire until the cavalry had approached to within 20
 paces. “Meantime, the French cavalry--the brigade which had crossed
 at Golmitz as well as the remainder of Beaumont’s Division, under
 its commander, in all nine regiments--approached. The first charge
 was made by nine troops (_Eskadrons_) under the division commander.
 They approached at a gallop. When the expected fire did not come, the
 dragoons gradually reined in their horses, so that finally they were
 going no faster than a slow trot. At 30 paces the command “Fire” was
 given in the infantry and quite a number of troopers fell, the rest
 galloping by the square on both sides. Eight subsequent charges were
 repulsed in a similar manner.”[312]

   [312] VON LETTOW-VORBECK, _Der Krieg von 1806-7_, II, p. 279. The
 charge of the 5th Lancers at Beaumont forms a counterpart of the
 above. KUNZ, _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, 5, p. 18.

We have moreover to consider, in this connection, the strength of the
infantry, the formation of the cavalry, and whether the latter charges
from several directions or in several successive lines. A small force
of infantry, especially when it may anticipate attacks from several
directions, must open fire sooner than a strong infantry force which
has to contend with an attack coming from one direction only. In the
first mentioned case, an attempt must be made to meet quickly, one by
one, the attacks which follow each other at intervals.

It is quite a different matter when the infantry itself is not directly
threatened, but can take a hand in repulsing a cavalry charge made on
another unit; then it is advisable to open fire at an early moment
in order to break the momentum of the charge at long range. (11th
Jäger-Battalion at Wörth; 8th Company of the 46th Infantry at Sedan).

This in part determines the rear sight elevation that should be used.
The sights should not be changed on the battlefield, although this
has been done on the drill ground by well trained soldiers without
impairing the continuity or accuracy of the fire. According to the
table of ordinates of the trajectory (par. 23 German I. F. R.), a
bullet fired when the sight is set at 700 m. and aim is taken at the
feet of the horse, does not rise above the height of a mounted trooper
throughout that entire distance. The bullets may pass entirely over the
target however, when the men take too full a sight in the excitement
of battle, or when, in rolling country or terrain covered with grass
or crops, they cannot see the bottom of the target and aim above that
line. It is better, therefore, to aim at the breast of the horse, with
sights set at 600 m., and to fire as soon as the target gets within 800
m. On account of the excitement attending every cavalry charge, it is
not advisable to change sights.

It is a good plan to fire one volley first and then to employ fire at
will. It is not easy for infantry, while awaiting the onrushing mass
of cavalry, to reserve its fire until, in the opinion of the leader,
the first shot may be fired. But this waiting is of great importance
to prevent the fire from becoming wild and ineffective. Since the
elimination of powder smoke, there is no reason why other volleys
should be fired after the first, for in the excitement of the fight
the volley cannot produce a moral effect. The horses certainly find
the rattling of fire at will more unpleasant than the sudden crack of
a volley. The advantage of the volley, of permitting a unit to be kept
better in hand, may be an important factor under certain circumstances
however. The volley should, as a rule, be used by supports that are not
exposed to fire. (8th Company of the 32nd Infantry at Wörth; the 1st
and 2nd Companies of the 83rd Infantry, and the 5th Company of Jägers
at Sedan).

Since the principal object of the fire is to destroy the cohesion
of the charge, and as cavalry always closes toward the center while
charging, no special importance need be attached to the distribution of
the fire.

As regards relative numerical strength, a platoon of infantry
consisting of 60 rifles (firing 360-500 rounds per minute), should be
a match for 1-3 troops (_Eskadrons_), and a company of infantry, under
favorable conditions, may be able to deal with a cavalry brigade.[313]
Cavalry can become dangerous for infantry only when the infantry is
surprised, finds no opportunity to fire, loses its steadiness and
morale, or attempts to reach cover by running.

   [313] A German cavalry brigade consists of eight troops
 (_Eskadrons_). _Translator_.


The Charge of the French Cuirassiers of the Guard at Vionville.

 At half past 12 on the afternoon of August 16th, 1870, the companies
 of the 10th Prussian Infantry Brigade were advancing east of Flavigny
 towards the Metz--Mars-la-Tour _chaussee_. As French infantry was
 not on the spot to put a stop to this movement, the 3rd Lancers and
 the Guard Cuirassier Regiment received orders to attack. The former
 regiment went to the rear, as no definite objective (?) had been
 assigned to it.

 The Guard Cuirassier Regiment was formed in two lines, 150 m.
 distance between them, with two troops (_Eskadrons_) in each line, a
 fifth troop (_Eskadron_) following as a reserve. Although hampered
 in its movements and thrown into disorder by abandoned baggage
 wagons and other camp litter that covered the ground, the regiment
 nevertheless made the charge with superb gallantry.

 The charge struck the 6th and 7th Companies of the 52nd Infantry,
 under Captain Hildebrand. These companies, rifles in hand and their
 leader in front, awaited the French cavalry, which came into view
 at a distance of 1200 m. The first echelon (6th and 4th Troops) was
 received with rapid fire at 250 paces. On the right, the 6th Troop
 (_Eskadron_) approached to within 60-80 paces of the Prussians,
 but a part then turned to the rear while a few troopers turned to
 the left. It is said, that of the leaders only one officer and one
 non-commissioned officer remained in the saddle, and that only
 twenty cuirassiers were rallied after the charge. The left troop
 (_Eskadron_) missed its objective completely. The Prussian rear rank
 faced about and fired on some French troopers who attempted to make
 an attack from the rear and who now also received fire from other
 units of Prussian infantry.

 During the charge, the distance between the first and second lines
 had become greater than at first ordered. When the first line broke
 in two, the second was still some 300 m. distant from the Prussian
 infantry and suffered some losses, probably from stray shots, which
 did not stop the movement however, as the fire soon ceased. German
 accounts, to be sure, do not mention that the second line could
 not be seen on account of the powder smoke, and that the fire was
 discontinued to let the smoke clear away. When the French line was
 100 m. away it received the command _chargez_ and the Prussian
 infantry again resumed its rapid fire, which shattered the attack,
 the leading troopers breaking down in a ditch about 10 paces in
 front of the Prussian line. The third line, its cohesion impaired
 and its advance hampered by fallen horses and riders, was just as
 little able to reach the Prussian companies. The right wing of the
 Cuirassiers raced around the left flank of the companies of the 52nd
 Infantry and encountered the Füsilier Battalion of the 12th Infantry,
 deployed in a single firing line, dense in the center. Some parts
 of this battalion formed squares. The charge was definitely stopped
 by the fire of this battalion. An attempt to rally the Cuirassiers
 was prevented by Prussian cavalry which now moved out. The French
 regiment, which had begun its attack with 575 sabers, had lost 22
 officers, 208 men (36.2% of its strength), and 243 horses. According
 to Dick de Lonlay,[314] after this charge, the regiment was able to
 form only 4 troops (_Eskadrons_) of 62 troopers each, instead of 5
 troops (_Eskadrons_) of 115 troopers each, which would mean a loss
 of 248 men. The first line had suffered the heaviest losses; in
 the 4th troop (_Eskadron_), which had lost all of its officers and
 non-commissioned officers, only 18 men were left.

   [314] _Français et Allemands_, III, p. 84. KUNZ,
 _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, 5, p. 11. The French _Gen. St. W._,
 II, pp. 301-309, gives the losses as 18 officers, 170 men, and 208
 horses.

A charge has a better chance of succeeding if it is prepared by
artillery fire.

 During the attack made by two troops (_Eskadrons_) of Landwehr
 Hussars against the 1st Battalion _Gyulai_ at =Tobitschau=, an
 Austrian square was broken by shells before the cavalry penetrated
 it. During the attack of Bredow’s Brigade at =Vionville=, the
 artillery was able to send its last shells against the enemy
 immediately past the right flank of the cavalry brigade.

The employment of cavalry in masses, contemplated in all armies,
compels us to consider the case when infantry must advance over open
ground in the face of hostile cavalry. Special units must then be
designated, who, by means of long range fire, repulse the cavalry or
keep it at a distance. At Minden (1759), Anglo-Hanoverian infantry
succeeded in driving the hostile cavalry from the field, and at
Vauxchamps and Etoges (14th February, 1814), Prussian infantry
succeeded in breaking through the French cavalry. It will be easy to
do the same thing with modern weapons, so long as cavalry is not very
superior in numbers, and is not supported by infantry, machine guns, or
artillery.

Infantry attacking dismounted cavalry should endeavor to bring long
range fire to bear on the led horses or threaten them by a flank
attack. For infantry to prolong the action at long and medium ranges
is only playing into the hands of the cavalry, and besides, the better
marksmanship of the infantry is bound to make itself felt at short
ranges. When the infantry has once gotten to within 700 paces (560 m.)
of the dismounted cavalry, it is very doubtful whether the latter will
still be able to mount; at the very least, it will be difficult for it
to do so (par. 362 German C. D. R.), even though the withdrawal can be
effected under cover, or when fresh troops take a hand in the fight.


Provisions of Various Regulations.

 =England.= The possibility of a successful cavalry charge is almost
 universally contested. When necessary, the skirmishers that are
 immediately threatened close in toward the center. Bayonets are to be
 fixed. An opportunity for successful employment of cavalry is offered
 when infantry has fired away all of its ammunition; when it is forced
 to retire; and when the approach of the cavalry is facilitated by
 dust, fog, or heavy rain.

 =Austria.= _Brave and steady infantry has nothing to fear from
 cavalry charges, so long as it retains its steadiness, presence of
 mind, and morale, and delivers its fire steadily and with good aim at
 short range._

 When fighting cavalry, movements and changes of formation should be
 ordered only when sufficient time is available, and then only for the
 purpose of bringing a sufficient number of rifles into action and
 for better utilizing the terrain. When a cavalry charge is suddenly
 made from a short distance, it is better to remain in a narrow
 formation than to deploy hastily, provided the fire is delivered with
 steadiness. As cavalry frequently attacks only for the purpose of
 forcing the infantry to discontinue its advance, or to induce it to
 take up a close order formation, all units not immediately threatened
 by the attack should continue their movement or remain in their
 positions.

 When a force has to cover long stretches under conditions which make
 it probable that a cavalry attack will be made, the battalions,
 companies, or platoons should be so grouped that they can quickly
 meet the cavalry attack in any direction, and can mutually support
 each other in warding it off. Staffs and vehicles should place
 themselves within the protected area thus formed.

 The threatened units turn in the appropriate direction, properly
 utilizing cover and obstacles while so doing, and, when necessary,
 fix bayonets. Only such a part of the force is designated to fire as
 seems necessary for warding off the attack; the other parts continue
 to carry out the task assigned them. The commander retains a part of
 his force in readiness for warding off unexpected attacks.

 “When exposed to hostile fire while warding off a cavalry charge, the
 men should assume the position offering the smallest target.

 “If a platoon is _directly attacked_ by cavalry, it will only in rare
 cases be advisable to open fire at ranges beyond 600 paces (450 m.);
 _frequently it will be a good plan, however, to let the cavalry come
 up close_. When the platoon participates in warding off a cavalry
 attack made against another unit, it may open fire at longer ranges.

 “Fire at will is the principal kind of fire to be used in warding off
 cavalry.”

 =France.= Infantry, no matter in what formation it may happen to be,
 has nothing to fear from hostile cavalry, even if the latter is in
 superior numbers, provided the infantry remains cool, well in hand,
 and makes good use of its fire.

 When cavalry surprises infantry, the effect is as great as of old.
 Infantry should therefore carefully protect itself in all situations
 of combat, especially during critical moments.

 If cavalry is reported, infantry can guard against all contingencies
 by echeloning. It should not allow itself to be diverted from its
 task so long as the cavalry does not begin an attack.

 Any disposition that enables infantry to change front quickly to meet
 a charge, and to deliver a strong fire, is calculated to stop even
 the boldest cavalry.

 When fighting dismounted cavalry, it is considered desirable for
 the infantry to advance quickly to medium and short ranges for the
 purpose of firing upon the cavalry as it mounts.

 =Russia.= Nothing prescribed.

 =Japan.= Infantry which, while engaged with the enemy, is forced to
 discontinue its movement or to change its formation for the purpose
 of warding off hostile cavalry, has already suffered a partial
 defeat. Only those fractions that are absolutely necessary for
 repulsing the cavalry should take up the fight against it.




VIII. INFANTRY VERSUS ARTILLERY.


1. THE PASSAGE OF INFANTRY THROUGH ARTILLERY LINES.

The artillery of a mobilized German army corps with its twenty-four
batteries takes up approximately 2500 m. of the front of about 4000
m. available for the corps. When the ground is unfavorable, the front
available for the other arms may be still further reduced. All remedies
suggested for reducing the frontage required by artillery offer no real
solution of the difficulty; in fact, they have resulting drawbacks,
such as the reduction to ten paces of the interval between guns, and
the posting of artillery in two lines, one in rear of the other. On
account of these drawbacks, a commander will avail himself of these
remedies only in case of the most urgent necessity. The question as
to how infantry can best pass through these long artillery lines is
therefore of especial interest. While artillery will generally seek
commanding positions and avoid covered terrain, infantry will make use
of depressions and cover as the natural routes of advance for passing
by batteries in action and for deploying subsequently in front of them.
In this case the solution of the problem is simple. The difficulties
are disproportionately greater when terrain impassable for artillery
is lacking. Nothing could be more desirable for hostile artillery
which has adjusted its fire upon our batteries, than for the intervals
between our guns to become suddenly filled with infantry, whereupon
our artillery, until now under fire, would have to cease firing so
as not to endanger our infantry. This pause in the fire will be more
noticeable, when our artillery has not yet succeeded in gaining a
superiority of fire over the hostile guns; and its length will depend
upon the depth of the infantry formation. In this case the infantry
cannot avoid heavy losses as it must cross the fire-swept space in rear
of the guns, and soon thereafter must enter the zone of the opponent’s
actual “fire for effect,” besides losing for the time being the support
of its own artillery fire. It is obvious that for infantry to advance
in deployed lines through artillery in action, condemns the latter
to long silence, and even exposes it to the danger of being placed
altogether out of action. Infantry can pass through artillery lines at
certain points only, its passage being subject to an agreement between
the infantry and artillery commanders. It is advisable to have those
batteries cease firing whose fire has the least influence on the course
of the artillery combat. It is, however, of the utmost importance
that the fire of all hostile batteries which possibly could fire on
our infantry, be kept down by the increased fire of our artillery. In
this manner, we may perhaps be able to draw the fire of the hostile
artillery away from those points at which our infantry is to pass
through our artillery line. This is especially important. It will also
be advantageous to designate successively, different points in the
artillery line for the passage of infantry. This should be done for two
reasons: first, in order that a favorable target whose re-appearance
the hostile batteries could await with loaded guns, may not be
presented to the enemy at one point for a prolonged period; second,
in order that movements by the flank on the part of the infantry may
be obviated. The column of squads would be a suitable formation in
which two battalions of infantry could simultaneously pass through the
line of guns approximately within the space occupied by one battery.
These battalions should then at once deploy, executing front into line
toward their respective outer flanks. The guns can resume firing only
when their infantry has reached a point 3-400 m. in front of them. The
artillery will be able to resume its fire earlier when it is posted in
rear of a crest, and for this reason such points should be selected for
the passage of infantry.


2. THE ADVANCE UNDER ARTILLERY FIRE.[315]

   [315] A lecture delivered by Major C. E. D. BUDWORTH, R.A., at
 the Royal Artillery Institution, on December 3, 1908, entitled,
 _Infantry Formations in the Attack: from an Artilleryman’s Point of
 View_, contains some interesting information. The lecture mentioned
 appeared in _The Journal of the Royal Artillery_ for February, 1909.
 _Translator_.

In almost every attack, infantry will be obliged to advance for
considerable distances under artillery fire without being able to
take advantage of cover. It should guard against being surprised by
artillery fire while in an unsuitable formation.

In the first place, everything that facilitates the enemy’s adjustment
and observation of fire should be avoided. (See p. 119 supra). To this
end, infantry should not remain unnecessarily long near objects that
are clearly visible at a great distance. If it is noticed that the
enemy is beginning to adjust his fire on some prominent feature of
the terrain, that point should be passed as quickly as possible; the
same is true of a plain in the enemy’s zone of fire. Narrow columns,
separated by intervals of 50 m., their heads not on the same line, are
advantageous. This formation prevents shrapnel from simultaneously
striking two columns, and makes it difficult for the enemy to judge
the relative position of the smoke from the burst of his shrapnel with
respect to the target. This increases the difficulties of the enemy’s
observation of fire, as it is not easy for him to determine whether his
shots go over or fall short. A shallow echelon formation (about 50 m.
deep, as used in Russia, for example) is valueless for reducing losses,
owing to the depth of the beaten zone of modern projectiles.

The narrowest possible front should be presented to the enemy when
within his zone of fire.

It is moreover desirable to make the further observation of fire
difficult for the hostile artillery, and to diminish the effect of his
projectiles at the target (see p. 120 supra) by taking up suitable
formations. Broad, shallow formations were suitable against the shell
fire of the past. However, they had the great drawback of considerably
facilitating the observation of shots falling short or going over, as
the smoke from the burst hid the target in the first case, and as
the target appeared silhouetted against the smoke from the burst in
the second. The cone of dispersion of the modern base charge shrapnel
combines comparatively small lateral spread with great effect in depth.
The effect of a well-placed shrapnel may be confined to one target, and
that of projectiles bursting in the intervals reduced by taking up a
formation in which narrow columns (columns of squads) are separated by
wide intervals (up to 50 m.).

[Illustration]

The range is determined or verified by bracketing; that is, by
enclosing the target between shots which, fired at a known difference
of range, strike respectively, short of and beyond the target. In
France this is done either by battery salvo or by piece. In the former
case, the French distribute the fire equally over the entire space
which they wish to cover with fire; hence, they do not direct it upon
the individual columns, especially when they employ indirect laying,
their favorite mode of procedure. It is in this kind of fire especially
that narrow columns, separated by wide intervals, are a great
advantage, because it is pure accident if a projectile falls so that
its burst can be observed. Moreover, when the columns are not abreast
of each other, the observations of bursts may be contradictory. Thus,
in one salvo, “over” and “short” bursts may be obtained, especially
if several bursts could not be reliably observed, and the salvo will
have to be repeated. When a projectile bursts “short,” immediately
in front of the 1st company, for example, it may be assumed that the
next projectile will be fired at a range increased by 100-200 m. The
1st company should therefore move to the front at double time, the 2nd
and 3rd likewise, while the 4th executes platoons front into line and
takes to cover in anticipation of an “over” shot. The “over” meant
for the 1st company will then be the signal for the 4th company to
rush forward. _The following general rule may be given: A projectile
bursting “over” or just “short” of the target requires that the force
fired upon move quickly; a projectile bursting far “short” of the
target requires that cover be taken._ The platoon and squad leaders of
the attacking force should not betray its presence by standing upright;
the force should disappear absolutely without leaving a trace.

A force cannot, in the long run, prevent artillery from effecting an
adjustment of fire upon it; all it can do is to postpone the beginning
of the fire for effect.

Fire for effect is of three kinds:

1. “Progressive fire” (_tir progressif_).[316] In this fire, after
establishing a bracket (as a rule, one of 200 m.), every piece fires
two rounds at each of four ranges, viz., at a range 100 m. less than
the short limit of the bracket, at both ranges of the bracket, and at a
range 100 m. greater than the long limit of the bracket. For example,
if a bracket has been established for the target at 3000 and 3200 m.,
the battery would fire at 2900, 3000, 3200, and 3300 m.

   [316] Called “Zone Fire” in our field artillery. _Translator_.

2. “Sweeping” (_fauchage_) is employed when it is desired to cover
a broader zone. In this every gun fires three rounds at each of the
ranges designated. The first round is fired with the line of sight
directed on the right portion of the target (or on the aiming point).
Before firing each of the succeeding rounds, the direction of the piece
is changed to the left by three turns of the traversing handwheel. At
the next range this process is reversed, the direction of the piece
being changed to the right by three turns of the traversing handwheel
after each round. At 2500 m., for example, a battery can cover, in this
manner, a space twice the width of its own front.

3. “Fire at successive ranges” (searching fire). In this fire salvos
or volleys are delivered at the target at a number of ranges to be
designated by the battery commander.[317]

   [317] The Belgian Drill Regulations (1907) give the following
 details in regard to the fire effect of a French four gun battery: In
 “progressive fire” (_tir progressif_), 32 rounds cover a space 100
 m. wide and 400 m. deep (1 fragment covers 6 sq. m.). When direct
 laying is employed, one fragment covers 2 sq. m. In “progressive fire
 with sweeping” (_tir progressif avec fauchage_), 48 shrapnel cover a
 space 200 m. wide and 400 m. deep, each fragment covering 8 sq. m.
 Depending upon the range, 1¹⁄₂ to 5 minutes are required to secure
 adjustment. (See p. 119 supra).

During the Russo-Japanese war, all close order formations proved
unsuitable under artillery fire, except when the terrain afforded
cover. The Japanese infantry recognized very soon that the best
protection against artillery fire lay in constant motion (irregular
rushes made by small units) and in wide extension. The following
procedure, employed at Yoshirei on July 31st, 1904, seems worthy of
imitation:[318] The several platoons of the companies followed each
other in deployed lines at distances of 200-300 m. When they had to
cross open ground in order to reach a designated line, the platoons
sought to advance by squads, whose men were deployed at intervals of
5-10 paces and who moved at a rapid gait interrupted by breathing
spells. The men invariably assembled when cover was reached. The losses
were insignificant. The Russians also made use of a similar procedure
after their first disastrous experiences. In many instances the
platoons ran forward in single rank. “Change of gait and direction, as
well as the use of loose irregular skirmish lines make it difficult for
the artillery to hit anything.” (Par. 450 German I. D. R.).

   [318] SIR IAN HAMILTON, _A Staff Officer’s Scrap Book_, I, p. 337.


Formations used by Infantry during the Russo-Japanese War when under
Artillery Fire.

[Illustration: a.

A platoon in route column forms four columns of files.]

[Illustration: b.

A company in column of platoons, each in line of skirmishers with the
men 2-4 m. apart.

(It would be better to use sections instead of platoons).]

[Illustration: c.

The ranks of the sections in each platoon of the company following each
other at a distance of 100 m.

This formation was taken up from company column (German).]

These formations made it possible to advance at a walk to within 3000
m. of a hostile position; beyond that an advance by rushes had to
be resorted to, in which the attacking force avoided showing itself
simultaneously in long lines. The simplest scheme might be to move
forward in column of sections, each section in skirmish line. Formation
“a” is well adapted for quickly crossing fire swept places, and when
there is hope of re-forming the column subsequently. Formation “c”
is suitable for quickly deploying from company column. However, the
last-named formation no longer guarantees a proper leading of the
company, and quite naturally does not absolutely prevent losses. After
the Japanese 5th Brigade (Nambu) had taken possession of Yuhuntun[319]
and the three houses during the night of March 6/7, 1905, the following
dispositions for attack were made by the Russians about noon on the
7th: On the right, the 5th and 10th Rifle Regiments, in five lines,
each consisting of one battalion (total depth of the formation 600 m.);
in the center, the 123rd Infantry (Koslov) of which the companies of
three battalions were deployed in single rank lines, each consisting
of one company, with the men at intervals of from 3 to 5 paces, the
companies in rear of each other at distances of 100 paces; the IVth
Battalion, similarly formed, was posted in echelon to the left rear.
The 124th Infantry advanced on the left flank. The Koslov Regiment,
advancing without hesitation in quick time and at attention, was fired
on by three Japanese batteries while it was moving from 4000 to 2000 m.
The regiment lost about 600 men. This loss is insignificant when the
size of the target (about 600 m. wide and 1000 m. deep) is considered.
The Japanese did not care to become involved in a serious infantry
action and therefore evacuated the place. It would have been better
to advance by rushes with smaller units, as the terrain afforded no
cover whatever. Whenever the Japanese had sufficient time, they crossed
such plains singly, one by one, and then assembled under cover for the
attack.

   [319] V. TETTAU, _Achtzehn Monate mit Russlands Heeren in der
 Mandschurei_, II, p. 334.

   SPAITS, _Mit Kasaken_, p. 310.

   Col. CSICSERICS V. BACSANY, _Unser neues Feldgeschütz_, 1907, pp.
 17 and 21.


3. FIRING ON ARTILLERY IN POSITION

was in the past a pet fire problem. The effect of frontal fire on
artillery whose guns are protected by shields is so small that the
expenditure of ammunition is not justifiable.[320] The gap between the
steel shields of the French field gun is not large enough to exert a
noticeable influence. Steel shields, 3 mm. thick, afford protection
against steel jacketed bullets fired at or beyond 300 m.; against
“S” and “D” projectiles they afford protection, it is said, beyond
500 m. only. Machine guns directing continuous fire on a point may
obtain better results. According to firing tests 3 mm. armor plate
can be pierced up to 1000 m. only by special projectiles (solid steel
projectiles and those having a steel core), the adoption of which is
precluded on practical grounds (variations in sectional density, and
difficulty of manufacture).[321] For this reason, it is better to leave
the task of destroying shielded batteries, even when they are in the
open, to one’s own artillery, than to attack them with infantry. The
fire effect of the infantry is not noticeably increased when delivered
obliquely against the front of the battery. (Par. 184 German I. D. R.).
In Germany the gun commander and cannoneer No. 3, who is posted at the
trail, are then especially endangered; but in order to flank the guns
effectively and to reach in rear of the shields with its fire, the
infantry must move to a flank a distance at least equal to ¹⁄₃ of the
range, and even then the fire effect is very small. The effect may even
be entirely nullified when the flanking fire is delivered from the side
on which the caisson bodies are posted. In this case it suffices to
push forward the caisson body to protect the personnel. It is a good
plan for infantry to direct its fire on the limbers and the reserve.
And again, infantry should not let any opportunity pass to fire on
artillery in motion or in the act of limbering or unlimbering within
effective range. Guns moved by hand into positions from which direct
laying can be employed for the purpose of warding off the infantry
attack, offer particularly favorable targets. Infantry that is to
capture artillery must approach its objective by means of irregular
rushes made by small groups, and increase its fire to the utmost
intensity when the limbers are brought up to the guns. The effect of
artillery fire is small under 200 m., in the absence of canister.[322]

   [320] Even prior to the adoption of shields it was demonstrated
 that infantry was unable to destroy the matériel of batteries
 so as to render them immobile; it could only interfere with the
 _personnel_, but could not demolish the batteries.

   [321] _Mitteilungen über Gegenstände des Artillerie und
 Geniewesens_, 1907, No. 5.

   [322] The capture of the Smolenski Artillery Battalion on October
 14th, 1904 (Shaho). _Artilleristische Monatshefte_ for March, 1908.

[Illustration: Germany.

Field Howitzer.

Field Gun.]

[Illustration: France.]

The disaster which overtook Trautmann’s Battery at St. Hubert, during
the battle of Gravelotte, demonstrates how difficult it is to unlimber
on open ground when under effective infantry and artillery fire; but,
if five limbers with their teams had not stampeded, perhaps it might
have been possible after a while, for the battery to reopen fire.
Hasse’s Battery, also at St. Hubert, was rendered incapable of moving
in a short time, but, in spite of the greatest difficulties, managed to
continue its fire for about two hours, though with only a part of the
guns. Gnügge’s Battery managed to unlimber under cover of a garden wall
at St. Hubert and to maintain itself there under enfilading infantry
fire till the end of the battle. Trautmann’s Battery lost 17 men and 37
horses; Hasse’s Battery, 38 men and 77 horses; and Gnügge’s Battery, 15
men and 40 horses.[323]

   [323] HOFFBAUER, _Deutsche Artillerie_, III, p. 227.

Unlimbering under uninterrupted hostile fire at short range will always
produce conditions similar to those in Trautmann’s Battery, and in
the two British batteries of Colonel Long at Colenso.[324] These two
batteries did not cease firing because they had suffered too heavily,
but only because they had expended all their limber ammunition and the
caissons were unable to come up. It was impossible for these batteries
to limber up under the hostile fire. It was likewise impossible to
destroy a battery, though without protecting shields, even when great
quantities of ammunition were expended.

   [324] _Kriegsgeschichtliche Einzelschriften_, 32, p. 43.

At the battle of Beaumont, the artillery of the 7th Infantry Division
suffered heavy losses. “Although the first caisson sections were up and
the men with them were detailed to assist in working the guns, the gun
squads in both batteries had dwindled down to 2 or 3 men each by 1 P.
M., _i.e._, within half an hour.” Immediately after the French attack
had been repulsed, one of these batteries was able to accompany the
advancing infantry, however, while the other (the 4th Light Battery)
could not move its guns until an hour later, as it had lost 29 men and
34 horses.[325] This example proves again that when artillery has once
managed to go into position and to open fire, it cannot be annihilated
by infantry alone, and therefore need not fear to take up a more than
temporary position in the first line.

   [325] HOFFBAUER, _Deutsche Artillerie_, 8, pp. 44 and 210.

   HOPFFGARTEN-HEIDLER, _Beaumont_, p. 40.

The best way for artillery to protect itself against annoyance from
hostile infantry fire is to push forward an infantry screen, even
if only a weak one. In the days when batteries had no shields, this
screen enabled artillery to devote its entire attention to the
principal target without regard to hostile infantry. At the present
time, especially in positions in rear of a crest and in long artillery
lines, the principal object of such a screen is to prevent hostile
patrols from molesting the artillery. Small detachments posted at wide
intervals are sufficient for this purpose. The flanks and rear are now
as in the past the vulnerable points and are most exposed to daring,
sudden attacks, even if only made by weak hostile detachments. (Par.
448 German I. D. R.).

 At the battle of =Vionville=,[326] about 5 P. M., four horse and
 seven field batteries of the IIIrd Army Corps were engaged near
 =Flavigny= with ten French batteries. After this artillery duel had
 lasted half an hour, French Guard Infantry advanced to the attack.
 This was repulsed by artillery fire at a range of 800 m., but the
 fire of the artillery was diverted from its proper objective by the
 advance of this infantry. Similarly, at =St. Privat=, two batteries
 of the Guard Artillery had to direct their fire on French skirmishers.

   [326] _Gen St. W._, I, p. 557.




IX. THE ATTACK.


The defense may repulse the enemy, but only the attack can annihilate
him. The decision as to whether the force is to attack or stand on
the defensive depends upon the tactical situation and the will of the
commander, and not upon numerical superiority, of which one is not
aware, as a rule, until after the battle.[327] Determined attacks,
again and again repeated, in spite of all failures, are the surest
means of gaining victory and of preventing the enemy from becoming
aware of his superiority. Only pressing reasons (marked hostile
superiority, necessity for awaiting approaching reinforcements, or
the failure of an attack), and never favorable terrain conditions,
should determine a commander to stand on the defensive. In defense the
eventual assumption of the offensive is kept constantly in view. A
commander who voluntarily stands on the defensive for the purpose of
letting the opponent attack, and then attacks him in turn, reaps only
the disadvantages and never the advantages of both the offensive and
the defensive.

   [327] See _Taktik_, V, p. 121, et seq.

The attack may take various forms, depending upon whether the
dispositions have to be made under hostile fire (surprise and
rencontre), or whether the enemy has renounced the initiative and
awaits the attack in a deployed formation, or in a position prepared
for defense (deliberately planned attack). In the last case the
attack requires more careful preparation and in many instances even
necessitates the employment of special auxiliaries (such as guns
capable of high angle fire, and engineer trains). However, the advance
of a strong firing line to within assaulting distance of the enemy, and
the uninterrupted fight for the superiority of fire, are common to all
attacks.

Aside from the attack against an enemy in position and the rencontre
there is an attack formation more closely resembling the rencontre in
character, which may be called the _abridged attack_.[328] This attack
formation is used in forestalling the enemy in occupying important
points, in preventing enveloping movements, in carrying out flank
attacks, in surprising the enemy, in warding off a hostile surprise,
in relieving the pressure on a neighboring force, etc. It is moreover
appropriate where the conformation of the ground or the time of day
prohibit a use of the rifle.

   [328] _Abgekürzter Angriff_.

 The first stages of the fight of the 6th Infantry Division at
 =Vionville= are of this character. The fire fight was relegated to
 the background in view of the constant movement to the front. The
 situation prohibited our properly taking advantage of our superior
 marksmanship.--The attack on the railroad cut of =Nuits=, during the
 late afternoon of December 18th, 1870, progressed similarly.[329]

   [329] KUNZ, _Gefecht von Nuits_, p. 19, et seq.


1. THE SURPRISE.[330]

   [330] See _Taktik_, V, p. 190.

Insufficient reconnaissance may place a force in a situation where it
will be obliged to go into action directly from route column or from
a formation unsuitable for combat, against an enemy who unexpectedly
opens a lively fire at short range, thus increasing the moral effect of
the surprise by actually inflicting losses. The force which is taken by
surprise will without doubt overrate the seriousness of the situation
and will be inclined to overestimate the strength and morale of the
opposing force. This must be taken into account in coming to a decision.

Above all else, it is important to develop, as promptly as possible,
a fire effect at least equivalent to that of the enemy, to let the
troops regain confidence, and to secure the initiative. A bold
decision is best calculated to extricate a force from such a critical
situation.[331] It is of little use to deploy, take cover, and open
fire, when the enemy is well concealed; a decision to retire is still
less to be approved, because at short ranges it is bound to lead to a
complete annihilation of the force. As a rule, a defeat can only be
averted, in such a case, by assuming the offensive and thus repulsing
the enemy. The decision for attacking directly from route column
(or, when the enemy is still at a distance, at least for deploying
toward the front) is the more justifiable, since an enemy who prepares
an ambuscade for us is, as a rule, conscious of his inferiority in
numbers, morale, and training, and resorts to deceit because he does
not dare to meet us in the open. Therefore, overwhelm the enemy with
fire and then charge him with the bayonet. An impetuous advance may
perhaps intimidate him, and our losses will be less, at any rate, than
if we turn our backs on him and await our fate in what is at best but
a poor position, as it is taken up, as a rule, during the first moment
of panic. However, even if a force that is taken by surprise cannot
avert disaster by making a determined counter-attack, it can at least
save its honor and morale. This is equally true of the rencontre on the
battlefield.

   [331] “No matter how unexpectedly the enemy may appear, you should
 never forget that he may be annihilated either with the bayonet or
 with fire. The choice between the two is not a difficult one, and the
 formation to be adopted is of secondary importance. When the enemy
 is at close quarters, always use the bayonet; if he is still at a
 distance, fire on him, and then use the bayonet.” DRAGOMIROV.


Examples of Surprises.

 The surprise at =Baalon= on September 17th, 1870.[332] The surprise
 at =Vouziers= on December 15th, 1870.[333] The conduct of the French
 infantry when surprised in its camp at =Beaumont=.

   [332] CARDINAL VON WIDDERN, _Krieg an den rückwärtigen
 Verbindungen_, I, p. 149.

   [333] _Ibid._, II, p. 125.

 During the battle of =Noisseville= there occurred an unusually
 instructive episode, the disastrous results of which could have been
 easily avoided if the mounted officers on duty with the force had
 been sent out to reconnoiter. Six companies of the 44th Infantry
 (Prussian) were advancing from =Flanville= against =Montoy=. On
 the French side, the 62nd Infantry was likewise advancing against
 Flanville and had arrived at Montoy when the 44th Infantry (Prussian)
 very unexpectedly appeared on its left flank. The French regimental
 commander decided to attack at once. “The Prussian detachments
 advancing south of Montoy were about to scale the west slope of
 the ravine near there, when, at very short range, they suddenly
 encountered the rapid fire of a dense French skirmish line, which was
 immediately followed by the counter-attack, consisting of columns
 in close order. At the same moment, the left flank of the Prussians
 was attacked from the south, and other hostile columns advanced from
 the park through the west entrance of the village. The Prussian
 skirmish lines were repulsed in an instant, and thrown into complete
 confusion. The hostile fire had an annihilating effect on account of
 the short range, and the situation was at once completely reversed.
 The Prussians sought in vain to gain a firm foothold in the eastern
 outskirts of the village of Montoy. Their losses were heavy. The four
 companies (3rd, 9th, 11th and 12th) of the 44th Infantry numbered
 in all 18 officers and 840 men; they lost 7 officers and 480 men,
 of which number 1 officer and 82 men (all unharmed) were taken
 prisoners. The 9th Company suffered least; but the 3rd, 11th and
 12th Companies (44th Infantry) lost in all 55.5% of their effective
 strength, the 3rd Company even losing 67%.”[334]

   [334] KUNZ, _Noisseville_, p. 32, et seq.

 This surprise could without doubt have been avoided. If the 44th
 Infantry had sent mounted men ahead, it would have been in a position
 to let the French walk into its fire. Soon after this occurrence,
 the French infantry also unexpectedly received flanking fire from
 Flanville, which forced it to abandon the pursuit after suffering
 some losses.

When two forces unexpectedly collide in close country, the advantage
rests decidedly with the one that opens fire and advances to the charge
first. This onslaught with cold steel should become second nature
to the troops. In traversing close country, a force should be in a
formation that enables it to develop an adequate fire and to make a
charge in compact formation. A line formation is entirely unsuitable,
as a rule, on account of the difficulties of the terrain to be
overcome, and in a skirmish line the officers cannot properly control
the men.

For passing through thinly scattered timber without underbrush,[335]
company column is a suitable formation, and for dense woods platoons
advancing either abreast or echeloned, each platoon in line of squads
in columns of files. If the platoons or sections were to advance in
single file, the columns would be too long, and it would be next to
impossible to maintain the intervals. The six or eight small columns
of files of a platoon are, on the other hand, close enough together to
keep each other in view; besides, they are easily and quickly deployed
for firing and charging, and can meander through the woods more readily
than an organization in close order. Moreover, the leaders can exercise
better control over the men than in skirmish line, which invariably
bunches up at the places that are most easily passed, while connection
is not maintained at all at other points and march direction and
cohesion is lost. (See the passage of the Bois de Givodeau during the
battle of Beaumont).[336]

   [335] See _Taktik_, VI, p. 117, et seq.

   [336] See _Taktik_, VI, p. 125, with sketch. HOPFFGARTEN-HEIDLER,
 _Beaumont_, p. 112, et seq.

   Examples: The conduct of the infantry of the IXth Army Corps in
 passing through the Niederwald of Wörth, may serve as a model. KUNZ,
 _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, 13, p. 108, et seq.

   Engagement of La Landrière on January 11th, 1871. _Geschichte des
 Regiments Nr. 20_, p. 292.

   _Wald- und Ortsgefecht_, p. 109.


2. THE RENCONTRE.[337]

(Pars. 315-317 and 352-361 German I. D. R.).

   [337] See also _Taktik_, V, p. 192, et seq.

“Uncertainty and haziness of the situation are the rule in war. During
marches in campaign the opponents will frequently not gain detailed
information of each other until they come into actual contact. Thus
the rencontre develops out of a collision of route columns.” (Par. 352
German I. D. R.).

Both forces are marching toward each other, and the collision occurs
frequently at a point not intended by either; as every minute brings
the heads of the two columns closer together no time is to be lost.
The commander who desires to wait until he can come to a decision
consonant with the results of the reconnaissance will arrive too late.
The tactical situation in its entirety determines whether or not an
attack should be made. If we do not take advantage of the fleeting
moment the enemy will surely do so, and, as a rule, he will not be
any better prepared for action than we are. Frequently the deployment
from route column is not made because the commander desires it, but
because it is necessary in order to avert a crisis in the leading line.
The commander who is acting under hostile pressure should endeavor to
regain the upper hand as quickly as possible so that he can dispose
of the troops of the main body with a definite object in view. In a
rencontre, the advantage rests almost invariably with the commander
who quickly sizes up the situation, attacks promptly, and succeeds in
throwing the opponent on the defensive. A bold, impetuous attack, which
would lead to disaster in the presence of an opponent already deployed,
may, in this case, be productive of victory. The direction in which the
attack is made is of less importance than a prompt decision on the part
of the commander and the simultaneous launching of the whole force in a
definite direction. We must take the terrain as we find it. In covered
terrain, the effect of the surprise will be increased still more, while
in open country, the preparatory stage of the combat will soon lose
that character, because the side which has an advantage as regards
terrain will make use of it, and the conviction will force itself upon
the opponent that victory cannot be gained by an impetuous attack
alone. It will be easy for a commander to come to a decision as to the
action to be taken if he is conscious of his own strength or fears that
the enemy desires to avoid an attack. (The commanders of the advanced
troops of the IIIrd Army Corps at Vionville). _The rencontre increases
the difficulties of troop leading, but makes the attack easier for the
troops._

      *       *       *       *       *

The difference between a deliberately planned attack and a rencontre is
most clearly apparent in the conduct of the advance guard. Its task is
to secure the prospective artillery position and to create favorable
conditions for the combat of the main body. This requires that ground
be gained to the front so as to enable the main body to deploy while
moving forward. In addition, the advance guard should seize and hold
important points, without, however, anticipating the intentions of
the commander of the whole force. It is moreover desirable for the
advance guard to interfere with the hostile deployment. Points lying
on the flanks or in advance of the artillery position, especially if
they command the latter, should be quickly seized; when necessary, the
advance guard must fight for their possession. Its commander should
quickly pick out the points that are important for this purpose; he
should, by no means, be satisfied always to begin the fight where the
point of the advance guard happens to be. Under certain circumstances
the main body will have to concentrate for action farther to the rear
so as to hasten the deployment and to take advantage of favorable
terrain. When the enemy has an undeniable start in deployment, the
commander may decide to let the opponent advance to the attack, and
then bring about the decision by simultaneously launching his main
body. Only thus can one in the long run avoid fighting superior
numbers with an inferior force. (Par. 360 German I. D. R.). It is much
easier to decide whether this or that point is of importance, than to
answer the question as to whether the strength of the advance guard
will suffice for the task of taking it. The reports of the cavalry in
regard to the enemy’s strength and the composition and formation of his
columns, will scarcely furnish an adequate basis for a pertinent answer
to this question. Moreover, one will usually not be able to tell,
until after the action has commenced, how far the hostile deployment
has progressed. But, in any case, long hostile firing lines demand
caution. However, a start in deployment is not indicated by the combat
frontage alone. A factor of far greater importance is which force has
been most successful in making preparations for going into action by
developing its main body and by having artillery near at hand. It is
artillery that clears up the situation. When an infantry division
encounters a hostile force deployed on a front of 400-600 m., this
does not necessarily mean that the entire division must systematically
concentrate for action, as this would cause a considerable loss
of time, thus giving the enemy a great advantage. _The general
situation and the mission of a force are of greater importance for the
commander’s decision, than the state of readiness for action of the
opposing forces._

_Issue of orders._ See _Taktik_, V, p. 197.

The advance guard must be promptly informed of the intentions of the
commander (_i.e._, whether he intends to attack, to concentrate for
attack farther to the rear, or to let the enemy attack[338]) and of the
location of the prospective artillery position. The attack order should
be withheld until the combat of the advance guard has sufficiently
cleared the situation, but a development of the force should be ordered
at once.

   [338] Par. 350 German I. D. R.

The advanced detachments should endeavor to gain a start in deployment
over the enemy and cover the advancing artillery in front and flank,
by quickly deploying strong firing lines and pushing machine guns to
the front. After they have done this, they should promptly advance
to the attack. Through this, our firing line, while in the act of
deploying, runs the serious risk of suddenly encountering, at short
range, the fire of superior hostile troops, at a time when all the
troops approaching the field are still too far distant to increase its
fire power.[339] Whether the quickly formed firing lines should at once
move forward to the attack in a rencontre, depends upon the impressions
received by the commander. His dispositions should be such as to compel
the enemy to disclose his available forces at an early moment. Every
fighting line is so sensitive to fire simultaneously delivered against
its front and flank, that an attempt to turn the hostile position will
instantly force the enemy to take counter-measures. If the enemy is
unable to keep pace with us in deploying a firing line, if he is unable
to deploy skirmish lines as dense as ours, this state of affairs
should induce our commander to proceed to the attack; if the reverse
state of affairs exists, he should await the arrival of reinforcements.
But in order to obtain this insight into the existing situation the
troops must get close to the enemy. Such an insight into the hostile
dispositions cannot be gained at long range. The extent of a hostile
position may perhaps be determined at long range with the best field
glasses, but the strength and power of resistance of the enemy can
never be gauged in this manner. If one threatens to push an attack
home, however, the enemy will be compelled to show his hand. When
opposed by an enemy whose strength is unknown, it will unquestionably
be necessary to approach to the extreme limit of short ranges. From
here the dispositions of the enemy may be clearly recognized, and, in
addition, at 600-800 m., a firing line that has made a lodgment in
some feature of the terrain will not as yet be exposed to annihilating
losses. Misconceptions are scarcely to be avoided in such a situation.
One must trust to luck and take some risks. On the other hand, the
training of the infantry should afford the assurance that it will not
give up the position it has once reached; it should firmly hold the
ground gained, and persevere.[340]

   [339] This induces the British _Infantry Training_ to prescribe
 that in a rencontre a concentration for attack should invariably be
 ordered.

   [340] Military history furnishes a multitude of examples of
 the fact that a force can persevere in spite of the most galling
 fire (St. Privat. Gorni Dubniac). A reverse does not occur, as a
 rule, until the advent of unforeseen circumstances. The Brigade of
 Highlanders held out for hours at Magersfontain, and an insignificant
 change of front on the right flank subsequently caused the whole line
 to retire. See _Kriegsgeschichtliche Einzelschriften_, 32, p. 74.

When infantry is compelled to go into action, the necessity of
occupying important supporting points and of gaining ground for the
concentration for action, requires a broad front to be covered. (Par.
357 German I. D. R.). The artillery, which will arrive soon thereafter,
will then bring relief to the infantry in critical situations.

In every rencontre there comes a moment when the fight is at a
standstill. At this moment an attentive observer may notice that,
although it is impossible to push the attack home without further
reinforcements, the space in which the concentration for action is to
take place, is secured against a hostile attack, or that the enemy has
been deprived of the initiative and has been thrown on the defensive.
This is the moment in which the commander regains the initiative
and in which, by means of an _attack order_, he can dispose of the
troops of the main body as he sees fit. _The “rencontre” differs
from the “deliberately planned attack,” in that, in the latter, the
concentration for action can proceed smoothly as desired by the
commander, while in a rencontre the opponent, for the time being,
dictates the course of action. Therefore the commander should make
efforts to free himself from this restraint, i.e., he should endeavor
to launch his troops in a manner not influenced by the dispositions of
the enemy._

The degree of control which a commander retains over the course of the
combat depends upon the promptness with which he gains a general idea
of the situation. For this, if for no other reason, he should be as
near the head of the column as possible while on the march. The troops
sent first into action, supported by the artillery, must put every
available man into the fight, in order to repulse attacks made by the
enemy and to enable the commander to launch the main body as an entity.
In any case, the battalions of the main body should not be successively
thrown into the fight as soon as they arrive, for the purpose of
overcoming a temporary crisis, or for relieving the advance guard from
a dilemma. The machine gun batteries, whose employment was particularly
important during the preparatory stage of the fight, should be
withdrawn as early as possible so as to be available as a reserve in
the hands of the commander.

In bringing the main body into action, deployments by the flank should
be avoided. The deployment should be initiated by subordinate units
(in an infantry division, by regiments) moving out of the route column
and toward the objective points determined by the purpose of the
combat.[341]

   [341] General VON SCHLICHTING holds a different view in his work
 _Taktische und strategische Grundsätze_, I, p. 106. “In a rencontre,
 the piece on the board of the battlefield can be moved only when the
 next one is clear of the march column and ready for action. Further
 action is then not only permissible but imperative.”


Provisions of Various Regulations.

 In all the regulations, those of Germany excepted, the rencontre is
 treated with marked reserve.

 =Austria.= “When a collision occurs with an opponent who is likewise
 in the act of advancing--_rencontre_--the different parts of the
 force and their subdivisions must make strenuous efforts to advance
 in the designated direction. In a rencontre, it will be proper to
 concentrate the main forces, prior to making the attack, only in case
 it becomes apparent during the preparatory stage of the action that
 the enemy has gained a visible start in deployment. The endeavor
 to forestall the enemy, and the necessity of promptly reinforcing
 the troops already engaged, will often curtail or preclude the
 preparatory concentration of the main body in a rencontre, and force
 the commander to permit at least parts of his approaching troops to
 go directly into action.” If conditions are eminently favorable for
 the enemy at the point where the collision occurs, it may sometimes
 be more desirable to stand provisionally on the defensive with the
 advance guard until other troops come up.

 “Under such circumstances, it may even be advisable to withdraw the
 troops covering the march; but in that event, the relation of the
 force to neighboring columns should be considered.”

 =France.= The commander should decide promptly whether to attack, to
 stand on the defensive, or to avoid an engagement for the time being.
 The regulations do not provide for employing the troops directly
 from route column. The advance guard is frequently thrown on its own
 resources; it is often forced to fight on a very broad front, and
 to place all of its troops into action at the very beginning of an
 engagement for the purpose of seizing and holding supporting points
 necessary for the subsequent deployment.


Examples.

 1. The deployment for action of the 5th Infantry Division from the
 defile of Gorze, against the French Division Vergé, at the battle of
 =Vionville= (16th August, 1870), is especially instructive.[342]

   [342] _Gen. St. W._, I, p. 549. VON SCHERFF, _Kriegslehren_, II,
 p. 50. KUNZ, _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, 8-9, p. 32, et seq.
 _Taktik_, V, p. 210.

 2. The engagement of the 2nd Bavarian Division at =La Thibaudine=
 (=Beaumont=). The French concentration for action had progressed
 farther than that of the Bavarians. The reconnaissance by the cavalry
 was insufficient.[343]

   [343] HOPFFGARTEN-HEIDLER, _Beaumont_, p. 90.

 3. The fight of Mondel’s Brigade at =Trautenau=.[344] Likewise the
 fight of the Vth Army Corps at =Nachod= on June 27th, 1866.

   [344] _Taktik_, V, p. 206. STROBL, _Trautenau_, p. 8, et seq.
 KÜHNE, _Kritische Wanderungen_, 3, p. 16.




X. THE ATTACK ON AN ENEMY DEPLOYED FOR DEFENSE.


1. LESSONS OF WAR.

 During the =Boer War= (1899-1902), the British infantry always
 attacked positions prepared for defense. Aside from the superannuated
 fire tactics and deficient marksmanship training of the British,
 their failures in the early engagements of the war may generally be
 traced to the following causes:--

 1. Insufficient reconnaissance. This caused British detachments to be
 surprised, in a number of cases, by fire at short range. (Brigade of
 the Guards at =Modder River=). In many instances, the British forces
 were even surprised by fire while in close order formations. (Hart’s
 Brigade at =Colenso=).

 2. Pure frontal attacks, in which equal forces were frequently pitted
 against each other. (=Modder River=, =Magersfontain=, =Colenso=).

 3. Insufficient protection of the flanks by echelons against fire
 surprises carried out by small detachments.

 4. Insufficient coöperation of the artillery and infantry.

 5. Isolated attacks made by brigades (consisting of 4 battalions).
 The employment of several brigades simultaneously for concerted
 action was a rare exception.

 6. Insufficient support of the firing line. A timely reinforcement of
 an organization that had already been shaken never did occur.

 7. Hesitating use of reserves in the crisis of the fight. At
 =Magersfontain= only 8¹⁄₂ battalions out of 13, and at =Colenso=
 only 6 battalions out of 16¹⁄₂, had been seriously engaged. When
 =Spionskop= was evacuated, 11 battalions had not as yet been engaged.
 The attacks were begun, but not pushed home.


The Infantry Attack in the Russo-Japanese War.

 The combat tactics of the Russian infantry[345] (Russian I. D. R.
 of 1903) were based on shock action, narrow frontage, and deep
 formations. The bayonet training preached by Dragomirov was the
 result of the belief in decisive psychological impressions and the
 consciousness that the Russian fire tactics, based upon volley fire,
 were inadequate to annihilate a well concealed defender. Thus, the
 endeavor to cross blades with the opponent as quickly as possible,
 led to a headlong rush to the front, without creating the preliminary
 conditions necessary for pushing the attack home. The hesitation of
 the higher commanders to throw in every available man at the decisive
 stage, and the tendency, reaching down to the lowest grades, of
 creating detachments and separate missions, contrasted unfavorably
 with this splendid offensive spirit.

   [345] “The Russian infantry is embued with a mixture of defensive
 spirit and instinct for hand to hand fighting.” COUNT MARENZI.

 The Japanese infantry was trained according to the letter and spirit
 of the German regulations of 1889. It had fought shy of unhealthy
 tendencies after the Boer war, cultivated the independence and
 initiative of all leaders, and recognized the necessity of night
 combats and of using the spade. In addition, the way for success was
 carefully, almost cautiously, prepared by the commander-in-chief, who
 left nothing to chance. It is easy for subordinate leaders to be bold
 and daring, when they know that the commander-in-chief has neglected
 nothing to ensure victory. The principal characteristics of the
 Japanese combats were--

 1. The cautious advance, frequently under cover of darkness;

 2. The systematic preparation of the attack by the coöperation of
 infantry and artillery, and the determined advance along the whole
 front;

 3. The attempt to induce the enemy to launch infantry at a point
 where the decisive attack was not to take place;[346]

   [346] The advance of the Vth Army at Mukden.

 4. The sudden launching of the decisive attack;

 5. The prompt preparation of every captured position for defense;

 6. The absence of pursuit.

 The fights at =Wafangu=,[347] as well as the attack made by the Guard
 and the 12th Division at the =Yalu=[348] proceeded entirely according
 to German pattern.

   [347] _Einzelschriften über den Russisch-Japanischen Krieg_,
 Vienna, 1906, I, p. 226. The envelopment of the Russian right flank
 by the Japanese 19th Brigade is especially instructive.

   [348] _Ibid._, I, p. 79, et seq. _Kriegsgeschichtliche
 Einzelschriften_, 39-40, p. 123, et seq. Consult also VON LÜTTWITZ,
 _Angriffsverfahren der Japaner_, p. 2.

 A change took place in the tactical methods of the Japanese when the
 Russian artillery--whose ballistic properties were superior to those
 of its antagonist--brought a greater number of guns into the field,
 and when, in addition, the Japanese infantry became numerically
 inferior in the battles after Liao Yang.[349]

   [349] The statements in regard to the strength of the opposing
 forces are still very contradictory. At Liao Yang 120,000 Japanese
 confronted 150,000 Russians; at Mukden the Russians had perhaps
 10,000 rifles, 300 field guns, and 100 heavy pieces of ordnance more
 than the Japanese.

 The task set commanders of armies and leaders of troops by the
 government, had to be met by a continuance of the offensive.[350]
 The peculiar character of the theater of war made it difficult to
 maneuver the enemy out of his strong positions; so at best nothing
 remained for the Japanese--unless they wished to renounce the
 offensive entirely--but to conquer the enemy by attacking him in
 front. Since the advantages of the attack--superior numbers and the
 freedom of choosing the point of attack--were thus dissipated, the
 victory had to be gained by making use of defensive expedients. As
 the demoralizing and retarding effect produced by fire increased
 more rapidly than the morale of the assailant, nothing remained but
 to intrench and to take advantage of the cover afforded by darkness
 as in fortress warfare. Moreover, the inferior forces available
 precluded deep formations and necessitated an immediate development
 of the entire force in one line. Thus the desire to push forward
 resolved itself into an advance along a broad front. Favored by the
 purely passive conduct of the Russians, this led to an envelopment of
 their flanks and a pressure on their line of retreat. The Japanese
 were able to overcome the constantly growing power of resistance
 of the Russian defense, because, while strictly adhering to the
 offensive, they availed themselves of defensive expedients although
 their movements were retarded thereby.

   [350] C. H. _Über das innere Wesen der japanischen und
 neuzeitlichen Offensive. Streffleur_, 1907, October number.

 The conduct of the attack was, of course, considerably influenced
 by the character of the terrain. The 1st Army, fighting in hilly
 country, perhaps remained true longer to regulation formations and
 long rushes than the other Japanese forces, but was finally obliged
 to resort to a wide extension of closed bodies. The IInd and IVth
 Armies were differently situated, as the attack over open plains fell
 to their lot.

 Speaking generally, the following details may be given in regard
 to the method of attack of the Ist Japanese Army:[351] Units were
 pushed into action abreast; objective points were assigned to each;
 and certain lines or points, according to which they had to maintain
 touch, were indicated to subordinate units. To avoid a surprise, if
 for no other reason, thin firing lines were formed at the outset, and
 in a serious attack whole companies, in dense firing lines capable of
 developing a strong fire, were at once thrown in; these advanced to
 mid ranges in order to open fire, as a rule, under 1000 m. The Ist
 army had a special _penchant_ for making rushes of 80-100 m.,[352]
 usually by entire companies; the assault was, in many instances,
 begun as far as 300 m. from the hostile position, and then pushed
 home; supports and reserves followed in extended formation, but
 assembled promptly on reaching cover. The infantry was disinclined
 to intrench during an advance, but never neglected to fortify
 quickly a captured position. In the combats of the Ist Army we will
 find the best lessons applicable to our conditions.

   [351] _Streffleur_, 1907, January number.

   [352] This is not true of the 4th Guard Regiment. See VON LÜTTWITZ,
 _Angriffsverfahren der Japaner_, p. 24: Rushes of 50 m. were made
 “as the men otherwise got out of breath and shot badly.” An advance
 was made by squads and crawling was tabooed. The new Japanese Drill
 Regulations warn against making rushes less than 30-40 m. long. On
 the other hand, according to the opinion of von Lüttwitz, the length
 of rushes will seldom exceed 100 m.


Examples.

 1. The engagement of the Guard Division at =Yangtsuling= on July
 31st, 1904.[353]

   [353] GERTSCH, I, pp. 92 and 100 (Good maps). SIR IAN HAMILTON, _A
 Staff Officer’s Scrap Book_, I, p. 313. _Urteile und Beobachtungen
 von Mitkämpfern_, I, p. 57.

 2. The attack made on October 11th, 1904, by the 15th Infantry
 Brigade (2nd Infantry Division) against =Temple Hill= (=Terrayama=),
 which was held by 4-6 companies.[354]

   [354] BRONSART V. SCHELLENDORFF, _Beim japanischen Feldheer_, p.
 132.--VON LÜTTWITZ, _Angriffsverfahren der Japaner_, p. 23.

 Fire was opened at 900 m.; long rushes were used and firing line and
 supports were deployed; after a brief but violent fire action at 500
 m., the hostile position was reached in a single rush and carried.

 The artillery, to be sure, supported this attack with accelerated
 fire.

 3. The attack made by the 4th Guard Regiment on October 12th, 1904,
 against a height south of =Huaku= (battle on the =Shaho=).[355]

   [355] _Ibid._, p. 24.

 4. The attack made by the 3rd Brigade (2nd Infantry Division) under
 General Matsanuga, on October 12th, 1904 (long rushes), against the
 heights south of =Shotasko= (battle on the =Shaho=).

_Outline Sketch of the Formation of the 3rd Brigade._

                         Frontage about 2000 m.

                 4. Infantry:                            29. Infantry:

 5. and 6.     4. and 2.       12. and 11. Cos.         10. and 2. Cos.
 ---------     ---------       -----------              ----------
 7. and 8.     1. and 3. Cos.                            9. and 3. Cos.

                           Brigade Reserve:

                  9. and 10. Cos.      11. and 12._ Cos.
                  ---------------      -----------------
                    4. Infantry.         29. Infantry.

 Troops in the act of coming up, but not employed:

                                       1. and 4. Cos.        II. Bn.
                                       -------------- and -------------
                                        29. Infantry.     29. Infantry.

 First line: Eight companies (apparently entirely deployed). Interval
 between skirmishers 3 paces; between companies 40 paces.

 The first halt (lasting seven minutes) was made at 1500 m. and
 the distance to 800 m. was then covered at a rapid run. The men
 that could not keep up, halted to recover their breath and then
 followed independently. At 800 m., the line opened a lively fire at
 will, which lasted for two minutes, and then advanced by rushes
 by companies (first the right, then the left companies of the
 battalions). During this advance the supports (2 battalions) were
 absorbed by the firing line. At the same time the brigade reserve
 approached closer to the firing line (the original distance between
 reserve and firing line, before the advance began, was 300 m.). The
 last halt for firing was made at 250 m., from the enemy’s position,
 and the latter was then carried in one rush. The losses amounted only
 to 235 men.[356]

   [356] VON LÜTTWITZ, _Angriffsverfahren der Japaner_, p. 24. SIR IAN
 HAMILTON, _A Staff Officer’s Scrap Book_, II. Consult the same work
 on the unsuccessful pursuing action fought by the 3rd Brigade at the
 Chosenrei Pass.

      *       *       *       *       *

 In the IInd and IVth Armies, who fought, as a rule, on terrain
 devoid of cover, a far more cautious method of attack was produced.
 The distinguishing features of this mode of attack were thin firing
 lines (skirmishers at intervals of 5-10 paces) increasing only very
 gradually in density, and great frontage (a company 250, a battalion
 800, and a brigade 2000-3000 m.).[357] This caused the attack to
 falter in many instances as soon as it had come within 400 m. of the
 hostile position, whereupon nothing remained but for the line to
 intrench and to work forward slowly from one position to another.

   [357] VON LÜTTWITZ, _Angriffsverfahren der Japaner_, p. 47.


Examples.

 1. The engagement of the 3rd Infantry Division on October 12th, 1904,
 at =Shiliho= (battle on the =Shaho=).[358]

   [358] _Ibid._, p. 26.

 2. The engagement of the 5th Infantry Division, from March 6th to
 9th, north of =Madiapu= (battle of =Mukden=). This division required
 three days to work forward from 1100 m. to within assaulting
 distance of the enemy’s position. Cover for men standing upright was
 constructed at 1100, 950, 530, 390, 300, 200, 160 and 125 m., that
 under 300 m. being built of sand bags.[359]

   [359] _Ibid._, p. 52. The attack order of the 5th Infantry
 Division, in _Urteile und Beobachtungen von Mitkämpfern_, I, p. 121.

 3. The combats of the 10th Division on March 3rd and 10th, 1904
 (battle of =Mukden=).[360]

   [360] BRONSART VON SCHELLENDORFF, _Beim japanischen Feldheer_, pp.
 217, et seq., 225, et seq., 242 and 244, et seq. On the use of sand
 bags, consult _ibid._, pp. 236 and 292.

 Confidential British instructions dealing with the tactical lessons
 of the =Russo-Japanese war=, make the following deductions:
 “* * * * The above shows the great importance of local reconnaissance
 by infantry, of which considerably more must be demanded than has been
 done up to the present time in European armies. It shows, moreover,
 the advantages of thin firing lines during the preparatory stage of
 the action, and the insignificant effect produced by shrapnel and
 long range fire on such lines in which it is desirable to advance,
 without halting on the way, to within 1000 yards of the enemy. The
 necessity of gaining a superiority of fire before advancing to the
 assault, and the necessity of an increased supply of ammunition, are
 confirmed anew. It is further demonstrated that the bayonet of the
 infantryman is still capable of playing an important role in battle.”


2. THE CONDITIONS UPON WHICH SUCCESS DEPENDS.

The Russo-Japanese war confirms the opinion that the issue of combat
is but little influenced by the formations taken up; that _esprit_
and the determination to conquer are of far greater importance than
any formation. The most difficult task that infantry can be called
upon to perform consists of successfully pushing home an attack over
open ground commanded by hostile fire. “It would be wrong,” said
Fieldmarshal Moltke, “were one to attempt to lay down in regulations
that a force should not advance over a plain against an enemy under
cover. _But every superior commander ought to consider what such an
operation portends._” Heavy losses are unavoidable in a destructive
fire fight lasting for hours.[361] The attack will not succeed so long
as the enemy commands the plain with his fire. The commander of the
attacking force must find ways and means to wrest this command from the
enemy. All of the battles of recent campaigns have demonstrated that
an attack is bound to succeed if it is thoroughly prepared by infantry
and artillery fire, is undertaken by adequate forces, and is pushed
with determination close to the enemy; and that such an attack is, in
fact, superior to the defensive. The success of an attack on a position
prepared for defense might depend upon the following preliminary
conditions:

(a) Careful reconnaissance, for the purpose of determining the most
favorable direction for the attack.

(b) Occupation of the foreground of the hostile position. When the
foreground is entirely open, an advance must be made under cover of
darkness up to the medium ranges.

(c) Preparation of the infantry attack by the closest coöperation of
infantry and artillery.

(d) Timely determination of the point at which the decisive attack is
to be made.

(e) Careful utilization of the terrain during the advance, so as to
allow of delaying the opening of fire until the force is as close as
possible to the enemy.

(f) Suitable disposition, distribution in depth, and deployment of
a strong force for the purpose of bringing about a superiority of
infantry fire. The organization detailed to make the attack must have
its entire effective strength available for accomplishing its proper
task, and not be compelled to detach parts for guarding its flanks.

(g) Ensuring concerted and simultaneous action on the part of the
attacking forces. As the enemy has given up any idea of assuming the
offensive, at least for the time being, the attacker should not allow
the advantage to escape him of choosing time and direction of the
attack.

   [361] General VON SCHLICHTING, in his work _Taktische und
 strategische Grundsätze_, maintains the opinion--in contrast to
 General VON SCHERFF--that open terrain commanded by hostile fire is
 impassable for infantry. At any rate, military history has yet to
 furnish proof of this.


3. PREPARATION OF THE ATTACK.


Reconnaissance. Preparatory Position.

“If the enemy decides to stand on the defensive, he renounces the
initiative for the time being. The attacker will then have time to
reconnoiter the hostile position and to weigh all the circumstances
that favor the attack. He should not limit himself to reconnaissance
by the cavalry and to observation through field glasses. Mounted
officers’ and infantry officers’ patrols should supplement this
reconnaissance, and complete the information gained as the enemy is
approached.” (Pars. 362 and 363 German I. D. R.).

The local reconnaissance (see p. 248 supra) should be conducted with
all possible care; timely directions should be given in regard to
it during the approach to the battlefield;[362] the activity of the
reconnoitering bodies should continually increase as the enemy is
approached; and the work itself should be divided in a systematic
manner. Excessive thoroughness may retard reconnaissance work to
such an extent, on short winter days especially, that success may be
jeopardized. (Par. 305 German I. D. R.). As a result freedom of action
will be lost and the energy of the attack weakened. It would be wholly
wrong to postpone the decision for making the attack until something
definite is known of the strength and dispositions of the enemy.
These matters are almost never cleared up until after the battle. The
decision as to whether or not an attack should be made is determined
primarily by the general situation. (Par. 355 German I. D. R.). The
latter may force a commander to advance promptly without permitting
him to await the results of the reconnaissance. The character of the
terrain and the preparation the enemy is known to have made, determine
whether the commander ought to attack at once, whether he ought to
utilize the cover of darkness for the advance of the attacking troops,
or whether he ought to attempt to maneuver the defender out of his
position.

   [362] According to experience the reconnaissance work generally
 flags during a halt, although that is the very time when an increased
 activity is desirable. The reconnaissance work in the IXth Corps on
 August 18th, 1870, from the arrival at Caulre until the advance guard
 opened the fight, is particularly instructive. _Der 18. August_, pp.
 124, et seq. and 215.

The information required as a basis for this decision will, as a rule,
not be obtainable without a fight. In spite of all the objections
arrayed against reconnaissances in force, they cannot be avoided, if
it is desired to gain prompt and certain insight into the enemy’s
situation. It cannot be expected that the defender will passively
permit the assailant to gain an insight into his dispositions. A
feint will accomplish nothing; the enemy must be seriously engaged,
so that he will show his hand.[363] Yet in spite of these combats,
misapprehensions are not precluded.

   [363] It was the intention of the Japanese commander-in-chief, on
 October 10th, 1904 (battle on the Shaho), to attack the Russian army
 before it had completed its concentration for battle. The advance
 guards of the Reserve Division and of the 5th Division encountered
 advanced Russian detachments at Kushutsy (Xth Army Corps), and at
 Wulitaisy (XVIIth Army Corps), whose weakness was, however, not
 recognized. In the belief that the Russian main position had been
 encountered, the advance on the hostile position was ordered for the
 night 10/11th October, the attack to take place at daybreak on the
 11th. 9th Supplement to the _Militär-Wochenblatt_, 1906, p. 327.

It is quite natural that isolated detachments, in their endeavor to
gain an insight into the hostile dispositions, may find themselves
suddenly within short range of the enemy. In such a situation, the
detachment should maintain its position, as its fire will frequently
facilitate the approach of the other attacking troops. Almost every one
of the more serious engagements furnishes examples illustrating this
feature.[364]

   [364] The perseverance of Nambu’s Brigade on March 7th, in the
 “three houses” (Yuhuntun near Mukden). _Vierteljahrshefte_, 1907,
 p. 78. The perseverance of the troops in the Palungshan works,
 captured on August 22nd, 1904, by being enveloped on both flanks.
 (Port Arthur). _Streffleur_, _Einzelschriften_, 4, pp. 81 and 91.
 The perseverance of parts of the IInd Battalion of the 3rd Guard
 Regiment in the engagement at Towan (31st July, 1904). _Urteile und
 Beobachtungen von Mitkämpfern_, I, p. 60.

In order to guard the reconnoitering troops from being driven back, if
for no other reason, it is advisable to place in readiness an adequate
force of artillery. As the artillery is protected by shields, it can
take up the fight even against superior artillery with better chances
of succeeding than in the past.

If the commander has decided to attack and has determined against
what part of the hostile position the main attack is to be made, the
foreground of the hostile position is at once occupied, and the enemy’s
advanced troops forced back, so as to prevent the defender from gaining
an insight into the dispositions of the assailant.

The assailant should launch as few troops as possible for initiating
the action. They should avoid engaging prematurely in a fire fight with
the infantry of the hostile main position, even if the terrain would
permit a covered approach to short range. If the advanced troops allow
themselves to be enticed into doing this, they expose themselves to the
danger of suffering a defeat, and oblige the commander of the whole
force to launch for their relief troops that were intended for the main
attack.[365]

   [365] “It is a general principle to push as close as the terrain
 permits to the enemy’s position with advance troops for the purpose
 of opening fire.”

Insufficient information in regard to the enemy and undue precipitation
in issuing orders may place advanced troops in such an unfavorable
situation. If the defender allows himself to be tricked into assuming
the offensive for the purpose of driving off harassing detachments, so
much the better for the assailant, for the latter’s artillery will then
find an opportunity to fire on the enemy.[366]

   [366] The French regulations hint at this. Look up the advance of
 French infantry during the combats around Ste. Marie aux Chênes. _Der
 18. August_, pp. 174 and 179.

 =Austria.= “Under certain circumstances, the covering troops will
 have to be reinforced at an early moment in order that a strong line
 may be formed opposite the enemy, but, in many cases, they will
 nevertheless still abstain from advancing into the zone of effective
 fire.” The Austrians usually employ strong covering bodies. The
 Germans desire to ensure simultaneous action on the part of all the
 troops in opening the combat.

 At =Spicheren= the commander of the 14th Infantry Division, under
 the erroneous assumption that the heights of Spicheren were only
 occupied by troops covering the entraining at Forbach, issued orders
 to General von François to drive away the hostile artillery. All of
 Frossard’s Corps, however, was in position on the heights on which
 the artillery was posted.[367]

   [367] _Gen. St. W._, I, p. 310.

 At 10 A. M., on August 6th, 1870, the commanding general of the Vth
 Army Corps issued orders to the advance guard to cross the Sauer with
 four battalions at =Wörth= and =Spachbach= (1500 m. apart) and to
 occupy Wörth and the heights beyond, where the entire corps of Mac
 Mahon was in position.[368]

   [368] _Gen. St. W._, I, p. 320.

The advance of the attacking troops, under cover of the advance guard,
into a preparatory position, is made in such a manner that units are
opposite their objectives when the subsequent forward movement against
the enemy is begun.[369] This frequently requires a rearrangement of
the forces so that even an assailant who is numerically inferior may
be superior at the decisive point. A simultaneous attack from the
front and flanks requires reserves everywhere and is opposed to the
economical employment of the forces; it may easily lead to failure, and
is justifiable only when the assailant is greatly superior in numbers
or morale.

   [369] The deployment of the 1st Infantry Brigade of the Guard, near
 Ste. Marie aux Chênes, against St. Privat. _Der 18. August_ p. 408.

A premature deployment impairs the leader’s influence on the course
of the combat and makes it difficult to change the direction of the
attack. Route columns, taking advantage of all available cover, will,
therefore, be retained as long as possible, and only subordinate units
permitted to march directly toward their proper objectives, until the
hostile fire compels a more extended deployment (development). The
preparatory position is taken up in the last sheltered area in front
of the hostile position, provided that that area is large enough to
accommodate the attacking force when deployed for action, and to shield
it from the observation and the fire of the enemy.

In country generally devoid of cover, infantry will have to be placed
in a preparatory position when three kilometers or more from the enemy,
even when the latter’s artillery will in all probability be neutralized
by our own.

“In order to ensure the concerted advance of the various units into the
preparatory position, it is advisable, especially in close country,
to have them move from one covered position to another. If this is
done, units whose march was favored by the nature of the ground, will
not arrive prematurely within dangerous proximity of the enemy, while
others who had farther to go, or whose advance was difficult, are
still a considerable distance to the rear. The leader should make his
dispositions so that no loss of time will result from this advance from
one covered position to another.” (Par. 369 German I. D. R.).

Where large forces are concerned, the attack on a position carefully
prepared for defense will consume several days, the assailant placing
his artillery in position on the first day and reconnoitering under
cover of infantry, which is pushed to the front.[370] The troops of
the first line are pushed forward far enough before daylight so that
they can intrench under cover of darkness and open fire at dawn.
This will be more difficult to accomplish when covering troops or
advanced positions are located in front of the hostile position. If the
assailant has succeeded, on the previous day, in driving these troops
back upon the main position, an advance to within effective range may
be made during the night in order that the fire fight may be opened on
the succeeding day. Although the chance of taking the enemy by surprise
is eliminated in such a case, the advantage of having diminished the
distance that will have to be crossed under fire remains.[371]

   [370] The attack on fortified positions is discussed in detail
 in _Taktik_, V, p. 237, et seq., as It depends upon the closest
 cooperation of field artillery, foot artillery, infantry and pioneers.

   [371] The engagement at Belmont, on Nov. 22nd, 1899, furnishes an
 interesting example of unforeseen friction. The advance, in this
 instance, was made during the night from a point 8 km. from the enemy.

It is difficult to find shelter for the rearward echelons, which must
be kept in readiness in very close proximity to the leading line. These
rear echelons must either be intrenched or at least sheltered by masks.
General actions should be avoided at night.


4. THE COÖPERATION OF INFANTRY AND ARTILLERY IN BATTLE.

Upon completion of the concentration for action (development), the
infantry has to advance within the zone of effective infantry fire. In
doing this the infantry must either pass by or through the artillery
which is already engaged.[372]

   [372] See p. 316, et seq.

During the Russo-Japanese war, the effect of shrapnel, in spite of the
mediocre matériel and the lack of shields, forced the artillery of both
belligerents to seek shelter on the reverse slope of heights. When this
was neglected and when batteries went into position in the open, within
effective range, they were quickly silenced. The fear of shrapnel
caused both sides to advance cautiously, to relinquish all close order
formations at an early moment, and to employ the spade extensively.
This alone was evidence of the fact that the artillery had accomplished
a good deal. Moreover, it was not altogether accident that the first
few of the larger Japanese night attacks occurred coincidentally with
the appearance of Russian artillery matériel, which was superior both
as regards numbers and power. The new German I. D. R. (par. 444), in
contrast with the previous edition (II, par. 82). prescribe that the
infantry attack should not be postponed until a superiority of fire
has been gained. Thus, the regulations draw logical conclusions from
the modern armament and seek to avoid useless bombardments of hostile
positions (such, for instance, as the Russians indulged in at Plevna
and the British in South Africa).

“_The principal duty of field artillery is to support the infantry
in the most effective manner. Its duties are inseparably connected
with those of the infantry. It should, on principle, always fight the
targets that are most dangerous for its infantry._” (Par. 364 German F.
A. D. R.).

The German Field Artillery Drill Regulations prescribe that the guns
should fire over the heads of the advancing infantry (par. 375), and
that single batteries should accompany the infantry attack to within
close range of the enemy (par. 471). When an assault is to be made, the
infantry expects the artillery to direct its fire against the point of
attack until immediately before the assault begins.

“But our infantry should never be obliged to dispense with the support
of artillery. The gun shields afford considerable protection, even at
the short ranges. _At the decisive moment the artillery should not
shrink even from the heaviest infantry fire._” (Par. 369 German F. A.
D. R.).

“In selecting an objective, it is essential for the artillery to
consider whether, by fighting it, the infantry will be effectively
supported. Whether the hostile infantry or artillery is chosen as
an objective will depend upon the situation. As a rule, the hostile
artillery will be the proper objective for our artillery during the
preparatory stage of the action. As the distance between the opposing
infantry forces decreases, it will become more and more necessary for
the artillery to devote itself to the hostile infantry.” (Par. 432
German F. A. D. R.).

If the artillery is equipped with shielded guns, it can devote itself
for some time to the most important target without regard to the
hostile artillery, contenting itself with merely occupying the latter’s
attention. (Par. 469 German F. A. D. R.). To silence artillery in a
concealed position requires curved fire and a good deal of ammunition;
but, on the other hand, artillery so posted cannot fire upon advancing
skirmishers.[373] Therefore, the advancing skirmishers of the assailant
should force the hostile artillery to leave its cover and to expose
itself to the attacker’s artillery. (Pars. 330 and 496 German F. A. D.
R.).

   [373] This is partly due to the fact that fire cannot be adjusted
 quickly enough, and that it is difficult to follow moving targets.
 Besides, when the targets are small and numerous, they are difficult
 to hit.

The result of this procedure will be that the artillery of both sides
will engage each other’s attention with only a small part of their
guns, and concentrate the remainder on the hostile infantry. It is
obvious that the infantry will very soon demand of its artillery in
definite terms that it should first annihilate the hostile artillery
before the infantry can think of continuing the attack.

The provisions of the German regulations in regard to the fusion of
activities of infantry and artillery mark an entirely new departure.
The commencement of the infantry attack is accordingly no longer
dependent upon the result of the artillery combat; on the contrary,
both combats are of equal importance and proceed along parallel lines;
the only danger is that the infantry may make a headlong rush to the
front before a superiority of fire has been gained.

 Confidential British instructions, dealing with the lessons learned
 by the Japanese in Manchuria, contain the following: “Intrenched
 artillery can be permanently silenced only under very exceptional
 circumstances, as it will withdraw its personnel temporarily, as
 soon as the hostile fire becomes too hot, and resume its fire again
 when that of the enemy abates. The infantry attack should therefore
 be launched without awaiting the result of the artillery combat, but
 the infantry must insist upon the artillery completely engaging the
 attention of the hostile guns during the advance. Another reason for
 not awaiting the outcome of the artillery combat, lies in the great
 frontage of battle lines. The unsuccessful attack made by a division
 will then frequently cause the neighboring unit to make an immediate
 attack.”

 =Austria= (1904). “The artillery must be given an opportunity and the
 necessary time for effectively preparing the infantry attack. So long
 as the artillery engaged with the hostile batteries has not achieved
 a noticeable success, or is not at least neutralizing the hostile
 artillery, the infantry attack remains a difficult undertaking.”

 =France.= The artillery during the preparatory stage of an action:
 The artillery should endeavor to silence the hostile artillery as
 quickly as possible, without employing more guns than are absolutely
 necessary. The commander should give the order for the attack only
 when the preparation is considered sufficient.

 =England.= The regulations emphasize the necessity of pushing
 infantry forward, and of supporting that infantry energetically, so
 as to compel the defender to expose himself. “As soon as the hostile
 batteries have been sufficiently silenced, or the infantry advances
 to the attack, the fire is directed upon the point of attack in order
 to prepare and to cover the assault.”

 =Italy.= The regulations state that artillery is a supporting arm
 for infantry. “If the hostile artillery discloses its position from
 the start by employing direct fire against the assailant’s artillery
 or infantry, the attacker’s batteries endeavor to silence it or to
 draw its fire upon themselves, in order to facilitate the deployment
 of their own infantry. If, on the other hand, the hostile artillery
 remains concealed for the purpose of saving its fire for the infantry
 when the latter offers a favorable target upon arriving within
 effective range, then it would seem advisable for the artillery of
 the assailant not to open fire at all, or to open fire only with
 enough guns to cope with the available targets. The assailant’s
 artillery brings the fire of all its batteries into play when the
 defender’s artillery is compelled to come into action in order to
 support its own infantry against the advance of the attacker’s
 infantry.”

The difficulties of providing for coöperation between infantry and
artillery are due to the impossibility of distinguishing at all times
with certainty between friend and foe (assaulting guidons),[374]
since the elimination of powder smoke and the adoption of neutral
tinted uniforms; and, further, to the circumstance that, while we have
a signal for increasing the range of the artillery (g.g.g.), we have
none for indicating that the fire is to be concentrated upon certain
points. “Uninterrupted communication with the fighting line in front
must be provided for. For this purpose officers, who report by signal
or by telephone, should be sent forward. These officers are primarily
to ascertain how close their own firing line is to the enemy, in order
that the artillery may keep up its fire as long as possible.” (Par. 376
German F. A. D. R.). In England, it has been suggested to indicate the
point upon which fire is to be concentrated, by the colored ball of
smoke of a special projectile. It requires strict attention on the part
of the infantry to make its work harmonize with that of the artillery.
Every opportunity, for example, when the hostile infantry is forced
under cover by a burst of fire, should be utilized for advancing. This
is particularly emphasized in France. The defender is to be blinded by
a hailstorm of fragments. “Every rafale of the artillery will either
cause the most advanced line to make a rush, or the troops of the rear
line to come up to the firing line in order to reinforce it or to carry
it forward as much as possible. Thus the rafale becomes a veritable
shield for the infantry (_véritable bouclier de l’infanterie_).”
LANGLOIS.

   [374] During the attack on the Waterberg, on August 11th, 1904, the
 various units were ordered to carry, on their outer flanks, flags
 attached to long poles. These flags were white in Estorffs, red in
 v.d. Heyde’s, blue in Müller’s, and green in Deimling’s detachment.


5. THE POINT OF ATTACK.[375]

   [375] See _Taktik_, V, p. 138.

The reconnoitering troops are charged with the duty of ascertaining
the parts of the hostile position which can be approached under cover,
which are weaker than the others (frequently true of the flanks),[376]
or which can be enfiladed. The attack will usually be directed
against the weakest point in the hostile position, or that on which
the greatest volume of fire can be concentrated from enfilading or
commanding positions. At all other points of the battlefield, the
assailant will endeavor to deceive the opponent, with weak forces, as
to his true intentions, but, at the decisive point, he should launch
superior numbers. The French regulations contend that such weak points
will only become apparent during the course of the fight, and therefore
separate the troops into a preparatory and a decisive combat group.

   [376] Example: The right flank of the French position at Wörth, and
 at Roncourt (St. Privat).

The desire to strike the weakest point in the enemy’s line causes
the decisive blow to be directed against a flank, and the numerical
superiority requisite for gaining the superiority of fire, leads to


6. ENVELOPMENT.

(Pars. 392-396 German I. D. R.).

The desire of the attacker to put a superior number of rifles into the
fight, in order to gain a superiority of fire more quickly, naturally
leads to an extension of the firing line and to an overlapping of the
defender’s line. The advantage of overlapping the enemy’s line lies in
the fact that part of the line attacked is exposed to both frontal and
oblique fire. The effect of this oblique fire is increased by bending
the wing of the attacking line toward the enemy. If the attacking line
succeeds in pushing its firing line so far forward that not only the
hostile wing but also the hostile flank is struck, an envelopment is
brought about with the result that the lines of fire of the assailant
cross each other within the hostile position. If the defender refuses a
wing, portions of his line may be enfiladed. This will cause such heavy
losses that the defender will begin to succumb first at the salient
point of his line. A further advantage is gained by a pressure on the
enemy’s line of retreat.

[Illustration]

Pure frontal attacks offer little prospect of success;[377] they may
perhaps force the enemy back, but they cannot annihilate him.

   [377] It is only necessary to invite attention to the first attacks
 made by the Prussian Guard against St. Privat, and to the attack made
 by the 72nd, 40th and 11th Infantry Regiments against the height
 of Maison Blanche south of Rezonville, on August 16th, 1870. KUNZ,
 _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, 8-10, p. 128.

For carrying out the attack itself, it is immaterial whether the
commander launches it against the hostile front or a hostile flank;
individual companies, battalions, and, in large units, regiments,
finally make a frontal attack anyway. The fear of the front of the
enemy should not lead the enveloping force to attempt to execute
another enveloping movement when it encounters a newly formed front.
Surprise is, to a certain extent, essential to the success of a flank
attack.[378] The troops holding the enemy in front [secondary attack]
must, therefore, hold him in such a manner as to keep him in ignorance
about the true point of attack, must so engage his attention that he
will finally place the bulk of his force into the frontal action. If
this does not occur, the opponent will soon distinguish sham from
reality and will not oppose a weak, inactive containing force with
more troops than are absolutely necessary. In this connection, compare
the conduct of the 1st Army at Königgrätz and of the Prussian Vth Army
Corps at Wörth with the vacillating action of the Russian IIIrd and
Ist Armies at Sandepu.[379] So long as the enemy is not firmly held
in front, he will be able to evade an envelopment by withdrawing. The
combats of the Boers in the Orange Free State furnish numerous examples
of this fact. The Austrian regulations have very properly coined the
term “attack on two fronts”, which better indicates the task of both
parts of an attacking force.

   [378] The attack of the Guard at Chlum (Königgrätz). V.
 LETTOW-VORBECK, II, p. 474. The assault and capture of the hill of
 Forbach at Spicheren by six battalions of the IIIrd Army Corps. _Gen.
 St. W._, I. p. 356. The assault and capture of the Mont de Brune
 (Beaumont) by 6¹⁄₂ Prussian companies, which were followed by 4²⁄₃
 companies more. The hill mentioned was defended by 6 battalions and 3
 batteries; 6 guns were captured. HOPFFGARTEN-HEIDLER, _Beaumont_, pp.
 132 and 227.

   [379] _Taktik_. V. p. 42.

Whether the decisive blow is directed against the front or a flank,
depends upon the result of the fire. The advantages offered by an
enveloping movement must not lead to holding the enemy once and for
all in front, while the main attack is directed against his flank. A
frontal attack made in conjunction with a threatening demonstration
against the hostile flank frequently offers far greater prospects
of success.[380] If a superiority is to be employed to advantage,
an envelopment must be made; all objections advanced against the
“enveloping craze” are disposed of by this statement.[381] “A condition
precedent to an envelopment is that the enemy be held in front. For
this purpose a determined demonstration is most effective.” (Par. 392
German I. D. R.).

   [380] The attack on Flanville, on September 1st, 1870, is an
 instructive example. KUNZ, _Noisseville_, p. 87. _Gen. St. W._, II.
 p. 1407.

   [381] V. D. GOLTZ, _Das Volk in Waffen_, pp. 328 and 332. BLUME,
 _Strategie_, p. 170. MECKEL, _Truppenführung_, p. 221.

The risks involved in an envelopment must not be
overlooked--overextension and dispersion of the troops;[382] the
possibility that the troops fighting in front and those fighting on the
flank, separated from each other, may be defeated in detail, whether
this be brought about by the defender assuming the offensive, or by
the force holding the enemy in front allowing itself to be enticed
into making a premature advance and suffering a defeat before the
envelopment has a chance to become effective.

   [382] The attack made by François’ Brigade during the battle of
 Spicheren. _Gen. St. W._, I. p. 318. Between 12 and 1 o’clock, this
 brigade covered a front of 4000 m. See p. 262, supra.

“The envelopment is effected in the simplest manner if the forces
designated for this task, when still at a distance from the enemy, are
given a march direction that will bring them against the hostile flank.

“When initiated during the development for action or when carried out
by retained reserves, the envelopment is much more difficult.” (Par.
393 German I. D. R.).

In the last-mentioned case it may happen that the force detailed to
make the flank attack strikes the enemy’s front instead of his flank.
The same is true of attempts to envelop with parts of the infantry of
the first line that are already deployed, perhaps already engaged,
when the terrain is not specially favorable for such a movement. Such
movements may, in special cases, be carried out at night. (Enveloping
movements of the divisions of the Japanese IIIrd Army at Mukden). As a
rule, this brings about only an overlapping and flanking of the parts
of the hostile position next adjacent to the wing making the movement,
but does not produce a concentric effect on the hostile flank. Yet,
even weak detachments that reach positions from which they are able to
enfilade the enemy, facilitate the advance to the front.

In starting an enveloping movement when at a considerable distance
from the enemy, the force which is to make it, is directed upon a
point located in rear of the hostile position, approximately where
his reserves are presumed to be. If then the fighting line is further
extended toward the outer flank, the assailant avoids facing the
hostile front directly, and will almost invariably have a start over
the defender in extending the threatened wing. The troops still in the
act of withdrawing from the route column naturally take charge of the
protection of the flanks.[383]

   [383] Compare the deployment for action of the 1st Guard Division
 at Königgrätz with that of the 4th Japanese Division at Wafangu. In
 the last-mentioned case, the leading (10th) brigade was launched
 in a very skillful flank attack; the second brigade took charge of
 protecting the flank.

If a flank march in front of the enemy should become necessary, it can
be undertaken with sufficient safety only when proper preparations
have been made--distribution in depth, shortening of route columns,
due regard being had to protection of the front and flanks--to permit
a deployment of the force at the right moment and in a suitable
formation toward the hostile side.[384] Within effective range of the
enemy, such a movement by the flank can be carried out only when cover
is available, otherwise the hostile fire will very quickly force the
troops making the flank march to face to the front.[385]

   [384] V. SCHLICHTING. _Taktische und strategische Grundsätze_,
 I, p. 90, et seq. The attack of the six Brandenburg battalions
 against the Hill of Forbach (Spicheren) is especially instructive
 in this connection. The attacking force was threatened by hostile
 troops lodged in the Stiring Wald. The first deployment caused the
 attacking force to face toward the front of the French position.
 As soon as this was noticed, the skirmishers were withdrawn in
 order to be pushed into the fight again at another place. GERNIER,
 _Einmarschkämpfe_, p. 184.

   [385] Look up the conduct of the 22nd Infantry Division at
 Villermain-Cravant, on December 8th, 1870. It is indeed true that a
 violent snow storm and thick weather made it possible for this force
 to disengage itself from the enemy and to join the 1st Bavarian Army
 Corps at Cravant.

 The attempt of the 16th Infantry Division to envelop the French
 position on the =Hallue=[386]: The 30th Brigade used the road leading
 along the hostile front from Querrieux to Frechencourt, for its
 movement. The leading regiment of the brigade, the 28th Infantry,
 on debouching from Querrieux, immediately faced toward the annoying
 flanking fire and endeavored to advance in the face of it, while the
 brigade commander, energetically carrying out the orders given him,
 led the 68th Infantry toward Frechencourt, thus forestalling several
 French battalions that were hurrying up from the east. The village
 was occupied and held by the 68th Infantry, but a frontal offensive
 movement against the hostile main position could not be carried out
 from here either, in spite of the inferiority of the French troops.

   [386] V. MALACHOWSKI, _Frontalschlacht und Flügelschlacht_, p.
 24, et seq. KUNZ, _Nordarmee_, I, p. 134, et seq. In regard to the
 conduct of the 15th Infantry Division, which was to hold the enemy in
 front and which advanced prematurely before the enveloping movement
 of the 16th Division had become effective, consult p. 282 supra, and
 _Taktik_, V. p. 163.

Whether an enveloping force can be sent into action at once without
being first placed in a preparatory position[387] or whether it should
first be concentrated, depends upon the situation of the troops engaged
in front with the enemy (the necessity of relieving the pressure on
the Ist Army engaged in front with the enemy at Königgrätz), and upon
the counter-measures taken by the enemy. If the assailant encounters
a newly formed front, it would be a mistake for him to attack
successively with the different units.

   [387] According to the opinion of General V. SCHLICHTING, a
 preparatory position should be taken up. _Taktische und strategische
 Grundsätze_, III, pp. 133 and 154, et seq. See _Taktik_, V, p. 174.

Whether the troops holding the enemy in front participate in the
assault during an enveloping movement, depends upon circumstances. They
may frequently better ensure the success of the attack by delivering an
enfilading fire than by advancing. The commander should, at any rate,
not lose sight of this advantage. If both groups (the enveloping and
the holding group) advance to the decisive attack, they should do so
simultaneously. The group holding the enemy in front must resist the
temptation of moving to the front before the envelopment can become
effective.[388]

   [388] Consult _Der 18. August_, pp. 377, 561 and 590. In regard to
 the attack made by the Guard and the Saxons and the premature attack
 made by the Guard at St Privat.

 The attack on =Ste. Marie aux Chênes=, on August 18th, 1870,[389] and
 that made by the 37th Infantry Brigade on =Ladon=[390] are models
 worthy of imitation. “The brigade commander personally directed
 Lieutenant-Colonel v. Hagen (commanding the troops holding the enemy
 in front) to have the signal ‘forward double time’ sounded as soon
 as he could see the skirmishers of the 78th Infantry coming over the
 heights to the right front.”

   [389] The 1st Infantry Division of the Guard received orders “to
 form for attack against St. Privat, but not to attack that village
 before the expected arrival of the Saxon Corps.” _Der 18. August_,
 pp. 167 and 288.

   [390] HÖNIG, _Gefechtsbilder_, III, pp. 58 and 49.

 At =Gorni Dubniac=, on October 30th, 1877, the scheme of designating
 the moment for attack by means of artillery salvos, failed. During
 the attack on =Scheinovo=, on January 9th, 1878, the simultaneous
 advance of Prince Mirski’s troops was regulated by the clock.

If the attacker desires to deliver an effective blow against the
enemy’s flank, _a considerable interval must be left between the troops
charged with the holding attack_ [secondary attack] _and those detailed
to make the flank attack_, when the envelopment is initiated. (Par. 393
German I. D. R.). The width of this gap is increased to a seemingly
dangerous degree by the range of modern weapons, but real danger is not
to be apprehended as a counter-attack of the defender exposes both of
his flanks to an enveloping attack. If the enveloping group continues
to advance, that advance in itself will very soon set a limit to the
enemy’s counter-attack. The seemingly dangerous gap in the line, at
the commencement of an action, is closed more and more as the enemy is
approached. Nevertheless, this gap may induce a cautious leader to draw
the enveloping group closer to the frontal group, thereby impairing
the effectiveness of the envelopment. The flanking groups accomplish
the best results, but in following up tactical objectives, they should
never lose sight of the annihilation of the enemy. The difficulty of
coördinating the action of the separated parts of the line is greater
than the danger to be apprehended from a hostile counter-attack against
the frontal group. As a rule, the entry of the enveloping group into
action will be the signal for a general attack. The effectiveness of
the enveloping attack is proportional to the energy with which it is
made, but the danger to be apprehended from a hostile counter-attack
increases in the same ratio.

[Illustration]


Provisions of Various Regulations.

 =Austria.= When possible, the reserve is to be designated to make the
 enveloping movement. (Par. 407 Austrian I. D. R.). When practicable,
 a part of the reserve is employed from the start for the envelopment,
 and, under certain circumstances, also for the purpose of gaining
 positions from which an enfilade fire can be delivered, and for
 supporting the advance of the frontal attack. The group holding
 the enemy in front may at first fight a purely defensive action to
 prevent a hostile counter-attack, to screen our own dispositions, and
 finally, by means of a fire fight at effective ranges, to hold the
 hostile troops in their position.

 =France.= The envelopment is occasionally mentioned in the
 regulations (for example in pars. 290, 301 and 302). The Field
 Service Regulations, in discussing the attack, whose different stages
 may vary in length depending upon the intentions of the commander,
 state, however, that the attacker “may assail a wing or a flank of
 the enemy, with superior forces, for the purpose of annihilating him.”

 =England.= The importance of flank attacks, even those in which
 the defender is subdued by the flanking fire of mounted troops, is
 specially mentioned, but, in this connection, it is emphasized that
 it is immaterial whether the attack is finally directed against
 the front or a flank of the enemy. The holding attack is to be
 carried out with energy in front to prevent the enemy from drawing
 reinforcements to other points.

 =Italy.= While the regulations of 1891 still unqualifiedly
 acknowledged that any frontal attack might succeed, the regulations
 of 1903 called attention to the importance of the envelopment,
 without denying “that the frontal attack might be the decisive one.”
 Surprise is an advantageous factor for success, and for this reason,
 even covering troops, for example, may have to be dispensed with on
 the march.

 If a force desires to take the enemy by surprise, it must carefully
 take advantage of the ground. The surprise may be made more complete,
 if the accompanying frontal attack is energetically pushed. On the
 other hand, considerations for the troops in the holding attack, set
 a limit to the extension of the flanking movement. The fire power of
 the troops in the holding attack must not be exhausted, or the troops
 themselves defeated by a hostile counter-attack, before the moment of
 the general advance arrives. They must pay the strictest attention to
 the course of events on the opponent’s side; if the enemy retires, or
 shifts parts of his force in order to meet a flank attack, the troops
 in the holding attack must act with energy. If such signs are not
 apparent, a frontal advance will, as a rule, be proper only when the
 pressure of the flank attack makes itself felt on the enemy’s line.
 This is the only way in which “simultaneous action by both attacks
 may be ensured, and this is of decisive importance to the successful
 issue of the combat.”


7. REMOVAL OF PACKS.

It is advisable for infantry to remove packs for an attack; such
tremendous physical exertions await the troops that everything ought
to be done to reduce the load carried by the individual man.[391] “As
soon as it becomes doubtful whether the troops will be able to perform
the task assigned them in action without such relief, all independent
commanders, and, in organizations larger than a regiment, commanders
of regiments and of higher units, have authority to order the men to
remove their packs. In issuing such an order they should bear in mind
the disadvantages which may result from leaving the packs behind. When
knapsacks are removed, the ammunition and iron rations should be taken
from them. Overcoats, cooking utensils, canteens, bread bags, and
intrenching tools remain on the men.” (Par. 301 German I. D. R.).

   [391] Examples from military history in _Militär-Wochenblatt_,
 1902, No. 32.

According to the French Manual of Field Engineering, the skirmishers,
especially when intrenching, may utilize the knapsack as cover.

In a defeat knapsacks will frequently be lost. Thus the Russians,
after the second battle of Plevna, and Frossard’s Corps, after the
battle of Spicheren, lost their knapsacks with camp equipment and iron
rations, and, in consequence thereof, suffered great hardships during
the succeeding days. On the other hand, during their retreat, the
43rd, 44th and 45th Infantry Regiments of the Ist Army Corps managed
to recover without trouble the packs which they had removed before
entering the battle of Trautenau.

 The infantry of the Xth Army Corps had left its knapsacks behind
 on August 8th, 1870, and did not get them again until the early
 part of September. The knapsacks were not hauled on wagons after
 the organizations, but were left at the railroad station of St.
 Ingbert. On August 6th, 1870, the Würtemberg Field Brigade had left
 its knapsacks in a bivouac near Reimersweiler at the risk of never
 seeing them again. Among other reasons, General v. d. Tann considered
 it impossible for the 2nd Bavarian Division to advance beyond Wörth,
 because the organizations might perhaps thereby have been separated
 for several days from their baggage, which they had left behind
 between Preuschdorf and Görsdorf.

When knapsacks are removed, a detachment will have to be left behind
to guard them, otherwise they may be robbed of their contents.[392]
The troops always consider the trip to the rear to get the baggage
a special hardship; wagons will very rarely be available for this
purpose, as after great battles all the wagons in the entire
neighborhood will be requisitioned for transporting the wounded, and as
supply wagons will, as a rule, not be at hand.

   [392] This was neglected by the 20th and 35th Infantries, on August
 16th, 1870.


8. THE EMPLOYMENT OF MACHINE GUNS.

In an attack upon a defensive position which is held in force, machine
gun batteries will generally be held in rear for the time being. They
form a mobile reserve in the hands of the commander-in-chief, who may
employ it for quickly reinforcing threatened points, for exerting a
pressure upon the wings and flanks of the enemy, and for preparing the
assault. Machine gun companies, either broken up into platoons or not,
as the case may be, endeavor to reach positions from which they can
facilitate the advance of their infantry.

It is especially advantageous if the fire that is directed upon the
point where the hostile position is to be penetrated, comes from a
position permitting a good view, or from an oblique direction, because
the fire will not have to be discontinued even when the infantry
continues its advance or moves to the assault. If such a position,
permitting the greatest fire effect, is reached (at about 800 m. or
less from the hostile position) any further advance of the machine guns
is faulty, because it interrupts the fire and necessitates fresh laying
and adjustment.

Upon the victorious termination of a fight, the machine guns should
participate in the first stages of the pursuit by making an extended
use of their fire. They hurry forward into the captured position, as
soon as it is apparent that the victory has been gained, in order to
support the infantry in holding the position, to cover the infantry
while it is re-forming, and to reduce the last vestige of the enemy’s
resistance. If the attack fails the machine guns cover the retiring
troops.


9. THE CONDUCT OF THE ATTACK.

In an infantry attack, the art of minor troop leading consists of
pushing a firing line, superior to the enemy, to the strip of ground
from which the power of our rifle can be utilized to the best advantage
for vanquishing the enemy; secondly, of bringing up supports, without
exposing them to unnecessary losses, so that they will be promptly
available in case of need. The preparations which the enemy has
made for attaining the maximum fire power (by intrenching, placing
ammunition in readiness, and by ascertaining ranges) must be offset
by employing a superior number of rifles. The commander who brings a
greater number of rifles into action than his opponent, may count on
gaining a superiority of fire quickly and with certainty.

The task of higher troop leading consists of simultaneously launching
the troops against the common objective.

The effect of modern projectiles requires that, on open ground, the
first deployment be made when 4000-5000 m. from the enemy. The best
scheme would be to advance, without halting, to within decisive short
range of the defender, and then to open fire, but, as previously
stated, the defender should endeavor to prevent the assailant from ever
reaching these ranges. This design of the defender must be frustrated;
if artillery is unable to accomplish this, machine guns or a part of
the infantry must enter the fight; but all parts of the force not
required for this fire fight at medium ranges should continue their
movement without interruption.

The most difficult task that infantry may be called upon to perform
consists of advancing over an open plain, in the face of unsubdued
artillery, when the situation does not permit night or the effect of an
envelopment to be awaited.

The first deployment as skirmishers is made for the purpose of
protecting the advancing troops against surprise. Frequently, a squad
or a section per company will suffice for this purpose, but these units
should cover the entire front available for the organization to which
they belong. A uniform and simultaneous advance along the whole line
is impossible however, on account of the diversity of the ground at
various points. When cover is available, skirmish lines may be formed
quickly and pushed forward as entities, but when cover is lacking,
firing lines may have to be deployed slowly and piecemeal. The unit
that has pushed farthest to the front must facilitate with its fire the
advance of those who have encountered greater obstacles in advancing.

Long, dense firing lines and the supports following them are exposed
to such heavy losses in open country, even at long ranges, that their
advance will soon hesitate. Moreover, the defender will only fire
on targets whose size and density promise a great number of hits.
Therefore, the assailant should endeavor to lead his infantry forward
in loose, disconnected skirmish lines, which are difficult for the
enemy to hit. As a rule, the assailant should not open fire until
after he has been reinforced and has sufficient fire power available.
(Par. 334 German I. D. R.). The situation in which these thin firing
lines are placed is by no means a favorable one, as the defender will
concentrate his fire on the points where the assailant seems to be
filling up his line “for the purpose of overwhelming the defender
permanently by a superiority of fire.” (Par. 413 German I. D. R.). The
skirmishers will then quite naturally open fire for the purpose of
interfering with the cool delivery of the defender’s fire.

Such a piecemeal, almost independent advance, during which the effect
of the accustomed word of command is considerably reduced and control
and supervision of the individual skirmisher is impossible, presupposes
that the troops are well-drilled, individually trained, and, above all,
intelligent. Attention must also be called to the fact that the firing
line can offer but a weak resistance to an enemy advancing unexpectedly
in force. But, in spite of these drawbacks, this mode of advance
has its advantages for crossing a plain devoid of cover. It permits
favorable fire positions to be reached with greater safety, especially
if these positions can be picked out with the aid of field glasses,
than would be the case if dense skirmish lines were led forward
simultaneously.

The advance of the infantry under hostile fire, over open ground, may
accordingly be conducted--

1. At a walk, by long rushes made by strong units (by platoons at
least), supported by powerful artillery fire or by the fire of a
machine gun battery or a detachment of skirmishers posted in a
favorable position;

2. By shorter rushes made by smaller units (“proper only when
conditions demand it”);

3. By crawling, or, in exceptional cases (for example in passing
through fields of standing grain), by employing

4. Fire while in motion.

The fire fight at long ranges and near the extreme limit of mid ranges
is only a means for the purpose of reaching the decisive battle ranges,
and of interfering with the undisturbed delivery of the enemy’s fire.
Fire must be opened at as late a moment as possible. Our firing line
should in any case be strong enough, upon entering the zone of mid
ranges, to reply effectively to the enemy’s fire. Experience has shown
that an assailant who opens fire at “long” ranges rarely reaches short
ranges. (See p. 149 supra).

The distances at which the echelons in rear follow the firing line
should be less (as laid down in the Italian and Russian regulations)
than the distance which separates the firing line of the attacker from
that of the defender. The distances may be increased without danger at
this stage of the combat, as the decision is not imminent, but on the
flanks the supports will have to be brought up closer in order that an
unexpected flank attack may be effectively opposed. All parts of the
attacking force move--as long as possible at a walk--straight to the
front. Subordinate leaders, taking advantage of all available cover,
should endeavor to lead the supports skillfully after the firing line.
This requires that the ground to be crossed be reconnoitered. As a
rule, a movement by the flank upon leaving cover is costlier than an
advance by squads or sections over open ground. Long lines make it
easier for the hostile artillery to adjust and observe its fire, while,
when a greater number of targets of smaller frontage is exposed, this
is made more difficult. For this reason, supports are not led forward
as entire units, but, on the contrary, they are broken up, and, under
certain circumstances, even disintegrated into smaller units. The
units following in rear remain as long as possible in close order
formations, preferably in route columns. “Man is by nature exceedingly
timid. Soldiers, even those drawn from the educated classes, who were
fully aware of the supreme importance of gaining the victory, broke
down on coming under fire. In close order the moral encouragement due
to the proximity of superiors and comrades kept up their courage.”
(Hessert).[393] Where cover is lacking, the supports will also have to
be deployed. Large units are broken up into platoons, which deploy and
follow each other at considerable distances.[394]

   [393] “We are prone to place the individual on too high a pedestal,
 and, in doing so, to ignore the psychological element of combat.”
 Major-General Stieler.

   [394] The losses sustained during the advance of the Russian
 reserves at Plevna (11th September, 1877), and during the attack made
 by the Guard on Gorni Dubniac, led to a spontaneous deployment on the
 part of the reserves.

As soon as the enemy opens fire, platoon commanders must decide
whether or not it ought to be returned; but the closer one can get to
the enemy without firing a shot, the better. According to the German
F. S. R. (par. 296), a prolonged, uninterrupted forward movement of
skirmish lines in the open, at less than 1000 m. from the enemy, is
possible only when supported by adequate fire. On the other hand, even
skirmishers lying down suffer serious losses when 600 m. from the enemy.

Thus, at mid ranges, begins the actual, protracted fire fight, which,
in the first place, is to make a further advance possible, and which,
subsequently, is to produce a superiority of fire. As taught by
experience, this cannot be accomplished from a single position, if the
enemy is efficient.

 A so-called “main firing position”, which was to be located 400-600
 m. from the enemy, was frequently used during peace maneuvers for the
 purpose of bringing cohesion and harmony into the attack. In making
 use of such a position, the principal difficulty of every serious
 infantry attack, that of crossing the space lying between the first
 firing position and the assaulting position, was not appreciated.

 =Austria.= (Par. 589 I. D. R.). “When conditions are very favorable,
 it might be possible to choose the firing position in which the
 decisive fire fight is to be begun, so close to the enemy that the
 decision can be gained from it.”

The fire fight must be taken up by enough troops to make it
impossible for the defender, who holds his position strongly, to gain
a superiority of fire over some parts of the attacking force. The
supports will now move closer to the firing line, in order to fill
every gap in that line and to meet every attempt of the defender to
gain the upper hand. The echelons of the second line which have not as
yet been absorbed by the firing line, move up in a similar manner. If
the hostile fire abates, parts of the firing line should endeavor to
get closer to the enemy; they are followed by the next adjoining units.
At this stage of the action the attacker will have to give up, to some
extent, his distribution in depth.

Superiority of fire is an essential condition to victory. It is
attained by better marksmanship, fire control and fire direction, by
taking advantage of cover, and by concentrating a powerful fire against
the decisive point. When the attacker’s troops are not well trained,
a greater number of rifles and more ammunition will be required to
gain this superiority. Accordingly, the attacker will either make an
envelopment or employ fire of position. The attacker possesses a great
advantage, in that he does not need to gain a superiority of fire
along the whole front, but only at a single point. It suffices for
him to contain weak portions of the hostile front with suitable, well
concealed combat groups capable of quickly developing a powerful fire,
while he masses the bulk of his forces against the decisive point. The
defender, who never knows where the decisive blow is going to fall,
ought not to allow himself to be enticed into occupying portions of his
line more weakly than the rest.

The attainment of the superiority of fire requires time, and, in
addition, coolness and patience on the part of the leaders. All the
ammunition that is expended in gaining this superiority is later
compensated for by fewer losses. The heavy losses sustained by the
Prussian troops on the slopes of Point du Jour, on August 18th, 1870,
may be traced directly to the fact that the leaders did not know how to
wait.

Superiority of fire[395] is absolutely essential to the success of the
attack. Any failure to appreciate this principle will lead to such
heavy losses that even if the assailant were to reach the enemy’s
position, he would be too weak to gain the victory.[396]

   [395] For the situation of the British Guard at Modder River
 (28th November, 1890), see p. 182 supra. The Guards were closely
 hugging the ground at a distance of 800 m. from the enemy. After
 29 ammunition carriers had been shot at the very beginning of the
 engagement, all attempts to carry orders or ammunition to the firing
 line were abandoned. No attempts were made to relieve the pressure by
 means of the fire of sharpshooters, by bringing up reinforcements, or
 by gaining ground by crawling.

   [396] “Battles are won by the superiority of fire.” FREDERICK THE
 GREAT in his _Military Testament_, 1768.

During the fluctuating fire fight, which lasts for hours, the attacker
will have succeeded in working forward little by little until he is
close to the enemy’s position. His superiority will now make itself
felt; the fire from the part of the hostile line that is to be
penetrated will begin to abate; and, at first, single groups, then
several, and finally, whole units of the enemy’s line will commence to
crumble away. The attacker should wait until this effect is produced
before he begins the assault; if he does not do this, the attack is
sure to fail.

_Austria._ (Par. 590 I. D. R.). “The close approach of a long firing
line to an enemy who occupies a good position, may well pass as a
proof of the assailant’s superiority. Nevertheless, this does not,
under all circumstances, furnish assurance that a forward movement for
the purpose of penetrating the hostile position will now succeed; a
premature assault may still result in disaster. _As long as the conduct
of the opponent does not show clear indications that his fire power is
crippled, nothing remains for the attacker but to continue the fight
for the superiority of fire._”

Even in this, mistakes are not precluded. It is far from easy to
recognize when the defender of a position has been sufficiently subdued
by fire to make an assault feasible, and when the proper moment has
arrived for launching the reserves. It is only necessary to recall the
premature advance of the artillery and cavalry over the ravine of the
Mance brook, on August 18th, 1870.

The cessation of the defender’s fire, in itself, is not a sure
sign that his firing line is shaken, as the attacker is unable to
distinguish between a fire pause ordered by the commander on the
defensive and the forced discontinuance of the fight. Sure indications
are not available until men actually leave the defender’s fighting line
here and there, and attempts of the leaders to hold the wavering ones
are clearly apparent.

At this moment, a leader who has resolved to assault, should order
bayonets fixed.

      *       *       *       *       *

The temporary interruption of the fire occasioned by fixing bayonets is
of no importance, as the superiority of fire has already been gained.
If bayonets are prematurely ordered to be fixed, the accuracy of the
fire will soon be impaired, as the firing of rifles, weighted down
by the attached bayonets, increases the fatigue of the men. When the
troops are excited, the downward deflection of the bullets caused by
fixing the bayonet can, however, only produce a good effect. It is
best to fix bayonets at the signal “Fix bayonet”. In the excitement
prevailing at the moment, it will be impossible to execute the order
with any uniformity, but it is a good plan, in time of peace, to
require one man of each file to fire while the other one fixes his
bayonet. The approaching reserves fix bayonets while on the march.


10. THE ASSAULT.

“The assault does not, strictly speaking, belong to the domain of
tactics. Rules, showing in what formations and under what conditions
the assault should be made in war, cannot be formulated. At any rate,
fire tactics are not only an essential factor but also the crowning
act of combat; the assault is nothing but the postlude. All modern
combats show that the morale of the men suffers most, and that, in
consequence thereof, troops deteriorate quickly when they are exposed
to the annihilating effect of fire. This lesson was thoroughly learned
by the Austrians in 1866, and by the Russians in front of Plevna. Of
what avail were ‘self-sacrifice’, the ‘unconquerable determination to
gain the victory’, the ‘desire for hand to hand conflict’, and all
the other terms that are employed to prove that the moral factors are
the decisive ones in war? That they are the decisive factors needs
no proof whatever; it follows, as a matter of course, from uniform
training, uniform leadership, and uniform arms. But tactics fit for
use in war, are to furnish, above all else, ways and means, showing
how and by what methods the fighting energy of troops may be preserved
most effectively, and thus contribute directly toward preventing the
premature deterioration of the morale of the troops.”[397]

   [397] Colonel KEIM in _von Löbells Jahresberichte_, 1899, II, p.
 561.

“The defeat of the opponent is consummated by the assault with fixed
bayonets.” (Par. 324 German I. D. R.). A premature advance to the
assault, with all the peculiar features attending it, produces an
aversion against the attack, an undue extension of battle lines, and
makes it impossible for reinforcements to come up, except under cover
of darkness.

The decision for making the assault emanates either from the
subordinate leaders in the firing line or from the commander of the
whole force. The latter may give the impulse for the assault by
launching the reserve. This is undoubtedly the safer procedure. “When
the decision to assault emanates from the commanders in rear, notice
thereof is given by sounding the signal ‘fix bayonet’, which must be
repeated by all the units that are to take part in the assault. At this
signal the skirmishers increase their fire to the utmost. The parts of
the firing line which are still in rear, move forward, as quickly as
possible, to a position close to the enemy. All reinforcements in rear
hasten straight to the front. As soon as the leading line is to form
for the assault, all the trumpeters sound the signal ‘forward, double
time’, all the drummers beat their drums, and all parts of the force
throw themselves with the greatest determination upon the enemy. It
should be a point of honor with skirmishers not to allow the supports
to overtake them earlier than the moment of penetrating the enemy’s
position. When immediately in front of the enemy, the men should charge
bayonet and, with a cheer, penetrate the position.” (Pars. 346-348
German I. D. R.).

It is very difficult for a superior commander to perceive when the
proper moment for making the assault has arrived, as he is compelled
to remain so far in rear of the fighting line, especially where large
forces are concerned, that he can only follow the general course of
the attack. The first indication which he receives as to whether the
enemy’s fire power has been broken all along the line, is the advance
of his own firing line. He will still more rarely be able to see in
time when the resistance of the enemy abates at some one point, and
it will be quite impossible for him to issue orders with sufficient
promptness to turn such an advantage quickly to good account.[398]

   [398] “The attack fed from the rear, which may be likened to the
 closing of a telescope, is one of the most peculiar results of
 constructive theory, which seeks, by this means, to increase the
 energy of the first line, but only succeeds in massing too many men
 in front of the enemy, a better condition than which the enemy could
 not desire.” VON MALACHOWSKI, _Scharfe Taktik und Revue-Taktik_, p.
 230. Incorrect estimate of the situation by the commander of the
 Ist Army on August 18th, 1870. F. HÖNIG, _Vierundzwanzig Stunden
 Moltkescher Strategie_, p. 145. _Der 18. August_, p. 271.

The firing line will, therefore, frequently have to take the initiative
in bringing about the assault. It is absolutely necessary, especially
if the enemy evacuates the position, that the firing line, quickly
taking advantage of this moment, pass over to the bayonet attack. If
the firing line were to wait until the reserves are up, valuable time
would be lost, under certain circumstances; the enemy might recover
from his temporary bewilderment and re-form, or might even receive
reinforcements. In addition, hesitation on the part of the attacker
would enable the enemy to gain time, evacuate the position unmolested,
retire in good order, and perhaps take up a new position, or at least
evade quickly the pursuing fire of the assailant. The firing line
would be the first, in such a case, to perceive when and where the
resistance of the enemy abates; it should therefore make the most of
this knowledge and throw itself upon the part of the defender’s force
that is in the act of withdrawing.

When the impulse for the assault emanates from the firing line, there
is danger that instead of a general attack only a local one will
result. It is impossible to conceive that the whole firing line will
simultaneously consider that the moment for the assault has arrived;
in general, only a part of that line at a time will come to this
conclusion. Such local attacks are hazardous, however, and have some
chance of succeeding only in covered terrain. A local assault made
by a single battalion or company will usually attract the fire of a
considerable portion of the hostile line and quite naturally dash
itself to pieces against it. Even assuming that a gallantly charging
unit succeeds in unexpectedly penetrating the hostile line at some one
point, the defender will at once attack it in vastly superior force
and compel it to retire with heavy loss. Furthermore, the failure is
usually not confined to the one unit. The troops on the right and left
of it, although they are perhaps farther from the enemy, and have not
yet shaken him sufficiently by their fire, nevertheless join in the
assault, as soon as they see the first unit rush forward. As a rule,
when the decision to assault emanates from the firing line, a series
of unsuccessful assaults will result. These will, however, bring good
troops closer and closer to the enemy, until the great moment of
definitely gained superiority finally arrives.

 The General Staff account of the Franco-German war[399] very aptly
 describes the decisive moment for the assault: “The tension of
 the tactical situation was increased to the highest pitch by the
 prolonged fight at close range; the time was now ripe for the
 decision and the German corps commanders issued orders for the
 assault. Before this order reached the leading line, however, the
 German general officers on the spot had decided, at about 7:30 P.
 M., to undertake the assault on their own responsibility, as they
 considered the attack sufficiently prepared. On the signal given by
 them, and in many instances of their own accord, the Prussian and
 Saxon battalions hurled themselves, just as the sun was setting, on
 the position which had been so long and so tenaciously defended by
 the enemy.” (=St. Privat=). Consult, _Der 18. August_, pp. 525 and
 571.

   [399] _Gen. St. W._, II, p. 800.

 “When the XIth Army Corps issued from the =Niederwald= (near
 =Wörth=), the infantry encountered such a heavy fire from the
 direction of =Elsaszhausen= that the troops had to choose between
 either advancing farther or giving up the advantages that had been
 gained at such great sacrifices. The former course was indeed open
 to objection, as the troops were exhausted, as organizations were in
 confusion from the fighting they had just gone through, and as only
 three formed and fresh battalions were available.”--“General von Bose
 now ordered a general attack. At the signal ‘the whole force will
 advance’, the firing lines rushed from the Niederwald and, with loud
 cheers, threw themselves upon the enemy.”[400]

   [400] _Gen. St. W._, I, p. 267.

 The assault was thus not a result of the superiority that had been
 gained, but an act of desperation in a situation that had become
 unbearable. Moreover, the success of the assault was not due to any
 numerical superiority of the attacker, but to the lack of initiative
 of the defender, and to the fact that he confined himself to purely
 defensive action.

It is, therefore, after all, an open question whether the initiative
of parts of the line should govern the conduct of the entire force. In
some instances, it certainly ought not to govern, if disaster is to be
avoided. When a portion of the firing line advances, however, and the
tactical situation in any way permits, neighboring units should at once
conform to the movement. The units in rear, in particular, should, in
this case, promptly hurry forward by the shortest route without regard
to losses, support the firing line, and prevent it being repulsed.
(Par. 345, German I. D. R.).

This brings up the question, as to whether the trumpeters of the
assaulting units should sound the signal “fix bayonet,” in this
assault, and thus bring about a prompt general assault by the entire
line. This might obviously cause the troops to advance prematurely
to the assault, a danger which might be brought about by the junior
platoon commander. No one but the supreme commander, therefore, has
the right to order this signal to be sounded when he wishes a general
assault to be made. This is prescribed in the German Infantry Drill
Regulations (par. 347). If the commander of the firing line decides
to assault, he transmits his decision to the rear by means of signals
(s. s. s.). The supreme commander can still restrain the skirmishers
by the signal h. h. h., or bring about a general assault all along the
line by giving the signal “fix bayonet”. If a unit moves to the assault
contrary to the wishes of the supreme commander, he should possess
enough nerve to look on calmly while it is being defeated. It is much
better for him to allow a single unit to be defeated than to cause the
failure of the general attack by a premature advance.

“Although the assault should be made as nearly simultaneously as
possible, this is not to be understood as meaning that all the units
should penetrate the hostile position at one and the same time. Such
simultaneous action is immaterial, and might, indeed, cause parts of
the line who had a chance of successfully carrying out the assault,
to hesitate because others are still in rear. The power of the attack
would accordingly be impaired. All units that have once started must
continue to advance uninterruptedly.” (Par. 349 German I. D. R.).

It depends upon the situation whether the troops intended for the
holding attack finally participate in the assault itself. If they can
bring an effective fire to bear upon the point of attack from an
oblique direction and thereby ensure the success of the attack, they
should make the most of this advantage. (Par. 340 German I. D. R.).

When the enemy advances to the frontal counter-attack, as laid down in
the Russian and British regulations, the skirmishers throw themselves
down for the purpose of firing. The supports in the act of moving up
continue their march. If the enemy faces about, all the troops press
after him.

 The French regulations (par. 270) also consider such a counter-attack:

 “If the attacker presses forward too hastily and if he threatens
 to carry the defender’s position, fresh troops, which have been
 assembled in a place sheltered from view, attack him energetically,
 while the troops already engaged increase the intensity of their
 fire. This powerful and energetic counter-attack produces confusion
 in the enemy’s ranks and compels him to retire, or at least to
 discontinue his forward movement until he has had time to recover....
 The troops in the counter-attack should move forward without
 hesitation and regardless of the cost. When such a forward movement
 has to be discontinued, the commander must decide where it shall
 cease. The efforts of all should be directed toward one object, that
 of tiring and demoralizing the enemy by constant counter-attacks,
 until the moment arrives when the commander must order the offensive
 to be assumed.”

The German Infantry Drill Regulations contain no further rules for the
conduct of the assault. If the physical and moral power of the enemy is
so broken by the preceding fire fight that he commences to evacuate his
position, it is quite immaterial what sort of an assault is made; the
men simply fire and rush quickly after the retiring enemy. In this case
the assault is nothing but a postlude of the fire fight.

A brave and well disciplined opponent who is energetically led, will
not allow himself to be forced to evacuate his position by fire alone;
to compel him to evacuate his position will at the very least require
that an assault be threatened.

Before the Boer war, the British held the view that the effect of the
fire fight alone was so great that the assault would strike nothing
but an evacuated or, at most, a feebly defended position. The assault
was to commence after the enemy had ceased firing and had sought
protection in his trenches. The following statement is made by one who
fought on the Boer side:

 “The artillery supported the advance until the latter had arrived
 within 300 or 400 m. of the enemy; then it ceased firing. After a
 brief period of preparation by fire, the British infantry began the
 assault simultaneously in one long line. This assault, made without
 fire support, was repulsed without trouble by the Boer fire. On
 several occasions, short lines of our opponent had begun to advance,
 but these were in every instance forced to throw themselves down
 after a few moments had elapsed. Thereupon the whole British line,
 in my estimation at least 300-400 men strong, began to advance. One
 could clearly hear the British leaders call to their men to cease
 firing, could clearly hear the command ‘fix bayonet’, and the cheer
 ‘God save the Queen’! run along the British line. Then the whole
 hostile line rose. As they rushed toward us, they looked to me like a
 grayish yellow swarm, the men being almost shoulder to shoulder and
 the line being in places three to four men deep, just as frequently
 happens in charges made during our own peace maneuvers. At the same
 moment, we began firing. Our fire was at first somewhat wild, but
 was soon better controlled by our more experienced fighters calling,
 ‘Steady boys, steady, then none of them will reach us’. More and
 more men fell in the British line, and, when it had arrived within
 100 or 80 paces of our position, its energy had spent itself. A
 part of the men threw themselves down behind boulders and fired,
 while the majority rushed back to the shelter of some bushes; but
 even there it was for the most part impossible to hold them. An
 assaulting enemy who does not fire, is not dangerous, even if he is
 numerically superior. In this case, the defender can fire a number
 of times, and the closer the assailant is to the defender’s position
 the more quickly and certainly will his force dwindle away. No one
 will, however, be able to induce the same men to advance again under
 hostile fire over an open field, that is, to expose themselves
 without shelter to the hostile fire.”[401]

   [401] Supplement 8 to the _Militär-Wochenblatt_, 1901.

 The same lesson was learned long ago at =Gorni Dubniac= and at
 =Plevna=.

It is obvious that fire support is essential to the success of such an
assault. This should be furnished in the first place by the artillery.
In furnishing this support, artillery can employ time fire only until
the infantry arrives within 300 m. of the enemy, while percussion fire
may be continued until the infantry arrives within 150 m. of the enemy.
During the attack on Pieters Hill (1900), Colonel Kitchener is said
to have told his artillerymen that he would not censure them if two
or three of their shrapnel burst in the ranks of his infantry. The
following statement appears in a British memorial on the lessons of
the war in the Far East: “The moral effect produced by artillery fire,
which forced the defenders to take to cover and did not even permit
them to raise their heads above the parapet, was so highly esteemed
by the Japanese infantry that it requested the batteries to continue
firing, without regard to the losses thereby inflicted in its own
ranks, until it had taken the position or unfurled small national flags
as an indication that fire support was no longer necessary. According
to the opinion of the Japanese themselves, the losses inflicted in
their infantry by their own guns were insignificant in comparison to
the losses which the defender could inflict by delivering his fire
undisturbed at a range of a few hundred meters, when not kept down by
the attacking artillery.” According to the Austrian regulations, one
unit is to remain halted for the purpose of directing its fire upon the
point of attack or upon any reserves that might appear. This provision
involves a grave danger, in that it may induce the leader to retain
a considerable number of troops in rallying positions, instead of
launching his whole force in the assault.

When fire support is deemed necessary in an attack, the artillery will
perhaps be best able to furnish it until the infantry has reached
a certain point. Then a moment will arrive, however, when the guns
will have to cease firing, and when even the infantry units which
have been left behind to support the attack, will no longer be able
to direct their fire upon the enemy on account of the wide frontage
of the assaulting force. The defender’s troops would have to be poor
indeed, if they would not at this moment, when the assailant’s fire has
practically ceased, raise their heads above the parapet for the purpose
of emptying their magazines once more at the assailant, even though the
fire be unaimed.

If the assault is to succeed, it is essential however, that, while the
attacker covers the last 100-150 m., the defender be compelled to keep
under cover. _This can only be accomplished by employing fire while in
motion._

This fire is practicable because the defender, who has been overwhelmed
in the fire fight, has sought shelter in his works; it is advantageous,
as it is only to compel the enemy to keep under cover. It would
unquestionably be a mistake, and not justifiable in any case, to employ
fire while in motion, when these conditions are not fulfilled, when the
enemy is not completely subdued and is perhaps waiting under cover,
ready to meet the assailant’s assault. Supporting the infantry assault
with fire has, moreover, the additional advantage of preventing the
defender from bringing up his reserves.

 The following is taken from a private letter of Sir Ian Hamilton,
 perhaps the foremost British infantry tactician, who had the good
 fortune, at Elandslaagte and Doornkop, of leading his command close
 up to the enemy: “It is my opinion that no matter what regulations
 are promulgated in time of peace, the men will fire during the
 assault. You may rest assured that nothing will prevent their doing
 this. One would do well, therefore, to reckon with this factor from
 the very start. The greatest danger is always that the men will throw
 themselves down instead of continuing the advance. And, if the men
 have once thrown themselves down during the assault, they will rise
 only for the purpose of retreating.”[402]

   [402] In _Ausbildung der Infanterie für den Angriff_, p. 63,
 Colonel VON DER GOLTZ makes the following statement in regard to an
 experiment: “As the line gradually drew closer to the defender’s
 position, the desire of the individual men to get into the hostile
 position as quickly as possible, became more and more apparent; the
 prone position for firing was abandoned for the kneeling position,
 finally for the standing position, and, quite naturally, fire while
 in motion resulted in the end. Fire while in motion is authorized
 by the regulations and is, in this case, certainly permissible. Its
 employment in this case may be traced to the very proper desire of
 not allowing the enemy, who has been held down this long, to raise
 himself above his parapet. This fire while in motion should not be
 confused with the fire while in motion formerly employed by long
 skirmish lines at long ranges, and condemned at that time. The
 latter had for its object not the keeping down of an enemy already
 overwhelmed, but, on the contrary, was intended to overpower an
 unshaken opponent.”

 =Russia.= The attacking force approaches the enemy so close (35 m.)
 that the troops are enabled to throw themselves upon him. The point
 at which the hostile position is to be penetrated is designated and
 the men form in rear of their platoon leader. The reserves move at a
 run or by crawling close up to the firing line. If the assault is
 begun at a greater distance than 35 m. from the hostile position,
 fire while in motion is employed, “in order that the enemy may not
 regain his senses and may be prevented from rising above his parapet.”

During an unexpected encounter at night, on unfavorable terrain
(Swiep-Wald at Königgrätz), as well as during obstinate fights for the
possession of fortifications (the Grivica Work at Plevna, Scheinovo),
bayonet combats are unavoidable, provided both forces are equally
determined. During the fight for the possession of Servigny, on the
evening of August 31st, 1870, serious hand to hand fighting occurred
in the narrow village streets.[403] The Russo-Japanese war also proved
beyond the shadow of a doubt that determined troops will maintain their
positions until they are thrown out of them by cold steel.[404]

   [403] KUNZ, _Noisseville_, p. 51. See p. 134 supra. Fieldmarshal
 MOLTKE makes the following observations in regard to the bayonet
 fights of the campaign of 1859: “General Niel credits his victory at
 Solferino to the use of the bayonet. The question as to how often the
 advance to hand to hand conflict is carried out, may be left open. As
 a rule, it is employed only when it may be presumed that the enemy
 will not await the onslaught.” In his memoranda of 1865, in regard
 to the influence of improved fire arms on tactics, he states: “If
 the bayonet fights, so often mentioned in French accounts of the
 campaign of 1859, were stripped of their dramatic splendor, and if
 the simple prosaic truth could be ascertained, by far the greater
 number of these reports would be corrected in so far as to state that
 the opponent, shaken by more or less heavy losses, avoided the actual
 collision.”

   [404] Examples: The attack on Tempel Hill on October 11th, In
 _Angriffsverfahren der Japaner_, VON LÜTTWITZ.--The capture of
 works No. 17 and No. 18 by the 2nd Division, on March 1st, 1905
 (Mukden).--Description by an eyewitness of a bayonet fight. Sir IAN
 HAMILTON, _A Staff Officer’s Scrap Book_, p. 252.--A bayonet fight
 occurred in the day time, in the open, when the 11th Rifle Regiment
 broke through the line at Hamatan during the battle on the Yalu,
 (see _Kriegsgeschichtliche Einzelschriften_, 39-40, p. 131), and in
 Bernaul’s Regiment, during the engagement at Datshishiao, on July
 24th, 1904.

The defender will never retire simultaneously all along the line;
frequently isolated groups and then entire units will leave his
line when the superiority of the attacker’s fire becomes effective.
Officers, non-commissioned officers and capable privates will endeavor
to keep the weak-kneed from running away.[405]

   [405] At Villepion, Captain von Hoffmann made a wavering section
 hold its position by springing toward them, revolver in hand, and
 yelling: “I’ll shoot the first man who gets up! my revolver will
 hit too, whether Chassepot bullets will hit you is a question.”
 _Geschichte des Bayerischen Leibregiments_.

If the assault is not made at this moment, the crisis may pass, but
a determined rush by the attacker will, as a rule, bring about the
decision. The threat of a bayonet attack usually decides those who have
remained in the position, to make no further resistance. The attacker
must make use of the moral factors in an assault, hence the importance
of running, cheering, and accompanying the advance of all bodies in
close order by the beating of drums and the sounding of trumpets.[406]

   [406] One must read KUNZ, _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, 13, pp.
 80, 116, 123 and 156, in order to appreciate what an electrifying
 influence the beating of drums may have even on retreating lines.

 “The French were unable to withstand an energetic attack, when
 undertaken in anything like sufficient strength and accompanied by
 cheers and beating drums.” BOGUSLAWSKI.

 “Suddenly some soldier shouted: ‘Columns! Columns!’ Captain von
 Wobeser rose to see what was going on, but at the same moment his men
 rushed back and made straight for the Bois.”--“The mere launching of
 the attack from the direction of =Point du Jour= sufficed to induce
 the well concealed force of about 400 men, which held the gravel
 pits, likewise to beat a retreat that very much resembled a rout.”
 HÖNIG.

In time of peace there should be instilled in the soldier the
conviction that, with the bayonet, he is a match for any opponent;
that, in bayonet fighting, no other infantry is the equal of his own.
The soldier should not be taught to shrink from the bayonet attack, but
to seek it. If the infantry is deprived of the _arme blanche_, if the
impossibility of bayonet fighting is preached, and the soldier is never
given an opportunity in time of peace of defending himself, man to man,
with his weapon in bayonet fencing, an infantry will be developed,
which is unsuitable for attack and which, moreover, lacks a most
essential quality, viz., the moral power to reach the enemy’s position.

“The rarity of bayonet fights does not prove the uselessness of the
bayonet, but shows that opponents will rarely be found who are equally
capable of making use of it. Indeed, the bayonet cannot be abolished
for the reason, if for no other, that it is the sole and exclusive
embodiment of that will power which alone, both in war and in every-day
life, attains its object, whereas reason only tends to facilitate the
attainment of the object.

“Let us assume that there exists an army which bases success in battle
on fire action, and takes for granted that the enemy will not be
able to get near enough to make a bayonet attack. If this army were
to encounter another army which, without undervaluing the effect of
fire, remembers the bayonet at the proper time, it would be filled
with the most dreadful dismay when the enemy actually assails it with
the bayonet. With modern rifles, bullets are unquestionably a good
substitute for the bayonet at close quarters, but this is true only
of troops who do not fear annihilation, _i.e._, troops trained to use
the bayonet and capable of closing with the enemy after firing. If
this is not the case, such firing at close quarters is a pure waste
of ammunition, since men who are afraid to close with the enemy, if
necessary at such a moment, will usually fire into the air.

“If the soldier has been taught, however, to annihilate the enemy
from a distance and from behind cover, he will naturally prefer this
mode of inflicting losses, since he runs very little risk of getting
hurt, and will, moreover, acquire an aversion for exposing himself to
danger, _i.e._, he will shrink from bayonet work. Hence, if we attach
too much importance to marksmanship, we produce a more or less trained
soldier, who may possibly be a very good shot at long ranges, but who
is not especially inclined to take his chances in a bayonet fight.
Incidentally, target practice develops the mentality of the man, but
does not improve his morale.” DRAGOMIROV.

Of every 100 wounds, the following percentages were produced by cutting
weapons:

 Campaign of 1859               1.67%
 Campaign of 1864               4.0 %
 Campaign of 1866 (Prussians)   5.4 %
 St. Privat (Germans)           1.0 %
 Russo-Turkish war              0.9 %

In time of peace the assaulting distance is to be about 150 m. During
the Franco-German war, the assault against Elsaszhausen (battle of
Wörth) was launched at about 300 m.[407] and that against St. Hubert
at 100-200 m. from the enemy.[408] The 107th Infantry, after charging
over a distance of more than 500 paces, captured a hedge which was held
by the French north of St. Privat, and, in the assault against the
northern outskirts of the village, a distance of 300 paces had to be
covered.[409] In the attack on Le Bourget, on October 30th, 1870, the
center column halted when 600 m. from the village; “then began a wild,
headlong assault against its outskirts.”[410] The Japanese frequently
had occasion to cross similar stretches at a run, but there were also
instances where their assaulting troops had only to cover a few meters
(1st Division at Kinchau, 20 m.).

   [407] _Gen. St. W._, I, p. 267.

   [408] HÖNIG, _Vierundzwanzig Stunden Moltkescher Strategie_, p. 127.

   [409] _Gen. St. W._, II, p. 804.

   [410] KUNZ, _Le Bourget_, p. 21.

=If the attacker succeeds in carrying the position=, he will be
at a disadvantage for the moment; his troops will be in confusion
and exhausted, and a large number of officers will be gone. If the
defender, reinforced by fresh reserves, takes advantage of this moment,
he may be able to turn the tide of the battle. The inclination of
the men to pursue the enemy with the bayonet, instead of halting and
making the most of the fire power of their rifles, is noticeable in
all battles. The attacker will have to take steps to restrain his
victorious infantry, and, as soon as opportunity offers, to pursue
the enemy with fire. Under cover of this fire fresh troops or quickly
assembled detachments should advance on the flanks in pursuit of the
enemy. There is a wide difference between a wild, headlong rush after
the enemy and a systematic pursuit. Infantry that rushes headlong to
the front after penetrating a position must be brought back at any
cost, unless it can enter a second position simultaneously with the
enemy.[411]

   [411] The conduct of the 47th Infantry Brigade after the capture
 of Ste. Marie aux Chênes. _Der 18. August_, p. 184. The second line
 of the position at Düppel was carried by the pursuing victors at the
 first rush. _Gen. St. W._, 1864, II, p. 539.

In addition to pursuing the enemy with fire, the attacker should
re-form his troops without regard to their original arrangement (if
the enemy gives him time enough, the original organizations should
be re-formed), occupy the position, replenish ammunition, and remove
the prisoners. It is a mistake to mass more rifles in the captured
position than can be employed to advantage, as the enemy will in all
probability direct a heavy fire upon it. As soon as the fight has been
decided, the echelons in rear should be halted, so that they can be
employed as occasion demands. The leaders of these units will often
have to act independently in such a case. (Par. 350 German I. D. R.).
Preparations should be made to the end that hostile counter-attacks
may be at once repulsed. These rules are particularly important when
the position that has been carried is not the main position but only
an advanced post.[412] These measures must be taken independently
by all leaders who participated in the assault, without waiting for
orders from superior authority. The pursuit should be begun as soon as
possible with formed bodies of troops (if practicable, while the enemy
is being pursued by fire), in order to interfere with his re-forming,
to prevent his taking up route column, and to overrun his rallying
positions. The battle of Beaumont consisted of a whole series of such
pursuing actions. The arrival of night should by no means be used as an
excuse for discontinuing the pursuit, for night above all else is the
mightiest ally of a bold victor.[413]

   [412] See _Taktik_, V, p. 359, et seq. See also the measures taken
 after the capture of St. Privat. _Der 18. August_, p. 533. The
 situation in Fröschweiler; KUNZ. _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_,
 17. pp. 109 and 153. As in peace, the signals, ‘the whole force
 assemble,’ and ‘the whole force halt,’ was sounded everywhere. How
 little the infantry was inclined to pursue is shown by the conduct
 of the 94th and the 32nd Infantry Regiments. _Ibid._, pp. 87-90. The
 10th Company of the 32nd Infantry marched fully two miles to the rear
 to a bivouac which they had left in the morning.

   [413] See _Taktik_, V. p. 436.

=If the attack fails=, it will be the duty of the commander to arrest
the flight of the skirmishers who are rushing to the rear under hostile
fire. It will be impossible, however, to halt these men while they
are exposed to the most effective fire of the enemy. Only when the
nearest cover is reached can there be any question of halting. (Par.
327 German I. D. R.). When cover is not available near at hand, the
exhaustion of the troops will soon stop the flight, or the leaders
may be able to face them again to the front, as soon as the hostile
fire abates. However, the retreating troops will have placed quite a
distance between themselves and the enemy before this can be done, and
the latter, unmolested by fire from the attacker, will be able to take
full advantage of the technical qualities of his rifle, unless the
attacker’s artillery or cavalry prevent his doing so. No matter where
the retreating troops come to a halt and face to the front, there they
must stay, and, if the hostile fire permits, intrench.

 The perseverance of the Prussian Guard 600-800 m. in front of
 =St. Privat=,[414] and of the British Brigade of Highlanders at
 =Magersfontain=, immediately in front of the Boer position, on
 December 11th, 1899, is worthy of imitation.

   [414] The distance at which the first attack came to a standstill
 is variously given as 300 (3rd Guard Regiment and IInd Battalion of
 the 1st Guard Regiment) and 800-900 paces (2nd Guard Regiment). See
 _History of the 3rd Guard Regiment_, pp. 276, 279 and 280; that of
 the _1st Guard Regiment_, p. 165; that of the _2nd Guard Regiment_,
 p. 232. “Headed by a few of the officers who still remained,
 the depleted lines clung to the slope; with iron endurance and
 self-sacrifice they maintained the dearly bought positions.” _Gen.
 St. W._, II, p. 872.

 The assault on =Gorni Dubniac= came to a standstill at very short
 range, and a part of the skirmishers of the Moscow and Pavlov
 Regiments maintained their positions 50 m., the remaining Russian
 skirmishers 320 m., from the trench.[415]

   [415] PUSYREWSKI, _Die russische Garde_, p. 126.


11. THE USE OF THE SPADE IN ATTACK.

(Pars. 157, 313, 339, 380 and 381 German I. D. R.).

In every attack there are situations in which it may be advantageous to
use intrenching tools--

1. In fortifying rallying positions.

The Japanese, whose mode of waging war was very cautious, fortified the
initial positions from which their attacks were made, in order that
they might have rallying positions in case of defeat.[416]

   [416] On July 19th, 1904, the 12th Infantry Division (Ist Army)
 had pushed back Russian troops at Shaotao and at once fortified a
 position 2700 m. from the new Russian position at Yushuling. From
 this position the 12th Division advanced, on July 31st, as a Russian
 attack had not taken place. The extended fortifications facing the
 Russian Shaho position were made with the same end in view. The war
 in the Far East was one of positions, since neither army possessed
 sufficient freedom of action. See p. 341, et seq., supra.

2. In intrenching after making an advance under cover of darkness to
within effective range of the enemy for the purpose of opening fire at
daybreak. In this case, the advancing force is, as a rule, instructed
to advance until it comes under hostile fire and then to intrench.[417]

   [417] During the attack on Paardeberg, on February 27th, 1900, the
 Canadians were ordered to advance before daybreak from their trenches
 located 500 m. from the Boer position, and to throw themselves down
 and to intrench as soon as they were fired upon. This was done
 when the force was 100 m. from the enemy. _Kriegsgeschichtliche
 Einzelschriften_, 33, p. 60.

   The Japanese 45th Infantry, in its advance under cover of darkness
 against Oerrshikiatsi (Shaho) was first fired upon at a range of 1000
 m., whereupon the men threw themselves down and intrenched; when the
 hostile fire abated, the regiment advanced again, and when the enemy
 resumed his fire, it intrenched. A third advance brought the regiment
 within 500 m. of the defender’s position and it was able to make the
 assault during the forenoon of October 12th, 1904.

3. In intrenching an echelon posted to cover advancing infantry.

4. In fortifying a captured position. The want of intrenching tools in
quickly putting captured positions in a state of defense, so often felt
during the Franco-German war and the Russo-Turkish war, has now been
removed by the introduction of portable tools.[418] The necessity of
quickly preparing captured positions for defense presented itself in a
number of instances.

   [418] Examples: The French in St. Privat. The Germans and later
 the French in Noisseville. on September 1st, 1870. Villepion,
 on December 1st, 1870 (HÖNIG, _Volkskrieg_, III, p. 257; KUNZ,
 _Loigny_, p. 49): Les Granges, on January 11th, 1871 (_Geschichte des
 Regiments Nr. 20_. p. 297). Fortifying the position on the second
 ridge of the Green Hills in front of Plevna, on September 10th, 1877
 (KUROPATKIN-KRAHMER, II, p. 178). Tempel Hill (Terrayama), on October
 11th, 1904. In the last mentioned case three offensive returns were
 repulsed from the captured position, which had been prepared for
 defense. The fights for the possession of the village of Linchinpu
 (on the right bank of the Shaho, north of the railway), captured
 on October 14th, were still more obstinate; the position had to be
 prepared for defense under hostile artillery fire. (VON TETTAU,
 _Achtzehn Monate mit Russlands Heeren in der Mandschurei_, II, p.
 136).

5. In holding ground that has been gained in an attack when further
advance is impossible, that is, in situations such as confronted the
infantry of the Guard on August 18th when its first attack came to a
standstill. During the attack on Gorni Dubniac, in the Russo-Turkish
war, the Russian Guard intrenched when a further advance became
impossible. During the attack on Telish, which occurred a few days
later, specific orders were issued for the troops to intrench when
1000-2000 m. from the Turkish works.[419]

   [419] PUSYREWSKI, _Die russische Garde_, p. 166.

As a result of the lessons gained in the Russo-Turkish war, general
instructions were issued to the Russian infantry on the subject of
intrenching in attack. According to these instructions, the spade was
to be used in attack in the following cases: In fortifying a captured
position, as a protection against a possible offensive return of the
defender; in holding supporting points necessary to a continuation of
the attack; and in placing rallying positions in a state of defense.
The order directing troops to intrench was to be given, in all cases,
by the supreme commander. The following procedure was to be observed:
“Every man equipped with a spade and who is not sheltered by some
feature of the terrain, places his rifle on the ground and, lying on
his left side, begins to excavate a hole parallel to his body. This
hole should be as long as the distance from his left elbow to his knee,
as wide as the length of the spade-handle, and as deep as the width of
the blade of the spade. The excavated earth and sod he places in front
of his head, which he endeavors to protect as quickly as possible. When
this work is completed, he rolls over into the excavated hole, and,
lying on his right side, repeats the operation. When he has obtained
sufficient cover, he hands his spade to the other man of the file, who
proceeds in a similar fashion.”

The Japanese, on account of their numerical inferiority, found it
necessary to get along with few supports and reserves, and therefore
made use of the spade in terrain devoid of cover, or utilized sand
bags,[420] which were carried along. In this manner, they laboriously
worked their way to within assaulting distance of the enemy. In many
instances, this necessitated whole days of fighting when an envelopment
was impossible. Sand bags were an advantage when the ground was frozen
or when the sod was not thick.

   [420] See p. 344 supra. Frequently the bags, which could be tied
 with a string, were filled near the place where they were to be used.
 The advance was considerably retarded by carrying along sand bags.
 During the attack on Yuputz, on March 1st, 1905, by the 8th Infantry
 Division of the IInd Army, the first sand bag cover was constructed
 700 m. and the last 250 m. from the village.

 _Results of Russian experiments._ The sand bag employed was made
 of coarse linen of grayish green color and when filled and tied,
 was approximately 50 cm. long (width of a man’s shoulders), 30-35
 cm. wide, and 30-35 cm. high. The filled sand bag weighed 14-20
 kg., depending upon the filling material (sand or broken stone).
 When filled with sand or broken stone, the sand bag stopped all
 projectiles, while, when filled with earth, even two bags placed in
 rear of each other did not afford sufficient protection. The sand
 bags were scarcely discernible with the naked eye at 400 m. They were
 not an easy target to hit, and, even at 300 m., it was difficult to
 aim at them.

 The men had a distinct aversion against constructing shelter trenches
 while lying down. During the war they could be made to intrench only
 by great exertions on the part of the officers. The reason for this
 is obvious; digging with the small spade while in a prone position
 is uncomfortable. The skirmisher considers it much more profitable
 to fire than to puzzle out how he can best stir up the soil with the
 small spade while in a prone position. Moreover, he knows that at any
 moment he may have to make a rush to the front.

 The beautiful idea that these trenches were to be used and widened
 by the reserves, was usually not carried out. The reserves preferred
 to make longer rushes and to take advantage of folds of the ground
 rather than occupy themselves with intrenching under hostile fire.

 At ranges from 2000-1000 m., single men made short rushes, only 30-40
 m. long, as the filled sand bag constituted a considerable load.
 Before a man ran forward, he slung his rifle, grasped the sand bag
 with one hand at the tied end, with the other at a loop specially
 provided for that purpose; then he jumped up, ran forward 30-40 m.,
 as rapidly as he could in a crouching position, placed the sand bag
 on the ground, and threw himself down behind it. Under effective
 hostile fire, at 1000-550 m. (during our peace maneuvers at 420-280
 m.), the men then crawl forward, utilizing the sand bag as cover.
 The men would rather crawl a greater distance with the sand bag than
 intrench while lying down.

 From the position of the enemy, the skirmishers lying behind grayish
 green sand bags could not be recognized with the naked eye at
 2000-1000 m. It is reported that both officers and men were at first
 very much disinclined toward making these experiments, but that they
 changed their views after one or two exercises, and the principal
 apprehension, that of increasing the weight of the field equipment,
 disappeared because of the undeniable advantages of the sand bag.

Such cover constructed by the assailant has no greater value than
natural cover found on the ground over which the attack is made; it
affords protection during halts and induces retreating skirmishers to
face to the front again at an earlier moment than would otherwise be
the case.

“It should not be forgotten, however, that time gained is of greater
benefit to the defender than to the assailant. Moreover, the great
difficulty of inducing a firing line which has made a lodgment under
hostile fire, to advance from its laboriously constructed cover,
admonishes us to be cautious in employing the spade during an attack.
The construction of cover ought never to impair the desire for making
an impetuous attack, or destroy the offensive spirit.” (Par. 313 German
I. D. R.).

When a body of troops intrenches during an attack, it must detach
half of its force to keep up the attack; this cannot be offset by an
increased rate of fire, even if squad leaders, range finders, and
musicians, take part in the fight, as the men offer a taller target
while intrenching, and as the newly turned earth facilitates the
enemy’s aim. A superiority of fire that has been gained may thereby be
lost. However, when the defender’s troops have been so shaken that the
assailant can detach half of his rifles with impunity, the latter need
not remain lying on the ground, but can advance, in most cases, closer
to the enemy’s position. The use of the spade is, therefore, proper
only when ground that has been gained is to be held, and when the
enemy’s fire permits intrenching.

 =Russia.= In instructions issued by General Kuropatkin, the following
 statement in regard to the Japanese infantry appears: “It advances in
 widely deployed lines. The firing line advances by short, alternating
 rushes, the men then throwing themselves down and intrenching. In
 spite of our extraordinarily violent fire, the firing line continues
 to advance by alternate rushes, leaves its half completed shelter
 trenches and begins to dig new ones. The supports then advance by
 alternate rushes, occupy the first line of trenches and complete
 them. When the firing line advances from the second line of trenches,
 they are occupied by the supports, while the reserves move up into
 the first line of trenches. In this manner, the advance is continued
 by successive rushes. From this, it is apparent that the infantryman
 in the firing line must act on his own initiative in selecting a
 point for intrenching.”

 =Japan.= In a number of cases, the Japanese conducted an attack in
 the manner described. At Liao Yang, on September 1st, 1904, shelter
 trenches were dug at 750 and at 530 m. from the Russian position.
 The advance beyond this was so managed that the men intrenched after
 every rush, finally arriving, in the course of the day, within 300
 m. of the enemy. An assault made from this position on the afternoon
 of the 2nd was repulsed. The whole Japanese line again faced to the
 front on arriving in the shelter trenches which they had dug 300 m.
 from the hostile position. The Japanese now perfected their weak
 intrenchments and were even able to repulse two counter-attacks
 made by the Russians. This was certainly an exceptional case, and,
 besides, it involved an attack on a fortified position.

 The German Manual of Field Engineering (No. 46) recommends that the
 man, when lying on his left side, construct in the first place a
 parapet 30 cm. high, as head cover and rifle rest. This produces pits
 50 cm. wide, 60 cm. long, and 40 cm. deep, usually deeper in front
 than in rear, which makes aiming uncomfortable.

 =France.= According to the _Instruction pratique sur les travaux de
 campagne_ (24th October, 1906), the men are to improve available
 cover; where natural cover is wanting, artificial cover is to
 be constructed when the hostile fire compels a halt or the men
 are forced to halt to regain their breath. At short ranges, the
 skirmishers dig individual pits. It is desirable for the soldier to
 use his knapsack as cover while working, and to leave it in position
 later also, to get better head cover.

 =England.= Although the troops are not equipped with portable
 intrenching tools, it is prescribed that captured positions be
 fortified; in open country, when the hostile fire is too hot, this is
 to be done at night.

 The suggestion of creating cover for skirmishers by using the
 pits produced by short shell salvos, is a singular one. Detailed
 experiments have been made in =Austria=.[421] In instructions issued
 by the commander of the XIth Corps, it was recommended that, when
 exposed to moderate hostile fire, the soldier should hug the ground
 as closely as possible while at work. The intrenching proceeded
 most rapidly when the soldier first excavated the ground in front
 and threw it forward. But in order to do this, the man has to push
 himself backward during the work and must throw the earth some
 distance. The parapet is low, but affords sufficient protection.

   [421] _Streffleur_, 1906, III, p. 387.

[Illustration]

 The task is greater when the soldier lies first on his left, then on
 his right side, removes earth from a borrow pit at his right and then
 from one on his left, and piles it up in front. As the skirmisher
 lies on the natural surface of the ground during this operation, he
 naturally constructs a higher parapet.

The following general rules governing the use of the spade in attack
may be laid down:

1. An invariable use of the spade in attack must be unhesitatingly
condemned. The best means of gaining the superiority of fire, and the
best protection against hostile fire, is our own fire.

2. It must not be left to the soldier’s discretion, as to whether or
not he shall intrench. The order for intrenching should in every case
emanate from the supreme commander.

3. As a rule, the spade should be used in those phases of combat that
partake more of a defensive character, in particular--

(a) To protect artillery and prepare rallying positions during the
preparatory stage of the action;

(b) To shelter troops detailed to contain the enemy while enveloping
movements are in progress;

(c) To shelter troops that are to keep down the hostile fire by their
own delivered from enfilading or commanding positions;

(d) To maintain a strip of ground or a supporting point that has just
been gained, whether this has been captured from the enemy or whether
the attack has come to a standstill at that point and a pause in the
fighting occurs.

4. An attack with the aid of the spade from trench to trench is
advisable only in exceptional cases, when the attack is a purely
frontal one and is made over ground devoid of cover.


12. THE EMPLOYMENT OF RESERVES.[422]

(Pars. 294, 295, 366, 388, 393, 427 and 436 German I. D. R.).

   [422] _Taktik_, V. p. 334, et seq.

The infantry attack may be characterized as a fire fight. It would seem
desirable to surround the enemy’s zone of approach, or the position
one wishes to attack, from the very outset with a dense, continuous
line of rifles, and to overcome the resistance of the enemy in the
earliest phases of the combat by means of an overwhelming volume of
fire from as many rifles as possible. The impediments that stand in
the way of carrying out this idea lie in the terrain, the ignorance of
the enemy’s position, and in human nature. The defender can be driven
from his position only by an attack; the impulse for an advance must be
given by fresh troops; and the success gained by the firing line must
be clinched by a retained assaulting force. The necessity of having
a formed body of troops available, until the fight is in full swing,
to meet unforeseen contingencies, further requires that a reserve
be provided. Organizations should not be broken up any more than is
absolutely necessary. The number of troops which the commander will
retain for the time being, will depend upon the amount of information
he has in regard to the situation. During an attack the reserve is
frequently not designated until a preparatory position is taken up. In
attack about ¹⁄₄-¹⁄₃, and in defense ¹⁄₆-¹⁄₂ of the whole force is put
in the reserve, depending upon whether the ensuing action is to be a
purely defensive one or the decision is sought.

The reserve enables the commander to “shift the center of gravity of
the fight to the point desired by him, to reinforce his line where he
considers proper, to equalize fluctuations of the combat, and, finally,
to bring about the decision.” (Par. 294 German I. D. R.). As the combat
progresses, the commander must decide whether the situation is such
as to compel him to employ the reserves to cover his retreat,[423] or
whether it is proper for him to put in his last troops for the purpose
of gaining the victory. If the reserve has been put in and the attack
fails (or, as at Wörth, the defender succumbs after putting in all the
reserves) defeat is certain; but it would be a mistake not to employ
the reserve, to keep it in readiness to cover a possible retreat, if
its intervention can yet bring about a favorable termination of the
combat.

   [423] See deliberations of General v. d. Tann at Coulmiers. HELVIG,
 _Das erste bayerische Armeekorps_, p. 203.

 The employment of the reserves by the Russians at =Plevna=, on
 September 11th, 1877: The general reserve consisted of nine
 battalions and was too weak to make an impression at one point;
 fifteen battalions were detailed to cover the lines of communication
 and the artillery (which was not at all in danger). Forty battalions
 that did not enter the fight were scattered all over the battlefield,
 no one being able to account for their presence.[424] When Skobeleff
 had effected a lodgment in the Turkish position, every available
 man should have been sent to this point. Although there were 9
 battalions, 30 guns, and 4 troops (_Eskadrons_) available, only
 the Schuja Regiment (1300 men), which had suffered heavy losses in
 previous actions, was despatched to the point in question, and that
 more for the purpose of covering the retreat than to make the most of
 the success that had been gained.

   [424] In the Franco-German war, the same thing happened on the
 German side. _Der 18. August_, p. 221.

 In contrast to the Japanese commanders, who promptly launched all
 their troops, the Russian commanders were inclined to despatch
 numerous detachments, to organize provisional units, while completely
 ignoring existing organizations (this had, indeed, also the
 advantage that a suitable leader could be found for carrying a
 special mission into execution), and to form strong reserves by
 details from any and all imaginable units. These reserves were
 frequently not used at all.[425]

   [425] On July 31st, 1904, when, in pursuance of orders from General
 Headquarters, a regiment and a battery was to be despatched to
 Mistshenko’s Cavalry Division, 15 km. away, a provisional regiment
 of two battalions was formed, without apparent reason, for the
 purpose from the 139th and 140th Infantry Regiments. In regard to the
 inclination of the Russians to form detachments, see LÖFFLER, I, pp.
 11, 27, 53 and 54.

 On March 5th, 1905, the commanding general of the Xth Army Corps
 (Zerpitzki) had available one brigade of his 31st Division, one
 regiment of his 9th Division, one regiment of the VIIIth Corps, three
 Rifle regiments of the mixed Rifle Corps, the 5th Rifle Brigade, and
 one regiment of the Vth Siberian Army Corps.[426]

   [426] See V. TETTAU, _Achtzehn Monate mit Russlands Heeren in der
 Mandschurei_, II, p. 483.

 On October 15th, in the battle on the =Shaho=, the general reserve
 of the army consisted of 32 battalions belonging to five different
 divisions and five different army corps. In his order for the battle,
 Kuropatkin laid particular stress on the necessity of forming
 reserves (Army Orders dated August 15th, 1904): “Keeping back more
 than half of the force in reserve is the best guarantee for success.”
 On December 27th, 1904, he made a similar statement.

The reserves are created to be used; every available man must
participate in the decisive stage of the combat. If the enemy yields
before the reserve is launched, so much the better; if he does not give
way, all the troops that are at hand must be put in. The main thing is
to gain the victory; scruples may be indulged in afterwards. A defeated
commander who leaves the battlefield with troops that are still
partially intact, has not made the most of the means at his disposal
for combat, provided the situation was such that the launching of the
reserves could have secured the victory. As shown by Hastenbeck (1757),
by Idstedt (1850), and by Bapaume, at the moment of the crisis there is
no sharp dividing line between victory and defeat, and the reserves may
decide the fate of the day. The decision of Archduke Albrecht, during
the battle of Custozza (1866), to push his last reserves into the fight
was worthy of a great commander.

 In contrast with this, =Russia= (1904): “In employing the general
 reserve, the commander-in-chief must be even more economical than
 the troop leader; he should, when necessary, detail single units to
 support this or that section, _but he should in no case use up his
 whole reserve before the decision has occurred_.” The failures of
 the British in the South African war may likewise be traced in part
 to a faulty use of the reserves. Thus, we read in the regulations of
 1896: “The reserve should occupy a favorable defensive position in
 order to check the enemy in case of defeat; if the attack succeeds,
 the reserve should move up into the position and take charge of the
 pursuit.”

“Troops that give up a fight are like the swimmer who, after having
made the most inconceivable exertions to swim across a broad, deep
river, shrinks from the last spurt and drowns, although he need only
stretch out his arm to reach the opposite shore.” (DRAGOMIROV).

In employing the reserve, it should be remembered that the whole
available force must be launched at the decisive moment at the decisive
point, and that the commander ought not to detach portions of the force
intended for the decisive blow for tasks of secondary importance.

 The launching of L’Estocq’s Corps at =Preussisch-Eylau=, is still a
 model worthy of imitation.[427]

   [427] LETTOW-VORBECK, _Feldzug von 1806 und 1807_, IV, p. 107.

 In the battle of =Vionville=, three battalions and four batteries
 were detached from the 20th Infantry Division, which had arrived
 during the afternoon, and sent to the right flank to take part in
 the action of the 5th Infantry Division, as infantry support seemed
 necessary on the right flank. When the head of the division reached
 Tronville, the question was discussed, as to whether it was desirable
 first to concentrate the division for action, or to throw the leading
 battalions into the Tronville forest, where portions of Lehman’s
 Brigade were still holding their ground. As an advance of the French
 out of the woods would have endangered the left flank of the Prussian
 artillery line, three battalions were at once thrown into the forest,
 while the six remaining battalions were kept in reserve for the time
 being. Subsequently, three more battalions were sent forward to
 reinforce the infantry engaged in the forest

 “What a decisive blow the 20th Division could have struck, if it had
 been employed in one body!” (V. LIEBERT).[428]

   [428] _Gen. St. W._, I, p. 595. _Kriegsgeschichtliche
 Einzelschriften_, 18, p. 580.--V. SCHERFF, _Kriegslehren_, II,
 p. 146.--Essay by V. LIEBERT published in Supplement of the
 _Militär-Wochenblatt_, 1895. From the description contained in
 the 4th Supplement of the _Militär-Wochenblatt_, 1895, p. 177. It
 appears, at any rate, that the support given by the 39th Half-Brigade
 was not absolutely necessary. On the right flank as well, a united
 employment of the force for the attack of Hill 970 ought to have
 been possible; as it was, regiments were cut up in making isolated
 assaults, which had no effect whatever on the outcome of the general
 action. KUNZ, _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, 8/9, p. 128, et seq.

The decision is usually brought about by pressure on a flank, but it
might become necessary to accomplish this result by launching large
masses against some point of the hostile front.[429]

   [429] General MINARELLI-FITZGERALD, _Infanteriemassen im Angriff_.
 Colonel CSICSERICS VON BACSANY of the Austrian Army, in a brilliant
 study entitled _Die Schlacht_ (Vienna, 1908), argues that with the
 increased combat frontage of armies, local successes have no longer
 the same Influence on the outcome of the battle as of old. Compare,
 for example, the envelopment of the Russian left flank at Liao Yang,
 and the penetration of the line at Yuhuntun (Mukden), with the effect
 produced by the capture of Chlum and St. Privat on the outcome of the
 battles of Königgrätz and Gravelotte, respectively.

The difficulties of accomplishing this are best illustrated by the
situation of the IIIrd Army Corps on the afternoon of August 18th,
1870, when Prince Frederick Charles yielded to the entreaties of
General von Alvensleben and permitted him to advance south of the
Bois de la Cusse.[430] Similar situations resulted in the case of the
Austrian 1st and VIth Army Corps at Königgrätz, the French IIIrd and
IVth Army Corps, on a front of 2.75 km., with the Guards in rear,
between Noisseville and Failly, and, finally, the advance of the
1st East Siberian Rifle Division at Wafangu. The French regulations
likewise contemplate a decisive attack made by large masses on a narrow
front. If these troops which are to clinch the success gained by the
fighting line, are deployed on the front laid down in regulations, they
will be unable to use their weapons. It isn’t mechanical shock action,
but fire effect that decides the battle. In such a mass of troops, only
fractional parts will be able to fire, the major portion is crowded
together and becomes a dense, defenseless target, exposed to all the
psychological impressions produced by crowding human beings into a
narrow space.[431]

   [430] _Der 18. August_, pp. 484 and 558, sketches 34 and 35.

   [431] The successful attacks made by masses of fanatical warriors
 in colonial wars are carried out under such peculiar conditions that,
 for our purposes, deductions therefrom are not admissible. The defeat
 of the two French brigades at Bang-Bo (24th March, 1885), and at
 Ki-lua (28th March, 1885). LEHAUCOURT, _Les Expéditions de Tonkin_.
 The defeat of the Italians at Adua (1st March. 1896).

A brigade, therefore, should not deploy on a front of 1500 m., _i.e._,
put only about ¹⁄₄ of its men in the first line; but no objection can
be made if the brigade, in moving to the final decisive assault, at
once advances on a front of 2500-3000 m.


13. THE CONDUCT OF THE LEADERS IN ACTION.

The difficulties of troop leading increase as the power of the
commander to control and direct all ranks in action by words of command
diminishes. In action, therefore, those means must be adopted that will
facilitate the transmission of orders. This requires first of all the
choice of an appropriate position for the leader.

The beginning of an action should find the leader as far forward as
possible; during the advance to the battlefield, with the advance
guard (par. 277 German I. D. R.), for neither messages nor reports,
nor a map can adequately take the place of personal inspection of the
situation of the enemy, of neighboring units, and of the ground. So
placed, he can best direct the first deployment, upon which the future
course of the action so largely depends, secure advantages by making
prompt decisions in face of the enemy, save his own troops from making
detours, handle them in accordance with a definite plan, and preclude
arbitrary action on the part of the commander of the leading unit.

During the action, the superior commander can influence the course
of the fight, his personal example excepted, only by employing his
reserves. His place is, therefore, near the reserves, at a point that
can be readily found, and never in the firing line.

A company commander should remain where he believes he can best control
his company, as a rule, perhaps in the firing line. He provides for the
supply and distribution of ammunition that is brought up from the rear,
and regulates the coöperation of the platoons. (Pars. 216, 457 and 458
German I. D. R.).

A battalion commander should only in very exceptional cases take post
in the firing line; he should nearly always remain with parts of the
force that are held back for the time being, but, in any case, where
he can effectively supervise his battalion. The choice of a regimental
commander’s position is influenced by the same considerations; when his
regiment is acting as part of a brigade, he must select his position so
as to facilitate the transmission of orders from brigade headquarters.
The brigade commander will, as a rule, remain near his reserves, at a
point from which he can best overlook the deployment of his brigade.

On account of the fact that extended order fighting predominates,
leaders of all grades must be particularly careful to maintain
connection between the several parts of their command, with each other,
and with adjoining units, and to preserve their influence over their
firing lines. Superior commanders should, in addition, see that their
troops do not get out of hand, and all subordinate leaders, after
carrying out a task assigned them, should endeavor promptly to rejoin
their proper commands, or place themselves at the disposal of the
commander of troops still engaged with the enemy.

These requirements will be fulfilled, if superior commanders order
nothing that they should not and cannot order, and if the officers
charged with the execution of the orders coöperate to attain the
desired end, and do not abuse the freedom of action allowed them.

While subordinate leaders, up to and including company commanders,
are mainly occupied with fire control and fire direction, and should
influence the men by their personal example, superior commanders have
other tasks, which they must not neglect for the purpose of interfering
in the sphere of action of their subordinates. They can influence the
fire action only by sending the necessary forces to those portions
of the firing line whose fire they wish to augment. An interference
on their part with the action of subordinates is permissible only in
case of obvious misunderstandings or mistakes, which would cause the
combat to take a course other than that intended. The larger the unit
commanded by an officer, the greater the latitude that must be allowed
him. The leaders should concentrate their attention upon the general
execution of their special tasks as part of the whole scheme, rather
than upon supervision of details. It is by no means essential for all
parts of the force to employ identical means to attain one and the same
object. Every leader should bear in mind that _omission or neglect are
greater crimes than a mistake made in the choice of means_.

The initiative of leaders of all grades is the foundation of great
victories in war, but this initiative must neither jeopardize unity of
action nor direct the course of events into channels not intended by
the commander.[432]

   [432] See _Taktik_, III, p. 174, and V, p. 57, et seq.

The best safeguard against the results of an act of unjustifiable
initiative is to ask oneself: “What orders would my superior have to
give me, if he were in my place and knew what I know?”


14. UNITED ACTION VERSUS TACTICAL MISSIONS.

 Although no one disputes that victory depends upon a superiority of
 fire at the decisive point, yet there is a great diversity of opinion
 as to how this superiority is to be attained.

 General Bronsart von Schellendorff states:[433] “Every battle seeks
 to bring about a decisive victory, but this is, after all, invariably
 the sum of local victories. Successful battle-tactics consist of
 correctly estimating the tactical value of these local successes
 and of contriving to gain a victory at the decisive point; in other
 words, to manage so that the sum-total of positive factors will be
 greater than that of the negative factors.”

   [433] _Betrachtungen über die zeitgemäsze Fechtweise der
 Infanterie_, 1891, p. 36.

 In the opinion of the advocates of this course,[434] unity of action
 is attainable by practice and study, but not by set formations. If
 unity of action could be ensured in all bodies of troops by means
 of study and practice, there would seem to be no reason why the
 regulations should lay down still more definite rules to govern the
 manner in which an attack should be conducted. The matter is not
 so simple, however. Bearing in mind the great latitude that the
 regulations allow each individual in choosing the formation which he
 deems proper in a given case, it is obvious that many very different
 procedures may result. This in itself is no drawback, and to a
 certain extent this condition must exist, as the task in hand, the
 nature of the country, and the existing situation vary. But, if a
 given problem can be correctly solved in several ways, it will also
 admit of a decidedly incorrect solution; and it is the more likely
 to be solved incorrectly, the less study and practice is indulged in
 by a large part of the corps of officers, and the less this class of
 officers finds in existing regulations as a guide to conduct. When,
 in spite of undeniable progress, we see dispersed attacks and an
 unquestionably incorrect conduct in every maneuver, and this with a
 corps of officers nearly all of whom are professional soldiers, who
 have had the advantage of study and practice, what may we expect
 in war, where the corps of officers will be very largely composed
 of officers of the Reserve and Landwehr, who have but very limited
 opportunities for study and practice, but who, after the very first
 battle, may have to command companies.

   [434] General VON SCHLICHTING, _Taktische und strategische
 Grundsätze der Gegenwart_. See also the essay in the July number of
 _Jahrbücher für Armee und Marine_, 1898.

 General von Scherff,[435] the chief advocate of “united action,” is
 opposed to the “combat with units of command” (_Kommandoeinheiten_)
 briefly sketched above. He makes a distinction between battle-tactics
 and the tactics of detachment warfare. In his opinion, the sum of
 the local successes can by no means gain the victory; that can only
 be done by the united launching of adequate forces at the decisive
 point. “No weapon in the world will ever alter the fact that five
 battalions united in one body have a greater inherent fighting
 power than five separate battalions--not to mention twenty separate
 companies--always provided that a united body of troops is also
 launched as one body.”

   [435] _Kriegslehren in Kriegsgeschichtlichen Beispielen der
 Neuzeit_, I-IV, _Ein Schlachtenangriff_, 1898.


Examples Illustrating the Necessity of a United Attack.

 1. The 26th Infantry Brigade was alarmed and put in march toward the
 battlefield to support the advance guard brigade of the VIIth Army
 Corps, engaged at =Colombey=. The commander of the 26th Infantry
 Brigade received orders from the commanding general to engage. It
 was not necessary for the brigade to provide its own reserve as the
 25th Brigade had been directed to concentrate between Marsilly and
 Colligny, and to be at the disposal of the corps commander. The
 troops already engaged were in a critical situation; their moral and
 physical energy was exhausted. It is only too patent that the first
 battalion (1st Battalion, 13th Infantry) appearing on the scene was
 thrown into the fight to afford at least temporary relief, but this
 insufficient reinforcement was involved in the general failure. After
 about a quarter of an hour, the 25th Brigade (the IIIrd Battallion,
 73rd Infantry had remained in bivouac at Pange) was concentrating
 for action at Coincy, but, instead of its making a united attack,
 only the 1st Battalion of the 73rd Infantry was launched. This
 battalion did, indeed, penetrate into the “Tannenwäldchen” at the
 “Todten-Allee”, but was then surrounded on three sides, had to fall
 back with considerable losses, prevented the further advance of the
 IInd Battallion of the 73rd Infantry, and rallied on the Füsilier
 Battalion of the 13th Infantry, on the bank of the Vallières brook.
 “Although the General Staff account of the war is silent on this
 subject, we are justified in assuming that only the presence of the
 brigade commander, who had learned a lesson from the second local
 assault, prevented the Füsilier Battalion of the 13th Infantry from
 making a fourth isolated effort. After re-forming the organizations,
 the new attack, which was made with indomitable spirit, proceeded
 more in connection with that of three other battalions advancing on
 the same line, and this united advance was closely followed by a
 second echelon consisting of the last battalion of the brigade (the
 IInd Battalion of the 13th Infantry), which had arrived just in time.
 The result was that the enemy was completely routed.”[436]

   [436] _Gen. St. W._, I, p. 470. VON SCHERFF, _Kriegslehren_, I, p.
 41, et seq.

 2. At the Gorze-Rezonville road, on August 16th, 1870, the isolated
 attacks made against Hill 970 by eight battalions, belonging to three
 different brigades, likewise accomplished nothing, whereas, had a
 higher commander been present, a united attack launched by him would
 undoubtedly have been successful.[437]

   [437] _Gen. St. W._, I, p. 631. VON SCHERFF, _Kriegslehren_, II, p.
 271. KUNZ, _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, 8/9, p. 128, et seq.

 3. The well executed attack made against the hill west of the suburb
 of =St. Martin=, on January 19th, 1871, by six battalions of the 29th
 Infantry Brigade shows the importance of the united launching of a
 large body of massed infantry. The engagement of the 16th Infantry
 Division, in particular the attack made on =Grugies= (battle of =St.
 Quentin=) is the antithesis of the above-mentioned attack. Although
 the situation did not necessitate the simultaneous launching of the
 available forces, the brigade attacked in driblets. The attack made
 by these fractions, launched one after another, was not able to
 bring about a decision. In the first place, at about 11 A. M., three
 companies (5th, 6th, and 7th of the 69th Infantry), soon afterwards
 supported by the 8th Company of the 29th Infantry, and the 8th
 Company of the 69th Infantry, attacked the French position at the
 railway embankment and cut. The Prussian troops fought with great
 gallantry, the 5th, 6th and 7th Companies of the 69th Infantry making
 four attacks, and the other two companies, three. Although these
 five companies succeeded in gaining temporary successes, they lacked
 a common commander, and were supported from the rear only when they
 were thrown back after fighting for three-quarters of an hour.

 About noon, the four companies of the Ist Battalion, 29th Infantry,
 were brought up, but did not engage until the first line had been
 forced back and the 5th, 6th, and 7th Companies of the 69th Infantry,
 at any rate, were out of action for the time being. Incidentally,
 it may be mentioned that the Ist Battalion of the 29th Infantry
 attacked in three groups, the strongest of which consisted of 2-l/2
 companies, the weakest of only half a company. Only the strongest
 of these groups scored a success, and the Ist Battalion of the 29th
 Infantry was completely routed after a bloody fight. The 9th and 10th
 Companies, 29th Infantry, did not arrive on the battlefield until
 after the companies of the Ist Battalion of this regiment, whose
 heroic fight cannot be sufficiently praised, had ceased to exist as
 tactical units.

 At 12:30 P. M., the 3rd and 4th Companies of the 70th Infantry
 were brought up and threw back the French, but were in their turn
 defeated. At this moment the 10th and 11th Companies of the 40th
 Infantry arrived; these companies were also able to advance, but
 their success was a temporary one only.

 At 1:30 P. M., the IInd Battalion of the 40th Infantry appeared,
 threw the French back, but was soon attacked by superior forces and
 suffered the same fate as its predecessors.

 At 2:30 P. M., the Füsilier Battalion of the 70th Infantry and the
 9th and 12th Companies of the 40th Infantry were brought forward, but
 only the former engaged seriously at once--again without success.
 A little while later, the 9th and 12th Companies, 40th Infantry,
 advanced energetically. At about 3:30 P. M., the French made a very
 strong counter-attack; all that had been gained seemed about to
 be lost again, when the decision was finally brought about by the
 vigorous action of the 41st Infantry and a charge made by Reserve
 Dragoons.

 The capture of Grugies, of the sugar mill, and, a little later, of
 Gauchy, now followed.

 The resistance of the French was broken. General von Barnekow
 had thus, apparently, gained his object; but at what a price? In
 this engagement, the launching of troops in driblets may be very
 accurately followed:

 1. At 11 A. M., five companies were launched in two separate groups
 (5th, 6th, and 7th Companies, 69th Infantry--8th Company, 29th
 Infantry and 8th Company, 69th Infantry);

 2. Toward noon, four fresh companies (1st Battalion, 29th Infantry)
 were also launched in separate groups;

 3. A little later, two fresh companies were put in (9th and 10th
 Companies, 29th Infantry);

 4. At 12:30 P. M., two fresh companies were launched (3rd and 4th
 Companies, 70th Infantry);

 5. A little later, the 10th and 11th Companies, 40th Infantry, were
 pushed in;

 6. About 1:30 P. M., the IInd Battalion, 40th Infantry, was brought
 up;

 7. About 2:30 P. M., the Füsilier Battalion, 70th Infantry, and the
 9th and 12th Companies, 40th Infantry, advanced.

 Thus, between 11 A. M. and 2:30 P. M., General von Barnekow gradually
 drew into the fight twenty-five companies, in seven different
 detachments, from the reserve formed by the 16th Infantry Division
 at Essigny le Grand. Besides, the troops generally did not appear on
 the battlefield until the energy of the troops already engaged was
 exhausted.[438]

   [438] KUNZ, _Nordarmee_, II, pp. 135 and 212.

 Moreover, the retreat of the several detachments was not a voluntary
 one, for the French, thanks to their great superiority, generally
 forced them to retire. This engagement thus presents a series of
 partial successes, which became reverses, however, in a very short
 time.

 _Launching reinforcements in driblets increased the numbers required
 beyond all reasonable bounds, produced heavy losses, and involved
 the weak reinforcements, which arrived successively, in disaster,
 without turning the tide of the battle. Decisive victories can only
 be brought about by simultaneously launching masses._

 “The system of close order battalion tactics was no longer
 practicable under Chassepot fire, and everyone promptly went to the
 opposite extreme of extended order, company column tactics, with
 which all were sufficiently familiar, since it had been carefully
 practiced in minor field exercises in time of peace.” (The attack
 made by the 26th Infantry Brigade against =Schlosz Aubigny=, August
 14th, 1870[439])

   [439] _Gen. St. W._, I, p. 466; VON SCHERFF, _Kriegslehren_, I, p.
 16; VON MALACHOWSKI, _Scharfe Taktik und Revue-Taktik_, p. 18. This
 example is the more instructive, as both advocates of these opposing
 views show how, in their opinion, the attack should have been made.
 The same attack is, moreover, treated in _Militär-Wochenblatt_,
 1901, Numbers 41 and 42, under the title _Selbständigkeit und
 Auftragsverfahren_.

 There is always danger that unity of action will be sacrificed by the
 continued assignment of individual tasks; that the leader will not
 be able to count with confidence on the initiative of subordinate
 leaders restoring this unity, and “that, in the end, no higher
 commander will any longer have the assurance that his wishes will
 be carried out.” The battles around Metz during August, 1870, show
 a tendency on the part of the infantry to leave behind, in reserve
 and in rallying positions, parts of the troops launched to perform a
 certain combat task, “to detach parts to maintain communication (very
 often not at all endangered) with neighboring detachments”, and to
 despatch others to a distance to cover a flank, or to make a wide
 turning movement for the purpose of enveloping the enemy’s flank.

 To prevent a battle from degenerating into a number of disconnected,
 local combats, and to ensure that the enemy will be actually
 subjected to the fire of as many rifles as the supreme commander
 intended, General von Scherff proposes that the battle formation,
 consisting of several echelons separated by fixed distances, be taken
 up outside of the zone of hostile fire, and that these echelons
 then advance simultaneously and as uninterruptedly as possible upon
 the enemy. In this movement the terrain is to be taken advantage of
 only so far as the orders permit. In view of the flat trajectory of
 the modern rifle, he concedes that fire while in motion, formerly
 considered permissible by him at long and medium ranges, may be
 replaced by an advance by rushes of the firing line, alternating
 with firing in a prone position, the ammunition to be expended at
 each halt being fixed by the officer charged with fire direction.
 He moreover considers it necessary to have a main firing position,
 located approximately at the outer limit of short ranges, for the
 purpose of gaining the superiority of fire. Base units must be
 designated in order to prevent weak detachments from encountering the
 enemy single-handed. Moreover, he intends to keep the advance going
 by increasing the fire, and by detailed and definite orders providing
 for the constant reinforcement of the firing line by men of the
 steadily following supports and reserves. Further, since according to
 his proposal, a halt by the rear echelons of an attack that has once
 been launched, is excluded on principle, it follows of necessity,
 that, for the fire effect of the firing line at the really decisive
 ranges, there can remain only a very brief period of time, measurable
 in minutes, which is amply sufficient, in his opinion, for the object
 to be accomplished.

 It is charged that General von Scherff’s proposal[440] (see p. 205
 supra) favors a set scheme for conducting every fight. This is not
 true; there is quite a difference between “more definitely regulating
 the conduct of an attack”, aimed at by the author of _Kriegslehren_,
 and the formulation of a normal procedure.

   [440] The 10th Supplement of the _Internationale Revue_ 1900, gives
 General von Scherff’s ideas on the infantry attack. See also his
 _Reglementarische Studien_, p. 58, and _Ein Schlachtenangriff_, p.
 102. _Vergleichender Rückblick auf die neueste Tagesliteratur über
 den Infanterieangriff_, 1906.

 “Where a number of individuals are to coöperate for the purpose of
 performing a certain task, the nature of the case requires that
 each one be able to picture to himself beforehand the nature of the
 task, so that his share in it will appear clear and definite. Each
 one must know what he is to do, when and where he should engage,
 what his role is to be, etc. etc., or the result will be hopeless
 confusion.”--“The drill regulations must supply this picture and the
 drill-ground is the place where its general forms should be impressed
 upon every individual participating in the performance of a task.”
 Experience has taught us that this image of the drill-ground becomes
 distorted in war through influences which have almost never permitted
 it to appear on the battlefield in its true form. The initiative of
 subordinate leaders should overcome the obstacles which stand in the
 way of a realization of this ideal image.

 =The system of tactical missions= reckons with the sum-total of local
 successes, assigns tasks to the different units of command, and
 leaves to the latter the choice of the means, without restricting
 their independence. The course of the combat can be influenced only
 by the action of retained forces, and it is sought to produce united
 action by acquainting all leaders with the object of the combat, they
 in turn endeavoring to attain this object even though they do so in
 different ways.

 =The system of united action= seeks to ensure victory by
 simultaneously placing in readiness all the forces intended for
 the general combat, by an orderly concentration for action, and by
 launching the troops at one and the same time, without, however,
 requiring all parts of the force to employ the same formations. This
 system dictates to the leader the number of troops he should launch.
 Since in action everything is ordered as necessity therefor arises,
 the result is that the leader loses sight of the general action in
 view of the great number of separate orders that must be issued.

 In the system of tactical missions, there is danger of arbitrary
 action on the part of subordinates, and of dispersion; moreover,
 it is not always easy to deploy strong firing lines, and there is
 an increased tendency to overestimate the value of cover and, in
 consequence, to overstep the assigned frontage.

 The system of united action is open to the objection that initiative
 of the individual disappears and that the rules laid down in drill
 regulations degenerate into a pattern devoid of all spirit.

 In =Austria= (1906), Captain Wachtel[441] suggests that, when a
 decision is not sought, an attack in groups be made, and that, when a
 decision is sought, a united attack be made. In =Switzerland=, Major
 Sonderegger[442] advocates a procedure based on that of General von
 Scherff.

   [441] _Gruppen- und Einheitsangriff_.

   [442] _Der ungebremste Infanterieangriff_, 1906.

 The initiative of the individual should carry the troops over
 difficulties occasioned by the terrain or the enemy. Such checks
 occur most frequently from the time a force enters the zone of
 effective hostile fire until the assault has been decided upon. In
 the author’s opinion, the individualized attack is a concession made,
 at the expense of united action, for the purpose of making the attack
 succeed at all.




XI. THE DEFENSE.[443]

   [443] _Taktik_, V, p. 308. HOPPENSTEDT, _Taktisches Handbuch für
 den Infanterieoffizier_, p. 30.


The invariable guiding principle in defense is to make the most
profitable use of fire. This principle governs in the selection of a
position and in strengthening it artificially.

The defender’s object may be--

1. =Temporary occupation= of a piece of ground;

2. =Purely passive defense=, outpost, rear guard, and delaying actions;

3. =Offensive-defensive action=, _i.e._, to bring about a decision by
combining the offensive with the defensive.

In fortress warfare, situations may arise which may make it necessary
to hold a piece of ground obstinately, without it being possible to
assume the offensive. In the French, Russian, and Italian regulations,
only the offensive-defensive is considered. The Italians see in the
defensive nothing but a preparation for the offensive; the Russians
seek to shake the enemy with fire in defense, so that they can
subsequently assume the offensive.

The defensive is dependent upon the terrain, and is subject to the
condition that the locality where the tactical situation requires
a stand to be made offers a position favorable for employing fire
to good advantage, and that the opponent actually attacks where the
defender expects him. The employment of the defensive is restricted
by its dependence on the ground and on the measures of the enemy. Its
employment may frequently be explained by the fact that one of the
contending parties allows itself to be checked to such an extent by the
initiative of the other that it can only offer a passive resistance.
Such passive resistance may here and there score a success by chance
(Plevna, St. Privat), but, as a rule, only the assailant reaps a
benefit from such situations.


1. THE PASSIVE DEFENSE

seeks to avoid a decision, and must therefore endeavor, by opening fire
at an early moment, to prevent the enemy from reaching short ranges.
(See p. 147 supra). It is not absolutely necessary to have a clear
field of fire or strong reserves, but the latter, kept a considerable
distance in rear, must be strong enough to enable the force to
disengage itself from the enemy.

Since only a temporary resistance is to be made, it is permissible for
the force to cover a greater front. The defender should endeavor to
compensate for his numerical inferiority by expending a large amount of
ammunition and by employing machine guns. It is an advantage to have
obstacles in front of the position and cover in rear of it, because the
former retard the enemy’s advance and the latter shelters the troops
from his fire in case of a retreat.


2. THE DEFENSE SEEKING A DECISION.[444]

   [444] During the attack on the large work at Gorni Dubniac, the
 Finnland Regiment was unable to advance from its last position, only
 70-100 paces distant from the enemy, over the foreground swept by
 grazing fire. Several attempted assaults were repulsed.

Decisive results can only be obtained at short and medium ranges. Long
range fire may, indeed, inflict losses on the enemy and delay his
advance, but it cannot repulse him. (See p. 148 supra).

It is not sufficient merely to ward off the attack with fire; the
offensive must be assumed. When this is not done, the assailant can
repair his losses and try another attack. When the defender has
repulsed the enemy, he should follow up this success with an attack.
However, as he will rarely be able to do this with the force at his
disposal, fresh troops will be required. (Beaune la Rolande, Lisaine).
The change from the tactical defensive to the offensive offers the same
difficulties as the corresponding strategical move; but, in the former
case, there is present, in addition, the element of danger and the
difficulty of perceiving the right moment.[445]

   [445] _Taktik_, V, p. 320. Compare this with Benedeck’s hesitation
 at Königgrätz.

A position is of value only when it compels the enemy to attack,
directs his movements into definite channels, and induces him to make
wide turning movements, which cause him to lose time and produce
favorable conditions for the assumption of the offensive on the part
of the defender. Every position that enables the defender to use all
his weapons, and does not deter the enemy from making an attack, is
suitable for this purpose.

“By placing our troops in an unassailable position, we actually refuse
battle and force the enemy to seek the decision in another manner.
* * * A defensive position approaches its ideal to the extent that
its strength is hidden and opportunity is offered of surprising the
enemy by our tactical combinations. One should endeavor to conceal
the advantages which one intends to derive from the formation of the
ground, just as one hides from the enemy the bulk of one’s troops and
their actual position. This is, indeed, only practicable to a certain
extent, and requires perhaps a peculiar and little used method of
treatment.”[446]

   [446] CLAUSEWITZ, _On War_, VI, 12 (_Militär-Klassiker_, p.
 364). The Boers were masters of the art of concealing defensive
 positions. At Colenso, on the Modder River, and at Magersfontain,
 their positions were located in places where neither the British
 artillerists nor the reconnoitering detachments suspected them to be.

Modern firearms make the defense so strong in front that it suffices to
hold this part of the position with a weak force supplied with plenty
of ammunition, and provided with weak supports, at a few points, to
replace losses. As these supports have a definite task to perform, they
are posted as near the first line as the available cover permits, in
order to cut down the distance to be traversed by them under fire.
When practicable, they are intrenched within the firing line itself. As
it is advisable to supply these troops with a great deal of ammunition,
some of the ammunition wagons belonging to the battalions held in
reserve may be turned over to them. The general reserve intended for
offensive action should be kept far in rear of the line. When kept too
close to the first line, the defender will be unable to move it to any
point desired, after the direction of the attack becomes apparent.
The defender should examine his position from the point of view of
the attacker, and ask himself, “_With how weak a force may I occupy
the position and still obtain the frontal strength described in the
regulations, and how strong can I make the general reserve so as to
bring about a decision?_”

At some parts of the position, an attack will have good prospects of
succeeding, at others it would encounter difficulties, and, finally,
at others it could not possibly succeed. While many troops are needed
in the first-mentioned portions (sections), comparatively few troops
will suffice to hold those sections which are less favorable for
the attacker (on account of their free field of fire, obstacles,
and the absence of artillery positions in which the attacker can
place his guns). This leads to a division of the defensive position
into sections, each forming a separate unit of command (battalion
or company) and, when necessary, detailing its own reserve (section
reserve). When the frontage of the sections, as determined by the
above-mentioned examination of the position, is considerable, or when
obstacles lie within the position, a further subdivision may become
necessary. This does not imply that the position must be held in
equal strength all along the line; portions of the line that are very
difficult to attack need only be kept under observation. Gaps in the
defensive line are, as a rule, of very little value to the assailant,
as the defender will frequently be able to sweep the space in front of
them from a flank. “In order to keep all parts of the foreground under
observation, and to prevent portions of the hostile force from escaping
the defender’s fire, a division of the foreground corresponding to the
division into sections must be made when necessary.” (Par. 403 German
I. D. R.).

Weak points, _i.e._, points against which the assailant can suddenly
mass superior forces at short range, or in the defense of which a
coöperation of infantry and artillery is impossible, must be specially
strengthened: by obstacles; provision for flanking the hostile advance;
and preparation of supporting points in rear of the position. In
addition, such weak points must be occupied with a strong garrison, by
employing two firing lines, one above the other; reserves; and machine
guns.

Enclosed farm yards (Point du Jour, on August 18th, 1870), and small
patches of timber, are best not occupied at all; they are far more
valuable as sham defenses in that they draw the fire of the assailant.
At any rate, it is a question whether, at the last moment, when the
hostile assault must be warded off, it will be possible to occupy such
points.

As a general rule, only a single defensive position, consisting of an
infantry and an artillery line, is selected.

 The Russians invariably posted strong advanced detachments in front
 of their main defensive positions. As a result, the most serious
 fights usually occurred in the positions taken up by these advanced
 troops.[447] At =Haicheng=, for example, a strong main position had
 been prepared, in which a stand was to be made. In spite of this,
 the IInd Siberian Corps was left in a strongly fortified advanced
 position west of =Simutcheng=. This corps, in its turn, fortified two
 lines of advanced positions far in its front.

   [447] LÖFFLER, _Russisch-japanischer Krieg_, I, p. 109. See
 _Taktik_, V, p. 305, in regard to the numerous positions in the
 valley of the Shaho.

 “Thus, on July 31, 1904, only seven battalions of this corps finally
 fought at =Daputsi= and =Liadapu=. When they were thrown back by
 superior forces, the mistake was made of bringing up fresh troops
 to regain the position captured by the enemy. These troops arrived
 too late and had to make a difficult attack on the Japanese, who
 had already occupied the captured position. Naturally their frontal
 attack accomplished nothing.

 “The force thus suffered a defeat needlessly, and, although the
 defensive had been decided upon, a lot of men were sacrificed in an
 attempt to retake an advanced position that had been captured by the
 enemy. The corps evacuated its strong position without a fight when
 its line of retreat was endangered by Mistshenko’s being forced back.
 The Russians likewise evacuated their main position at Haicheng when
 news was received that strong hostile forces were advancing against
 the left flank of the position.”[448]

   [448] See _Kriegsgeschichtliche Einzelschriften_, 41/42, p. 49.

As a rule, it is not advisable to occupy =advanced positions=,[449]
_i.e._, positions lying within effective range of the main position.
Supporting points immediately in front of the main position, projecting
from it like caponiers, and flanking the ground over which the
assailant will have to make his attack, must not be confounded with
these advanced positions. St. Hubert and St. Marie aux Chênes, on
the battlefield of Gravelotte are good examples of both classes of
positions. In order to gain time, a commander may sometimes find it
advantageous to occupy and temporarily defend advanced positions lying
still farther to the front. (Lisaine, and Shaho). In doing this,
favorable terrain (Chavannes on the Lisaine) and skillful leadership
are essential.

   [449] _Taktik_, V, p. 270, et seq. No objection can be made to
 the contemplated construction of advanced positions in front of
 the Shaho position, as the Russians desired to gain time for the
 offensive movement to be made by their left wing. The uncertainty
 and hesitation produced by the constant changes in orders, and the
 excessive reinforcement of the advanced detachments, which allowed
 themselves to be led into making a stubborn defense, was fatal.

 In =France= and =Russia= much is expected of advanced positions.
 In =England= particular importance is attached to them when they
 draw the enemy in a direction facilitating the conduct of a
 counter-attack. The British consider that supporting points lying in
 front of the position had best be left unoccupied, unless they can be
 supported by artillery fire from the main position.

 “Smokeless powder and the great range of modern firearms will
 frequently make reconnaissance so difficult that it will be possible
 to gain an approximate idea of the enemy’s strength only by a fight.
 For this reason, in situations similar to that existing west of
 Belfort, in January 1871, advanced detachments, whose mission it is
 to deceive the enemy as to the defender’s strength, and to compel
 him to deploy, will have a greater justification now than at that
 time. Nowadays, such detachments may cover a considerable front
 without danger, especially when they are plentifully supplied with
 ammunition. This will make it still more easy to deceive the enemy,
 and a skillful defender will know how to make the most of it.”[450]

   [450] _Studien zur Kriegsgeschichte und Taktik_, II, p. 237.

Advanced positions[451] are apt to mask the fire from the main
position, and fights for their possession may easily lead to the defeat
of the troops holding them. The danger of the fight taking place and
being decided in the advanced position must be reckoned with. (Battles
of Ligny and on the Hallue). On the other hand, it may be advantageous
to employ scouting detachments, cyclists, and machine guns, and to
construct dummy intrenchments in front of the main position. (Par. 407
German I. D. R.). The French, more than anyone else, are convinced of
the advantages to be derived from an employment of advanced positions
(for example in deceiving the enemy as to the location of the main
position). In a deliberately planned concentration and advance into
action, such positions are, however, so effectively enveloped that
they do not come into play at all and fall an easy prey to the enemy.
However, we do not wish to deny their occasional usefulness in
cases where it is necessary to gain time for concentration and for
strengthening the main position. In fights for their possession, an
idea may frequently be gained of the intentions and dispositions of the
assailant. Moreover, they offer opportunities for surprising the enemy
with fire, and induce him to make premature attacks and to mass his
troops in the ones he has captured.

   [451] Par. 21 German _Manual of Field Engineering_: “Their use is
 principally restricted to special cases in fortress warfare.”

Next to a free field of fire (clearing the foreground, and ascertaining
ranges), the determining factors in selecting a position are elbow room
in and in rear of the position, supporting points for the flanks, and
cover. The natural cover available on the ground is made use of as best
suits the purpose of the action.

The line in which the artillery intends to fight the decisive action
constitutes the “framework” of the position. Although artillery will
rarely be able to perform all its tasks in a single position, its first
position is selected with due regard to the position of the hostile
artillery. The most important position is that from which the hostile
infantry attack is to be repulsed. This should be selected far enough
in front of the artillery to enable the latter to fire over it, and to
deprive the assailant’s artillery of the opportunity of hitting the
defender’s infantry and artillery at one and the same time. (Par. 401
German I. D. R.). A distance of 600 m. between infantry and artillery
is considered sufficient for this purpose. In view of the protection
afforded by gun shields against infantry fire, it is scarcely necessary
to post skirmish lines in advance of the artillery. But, where the
infantry line is not continuous in front of the artillery, troops
should be posted, so as to protect the artillery personnel from
being annoyed by hostile patrols. It will seldom be possible for a
commander to do justice to the requirements of both arms; in every
compromise, one or the other arm is only too apt to be placed at a
disadvantage. The needs of the infantry, whose choice of a position is
more restricted, take precedence. While infantry can govern its action
by that of the artillery during the preparatory stage of an attack,
this is impossible in defense, as the infantry is obliged to carry the
fight through to its logical conclusion in the position in which it is
begun.[452]

   [452] As the artillery is less restricted in the choice of
 positions, and as the final outcome of the fight depends, after all,
 on the outcome of the infantry action, the demands of the infantry,
 contrary to par. 292 German I. D. R., must be considered in the first
 place.


3. FORTIFYING THE POSITION.[453]

   [453] Germany: _Manual of Field Engineering_, 1905. France:
 _Instruction pratique sur les travaux de campagne_ (December 24th,
 1906). England: _Manual of Military Engineering_, 1905. Russia:
 _Mitteilungen vom Ingenieur Comité_, No. 41 (1906). The Austrian and
 Italian regulations are undergoing revision.

The apprehensions formerly entertained in regard to prematurely
fortifying a position, and which are still shared by the French
regulations, are no longer to be found in the new regulations. The
construction of field fortifications requires time, if they are to be
of value, and if they are to give leaders and troops the assurance
that they can be defended by the minimum number of men.[454] Even
intrenchments that have been constructed in vain will frequently prove
useful in deceiving the enemy. In many cases, it will be necessary to
be prepared to meet a hostile attack made from several directions. This
contingency should be taken into account by at least preparing for the
work beforehand.

   [454] At 10 A. M., on August 18th, 1870. General Canrobert received
 orders to place St. Privat in a state of defense. At 11 A. M., the
 first reports of the approach of the Prussian Guard were received,
 and at 4 P. M., Ste. Marie aux Chênes was in German hands. Hence,
 only five hours were available for these preparations for defense.

“If the situation turns out to be different than was expected, the
intrenchments already constructed should not influence the decisions
of the commander. On the other hand, the consideration that the works
might be built unnecessarily must not cause their construction to be
omitted altogether.” (Par. 311 German I. D. R.).

 In the preface to the French regulations, it is emphasized that
 intrenching a position ought neither to impair the spirit of the
 offensive nor hamper the movement to the front. “Intrenchments are
 a means to an end, but not the end itself. They should only be used
 when no violence is done thereby to the tactical situation, and one
 should never hesitate, for a single moment, to abandon them, if the
 situation requires, or to construct others, at another place, if it
 becomes necessary.” The men should therefore be trained in handling
 the portable intrenching tools, until they can use them skillfully in
 any position of the body.

 “The use of intrenchments may also be abused. To remain inertly
 in a place is just as fatal as to advance without making use of
 cover. When temporary halts are made, the commander for the time
 being, often placed in that position by chance (_chef du moment,
 chef d’unité ou chef de groupe éventuel_), indicates whether or not
 intrenchments are to be constructed.”

 Battle intrenchments are to protect the soldier against hostile
 fire, without hampering him in using his rifle. “They are one of
 the factors which ensure economy in men, in that they save a body
 of troops from suffering unnecessary losses. But their importance
 always recedes before the general requirements of an action, and they
 should never in any way interfere with the advance of troops; on the
 contrary, intrenchments are to make it possible to bring troops
 within effective range of the enemy, without impairing their physical
 condition or their morale.”

Intrenchments enable a commander to save troops, which he can use
offensively at the decisive point. They do not fulfill the object
for which they were intended, when they make it easier for the enemy
to pick out the position. “Works which cannot be perceived from the
foreground even through powerful field glasses, afford the most
effective protection against artillery fire.” Trenches should therefore
be deep, have a low parapet, and be properly masked.

The commander indicates when work is to begin. Every unit must intrench
the portion of the defensive line which it is to defend; working
parties, specially detailed from troops not intended for the immediate
defense of the position, can be counted on only when extensive works
are to be constructed.

Continuous lines of trenches are seldom built; it suffices to construct
a line of works with intervals, _i.e._, battalion groups, the intervals
being simply held by a weak force.

These battalion groups (par. 24 German Manual of Field Engineering)
are constructed without regard to any fixed form, as the tactical
employment of the companies requires. They consist of firing trenches
(flanks refused and echelons in rear of the wings), provided with
splinter proofs, and adequate cover trenches, so that all the men, if
possible, will be sheltered from artillery fire.

The aim is, first of all, to construct inconspicuous standing firing
trenches. These should have low parapets and be provided with numerous
traverses to restrict the effect of high explosive shell. In order
that these traverses may not betray the location of the position, they
should not rise above the parapet.[455]

   [455] These traverses afford very little shelter against enfilading
 fire; it is advisable to keep sand bags in readiness as a protection
 in case such fire is received.

Deep, narrow trenches afford the best protection against artillery
fire (the trench should be about 0.60 m. wide at the bottom). Narrow
trenches are especially difficult to pick out from a balloon. In
constructing trenches having no parapet at all, special precautions
must be taken in order that their location may not be betrayed by the
scattered earth or by their rear wall, which will be visible when they
are located on the slope facing the enemy. When the trenches are to
be held for some time, provision must be made for the construction
of splinter proofs,[456] other overhead cover, and loopholes of
observation.

   [456] These lie about 0.50 m. below the natural surface of the
 ground and accommodate 5-6 men: they are separated from each other by
 an earth wall 1 m. thick.

Numerous light splinter proofs are generally to be preferred to a
few larger and stronger ones, as they afford sufficient protection
against shrapnel bullets and fragments. They may be protected against
direct hits from field guns, or other guns having a flat trajectory,
by sloping their roofs to the rear at an angle as nearly as possible
coincident with the angle of fall of those projectiles.

Since field intrenchments are incapable of furnishing protection
against direct hits from guns having a curved trajectory, this object
must be attained by skillfully distributing splinter proofs along the
front. These should be inconspicuous and should not take up too much
room. The comfort of the troops in the trenches should also be provided
for by constructing kitchens, latrines, drainage ditches, and dressing
stations.

In addition, field magazines for storing ammunition should be built,
and alarm arrangements made. Moreover, covered communication should be
provided along the line and to the rear. The front and gaps in the line
may be very effectively flanked by fire from skillfully constructed
refused wings.

In constructing a battalion group of intrenchments, provision will have
to be made, in addition, for the following:

[Illustration: Intrenchments for a Battalion.]

[Illustration: Firing Trench with Cover Trench.]

[Illustration: Firing Trench with Splinter Proofs.]

[Illustration: Profiles.]

[Illustration: Firing Trench in ordinary soil.]

[Illustration: Splinter Proof.]

[Illustration: Communicating Trench.]

[Illustration: Communicating Trench without Parapet.]

[Illustration: Machine Gun Pit.]

1. =Observation of the foreground=, “for the purpose of reconnaissance
and security, as well as for noting the effect of one’s own fire.” In
order that observers may not betray the location of the position, it
is recommended that they be posted at inconspicuous points affording
a sufficiently extended view, and screened from the observation of
the enemy. When they have to be posted in the defensive line, the
terreplein is either lowered in places, so that they can just look over
the parapet, or special observation stations are constructed. Provision
must be made for communication between the several parts of the line
and with the next higher headquarters.

2. =Clearing the foreground.= As a rule, it will be practicable to
employ for this work troops not needed in digging trenches. As time
is lacking in field warfare for extensive work, such as cutting down
embankments and removing dead angles, one will have to be content with
trampling down or burning standing grain, removing objects which the
enemy might use as aiming points, and cutting clearings through woods.
It is not advisable to demolish stone walls and houses, as the debris
is difficult to remove and affords cover to the enemy.

3. =Dummy intrenchments and masks.=[457] These are to deceive the
assailant as to the position and extent of the defensive works.
They should not be located in the same fire swept zone as the
defensive works themselves, and at a distance should look like real
fortifications. Masks are to screen defensive works or troops, without
restricting the fire of the latter. Natural features are best suited
for this purpose, but may be replaced or supplemented by artificial
masks.

   [457] _Taktik_, V, p. 291. At Magersfontain, the Boers constructed
 dummy trenches on the crest, while the trenches actually held by them
 were located at the foot of the slope. The result is well known.

In many cases, it will suffice to place a few skirmishers behind a
parapet that has been hastily thrown up with a plow.

4. =Cover trenches and communicating trenches.= These constitute a
considerable portion of the defensive works. Communicating trenches
may be either covered ways or zigzags, and connect the cover trenches
with the firing trenches. Sortie steps should be provided in order to
facilitate a prompt advance from the trenches. In many cases, it is
impossible to avoid placing firing and cover trenches so close to each
other that the enemy’s shells can strike both simultaneously.

5. =Obstacles.= These need only be constructed when two forces confront
each other for a protracted period. The purpose of obstacles is to hold
the enemy where he will be exposed to the most deadly fire; retard his
advance; compel him to confine his movements to certain avenues of
approach (this is especially valuable in night combats); and eliminate
dead angles in front of the position. The presence of extensive
obstacles forces the enemy to advance systematically. As a rule, they
can only be removed by pioneers. They should not be located too near
the position, as they are apt to be damaged by artillery fire directed
at the position, and interfere with the defender’s fire. When they
are too far in front of the position, the defender will not be able
to guard them and prevent their destruction. In general, they should
not be more than 200 m. from the position. It is better to construct
several lines of small obstacles than a single line of large ones. The
requirement that obstacles must not interfere with the defender’s fire,
must not afford the enemy an opportunity to approach under cover, and
must remain intact under hostile artillery fire, is best met by marshy
ground and by wire entanglements. Obstacles should be provided with a
slight glacis in order to prevent artillery fire from destroying them
prematurely. When wire entanglements are too high, they are easily seen
at a distance, and, although they are little damaged by artillery fire,
the attacker can make preparations to remove them.


Russian Views.

 A defensive position consists of an advanced position, a fighting
 line with firing trenches and batteries, supporting points in rear,
 and, finally, a fourth line, which serves as a rallying position.
 The key to a position, which lay formerly in the line of supporting
 points, lies at present in the firing trenches in which supporting
 points must be provided. (Colonel Golenkin advocates the use of
 semi-circular works as supporting points, and Lieutenant-Colonel
 Mordovin large closed works). “These semi-circular works are in
 a sense the anchors by means of which the firing line clings to
 the position which it has occupied.” It does not matter if the
 enemy penetrates the first line and captures one or two of these
 supporting points, for others remain on either side; the latter and
 the second line of supporting points then form a new though somewhat
 indented defensive line. As the attacking force which has penetrated
 into the position, is hemmed in on both sides, it will hardly be able
 to sustain the counter-attack made by the defender’s reserves, and
 its temporary success will turn into defeat. But, in order that this
 may be accomplished, a second line of supporting points is absolutely
 essential. Large closed works of high command, but a smaller number
 than is employed in the first line, are recommended for this purpose.
 According to Russian opinions, several lines of fortifications are
 essential in order to check an enemy who has penetrated the first
 line, and to facilitate the defender’s final retreat in case of
 necessity.

 Particular importance is attached to advanced positions, to positions
 for the reserves, echeloned to the right and left rear of the flanks,
 and, finally, to rallying positions. Advanced positions are either
 to serve “reconnaissance purposes,” by forcing the enemy to an early
 deployment, or to do duty as “caponiers” from which a flanking fire
 may be brought to bear on the foreground.

 Advanced positions, doing duty as “caponiers,” are invariably to
 consist of closed works, those serving “reconnaissance purposes” of
 open works. The latter are to be defended “to the last ditch,” and
 are not to be evacuated until the enemy approaches to about 400 m. or
 less, but the garrison is not to allow itself to become involved in a
 bayonet fight.

 In contrast with this distribution in depth--2 km., in the model
 given--Lieutenant-Colonel Jabel, whose views are based on the same
 experiences, advocates the use of only one line of fortifications. He
 states: “The length of the battles, which sometimes lasted two weeks,
 as well as the terrible intensity of fire in general and artillery
 fire in particular, produced such an absolute nervous exhaustion that
 the decisive action could be fought only in a single line. With its
 capture, further fighting had only small prospects of success * * *”
 “When firing trenches have been constructed at the points where the
 best effect can be obtained from long and short range fire, they
 should not be evacuated prematurely, but held, in order to make the
 most of this fire effect, until the enemy arrives close enough to use
 his bayonets. If the troops holding the trenches retire immediately
 before the bayonet fight, their retreat invariably becomes a rout,
 and, in any case, entails tremendous losses, for, after leaving
 their trenches, they will be helpless and exposed in the open to the
 hostile fire.”


4. THE CONDUCT OF THE DEFENSE.

In his _Tactical Handbook_, Major Hoppenstedt suggests a method,
well meriting attention, for decreasing the effect of artillery fire
on a defensive position. He believes that dummy intrenchments, not
too conspicuously located, partially, but not skillfully masked and
occupied, will deceive the attacker’s artillery for some time, at any
rate, until the advanced troops of the attacker induce the defenders to
man their parapet and expose themselves to shrapnel fire. The “defense
should be conducted in such a manner that the garrison of the main
position will not need to expose itself to the enemy’s artillery fire
as soon as his advanced troops appear.” Major Hoppenstedt believes that
this can be attained, in hill positions, by conducting the fire fight,
at long and medium ranges, from positions in rear, the defender moving
up into the main position, specially prepared for this purpose, when
the attacker disappears in the defiladed spaces in front of it. The
objection to this method is that it necessitates too large a force to
hold the position.

 “In a protracted, obstinate fight, the defender’s trenches,
 exposed to the combined hostile infantry and artillery fire, will
 finally become filled with dead and wounded, and it will rarely
 be practicable to remove them. The arrival of reinforcements will
 increase the confusion and the losses, and the fighting energy of the
 troops will decrease with tremendous rapidity. This is one of the
 greatest disadvantages of the defense as compared with the attack and
 its constantly moving lines.

 “In such cases, which will be typical at points where the attacker
 intends to penetrate the line, it may be a real act of salvation for
 the defender’s firing line to rush to the front.

 “In fighting at short ranges, especially just before the assailant
 makes his assault, such a rush to the front on the part of the
 defender’s line, may be a good move for another reason. As is well
 known, the attacker’s artillery must change targets when its infantry
 arrives within a certain distance of the defender’s position. The
 Germans (par. 446 I. D. R.) fix this point at 300 m. from the enemy,
 and the French, whose guns have a flatter trajectory, fix it at 500
 m. In attacking a hill position, when the fire is well observed, the
 distance of this point from the position will be considerably greater.

 “But, no matter where the actual location of this point may be,
 skillful infantry will start its assault very close to the point
 fixed by the regulations, and never beyond it, so as to avoid
 interfering with the fire of its artillery. Under such circumstances,
 it may be a skillful move for a defender who is still full of fight,
 to decrease the distance which separates him from the hostile
 infantry, in order that, by so doing, he may escape from the hostile
 artillery fire and from the smoke which obscures his vision. If he
 finds cover farther to the front, so much the better, for he will
 then have that much of an advantage over the attacker.”

The weakness of most defensive positions lies in the danger of a sudden
attack being directed against a flank. The assailant will endeavor to
avoid making an attack against the front of a position prepared for
defense, when such an attack has small chances of succeeding, and seek
the decision by attacking a flank, where conditions are, to a certain
extent at least, equalized. The danger of a flank attack increases
with the length of the defensive line. It is by no means a good move
to prolong the threatened wing (French VIth Army Corps at St. Privat)
for the purpose of warding off an envelopment. The power of extension
is bound to reach a limit sooner or later, and the wing attacked will
then be so weak and attenuated that it will not be capable of offering
serious resistance.

To ward off an employment by refusing a flank likewise promises little
success. The enemy’s superiority of fire will make itself felt,
first of all, at the salient thus formed (see p. 357 supra), and his
convergent artillery and infantry fire, which may even enfilade parts
of the line, will paralyze all tactical movements of the defender at
this point.

By prolonging the line and by refusing a flank, we only postpone
the decision a little while, but cannot effectively cope with an
envelopment. This must be accomplished in a different manner.

The best scheme would be to flank the enemy’s enveloping force by
posting an echelon in a suitable position, or to bring about a decision
by employing the reserve offensively. However, for carrying out these
measures, more time is required than for merely refusing a flank. Time
may be gained by making an extensive reconnaissance on the flanks with
strong detachments, and by occupying supporting points lying on the
flanks, which the enemy would have to take before he could think of
attacking the main position.

      *       *       *       *       *

In employing machine guns in defense, it should be borne in mind that
they are unsuited for carrying on protracted fire fights, and that the
mobility of the machine gun batteries cannot be utilized when, from the
very start, they are assigned a section to defend.

In general, it will be advisable in defense to keep the machine
guns at first with the reserve, and to employ them, when necessary,
to reinforce the defensive line at threatened points, to prevent
envelopment, to repulse an assault, or to participate in an offensive
movement.

This does not preclude their coming into action at the very opening of
an engagement, for instance, where it is necessary to command important
avenues of approach.

When a withdrawal under cover is assured, it will also be possible to
post machine gun batteries in such a manner, in front or on a flank of
the main position, that they can bring a sudden fire to bear on the
area in which the opponent will in all probability post his artillery.

Machine gun fire may sometimes be employed to sweep defiladed spaces in
front of the defensive line.

      *       *       *       *       *

If the direction of the hostile attack is known, the occupation of the
position should not be longer deferred. It is always risky to occupy
the position in the face of hostile batteries, especially as the fire
of the defender’s guns is masked by the skirmishers moving forward. If
the defender can manage to give the attacker the impression that the
position is still unoccupied, perhaps thereby inducing him to advance
less cautiously, and then surprise him with fire, a depressing moral
effect far exceeding the material success may be counted upon.[458]
The firing line should be made so strong that the fire fight will
have a chance of succeeding. A gradual launching of the troops should
not be decided upon, as the losses are comparatively insignificant in
defense, and as it is important to develop a heavy fire so as to make
it difficult for the enemy to gain the fire superiority. The principles
governing the moment for opening fire have already been discussed (pp.
147 and 154 supra).

   [458] Engagement at Modder River, on November 28th, 1899.
 Engagement at Colenso, on December 15th, 1899.

The enemy must be prevented from gaining the superiority of fire.
This should be accomplished by concentrating the fire from a large
number of rifles upon the parts of the enemy’s force in motion. The
defender should make the most of the advantage which his preparedness
gives him. The attacker’s firing line with its supports forms the
target. A departure from this rule is in order, in the case of a French
assailant, as the latter places the bulk of his force in the reserves
and not in the firing line. It will frequently be practicable for the
defender to discontinue his fire and to take cover when the assailant
lies down and fires; but, while under cover, everything should be
prepared for resuming the fire when the enemy rises to continue his
advance (p. 156 supra).

If it has been found impossible to prevent the enemy from reaching the
extreme limit of short ranges, the commander must decide whether to
continue the fight until a decision is reached, or whether to break off
the action.

When the opponent has entered the zone of short ranges, it will be too
late for the defender to retire, unless the terrain in rear of the
position is especially favorable, or other troops can take a hand in
the fight to cover the withdrawal. The onrushing assailant is received
with accelerated fire; the defender fixes bayonets, determined to risk
a fight at close quarters. “The defender who does not fix bayonets is
already casting furtive glances towards the best line of retreat.”

While repulsing an assault, it would be a good plan for the defender to
step upon the rear wall of the trench so that the latter would become
an obstacle for the attacker. But this scheme can only be employed when
the troops are completely in hand.

While the fire of the defender is increased to the utmost intensity by
the entrance into the fight of all the supports, the general reserve,
which now takes a hand in the fight, seeks to bring about the decision
by advancing to attack. On arriving close enough to assault, the attack
reaches its most critical stage, and even a counter-attack made by a
comparatively small force may turn the scale in favor of the defense.


5. THE COUNTER-ATTACK.[459]

   [459] See F.C. V. H. _Zum Studium der Taktik_, p. 418 et seq.

In large engagements, the great power of resistance possessed by well
posted bodies of troops will often determine the commander of the
force on the defensive to contain the enemy at one point with a strong
defensive position, while at the same time assuming the offensive at
another. (This was planned, but not carried out, at Dresden, in 1813,
and at Troyes, early in February, 1814; carried out with success, in
Lee’s operations around Richmond, during the latter part of June,
1862, and on the Lisaine in 1871; and miscarried on the Shaho, because
Kuropatkin made his decision dependent upon reports in regard to the
position of hostile reserves, which were non-existent in reality).
Whether the offensive should be assumed while the enemy is still in the
act of deploying,[460] or whether one must be satisfied with assuming
the offensive at the last moment, is best determined by the relative
strength of the opposing forces. When battle-fronts are short this may
still be advantageous, but when the lines are long, a counter-attack
can affect only a small part of the assailant’s line, while the major
portion thereof successfully pushes the attack home. Then the position
and the day will be lost anyway, in spite of a local success.

   [460] Roszbach, 1758; Austerlitz. 1805 (_Schlachterfolg_, p. 28);
 Salamanca, 1812.

The initial measures taken assure freedom of action to the defense,
but the commander must not await exhaustive messages. Prompt action
is necessary, either for throwing back the advanced troops of the
assailant, or for striking a blow at the hostile flank. In the latter
case, it is an advantage if only weak reserves are struck, but hostile
forces making a turning movement may also be encountered, and the
commander will have to decide whether to deploy quickly and assail the
enemy, or whether to take his chances in a rencontre.[461]

   [461] The advance of Memerby’s Brigade during the battle of
 Noisseville. KUNZ, _Noisseville_, p. 41.

Even a success gained at a tactically unfavorable point will make
itself felt, if it is won early enough and if the most is made of it.
As a rule, tactical considerations determine where the commander should
launch his reserves for the counter-attack.

The counter-attack here meant is an act of the commander of the whole
force; in bodies of troops acting as part of a larger force and in
numerically inferior forces, the warding off of the flank attack
remains almost always the only remedy.

“The general reserve should be posted at the point from which it can
best move forward, counter to the probable direction of the hostile
attack, while, at the same time, making the most of the features of
the ground. When only one flank is secure, the general reserve is, as
a rule, placed in echelon in rear of the unprotected wing. When both
flanks are in the air, nothing remains but to place sufficient reserves
in readiness in rear of one flank to ward off a hostile envelopment,
while retaining as strong a force as possible in rear of the other
for the purpose of bringing about the decision. The echeloned general
reserve must have room for development, whether this be for warding off
a hostile envelopment or for making a counter-attack.” (Par. 410 German
I. D. R.).

The general reserve should be posted in rear of the center of the
position only when the front is short and the situation is not as yet
cleared up. In this position it will frequently be exposed to the fire
directed against the first line, and its entry into action will usually
involve a loss of time. When adequate information is available of the
measures taken by the opponent, or the nature of the ground compels him
to direct his decisive attack against a wing, this alone determines
the position of the general reserve.

Since the counter-attack is to take the enemy by surprise, the position
of the general reserve must be concealed, and precautions must be taken
to keep hostile patrols in the dark, as long as possible, in regard to
its actual location. The ground over which the general reserve is to
advance should be free from obstacles, so that the counter-attack can
be made rapidly and with uniformity.

Since the assailant will almost invariably endeavor to direct his
attack against a flank, the general reserve of the defender should
be posted at such a distance in rear of the threatened wing that the
troops composing it will be sheltered to some extent from hostile
fire. In order that the fully deployed general reserve, when making
a counter-attack, may clear with its inner flank the outer flank of
the line holding the position, and not get into the latter’s zone
of fire, a sufficient interval must be left between the two. This
interval should increase with the size of the reserve. As a rule, the
counter-attack should be launched so as to produce the decision when
the assailant has arrived within assaulting distance of the defender.
This requires that the general reserve and the line holding the
position be separated by an interval of at least 200 m. In addition,
the counter-attack must be so made that it will actually strike the
assailant in flank; and this it cannot do unless the general reserve is
posted sufficiently far to a flank. The center of the reserve should
be launched so as to strike not only the flank of the enemy’s firing
line, but that of his supports as well. If the general reserve is
posted too near the first line, there is danger of it being enveloped
together with the first line, and committed to purely defensive action
(refusing a flank). On the other hand, if it is posted too far to a
flank, its timely entry into action is not absolutely assured; the
assailant may turn against it, cut it off from the defensive position,
and defeat it in detail. The farther the general reserve is off to a
flank, the more effectively will it strike the enemy in flank, but it
will be correspondingly more difficult to conceal it. The necessity
of pushing the general reserve far to a flank decreases, as the scope
of the attacker’s envelopment of the defensive line increases. It may
frequently be to the defender’s advantage to induce the assailant
to make a far-reaching envelopment, provided the line defending the
position is not placed in an unfavorable tactical situation by so
doing. Since the attacker will probably have detachments echeloned in
rear of his flank, the troops entrusted with the counter-attack must
similarly have an echelon in rear of their exposed flank in order to
protect themselves against a flank attack.

[Illustration]

It is impossible to lay down a fixed, normal strength for the reserve.
This depends upon the strength of the position, and the degree of
resistance the intrenchments are capable of rendering; but, in any
case, the force intended for local defense should be strong enough
to compel the enemy to deploy completely, and prevent his carrying
the defenses before the counter-attack is made. Large quantities of
ammunition and intrenchments capable of rendering effective resistance
must compensate for the shortage of men in warding off the enemy, in
order that the general reserve may be made as strong as possible. The
question, as to how thinly the position must be occupied, and how
strong the general reserve may be made, can only be answered in each
particular case. If the attack made by the general reserve is to
produce any effect, it must not be undertaken with too small a force,
as it could then be checked by weak detachments.

While the general reserve lies in waiting for the enemy, it may either--

1. Remain in a preparatory position, in one or more groups, and deploy
during its forward movement; or

2. Take up the attack formation from the start.

The first method has the advantage, when the space required is small,
of permitting the general reserve to be concealed, and allows changes
to be made in the direction of march and in the dispositions.

The second, although it enables the reserve to advance promptly to the
counter-attack, is rarely suitable, as the reserve in combat formation
is not so easily concealed, as it is more difficult to make changes
in the dispositions and the direction of march, and as this formation
seems only practicable for making an advance in one direction--straight
to the front.

It is of the utmost importance to know when the counter-attack should
be launched. In warding off the enemy by purely frontal action, no
special disadvantages result from prematurely launching the general
reserve; if it enters the action too late, it will still be able to
throw back the assailant who has penetrated into the position. With the
counter-attack it is different; it must take place when the opponent is
under the most effective fire at short range. If the counter-attack is
made prematurely, especially when the reserves and flank echelons of
the attacker have not as yet been used up, the latter, while, indeed,
exposed to the most violent fire of the defender, will be able to
take counter-measures. In that case, two entirely independent actions
may result, and the counter-attack made by the general reserve may be
checked by the retained echelons of the attacker and repulsed by their
fire. When launched prematurely, the counter-attack will not always
repulse the hostile attack; and when launched too late, it may perhaps
still bring about the decision, or avert a defeat, but it will never
produce decisive results.

A counter-attack made after the attacker has penetrated into the
position, and while he is endeavoring to dislodge the garrisons of such
supporting points as still offer resistance, reckons with the fact
that the hitherto victorious assailant, exhausted and in confusion,
will not be a match for a well aimed blow delivered by a considerable
number of troops. However, a defender will scarcely contemplate such
an employment of his general reserve; for him the important thing
is to repulse the attack in front of and not within the position.
Although military history presents comparatively numerous instances of
such _retours offensifs_, this may be explained by the fact that the
counter-attack was launched too late. The weakness of the assailant is
but momentary, and the most must be made of this by advancing against
him promptly by the shortest line. But if the assailant has had time to
re-form and to bring up his batteries, it will usually be too late to
make a counter-attack.

 Aymard’s Division (French), which had penetrated into =Servigny=
 under cover of darkness, but had made no attempt to occupy the town
 systematically or to re-form the disordered troops, was driven out
 again by a counter-attack made by only eleven Prussian companies.[462]

   [462] KUNZ, _Noisseville_, p. 52. _Das Wald- und Ortsgefecht_, p.
 181.

 The numerous counter-attacks made by the French during the battle
 of =Wörth= (for example the counter-attack made by Maire’s Brigade)
 pushed too far forward into the zone of the German artillery
 fire, and did not have the expected success. The well-led French
 counter-attack made by about 1200 men from the south edge of
 the =Niederwald=, was discontinued at a timely moment.[463] The
 well-directed counter-attack made by the 1st Turco Regiment at
 =Wörth=, after the capture of =Elsaszhausen=, was successful and is
 especially instructive.[464] The attack made by General de Sonis for
 the purpose of retaking =Loigny= was undertaken too late and with
 inadequate forces.[465] The same is true of the counter-attack made
 by the 3rd Bavarian Division on =Zella= (4th July, 1866).

   [463] KUNZ, _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, XIII, pp. 75 and 159.

   [464] _Ibid._, XVI, p. 187, et seq.

   [465] HÖNIG, _Volkskrieg_, IV, p. 124.

The French regulations recommend a unique procedure, which may be
successful when employed against an opponent not prepared to meet
it. “Under certain circumstances, counter-attacks may be combined
with retreat maneuvers. The advanced troops should bring the enemy
to a standstill with their fire and compel him to deploy. Then they
should break off the action without becoming involved in a fight at
close quarters. In this manner, the attacker is drawn onto terrain
reconnoitered beforehand, where fresh troops, hidden up to the last
moment, attack him impetuously under favorable conditions at a time
when he is tired and worn out by a long movement.”

The most difficult thing about a counter-attack is to seize the
right moment for launching it. As it is impossible to foretell how
long it will take the enemy to arrive within assaulting distance,
no rule can be laid down as to the proper moment for launching the
counter-attack. The best plan would be to screen the movements of the
reserve, and, as the attacking troops approach, to bring it gradually
up to the point from which it is to move forward. A commander requires
wide practical experience and great force of character to judge the
situation calmly and dispassionately, while fully aware that launching
the counter-attack either too soon or too late may prejudice the
result. There is always danger that the suggestions which reach him
from various quarters may cause him to take half-measures. The stronger
the general reserve and the weaker the force holding the defenses, the
more numerous and urgent will be the requests for support; and he will
not find it easy to resist the temptation to grant these requests and
accordingly weaken the general reserve, which is intended for offensive
action.

We must now consider the question as to whether the counter-attack
should rely on fire action alone, or should resort to the bayonet as
well. The unexpected advance of a large body of troops against a flank
of the enemy will rarely fail to produce an effect. If the enemy does
not yield to fire, it is obvious that an assault will have to be made.
A counter-attack made unexpectedly is, as a rule, successful at the
start; but, if its commander follows up this initial success when not
supported by strong reserves, a reverse may take place resulting in the
defeat of the defender’s entire force.

 A counter-attack made by three companies (9th, 10th, and 11th) of the
 3rd Bavarian Infantry Regiment brought relief to the two batteries
 which had gone into action near =Goury= (battle of =Loigny=). The
 Ist and IInd Battalions, 3rd Infantry, the Ist and IInd Battalions,
 12th Infantry, and the 7th Jäger-Battalion joined in this attack, and
 when the batteries finally followed, the force succeeded in throwing
 back the French battalions immediately opposing it. The twenty-one
 companies now made the mistake of attacking =Ecuillon=, which they
 occupied. The attacking force had traversed about 2000 m., and as
 there were no reserves and flank echelons, the Bavarians were obliged
 to give way before an assault made by seven fresh battalions against
 their unprotected left flank. The mistake of pushing forward too far,
 and the lack of supports in rear of the exposed flank, was bound to
 exact a penalty, as soon as the French were in a position to advance
 on their own account.[466]

   [466] HÖNIG, _Volkskrieg_, IV, p. 43.

 A very instructive episode occurred on August 26th, 1904, near
 =Tsinortun=. Toward noon the Japanese Guard and the 10th Division
 advanced through fields of tall kaoliang for the purpose of
 enveloping the right wing of the IIIrd Siberian Army Corps. The
 commanding general, Lieutenant-General Iwanov, directed the reserve
 (apparently parts of the 3rd East-Siberian Rifle Division) to make a
 counter-attack against the left flank of the Japanese. The Russian
 counter-attack was taken in flank by a brigade of the Guard, which
 followed in rear of the Japanese attacking force, and had to retire.
 The decision was then brought about by the counter-attack made by the
 140th Infantry, which unexpectedly appeared on the left flank of the
 Japanese. The engagement at Tsinortun is moreover of special interest
 as regards the Japanese method of attack.[467]

   [467] LÖFFLER, _Allgemeine Lage_, I, pp. 68 and 69. V. HOEN, _Der
 russisch-japanische Krieg_, in _Organ des militär-wissenschaftlichen
 Vereins_, p. 166. NIESSEL, _Enseignements tactiques_, p. 158.

So far we have only considered the counter-attack made against
the flank of an attacker, and against the front of an enemy who
has victoriously penetrated into a position. The success of a
counter-attack against the enemy’s flank depends primarily on moral
factors; besides, after protracted fighting, supports and reserves in
rear of the flank are frequently lacking, so that the attacker cannot
quickly form an adequate firing front towards a flank.[468]

   [468] Examples of successful counter-attacks against an enemy’s
 flank: Battle of Loigny, on December 2nd, 1870; the counter-attack
 made by 21 companies of the 4th Brigade at Goury (HÖNIG,
 _Volkskrieg_, IV, p. 55), and that made by the Ist Battalion,
 10th Infantry, and the Ist and IIIrd Battalions, 13th Infantry,
 at Goury (_ibid._, p. 41); the flank attack made by Kottwitz’
 Brigade (_ibid._, p. 82, and p. 220 supra); the flank attack made
 by the garrison of Fougeu on the attacking columns of General
 Sonis: the brilliant flank attack made by the IIIrd Battalion, 90th
 Infantry, during the battle of Orleans, on December 4th, 1870 (KUNZ,
 _Orleans_, p. 148); and the counter-attack made by General Bataille
 on the Stiring Wald during the battle of Spicheren. The last-named
 counter-attack is a good model, both as regards conception and
 execution. (_Wald- und Ortsgefecht_, pp. 93 and 96).

Theoretically, a frontal counter-attack, _i.e._, one made straight
to the front from a position, while the assailant is advancing to
the assault on a broad front, ought to offer the least chances of
success, but military history proves the contrary in those cases where
the defender awaited the proper moment. This moment arrives when the
defender clearly perceives that the enormous losses suffered by the
attacker begin to impair the morale of his remaining men. This becomes
apparent through a slackening in the attack, through an uncertainty of
movement, and, finally, through hesitation, the latter being usually
preceded by wavering.[469]

   [469] “The defender will only be able to make a frontal
 counter-attack from his position when he has repulsed the assault and
 has made the most of fire action, or when it is important to drive
 away the enemy who has been brought to a standstill in front of the
 defender’s position. A premature counter-attack may lead to the loss
 of the position.” (Par. 414 German I. D. R.).

The moral effect of a determined counter-attack with cold steel during
the closing moments of an attack will undoubtedly be great. Meckel
says[470]: “Here likewise, it is of the greatest importance to bring
up the supports promptly, so as to increase the volume of fire to the
utmost and to produce that superiority which quite naturally resolves
itself into an offensive movement. The defender who does not fix
bayonets is already casting furtive glances towards the best line of
retreat.”

   [470] _Lehre von der Truppenführung_.

 This “superiority” caused the French to advance from the wood of
 =Elsaszhausen= against the skirmishers of the XIth Army Corps
 appearing at the northern edge of the =Niederwald=. The success they
 met with at the start induced the French to continue their advance,
 and when a reverse occurred subsequently, the wood of Elsaszhausen
 was taken by the Hessians without difficulty.[471]

   [471] KUNZ, _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, XIII, p. 121, et seq.

Although such counter-attacks, directed against the strong firing line
of the attacker and unsupported by the defender’s fire, were frequently
successful in war, this was due to the moral effect produced on the
attacker by the sudden and unexpected onset of a long line of infantry.
Troops thus unexpectedly attacked, and, in addition, deprived of the
support of their own artillery, almost invariably lost their heads.
However, if the attacker is prepared for such an event, remains cool,
meets the counter-attack of the defender with a powerful fire at short
ranges, and brings up his supports, in order to follow up the effect of
his fire with an offensive movement, there can be no doubt as to the
result.[472]

   [472] The battles of Soor and Kesselsdorf are interesting examples
 of this. (_Kriege Friedrichs des Groszen_, II, pp. 75 and 234).
 In both cases the defender’s frontal counter-attack forced the
 assailant to face about; but at Soor a second line of infantry, and
 at Kesselsdorf a charge made by the Bonin Dragoons finally turned the
 scale in favor of the assailant.

Such a counter-attack, however, is only possible when the defender
still has strong, intact reserves at his disposal, which he has kept
in readiness in the closest proximity to the firing line until the
decisive moment. An organization acting as part of a larger force,
and whose flanks are secure, as a rule has no choice but to make a
frontal counter-attack, unless offensive action is to be dispensed with
altogether.

 Short frontal counter-attacks from a position were made successfully
 by the British in the battles at the opening of the 19th Century.
 (In these counter-attacks, the British fired a volley and then
 advanced to the assault). Such successful counter-attacks were made
 during the battles of =Vimiero=, =Maida=, =Busaco=, and especially
 =Waterloo=.[473]

   [473] At Waterloo, the counter-attack made by Picton’s Division and
 the British Guards repulsed the French attack. VON OLLECH, _Feldzug
 von 1815_, pp. 230 and 247. See also note p. 151 supra.

 At =Beaumont=, the 66th Infantry made a counter-attack when the
 French had approached within 40 m. The 66th had already begun to
 waver, here and there, when its energetic and unexpected advance
 caused the French to retire.[474]

   [474] HOPFFGARTEN-HEIDLER, _Beaumont_, p. 53.

 In the battles of the =Russo-Turkish war of 1877-78=, frontal
 counter-attacks were successfully made in several instances.

 In the engagement at =Kazeljevo= (5th September, 1877), the frontal
 counter-attack made by the Russians, who were numerically far
 inferior, saved them from defeat, as all their lines of retreat were
 obstructed by their trains, which had gone astray.[475]

   [475] SPRINGER, _Der russisch-türkische Krieg_, III, p. 171.

 The most instructive fight in this connection is the engagement of
 =Gorni Bugarov= (1st January, 1878). General Weljaminov’s detachment,
 which consisted of the Pensa and the Tambov Infantry Regiments,
 occupied a flank position on the southern foothills of the Balkans,
 on the road leading from =Orchanie= to =Sofia=. The Russians allowed
 the Turks to approach to very short range before they opened fire,
 which was immediately followed by a counter-attack all along the
 line. This seems to have been the result of the initiative of the
 several battalion commanders. The Turks (15 battalions) faced about
 and retired on Sofia. The Russian infantry was led back to its first
 position.[476]

   [476] _Ibid._, VII, p. 134.

 On the same day, the attack made by the Preobrajenski Regiment
 of the Russian Guard at =Tashkessen= was repulsed by the frontal
 counter-attack made by a weak force of Turkish infantry.[477]

   [477] BAKER-PASHA, _War in Bulgaria_, II, p. 57.

During the Russo-Japanese war such frontal counter-attacks were very
frequently made. When undertaken with inadequate numbers, they were
invariably repulsed by the fire of the Japanese, especially when the
latter found cover in previously constructed trenches.


Provisions of Various Regulations.

 =Austria-Hungary.= If a counter-attack is contemplated, the commander
 should resist every temptation to employ parts of the general reserve
 for other purposes than for carrying out that attack. In this case,
 the general reserve should be placed in readiness so that, while the
 opponent advances within the decisive zone, it can quickly deploy
 and carry out the counter-attack with determination by directing a
 powerful fire against the flank of the enemy. Freedom of movement
 on one flank is absolutely essential to the execution of the
 counter-attack. Local frontal counter-attacks are to be avoided; the
 enemy is to be annihilated by fire.

 When it is not contemplated to make a counter-attack with the general
 reserve, the latter is to be employed either for directly reinforcing
 the troops in one of the sections, or for engaging the hostile troops
 making an enveloping attack on the position.

 =France.= The regulations make a distinction between counter-attack
 (_contre attaque_) and offensive return (_retour offensif_). A
 counter-attack is made by the reserve before the enemy penetrates
 into the energetically defended supporting points. In contrast
 herewith, every attempt to retake a captured position is called an
 offensive return.

 A counter-attack with troops of the second line is to be made as soon
 as the assailant presses the fighting line too closely. A powerful
 and suddenly executed counter-attack, supported by the fire of the
 first line, will, at the very least, check the enemy until the
 fighting line has had time to recover.

 Occasionally, it may be advantageous not to await the crisis, but
 to force the assailant to deploy by directing a heavy fire upon
 him, then to break off the action, inducing the enemy to press
 on, in order to draw him, by this means, onto previously selected
 and reconnoitered terrain, where he is suddenly attacked in flank
 by fresh troops. Military history shows that this very procedure
 has frequently been successful. “If the attacker presses forward
 too hastily and if he threatens to carry the defender’s position,
 fresh troops, which have been assembled in a place sheltered from
 view, attack him energetically, while the troops already engaged
 increase the intensity of their fire. This powerful and energetic
 counter-attack produces confusion in the enemy’s ranks and compels
 him to retire, or at least to discontinue his forward movement until
 he has had time to recover.”

 “The same activity, the same determination to maneuver, must
 prevail everywhere. Every mistake and every weakness of the enemy
 must be quickly perceived and promptly utilized. The troops in the
 counter-attack should move forward without hesitation and regardless
 of the cost When such a forward movement has to be discontinued, the
 commander must decide where it shall cease. The efforts of all should
 be directed toward one object, that of tiring and demoralizing the
 enemy by constant counter-attacks, until the moment arrives when the
 commander must order the offensive to be assumed.”

 =England.= The counter-attack may be made either by the garrison
 of the firing trenches, as a frontal counter movement, or by the
 general reserve, accompanied by artillery and cavalry, as a decisive
 counter-attack. The moment when the attacker has used up his
 reserves and is about to assault is generally considered as the most
 propitious for making the counter-attack.

 =Japan.= The Japanese entertain the same views as the Germans.
 “The better the position, the location and construction of the
 intrenchments, and the distribution of troops, the greater the
 number of men that can be saved in garrisoning the position, and the
 stronger the general reserve available for an offensive movement. By
 this means the chances of victory are increased. * * * Frequently
 there is danger that the defender will be committed to purely passive
 defense, and that freedom of action will be lost. Therefore, when the
 proper moment arrives, the decisive counter-attack should be made.”




XII. THE RETREAT.

(Par. 426 German I. D. R.).


A retreat under effective hostile fire means annihilation; only the
presence of cover immediately in rear of the fighting line should
induce a commander to come to the weighty decision of reaching
it by running. (Russia). On account of the great range of modern
weapons, defeated troops, on open ground, cannot escape from fire
by running.[478] No rules can be laid down in regulations as to the
conduct of a retreat after a defeat. As a rule, further resistance is
no longer possible; neither is it practicable to leave some troops
in position to cover the retreat. The defeated force must retire in
a direction perpendicular to the front of the enemy,[479] and cannot
re-form until the fire of the opponent ceases or at least abates. (Par.
428 German I. D. R.). Artillery which is moved to the rear at a timely
moment, and all available cavalry should cover the retreat of the
infantry, so as to prevent the hostile cavalry from making the most of
its opportunities for effective action.

   [478] Furthermore, the danger of panic should not be
 underestimated. See KUNZ, _Kriegsgeschichtliche Beispiele_, XIII, p.
 49, and XVI. p. 243, in regard to the panic created in a skirmish
 line near the Bruch Mühle west of Gunstett (Wörth). This skirmish
 line was running to the rear toward a rallying position and the panic
 was produced by the command “To the rear. Double Time! March! March!”
 The panic was nipped in the bud by the energetic action of a mounted
 field officer. Major v. Below.

   [479] The 57th Infantry, whose right flank had been enveloped and
 roughly handled by a counter-attack made by the French, retired to
 its left rear through the fragments of the 16th Infantry. This caused
 the two regiments to change places. (The attack made by the 38th
 Brigade at Mars-la-Tour). _Kriegsgeschichtliche Einzelschriften_, 25,
 p. 35.

To order a retreat at the right moment requires military instinct;
rules cannot be laid down in regard to it.

“Troops which, while engaged with the enemy, are either withdrawn by
order or defeated, can no longer choose their line of retreat. If the
enemy pursues, they must retire perpendicularly to their former front,
without changing formation, and need a force on which they can rally
in order to prepare for renewed resistance. From this it follows that
a systematic retreat can only be carried out when the force still has
some distribution in depth. It would be wrong however, for a force
intended for decisive action to retain a reserve for covering the
retreat instead of employing it for the purpose of gaining the victory.”

To break off the action by systematically relieving the troops engaged
with the enemy,[480] is only possible if the force still has reserves
available, if cavalry and artillery are in a position to take a hand in
the fight, or if the troops that have been withdrawn are sheltered from
the enemy’s fire by features of the ground--all of which depends in
many cases on chance.

   [480] _Taktik_, V, p. 344.

It is much more difficult to break off an action in defense than in
attack, as in the former case, the assailant approaches closer with
every moment. This brings up the question, as to whether it would not
be better for the defender to hold out until darkness sets in than
expose his troops to the incalculable results of a retreat under fire.
When the assailant has once entered the zone of short ranges, the
defender will no longer be able to effect a systematic retreat. If the
defender has used up all his reserves, the withdrawal should be begun
at the point where the enemy is not pressing his attack, or where he
has been unable to gain a superiority of fire. When a withdrawal is
made, the whole local front should retire at once and simultaneously;
it would be a mistake to reduce gradually the strength of the units
engaged, for this would only give the enemy an opportunity to
annihilate completely the remaining parts. If a company cannot maintain
its position, a platoon certainly could not do so.

[Illustration]

As soon as the commander decides to break off the action, the reserve,
if one is still available, should be sent to the rear to take up a
rallying position, which should be so situated that it can make its
influence felt as soon as the main position is evacuated. As every
defeated force, or one that is withdrawn by order, retires straight to
the rear, the rallying position, in order to allow the troops holding
it to fire effectively, must be located as far as possible to a flank
of the line of retreat. If the outer flank of the position can be
advanced, fire may be opened at an earlier moment, but this will only
be practicable in minor engagements. The distance of the rallying
position from the main defensive position should be such as to compel
the enemy to advance again under fire, and prevent his carrying both
the main defensive position and the rallying position at one rush. On
the other hand, the rallying position should not be so far to the rear
that the retreating troops may be annihilated before they enter its
effective zone. However, as the troops in the rallying position are
also to effect a withdrawal, it is not a good plan for them to engage
the enemy from the start at too short a range. “It is most desirable
when artillery and machine guns supported by cavalry suffice for this
purpose, while the infantry uninterruptedly continues its retreat. The
mounted arms follow later at an increased gait.” (Par. 429 German I. D.
R.).

The rallying position should be occupied in time, so that all
dispositions for holding it can be made calmly and without
precipitation. A powerful fire at mid and long ranges is requisite
to prevent the enemy from reaching decisive ranges. The firing line
should, therefore, be strong and the supports weak. If a reserve
is still available, it is at once sent back into a second rallying
position, to cover the withdrawal of the troops occupying the first
rallying position. A free field of fire down to the shortest ranges is
not necessary. If the position is on elevated ground, the firing line
should be posted so far in rear of the crest that, while its fire can
still sweep the ground at mid ranges, and perhaps at the extreme limit
of short ranges, the skirmishers, on retiring, will be sheltered as
soon as possible. Fire should be opened as soon as possible, in order
to retard the enemy’s advance.

The troops holding a rallying position should delay the enemy’s advance
long enough to give the retiring force ample time and room to re-form,
so that it can effect its retreat in good order. When this has been
accomplished, the troops occupying the rallying position retire, unless
there is hope that fresh troops may bring about a change in the state
of affairs. As a rule, a second rallying position will be necessary,
but it would be a mistake to halt in every seemingly favorable
position. When a retreat has once been decided upon, it is generally
necessary to get away from the enemy as quickly as possible.

“The commander must conduct the combat attending a retreat according to
a well-ordered plan. He must indicate where the rallying position is to
be, what troops are to occupy it, and assign march directions to the
different columns. Only after he has given these orders and has assured
himself that they will be executed, does he leave the battlefield, in
order to meet his troops soon thereafter with new orders.[481] The
rest is the business of subordinate leaders.” (Par. 432 German I. D.
R.). The latter remain with their organizations for the purpose of
maintaining order and cohesion. (Par. 297 German I. D. R.). Adjutants
and officers detailed to receive orders should be sent to the rear
ahead of the troops.[482]

   [481] This sentence in our regulations, not to be found in those of
 other armies, was necessary to absolve a superior commander from all
 blame for leaving his troops and the battlefield. V. SCHLICHTING, I,
 p. 115. See _Taktik_, V, p. 350.

   [482] For the conduct of a retreat, see _Taktik_, V, p. 373, et seq.




XIII. CONTAINING ACTIONS.


THE DELAYING ACTION AND THE HOLDING ATTACK.

Since the attacker will invariably seek to overpower the defender,
and the latter will endeavor to prevent this by force of arms, it is
obvious that an enemy can be “delayed” or “held” only when he permits
this to be done. It is difficult to conduct a delaying action or a
holding attack, because our training, which is based on offensive
action, causes subordinate leaders to follow up every little advantage.
In delaying actions, the defensive, and in holding attacks, the
offensive intention predominates. The latter may consist of merely
threatening the enemy with an attack, or of seriously engaging him.
(Par. 392 German I. D. R.). Both the delaying action and the holding
attack aim at deceiving the enemy.[483] Accordingly, the characteristic
features of these combats are great frontage, large expenditure of
ammunition, and long range fire, but, at the same time, few rifles,
in order to deceive the enemy as to the strength of our force. In
both combats, troops require considerable distribution in depth. The
object of a delaying action is to gain time until the troops in rear
can deploy, neighboring columns can come up, or a turning movement
can become effective. (Par. 417 German I. D. R.). Troops fighting a
delaying action require considerable distribution in depth so that
they can effect a withdrawal. Distribution in depth is still more
necessary in a holding attack,[484] in order that the troops may be
able to repulse a counter-attack made by the enemy, or, by attacking
him energetically, prevent his withdrawing. A force fighting a delaying
action should keep its supports far to the rear, while a force charged
with holding the enemy should keep them in close proximity. By properly
employing his artillery, the commander can best exercise an influence
on the course of the combat. (Par. 419 German I. D. R.). Since a
delaying action is to be fought at long ranges, a field of fire is
only required at those ranges; defiladed spaces in the foreground may
frequently be a positive advantage. The fire fight is kept up only so
long as it is necessary to keep the enemy at a distance. In a holding
attack, it will not be proper to keep up a continuous fire; the violent
fire breaking forth from time to time must teach the defender that a
force is lying in waiting opposite him, ready to rush forward at a
moment’s notice.

   [483] This is still more pronounced In demonstrations. (_Taktik_,
 V, p. 11). “Feints are to deceive the enemy as to our intentions,
 but they may consist of offensive action. The regulations do not lay
 down specific rules either for them or for other more rare methods
 of combat; accordingly, their conduct will vary with the situation.”
 (Par. 420, German I. D. R.).

   [484] _Taktik_, V, p. 161.

The object of threatening with an attack may frequently be accomplished
by engaging the enemy with several detachments which are separated
by intervals. (Par. 288 German I. D. R.). The negative object of
preventing the enemy from withdrawing may be accomplished with a
weak force; the positive object of compelling the enemy to use up
his reserves in the early stages of the fight and at a less decisive
point, requires that lie be engaged with a stronger force. A determined
commander will not allow himself to be held by demonstrations. The
manner in which the Vth Army Corps forced the French to bring up their
reserves into the first line at Wörth, is worthy of imitation.

The size of the group charged with holding the enemy depends upon the
extent of front to be covered and the probable duration of the combat.
The conduct of such a force will vary considerably, depending upon the
distance to the point where the decisive action is to be fought. When
the holding force is close to this point, it should engage the enemy
energetically.

 =England.= The holding attack is to deceive the enemy as to the
 direction in which the main attack will be made, and, when the
 crisis of the action approaches, prevent his withdrawing troops from
 those parts of his front which are only threatened and opposing the
 decisive attack with nearly his entire force. Accordingly, the troops
 making the holding attack should act vigorously, as soon as the
 attack develops, and be in readiness to transform their demonstration
 instantly into a real attack.




XIV. THE INFANTRY COMBAT ACCORDING TO VARIOUS DRILL REGULATIONS.


THE AUSTRIAN DRILL REGULATIONS OF 1903.[485]

   [485] The various provisions of the German and Austrian Infantry
 Drill Regulations are skillfully compared by Major-General
 REGENSPURSKY V. REGENY, Austrian Army, in an article entitled _Die
 taktischen Lehren des Exerzierreglements für die k. k. Fusztruppen
 vom Jahre 1903. Ein Vergleich mit dem deutschen Reglement 1906_.
 (_Militär-Wochenblatt_, 1906, Nos. 7 and 8).


ATTACK.

 Both the rencontre and the attack on a position prepared for defense
 are considered. The regulations in regard to the rencontre have been
 revised, so as to permit a commander to launch the battalions of his
 main body directly from route column, or to concentrate his main body
 farther to the rear, while his advance guard stands on the defensive.
 The =attack on a position prepared for defense=, even after the
 attacker’s artillery has succeeded in paving the way for its
 infantry, consists of a laborious advance from one firing position
 to another. The question as to whether an attack is feasible without
 the support of artillery fire, is answered to the effect that it
 will, as a rule, be a difficult undertaking, unless the artillery has
 sufficiently silenced the batteries of the defender. The regulations
 divide the attack into two clearly defined phases, viz., the advance
 to the decisive firing position (the main firing position), and the
 decisive action.

 The provisions of the regulations coincide very nearly with the views
 considered sound in Germany, and therefore an attempt will here
 merely be made to point out several differences. The combat formation
 necessary for the decisive stage of the action is taken up during
 the preparatory stage, so that, when the forward movement commences,
 the troops need only move straight to the front. (Par. 568). In a
 division, by appropriately combining “tactical units”, echelons are
 formed, whose strength depends upon the purpose of the combat, the
 information of the enemy, and the relation of the division to other
 bodies of troops. (Pars. 533, 540 and 541). Rules for the employment
 of thin or dense firing lines are not given. “The attacker should
 advance impetuously to the point where he can employ his rifles
 effectively,” (Par. 582).

 “In an attack, everything should be done to get within effective
 range of the opponent before fire is opened by the whole line.” (Par.
 323). When acting as part of a larger force, a platoon may open
 fire independently, if it suddenly encounters the enemy or if it
 finds a good opportunity for firing which the company commander has
 overlooked. (Par. 338). Unless the battalion commander has reserved
 to himself the right of designating the moment for opening fire, the
 company commanders direct when fire shall be opened, and conduct the
 fire fight at mid and short ranges. At long ranges, the battalion
 commander designates the companies that are to fire.

 =Kinds of fire.= Fire at will and volley fire are employed. As a
 rule, volleys are only used when the troops are in close order, but
 may also be used in skirmish line to test the range. According to
 par. 331, the rate of fire may be accelerated, and in pars. 327 and
 686, fire surprises are authorized.

 When exposed to effective fire, the firing line is to =advance by
 rushes=. These are to be made by alternate units moving forward,
 supported by the fire of those remaining behind. Rushes are only in
 exceptional cases to be made by units smaller than a platoon. “The
 length of the rushes depends upon the character of the ground and
 the tactical situation, as well as upon the physical condition of
 the men. They serve as an expedient for reaching the next firing
 position.” (Par. 313).

 Movements under effective hostile fire may sometimes be made by
 =crawling=. This is considered especially useful in rectifying
 alignments. (Par. 196).

 For =envelopment=, see p. 362 supra.

 For the =use of the spade in attack=, see p. 393 supra.

 =Assault.= “The close approach of a long firing line to an enemy who
 occupies a good position, may well pass as a proof of the assailant’s
 superiority. Nevertheless, this does not, under all circumstances,
 furnish assurance that a forward movement for the purpose of
 penetrating the hostile position will now succeed; a premature
 assault may still result in disaster.

 “As long as the conduct of the opponent does not show clear
 indications that his fire power is crippled, nothing remains for
 the attacker but to continue the fight for the superiority of
 fire. In doing this, the commander should not hesitate to put in
 his last man if necessary. The assault--in case the enemy still
 offers resistance--should not be made until the attack has been
 pushed sufficiently close to the enemy’s position, and the power of
 resistance of the enemy is palpably broken.

 “It is immaterial what formations are taken up for this closing act
 of the combat, as it should be the natural culmination of a situation
 strained to the utmost. The troops must understand that there is no
 longer any chance to go back; that on the contrary, at this moment,
 honor and salvation lie wholly in moving to the front.

 “When the assault has once begun, the hostile position should be
 carried in one rush. Any hesitation or halting, at this critical
 stage of the action, may nullify the previous success, and must
 therefore be quickly overcome by the reserves, if any are still
 available, taking a hand in the fight.” (Pars. 590-592).

 The decision to assault may emanate either from the firing line, from
 the commander of the whole force, or from the commander of one of the
 units. If the decision emanates from the firing line, all the troops
 are to conform to the movement of that line. The following provision,
 which applies even to a company acting alone, differs from the German
 regulations, viz., “During the assault, a part of the assailant’s
 force should, whenever practicable, continue its fire and direct it
 upon any hostile reserves that may appear.”


DEFENSE.

 The regulations governing the =defense seeking a decision= differ
 but little from the views entertained in Germany. The actual work
 of preparing a position for defense is not to commence until the
 direction in which the enemy is going to make his attack is known.
 The assailant is to be prevented, as far as possible, from obtaining
 information of the position and the measures taken for strengthening
 it. This is to be accomplished by pushing small detachments to the
 front to hamper the enemy’s advance.

 In the past, =advanced positions= were decidedly opposed by the
 Austrians, but at present their use is recommended in cases where
 time is to be gained or the enemy is to be deceived, or where
 fire from such positions would inflict considerable losses on the
 enemy. However, the regulations seek to obviate the danger of the
 principal fight taking place in the advanced position instead of in
 the main position, by adding: “But such a measure should not cause
 the commander to swerve from the firm determination to carry out his
 original intention.”

 The tremendously increased fire power of infantry is to make it
 possible to hold the front with a comparatively weak force, while
 the remaining troops are concentrated as a reserve with which the
 actual decision is to be brought about. The commander should resist
 every temptation to use the general reserve for other purposes than
 for carrying out the =counter-attack=, which should be ordered when
 the assailant is under the most effective fire of the position. The
 general reserve should then be quickly deployed and should make its
 attack with determination, by directing a violent fire against the
 flank of the enemy. Local frontal counter-attacks are to be avoided.
 The garrison is only charged with the task of annihilating the enemy
 with its fire, which should be increased to the utmost intensity.


THE ITALIAN DRILL REGULATIONS OF 1903 AND 1906.[486]

   [486] Major-General MIKULICZ RADECKI, Austrian Army, _Das neue
 Exerzierreglement der italienischen Infanterie_, Vienna, 1906. V.
 GRÄVENITZ, _Die neueren taktischen Vorschriften für das italienische
 Heer_, in _Vierteljahrsheft_, 1905, I, p. 90, et seq. _Der
 Infanteriekampf in der oberitalienischen Tiefebene_, in _Streffleur_,
 1907, October and November numbers (also obtainable in special
 pamphlet form).

   P. RATH, _Der Kampf in der italienischen Kultur_, in _Militärische
 Welt_, 1907, January-February number.


ATTACK.

 The peculiar character of the probable Italian theater of war in
 Upper Italy, with its numerous forests of tall timber, and its many
 defiles, causes special attention to be paid to the offensive.[487]
 The regulations emphasize the necessity of the coöperation of
 infantry and artillery.

   [487] Unless otherwise ordered, the advance guard advances against
 the hostile forces which it encounters in its march, whether its
 action be to determine, as quickly as possible, the strength of the
 opponent and to save its main body from an unnecessary delay, or
 whether it be to deceive the opponent as to the location of its own
 forces, or, in certain cases, to make the most of a surprise. (Par.
 37).

 Although the platoons intended for the firing line are brought up
 in close order formation, the actual combat formation is not taken
 up until the situation makes this necessary; but, in any case, the
 leading element is to enter the zone of hostile fire in a deployed
 formation. To neutralize the mixing of units as much as possible
 as the action progresses, the firing line is formed into groups
 separated by intervals of 4-5 paces, although this increases the
 casualties. These intervals may be increased, when required, to 10
 paces. (Intervals between skirmishers in the firing line are usually
 at least 15 cm., otherwise 3 paces). The firing line is to advance
 until increased casualties force it to open fire.

 =Kinds of fire.= Only fire at will is employed. (This is also used
 when the troops are in close order and formed in four ranks). The
 battalion commander in the first line directs that fire be opened, as
 soon as it is certain that a good effect can be produced. When two
 targets appear, the fire is to be directed upon the one promising the
 best results (_i.e._, not necessarily the one that is tactically most
 important). “In order that the intensity of the fire may correspond
 to the requirements of the tactical situation existing at the moment,
 officers, by reason of their tactical training, should be able to
 state approximately how many rounds are necessary to produce the
 desired effect, the range, degree of visibility and character of the
 target, the nature of the terrain and of their position, as well as
 the physical condition and morale of their men being given. From
 these estimates may be deduced how many rifles must be employed in
 order to bring about a decisive result in the shortest possible time.”

 The =advance by rushes= may be made either at a walk or at a run, but
 the regulations do not prescribe in detail how it shall be conducted.
 The following points are considered especially important: The time
 for making a rush, its length, and whether it should be made by
 a whole unit simultaneously or in echelon. All this depends upon
 various circumstances, which the leader, alter due consideration
 of the terrain and the hostile fire, as well as of the physical
 condition and morale of his men, is to judge in each particular case.
 In doing this, he is to bear in mind that the rush must be made as
 unobserved by the enemy as possible, so that the latter cannot direct
 his lire upon the advancing unit.

 The rushes are to be made first by those parts of the firing line
 which are favored by the terrain and which have gained a superiority
 of fire over the hostile troops immediately opposed to them. Units
 which could only advance by rushes at the cost of considerable and
 useless losses, are to wait until the neighboring units have pushed
 ahead, support these with their fire, and then advance in turn under
 cover of the fire of the others.

 As a general rule, so long as the hostile fire permits, rushes are
 to be made by entire companies, or at least by whole platoons. The
 length of the rushes and whether they are made at a walk or at a run,
 depends upon the nature of the terrain. Upon completing a rush, fire
 is to be opened at once.

 When the intensity of the hostile fire increases, or after the
 organizations have become mixed, rushes can no longer be made by
 entire units but only by squads or like fractions. These leave the
 firing line and endeavor to reach the next cover at a rapid run.
 or, if cover be lacking, throw themselves down in order to open
 fire again at the shorter range thus gained. As a rule, the leading
 echelons open fire at once from their new positions, so as to
 facilitate the advance of the others, unless special circumstances
 make it advisable to delay the firing until all the other units have
 reached a good position and are able to direct an effective fire upon
 the enemy.

 At short ranges, in covered terrain, or on ground swept by hostile
 fire, the best way to avoid losses is to advance in small groups
 consisting of several skirmishers. During each rush, the adjoining
 flanks of neighboring units cease firing, so as not to injure the men
 of the advancing unit. Platoon and company commanders hurry ahead,
 while squad leaders see that all of the men move forward.

 Standing crops frequently enable the echelons in rear to follow the
 firing line in closer order, and may even permit supports, which are
 to carry that line forward, to come up in that formation.

 The =assault= is to be made either in close or extended order to the
 tune of the Royal March and with loud cheers.

 The regulations assume, however, that the superiority of fire, gained
 by the mutual coöperation of infantry and artillery and by the
 participation of the reserves, will induce the opponent to retreat.
 When engaged with an obstinate opponent, who remains in his position,
 only a part of the leading line is to be launched against certain
 sections (_tratti_) of the defensive position, while other parts, by
 means of rapid fire, prevent the enemy from supporting the threatened
 sections. In conjunction with this frequently emphasized scheme of
 penetrating several specially important sections of the hostile
 position, the regulations express the view--by no means generally
 considered sound-that the capture of several judiciously chosen
 points will force the enemy to retreat.

 The assault is, as a rule, to be made by order of the commander of
 the whole force. The short burst of rapid fire preceding the assault
 is suddenly terminated by the command “attention” (_attenti_), and
 at the command “to the assault” (_per l’assalto_), the men throw
 themselves with loud cheers, accompanied by the sounding of trumpets
 and the beating of drums, upon the enemy. When a unit has already
 gotten so close to the enemy that further waiting would be useless,
 it advances to the assault, after getting permission therefor, or,
 otherwise, on its own responsibility. All the rest of the troops are
 to join in this movement.


DEFENSE.

 So long as it is not definitely known in which direction the enemy
 will approach, the position is to be occupied with as weak a force as
 possible. The decision is to be brought about by a =counter-attack=.
 Long range fire is only considered proper on broad stretches of open
 terrain devoid of cover; and, in general, fire is not to be opened
 until the enemy arrives at short ranges. As soon as fire is opened,
 all the supports are to be in the firing line. A counter-attack is
 undertaken by the first line only in exceptional cases.


THE FRENCH DRILL REGULATIONS OF 1904.


ATTACK.

 Both the French and the German regulations show a decided preference
 for the offensive, and both have eliminated all rules which might
 produce normal formations. There is an unmistakable inclination
 towards shock tactics in the French regulations, although the term
 “shock troops” has been replaced by “maneuvering troops”. “The
 forward movement alone is decisive and irresistible.... The fire is
 the element that executes”. The habit of looking upon the German army
 as a probable opponent leads the French to provide for reconnaissance
 with mixed detachments. The regulations do not touch upon the tactics
 of the rencontre, and prescribe a more cautious conduct for the
 advance guard than the German regulations.[488] The advance guard
 is to occupy supporting points, under cover of which the main body
 can deploy, and to complete the reconnaissance by its fight. The
 necessity of infantry detachments completing the reconnaissance made
 by the cavalry is particularly emphasized.

   [488] See pars. 354, 356, 357 and 366 German I. D. R.

 Another difference between the two regulations considered lies in the
 manner of making use of the cover afforded by the ground. The danger
 of going too far in this direction is guarded against in the German
 regulations by assigning combat sections to the various units. The
 French regulations prescribe a group formation of the several combat
 elements, and a concentration at favorable points, while the plain
 devoid of cover is left unoccupied. The center of gravity of a French
 attack does not lie in the firing line--the fight for the superiority
 of fire is not mentioned--but in maneuvering troops cautiously led
 after the firing line. The defender is to be engaged all along the
 line and, when the weak points of his position are recognized, the
 commander-in-chief is to give the order for the assault.

 This division of a force into a fire and a shock group causes the
 French to prefer the echelon formation on general principles. A
 brigade is formed as follows, for example: Two battalions of the 1st
 regiment in the first line, which is followed at 400 m. by the third
 battalion (_troupe d’entrainement_); the 2nd regiment follows at a
 like distance as a reserve.

 The regulations divide the attack into the artillery and the
 infantry preparation (_préparation_), the decisive action (_l’action
 décisive_), and the completion (_l’achèvement_).

 =The artillery in the preparatory action.= The artillery is to
 endeavor to silence the hostile artillery as quickly as possible,
 without, however, expending more ammunition than is absolutely
 necessary.... The commander is not to give the order for the attack
 until the preparation is considered sufficient.

 The troops are led forward over the terrain in a particularly careful
 manner (see p. 208 supra), and are then concentrated in a sheltered
 and protected place. Twelve mounted men (Reservists) are attached
 to every infantry regiment for reconnaissance purposes. The manner
 in which the French utilize the ground is typical. In this, widely
 separated parts of the force may unexpectedly encounter a strong
 hostile firing line, and may be defeated in detail.

 The official regulations are supplemented by special regulations
 issued in March 1907 for the army maneuvers by General Lacroix,
 formerly commanding the VIIth Army Corps, and at present Vice
 President of the Supreme War Council.

 =Assembly.= The division is assembled in division square (_carré de
 division_), in which the brigades are in line or in echelon, the
 regiments in line of double columns or in line of company columns,
 abreast or in echelon. If a frontal attack is to be made, in which
 successive lines are pushed forward without any attempt to envelop
 (in other words a pure frontal attack), the division is concentrated
 with the brigades abreast, their regiments in echelon. If a flank
 attack is to be made, in which the leading brigade must be protected
 by an echelon and a reserve ready for any eventuality, the division
 is concentrated with the brigades in echelon, their regiments
 abreast. The artillery is posted in section column near a road in
 rear of the _carré_. The pioneer company is divided into four parts,
 corresponding to the four heads of columns of the assembled troops,
 for the purpose of removing obstacles and cutting passages during the
 forward movement. The cavalry is pushed forward and the assembled
 force is protected in all directions by outposts of infantry and
 cavalry.

 =Preparations for the advance in mass formation.= During the
 concentration, mounted officers reconnoiter the covering features of
 the terrain which are to be utilized during the advance of the massed
 division, and later these officers act as guides.


Preparatory attack formation.

 =A. Pure frontal attack.= The leading regiment in each brigade is to
 have two battalions in the firing line and supports, the third to
 be echeloned in the rear of the outer flank. All of the battalions
 are to be protected by infantry patrols and by a small detachment of
 cavalry. The second regiment is to have one battalion echeloned in
 rear of the inner flank of the leading regiment, and the divisional
 cavalry is to be held in rear of the division, in readiness to
 advance to the right or the left.

 =B. Flank attack.= The two regiments of the leading brigade are to
 furnish their own firing lines, supports, and reserves. The third
 regiment is to be echeloned 500 m. in rear of the others, and the
 fourth regiment is to form the general reserve. The cavalry is to
 reconnoiter on the outer flank. In this case, as well as in a pure
 frontal attack, the artillery is to take up a position from which it
 can support the attack. Drummers, trumpeters, and bands, are to march
 with the general reserve. The regulations state that it is absolutely
 essential for infantry units to be sheltered from hostile observation
 during their forward movement, and that they must remain under
 control of their leaders up to the last moment. Troops are not to
 deploy until they enter terrain swept by the enemy’s fire. (According
 to the decision of umpires at peace maneuvers, this would be at 5000
 m.). It should be borne in mind that deployed troops cannot move by a
 flank, but only straight to the front.

 The forward movement, in which the terrain will invariably cause
 lateral displacements of troops, is made from cover to cover, when
 necessary, from one supporting point to another. No hard and fast
 rules or normal formations are prescribed for this advance.

 The advance is to be made as long as possible without firing a shot.
 When this is no longer practicable, recourse is to be had to fire, as
 the only means of making a further advance possible.

 =Kinds of fire.= Fire at will (_feu à volonté_), principally used at
 short ranges, for the purpose of retarding the enemy’s advance; fire
 with counted cartridges (_feu à cartouches comptées_), the number
 being given (this is the fire usually employed); magazine fire (_feu
 à répétition_); and the fire of specially designated marksmen. Volley
 fire has been again prescribed. “Bursts of fire” (_rafales_) are
 typical of French fire tactics. (See p. 164 supra).

 After fire has been opened, the advance is to be made by rushes, but
 the regulations do not prescribe how these shall be made.

 The regulations contain a very realistic description of the infantry
 combat with its fluctuations, isolated attacks, and reverses. They
 emphasize that all must be animated by a desire to carry forward, by
 means of reinforcements, any troops that may have been checked. At
 the point where an advance is absolutely impossible, as many hostile
 troops as possible are to be held fast by an energetic fire fight,
 while the troops in the decisive attack engage the enemy and advance
 impetuously.

 A series of attacks is to be made from the various covering features
 all along the line. These, made with the impetuosity inculcated
 by the regulations, are very apt to fail prematurely. This is
 particularly likely to happen because some of the troops will fall
 behind, while others are able to push ahead more rapidly. These
 attacks are to destroy the power of resistance of the enemy and to
 exhaust him physically. The leading units are to cover with their
 fire the advance of those who are less favored by the terrain.[489]
 During peace maneuvers, the fight now comes to a standstill at a
 range of 600 to 800 m.

   [489] According to DENCAUSSE, in _Journal des Sciences Militaires_,
 1906, and November-December number 1907, the infantry should endeavor
 to approach within 700-800 m. of the enemy’s position without firing
 a shot.

 The supports (_renforts_) follow in a similar manner, ready to move
 up into the firing line at the first signal to that effect, or
 independently in case the situation requires it. Their entry into
 action is in a general way determined by the commander of the whole
 force. They are to augment the fire power of the firing line or
 to carry it forward. The efforts of all are to be directed toward
 constantly keeping up the advance.

 At some points, the troops, when reinforced by their supports,
 will be able to attack some of the enemy’s supporting points,
 and to effect a lodgment on the ground captured. At other points
 the attacking group will be too weak to push the attack home. In
 such a case, the troops are to effect a lodgment on the terrain
 (_s’accrochent sur le sol_) in rear of the nearest cover, as close
 as possible to the enemy’s position, and are to maintain themselves
 there until artillery or neighboring troops can support them. The
 fire of these troops is to give the enemy the impression that an
 attack is to be made here also. “No matter how successful these
 usually protracted fights may be. troops must be launched in a
 decisive attack at some points. The infantry should endeavor to
 compensate for its numerical inferiority by skillfully utilizing the
 ground and intrenchments, by great activity, and, above all else, by
 invincible pertinacity. The supporting point will thus become the
 center of the fight of a separate combat group.”

 The commander should endeavor to maintain cohesion, and to equalize
 fluctuations in the combat by controlling the activity of the
 artillery and by putting in fresh troops. During this group combat,
 the commander must decide where the retained troops should be
 launched for the assault. The selection of a point of attack is
 essentially the personal task of the commander and is an index of
 character and of eye for the value of ground, neither of which can be
 regulated by fixed rules. The regulations do not believe that close
 order formations can be dispensed with in launching the assaulting
 troops. Troops in close order, utilizing the ground to the best
 advantage, so as to suffer but slight losses from hostile fire, are
 to be brought up to the fighting line in a flexible echelon formation
 in order to give to that line, as _troupes d’assaut_, the impetus for
 the assault.

 According to Thomas de Colligny,[490] formerly general staff officer
 of the 9th Infantry Division, a battalion designated to make an
 assault should form in four lines, each consisting of one company;
 the distance between lines being 150 m., and the front covered
 likewise 150 m. Each of the three leading lines should be formed
 in line of platoons in columns of route at deploying intervals
 sufficient to allow single rank line to be formed, and the fourth
 line in a similar formation with 10-pace intervals between platoons.
 When one of the lines is checked, the next succeeding one is to carry
 it forward. If the French believe such close order formations to be
 indispensable, they will be compelled to make a more extensive use of
 cover.

   [490] _Conseils à mon bataillon_, p. 107.

 Colonel Dencausse is the exponent of a suggestion made by General
 Bonnal. The latter forms a division for attack as follows: One
 regiment, on a front of 600 m., as the advanced line (_avant ligne_),
 in rear of that, the assaulting troops (_troupes d’assaut_). First
 line: one regiment, its twelve company columns abreast; second line:
 one regiment, its three battalions in double column at extended
 intervals, 300 m. in rear of the first line; third line: the fourth
 regiment, its battalions in route column abreast of each other, 300
 m. in rear of the second line. While, during our peace maneuvers, we
 continue to fire on the enemy’s firing line in the expectation that
 his supports and reserve will in the end enter our zone of fire, it
 might be advisable, when confronted by a French opponent, to direct
 our fire on his reserves as soon as these become visible.

 =Envelopment.= This is occasionally mentioned in the regulations
 (for example in pars. 290, 301 and 302). However, the Field Service
 Regulations, in discussing the attack, whose phases may vary in
 length depending upon the intentions of the commander, state that the
 attacker “may assail a wing or a flank of the enemy with superior
 forces for the purpose of annihilating him.”

 For the =use of the spade in attack=, see p. 392 supra.


DEFENSE.

 The French defense is characterized by group fortifications, advanced
 positions, and advanced posts[491] (intended to prevent hostile
 reconnaissance), and numerous counter-attacks.

   [491] These frequently consist of detachments of all arms
 (_détachements de couverture ou de contact_). General BONNAL.
 (_Deutsche Revue_, December number, 1907) says: “The French
 regulation--in contrast to the German--provide in defense for
 detachments of all arms, which are pushed forward for the purpose
 of compelling the enemy to show his dispositions, and to draw him
 on in a direction favorable for the defender. Both systems have
 their advantages and disadvantages, and we, for our part, are of the
 opinion that in sending out advanced detachments one must exercise
 great care in order that these may not be defeated in detail, for
 this is invariably detrimental to the whole force.”

 For defense, a force is divided into the firing line with its
 supports, and the maneuvering troops (general reserve) intended
 for offensive action. In addition to calling attention to the
 necessity of overwhelming with fire the hostile troops advancing over
 open ground, the regulations recommend that the fire be withheld
 occasionally and that the enemy be allowed to run into the greatly
 accelerated fire which is unexpectedly directed upon him. The fire is
 to be discontinued as soon as the enemy takes to cover, and is to be
 increased to the utmost intensity when he moves in dense formation
 over open ground. The supports are to be used to augment the fire
 power of the firing line.

 =Counter-attack.= General Lacroix states: “The frontal attack is
 met by the offensive return (_retour offensif_), the flank attack
 by the counter-attack. In order to prepare for this, the commander
 should ride ahead to examine the ground, and to consider what
 counter-measures he should take. The artillery can render the most
 effective assistance by registering its fire upon the points at which
 the enemy will probably advance, and by preventing him from leaving
 his position. If the attack is successful, the local reserve advances
 beyond the firing line, which has entered the hostile position, and
 fires upon the retreating enemy. The general reserve now becomes the
 local reserve, and the former firing line re-forms and becomes the
 general reserve.”

 The regulations make a distinction between counter-attack
 (_contre attaque_) and offensive return (_retour offensif_). A
 =counter-attack= is made by the reserve before the enemy penetrates
 into the energetically defended supporting points. In contrast
 herewith, every attempt to retake a captured position is called an
 =offensive return=. (For details see p. 439 supra).

 Occasionally, it may be advantageous not to await the crisis, but
 to force the assailant to deploy by directing a heavy fire upon
 him. then to break off the action, inducing the enemy to press on,
 in order to draw him, by this means, onto previously selected and
 reconnoitered terrain, where he is suddenly attacked in flank by
 fresh troops. Military history shows that this very procedure has
 frequently been successful.

 “The same activity, the same determination to maneuver, must
 prevail everywhere. Every mistake and every weakness of the enemy
 must be quickly perceived and promptly utilized. The troops in the
 counter-attack should move forward without hesitation and regardless
 of the cost. When such a forward movement has to be discontinued, the
 commander must decide where it shall cease. The efforts of all should
 be directed toward one object, that of tiring and demoralizing the
 enemy by constant counter-attacks, until the moment arrives when the
 commander must order the offensive to be assumed.”


THE BRITISH DRILL REGULATIONS OF 1905.[492]

   [492] _Infantry Training._ _Combined
 Training_.--_Vierteljahrshefte_, 1906, III, _The Development of the
 Tactical Views in the British Army after the Boer War_.


ATTACK.

 The regulations do not mention the rencontre. A normal offensive
 battle consists of “an advance from point to point. Every lodgment
 made in a new firing position weakens the enemy’s strength in his
 main position, and paves the way for a further advance; every advance
 must be thoroughly prepared and systematically carried out.”

 In the following, the attack made by a brigade of four battalions
 is used as a basis. While the commander reconnoiters under the
 protection of his advance guard, the troops are concentrated in a
 “preparatory formation”, the battalions in one or more lines of
 “quarter columns” (column of companies). As soon as the commander
 has decided which flank of the enemy he will envelop, against which
 portion of the enemy’s line he will launch his decisive attack,
 he assembles his subordinate commanders to receive the orders.
 According to the regulations, it will rarely be possible to issue
 orders while the troops are still in march. The orders are, as a
 general rule, to be given in writing, and are to be supplemented
 by verbal instructions, in which the commander calls attention
 to the peculiarities of the terrain, especially where a hostile
 counter-attack is possible. In exceptional cases, the brigade
 commander designates the position to be taken up by the machine
 guns, and gives directions to them in regard to supporting the
 advance by long range fire. A base battalion is to be designated.
 When the enemy’s position is visible, a point of attack is assigned
 to every unit. When this is not practicable, the base battalion is
 led forward by officers familiar with the ground, or it is given
 a compass direction. Every leader is to provide independently for
 reconnaissance and for communication by signal flags and also by
 telephone; a mounted signal corps man accompanies the brigade
 commander.

 Every unit is formed in three lines for attack.

 The =first line=, consisting of scouts and skirmishers with supports,
 is made as weak as possible; without supports rarely more than
 one-fourth of the whole force.

 The =second line=, the reserves of the firing line, is under the
 orders of the appropriate battalion commanders, and is to reinforce
 the firing line, protect the Hanks, and deliver long range fire. The
 second line is to fill up the firing line to the maximum density,
 _i.e._, to one man per yard of front (0.9 m.).

 The =third line=, the general reserve, is to assure the success of
 the attack. It is to be made as strong as possible, seldom less than
 one-fourth of the whole force.[493] “The general reserve is directly
 under the orders of the commander of the whole force. It enables
 him to meet the varying contingencies of an engagement or to ward
 off counter-attacks. If the attack succeeds, the general reserve
 pushes forward rapidly to take up the pursuit; if the attack fails,
 it serves as a rallying force, but before the commander decides
 to leave behind even a part of it, he should consider whether, by
 launching all the troops at his disposal, he could break down the
 resistance of the defender. The commander can only exercise an
 influence on the course of the action by means of a reserve. If he
 keeps in his own hands a strong reserve, he will have it in his power
 to take advantage of any mistake the enemy may commit, to restore
 the battle should the leading troops meet with a serious check, to
 meet a counter-attack in force, or, in case of need, to provide the
 additional strength required to drive the attack home.”

   [493] According to the old regulations, a part of the general
 reserve had to remain in rear in rallying positions. (See p. 397
 supra).

 In contrast with these provisions, we find, strangely enough, under
 the heading “Brigade”, the hint that, when advancing to the assault,
 it is advisable to keep back a portion of the reserve in a rallying
 position. Even a battalion commander is invariably to retain at least
 half a company at his disposal. The British were not without reason
 censured because their flank attacks were ineffective in South Africa
 on account of the lack of energy of the frontal groups, and their
 new regulations accordingly contain detailed rules for the conduct
 of the “holding attack”. The troops holding the enemy in front are
 to threaten him for the time being. This is to be accomplished by
 wide extension, and by deceiving the enemy by occasional bursts of
 lire (_rafales_), by employing machine guns, by retaining supports
 far in rear, and by retraining, for the time being, from advancing to
 decisive ranges. But the troops are to be ready to join in the main
 attack when the latter advances. The regulations state that, in order
 to deceive the enemy effectually, adequate forces will have to be
 launched and that the commander will have to act vigorously. (See p.
 447 supra).

 Fixed rules for the front to be covered by a unit in action are no
 longer given. A unit fighting alone may cover considerably more
 front than when acting as part of a larger force. In a decisive
 attack, a battalion in the first line may put 125 rifles on every 100
 yards (90 m.) of front; these are distributed between firing line,
 supports, and battalion reserve; the latter may consist of one or
 more companies. Entire companies are only deployed in exceptional
 cases, for example on open ground, where it is difficult to bring
 up the supports. The size of the reserve depends upon the losses to
 be anticipated in the firing line; when these will be small, in all
 probability, the reserve may be made as strong as the firing line
 plus supports. In attack, a battalion may accordingly deploy on a
 front not exceeding 800 yards (formerly 540 m. was prescribed). A
 brigade of four battalions may deploy on a front of 1400-2100 m.,
 depending upon the number of battalions engaged.

 When the force arrives within 4 or 5 km. of the enemy, the battalions
 are formed in two lines of companies. Each company in the first
 line is preceded by a platoon in close order, and this is in turn
 protected by scouts. As soon as these scouts can advance no farther,
 they lie down and await the arrival of the fighting line. The latter
 advances under cover of the supporting fire of infantry, machine
 guns, and artillery. Fire of position is considered necessary. Fire
 at will is from now on used. This is to vary in intensity according
 to the character of the target, and the range. It is to increase to
 special violence when the attacking infantry advances over level
 ground or encounters obstacles. The fire is to be discontinued when
 the advancing skirmishers reach cover. The firing line is to advance
 as close to the enemy as it can without suffering excessive losses.
 Fire is to be opened when the hostile fire makes this necessary, but
 small losses are to be borne.

 After the fire fight is once begun, it is to be conducted with
 more rifles than the enemy has in action. “Battles are only won by
 controlled fire directed upon targets at decisive ranges” (according
 to the regulations, at ranges under 540 m.). Within the zone of
 effective fire, all the troops are to deploy. In consequence of
 this, skirmishers, who endeavor to work forward independently, are
 scattered all over the terrain over which the attack is being made.
 At the initial deployment, the interval between skirmishers is to
 be about 5-15 paces; at short ranges, at points where the decision
 is sought, there is to be at least one rifle for every two or three
 yards of front (1.80-2.70 m. = 2¹⁄₂-3¹⁄₂ paces). Another paragraph
 of the regulations prescribes that the maximum density is to be one
 rifle per yard of front. The British views, when compared to those
 entertained by them immediately after the South African war, have
 undergone a noticeable change, especially as regards the frontage of
 a firing line; dense firing lines, possessing strong fire power, are
 at present deemed essential to a decisive fight, while the fire of
 widely extended lines is considered ineffective. The intervals may
 vary considerably, but the regulations state that it should be borne
 in mind that the difficulties of conducting a fight are increased and
 the fire power reduced when too great a front is covered; moreover,
 that in covered terrain, and when counter-attacks may be anticipated,
 an overextension is actually dangerous. Because of the necessity of
 moving in thin skirmish lines, it is considered essential that the
 men be trained to act independently, to continue the fight even in a
 difficult situation, and to do everything in their power to carry
 out the original intentions of the commander.

 =Rushes= over open ground are not to exceed 80-100 yards (72-92
 m.) in length; as a rule they are to be shorter. According to an
 example given in the Firing Regulations, rushes are to be 25 yards
 (22 m.) long, at ranges from 650-500 yards (580-450 m.). A rush is
 to be continued while the enemy’s surprise lasts and he finds no
 opportunity to deliver aimed fire. In covered terrain, the rushes are
 to be made from one covering feature to another.

 “On open ground and within effective range, long lines of
 skirmishers, rising simultaneously, will suffer heavy losses even
 when making short rushes; the sudden movement of smaller units may
 take the enemy unawares, so that for a time at least well aimed fire
 is avoided. The rush is continued only while the surprise of the
 enemy lasts. The shorter the range, the smaller the advancing unit
 will have to be, and the shorter the length of the rushes.”

 The dispositions for a rush are to be made as unostentatiously as
 possible. The rearward detachments, which follow by rushes, are to
 advance, if possible, beyond the group already firing. When squads
 are unable to advance by rushes, the men may crawl forward singly.

 The regulations state that, when in close order, units of the
 strength of company columns (80-100 men, 4 platoons, in column of
 platoons at full distances), having a front of 10-12 files, suffer
 comparatively small losses when exposed to long range fire (1800-1200
 m.). The troops are to deploy before reaching effective ranges
 (1200-600 m.), as they will otherwise suffer serious losses. At
 decisive ranges the firing line is to be filled up to its maximum
 density.

 The whole force, a small part excepted, is to be launched in the
 =assault=; a sudden and unexpected advance of the assaulting troops
 is considered particularly important. The order for the assault is
 to be given by the commander of the whole force, but the manner of
 conducting it is left to company commanders.

 When the attack would be too costly by day, however, the troops are
 to intrench, wait until it is dark, and then advance to assaulting
 distance, where they again intrench (machine guns, and even single
 field guns are to be taken along). The assault is to be made, after a
 brief but violent fire fight, at the first streak of dawn.


DEFENSE.

 In defense, a force is divided into the fighting line with supports,
 and the reserve. The latter furnishes the outposts and the garrisons
 for the advanced positions (so-called temporary positions). The
 object of =advanced positions= is to mislead, deceive, and check
 the enemy. They are to be evacuated before the troops in them
 become seriously engaged. It is not considered necessary for the
 =main position= to consist of a continuous line of trenches; every
 platoon and even every squad may have its own trench. The principal
 requirements are good field of fire and mutual support by oblique or
 enfilade fire.

 The strength of the garrison is to be governed by the size of the
 field of fire and the character of the works. The regulations state
 that, under favorable conditions, a few men can defend a broad
 front, but that, when the attack is favored by the terrain, a strong
 garrison is required. Firing trenches, unless they are to serve as
 dummy intrenchments, are not to be constructed so as to stand out
 against the horizon. The importance of masking firing trenches, and
 of constructing overhead cover is emphasized; special cover trenches
 for the supports may be constructed in rear of the crest.

 Against skirmishers, fire is to be opened at 1000 m., but it is also
 considered desirable to withhold the fire until they get within short
 range. It is believed that this will be attended by success when the
 assailant is ignorant of the position of the defender or makes his
 attack with poorly disciplined troops. Continuous long range firing
 tires the eye and the hand. The decision is to be brought about by a
 =counter-attack= made by the general reserve. Local counter-attacks
 by section reserves are also recommended. The tendency of the
 British to make the section reserves very strong has been frequently
 observed. The final stage of the combat consists, as in Wellington’s
 day, of a counter-attack all along the line. As soon as the opponent
 has arrived within assaulting distance, the troops holding the
 position are to fix bayonets and, after delivering magazine fire, are
 to make a short frontal counter-attack.


THE JAPANESE DRILL REGULATIONS OF 1907.


ATTACK.

 The Japanese views coincide almost exactly with the German, but take
 their peculiar theater of war into consideration.

 =Kinds of fire.= Fire at will, volley fire, and rapid fire are used.

 =Rushes= are not to exceed 100 m. in length, as a rule, but the
 regulations admonish leaders to “guard against the mistake of making
 rushes that are too short. When rushes are shorter than 30-40 m.,
 their value will be insignificant, as a rule.” Leaders are likewise
 to avoid sending forward units smaller than a platoon, in order that
 the advance may not be too much retarded and the difficulties of
 leading increased.

 The regulations particularly emphasize that it will rarely be
 possible “to shoot an enemy out of his position”, and that, on this
 account, the decision will, as a rule, be brought about by the
 assault with cold steel. They further state that, when the enemy can
 be kept down by artillery fire, the advance of the infantry will
 be easy; that, as it is difficult to obtain a timely effect from
 artillery fire directed upon an enemy who takes advantage of cover or
 who occupies a fortified position, the infantry cannot wait for the
 successful termination of the artillery combat, but, on the contrary,
 should advance while that combat is in progress, for only by so doing
 can it count upon the effective coöperation of its artillery. But,
 nevertheless, infantry is to make the attack independently, even if
 it has to dispense entirely with the coöperation of the artillery.

 The regulations consider the rencontre and the attack on a position
 prepared for defense.

 =Rencontre.= The regulations prescribe that in a rencontre the
 advance guard should make a vigorous but, at the same time,
 deliberate attack; that the commander should promptly decide what
 to do, even if the situation is not entirely clear; and that, when
 practicable, the main body should be launched as an entity. A fight
 against a superior enemy is only to be avoided, for the time being,
 in case the latter has gained a start in deployment.

 =Attack on a position prepared for defense.= The commander frames
 his plan of attack according to the results of the reconnaissance,
 and leads his troops forward provisionally into a preparatory
 position, where he assigns deployment spaces and, if practicable,
 combat sections to the different units. In order that they may
 utilize the covering features of the ground to the best advantage,
 the different units are to avoid advancing abreast. On account of
 the difficulties attending an advance over ground swept by hostile
 fire, it is considered desirable for the troops to take advantage
 of the cover afforded by darkness. In order that, in such a case,
 serious lateral displacements of the troops may be avoided, the
 fighting line is to be sent forward the day before to endeavor to
 drive back the troops posted in front of the enemy’s main position.
 The regulations state that, when an attack is contemplated to be
 made during daylight against a strong position prepared for defense,
 there is no alternative but to approach the assaulting position by
 intrenching successive attack positions, but that, when circumstances
 permit, an attempt must be made to advance under cover of darkness to
 the enemy’s position. In the latter case, the assaulting position is
 to be designated during the day, after a thorough reconnaissance, and
 detailed preparations are to be made for the advance. As soon as the
 troops arrive during the night in the selected position, they are to
 construct cover quickly, and to intrench. When the ground is so hard
 that intrenching tools cannot be used without difficulty, recourse is
 to be had to the sand bags that are carried along. The men engaged in
 digging trenches are at all times to be ready for action.

 The regulations state that whether a force which has occupied an
 assaulting position should make the =assault= immediately at dawn or
 should first prepare it by fire, will depend on circumstances; and
 that, if attempted at dawn, the success of the assault will depend
 on the suddenness and rapidity with which it is carried out. The
 reconnaissance of the position and the work of removing obstacles is
 to be completed, if possible, during the night, so that avenues of
 approach will be open for the assaulting troops.

 If the reconnaissance has gained all the necessary information, and
 if the preparations are completed, the assault may be made before the
 night is over. The regulations say that, when an assault is made at
 night, the distance to be covered should be very short; and that it
 will depend on circumstances whether the assault is made suddenly,
 directly from the last firing position, or whether it is carried
 out upon the completion of works of approach. When necessary the
 assaulting bodies are to carry along hand grenades and demolition
 tools, the latter being selected in conformity with the results of
 the reconnaissance.

 The regulations state that to have captured a position does not
 suffice; that only the pursuit and dispersion of the enemy makes the
 victory complete. The troops that have penetrated into the hostile
 position are to continue the advance until they again find a field
 of fire, whereupon they are to fire upon the retreating enemy. The
 troops which do not take part in this fire are to re-form quickly,
 secure the captured position, take requisite measures for security,
 and make preparations to meet any hostile counter-attack. Troops are
 not to be assembled in large bodies at points exposed to hostile
 artillery fire. As soon as the enemy has gotten out of range, all the
 troops are promptly to resume the forward movement, and are to pursue
 him vigorously so far as due regard for cohesion and order permits.

 =Intrenching tools= are to be used in attacks on fortified positions,
 and in strengthening ground captured from the enemy.


DEFENSE.

 In defense, the Japanese regulations, like the German, provide
 for economical occupation of the front (group fortifications) and
 a general reserve, which is to be used offensively or to protect
 the flanks. Dummy intrenchments, patrols, and outposts are to make
 it difficult for the enemy to gain information of the defensive
 position. The Japanese views in regard to =advanced positions= are
 not so pronounced as the German, for, while their regulations mention
 the combat of the outposts pushed forward from the position, the
 danger of advanced positions is not especially emphasized.

 The training of the soldier is to be such that even after he has
 fired away all of his ammunition, he will still defend his position
 with the bayonet.

 Nothing is said in regard to the distance of the infantry position
 from that of the artillery. If information is received that the
 attacker has made a lodgment during the night in the assaulting
 position, small detachments are to advance and prevent him from
 strengthening his position.


THE RUSSIAN DRILL REGULATIONS OF 1907.

 The present regulations only treat of the formal matters of training
 and combat.


THE SWISS DRILL REGULATIONS OF 1908.


ATTACK.

 There is considerable similarity between the Swiss and the German
 regulations. The keynote is the offensive. The purpose of the
 combat and the condition of the troops are to govern the commander
 in deciding whether to stand on the defensive or to attack. The
 regulations state that decisive results are only offered by the
 attack; that considerations of a presumable hostile superiority and
 other apparently unfavorable conditions should not diminish the
 energy of the attack; and that the decision to launch the troops
 should never be made dependent upon the receipt of reports in regard
 to the enemy.

 The offensive is invariably to be assumed, unless the situation
 or the mission compel the force to stand on the defensive. The
 regulations state that, in attack, success does not rest alone upon
 superiority of fire and superiority of numbers; but that an impetuous
 advance and an unswerving determination to win are of just as much
 importance. The conduct of the Swiss attack varies, depending upon
 whether it is made in a rencontre or on a position prepared for
 defense.

 The views entertained in regard to the =rencontre= coincide with
 the German views. The regulations say that the result of the
 reconnaissance should not be awaited, because success depends largely
 upon prompt action. The commander may launch parts of his main body
 in succession, as soon as they arrive, when the force is operating
 in close country, when it is necessary to gain ground quickly on
 debouching from a defile, or when the enemy makes an impetuous
 advance. The commander is to direct all his efforts toward throwing
 the enemy upon the defensive, and then to launch the main body as an
 entity.

 The Swiss regulations, similar to those of the Japanese, only
 discuss the =attack on a fortified position=; various modifications
 of the attack, depending upon the preparations made by the enemy,
 are authorized. Advantage is to be taken of the cover afforded by
 darkness, and an extensive use is to be made of =intrenching tools=.
 The regulations state that an assault by day only has a chance of
 succeeding when the defender is completely subdued, and when only
 insignificant obstacles and defenses are encountered. When this is
 not the case, the day is to be used for making preparations for the
 attack, and the night for executing it.


DEFENSE.

 The regulations consider the involuntary defense in a rencontre; the
 deliberately prepared defense seeking a decision and contemplating
 an assumption of the offensive; the defense for the purpose of
 gaining time; and the occupation of a position in readiness, when the
 direction in which the hostile attack will be made is still in doubt,
 or when the commander intends to assail the enemy while the latter
 is in the act of deploying. In the =defense seeking a decision=,
 advanced positions are not to be used, because it is believed that
 the employment of detachments of troops in front of the defensive
 position will weaken the latter, and a hostile enveloping attack will
 soon force the advanced troops to fall back upon the main position.
 The regulations point out that if the advanced troops are supported
 by fire from the main position, the latter will be prematurely
 disclosed to the assailant. The employment of advanced troops is,
 however, considered justifiable to hold defiles, to deceive the
 enemy, or to support the cavalry.

 The works of a position are not to be continuous, but are to be
 constructed in groups. Infantry positions over which artillery is to
 fire are not to be less than 500 m. in front of the latter.




XV. THE EXPENDITURE AND SUPPLY OF AMMUNITION.[494]

   [494] Lieutenant-Colonel KOVARIK, _Versuch eines kriegsbrauchbaren
 Systems für den Munitionsersatz im Infanteriekampf_, Berlin, 1903.


1. HISTORICAL SKETCH.

The question of ammunition supply in action is of vital importance to
the infantry. To solve it correctly means to assure the success of the
infantry in fire action. The first question that needs consideration
is, whether the experiences of past wars show that the ammunition at
present carried by the infantry is sufficient, under all circumstances,
even when ammunition columns cannot reach the battlefield in time
because all the roads are choked with troops.

 For our purpose, it is sufficient to go back as far as the
 =Franco-German war=, in which breechloaders were used for the
 first time against breechloaders. Every German soldier carried 80
 cartridges, and the 6-horse battalion ammunition wagons carried 20
 additional rounds per man.[495]

   [495] Historical data given by D. GÜNTHER in _Die Entwickelung der
 Feuertaktik der Infanterie_, 1902.

 When one considers the total number of cartridges expended during any
 campaign, it seems impossible that a shortage of ammunition could
 ever have taken place. In the =Franco-German war=, the expenditure
 of ammunition in the Ist Bavarian Army Corps amounted to 4,163,000
 rounds (166 per rifle); in the IInd Army Corps, 1,105,600 rounds (44
 per rifle); and in the Saxon Army Corps, 1,450,000 rounds (about
 58 per rifle). The compilation of a table, showing the amount of
 ammunition expended in the Prussian army, was begun, but was soon
 discontinued, as it was found that the necessary data were lacking,
 the only information available being the record of the number of
 rounds issued by the reserve ammunition parks. The troops sent to
 the field army from the depot battalions, must have brought with
 them in each case a very considerable amount of ammunition, as each
 man carried 80 rounds, but no records are available to show how
 much ammunition was forwarded in this way. Furthermore, there is no
 record of the number of rounds actually expended and of the amount
 of ammunition lost or left on the dead and wounded. It is well known,
 that in the long periods, during which no engagement had taken place,
 an enormous amount of ammunition was lost on marches and in bivouacs.
 This applies likewise to battlefields. The commander of an ammunition
 column had his men pick up 22,000 rounds of needle gun ammunition in
 unbroken packages on the battlefield of =Hühnerwasser=.

 A shortage of ammunition first manifested itself where the troops,
 on removing their knapsacks, had neglected to take out the tin boxes
 filled with ammunition (for example in the 12th Jäger-Battalion at
 =Sedan=),[496] or where the ammunition wagons had been sent to the
 rear with the field train (for example in the 50th Infantry, on
 January 19th, 1871, in the battle at =Mont Valérien=, and in the 38th
 Brigade, at the battle of =Beaune la Rolande=).[497]

   [496] _Gen. St. W._, II, p. 1175.

   [497] HÖNIG, _Volkskrieg_, II, p. 259.

 The regimental histories contain only a few statements in regard
 to the amount of ammunition expended in the various engagements.
 Moreover, these statements are only approximations and, as a rule,
 cannot lay claim to trustworthiness.

 The amount of ammunition expended in the opening battles of the war
 was very small, due to the training and fighting methods of the
 Prussian infantry, and to the support it received from the artillery.
 Moreover, the short range of the rifle prohibited long range firing.

 “In order to hold its own against the intensity and long range of
 the hostile fire, the German infantry was compelled to fire more
 rapidly and at longer ranges than it had intended. In addition, the
 difficulties of fire control and fire direction were frequently
 increased on account of the tremendous loss of leaders. Under these
 circumstances, so much ammunition was expended that, among the troops
 fighting in the first line, the ammunition carried by the men was
 no more than enough. This explains why it not infrequently happened
 that the fighting efficiency of the infantry was impaired by a lack
 of ammunition. The first general shortage of ammunition occurred
 at the battle of =Mars-la-Tour= in the infantry of the IIIrd Army
 Corps.”[498]

   [498] _Gen. St. W._, V, p. 1460.

 On August 16th, at the battle of =Vionville=, the Prussian IIIrd Army
 Corps, whose effective strength was 21,050 rifles, expended 720,486
 cartridges, which corresponds to only 34.5 rounds per rifle; yet,
 in spite of this, the ammunition ran short. During the lull in the
 battle at noon, by removing the cartridges from the dead and wounded,
 each man in the 35th Infantry[499] was again supplied with about 200
 rounds of ammunition, which were then expended in the course of the
 afternoon, so that toward evening another shortage occurred.

   [499] _Geschichte des Regiments Nr. 35_, p. 32.

 The following figures in regard to the expenditure of ammunition
 during the battle of =Vionville= are taken from _Kriegsgeschichtliche
 Beispiele_, 8 and 9, by Major KUNZ:

 IInd Bn. Leib Regt.   12,749 rounds for  850 rifles, or  15 per rifle.
 Ist Bn. 40th Inf.     35,000   „     „   450   „     „   78  „    „
 IInd Bn. 40th Inf.     6,650   „     „   350   „     „   19  „    „
 IIIrd Bn. 40th Inf.    4,520   „     „   300   „     „   15  „    „

 A very annoying shortage of ammunition occurred in those parts of the
 Leib Regiment which were with the 72nd and 40th Infantry Regiments in
 front of the wood. The retained echelons in the wood had sufficient
 ammunition, but the troops in front lacked the means wherewith to
 inform the retained units of the shortage. In the 11th and 72nd
 Infantry Regiments a serious shortage of ammunition occurred after
 they had been engaged but a short time. (In a little less than two
 hours, the 72nd Infantry suffered the following percentage of losses:
 Ist Battalion, 53.2%; Füsilier Battalion, 48.2%).[500]

   [500] For data in regard to the expenditure of ammunition at
 Beaumont, see HOPFFGARTEN-HEIDLER, _Beaumont_, p. 184.

 The defense of the stone wall at =Buzanval= by the 50th Infantry
 (German), on January 19th, 1871, was one of the most obstinate
 defensive fights of the war. The numerical superiority of the enemy
 at this point was overwhelming and his troops were excellent,
 nevertheless the regiment maintained the same splendid fire
 discipline it had already exhibited at Lundby. The fight lasted nine
 hours. In his history of the regiment (p. 350), Lieutenant-General v.
 Boguslawski says:

 “The number of cartridges fired can no longer be accurately
 determined. Only the war diary of the IInd Battalion contains a note
 showing that 14,206 rounds were expended. As the 5th Company did not
 fire at all, and the 7th Company was only partially engaged, by far
 the greater portion of the ammunition must have been expended by the
 6th and 8th Companies.” The IInd Battalion, like the rest, has no
 record showing what ammunition was supplied to it during the battle.
 To cite an example: The 12th Company received about 3,000 rounds of
 ammunition during the fight. As the strength of this company was 180
 men in round numbers, each man received 17 additional cartridges.
 He therefore had 97 rounds available, including the ammunition
 originally supplied him.

 “Now, as each man still had an average of 5 cartridges on going into
 billets, he must have expended 92 rounds. From this we may assume
 that during the nine hours’ fight, he fired a little more than ten
 rounds per hour.”

 In the battle of =Beaune la Rolande=, some of the companies of the
 56th Infantry near Romainville had expended all their ammunition. In
 the 38th Brigade, only the Ist Battalion, 57th Infantry, was able
 to replenish its ammunition directly from the ammunition wagons
 near Romainville. The defenders of Beaune did not receive such
 assistance however, as only one ammunition wagon was brought up (by
 the Füsilier-Battalion, 16th Infantry), toward the close of the
 battle, for the units engaged there. The ammunition it contained was
 distributed among the men, but was not used. Organizations belonging
 to the IIIrd Army Corps turned over some of their ammunition, but,
 in general, the brigade had to rely practically on the ammunition
 carried by the men, for all the ammunition wagons had driven off at
 the beginning of the battle. Consequently, this battle was fought
 almost exclusively with the ammunition carried by the men--about
 80 rounds per rifle. As the French attack was not simultaneously
 directed against the whole front of Beaune, lulls occurred in the
 fight, which enabled the officers to send a supply of ammunition
 to the most seriously threatened points of the line. In a well
 disciplined organization, it is not difficult to send ammunition
 promptly to the most seriously threatened points by simply passing
 it along the line. This was actually done at Beaune la Rolande. In
 consequence of this redistribution, at some points in the cemetery,
 men fired as many as 200 rounds each, but others fired only 40 or
 less; the result, however, was the same, for the ammunition was
 almost exclusively supplied from that carried by the men--80 rounds
 per rifle. Moreover, a great many cartridges, and even unopened
 packages of ammunition, were found, on November 29th, in the position
 occupied by the 38th Brigade.

 The following figures give an idea of the amount of ammunition
 expended at =St. Privat= by the 2nd Regiment of the Guard. On August
 19th, the Ist Battalion required 27,340, the IInd Battalion 17,820,
 and the Füsilier-Battalion 7,870 rounds to replenish their ammunition
 supply. When the heavy losses suffered by this regiment are taken
 into account, the average expenditure of ammunition cannot be
 considered excessive.[501]

   [501] _Geschichte des 2. Garde-Regiments zu Fusz_, p. 250.

 At 10:30 P. M., on August 18th, the Rifle Battalion of the Guard
 managed to supply each one of its men with 20 rounds of ammunition,
 without drawing upon the contents of the ammunition wagons, which
 were left intact.[502]

   [502] _Geschichte des Gardeschützen Bataillons_, p. 121.

 The expenditure of ammunition on the French side was considerably
 greater in all the battles. At =Champigny=, every French infantry
 soldier carried 118 rounds of ammunition, which did not prove
 sufficient, however, to meet the demand. In the French Army of the
 Rhine, the average expenditure of ammunition from August 6th to 31st
 was 30 rounds, and in the fights of August 16th and 18th, 13 to 27
 rounds per rifle. In individual cases, the expenditure of ammunition
 was far in excess of these figures. The men of Grenier’s Division,
 against which the attack of the 38th Brigade was directed, claim
 that they fired as many as 150 rounds apiece, on August 16th. In
 the evening, at the close of the battle, the commanding general
 of the IVth Army Corps reported a shortage of ammunition.[503]
 Shortage of ammunition caused Marshal Bazaine to fall back to Metz
 on August 17th. Notwithstanding the proximity of the fortress of
 Metz, the French VIth Corps was unable to replenish its supply of
 ammunition before it was attacked by the Prussian Guard. Detailed
 information available in regard to the ammunition expended by the
 25th Infantry (French)[504] shows that each man had only 30 instead
 of 90 cartridges. (This was the regiment attacked by the Franz and
 3rd Guard Regiments, who lost 2,160 men--9% hits). The statement made
 in the history of the 2nd Guard Regiment (p. 233), that every French
 soldier had 300 rounds of ammunition available on August 18th, cannot
 be substantiated by French records.

   [503] HÖNIG, _Taktik der Zukunft_, p. 159.

   [504] PAQUIÉ, _Le tir en terrain varié_, p. 39.

 The expenditure of ammunition in the =Russo-Turkish war of 1877-78=,
 amounted to 33 rounds per rifle and carbine on the Russian side.
 The following detailed statements in regard to the expenditure
 of ammunition are available. In the engagement at =Aiaslar=, on
 August 23rd, 1877, the Sofia Regiment expended 94 rounds, and at
 =Karahassankioi=, the 140th Infantry expended 155 rounds per man.
 On December 28th, 1877, the 13th Rifle Battalion expended 122
 rounds per man. In this connection, it may be remarked that the
 Russian infantryman of that day carried 60 rounds of ammunition in
 his cartridge boxes. The ammunition carts carried 55 additional
 rounds per man, and the ammunition parks 62. If, as prescribed by
 the regulations at that time, only one ammunition wagon followed an
 organization into action, each infantryman had 78 rounds available,
 and each man of a rifle battalion 106 rounds.

 In front of =Plevna=, on July 20th, 1877, the Russians expended in
 six hours all the ammunition carried by the men and by the ammunition
 carts. On July 30th, during the second assault on =Plevna=, they
 expended in four hours all the ammunition carried by the men.[505]
 In the engagement at =Lovtcha=, the 3rd Rifle Brigade only fired
 during the pursuit. The brigade commander explained afterwards that
 his ammunition had run short nevertheless. During the advance, the
 ammunition wagons did not follow in rear of the organizations to
 which they belonged, and no provision had been made for bringing up
 the necessary ammunition.[506]

   [505] Details given in the German translation of the Russian _Gen.
 St. W._ (Vienna), III, pp. 330-331.

   [506] KUROPATKIN-KRAHMER, _Kritische Rückblicke auf den
 Russisch-Türkischen Krieg_, I, p. 88.

 On September 1st, 1877, the regiments which made the fruitless attack
 on the =Omar Bey Tabia=, expended the following ammunition:

 63rd  Infantry[507]    55,296 rounds, or  21 per rifle
 119th     „   [507]    99,744   „     „   43  „    „
 64th      „            24,650   „     „   10  „    „
 115th     „            45,360   „     „   24  „    „

   [507] These two regiments were only engaged from 1 to 1¹⁄₂ hours.

 In the Kasan Regiment (No. 64), which had expended less ammunition
 than any of the others on this day, the ammunition began to run short
 at the moment when the successful and decisive counter-attack of the
 Turks commenced. The same misfortune befell other organizations,
 after the fire fight had lasted but a comparatively short time, as
 apparently they had neglected to remove the cartridges from the dead
 and wounded.

 During the assault on =Scheinovo=, on January 9th, 1878, each man of
 the 11th Rifle Battalion fired 120 rounds in four hours. This is an
 average of 2 rounds per man, per minute.

 The Turks took more advantage of the rapidity of fire of their rifles
 than did the Russians.[508] It is said that at =Gorni Dubniac=, each
 man had 800-900 rounds of ammunition available, and it is a fact,
 that the force of 3,570 men garrisoning the group of works placed
 3,533 Russians out of action, in a fight lasting 9¹⁄₂ hours, while
 the Turkish losses in killed and wounded only amounted to 1,280
 men. During the attack, some Turks managed to fire more than 100
 rounds apiece. Kuropatkin found 120 empty cartridge shells beside
 a dead Turkish soldier.[509] In the engagement at =Tashkessen=
 (31st December, 1877),[510] which lasted eight hours, the Prisrend
 Battalion expended 292, the Tuzla Battalion 275, and a Rifle
 Battalion 263 rounds per man (30 rounds per man, per hour).

   [508] Each Turkish battalion was followed into action by 30 pack
 mules carrying 60,000 rounds of ammunition, and each man carried from
 100 to 120 rounds on his person.

   [509] KUROPATKIN-KRAHMER, _Kritische Rückblicke auf den
 Russisch-Türkischen Krieg_, I, p. 170.

   [510] BAKER, _War in Bulgaria_, II, p. 160.

 There is very little information available in regard to the
 expenditure of ammunition during the =Russo-Japanese war=. The
 Russian infantryman carried 120 rounds of ammunition, the 8
 one-horse ammunition carts carried 6,600 rounds per company, and
 the 2 two-horse ammunition wagons of the battalions 14,400 rounds
 each. Assuming the strength of a company as 200, this would give 210
 rounds per man. In the engagement at =Hamatan= (=Yalu=), several
 Russian organizations ran entirely out of ammunition. A number of
 rifle companies (the 6th Company, 11th Infantry, and the 2nd, 3rd
 and 4th, 12th Infantry), were able to replenish their supply without
 difficulty from the ammunition wagons. The following is taken from a
 thoroughly reliable report published in the _Kölnische Zeitung_ of
 September 24th, 1905:

 During the battle of =Liao Yang=, which lasted six days, the 138th
 Infantry fired 99,460, and the 139th Infantry 96,040 rounds. On
 September 1st, the 137th Infantry expended 189,000 rounds, in other
 words, nearly twice as much in one day as either of the other
 regiments expended in six. This excessive expenditure of ammunition
 was due to the very severe attacks which this regiment had to
 withstand on that day. These attacks were repeated on the next day
 and the regiment expended 169,000 rounds of ammunition. From October
 13th to 18th, at =Linshinpu=, the 139th Infantry expended 351,800
 rounds. During this engagement the Japanese succeeded in getting
 within 10 m. of the Russian lines. Thirty bodies were picked up at
 15 paces, and 580 bodies from 100 to 150 paces from the Russian
 position. The 139th Infantry lost 54 men killed, and 6 officers and
 250 men wounded. Major V. Tettau[511] states that during the battle
 of =Liao Yang= (30th August, 1904), the 36th Infantry expended
 416,800 rounds of ammunition, and the 34th Infantry (two battalions),
 250,000 rounds, or for 4,200 Russian rifles an average of not less
 than 160 rounds per rifle.

   [511] _Achtzehn Monate mit Russlands Heeren in der Mandschurei._

 The Japanese infantryman carried 120 rounds, and each company had, in
 addition, one two-wheeled ammunition cart carrying 16,000 rounds of
 ammunition. When packs were removed, each man carried a bag in which
 were packed three days’ rations, and from 200 to 250 cartridges. The
 Japanese infantry invariably followed the principle that each man
 should be supplied with as much ammunition as possible before going
 into action. In the engagement at =Kinchau= (26th November, 1904),
 the 1st Infantry Division expended 64, the 3rd 54, and the 4th 143
 rounds per man of the original effective strength.[512]

   [512] _Streffleur_, _Einzelschriften_, I. p. 224.

Although, according to the examples cited, 100 to 150 rounds of
ammunition per man will in general suffice in battle, cases may arise
where troops could fire a greater number of rounds to good advantage.
This must be taken into account when determining the number of rounds
with which the infantryman should be supplied--on his person and in the
ammunition wagons. Moreover, it must be remembered that the supply can
be replenished without difficulty from the ammunition columns after a
battle, so long as it is still possible to assign a separate road to
each army corps. When this is no longer practicable, the ammunition
columns will encounter almost insurmountable difficulties in supplying
the infantry with ammunition.


AMMUNITION SUPPLY OF THE PRINCIPAL ARMIES OF THE WORLD.

 ========++=======+=====+=======+============+======+=======++
 ~Coun-  ||  Year | Cal-| Weight|   System   |Weight| Weight||
 try.~   ||   of  |iber.|of car-| of loading |  of  |   of  ||
         || con-  |     |tridge.|            | clip.|  clip ||
         || struc-|     |       |            |      |filled.||
         || tion. |     |       |            |      |       ||
         ||       | mm. |   g.  |            |  g.  |  g.   ||
 --------++-------+-----+-------+------------+------+-------++
 ~GER-   ||  1905 | 7.9 | 27.19 |Mag. in rear|   7  |  126  ||
 MANY~   ||   S.  |     |       |of barrel,  |      |       ||
         ||       |     |       |loaded with |      |       ||
         ||       |     |       |clip holding|      |       ||
         ||       |     |       |5 car-      |      |       ||
         ||       |     |       |tridges.    |      |       ||
 --------++-------+-----+-------+------------+------+-------++
 ~AUS-   ||  1895 | 8.  | 28.35 |Mag. in rear|Frame | 158.25||
 TRIA~   ||       |     |       |of barrel,  | 16.5 |       ||
         ||       |     |       |loaded with |      |       ||
         ||       |     |       |frame       |      |       ||
         ||       |     |       |holding 5   |      |       ||
         ||       |     |       |cartridges. |      |       ||
 --------++-------+-----+-------+------------+------+-------++
 ~ITALY~ ||  1891 | 6.5 | 22.   |Mag. in rear| 12   | 138   ||
         ||Car-   |     |       |of barrel,  |      |       ||
         ||can-   |     |       |loaded with |      |       ||
         ||Mann-  |     |       |frame       |      |       ||
         ||licher.|     |       |holding 6   |      |       ||
         ||       |     |       |cartridges. |      |       ||
 --------++-------+-----+-------+------------+------+-------++
 ~ENG-   ||  1908 | 7.71| 27.5  |Mag. in rear| Clip | 150   ||
 LAND~   ||Lee-   |     |       |of barrel,  | 12.5 |       ||
         ||En-    |     |       |loaded with |      |       ||
         ||field. |     |       |clip holding|      |       ||
         ||       |     |       |5 car-      |      |       ||
         ||       |     |       |tridges.    |      |       ||
         ||       |     |       |[514]       |      |       ||
 --------++-------+-----+-------+------------+------+-------++
 ~FRANCE~|| 1886- | 8.  | 29.   |Mag. under  |  --  |  --   ||
         ||  98,  |     |       |barrel, car-|      |       ||
         ||1905 D |     |       |tridges     |      |       ||
         ||Lebel. |     |       |loaded      |      |       ||
         ||       |     |       |singly.     |      |       ||
 --------++-------+-----+-------+------------+------+-------++
 ~RUSSIA~||  1891 | 7.62| 25.812|Mag. in rear|  9.6 | 137   ||
 [516]   ||(Three |     |       |of barrel,  |      |       ||
         ||line   |     |       |loaded with |      |       ||
         ||rifle).|     |       |clip holding|      |       ||
         ||       |     |       |5 car-      |      |       ||
         ||       |     |       |tridges.    |      |       ||
 --------++-------+-----+-------+------------+------+-------++
 ~JAPAN~ ||  1897 | 6.50| 22.4  |Mag. in rear|  8.5 | 120   ||
 [516]   ||Arisaka|     |       |of barrel,  |      |       ||
         ||(Meidji|     |       |loaded with |      |       ||
         ||  80). |     |       |clip holding|      |       ||
         ||       |     |       |5 car-      |      |       ||
         ||       |     |       |tridges.    |      |       ||
 --------++-------+-----+-------+------------+------+-------++

 ========++==================++===========++=================++
 ~Coun-  || Number of rounds || Ammunition|| Number of rounds||
 try.~   || carried by a man.||   wagons. || carried by ammu-||
         ||                  ||           || nition wagons.  ||
         ||                  ||           ||             No. ||
         ||            Weight||           ||       per rifle.||
         ||     No.      kg. ||           ||No.         [513]||
 --------++------------+-----++-----------++-----------+-----++
 ~GER-   ||     150    |     ||4 Company  ||   14,400  | 77  ||
 MANY~   ||N. C. O.  45|     ||ammunition ||           |     ||
         ||Trum-       |4.5  ||wagons.    ||           |     ||
         ||peter     90|     ||           ||           |     ||
         ||Drummer   30|     ||           ||           |     ||
 --------++------------+-----++-----------++-----------+-----++
 ~AUS-   ||    120     |     ||4 Company  ||   9,450   | 47.2||
 TRIA~   ||N. C. O.  40| 4.31||ammunition ||           |     ||
         ||            |     ||wagons.    ||           |     ||
 --------++------------+-----++-----------++-----------+-----++
 ~ITALY~ ||    162     |     ||Infantry of the line,   |     ||
         ||Sergt. and  |3.736||in field train          | 24  ||
         ||Trum-       |     ||Alpini, on pack animals |     ||
         ||peter    126|     ||and on carts            |244  ||
         ||Inf.        |     ||                        |     ||
         ||Pioneers 108|     ||                        |     ||
 --------++------------+-----++------------------------+-----++
 ~ENG-   ||    115     |3.48 ||8 Pack animals          |250  ||
 LAND~   ||            |     ||8 Ammunition wagons     |     ||
 --------++------------+-----++-----------++-----------+-----++
 ~FRANCE~||    120     |     ||4 Company  ||   16,384  | 82  ||
         ||N. C. O.  56|3.48 ||ammunition ||     or    |     ||
         ||            |     ||wagons.    ||   19,000  |     ||
         ||            |     ||           ||    [515]  |     ||
 --------++------------+-----++-----------++-----------+-----++
 ~RUSSIA~||    120     |3.33 ||24 am.     ||In each of |     ||
 [516]   ||            |     ||carts:     ||the 8 1-   |     ||
         ||            |     ||Ist        ||horse carts|     ||
         ||            |     ||echelon, 8 ||   6000    |=36  ||
         ||            |     ||1-horse    ||In each of |     ||
         ||            |     ||carts      ||the 16 2-  |     ||
         ||            |     ||IInd       ||horse carts|     ||
         ||            |     ||echelon, 16||  14,400   |=30  ||
         ||            |     ||2-horse    ||           | --  ||
         ||            |     ||carts      ||           | 66  ||
 --------++------------+-----++-----------++-----------+-----++
 ~JAPAN~ ||    120     |2.9  ||Each com-  ||  16,000   | 80  ||
 [516]   ||            |     ||pany has   ||           |     ||
         ||            |     ||one cart.  ||           |     ||
 --------++------------+-----++-----------++-----------+-----++

 ========++===============++=============+===========
 ~Coun-  ||Reserve supply.||   Supply    |   Supply
 try.~   ||               ||  available  | available
         ||               ||    in a     |   in an
         ||               ||  division.  |army corps.
 --------++---------------++-------------+-----------
 ~GER-   ||Each of the 34 ||     150     |    150
 MANY~   ||am. wagons of  ||      77     |     77
         ||the 4 inf. am. ||     ---     |    144
         ||columns of an  ||     227     |    ---
         ||army corps,    ||             |    361
         ||carries 23,000 ||             |
         ||rounds or 144  ||             |
         ||per rifle.     ||             |
 --------++---------------++-------------+-----------
 ~AUS-   ||Each division  ||16 battalions|3 divisions
 TRIA~   ||has one div.   ||of 800 rifles|      224
         ||am. park of 30 ||each.        |       18
         ||am. wagons,    ||     120     |      ---
         ||which carry    ||      47.2   |about 242
         ||769,500 rounds ||      57     |
         ||or 57 per      ||     -----   |
         ||rifle.         ||     224.    |
         ||The corps am.  ||             |
         ||park same      ||             |
         ||strength as a  ||             |
         ||div. park.     ||             |
 --------++---------------++------+------+-----------
 ~ITALY~ ||In the 3rd sec-||Line: | Alpi-|Inf. of the
         ||tion of the am.||      |  ni: |line:
         ||column, 40     ||  162 |  162 |    162
         ||rounds per     ||   24 |  244 |     24
         ||rifle;         ||   40 |   90 |     40
         ||In the Arty.   ||  --- |  --- |     45
         ||park of the    ||  226 |  496 |    ---
         ||army corps, 45 ||      |      |    271
         ||rounds per     ||      |      |
         ||rifle;         ||      |      |
         ||In the Alpini  ||      |      |
         ||am. column, 90 ||      |      |
         ||rounds per     ||      |      |
         ||rifle.         ||      |      |
 --------++---------------++------+------+-----------
 ~ENG-   ||In the division||     115     |400 rounds
 LAND~   ||am. column, 125||     250     |per 1,000
         ||rounds per     ||     125     |rifles.
         ||rifle.         ||     ---     |
 --------++---------------++-------------+-----------
 ~FRANCE~||In the corps   ||     120     |    110
         ||am. park:      ||      82     |    ---
         ||Ist            ||     ---     |    312
         ||echelon    44.2||     202     |
         ||IInd           ||             |
         ||echelon    66.2||             |
 --------++---------------++-------------+-----------
 ~RUSSIA~||In the light   ||     120     |    267
 [516]   ||Arty. park   81||      66     |    164
         ||In the reserve ||      81     |    ---
         ||park        164||     ---     |    431
         ||            ---||     267     |
         ||            245||             |
 --------++---------------++-------------+-----------
 ~JAPAN~ ||      --       ||     --      |     --
 [516]   ||               ||             |
 --------++---------------++-------------+-----------

 By way of comparison with the above, the following table shows the
 number of rounds to 3 kg. of the ammunition for the several rifles
 specified:

              { Prussian smooth-bore infantry musket         85 rounds
 Paper Shells { Prussian rifled infantry musket (new model)  55   „
              { Prussian needle gun M/41-69                  78   „
              { French chassepot rifle M/66                  90   „

              { Infantry rifle M/71                          69   „
 Metal Shells { Swiss rifle, M/67, 69/71, 81                 98   „
              { Rifle, M/98 with loading clips              103   „

 The cartridges are carried as follows by the soldier:

 =Germany=: =45= rounds in each of the two cartridge boxes in front,
            and =60= in the knapsack;

 =Austria=: =20= rounds in each of the two cartridge boxes in front,
            and =60= in the knapsack;

 =Russia=:  =30= rounds in each of the two cartridge boxes attached to
            the waist belt, in a breast cartridge box, and in a reserve
            cartridge box attached to the knapsack;

 =France=:  =120= rounds, in three cartridge boxes, two in front, and
            one behind;

 =England=: In eight pockets attached to the waist belt, each holding
            =15= rounds (in addition each soldier carries a shoulder
            belt holding =50= rounds);

 =Japan=:   =30= rounds in each of the cartridge boxes in front, and
            =60= rounds in the cartridge box behind.


2. REGULATIONS GOVERNING THE SUPPLY OF AMMUNITION IN THE VARIOUS ARMIES.


GERMANY.

(Pars. 479-482 F.S.R.)

On the march, it is best to assemble all the company ammunition wagons
of the battalions, as this renders supervision easier, and enables
the battalion commander to regulate the replenishment of ammunition.
Companies acting alone, as well as those forming the support of an
advance guard, are followed by their ammunition wagons. It does not
seem desirable to unite the ammunition wagons of a regiment or of a
brigade on account of the distance separating the different battalions.
During the march to the battlefield, the ammunition should be taken
out of the knapsacks, and the contents of the ammunition wagons
distributed among the men. The men carry this extra ammunition in their
haversacks and in their coat and trousers’ pockets, etc.

 The two-horse company ammunition wagon, Model 1897, has a width of
 track of 1.53 m., and, when empty, weighs 450 kg. Compared with the
 ammunition wagon Model C, 1887, which was originally designed to
 carry ammunition in boxes, it is lighter by 75 kg., and can be turned
 within a shorter radius. The wagon body is provided with double doors
 in front and in rear. The interior is divided into four compartments
 (to be emptied separately), each capable of holding 16 bundles of
 cartridges placed on end. Each bundle contains 15 packages of 15
 cartridges in clips each. Each bundle of 225 cartridges weighs 7.25
 kg.

 As three bundles of cartridges are to be carried by one man,
 according to the Field Service Regulations (par. 480), 1
 non-commissioned officer and 21 men are detailed to unload the
 ammunition wagon. The unloading is managed as follows: Four men take
 post on each side of the wagon, two handing out the bundles to the
 other two, who lay them on the ground. The remaining men place the
 bundles in piles of three in such a manner that the carrying loops of
 two in each pile can be interlaced and held together by a stick or a
 bayonet. An ammunition wagon can be emptied in this manner in four
 minutes. The two ammunition bundles tied together are slung over the
 left shoulder, the rifle is slung over the right shoulder, and the
 third bundle is carried in the right hand. In this way, a man can
 carry 21.8 kg.

Each man is issued 60 to 75 cartridges from the ammunition wagon.
These weigh from 1.8 to 2.4 kg. When issued too soon, this additional
burden causes considerable inconvenience, and consequently reduces
the marching power of the men. The leader must also decide what shall
be done with the ammunition in case it has been issued prematurely,
and the troops fail to get into action. As soon as the ammunition
wagons are emptied, they are sent to the rear in charge of the mounted
wagonmaster, and refilled from the ammunition columns. When refilled,
they rejoin their proper organizations. If requested, ammunition must
be issued to any body of troops.

On the battlefield, ammunition wagons, unless they have been emptied,
follow the movements of the several companies and take up a position
under cover, indicated by the wagonmaster, as close as possible to the
firing line--never more than 800 m. in rear of it. In urgent cases,
this must be done without regard to losses. The firing line is supplied
with ammunition, when practicable, by the reinforcements sent forward.
When the firing line is about to run short of ammunition, this fact is
communicated to the troops in rear by repeatedly making the signal “m”.
This signal, when made to the front by the troops in rear, signifies,
“ammunition is coming up at once.”

In exceptional cases, when ammunition must be sent to the firing line
by individual men, the latter should invariably be detailed from troops
in rear which have not as yet been engaged. These men must endeavor to
reach the firing line by rushes or by crawling, and must then remain
with that line.

It is the duty of the battalion commander to see that the ammunition
taken from the ammunition wagons is promptly replaced. The higher
commanders would do well to provide a reserve supply of ammunition,
until the arrival of the ammunition columns, by assembling the
ammunition wagons of the troops held in reserve. (Par. 482 F. S. R.).
It will also be advisable to assign some of the ammunition wagons
of the troops held in reserve to the organizations who will, in all
probability, expend a large amount of ammunition.

The ammunition should be removed from the dead and wounded. If this is
done by the men of an advancing skirmish line, there is danger that the
forward movement will be retarded, and that some of the men will take
advantage of this opportunity to make themselves “scarce.” Officers
and men should endeavor to replenish ammunition at every opportunity,
without awaiting specific orders to that effect, and, in general, see
that not only the prescribed number of rounds, but, on the contrary, as
much ammunition as possible is on hand in the organization.

When the force is to stand on the defensive, especially if the position
to be occupied has been prepared for defense, ammunition should
be deposited all along the firing line. (Cartridge boxes or other
utensils may be used as receptacles). It is advisable to use first the
cartridges carried in caps, haversacks, coat and trousers’ pockets. The
contents of the right cartridge box are saved for decisive moments when
great rapidity of fire is essential. In replenishing ammunition, the
right cartridge box is filled first, then the left, and the surplus is
accommodated in haversack, coat and trousers’ pockets.


AUSTRIA.

(Par. 70 Regulations of 1903).

 The regulations are extremely thorough and deserve special attention.
 If an engagement is imminent, each private receives 20 additional
 rounds before leaving the bivouac or reserve position, and each
 non-commissioned officer 100 rounds from the company ammunition
 wagon, so that the latter is about half emptied.[517] This brings
 the total amount carried by each soldier up to 140 rounds, and
 increases the load of the privates by 0.71 kg., and that of the
 non-commissioned officers by about 4 kg. When troops go into action,
 the ammunition wagons are assembled and accompany the battalion
 reserve, taking as much advantage of cover as possible, so that the
 attention of the enemy may not be drawn to them. After the battalion
 reserve has been absorbed by the firing line, the ammunition wagons
 accompany the regimental reserve. When exposed to artillery fire, the
 wagons maintain intervals of twenty paces from one another. They are
 either placed under the orders of the battalion adjutant, or of the
 senior supply officer present with them, as may be directed by the
 battalion commander.

   [517] The company ammunition wagon carries 9,450 rounds of
 ammunition, packed in seven compartments. It consists of a body and a
 limber, has a width of track of 1.13 m., and is supplied with eight
 sacks which serve to carry ammunition to the troops. During the day
 its position is indicated by a red flag, and at night by a green
 lantern.

 In attack, it will, as a rule, only be possible to replenish
 ammunition until troops get within about 1,000 paces (750 m.) of the
 enemy. From this point on, however, it will be extremely difficult to
 supply ammunition. Every lull in the fight must be taken advantage
 of to replenish ammunition. The firing line receives a fresh supply
 of ammunition through reinforcements or through small detachments
 under non-commissioned officers sent forward from the reserves. These
 detachments, after distributing the ammunition they have brought
 up, remain with the firing line. The companies engaged in the fire
 fight later take advantage of every opportunity to replenish and to
 redistribute ammunition.

 In defense, all the ammunition wagons may be emptied before the
 action begins, and sent to the rear to be refilled. The ammunition
 should be deposited in the vicinity of the firing line. The
 subsequent replenishment of the supply should be managed as in an
 attack. If ammunition is very urgently needed by the firing line,
 and when no other remedy suggests itself, a part of the ammunition
 of the reserves may be turned over to the firing line. Special
 detachments should be detailed to remove the ammunition from the
 dead and wounded. Wounded men who are able to walk to the dressing
 station, turn over their ammunition to their comrades.

 If another organization requests to be furnished ammunition, the
 entire amount required, or a part thereof, depending upon the urgency
 of the case and the amount available, should be turned over to it.


RUSSIA.[518]

   [518] In each battalion, the ammunition wagon of the 2nd company
 carries 108 explosive cartridges, weighing 200 g. each, and that of
 the 3rd company carries 48 fuzes.

 The ammunition carried in the cartridge boxes of the men may prove
 insufficient during an action. On open ground the ammunition
 wagons, assembled by regiment, accompany the regimental reserve,
 and in covered terrain, they are assembled by battalion, and follow
 the battalion reserve. When practicable, their position is to be
 indicated during the day by red flags placed on their flank, and at
 night by green lanterns. In defense, an adequate supply of ammunition
 should be deposited in rear of the firing line, or should be at
 once distributed among the men. In attack, the ammunition supply of
 the firing line and of the supports is to be replenished when they
 enter ranges under 700 m. The best means of preventing shortage of
 ammunition is to husband it at long ranges. Ammunition wagons are not
 to be emptied and their contents distributed before an action begins;
 on the contrary, the ammunition is to be issued during the fight, one
 wagon after another being emptied. Ammunition may be sent forward
 from the reserve to the firing line, the men who carry it remaining
 with that line. On the other hand--and this seems to be the method
 most frequently employed--men from the firing line may be sent to
 the rear for ammunition. The men of the reserves at once turn over
 one-half of their cartridges to these men, who are then assembled and
 sent forward under the command of a non-commissioned officer. The
 ammunition is carried forward in sacks--so-called “bashlicks.”


FRANCE.

 Each company has one ammunition wagon, which is a part of the combat
 train (_train de combat_), and carries 16,384 Lebel cartridges, and
 36 intrenching tools. It can carry 19,000 rounds of the new “D”
 ammunition,[519] So long as any ammunition remains in the ammunition
 wagons, they remain under all circumstances with their battalion.
 They are assembled in battalion groups on the left flank of their
 battalion. When the battalion is broken up for advance, flank,
 rear guard, or outpost work, they remain with the main body of the
 battalion. When the companies are separated for a protracted period,
 the battalion commander decides whether or not the ammunition
 wagons should accompany their respective companies. The ammunition
 in the wagons is, as a general rule, to be distributed before the
 commencement of an action. If this is impossible when the force
 is taken by surprise, the commander of the group of ammunition
 wagons must bring them up as close as possible under cover, and
 the battalion commander must supervise the distribution of the
 ammunition. In quarters and on the march, the ammunition is to be
 replenished by taking the ammunition from the sick, from the men
 detailed away, or from the supply carried by the baggage wagon.[520]
 The ammunition in the baggage wagon is only to be used when all these
 other sources are exhausted. When an encounter with the enemy may
 be expected, and only a short march is anticipated, the ammunition
 carried in the baggage wagons may be distributed before starting.

   [519] The company ammunition wagon Model 1893 weighs 287 kg.
 when empty, and 770 kg. when filled. It carries 14,400 rounds of
 ammunition (net capacity 48%) or 66 rounds per rifle.

   [520] The baggage wagon weighs 450 kg. when empty, and 1054 kg.
 when loaded. It carries 36 intrenching tools, and a tool chest. Its
 net capacity is 45%. Forty knapsacks may be transported on this wagon
 in lieu of the ammunition.

 Any further replenishment of ammunition is to be ordered by the
 division commander. The empty company ammunition wagons are assembled
 in regimental groups and follow at least 1,000 m. in rear of the
 regimental reserve. At each halt, the wagon train is to prepare for
 defense. The regimental commander is to regulate the distribution of
 the ammunition sent forward by the ammunition columns.

 When this distribution cannot be made for some reason or other, the
 wagons, assembled in groups of four, follow their battalions. It is
 the duty of the battalion commander to keep the firing line supplied
 with ammunition. The contents of the company ammunition wagons are
 not to be replenished from the ammunition columns during an action.
 The ammunition is to be removed from the dead and wounded.

 The source of the ammunition supply is the corps ammunition park,
 which is divided into three echelons, as follows:

 1st echelon consists of two infantry ammunition columns and marches
 at the head of the combat train of the troops engaged;

 IInd echelon consists of three infantry ammunition columns;

 IIIrd echelon carries artillery ammunition only.

 Two infantry ammunition columns of the 1st echelon, which, as a
 rule, constitutes the “ammunition supply center” at the commencement
 of an action, march at the head of the combat train (_train de
 combat_). A half-filled infantry ammunition column must at all times
 be available at this “ammunition supply center.” Ammunition wagons
 of the infantry ammunition column are sent forward at the request
 of the division commander to the position taken up by the company
 ammunition wagons. The latter are generally posted not more than
 1,000 m. in the rear of the fighting line, and parts of each infantry
 ammunition column (usually one ammunition wagon for each battalion)
 are posted by an officer not more than 1,500 m. in rear of these.
 The empty company ammunition wagons are not refilled, the ammunition
 being sent forward directly from the ammunition columns. As soon as
 the infantry ammunition columns are informed which organizations they
 are to supply, they send out non-commissioned officers to locate the
 ammunition wagons of those organizations and establish communication
 with them. The commander of the ammunition column directs where empty
 ammunition wagons are to assemble. In emergencies, wagons of the
 infantry ammunition column may also drive close up to the fighting
 line. In this case, empty wagons assemble near the groups of company
 ammunition wagons, and from there they are sent back in trains to the
 ammunition column to which they belong.

 Every opportunity, such as a lull in the fight, or an abatement of
 the hostile fire, etc., must be utilized to distribute the ammunition
 of the company wagons or of the ammunition column.

 It is prohibited to send wagons or men to the rear for the purpose of
 bringing up ammunition on the battlefield. All men sent forward with
 ammunition should remain in the firing line.


ENGLAND.

 The British infantryman is usually provided with 115, and each
 machine gun with 3,500 rounds of ammunition. Each battalion is, in
 addition, provided with 8 pack animals, each carrying two ammunition
 chests containing 4,400 cartridges (77 kg.), and with 8 ammunition
 wagons.

 On the march, the pack animals and half of the ammunition wagons
 follow immediately in rear of the battalion. The (16) remaining
 wagons form a reserve ammunition column at the disposal of the
 brigade commander, and march at the tail of the brigade. When an
 engagement is anticipated, 50 additional rounds (1.3 kg.) may be
 issued to each man before leaving camp. During an action, one pack
 animal and two ammunition wagons follow each half-battalion. Empty
 company ammunition wagons are refilled from the brigade reserve
 ammunition column. When the wagons of the latter are empty, they are
 replaced by filled wagons from the ammunition column. The teams are
 not transferred with the wagons, but remain with the organization to
 which they belong.

 Ammunition wagons are expected to approach to within about 900
 m. of the firing line, and pack animals to within 450 m. One
 non-commissioned officer and two or three privates are to be detailed
 from each company to bring up ammunition. Each man is to carry a sack
 containing 600 cartridges (16 kg.). That this method of supplying
 ammunition is practicable under fire is shown by the distinguished
 conduct lists for =Paardeberg=, where men were praised or decorated
 for endurance and fearlessness in bringing up ammunition. (See p. 371
 supra). The men who bring up ammunition may be kept in the firing
 line when the ground is devoid of cover.

 The division ammunition columns, although they carry both infantry
 and artillery ammunition, constitute an integral part of the
 artillery battalions.


ITALY.

 When an encounter with the enemy is anticipated, the ammunition
 wagons are to be emptied, the men detailed to carry ammunition are
 to remove their packs, and each one of them is to carry ammunition
 weighing about 7.5 kg.

 The packs are to be removed only in case of urgent necessity.
 When this is ordered, however, the soldier first removes all the
 cartridges and the emergency ration from his pack. The ammunition
 knapsacks, which are always to be taken along, are, however, carried
 in turn by all the soldiers of the company.

 The advancing units that are in need of ammunition, may demand it
 from troops ordered to remain behind. They take along their own
 ammunition carriers. The latter, assembled in a squad, distribute the
 ammunition along the firing line, and remain with that line. In the
 first lull that occurs, they assemble again as a squad and take part
 as such in the action.

 The empty ammunition knapsacks belonging to organizations in reserve
 are to be refilled as rapidly as possible from the ammunition wagons
 sent forward from the ammunition park to the fighting line.

 The ammunition of the dead and wounded is to be removed ind
 distributed among the remaining men. During pauses in the fire, the
 ammunition is to be equalized in all organizations engaged in the
 fire fight.

 The ammunition wagons of the echelons in rear are to approach the
 fighting line as far as the available cover permits. Their position
 is to be indicated by flags. The ammunition carriers are to come to
 these wagons to refill the empty ammunition knapsacks.


3. WHAT DEDUCTIONS MAY BE MADE FROM THE REGULATIONS OF THE VARIOUS
ARMIES.

1. The contents of the ammunition wagons should be distributed at the
commencement of an action. This should not be done too early as the
packing and unpacking of ammunition takes time, and as the soldier
will not march so well when loaded down at the wrong time with 60 to
75 additional cartridges (1.8 to 2.4 kg.), unequally distributed in
haversack and pockets. It is also a good plan to issue as many rounds
of ammunition to the non-commissioned officers as to the men. During a
fight this ammunition can then be distributed to the men.

2. As soon as the ammunition wagons have been refilled from the
ammunition columns, which have been brought up, they should at once
endeavor to rejoin their battalions and should then follow as close
as possible in rear of the latter. The expenditure of ammunition
will never be equally distributed along the line; therefore, if the
battalion commander retains all four ammunition wagons directly under
his own orders, he will be better able to equalize the supply of
ammunition than would be the case if each ammunition wagon, as soon as
it is refilled, were to follow its own company, which, in many cases,
it will scarcely find again.

3. It is the duty of the commander to assign a few ammunition wagons
belonging to organizations held in reserve to bodies of troops which
will in all probability need a greater quantity of ammunition.

4. The organization must be in possession of an adequate supply of
ammunition on entering the zone of effective fire, i.e., at a distance
of 600 m. from the enemy. The sending of individual men to the rear
for the purpose of bringing up ammunition will only be practicable
in rare cases. As a rule, the violence of the hostile fire will make
this impossible. Only the best men can be sent back. It is asking too
much to expect them to cross twice the zone swept by hostile fire.
Moreover, the best men are needed in the firing line to encourage
the weaker element, and to replace disabled squad leaders. Under no
circumstances should the firing line be withdrawn to get ammunition
from the ammunition wagons, as an attack made unexpectedly by the enemy
might find the position unoccupied and thus cause its loss.[521] It is
a general principle that ammunition must be sent forward from the rear.

   [521] Examples: The loss of the park at Coulmiers (HELVIG, _Das 1.
 bayerische Armeekorps_, p. 202). The engagement at Daix on January
 21st, 1871 (_Geschichte des Regiments Nr. 61_, p. 174). KUNZ,
 _Loigny-Poupry_, p. 77.

5. The ammunition can be removed from the dead and wounded only
in defense, or in attack when the forward movement has come to a
standstill. In an advance, it cannot be done without retarding the
movement and without affording individual men an excuse to remain
behind.

6. The bringing up of ammunition by individual men, left to their
own devises, is not to be recommended, as it facilitates “shirking”;
moreover, if one of the men is disabled, the ammunition he carries
will never reach the firing line. Ammunition should either be sent
to the firing line with each support, or it should be carried by
detachments sent forward in thin skirmish lines under the command of
non-commissioned officers. These detachments should remain with the
firing line.

7. Whether or not signals for informing the troops in rear of a
shortage of ammunition in the firing line will fulfill the expectations
entertained for them, can only be determined by the test of war.




INDEX.


 A.

 ACCELERATED FIRE, effect of                                        162

 ACCELERATED TIME, in various armies (tables)                        54

 ACCURACY, effect of, in collective fire                            169

 ACTION
   Breaking off an                                                  441
   Conduct and duties of the leaders in                             399
   Containing                                                       445
   Delaying                                                         445

 ADJUSTMENT, artillery fire                                         319

 ADVANCE
   Crawling--see Crawling
   Fire while in motion                                          92, 93
   Firing line in attack                                            366
   Formations suitable for, through timber                          332
   Impulse from the rear                                             95
   Infantry under artillery fire                                    321
   Rushes--see Rushes
   Skirmish line                                                     76

 ADVANCE BY CRAWLING--see Crawling

 ADVANCE BY RUSHES--see Rushes

 ADVANCE GUARD.
   Battalion, formation for attack                                  212
   Conduct in a rencontre                                           334
   Conduct of, France                                               454
               Italy                                                451

 ADVANCED POSITIONS                                                 413
   Austria                                                          450
   Danger of fight being decided in                                 414
   England                                                          462
   Examples of                                                      412
   Example of attack on                                             348
   Japan                                                            465
   Russia                                                           413

 ADVANCED TROOPS                                                    349

 AGENTS DE LIAISON                                                  245

 AIM, points of                                                     165

 AIMING POSITION, warding off cavalry                               307

 ALPINI                                                          22, 24

 ALTITUDE, effect of, on ranges                                     145

 AMMUNITION
   Expenditure and supply of                                        468
     Franco-German War                                              468
     Russo-Japanese War                                             473
     Russo-Turkish War                                              472
   Expenditure of, during advance by rushes                          90
   How carried by soldier in various armies                         476
   Knapsacks                                                        483
   Machine guns                                                     261
     Austria                                                        288
     England                                                        290
     Switzerland                                                    284
     Germany                                                        273
   Rate of fire versus waste of                                     161
   Shortage of, examples                                            469
   Supply and distribution in action                                400
   Supply, Austria                                             475, 479
           Deductions from various regulations                      483
           Defense                                                  400
           England                                             475, 482
           France                                              475, 480
           Germany                                             475, 476
           Italy                                               475, 483
           Japan                                                    475
           Russia                                              475, 480
           Various armies (table)                                   475
   Wagon--see Ammunition Wagons,
   Weight of, in various armies (table)                              40

 AMMUNITION CARTS--see Ammunition Wagons

 AMMUNITION KNAPSACKS                                               483

 AMMUNITION WAGONS                                                   72
   Austria                                                          479
   England                                                          482
   France                                                           480
   Germany                                                          477
   Italy                                                            483
   Russia                                                           480

 APPLICATORY METHOD OF INSTRUCTION                               10, 11

 APPLIED TACTICS                                                 12, 13

 ARBITRATION, Courts of                                               3

 ARMY CORPS, frontage in attack                                     236

 ARTILLERY,
   Adjustment of fire                                               319
   Cavalry charge supported by                                      313
   Combat of infantry against                                       316
   Combat of machine guns against                                   297
   Combination fuses                                                113
   Coöperation with infantry                                   351, 354
   Effect of fire (France)                                123, 124, 321
   Field guns, in various armies                                    111
   Fire at successive ranges                                        321
   Fire diverted by advancing infantry                              327
   Fire effect of French 4-gun battery                              321
   Fire effect of (French data)                                123, 124
   Fire for effect                                                  320
   Howitzer, heavy field                                            118
             Light field                                            116
   Infantry screen                                                  327
   Line, distance from infantry line in defense                     415
   Losses, Franco-German War                                         20
           Percentage of                                            188
           Under infantry fire                                 326, 327
   Percussion shell (Model 96)                                      115
   Percussion shrapnel                                              111
   Positions in defense                                             414
   Preparatory action (France) in attack                            454
   Progressive fire                                                 320
   Searching fire                                                   321
   Shields, protection afforded by                                  324
   Shrapnel                                                    112, 113
     Effect of (table)                                         114, 122
   Sweeping fire                                                    321
   Time required for adjusting the fire                             119
   Time shell (Model 96)                                            116
              (Model 98)                                            118
   Time shrapnel                                               112, 113
   Unlimbering under infantry fire                                  326
   Zone fire                                                        320

 ASSAULT                                                            373
   Austria                                                          449
   Conduct of the                                                   374
   Decision to make an                                              373
   England                                                          462
   Examples                                                         376
   Fire support                                                     379
   Fire while in motion                                             381
   France                                                           457
   Guidons                                                          355
   Italy                                                            452
   Japan                                                            464
   Moment for making the                                            374
   Pursuit after successful                                         385
   Successful, conduct after                                        385
   Trumpet signal, fix bayonet                                      377
   Unsuccessful, conduct after                                      386

 ASSAULTING DISTANCE                                           385, 424

 ASSEMBLY FORMATIONS                                                 42
   France (_carré de division_)                                     454

 ATTACK                                                             329
   Abridged                                                         330
   Advance of the firing line                                       366
   Advance guard, conduct of the--in a rencontre                    334
   Advanced troops                                                  349
   Assault                                           352, 373, 374, 399
   Assaulting distance                                         385, 424
   Austria                                                          448
   Brigade, frontage of a, in                                       399
   Column                                                        44, 45
   Comparison with defense                                          329
   Conditions upon which success depends                            345
   Conduct of the                                                   365
   Coöperation of infantry and artillery                  351, 352, 354
   Decision to assault                                              373
   Deliberately planned, comparison with rencontre             334, 338
   Deployment, initial                                              366
   Distances                                                        368
     Of supports from firing line                                    99
   Duration of the                                                  351
   England                                                          459
   Envelopment                                                      356
   Examples
     Boer War                                                       340
     Russo-Japanese War                                        340, 345
   Fire fight                                                       368
   Fixing bayonets                                                  372
   Formation for, of a battalion                          211, 212, 213
   France                                                           453
     Advance in mass formation                                      455
     Group attack                                                   255
     Preparatory attack formation                                   455
   Frontage                                                         234
     Army corps                                                     236
     Battalion                                                      236
     Brigade                                              235, 236, 399
     Company                                               96, 235, 236
   Gaps in the line                                                 239
   General rules for use of intrenching tools                       393
   Higher troop leading, duties                                     366
   Holding                                                     357, 445
   Intrenching tools, use of                                        387
   Infantry against dismounted cavalry                              313
   Italy                                                            451
   Japan                                                            463
     I. Army                                                        342
     Influences determining tactics in Russo-Japanese War           341
   Launching the enveloping force                                   359
   Lessons of the Boer War                                          340
                  Russo-Japanese War                                340
   Local reconnaissance in                                          347
   Machine guns in                                                  365
   Methods of forming a battalion for (plates)                 215, 216
   Minor troop leading, duties                                      365
   Moment for making the assault                                    374
   Normal attack                                          203, 204, 205
   Number of men required                                           234
   On an enemy deployed for defense                                 340
   Orders, issue of, in rencontre                                    36
   Over plain devoid of cover                                       255
   Point of                                                         355
   Position of commander in                                         399
   Preparation by infantry and artillery (France)                   454
   Preparation of the                                               346
   Preparatory position, advance into                               350
   Provisions of various regulations in re use of spade in          392
   Pure frontal                                                     357
   Range finding instruments, employment in                         146
   Reconnaissance                                                   346
     In force                                                       347
   Rencontre                                                        333
     Compared with deliberately planned attack                      338
     Conduct of main body in a                                      336
   Reserve, strength of                                             395
   Reserves, employment of                                          394
   Rules for the advance under fire                                 367
   Sand bag cover                                              344, 390
   Secondary                                                        357
   Separation of holding and flank attacks                          361
   Signal (fix bayonet)                                             377
   Spade, use of, in                       387, 392, 449, 457, 465, 466
   Successful, conduct after                                        385
   Superiority of fire, necessity of                           370, 371
   Supports, advance of                                             368
             Distance from firing line                               99
   Surprise                                                         330
   Switzerland                                                      466
   Time for opening fire, general rules                             155
   Troop leading, duties of                                    365, 366
   United, examples illustrating necessity of a                     402
   Unsuccessful, conduct after                                      386

 ATTACK ON A POSITION PREPARED FOR DEFENSE
   Austria                                                          448
   Japan                                                            464
   Switzerland                                                      466

 AUSTRIA
   Advanced positions                                               450
   Advanced troops                                                  349
   Ammunition, how carried by soldier                               476
   Ammunition supply                                                475
     Regulations in re                                              479
   Assault                                                          449
   Attack                                                           448
   Attack on a position prepared for defense                        448
   Battalion, formations of the                                  69, 72
   Column of platoons, how formed                                    49
                       (plate)                                       62
   Company, strength of (table)                                      35
   Coöperation of infantry and artillery                            354
   Counter-attack                                              438, 450
   Crawling                                                         449
   Defense                                                          450
     Seeking a decision                                             450
   Development for action                                           208
   Envelopment                                                 362, 449
   Fire control and fire discipline                                 135
   Fire, kinds of                                                   159
         Time for opening                                           153
         While in motion, experiments with                           92
   Firing line, method of reinforcing the                            96
                Position, choice of                                 370
   Frontage                                                         241
   Front and facing distance                                         48
   Infantry combat                                              448-450
   Infantry versus cavalry                                          314
   Intrenching tool equipment (table)                                39
   Kinds of fire                                                    449
   Load carried by a soldier                                         40
   Machine gun                                                      288
     Ammunition supply                                              288
     And infantry, relative fire effect of                          267
     Fire, kinds of                                                 263
     Formations                                                     288
     Organization                                                   288
   Pace, length and number per minute (table)                        54
   Ranges, ascertaining                                             144
   Reinforcing the firing line, method of                            96
   Rencontre                                                   339, 448
   Rushes                                                       90, 449
   Skirmish line, formation of                                       80
   Superiority of fire                                              371
   Supply of ammunition                                        475, 479
   Telegraph detachments                                            248
   Use of spade in attack                                      392, 449


 B.

 BASE UNIT                                                          218
   Advantages and disadvantages                                218, 219
   Of combat, designation of                                        244

 BATTALION
   Acting alone, formation for attack                               212
   Advance guard, formation for attack                              212
   Attack formation, France                                         457
   Austrian, formation of the                                    69, 72
   Broad column (with plates)                                    67, 68
   Commander, duties in action                                      400
              Post in action                                        400
   Deep column (with plates)                                     67, 68
   Depth on the march                                                72
   English, formation of the                                         71
   Formation, in a containing action                                213
   Forming for attack                                               211
   French, formation of the (with plates)                            70
   Frontage in attack and defense                                   236
   German, formation of the                                      67, 68
   Group intrenchments                                              417
   Historical development                                            36
   Intrenching tool equipment (table)                                39
   Intrenchments for a                                         419, 421
   Italian, formation of the                                         70
   Japanese, formation of the                                        70
   Method of forming for attack (plates)                       215, 216
   Movements of the                                                  67
   Normal formation                                                  67
   Organization of the                                           36, 37
   Part of a larger force, formation in attack                      213
                           In defense                               213
   Route column, formation                                           72
                 Provisions of various regulations                   73
   Russian, formations of the                                        69
   Swiss, formations of the                                          71

 BATTALION COMMANDER
   Duties in action                                                 400
   Post in action                                                   400

 BATTLE UNIT                                                         34

 BAYONET FENCING                                                    134

 BAYONET FIGHTS                                                     382

 BEATEN ZONE                                                        179
   Definition                                                       179
   Depth at various angles of slope--General Paquié’s rule for
   determining                                                      183
   Formulae for computing depth of                                  180
   Increase and diminution of (table)                               181

 BELGIUM
   Fire control and fire direction                                  135
   Frontage                                                         242
   Front and facing distance                                         48

 BREAKING OFF AN ACTION                                             441

 BRIGADE                                                             37
   Attack formation of a French                                     454
   Cavalry, strength of                                             311
   Combat formation                                                  74
   Development for action (with plate)                         216, 217
   Formations                                                    73, 74
   Frontage in attack                                     235, 236, 399
   Importance                                                    37, 38
   Movements                                                     73, 74
   Three-unit organization                                          218

 BROAD COLUMN (with plate)                                           67


 C.

 CADENCE                                                         53, 54

 CAVALRY
   Charge of French Cuirassiers of the Guard at Vionville           311
   Charge supported by artillery                                    313
   Charges             302, 303, 304, 305, 306, 308, 309, 310, 311, 313
   Combat of infantry against                                       301
     Provisions of various regulations                         314, 315
   Combat of machine guns against                                   296
   Dismounted, infantry attack against                              313
   Losses
     Charge of French cavalry at Vionville                          312
     Franco-German War                                               20
     Percentage of                                                  188
   Massed employment                                                313
   Moral effect of a charge                                         306
   Regiment, strength of German                                     273
   Relative strength as compared to infantry                        311

 CHANGE OF DIRECTION, how executed                                  219

 CHANGE OF FRONT
   Examples of                                                 220, 221
   How executed                                                     219

 CHASSEURS ALPINS                                                    22

 CLEARING THE FOREGROUND                                            421

 CLOSE COLUMN, definition                                            47

 CLOSE ORDER
   Battalion                                                         67
   Brigade                                                           73
   Company                                                           56
   Compared with extended order                                     102
   Regiment                                                          73

 CLOSE ORDER FORMATIONS,
   Effect of fire on                                           102, 103
   Value of                                                    103, 104

 COLLECTIVE FIRE                                                    169

 COLOR, position of the                                              68

 COLT MACHINE GUN                                                   261

 COLUMN
   Attack in                                                     44, 45
   Battalion in route                                                72
   Broad (with plate)                                                67
   Close, definition of                                              47
   Comparison with line                                           42-45
   Deep (with plates)                                            67, 68
   Dimensions of broad and deep (plate)                              69
   Double                                                            71
   French double (plate)                                             70
   Open, definition of                                               47
   Route (machine gun battery)                                 273, 274
   Section (machine gun battery)                               273, 274

 COLUMN OF FOURS                                                     58
   How formed (plate)                                                58
   And squads compared                                               59

 COLUMN OF PLATOONS                                                  61
   How formed                                                        49
   Machine gun battery                                         273, 274
   (plate)                                                           62
   Vulnerability of                                            186, 187

 COLUMN OF SQUADS                                                    57
   Employment of                                                     59
   (plates)                                                          57

 COLUMN OF TWOS                                                      56

 COLUMNS, line of company, France (plate)                            70

 COMBAT
   Conduct and duties of the leaders                                399
   Drill, importance of                                             105
   Duration of                                                      178
   Frontage--see Frontage.
   Infantry                                                     448-467
     Austria                                                    448-450
     France                                                     453-459
     Italy                                                      451-453
     Japan                                                      463-465
     Japanese, Characteristics of                                   341
     Russia                                                         466
     Switzerland                                                466-467
     Versus artillery                                               316
     Versus cavalry                                                 301
     Versus machine guns                                            268
   Machine Guns                                                296, 297
     Versus artillery                                               297
     Versus cavalry                                                 296
   Orders                                                      243, 244
     Necessity for written                                          244
   Patrols                                                      80, 250
   Sections                                                         257
     Assignment of                                                  243
     Division of a position into                                    411
   Tasks, assignment of                                             243
   Train (machine guns)                                             270
   Unit                                                              34

 COMBAT DRILL, importance of                                        105

 COMBAT FRONTAGE--see Frontage

 COMBAT ORDERS                                                      243
   Items that should not appear in                                  244
   Written, necessity for                                           244

 COMBAT PATROLS                                                     250

 COMBAT SECTIONS                                                    257
   Division of a position into                                      411

 COMBAT TRAIN, machine gun                                          270

 COMBAT UNIT                                                         34

 COMBINED SIGHTS, use of                                            166

 COMMANDER
   Battalion, post of, in action                                    400
   Company, post of, in action                                      400
   Conduct in action                                                399
   Interference with subordinates                                   401
   Post of, in action                                               399
   Post of, in rencontre                                            398
   Regimental, post of, in action                                   400
   Selection of a position during combat                            244

 COMMANDS                                                            41
   Fire                                                             166

 COMMUNICATING TRENCHES                                             421

 COMMUNICATION
   With neighboring troops and next higher headquarters             245
   On the battlefield                                               246

 COMPANY                                                             34
   Ammunition wagons                        72, 477, 479, 480, 482, 483
   Austrian, in column of platoons (plate)                           62
   Columns of the                                                    56
   Commander, duties in action                                      400
              Post in action                                        400
   Dimensions of the 3 and 4 platoon company (plate)                 52
   Division into platoons, sections, squads                       46-53
               3 or 4 platoons                                   48, 53
   Formation of the                                              46, 47
   French 4-rank formation (with plates)                         65, 66
          In line (plate)                                            49
   Frontage in attack                                               235
               Attack and defense                                    96
               Defense and rear guard actions                       236
   German,
     In column of platoons (plate)                                   62
     In column of squads (plate)                                     57
     In company column (plate)                                       60
     In line (plate)                                                 47
     In route column (plate)                                         57
   Movements in line and column                                      56
   Non-commissioned officers, posts of, in various armies            47
   Organization of the                                           34, 35
   Range finders, post of                                        46, 47
   Russian, in column of platoons (plate)                            62
   Strength of the                                               24, 35
     In the various armies (table)                                   35

 COMPANY AMMUNITION WAGONS                  72, 477, 479, 480, 482, 483

 COMPANY COLUMN (with plates)                                        60
   Value of                                                    186, 187

 COMPANY COMMANDER,
   Duties in action                                                 400
   Post in action                                                   400

 CONCENTRATED FIRE, machine guns                                    263

 CONCENTRATION
   For action                                                       205
   French, into _carré de division_, in attack                      454

 CONE OF DISPERSION, machine gun fire                               264

 CONE OF MISSES, Wolozkoi’s theory of the constant                  173

 CONTAINING ACTIONS                                                 445
   Delaying action and holding attack compared                      445

 COÖPERATION
   Formation of a battalion in                                      213
   Infantry and artillery                                 351, 352, 354
     Difficulties of                                                354
     Provisions of various regulations                              354

 COUNTER-ATTACK                                           378, 428, 453
   After position is carried                                        433
   Austria                                                          410
   Decision brought about by the                                    234
   England                                                          463
   Examples of                                  433, 435, 436, 437, 438
   France                                                      439, 458
   Frontal                                                          436
   In conjunction with a movement to the rear                       434
   Moment for making                                           432, 434
   Moral effect of                                                  436
   Provisions of various regulations                           438, 439

 COURTS OF ARBITRATION                                                3

 COVER
   Sand bag                                                    344, 390
   Trenches                                                         421
   Use of                                                           256
     By firing line                                                 138

 COVER TRENCHES                                                     421

 CRAWLING                                                            86
   Austria                                                           49
   How executed                                                  87, 88

 CUTTING WEAPONS, wounds produced by (%)                            384

 CYCLISTS                                               28, 29, 30, 414
   Depth of detachment of                                            29
   Rate of march of                                                  29
   Use of, on battlefield                                           246


 D.

 “D” BULLET
   Data regarding                                                   130
   Effect on steel shields                                          324

 DANGER, effect of                                                  195

 DANGER SPACE, definition                                           179

 DEEP COLUMN (with plates)                                       67, 68
   French (with plates)                                              70

 DEFENSE                                                            408
   Advanced positions                                               413
   Ammunition supply                                                410
   Austria                                                          450
   Battalion group intrenchments                                    417
   Clearing the foreground                                          421
   Combat sections, division of the position into                   411
   Communicating trenches                                 419, 420, 421
   Company, frontage of                                              96
   Comparison with attack                                           329
   Conduct of the                                                   423
   Counter-attack                                              234, 428
     After position is carried                                      433
     Frontal                                                        436
     Moment for making                                         432, 434
   Cover trenches                                               419-421
   Distance of general reserve from defensive line                  430
   Distribution in depth in                                         232
   Dummy intrenchments                                              421
   England                                                          462
   Field magazines                                                  418
   Fire fight                                                       427
   Firing trenches                                                  417
   Flanks, protection of the                                        425
   Formation of a battalion                                    213, 214
   Fortifying the position                                          415
   Framework of the position                                        414
   France                                                           458
   Frontage in                                                 232, 233
   Frontage of a battalion                                          236
                 Company                                        96, 236
   Frontal counter-attack                                           436
   Gaps in the line                                                 411
   General reserve, location of the                                 411
                    Position of the                                 429
                    Strength of the                                 431
   Interval between general reserve and defensive line              430
   Intrenching, time essential for                                  416
   Intrenchments, purpose of                                   416, 417
   Italy                                                            453
   Japan                                                            465
   Long range fire, use of                                          150
   Machine guns                                                295, 425
   Masks                                                            421
   Number of men required in temporary                              233
   Observation of the foreground                                    420
   Obstacles, construction of                                       421
   Occupation of the position                                       426
   Offensive,
     Assumption of the                                              428
     --defensive                                                    408
     Necessity of assuming the                                      409
   Passive                                                          409
   Position,
     Advanced                                                       413
     Determining factors in selecting a                             414
     Division of the, into sections                                 411
     Fortifying the                                                 415
     Framework of the                                               414
     Requirements of a                                              410
   Purely passive                                                   408
   Range finding instruments, employment of                         146
   Refusing a flank                                                 425
   Reserve, strength of                                             395
   Russia                                                           422
   Section reserves                                                 411
   Sections, division of the position into                          411
   Seeking a decision                           233, 234, 409, 450, 467
   Splinter proofs                                        418, 419, 420
   Superiority of fire                                              427
   Supports                                                         410
   Switzerland                                                      467
   Temporary,
     Frontage in                                                    233
     Number of men required in                                      233
     Occupation of a position                                       408
   Terrain, character of, required by                               254
   Time for opening fire, in (general rules)                        155
   Traverses                                                        417
   Trenches (dimensions)                                       418, 420
   Troops required to occupy the position                      410, 411
   Weak points, strengthening of                                    412

 DEFENSE SEEKING A DECISION                                         409
   Austria                                                          450
   Frontage                                                    233, 234
   Number of men required                                           234
   Switzerland                                                      467

 DELAYING ACTION                                                    445
   Compared with holding attack                                     445
   Distribution in depth in                                         232
   Frontage in                                                      232

 DEMOLITION TOOLS                                                    39

 DEPLOYMENT                                                 78, 80, 209
   For action                                                       209
   France, from 4-rank formation (with plate)                    65, 66
   Initial, in attack                                               366
   Provisions of various regulations                                 80

 DEPTH
   Battalion on the march                                            72
   Cyclist detachment                                                29
   Distribution in                          222-225, 235, 237, 241, 242

 DEVELOPMENT FOR ACTION                                             207
   Brigade                                                     216, 217

 DISARMAMENT, proposals for                                           3

 DISCIPLINE and the moral factors                              107, 108

 DISPERSION                                                          33

 DISTANCE,
   Definition of                                                     47
   Assaulting                                                  385, 424
   Attack                                                           368
   Between elements in the battalion                             72, 73
   Facing, in various armies (table)                                 48
   General reserve from defensive line                              430
   Support from firing line in attack                                99

 DISTRIBUTION IN DEPTH                                              222
   Maximum, when necessary                                          235
   Necessity for                                                    224
   Necessity for, increase with size of force                       241
   Provisions of various regulations                           241, 242
   Relation to frontage                                             225
   Examples                                                    223, 237

 DIVISION, attack formation, France                                 457

 DOUBLE COLUMN, France (with plates)                                 70

 DOUBLE TIME                                                         55
   In various armies (table)                                         54

 DRILL AND TRAINING                                            105, 106

 DRILL ATTACK                                                       204

 DRILL, importance of combat                                        105

 DRILL REGULATIONS                                                13-16
   Provisions of various--see under name of country

 DUMMY INTRENCHMENTS                                           421, 423


 E.

 ECHELON FORMATION                                               73, 74

 EFFECT OF FIRE                                                     167
   As regards time                                                  172
   At medium ranges                                                 151
   Influence of the elevation selected                              162
   On artillery when unlimbering                                    326
   On close order formations                                   102, 103
   On thin and dense skirmish lines                                  77
   Standard of measurement of the                                   168

 EFFICACY OF FIRE                                                   140
   Against hill positions                                           183
   Dependent upon accuracy                                          156
   Influence of the ground on                                       179
   Influence of training                                            168

 ELEVATIONS, rear sight                                        165, 310

 ÉLITE TROOPS                                                    21, 22

 ENGLAND
   Advanced positions                                          413, 462
   Ammunition, how carried by soldier                               476
   Ammunition supply                                                475
     Regulations in re                                              482
   Assault                                                          462
   Attack                                                           459
   Battalion, formations of the                                      71
   Coöperation of infantry and artillery                            354
   Counter-attack                                              439, 463
   Defense                                                          462
   Envelopment                                                      362
   Fire fight in attack                                             461
   Fire of position                                                 154
   Fire, time for opening                                           154
         Kinds of                                                   160
   Frontage                                                         242
     In attack                                                      460
   Front and facing distance                                         48
   Frontal counter-attack                                           463
   Group intrenchments                                              462
   Holding attack                                                   447
   Infantry combat                                              459-463
            Versus cavalry                                          314
   Intrenching in attack                                            392
   Local counter-attack                                             463
   Machine guns                                                     289
     Ammunition supply                                              290
     And infantry, relative fire effect                        266, 267
     Organization                                                   290
     Views on                                                       297
   Mounted infantry                                                  26
   Normal attack                                                    203
   Pace, length and number per minute (table)                        54
   Rallying position                                                460
   Reserves, use of, prior to Boer War                              397
   Rushes                                                       91, 462
   Skirmish line, formation of                                       80
   Supply of ammunition                                        475, 482
   Telephone detachments                                            248
   Use of spade in attack                                           392

 ENVELOPMENT                                                        356
   Austria                                                     362, 449
   Dangers involved                                                 358
   England                                                          363
   Examples of                                                  357-361
   France                                                      362, 457
   Italy                                                            363
   Provisions of various regulations                           362, 363

 ESKADRONS
   Number in German brigade                                         311
   Strength of                                                       32

 ESTIMATING DISTANCES--see Range

 EQUIPMENT                                                        38-40
   Intrenching tool                                               38-40
   Tent, weight of                                                   40
   Weight of, in various armies (table)                              40

 EXPENDITURE AND SUPPLY OF AMMUNITION                               468
   Examples from military history                               468-474
   Franco-German War                                                468
   Russo-Japanese War                                               473
   Russo-Turkish War                                                472

 EXPLOSIVES                                                     39, 480

 EXTENDED ORDER                                                      75
   Compared with close order                                        102
   Movements in                                                      81


 F.

 FACING DISTANCE, in various armies (table)                          48

 FIELD ARTILLERY--see Artillery

 FIELD GUN                                                          111

 FIELD MAGAZINES                                                    418

 FIELD TRAIN                                                         72
   Machine guns                                                     270

 FIGHTING UNIT                                                       33

 FILE CLOSERS, position of                                       46, 47

 FIRE
   Accelerated, effect of                                           162
   Beaten zone, definition                                          179
   Collective, effect of accuracy in                                169
   Combined sights                                                  166
   Commands for firing                                              166
   Constant cone of misses, Wolozkoi’s theory of the                173
   Continuous, fatigue produced by                                  155
   Control                                                          134
   Curve of hits obtained by various marksmen                       170
   Danger space, definition                                         179
   Direction                                                        134
   Discipline                                                       133
   Distribution of, against charging cavalry                        311
   Effect                                                           167
     As regards time                                                172
     At medium ranges                                               151
     Influence of the elevation selected on                         162
     On artillery when unlimbering                                  326
     On close order formations                                 102, 103
     On thin and dense skirmish lines                                77
   Efficacy of                                                      140
     Against hill positions                                         183
     Dependent upon accuracy                                        156
     Influence of the ground on                                     179
     Influence of training on                                       168
   Elevations and points of aim                                     165
     To be used in warding off cavalry charges                      310
   Employment of infantry                                           132
   Expedients for minimizing the effect of hostile                  118
   Flanking                                                         254
   Formula for determining favorable range for firing against hill
   positions                                                        183
   Hits obtained by various marksmen (table)                        171
   Hostile, expedients for minimizing effect of                     118
            Formations suitable under                          120, 121
   Hurried, effect of                                               162
   Increasing difficulties in adjusting hostile artillery fire      119
   Indirect                                                         184
   Infantry                                                         126
     Against charging cavalry                                       308
     And machine gun, relative value of                         265-267
     Employment of                                                  132
   Influences affecting accuracy of                                 173
   Influence of the ground on efficacy of                           179
   Kinds of                                                         157
     Austria                                                        449
     France                                                         455
     Italy                                                          451
     Japan                                                          463
     Provisions of various regulations                          158-160
     Russo-Japanese War                                             157
     To be used in warding off a cavalry charge                     310
   Long range                                         148, 150-153, 176
   Losses produced by long range fire                               176
   Machine gun--see Machine Guns
   Marksmanship, effect of, in collective                           169
   Misses
     Effect of                                                      173
     Wolozkoi’s theory of the constant cone of                      173
   Moral effect of                                             191, 227
     On charging cavalry                                            309
   Number of rounds to be expended to accomplish a certain result   172
   Oblique, effect of, against shielded batteries                   324
   Observation of                                                   167
   Pauses in                                                        155
   Preparation                                                      149
   Provisions of various regulations in re kinds of                 158
                                           Time for opening         153
   Rafale                                                           164
   Rate of                                                          160
     At various ranges                                              162
     Versus waste of ammunition                                     161
   Ricochets, effect of                                             185
   Rifle-rests, influence of                                        178
   Superiority of, in defense                                       427
   Time for opening                                                 147
     General rules                                                  155
     On charging cavalry                                            308
     Provisions of various regulations                              153
   Training, influence of, on efficacy of                           168
   Trial volleys                                                    164
   Volley, value of                                            157, 163
   With counted cartridges                                          164
   Withholding the                                                  151
   Wolozkoi’s theory of the constant cone of misses                 173

 FIRE AT SUCCESSIVE RANGES                                          321

 FIRE EFFECT                                                        167
   As regards time                                                  172
   At medium ranges                                                 151
   Influence of the elevation selected, on                          162
   On artillery when unlimbering                                    326
   On close order formations                                   102, 103
   On thin and dense skirmish lines                                  77
   Standard of measurement of the                                   168

 FIRE FIGHT
   Attack                                                 368, 369, 461
   Defense                                                          427
   Machine guns                                                     283
   Superiority of fire in attack                                370-371

 FIRE FOR EFFECT                                                    320

 FIRE OF POSITION                                                   140
   Infantry                                                          85
   Machine guns                                                      85

 FIRE WHILE IN MOTION                                           92, 381
   Austrian experiments with                                         92
   Examples of employment of                                         93
   Losses when using                                                 92

 FIRING LINE
   Advance in attack                                                366
   Assembling the                                                    97
   Closing in                                                        97
   Dense                                                             75
   Prolonging the                                                    96
   Re-forming the                                                    97
   Reinforcing the, method of                                        96
   Selection of line to be occupied by                              138
   Strength and density                                              75
   Strength of the                                                  139
   Use of cover by the                                              138

 FIRING TRENCHES                                          417, 419, 420

 FIXING BAYONETS                                                    372
   Signal for, in assault                                           377

 FLAGS, Guidon                                                   62, 63

 FLANK ATTACK
   Separation from holding attack                                   361
   France                                                           455

 FLANKS, protection of the, in defense                              425

 FOREGROUND, division into sections                                 411

 FORMAL TACTICS                                                      12

 FORMATIONS                                                          42
   Advance through woods                                            332
   Assembly                                                     42, 454
   Austria                                       49, 52, 58, 62, 69, 72
   Battalion                                                      67-73
   Battle                                                            43
   Belgium                                                           58
   Brigade                                                        73-74
   England                                                       58, 71
   France                                       49, 65, 66, 70, 73, 454
   Germany                               47, 52, 57, 60, 62, 67, 68, 72
   Infantry under artillery fire                           318, 321-324
   Influence of various rifles on density of                        240
   Italy                                                     58, 70, 73
   Japan                                                         58, 70
   Line and column, comparison of                                    43
   Machine guns                                                273, 274
     Austria                                                        288
     Germany                                                   273, 274
     Switzerland                                                    287
   Netherlands                                                       58
   Provisions of various regulations                              69-71
   Purpose of                                                        42
   Regiment                                                      73, 74
   Route                                                             42
   Russia                                                58, 62, 69, 73
   Sweden                                                            58
   Switzerland                                                       71
   Tactical, importance of                                          108
   Troops in rear of firing line                                    186
   Vulnerability of various                               181, 186, 187
   Warding off a cavalry charge                                     302

 FORTIFYING THE POSITION                                            415
   Russia                                                           422

 FORTRESS WARFARE                                                    13

 FOURS, column of                                                    58
   Compared with column of squads                                    59
   How formed                                                        58

 FRAMEWORK OF A POSITION                                            414

 FRANCE
   Advance guard, conduct of the                                    454
   Advance in mass formation in attack                              455
   Advanced positions                                               413
   Ammunition, how carried by soldier                               476
   Ammunition supply                                                475
     Regulations in re                                              480
   Artillery fire, effect of                                   123, 124
   Assembly (_carré de division_)                                   454
   Assault                                                          457
   Attack                                                           453
     Artillery in the preparatory action                            454
     Formation
               Battalion                                            457
               Brigade                                              454
               Division                                             457
     Infantry preparation                                           454
   Battalion, formation of the (with plate)                          70
   Company (plate)                                                   49
     Strength of (table)                                             35
   _Contre attaque_                                                 439
   Coöperation of infantry and artillery                            334
   Counter-attack                                         378, 439, 458
     In conjunction with a movement to the rear                     434
   Defense                                                          458
   Envelopment                                                 363, 457
   Fire, kinds of                                              159, 455
   Fire pauses                                                      156
   Fire, time for opening                                           154
   Flank attack                                                     455
   Frontage                                                    241, 242
   Front and facing distance                                         48
   Group attack                                                     255
   Group combat                                                241, 242
   Infantry combat                                              453-459
   Infantry versus cavalry                                          315
   Intrenching in attack                                            457
   Intrenching, tool equipment (table)                               39
   Intrenchments                                                    416
   Kinds of fire                                               159, 455
   Line of company columns                                           70
   Load carried by soldier                                           40
   Machine guns                                                     290
   Offensive return                                                 458
   Pace, length and number per minute (table)                        54
   Platoon in 4-rank formation (with plates)                     65, 66
   Preparatory attack formation                                     455
   Pure frontal attack                                              455
   Rafale fire                                                      164
   Rencontre                                                        339
   _Retour offensif_                                                439
   Rushes                                                        90, 91
   Signal detachments                                               248
   Skirmish line, formation of                                       80
   Supply of ammunition                                        475, 480
   Supports, conduct in attack                                      456
   Units of direction                                               219
   Use of spade in attack                                      392, 457
   Vulnerability of various formations                              187

 FRONTAGE
   Army corps in attack                                             236
   Attack                                                           234
     England                                                        460
   Austria                                                          241
   Battalion in attack and defense                                  236
   Belgium                                                          242
   Brigade in attack                                           235, 399
   Combat formations                                                222
   Company in attack                                           235, 236
              Attack and defense                                     96
              Defense                                               236
              Rear guard action                                     236
   Considerations governing in attack                               229
   Defense, factors governing in                                    232
            Seeking a decision                                 233, 234
            Temporary                                               233
   England                                                     242, 460
   Examples                                                    223, 237
   France                                                           241
   Gaps in the line                                            239, 411
   Italy                                                            242
   Japan                                                            242
   Maximum, when justifiable                                        235
   Overextension of                                                 238
   Provisions of various regulations                           241, 242
   Regiment                                                         236
   Relation to distribution in depth                                225
   Resumé of most important points governing                        241
   Russia                                                           242
   Russo-Japanese War                                               239
   Various battles                                                  240

 FRONTAL COUNTER-ATTACK                                             436
   England                                                          463
   Examples of                                                 437, 438

 FRONT AND FACING DISTANCE in various countries (table)              48


 G.

 GAPS IN THE ATTACKING LINE                                         239

 GAPS IN THE DEFENSIVE LINE                                         411

 GATLING GUN                                                        259

 GENERAL RESERVE
   Distance from defensive line                                     430
   Interval from flank of defensive line                            430
   Position of the, in defense                                 411, 429
   Strength in defense                                              431

 GERMANY
   Ammunition, how carried by soldier                               476
   Ammunition supply                                                475
     Regulations in re                                              476
   Battalion, formations of the                                  67, 68
   Broad column (plate)                                              67
   Cavalry brigade, number of _Eskadrons_ in                        311
   Column of platoons (plate)                                        62
   Column of squads and route column (plate)                         57
   Company (plate)                                                   47
     Strength of (table)                                             35
   Company column (plate)                                            60
   Concentration, defense                                           205
   Deep column (plate)                                           67, 68
   Development for action, defense                                  207
   Distribution in depth, defense                                   207
   _Eskadron_, strength of                                           32
   Fire, kinds of                                                   158
   Front and facing distance                                         48
   Intrenching tool equipment (table)                                39
   Load carried by soldier                                           40
   Machine guns--see Machine Guns
   Pace, length and number per minute (table)                        54
   Ranges, ascertaining                                             143
   Rushes                                                            90
   Supply of ammunition                                        475, 476
   “To form for attack,” definition                                 207

 GROUND, influence of the                                           179

 GROUP INTRENCHMENTS                                                417
   England                                                          462
   Switzerland                                                      467

 GUARDS                                                              22

 GUIDON FLAGS                                                    62, 63
   Examples of the use of                                           355


 H.

 HATCHET, weight of the                                              40

 HEADQUARTERS, distribution of work at                              245

 HELIOGRAPH, use of, on the battlefield                             246

 HISTORY--see Military History

 HITS
   Number of, obtained by various marksmen (table)                  169
   Curves of hits (plate)                                           170
   Percentage of, standard of measurement of effect of fire         168

 HOLDING ATTACK                                                     357
   Compared with delaying action                                    445
   Separation from flank attack                                     361
   Strength of                                                      446

 HOTCHKISS MACHINE GUN                                              260

 HOWITZER
   Heavy field                                                      118
   Light field                                                      116


 I.

 INDIVIDUALISM, influence of, on tactics                            201

 INDIRECT FIRE                                                      184

 INFANTRY FIRE--see Fire

 INFLUENCE OF THE GROUND                                            179

 INFANTRY
   Advance under artillery fire                                     318
   Advance under fire, rules for                                    367
   Attack
     In Russo-Japanese War, characteristics of                  340-345
     On dismounted cavalry                                          313
   Combat
     According to various drill regulations                     448-467
     Against artillery                                              316
             Cavalry                                                301
               Provisions of various regulations                314-315
             Machine guns, general principles                       268
     In Russo-Japanese War                                          341
     Value of, as compared with machine guns                        267
   Conduct under machine gun fire                                   269
   Coöperation with artillery                                  351, 354
   Cyclists                                                  28, 29, 30
   Deployment                                                       201
     For firing on charging cavalry                                 303
   Élite                                                             21
   Equipment, weight of (table) in various armies                    40
   Fire, effect of, against shielded batteries                 324, 325
   Fire effect, as compared with machine guns                       265
   Fire of position                                                  85
   Firing on artillery in position                                  324
   Formations for advancing under artillery fire          318, 321, 324
   Importance and employment of                                   19-32
   Japanese, tactics in Russo-Japanese War                          341
   Load carried                                                      39
   Local reconnaissance of the                                      248
   Losses in Franco-German War                                       20
     Percentage of                                                  188
   Manner of fighting                                            19, 20
   Method of warding off a cavalry charge                           304
   Mounted infantry                                          25, 26, 27
   Passage through artillery lines                                  316
   Proportion to other arms                                          19
   Relative strength as compared to cavalry                         311
   Russian, tactics in Russo-Japanese War                           340
   Screen for artillery                                             327
   Tactical unit                                                  32-34
   Tactics in Russo-Japanese War                                    341
   Time for opening fire on charging cavalry                        308

 INFANTRY COMBAT
   Austria                                                      448-450
   England                                                      459-463
   France                                                       453-459
   Italy                                                        451-453
   Japan                                                        463-465
   Russia                                                           466
   Switzerland                                                  466-467

 INFANTRY SCREEN                                                    327

 INFORMATION OFFICERS                                               245

 INSTRUCTION
   Method of                                                       7-13
   Applicatory (or inductive)                                    10, 11
   Deductive                                                         11
   Maneuvers                                                      8, 12
   Map problems                                                   8, 11
   Military history, study of                                      7, 8

 INSTRUCTIONS FOR CAMPAIGNS                                          15

 INTERVAL
   Between general reserve and flank of defensive line              430
   Definition                                                        47

 INTRENCHING IN ATTACK
   Austria                                                     392, 449
   England                                                          392
   France                                                      392, 457
   Germany                                                          392
   Japan                                                       392, 465
   Russia                                                           392
   Switzerland                                                      466

 INTRENCHING TOOL EQUIPMENT                                       38-40
   In various armies (table)                                         39

 INTRENCHING TOOLS
   General rules for use in attack                                  393
   Use of in attack                                                 387
     Provisions of various regulations                         392, 393

 INTRENCHMENTS
   Battalion groups of                                              417
   Communicating trenches                                      419, 421
   Cover trenches                                              419, 421
   Dimensions                                                  418, 420
   Dummy                                                       421, 423
   Field magazines                                                  418
   Firing trenches                                        417, 419, 420
   Foreground, clearing the                                         421
               Observation of the                                   420
   Masks                                                            421
   Narrow trenches                                                  418
   Obstacles, construction of                                       421
   Purpose                                                          416
   Splinter proofs                                             418, 420
   Traverses                                                        417

 IRON RATION, weight of                                              40

 ITALY
   Advance guard, conduct of the                                    451
   Ammunition knapsacks                                             483
   Ammunition supply                                                475
     Regulations in re                                              483
   Assault                                                          452
   Attack                                                           451
   Battalion, formations of the                                      70
   Company, strength of (table)                                      35
   Coöperation of infantry and artillery                            354
   Counter-attack                                                   453
   Cyclists, rate of march of                                        29
   Defense                                                          453
   Envelopment                                                      362
   Fire, kinds of                                                   160
         Time for opening                                           154
   Frontage                                                         242
   Front and facing distance                                         48
   Infantry combat                                              451-453
   Intrenching tool equipment                                        39
   Kinds of fire                                                    451
   Load carried by soldier                                           40
   Pace, length and number per minute (table)                        54
   Ranges, ascertaining                                             143
   Rushes                                                       91, 452
   Skirmish line, formation of                                       80
   Supply of ammunition                                        475, 483
   Vulnerability of various formations                              186


 J.

 JAPAN
   Advance in skirmish line                                      76, 77
   Advanced positions                                               465
   Ammunition, how carried by soldier                               476
   Ammunition supply                                                475
   Assault                                                          464
   Attack                                                           463
     On a position prepared for defense                             464
     In Russo-Japanese War, characteristics of                 341, 342
   Battalion, formations of the                                      70
   Combat, characteristics of                                       341
   Counter-attack                                                   439
   Defense                                                          465
   Fire, kinds of                                                   160
   Frontage                                                         242
   Front and facing distance                                         48
   Infantry
     Combat                                                     463-465
     Tactics in Russo-Japanese War, characteristics of              341
     Versus cavalry                                                 315
   Intrenching in attack                                       392, 465
   Kinds of fire                                                    463
   Load carried by soldier                                           40
   Machine guns                                                     290
   Pace, length and number per minute (table)                        54
   Pursuit                                                          465
   Rencontre                                                        464
   Rushes                                                       91, 463
   Skirmish line, formation of                                       80
   Use of spade in attack                                      392, 466

 JÄGER                                                            21-23


 K.

 KAISERJÄGER                                                         24

 KINDS OF FIRE--see Fire

 KNAPSACKS
   Ammunition                                                       483
   Loss of                                                          364
   Weight of, in various armies (table)                              40


 L.

 LEADERS
   Conduct in action                                                399
   Duties in action                                       399, 400, 401
   Posts in action                                                  399

 LEADING--see Troop Leading

 LESSONS OF THE BOER WAR, in re
   Attack                                                           340
   Rushes                                                        88, 89

 LESSONS OF THE RUSSO-JAPANESE WAR, in re
   Attack                                                           340
   Fire control and fire direction                                  137
   Formations under artillery fire                              321-324
   Rushes                                                        89, 90

 LINE
   Comparison with column                                         42-45
   Vulnerability of the                                             187

 LINE FORMATION                                                  73, 74

 LINE OF COMPANY COLUMNS, French (with plate)                        70

 LINE OF PLATOONS, vulnerability of                                 186

 LOCAL RECONNAISSANCE--see Reconnaissance

 LONG RANGE FIRE                                      148, 150-153, 176

 LOSSES
   Artillery under infantry fire                               326, 327
   British, in Boer War                                             193
   Examples           20, 36, 45, 50, 51, 153, 167, 168, 176, 178, 188,
                                           189, 190, 193, 227, 312, 324
   Franco-German War (by arm)                                        20
   French Cuirassiers in charge at Vionville                        312
   In action                                                        185
   Infantry under artillery fire                                    324
   Percentage of                                     186, 188, 189, 227
   Produced by
     Long range fire                                                176
     Artillery and infantry fire, comparison                   167, 168
   Officers and men, comparison                                189, 190
   Skirmish line                                                     81
   When using fire while in motion                                   92


 M.

 MACHINE GUNS                                                       259
   Ammunition                                                       261
     Supply
       Austria                                                      288
       Battery                                                      273
       England                                                      290
       Germany                                                      273
       Russia                                                       291
       Switzerland                                                  284
       Transportation of                                            270
   Assignment to cavalry                                            296
   Attack, employment in                                            365
   Austria                                                          288
   Basket mount                                                     261
   Battery (Germany)
     Ammunition supply                                              273
     Column of platoons                                        273, 274
     Combat train                                                   276
     Employment of                                                  293
     Field train                                                    270
     Fighting                                                       270
     Formations                                                273, 274
     Movements and gaits                                            273
     Order in line                                             273, 274
     Organization                                                   270
     Relative combat value                                          273
     Route column                                              273, 274
     Section column                                            273, 274
   Belts, ammunition                                                261
   Cavalry                                                          261
   Colt                                                             261
   Column of platoons                                          273, 274
   Combat
     Against artillery                                              297
             Cavalry                                                296
     Of infantry against, general principles                        268
     Train                                                          270
     Value as compared with skirmishers                             267
   Companies
     Germany                                                        275
     Russia                                                         290
     Switzerland                                                    284
   Cone of dispersion                                               264
   Crawling into position (illustration)                            277
   Defense                                                          414
     Employment in                                                  425
   Development, historical                                          259
   Employment of                                                    263
   English views on employment of                                   297
   Examples of employment of                                        283
   Feldl gun                                                        219
   Field train                                                      270
   Fighting battery                                                 270
   Fire                                                             263
     Austria                                                        263
     Comparison with infantry fire                              265-267
     Concentrated                                                   263
     Cone of dispersion                                             264
     Effect of                                                 264, 294
     Germany                                                        263
     Kinds of                                              263, 287-288
     Progressive                                                    263
     Rate of                                                        261
     Sweeping                                                       263
     Switzerland                                               263, 287
   Formations
     Austria                                                        288
     Germany                                                   273, 274
     Switzerland                                                    287
   Fire effect                                                 264, 294
     As compared with a body of skirmishers                         265
   Fire fight                                                       283
   Fire of position                                                  85
   France                                                           290
   Gatling                                                          259
   Germany                                                          270
   Going into position                                              276
   Historical development                                           259
   Hotchkiss                                                        260
   In position (illustration)                                       279
   Intrenched (illustration)                                        281
   Japan                                                            290
   Kinds of fire
     Austria                                                   263, 288
     Germany                                                        263
     Switzerland                                          263, 287, 288
   Mitrailleuse                                                     259
   Mountain batteries                                               288
   Mounting, method of                                         261, 284
   Organization
     Austria                                                        288
     England                                                        290
     Germany                                              270, 271, 275
     Russia                                                         291
     Switzerland                                                    284
   Order in line                                                273-274
   Progressive fire                                                 263
   Russia                                                           290
   Schwarzlose                                                      260
   Searching fire                                                   263
   Section column                                              273, 274
   Sled mount                                                       261
   Sweeping fire                                                    263
   Swiss views on employment of                                     299
   Tripod mount                                                     261
   Various countries                                            284-293
   Weights of various, with mounts                                  261

 MAGAZINES--see Field Magazines

 MAIN BODY, conduct in a rencontre                                  336

 MAIN FIRING POSITION                                               369

 MANEUVERS                                                        8, 12

 MAP PROBLEMS                                                     8, 11

 MARCH, rate of, cyclists                                            29

 MARCHING, length of pace and                                        53

 MARKSMANSHIP, value of                                             169

 MASKS                                                              421
   Influence of                                                     120

 MATTOCK, weight of                                                  40

 METEOROLOGICAL CONDITIONS, effect of, on range                     145

 METHOD OF INSTRUCTION--see Instruction

 MILITARY HISTORY, EXAMPLES FROM
   Abridged attack                                                  330
   Advance, impulse from the rear                                    95
   Advanced positions                                               412
     Attack on                                                      348
   Ammunition, expenditure and supply of               89, 90, 468, 474
   Artillery fire diverted from proper objective by advancing
   infantry                                                         327
   Artillery supporting a cavalry charge                            313
             Under infantry fire                                326-327
   Assault                                                     376, 409
   Assaulting guidons, use of                                       355
   Attack                                                       340-345
     Formation of a brigade                                         207
   Battalions, strength of                                           36
   Cavalry charges     302, 303, 304, 305, 306, 308, 309, 310, 311, 313
   Changes of front                                            320, 321
   Charge of French Cuirassiers of the Guard at Vionville           311
   Close order formation, effect of fire on                    102, 103
   Column as attack formation                                    44, 45
   Combats, duration of                                             178
   Companies, consolidation of                                       36
   Concentration for action                               205, 209, 210
   Counter-attack
     After position is carried                                      433
     Against a hostile flank                                   435, 436
   Cover,
     Construction of, in attack                                     344
     Use of                                                         257
   Defensive position, location of                                  410
   Deployment                                                       206
     Of reserves                                                    369
   Distribution in depth and frontage                     222, 223, 226
   Dummy trenches                                                   421
   Effect of danger                                             195-200
             Fire on charging cavalry                               308
   Envelopment                                  357, 358, 359, 360, 361
   Expenditure and supply of ammunition                         468-474
   Fatigue produced by continuous fire                              155
   Fire,
     Effect of                                                      132
     Kinds of, used in Russo-Japanese War                      157, 159
                       Russo-Turkish War                       158, 159
     Withholding the                                           151, 152
   Fire control and fire direction, difficulties of                 137
   Fire effect on close order formations                       102, 103
   Fire pauses                                                      156
   Fire preparation                                                 149
   Fire support during an assault                                   380
   Fire while in motion                                              93
   Flank attack                                                     357
   Flanking fire                                                    354
   Formations suitable under fire                                   121
                       Under artillery fire          321, 322, 323, 324
   Frontage                                                    231, 232
     And distribution in depth                                      237
     In Russo-Japanese War                                          239
     Of battalions at Mukden                                        211
     Overextension of                                               238
   Frontal counter attacks                                     437, 438
   Gaps in the line                                                 239
   Improvised units, use of                                         197
   Influence of various rifles on density of battle formations       24
   Length of rushes and expenditure of ammunition                 89-90
   Lessons of the Boer War, in re attack                            340
                  Russo-Japanese War, in re attack                  340
   Local reconnaissance                                        250, 253
   Long range fire                              149, 150, 151, 152, 153
     In defense                                                     155
   Losses                                          36, 50, 51, 153, 332
     Percentage of                                        188, 189, 227
     Produced by infantry and artillery fire                        167
                 Long range fire                                    176
     Relative, officers to men                                 189, 190
     Under artillery fire                                           324
   Machine guns, employment of                  260, 275, 283, 289, 290
   Masks, effect of                                                 120
   Mistakes caused by trumpet signals                                42
   Mixing of organizations                                     195, 226
   Moral effect of a cavalry charge                                 306
                   Fire                                             426
                     Gen. Bennal’s impressions at Wörth             191
                         On charging cavalry                        309
   Number of troops required for attack and defense                 234
   Passage through timber                                           333
   Ranges, underestimation of                                       142
   Removal of packs                                                 364
   Rencontre                                                        339
   Reserves, employment of                           340, 395, 396, 397
   Rushes, employment of                                     93, 94, 95
           Length of                                             89, 90
   Sand bags, use of, in attack                                344, 390
   Study of                                                         7-8
   Surprise                                     208, 250, 252, 331, 340
   Surrender of British troops in Boer War                          192
   Telephone communication at Mukden                                247
   Temperature, effect of                                           145
   Trumpet signals, mistakes caused by                               42
   United attack, necessity of                                      402
   Use of spade in attack                                      387, 388
   Value of                                                    8, 9, 10
   Void of the battlefield                                          194
   Volleys, use of                                                  164
   Woods, passage through                                           333
   Wounds
     Produced by cutting weapons                                    384
     Character of                                              128, 129

 MINOR TACTICS                                                       12

 MISSES, effect of; Wolozkoi’s theory                               173

 MITRAILLEUSE                                                       259

 MIXING OF ORGANIZATIONS                                       195, 226
   How prevented                                                 96, 97

 MORAL EFFECT
   Cavalry charge                                                   306
   Counter-attack                                                   436
   Fire                                                        191, 227
     On charging cavalry                                            309

 MORAL FACTORS and discipline                                  107, 108

 MOUNTAIN TROOPS                                                     23

 MOUNTAIN WARFARE                                                    23

 MOUNTED INFANTRY                                            25, 26, 27

 MOUNTED MESSENGERS, use on battlefield                             246

 MUSICIANS
   Duties in skirmish line                                           79
   Posts in skirmish line                                            79


 N.

 NEEDLE GUN, compared with rifle, model 98, as regards flatness of
 trajectory                                                         153

 NETHERLANDS, column of fours                                        58

 NIGHT ATTACKS, distribution in depth                               233

 NIGHT OPERATIONS, close order formations, importance of            104

 NON-COMMISSIONED OFFICERS, posts of, in various armies              47

 NORMAL ATTACK                                                      203
   v. Boguslawski’s views                                           204
   Clausewitz’s views                                               204
   v. Scherff’s views                                               205

 NORMAL FORMATIONS, necessity for, in some countries                201


 O.

 OBSERVATION OF THE FOREGROUND                                      420
   Compared with deliberately planned attack                   334, 338

 OBSERVATION STATIONS                                               421

 OBSTACLES                                                          422

 OBUS ALLONGÉ                                                       115

 OFFENSIVE
   Assumption of the                                                428
     In defense                                                     409
   Spirit of the                                               109, 110

 OFFENSIVE-DEFENSIVE                                                408

 OFFENSIVE RETURN (France)                                     439, 458

 OFFICERS
   Demeanor, influence of                                            84
   Losses among                                                  50, 51
     Franco-German War (by arm)                                      20
     Relative to men                                           189, 190

 OPEN COLUMN, depth of                                               47

 ORDER IN LINE, machine gun batteries                          273, 274

 ORDERS                                                              41
   Combat                                                      243, 244
   Contents of                                                       41
   Issue of                                                          41
     In a rencontre                                                 336

 ORGANIZATION                                                        34
   Battalion                                                     36, 37
   Brigade                                                       37, 38
   Company                                                       34, 35
     In various armies (table)                                       35
   Machine guns,
     Austria                                                        288
     England                                                        290
     France                                                         290
     Germany                                                        270
     Japan                                                          290
     Russia                                                         290
     Switzerland                                                    284
   Mounted infantry (England)                                        26
   Regiment                                                          37

 ORGANIZATIONS
   Mixing of                                                   195, 226
     How prevented                                               96, 97
   Use of improvised                                                197


 P.

 PACE
   Diminution of length of, on various slopes                       141
   Length of, and marching                                           53
              In various armies (table)                              54

 PACES, number of, per minute                                        54

 PACKS, removal of                                             363, 364

 PANIC                                                     27, 107, 441

 PASSIVE DEFENSE                                               408, 409

 PATROLS                                                             27
   Combat                                                            80

 PEACE, eternal                                                       1

 PENETRATION, “S” bullet                                            131

 PLATOON
   Column of twos, vulnerability of                                 187
   Commander, post in close order                                    63
                      Skirmish line                                  79
   French 4-rank formation (with plates)                         65, 66
   Infantry, strength of the German                                 273
   One-rank, vulnerability of the                                   187

 PLATOONS
   Column of (with plate)                                        61, 62
     How formed                                                      49
     Machine gun battery                                       273, 274
   Division of the company into                                      46
   Three or four platoons                                            48

 POSITION
   Advance into a preparatory                                       350
   Advanced                                                         413
   Battalion groups of intrenchments                                417
   Communicating trenches                                           421
   Cover trenches                                                   421
   Determining factors in selecting a                               414
   Dummy intrenchments                                              421
   Foreground, clearing the                                         421
               Division into sections                               411
               Observation of the                                   420
   Fortifying the                                                   415
   Framework of the                                                 414
   Gaps in the defensive                                            411
   Intrenchments                                                418-422
   Masks                                                            421
   Obstacles, construction of                                       421
   Occupation of the                                                426
   Rallying                                                         442
   Requisites of a defensive                                        410
   Russian views in re defensive                                    422
   Sections, divisions into                                         411
   Temporary occupation                                             408

 POSTS
   Battalion commander in action                                    400
   Commander in a rencontre                                         338
   Company commander in action                                      400
   Musicians in skirmish line                                    79, 80
   Non-commissioned officers in close order                          47
   Platoon commanders in close order                                 63
                         Skirmish line                               79
   Range finders in close order                                  46, 47
                    Skirmish line                                79, 80
   Squad leaders in close order                                  46, 47
                    Skirmish line                                    79
   Regimental commander in action                                   400

 PREPARATION OF THE ASSAULT                                         352

 PREPARATION OF THE ATTACK                                          346
   By artillery, provisions of various regulations                  354

 PREPARATORY POSITION                                               350

 PROGRESSIVE FIRE
   Artillery                                                        320
   Machine guns                                                     263

 PURE FRONTAL ATTACK                                                357
   France                                                           455

 PURSUIT                                                            385
   Japan                                                            465


 Q.

 QUICK TIME, in various armies (table)                               54


 R.

 RAFALE                                                        158, 164

 RALLYING POSITION                                                  442
   England                                                          460
   Occupation of the                                                443

 RANGE
   Altitude, effect of, on the                                      145
   Ascertaining the                                                 140
     Pacing and galloping                                           141
     Provisions of various regulations                              143
   Ascertaining the                                                 140
     Range finding instruments                                      146
     Trial volleys                                                  145
   Error of estimation                                              141
   Formulae for determining favorable range for firing against hill
   positions                                                        183
   Influence of error in estimating the                             170
                Knowledge of the                                    140
   Meteorological conditions, effect of                             145
   Range finding instruments, permissible error                     146
   Trial volleys                                                    145

 RANGE FINDERS
   Classification                                                   143
   Duties in machine gun detachments                                283
   Post in close order                                           46, 47
           Skirmish line                                         79, 80

 RANGE FINDING INSTRUMENTS
   Errors permissible                                               146
   Principle of construction                                        146

 RANGING--see Range

 RANKS, influence of rate of fire upon the number of                 46

 RATIONS, weight of                                                  40

 REAR GUARD ACTION, frontage of a company in                        236

 RECONNAISSANCE
   Companies                                                        251
   Detachments of all arms                                          251
   In attack                                                        346
   In force                                                    251, 347
   Local, in attack                                                 347
          Object of                                                 250
          Of the infantry                                           248
   Patrols and scouting detachments                                  27

 REGIMENT                                                            37
   Cavalry, strength of German                                      273
   Combat frontage                                                  236
   Formation for attack                                             214
   Formations                                                    73, 74
   Importance                                                        37
   Organization                                                      37

 REGIMENTAL COMMANDER
   Duties in action                                                 400
   Post in action                                                   400

 REGULATIONS--see Drill Regulations

 REMOVAL OF PACKS                                              363, 364

 RENCONTRE                                                          333
   Advance guard, conduct of the                                    334
   Austria                                                          448
   Commander, position of                                           338
   Conduct of main body                                             336
   Examples of                                                      339
   Japan                                                            464
   Machine guns, examples of, in a                             295, 338
   Main body, launching of the                                      338
   Orders, issue of                                                 336
   Provisions of various regulations                                339
   Use of echelon formation in                                       74
   Switzerland                                                      466

 REPRESENTATIVE GOVERNMENT, influence of, on war                      3

 RESERVE
   Employment of, in attack                                         394
   Examples of employment of                         340, 395, 396, 397
   General, distance from defensive line                            430
            Interval from flank of defensive line                   430
            Position in defense                                     429
            Strength of, in defense                                 431
   In retreat                                                       442
   Launching or withholding the                                     396
   Section                                                          411
   Size of, in various units                                        235
   Strength of the (in attack and defense)                          395

 RETREAT
   Direction of                                                440, 442
   Rallying position                                                442
   Reserve                                                          442

 RICOCHETS, effect of                                               185

 RIFLE--see Rifles

 RIFLEMEN                                                            22

 RIFLE-RESTS, influence of                                          178

 RIFLES
   Automatic                                                        126
   Influence of various, on density of battle formations (table)    240
   Used in Russo-Japanese War                                       127
   Weight of, in various armies (table)                              40

 ROAD SPACE--see Depth

 ROUTE COLUMN (with plate)                                           57
   Battalion in                                                      72
   Machine gun battery                                         273, 274

 RUSHES
   Advance by                                                        82
   Austria                                                          449
   England                                                          462
   Examples of the employment of                             93, 94, 95
   Gait to be employed in                                        82, 86
   How made in various armies                                    90, 91
   Italy                                                            452
   Japan                                                        91, 463
   Length of                                                         83
   Lessons of the Boer and Russo-Japanese Wars               88, 89, 90
   Long or short                                                 85, 86
   Preparation for                                                   83
   Provisions of various regulations                              90-91
   Russia                                                            91
   Short or long                                                 85, 86
   Strength of the rushing unit                                      83
   Time required for                                                 83

 RUSSIA
   Advanced positions                                               413
   Ammunition, how carried by soldier                               476
   Ammunition supply                                                475
     Regulations in re                                              480
   Assault                                                          381
   Battalion, formations of the                                  69, 73
   Column of platoons (plate)                                        62
   Company, strength of (table)                                      35
   Defensive position, views on                                     422
   Fire, kinds of                                                   160
   Frontage                                                         242
   Front and facing distance                                         48
   Infantry
     Combat                                                         466
     Tactics in Russo-Japanese War, characteristics of              340
     Versus cavalry                                                 315
   Intrenching tool equipment of Russian companies                   38
   Load carried by soldier                                           40
   Machine guns                                                     290
   Pace, length and number per minute                                54
   Ranges, ascertaining                                             143
   Rushes                                                            91
   Sandbag cover, results of experiments                            390
   Skirmish line, formation of                                       80
   Supply of ammunition                                        475, 480
   Use of general reserve                                           397
          Spade in attack                                           392


 S.

 “S” BULLET
   Effect on corpses                                                130
             Materials                                              131
             Steel shields                                          324

 SAND BAGS                                                     344, 390
   Results of Russian experiments                                   390

 SCHWARZLOSE MACHINE GUN                                            260

 SCOUTING DETACHMENTS                                       27, 28, 414
   Use of, in reconnaissance                                        252

 SEARCHING FIRE
   Artillery                                                        321
   Machine guns                                                     263

 SECONDARY ATTACK                                                   357

 SECTIONS
   Assignment of combat                                             243
   Defensive position, division into combat                         411
   Division of the platoon into                                      46

 SECTION COLUMN, machine gun battery                           273, 274

 SHARPSHOOTER PLATOONS                                               21

 SHELL
   Comparison between that of field gun and howitzer                117
   Percussion (Model 96)                                            115
   Time (Model 96)                                                  116
        (Model 98)                                                  118

 SHIELDS
   Protection afforded by                                           324

 SHRAPNEL
   Comparison between that of field gun and howitzer                117
   Effect (tables)                                             114, 122
     On animate targets                                             125
   Incendiary effect                                                112
   Percussion                                                  111, 112
   Time                                                             112

 SIGNAL LAMPS, use of, on battlefield                               246

 SIGNALS                                                             41
   Advance                                                           41
   Assemble                                                          41
   Attention                                                         41
   Charge                                                            41
   Deploy                                                            41
   Employment of, by combat patrols                                  80
   Fix bayonet                                                  41, 377
   Halt                                                              41
   Misunderstanding of                                               42
   Trumpet                                                           41

 SITUATION, estimate of the                                          11

 SKI DETACHMENTS                                             30, 31, 32

 SKI RUNNERS                                                 30, 31, 32

 SKIRMISH LINES
   Boer advance in thin                                              75
   Cover, use of                                                    256
   Efficacy of fire against thin and dense (table)                   77
   Fire effect, as compared with machine guns                       265
   Formation of                                                      78
     In various armies                                               80
   Gaits of                                                          81
   Japanese advance in thin                                      76, 77
   Losses                                                            81
   Movements in                                                  81, 82
   Thin and dense                                                76, 77
   Vulnerability of                                            186, 187

 SNOW SHOE MARCHING                                              30, 31

 SPADE
   Use of, in attack                  387, 388, 392, 449, 457, 465, 466
   Small, weight of                                                  40

 SPLINTER PROOFS                                               418, 420

 SQUAD LEADERS
   Posts in close order                                          46, 47
            Skirmish line                                            79

 SQUADS
   Column of, compared with column of fours                          59
              (Plate)                                                57
   Division of the company into                                      46
   Machine gun, composition and duties of members of (Germany)      283

 STAFFS, division of work in                                        245

 STRATEGY
   Definitions of                                               4, 5, 6
   Relation of tactics to                                          6, 7

 SUPERIORITY OF FIRE                                      370, 371, 427

 SUPPLY OF AMMUNITION
   Austria                                                     475, 479
   Deductions from various regulations                              483
   England                                                     475, 482
   France                                                      475, 480
   Germany                                                     475, 476
   Italy                                                       475, 483
   Japan                                                            475
   Russia                                                      475, 480
   Various armies (table)                                           475

 SUPPORTS                                                        98, 99
   Advance of                                                       100
     In attack                                                      368
   Advantages of                                                    102
   Arguments against                                           101, 102
   Commander, duties of                                             100
   Conduct, French regulations                                      455
   Defense                                                          410
   Deployment in attack                                             369
   Distance from firing line                                     98, 99
   Duties                                                            98
   Formations                                                       100
   Movements                                                        100
   Necessity                                                         98
   Purpose                                                           98

 SURPRISE                                                           330
   Examples of                                                      331

 SURRENDER, British troops in Boer War                              192

 SWEDEN, column of fours                                             58

 SWEEPING FIRE
   Artillery                                                        321
   Machine guns                                                     263


 T.

 TACTICAL FORMATIONS, Importance of                                 108

 TACTICAL MISSIONS, compared with united action                     401

 TACTICAL UNIT                                               32, 33, 34

 TACTICS
   Applied                                                       12, 13
   Changes in                                                    13, 14
   Definitions of                                               4, 5, 6
   Formal                                                            12
   Grand                                                             12
   Japanese infantry in Russo-Japanese War, characteristics of      341
   Minor                                                             12
   Relation of strategy to                                          6-7
   Russian infantry in Russo-Japanese War, characteristics of       340

 TARGET, selection of a                                             147

 TASKS
   Assignment of                                                    218
   Dangers of assigning                                             405

 TELEGRAPH, FIELD, use of, on battlefield                           246

 TELEPHONE, FIELD, use of, in infantry combat                       246

 TEMPORARY OCCUPATION of a position                                 408

 TERRAIN, importance of                                             254

 TIMBER, advance through                                            332

 TRAINING and drill                                            105, 106
   Influence of, on efficacy of fire                                168

 TRAVERSES                                                          417

 TRENCHES                                                       416-420
   Dimensions                                                       418

 TROOP LEADING
   Duties of higher                                                 366
             Minor                                                  365

 TROOP UNIT                                                          34

 TRUMPET SIGNALS                                                     41

 TWOS, column of                                                     56


 U.

 UNIFORM, color of, influence on visibility                         119

 UNITED ACTION
   Compared with tactical missions                                  401
   Dangers of                                                       405

 UNITED STATES, three-unit organization                         38, 218

 UNIVERSAL SERVICE, influence of, on war                              4

 USE OF SPADE IN ATTACK                                             387
   Austria                                                          449
   France                                                           457
   Japan                                                            465
   Provisions of various regulations                                392
   Switzerland                                                      466


 V.

 VOID OF THE BATTLEFIELD                                            194

 VOLLEY
   Value of the                                                157, 163
   Trial                                                            145

 VULNERABILITY of various formations                           186, 187


 W.

 WAR                                                            2, 3, 4
   Importance and necessity of                                        2
   Influence of representative government in reducing number of
   wars                                                               3
   Influence of universal service on                                  4
   Lessons of, in re attack                                         340
                     Rushes                                      88, 89
   Purpose of                                                         4
   _Ultimo ratio_ of state policy                                  2, 3

 WEAPONS, changes and improvements in                                13

 WIGWAG FLAGS, use of, in infantry action                           246

 WIRE CUTTERS                                                        39

 WITHDRAWAL                                                         441
   Conduct of a                                                     441

 WOLOZKOI’S THEORY of the constant cone of misses                   173

 WOODS, advance through                                             332

 WOUNDS
   Produced by cutting weapons, (%)                                 384
               Infantry and artillery fire, comparison              167
               Jacketed bullets                                     129
               Shrapnel bullets                                     125
               Small arms in Russo-Japanese War, character of  127, 128


 Z.

 ZONE FIRE, artillery                                               320




INDEX OF EXAMPLES FROM MILITARY HISTORY.


 A.

 =~Aiaslar~=, August 25, 1877.                                     PAGE
   Ammunition, expenditure of                                       472

 =~Albuera~=, 1811.
   Losses                                                           227

 =~Amiens~=, November 27, 1870.
   Frontage                                                         237

 =~Austerlitz.~=
   Attacking column, formation                                       44

 =~Azay~=, January 6, 1871.
   Masks, effect of                                                 112


 B.

 =~Baalon~=, September 17, 1870.
   Surprise                                                         331

 =~Beaumont~=, August 30, 1870.
   Advance guard, deployment of                                231, 232
   Artillery, losses of the                                         327
   Cavalry charge                                                   309
   Deployment of an advance guard                              231, 232
   Distribution in depth                                       231, 232
   Flank attack                                                     357
   Frontage                                                    231, 232
   Frontal counter-attack                                           437
   Ineffective rapid fire at short ranges                           162
   Line of platoons in columns of twos                              121
   Losses, artillery under infantry fire                            327
   Rencontre                                                        339
   Surprise                                                         331
   Woods, passage through                                           333

 =~Beaune la Bolande~=, November 28, 1870.
   Ammunition, expenditure and supply of                            470
     Shortage of                                                    469
   Short range fire                                                 153
   Withholding the fire                                             152

 =~Belmont~=, November 22, 1899.
   Night march                                                      351

 =~Boer War~=--see South African War (1899-1902).

 =~Busaco.~=
   Frontal counter-attack                                           437

 =~Buzanval~=, January 19, 1871.
   Ammunition, expenditure of                                       470


 C.

 =~Casablanca~=, 1907.
   Effect of infantry fire on charging cavalry                      308

 =~Chagey~=, January 11, 1871.
   Short range fire                                                 153

 =~Champigny~=, November 30, 1870.
   Ammunition, expenditure and supply                               471
   Influence of the ground on efficacy of fire                      183
   Jägers, employment of                                             23

 =~Chevilly~=, November 30, 1870.
   Fire while in motion                                              93

 =~Chlum~= (Königgrätz), 1866.
   Flank attack                                                     357

 =~Colenso~=, December 15, 1899.
   Artillery under infantry fire                                    326
   Boer position, location of                                       410
   Density of battle line                                           240
   Insufficient reconnaissance                                      340
   Losses                                                           189
     Officers                                                       190
   Moral effect of fire                                        152, 426
   Pure frontal attack                                              340
   Reconnaissance, lack of local                                    249
   Reserves, use of                                                 340
   Surprise                                                         340
   Withholding the fire, moral effect                               152

 =~Colombey~=, August 14, 1870.
   Attack on Aubigny                                                405
     On the “Tannenwäldchen”                                        403
   Frontage                                                         237
   Losses                                                           195
   Mixing of organizations                                          195
   Moral effect of fire                                             199

 =~Coulmiers~=, November 9, 1870.
   Ammunition supply                                                484
   Reserve, employment of the                                       395

 =~Coulomiers~=, December 15, 1870.
   Withholding the fire                                             152

 =~Custozza~=, 1866.
   Battle lines, density of                                         240
   Cavalry charge                                                   302
     Moral effect of a                                              200
   Reserves, employment of                                          396


 D.

 =~Daix~=, November 26, 1870.
   Ammunition, supply of                                            484

 =~Datshishiao~=, July 24, 1904.
   Bayonet fight                                                    382

 =~Diamond Hill~=, 1900.
   Frontage                                                         238

 =~Doornkop~=, May 29, 1900.
   Opening fire                                                     150


 E.

 =~Etoges~=, 1814.
   Infantry versus cavalry                                          313


 F.

 =~Franco-German War~= (1870-71).
   Ammunition, expenditure and supply of                            468
   Close order formations, impossibility of employing, in first
   line                                                             102
   Fire, efficacy of                                                176
   Frontages                                                        237
   Losses among officers, percentage of (by arm)                     20
   Officers, number of, per 1000 men                                 51
   Proportion of the various arms                                    19

 =~Fuchau~=, 1905.
   Local reconnaissance                                             250


 G.

 =~Garcia Hernandez~=, 1812.
   Cavalry charge                                                   309

 =~Gitschin~=, 1866.
   Trumpet signal, misunderstanding caused by                        42

 =~Gorni Bugarov~=, January 1, 1878.
   Frontal counter-attack                                           438
   Short range fire                                                 153

 =~Gorni Dubniac~=, October 24, 1877.
   Ammunition, expenditure and supply of                            473
   Assault, inability to                                            409
   Fire, ineffectiveness of uphill                                  183
   Intrenching in attack                                            389
   Isolated attacks with inadequate forces                          223
   Perseverance under fire                                          387
   Reserves, deployment of                                          369
   Rushes, advance by                                                95
   Signal for attack, failure of                                    361
   Strength, relative, of opposing forces                           234

 =~Gravelotte~= (St. Privat).
   Advance to the battlefield                                        67
   Ammunition, expenditure                                          471
   Artillery under infantry fire                                    326
   Assault                                                          376
   Assaulting distance                                              385
   Attack made by the III. Army Corps                               398
   Battle lines, density of                                         240
   Close order formations under fire                                103
   Columns of twos, line of                                         121
   Companies, consolidation of                                       36
   Concentration for action                                         210
   Density of battle lines                                          240
   Enfilade fire                                                    254
   Envelopment                                                      361
   Fire,
     Artillery under infantry                                       326
     Close order formation under                                    103
     Columns of twos, line of, under                                121
     Enfilade                                                       254
     Long range                                                     152
     Pause                                                          156
     Perseverance under                                        108, 387
     Uphill, ineffectiveness of                                     183
   Flanking fire                                                    254
   Infantry fire, artillery under                                   326
   Intrenchments, construction of                                   388
   Losses, aggregate and detail                                     188
     At various ranges                                              176
     Franz regiment                                                 195
     Officers                                               33, 51, 190
   Lull in the fight at Point du Jour                               156
   March formations                                                  67
   Mitrailleuses, employment of                                     260
   Mixing of organizations                                          196
   Officers, losses among                                   33, 51, 190
   Organizations, mixing of                                         196
   Ranges, underestimation of                                       142
   Reconnaissance, relaxing in the                                  347
   Reserves                                                         398
   Stragglers                                                       196
   Uphill fire against trenches, ineffectiveness of                 183


 H.

 =~Haicheng~=, 1904.
   Advanced positions, several lines of                             412

 =~Hallue~=, December 23, 1870.
   Envelopment                                                        6
     Attempted, by first line                                       360
   Frontage                                                         232

 =~l’Hay~=, September 30, 1870.
   Fire while in motion                                              93

 =~Helmstedt~=, July 25, 1866.
   Change of front                                                  220

 =~Hühnerwasser~=, 1866.
   Ammunition found on the battlefield                              469


 K.

 =~Karahassankioi~=, August 23, 1877.
   Ammunition, expenditure of                                       472

 =~Katzbach~=, August 26, 1813.
   Attack in line                                                   108

 =~Kazeljevo.~=
   Frontal counter-attack                                           438

 =~Kesselsdorf~=, 1745.
   Frontal counter-attack                                           437
   Losses                                                           189

 =~Kinchau~=, November 26, 1904.
   Ammunition, expenditure of                                       474
   Assaulting distance                                              385

 =~Kolin~=, 1757.
   Losses                                                           189

 =~Königgrätz~=, July 3, 1866.
   Adjustment of fire facilitated by a poplar                       120
   Advance to the battlefield                                       205
   Battle lines, density of                                         240
   Cavalry charge, moral effect of a                                306
   Flank attack                                                357, 359
   Jägers, employment of                                             23
   Trumpet signal, misunderstanding caused by                        42


 L.

 =~Ladon~=, November 26, 1870.
   Envelopment                                                      361

 =~Ladonchamps~= (near Metz).
   Artillery fire, ineffectiveness of                               120

 =~Ladysmith~=, 1900.
   Supports                                                          98

 =~Le Bourget~=, October 30, 1870.
   Assaulting distance                                              385
   Columns of twos, line of                                         121
   Rushes                                                        93, 94

 =~Le Mans.~=
   Battalions, strength of                                           36
   Gatling guns                                                     260
   Officers, number present for duty                                 50

 =~Liao Yang~=, 1904.
   Ammunition, expenditure of                                  473, 474
   Battle lines, density of                                         239
   Fire                                                             155
   Frontage                                                         239
   Intrenching tools, use of, in attack                             392
   Machine guns                                                     291
   Strength of opposing forces                                      341
   Surprise                                                    208, 250

 =~Linshinpu~=, 1904.
   Ammunition, expenditure of                                       473

 =~Lisaine.~=
   Frontage                                                         228

 =~Loigny~=, December 2, 1870.
   Advance to the battlefield                                        67
   Counter-attack                                         433, 435, 436
   Intrenching tools, lack of                                       388
   Wheel executed by Kottwitz’ Brigade                              220

 =~Lovtcha~=, September 1, 1877.
   Ammunition, expenditure of                                       472
   Mixing of organizations                                          197
   Registration mark for artillery fire                             120
   Rushes                                                            95
   Strength of opposing forces                                      234


 M.

 =~Magersfontain~=, December 11, 1899.
   Boer position, location of                                       410
   Convalescence of wounded                                         129
   Dummy trenches                                                   421
   Fire surprise                                                    133
   Frontage                                                    227, 238
   Lack of reinforcements                                           227
   Losses                                                           189
     Officers                                                       190
   Perseverance under fire                                     137, 387
   Pure frontal attack                                              340
   Reconnaissance, lack of local                                    249
   Reinforcements, lack of                                          227
   Reserves, employment of                                          340
   Withholding the fire, moral effect of                            152

 =~Maida.~=
   Frontal counter-attack                                           437

 =~Marengo~=, 1800.
   Attacking column, formation of                                    45

 =~Mars-la-Tour~=--see Vionville.

 =~Minden~=, 1757.
   Infantry versus cavalry                                          313

 =~Modder River~=, November 28, 1899.
   Boer position, location of                                       410
   Fire fight                                                  132, 371
   Moral effect of fire                                             426
   Opening fire at long range                                       150
   Perseverance under fire                                          132
   Pure frontal attack                                              340
   Reconnaissance, lack of                                     252, 340
   Surprise                                                    252, 340

 =~Montoy~= (Noisseville).
   Surprise                                                         332

 =~Mont Valérien~=, January 19, 1871.
   Ammunition, shortage of                                          469

 =~Mukden~=, 1905.
   Advance in thin skirmish lines                                76, 77
   Assault with cold steel                                          134
   Attack, mode of Japanese                                    343, 344
   Battle lines, density of                                    239, 240
   Bayonet fights                                                   382
   Construction of cover in attack                                  344
   Frontage                                                         239
   Gaps in the attacking line                                       239
   Machine guns                                                     292
   Perseverance under fire                                          348
   Reserves                                                    395, 396
   Sand bags, use of, in attack                                     344
   Skirmish lines, thin                                          76, 77
   Strength of opposing forces                                      341
   Telephone communication                                          247


 N.

 =~Nachod~=, 1866.
   Bayonet attack                                                   153
   Concentration                                                    209
   Frontage                                                         231
   Losses                                                           153
   Mixing of organizations                                          196
   Rencontre                                                        339

 =~Nicholson’s Neck~=, October 24, 1899.
   Crawling                                                      87, 88
   Volleys, ineffectiveness of                                      157

 =~Noisseville.~=
   Bayonet fight                                                    382
   Counter-attack                                              429, 433
   Flank attack                                                     358
   Intrenching tools, lack of                                       388
   Losses                                                           332
   Reconnaissance                                                   253
   Surprise                                                         331

 =~Nuits~=, December 18, 1870.
   Abridged attack                                                  330


 O.

 =~Oerrshikiatsy~= (Shaho), 1904.
   Intrenching tools, use of, in attack                             388

 =~Orleans~=, December 3, 1870.
   Counter-attack                                                   436
   Strength of German battalions                                     36


 P.

 =~Paardeberg~=, February 18, 1900.
   Advance without firing                                           149
   Convalescence of wounded                                         129
   Crawling                                                          87
   Distribution in depth, lack of                                   238
   Frontage                                                     76, 227
   Intrenching tools, use of, in attack                             388
   Opening fire at long range                                       150
   Reinforcements, lack of                                          227
   Skirmish lines, thin                                              76

 =~Pieters Hill~=, February 27, 1900.
   Fire support                                                     380
   Frontage                                                         238
   Machine guns                                                289, 298

 =~Plevna~=, 1877.
   Ammunition, expenditure of                                       472
   Attacks with inadequate forces                              222, 223
   Bayonet fights                                                   382
   Combat impressions                                               191
   Fire, opening                                                    152
     Uphill, ineffectiveness of                                     183
     While in motion                                                 93
   Improvised units                                            197, 198
   Intrenching tools, use of                                        388
   Isolated attacks with inadequate forces                     222, 223
   Knapsacks, loss of                                               364
   Losses among officers                                            190
     At various ranges                                         152, 177
   Mixing of organizations                                          197
   Officers, losses among                                           190
   Opening fire at long range                                       152
   Ranges, underestimation of                                       142
   Reserves, deployment of                                          369
     Employment of                                                  395
   Rushes                                                            95
   Strength of opposing forces                                      234
   Underestimation of ranges                                        142
   Volleys                                                          158

 =~Podol~=, June 26, 1866.
   Jägers                                                            23

 =~Poplar Grove~=, March 7, 1900.
   Advance in attack formation                                      206
   Attack formation of a brigade                                    207
   Frontage                                                         238


 R.

 =~Russo-Japanese War.~=
   Advance in thin skirmish lines                                76, 77
   Ammunition, expenditure and supply of                            473
   Formations under artillery fire                             321, 322
   Frontage                                                         238
   Infantry attack                                             137, 340
   Local reconnaissance                                             250
   Machine guns                                                     290
   Rushes                                                            89
   Strength of opposing forces                                      341
   Wounds, character of                                             128

 =~Russo-Turkish War~=, 1877-78.
   Ammunition, expenditure of                                       472
   Attacks                                                     222, 223
   Frontal counter-attacks                                          438
   Losses                                                           176


 S.

 =~St. Privat~=--see Gravelotte.

 =~St. Quentin~=, January 19, 1871.
   Attack on Grugies, isolated                                      403
   Bayonet attack                                                   103

 =~Sandepu~=, 1904.
   Losses among officers                                            190

 =~Sapignies.~=
   Cavalry charge                                                   302

 =~Scheinovo~=, January 9, 1878.
   Ammunition, expenditure of                               94, 95, 473
   Cavalry charge                                                   303
   Losses                                                        94, 95
   Rushes                                                        94, 95
   Simultaneous attack                                              361

 =~Sedan.~=
   Ammunition, expenditure of                                       469
   Cavalry charge                                         308, 310, 311
   Losses among officers                                             51
   Mixing of organizations                                          197
   Packs, removal of                                                469

 =~Shaho~=, 1904.
   Advanced positions                                               348
   Artillery, capture of                                            326
   Attack formation of a brigade                                    343
   Battle lines, density of                                         239
   Frontage                                                         239
   Infantry attack                                                  343
   Intrenching tools, use of                                        388
   Machine guns                                                     292
   Reserves                                                         396

 =~Shiliho~=, 1905.
   Attack                                                           344
   Rushes                                                            90

 =~Shipka Pass~=, 1877.
   Short range fire                                                 153

 =~Skalitz~=, 1812.
   Jägers                                                            23
   Mixing of organizations                                          196

 =~Slivnica~=, November 17 and 19, 1885.
   Losses at long ranges                                            177

 =~Solferino~=, 1859.
   Bayonet fight                                                    382
   Battle lines, density of                                         240

 =~Soor~=, 1745.
   Losses                                                           189
   Frontal counter-attack                                           437

 =~Soor~=, 1866.
   Jägers                                                            23

 =~South African War~= (1899-1902).
   Assaults                                                         379
   Crawling                                                      87, 88
   Front, overextension of                                          238
   Lessons gained from the                                      88, 340
   Machine guns                                                     289
   Mounted infantry                                                  25
   Rushes                                                            88
   Skirmish lines, thin                                              75
   Surrenders                                                       192
   Wounds, character of                                             129

 =~Spicheren.~=
   Advance in assembly formation                                    210
   Ammunition, expenditure of                                       469
   Attack, orders for                                               349
   Change of front                                                  220
   Concentration                                                    210
   Counter-attack                                                   436
   Envelopment                                            357, 358, 360
   Formation in echelon and in line                             74, 226
   Front, change of                                                 220
   Frontage                                                         226
   Knapsacks, loss of                                               364
   Losses                                                           195
   Mixing of organizations                                     196, 226
   Orders for attack                                                349
   Stragglers                                                       195

 =~Spionskop~=, 1900.
   Crawling                                                          88
   Losses at short ranges, insignificant                       178, 189
   Reserves                                                         340


 T.

 =~Tagliamento~=, 1797.
   Attack formations                                                 45

 =~Tashkessen~=, January 1, 1878.
   Ammunition, expenditure of                                       473
   Frontal counter-attack                                           438

 =~Tel el Kebir~=, 1882.
   Night attack                                                     233

 =~Terrayama~= (Temple Hill), October 11, 1904.
   Attack                                                           343
   Bayonet fight                                                    382
   Intrenching tools, use of                                        388

 =~Tobitschau~=, 1866.
   Cavalry charge                                                   313

 =~Towan~=, 1904.
   Perseverance under fire                                          348

 =~Trautenau~=, 1866.
   Bayonet attack                                                   153
   Jägers                                                            23
   Packs, removal of                                                364
   Rencontre                                                        339
   Trumpet signal, misunderstanding caused by                        42

 =~Tsinortun~=, August 26, 1904.
   Counter-attack                                                   435

 =~Tugela~= (Pieters Hill), 1900.
   Rushes                                                            95

 =~Tuminling Pass~=, 1904.
   Losses, officers                                                 190


 V.

 =~Vauxchamps~=, February 14, 1814.
   Infantry versus cavalry                                          313

 =~Villepion~=, December 1, 1870.
   Holding wavering troops                                          382
   Intrenching tools, use of                                        388

 =~Villermain-Cravant~=, 1870.
   Flank march along hostile front                                  360

 =~Villiers~=, October 30, 1870.
   Influence of the ground on the efficacy of fire                  183

 =~Vimiero.~=
   Frontal counter-attack                                           437

 =~Vionville.~=
   Abridged attack                                                  330
   Advance in broad formations                                       67
   Ammunition, expenditure and supply of                       469, 470
   Artillery fire diverted by infantry                              327
   Cavalry charge                                    302, 304, 311, 313
     Moral effect of                                                302
     Preparation by artillery fire                                  313
   Close order formations, losses in                           102, 103
   Concentration                                                    209
   Cover, use of                                                    257
   Direction of retreat                                             440
   Flanking fire                                                    254
   Losses in close order formations                            102, 103
     Officers                                                       190
   Masks                                                            120
   Moral effect of a cavalry charge                            302, 303
   Packs, removal of                                                364
   Rencontre                                                        339
   Reserves, employment of                                          397
   Retreat                                                          440
   Trumpet signal, misunderstanding caused by                        42
   United attack, necessity of a                                    403
   Volley fire, ineffectiveness of                                  164

 =~Vouziers~=, December 15, 1870.
   Surprise                                                         331


 W.

 =~Wafangu~=, June 15, 1904.
   Attack                                                           341
   Communication                                                    247
   Distribution in depth, excessive                                 223
   Envelopment                                                 341, 359

 =~Wagram~=, 1809.
   Attacking column, formation of                                44, 45

 =~Waterberg~=, 1904.
   Assaulting guidons                                               355
   Machine guns, employment of                                      283

 =~Waterloo~=, 1815.
   Attacking column, formation of                                44, 45
   Battle lines, density of                                         240
   Concentration                                                    209
   Frontal counter-attack                                           437

 =~Weiszenburg~=, August 2, 1870.
   Losses among officers                                        51, 190
   Masks                                                            120

 =~Wörth~=, August 6, 1870.
   Assault                                                          376
   Assaulting distance                                              385
   Attack, orders to                                                349
   Battle lines, density of                                         240
   Cavalry charge                                              310, 311
   Change of front                                                  220
   Colors                                                            69
   Concentration                                                    209
   Counter-attack                                                   433
   Distance, elimination of, during advance                          72
   Distribution in depth                                            224
   Fire while in motion                                              93
   Interference by the commander-in-chief                           248
   Losses                                                           227
     Officers                                                        51
     Relative, officers and men                                     190
   Mixing of organizations                                          196
   Moral effect of fire                                             191
   Officers, losses among                                            51
   Orders to attack                                                 349
   Packs, removal of                                                364
   Panic                                                            440
   Passage through woods                                            333
   Reserve, employment of the                                       395
   Stragglers                                                       196
   Supports                                                         224
   Uphill fire                                                      183
   Woods, passage through                                           254


 Y.

 =~Yalu~=, 1904.
   Ammunition, expenditure and supply of                            473
   Attack                                                           341
   Bayonet fight                                                    382
   Losses, officers                                                 190
   Machine guns                                                     291

 =~Yangtsuling~=, 1904.
   Attack                                                           343

 =~Yoshirei~=, July 31, 1904.
   Formations under artillery fire                             321, 323

 =~Yuhuntun~=, 1905.
   Perseverance under fire                                          348

 =~Yuputz~=, March 1, 1905.
   Sand bags, use of                                                390

 =~Yushuling~=, 1904.
   Intrenching tools, use of                                        388


 Z.

 =~Zella.~=
   Counter-attack                                                   433




 Transcriber’s Notes


 Depending on the hard- and software used to read this text, not all
 elements may display as intended.

 The language used in this text is that of the printed book, including
 the use of inconsistent, erroneous, unusual or archaic spelling,
 hyphenation, capitalisation, punctuation, etc., except as indicated
 under Changes below. This applies to proper and geographical names
 and non-English words and phrases as well; accents and diacriticals
 have not been added or corrected unless mentioned below.

 The use of physical units has not been corrected; for example, the
 author regularly uses m for speed, kgm for energy, etc.

 In addition to the abbreviations given on page xxi, the book
 regularly uses differently abbreviated or shortened titles (sometimes
 single words) or translations of references; this has not been
 standardised.

 Page ix, Table of Contents: the differences between the Table of
 Contents and the headings in the text have not been rectified. Apart
 from (minor) differences in wording, not all headings in the text
 occur in the Table of Contents, and not all entries in the Table of
 Contents occur as headings in the text. Any auto-generated Table of
 Contents may therefore differ from the one on page ix ff.

 Page 71, “in double column of twice the width of front”: the source
 document was unclear at this point, the text might also have read “in
 double column or twice the width of front”.

 Page 183, 187: (Général) Le Joindre is the author of the publication,
 but his name is presented here as part of the title.

 Page 195, troop diagram: due to width restrictions, the diagram had
 to be split into two rows (as it was in the printed book).

 Page 475: The table appears to contain totals that do not agree with
 the data provided. Since it is not clear where the error was made,
 these calculations have been left as they were: row Germany, last
 column; row Austria, last column but one; row France, last column.

 The table contains footnote markers, but there are no corresponding
 footnotes on this or the following pages. In an earlier edition of
 the book, the footnotes (using the numbering from the table in this
 text) were as follows:

 [513] The strength of a company is assumed as 200 men (England
       excepted).
 [514] 10 Cartridges packed in a box.
 [515] New “D” ammunition.
 [516] During the Russo-Japanese war.


 Changes made

 Some minor obvious typographical and punctuation errors have been
 corrected silently; some tables have been split or re-arranged for
 better readability.

 Footnotes and illustrations have been moved outside text paragraphs.

 Spaced and non-spaced and italicised or regular “i.e.”
 and “Ibid./ibid.” have been standardised to “_i.e._” and
 “_Ibid._”/“_ibid._” “Minarelli Fitzgerald” has been standardised to
 “Minarelli-Fitzgerald”.

 Page 8: “sans le comprendre” and “sans le faire” changed to “sans la
 comprendre” and “sans la faire”.

 Various pages: “Wald und Ortsgefecht” and “Gruppen und
 Einheitsangriff” have been changed to “Wald- und Ortsgefecht“ and
 “Gruppen- und Einheitsangriff”.

 Page 11, footnote [18]: opening quote marks inserted before When one
 attempts ....

 Page 93: closing quote marks inserted after ... (300-400 paces).

 Page 143, footnote [139]: closing quote mark deleted at end of
 footnote.

 Page 162: “_... seit dem Jahre_, 1900,” changed to “_ ... seit dem
 Jahre 1900_,”

 Page 180: B′, C′ and D′ in the text have been changed to B, C and D
 cf. the illustration. Footnote [170]: angles have been transcribed α,
 β and γ for consistency with the illustration and the text.

 Page 195: Negrier changed to Négrier; footnote anchor [191] inserted.

 Page 229: closing quote mark inserted after ... the size of this
 echelon.

 Page 253: “Patrouillen und Radfahrkommandos” changed to “Patrouillen-
 und Radfahr-Kommandos”.

 Page 257: “and that cover to be utilized only” changed to “and that
 cover be utilized only”.

 Page 265, table: the column header “Machine gun” has been considered
 to be a heading a single column only.

 Page 304, footnote [306]: closing quote mark inserted after ... of
 units in rear.

 Page 324: “Csicseries v. Bacsany” changed to “Csicserics v. Bacsany”;
 “Feldgeschüts” changed to “Feldgeschütz”.

 Page 354: closing quote mark inserted after ... the advance of the
 attacker’s infantry.

 Page 355: “veritable bouclier” changed to “véritable bouclier”.

 Page 395: “Helwig” changed to “Helvig”.

 Page 399: footnote [430]: “_pp._ 484 and 558” changed to “pp. 484 and
 558”; footnote [431]: “Les Expéditions de Tonkins” changed to “Les
 Expéditions de Tonkin”.

 Page 429: closing quote mark inserted after ... or for making a
 counter-attack.

 Page 458, footnote [491]: “détachments de couverture” changed to
 “détachements de couverture”.

 Indexes: some entries moved to their proper alphabetical order.

 Page 513: page number 363 changed to 263 (entry Machine guns, Kinds
 of fire, Switzerland).

*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK TACTICS, VOLUME I (OF 2) ***

Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions will
be renamed.

Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright
law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works,
so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the
United States without permission and without paying copyright
royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part
of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project
Gutenberg-tm electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark,
and may not be used if you charge for an eBook, except by following
the terms of the trademark license, including paying royalties for use
of the Project Gutenberg trademark. If you do not charge anything for
copies of this eBook, complying with the trademark license is very
easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose such as creation
of derivative works, reports, performances and research. Project
Gutenberg eBooks may be modified and printed and given away--you may
do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks not protected
by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the trademark
license, especially commercial redistribution.

START: FULL LICENSE

THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK

To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full
Project Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at
www.gutenberg.org/license.

Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project
Gutenberg-tm electronic works

1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or
destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your
possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a
Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound
by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the
person or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph
1.E.8.

1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this
agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm
electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below.

1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the
Foundation" or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection
of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual
works in the collection are in the public domain in the United
States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the
United States and you are located in the United States, we do not
claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as
all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope
that you will support the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting
free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm
works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the
Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with the work. You can easily
comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the
same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg-tm License when
you share it without charge with others.

1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are
in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States,
check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this
agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing,
distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any
other Project Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no
representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any
country other than the United States.

1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:

1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other
immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear
prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work
on which the phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the
phrase "Project Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed,
performed, viewed, copied or distributed:

 This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
 most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no
 restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it
 under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included with this
 eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the
 United States, you will have to check the laws of the country where
 you are located before using this eBook.

1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is
derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not
contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the
copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in
the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are
redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase "Project
Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply
either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or
obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg-tm
trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.

1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any
additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms
will be linked to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works
posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the
beginning of this work.

1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.

1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
Gutenberg-tm License.

1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format
other than "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official
version posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm website
(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense
to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means
of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original "Plain
Vanilla ASCII" or other form. Any alternate format must include the
full Project Gutenberg-tm License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.

1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.

1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
provided that:

* You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
 the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
 you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed
 to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he has
 agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project
 Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid
 within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are
 legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty
 payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project
 Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in
 Section 4, "Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg
 Literary Archive Foundation."

* You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
 you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
 does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
 License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all
 copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue
 all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg-tm
 works.

* You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of
 any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
 electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of
 receipt of the work.

* You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
 distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.

1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project
Gutenberg-tm electronic work or group of works on different terms than
are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing
from the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the manager of
the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the Foundation as set
forth in Section 3 below.

1.F.

1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project
Gutenberg-tm collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm
electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
contain "Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate
or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or
other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or
cannot be read by your equipment.

1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGE.

1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium
with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you
with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in
lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person
or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second
opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If
the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing
without further opportunities to fix the problem.

1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO
OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.

1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of
damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement
violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the
agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or
limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or
unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the
remaining provisions.

1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in
accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the
production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm
electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses,
including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of
the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this
or any Project Gutenberg-tm work, (b) alteration, modification, or
additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any
Defect you cause.

Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm

Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of
computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It
exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations
from people in all walks of life.

Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future
generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary
Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at
www.gutenberg.org

Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary
Archive Foundation

The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non-profit
501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary
Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by
U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.

The Foundation's business office is located at 809 North 1500 West,
Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up
to date contact information can be found at the Foundation's website
and official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact

Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
Literary Archive Foundation

Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without
widespread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
freely distributed in machine-readable form accessible by the widest
array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
status with the IRS.

The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular
state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate

While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
approach us with offers to donate.

International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.

Please check the Project Gutenberg web pages for current donation
methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To
donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate

Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works

Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project
Gutenberg-tm concept of a library of electronic works that could be
freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and
distributed Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of
volunteer support.

Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in
the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not
necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper
edition.

Most people start at our website which has the main PG search
facility: www.gutenberg.org

This website includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.